INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL EQUIPMENT
CATALOGUE 2013 EDITION
Available on the
Toll Free 800-LOC8 (5628) | Tel +971 4 368 1565 | Email contact@loc8.ae | Website.loc8.ae
App Store
WELCOME Welcome to the 2013 edition of the Loc8 Product Sourcing Catalogue. As always we have our regular ranges, however, we are also pleased to highlight many new featured ranges (see some below) and to show our improved catalogue layout. The layout has been changed to reflect both the project and direct sales elements of our business, and the projects section will give you a good insight into the sort of work we carry out on a daily basis for our clients. Our field sales team are all fully trained to give advice on all of our product offerings and will be pleased to come and visit you to discuss your requirements. In addition our website has been updated to better show our range of core products and a helpful chat function is provided should you require specific information or assistance. I hope you find the catalogue to be useful and easy to work with and we look forward to getting involved where we can.
Our project team will design, supply and install many storage and handling solutions e.g. Racking, shelving, mezzanine floors, dock solutions, work shop equipment etc that all meet UAE municipality requirements.
Free site survey and consultations and being able to offer multi product turnkey solutions we feel we are the ideal partner to help you with all your Materials Handling needs.
ISO Certificates
Quality assurance goes without saying in Loc8 Group as we always pride our selves in quality products and services and take great pride in the ISO accreditation we have been awarded. AIRLINE™
some of our New Products F A B R I C A I R T U Nin N E L this years Issue
Page 14
Page 48 Unit shown with optional mounting installation.
LOWER ENERGY COSTS AND INCREASE EMPLOYEE PRODUCTIVIT Y. The AirLine Fabric Air Tunnel delivers balanced ambient airflow with Spot-On™ Air Outlets every 15" throughout the length of the fabric air tunnel. Available in lengths of 30' to 80', the AirLine reduces energy consumption, as well as eliminates airflow obstructions and noise associated with both floor and wall mounted fans.
Page 58
Page 64
Page 29
We provide AutoCAD & Simulation design
.........347 ............ ............ ............... 234 ............ ........ Dumpers gs ................ 6 Ba 14 e .. Dunnag ............ 380 ............ ............ ............ or ........ ............ ..145 Dock Do ers ................ ............ dd ............ ... 142 ..... 278 Dock La ler ................ E ............ ............ .... .... 2 5 .... .... 16 ve .......... lleys .... Dock Le ........................ .................... 15 5 Carry Tro ........................ ...... 234 t .... Cash & .... .... ............ Dock Lif .......... 37 3 ............ Boards 5 ............ hts ........ 42 Caution ........................ .................38–4 Dock lig er .................... .................. 15 ............ 8 .... .... 23 50 ad ............ .... .234 CC Strap ........... Dock Lo ing Lights ........ ................... ............ ............ ............ 5 ............ Fan .... ........................ ........... 81 ad ........ 281 ............ Ceiling Dock Lo Pockets ........ 0, 224, .... Ear Plug ction ............ .................... 38 cks ........ ............ ....... 12 212, 390 401 nt Chair tru Room Locker ge Prote s .................... .................31 ........... 7 . Docume ........................ A Ed .... .... .... .... y g0 ard .... ........ ........ 50 Changin & Toiletries Trolle ................. 47 Dollies ers ................ .. 212, 39 Elbow Gu ive ................ ..................3 .... 9 g 0 ............ rri l Dr 13 ........ nts ........ Industries .... 25 Changin Door Ba ........................ ............ 212, 39 Electrica der Picker .... .....................3 l Absorbe al 77 0 .... ck Or ........ .. 230 .........164 Chemica Pharmaceutic .....................4 Door Lo or Gates ........ ............ 212, 39 Electric ............ er ........ ............ .... 164 77 .... emical & ic Stack ........................ .............474 ............ .... or Sciss Barriers ........ ................ 505 ed Roll ..........4 ts Ch ctr s Do .... rat uc nd Ele .... od rfo Sta .... .... .... 7 ng .... l Pe er 75 nt Pr 8–43 tor .... Response .... ............ ................. 47 ....... 81 or Warni Steps ............ ..........4 Chemica ..3 va Absorbe Rolls & Dispens .... .... Do s .... .... Ele .... ck .... .... l So 3 nt ........ 403 ........ 504 Sided cy Spill ............ ............ ..212, 390 Chemica Absorbe ............ ............ ............ ............ Double r Locker ........ .................... 18 Emergen nt ................ l Wipes ............ 72 ............ 4 63 nts ........ ............ .... Tie me ..59 Chemica cking Table .... ...................... Absorbe ........................ ..................... ............ ............ .................... 45 Double Environ ............ Pa .... .... als ........ -Gate .... ............ . 504 nt ........ ........ 71 Clinical with chain Access Drain Se binets ............ ............ Expand-A Internal Signs ............ ... 71 Equipme load gate .................... .........136 l& er Ca .. 224 akroom isure Products .... na .... aw .... Clo Access ter .... Dr .... .... .... Ex .... .... .... Steps room/Le with Hangers .... ........... 299 ............ .......... 193 ............ ........... 279 ak .... ets um Clo .... Access Dr bin .... .........3....47 9 ........ 7 m Unit ............ ............ rage Ca ............ ............ ... 214 Dollies Cloakroo Containers .... iners ......... 10 Acid Sto Board Trolleys s ................ 35 ories............ 234........ .... ....... ................ om 8 e 4 nta le nd Access ................ 225 Bo ........ Dumpers tat Drum Collapsibl Distribution Co .................. 29 Adjustab Work-Mate Sta .................. 14 F 146 RoBags ........or/ ..................... 1 Dunnage .............. e 8 ........................................ .... 380 rrier/ .... le 54 ........Ca .... 22 .. 29 ........ um Collapsibl Mesh Sides .... ................ Adjustab d Dock Leveler ..................... Dock Door ers ................ Dr..................145 ............ ..................... 1 142 ocks ..... 278 7 ................................um esys .............................. .... E .... ere 38Ladd ...............Ch . Dock SidTrolle ... 54 psible 162 .... 3, 39 .... re .... lla Leveler ................Dr .... 155 .... 21 .... Wi .... Co Dock Air-Pow y Identification ........ ........ .... 234 Dock Lift3 ........ ........................ .......... 375 tchers .... ........ ....... & Carry ........ .... ........ s .... ...................... 43 r .... 5 Clu ible Metal Cash Ba 49lights ........ ............ ......... 380 Board.... cto 22 & ps .. 155 42 ................ on.... .... ........ .38– um pa ...... ... le lla Cauti ........ .... ........ .... ........ .... Dock ........ 38–43 Dr ........ .... ........ Co om ........ .... Ais .... rs Strap ........ .... .... 34.... r/C................................ ... 238 ................ ........... 50 ....385 ................ hePlug ............ Dock Load ............ ............ .........2 8 er Lightetss........ 2 ................ ... 81 Protecto CCCeilin rkers .... ................ ............ ................ 224,Cr 92 281us g Fan .... Loading ............ ................ ........ .... Dock .364 ............ ............ Ear 120, .... ................ .31 ..........1 Dr... um ....401 23 Pock ColumnA Aisle Ma -Tread Stairs .......... 26 trucks ........Locker ................ ............ ersction ................ ............ ........ .... ........... Document ........................ ......... 212, 390 heEdge ........ ............ ............ adProte Room ds ........ .................... 1........ ........................ um 6 ............ 390 50 e ........ Chair Trolley ........ ng ........ ..... 477 3, Dollie 39sBarri 212,De Changing..........................3 215 86 ............ ............ Elbow Guar & Toiletries ........................ rsging.... ers .............. 212, 390 259 Drive Dr 13 .......... ................ Combifil .. ....21 Alternati Platform Truck ................... 50 s .... r ........ Door undeChan ................ ....tries Electrical Fan .... stem ............ oards ............ ........ Absorbent ....Indus -ro.164 ................ 212, 390 llies ric Order Picke ................ .........3.... 230 Lock 8 ........ all 3 .... aceutical .........477 m .... 7 t Chemical .... .... Do Door 48 24 Elect .... ................ 164 ac .... 21 Sy Gates ........ ........ niu pb .............. 74 .... .. er ........ & Pharm Roll ................ ......4 or .... ... 77 ........ um .... ........ mi ... ical 505 Cu .... mp Stack .... on ........ Sciss .... .... Dr ........... 81 Electers ric .... ers .................... ......277 Co cts ........ gs ........ Alu .... .............4 its Chem ........ ..................... 477 Door Warn Festo Perforated ........ ing Barri ................ Un ............ rbent Produ & Dispenser Stand 8–43 ......475 onse ........ mpElevatorgency........ t Security cks ............ .136 Chemical .... ........ 5Sided ............ m Steps 1 tin ck ........ ....... 331 Abso Steps ................................ Du .... 27 tan ................ ....403 .. Door Socks ........ ................ ....504 ..............3 390 Spill Resp .... ac 19 niu ical Tru 183 .... rbent Rollsmp ........ sis ........ le um .. .... y mi .... ........ 12, Chem .... Abso ........ ........ Tru Dr ........ ....454 Emer er .... .... Co ........ Wa .......... 72 Doub Alu ..........................................2.... .... et .... Wipes ........ ................ ............ Fire Re Tier Lock ........................ rbents ........ ........................ ..... 63 ..59 .... bin .... ers onment .... Chemical ing Table ........ Double minium ........ GrippEnvir Ca ............ 229 .... ........ ................ m Three ocks ............ ....... 472 Abso 6 71 ..125 Alu se ................ ute -Gate ........rpo ........ al Pack ................ ............ .... . 504 ys chain r Seals ........ ........................ 21 ets niu nd-A ad lle ........ Clinic with Access ment um .. Signs Drain mi mp Expa bin al ........ Pu Dr .............. 224 Exter Cogate................................ Alu 36 Tro room Equip Products ........ .... l Ch & Intern ss load e Ca ........... 71 Drawer6Cabinets Firm Lo ........... Cloak ............ 87 ure ........ ........ lernalAll ick.....1ing ................ 299 Steps 193 nd ........r/P ....... 279 m Whee ........................ ........ 484 Acce ... Ha .... Hangers 30 s ................................ le Storag ............ etsine Cloakroom Access ge Cabin 69 ............ ..../Leis .............. Unit with ........................ nta .......Drum ....room ................ ........um Dr 357 ....Cloak CoBoard Aluminu Dollie .... ......... 109 ....... 214 iners Trolleys s .................... Acid Stora s ........ nt .................1 8 es ........ ........ Flammab nveyor ............ ..................3 e Conta ....n.... 144 Containers .......... 298 225 ndler Boom ........ .....Ha Standrs .... ue ........ 75Accessori ............ .........127 Adjustable Collapsibl Fme -Mateine .............. 54 ........ Co er/Rotator/ ........um ........ .58 Work ........ lleeyDistributio ......2Drum ... 21 . e Tro nta ler ........ . 221 ....... 298 Drum Carri ks ................Dr Co Collapsibl Mesh Sides ........ ........ Anti Fatig pes & Treads ........ Adjustable .... Dock Leve ........................ Flexible es ................ ................ 391 ............ e rag ........ ling Equip .................... 216 387 ... 54 owered ion r Sto ....Sides Drum 4Choc hers ........................ Collapsibl Meta l Wire ificatine Ta ...213,Hand ............ ................ 493 ................ ............ e .... 57 an Bay Ident .... 89 Air-P .... 30 um –43 nta ................ .............. ................ ................. 380 ....psibl.... Drum Clutc er/Compactor ............................38.... ....... 225 Aisle & Co Dr Anti-Slip Containers .... ers ........ ........... ys Colla ........ ........238 Protectors ............ Crush Floor Cr hic Markers .... ....................... ................ 92 ............ lle262 s ........ Drum .... .....364 Column ........ Aisle Mark -Tread Stairs ........ ............ .................... .... Tro .............. ck 1 5 ........ ................ ........ aders ........ ......................1 .... r .... .... tic ........ Ja 18 89 29 ........ Dehe 391 506 .... ifile 215 ating ........ ine .... 56 . .... ... .... .. ap ........ 8Truck ....86 ..1 Drum um .. 213,17 Altern Co rm .... all-rounders ............ nta ........ .... ........ ................ Fan ........ .... s ........ Dr........ ........... Platfo ................ ... 243 ....Comb Anti Sta System rity Cupboards e Boxes ............ Floor Gr fication ........ ...................... ... 217 ............ Drum Dolliepers ................ Compact g Units ........ .......... 488 Aluminium Steps ................ ........ s on.... ........cks .... ......277 terFesto ................ ..Lif ............ 84Dum ers ................Dr s ........ tant Secu Truck ................ ...... 275 ..1Drum 9 actin........ Truck r Tru....... 331 l Storag iner ................ .... nti 57 Comp.... Wayine Aluminium Three .... et ........ ........ 191 .........136 ........ Fire Resis Aluminium um .... ........ 25 ................ ... 472 9 uter Cabin g Trolleys ................ CoWheenta ets ........ Archiva ........ 18 ...22.... Drum Gripp ler All Purpose Carrier Aluminium Floor Ide Marking Tape ....................... ........ l Chocks .......... 216 ..............1 Firm Be484rmsComp ge Cabin ................ e Load .... ........ t .... Conta Hand 306 .... 2 iner/Pickin ................ en ................ ........Mo ................ .187 bil mable Stora ................ .... ve ..369 ....... Drum .... ........ 24 Conta ........ Aluminum ................ 95 ........ 2 .... oti ........ inm Flam ne .... ............ge Trolley ........ .... .................................58 ..........1 um ue nta ................ .....127 ....... Drum Handlersling EquipmentDr........ ..275 218 Conv er Autom Anti FatigCo s & Treads adseyor ........ BoomConta Flexib ......... 36 ................ 304 ............... 216 Floor La tion Labels .... ................ .... LoleCrane Tape .... ............ Hand t t 89 sContainers .... iner Stora .... ................ .... ................ .... ...57 ........ lle ................ ...............Pa .... en Drum Anti-Slip Containersinm ............ .... 67 ers ........ ys ........ Floor ........ .... 87 .... s ........ ... ca .1 ........um ..189 hic Mark ........ 295 iner Trolle ........................ ................ .......... 56 nta 178Drum Jack s ................Dr Conta.... ....181.... Anti Static Boxes ............................. ck .... .... Co Floor Grap ....... ............ .................... 57 ion ........ .... ................ .... ........ Trucks 84 Storage Floor Lo ............ 6 Lifter .... .... ................ Identificat ing Tape ........ .... .... er ........ ............ 189 llets .... s .... Drum ....... 57 Container nt Berm iner ........ible Tru Archival ..............1 2 4 Carri Floor .... ........ le Conta .... ........ Pa 23 ........ .... 0 Mark .... ........ Mobi 21 ....Booms ................................ 362 ........ um......195 ........ Conta ....inme Automotive ls.... ...... Drum Floor Lane tion .... Dr ........ ............. 57 ........... t Loader Convert or Scale g ................ .......24 er ........Labe........ inment ......... 14 Flo Loca ................ ........ ............................... 67 Drum Palle ts .........................................187 sitFloor .... ard ....Contaertibl ........ .... ion .... Gu 5 .... ........ .... e Truck llin 1 Palle 234 ........ .... ........ Po or 216 ....d ..........................................5.... 23 5 na Drum .... ............. 140 ........ ....Guar Floor Scale lling ........ 3, 39 ............... ............ ioner ........ Drum ....eyor B ConveyB ....Conv ........ ........ 335 ... 21 ers ........ ................ Drum Posit ioners ................ ....... 213, 391 Floor Sig .................... or Tape ........ 33 ............23 ............ Floor Signa ................ Tape .... 35 ................ 195sitionSlats ........ ........ Floor.... 35Posit s ........................ h ........ Conv Po Drum ...... 110 .... ts Floor cations Applications .....2 .... ............... Flo 5 .2 ....s &.... Appli ........um nsashash Appli ................ 196 ....... 195 108 Bag Cordlas ....cator ...... 110 tioCordl Drum Rack Stack ........Dr Cordl ...........23 ....Large tio Floor Sla Applicators & ns ns Containers ............................... ................ 222 Dunnage Appli s Tape catio ca pli....ca 398 ...389 ckFloor 5Rack Units ................ Ap........ ............ CordstrapgStrap ....... 519 h ........ Appingpli Foldable ...............Ra ................ 42 ... 23 196 as........ .................... ........um 238 Small Conta Batrap rdl........ ....iners .... Drum ........ ................ ........ Drum Rack ................Dr ................ ....... 222 iners .... ............... 108 Co or Tape ............ ageCords ........ 273............ Foldable ck ........ nta ........ .... .42 Trolley Flo ................ Rings s ns 280 nn l trolleysDu....... Steps r Protectors d Glove 223 ck Sta ................ Co .... .509 ........ ble ........ Drum whee tio ........ Corne ........ Bactainer .... 9 ........ 8 ........ ........ .... Folda four- tra........ p ........ .... 285 gCottoAp rge ca ................ ...........39 ........ Ra Dotte 4 ... 38 Slings 39 n Drillpli Shelf Truck age and rds ......................................311 ........... 222 ........ um Drum iners ........ ..213, 391 ............ Dr........ Folding its ........ iners .... ............... 519 ........ ........ Co ................ ............ ldable La Truck ........ ............................. pin ............ 8 Bagg Spill Conta ................ 226 nta Fo .191 .373 ap .... Un .... ng Steps ........................ .... ............ ..............240 Drum Co Coverall ........ Baggage ........ ........ s ........ Foldi ........ Str .... ers ck ........ ........ 42Stack High Lift ........ ........ .... Carts........ Ra 192 ced Truck ........tra ............ ................ ........ Small .... 395 ....... 380 .... .....375 Cradl ........ 273 ... 222 ........... ............ ........Drum Footbrake .... limber rds ........p........ .... ....e.... Drlsum ................ 285 ............ s ........ Co ................ 374 ........ ............ lleys ............ 23 Balan Steel Forks ............ ....... 79 ...... rs Crawler Stairc ers ........ Drum Stand s For Steel Barre ............ 199 Foldable 87,.... Ball Table ........................ ............ .... Forged.... Protectors ........ .............1 ........cto ................ 234 es ............ 2Standge Pallet Systems........um -Over Ladd 196 gs r Trolley .... 55 ................ tro ....... ........ Drum ......161 Steps .... r sPr........ote 223 09 ed Truck ............ ...........Rin Fork Blade ............ ........ ves................ ... 280 Bar Cradl ................ 281 alanc rne ............ ................ .........4 Glo 5 Dr ........ ws/B Co ............ .... d Cross Bactaine d four-wheel Drum Stora ge Units ........ ................ ................tte ......... 320 ........ 201 Cupboards ........................ Stand ............ 1 ....sions ............ Foldable elf Truck ........ .....................5 Fork Exten ............ 285 Barro .... ers ........ ............ ................ ........ill Do 200ngs Lift Cages er .... ........37 4Stora .... 318 .187 ....Floor ......280 ................ ............... Drum CW Strap .... Bay Mark ys ................ Sli e an Dr Fork ............ Front Load Sh ................ 3 ................ ....DoubleersSided rs sed um...... 200 tedine Store ........ EncloDr Trolle tto........n........ ........ der ....0 ... 39 ....32 ...37 ........ 227........ ................ ............ ................ ......311 Co Baggag ..213, 39 Fully Fork Moun ........ ............ 6 Beam ............ nta Folding Lock .... Cylin .... Trolley ................ ted Jibs y ........................ 201 ill CoMoun 73 ............ ....Stand ...................321 ..2Drum .... .... t Floor Drum .......... 85 Cylinder .... Bedding ............ .... ..........Sp ................l................ Fork 40Storess Horizontal ........ Heigh ............ pers .....3 e Truck ........ ........ Fork Cadd ral ....Low Conveyor ve ................ .......... 320 . 222 um ........ .... Drum Store s Vertical ........ ........ 469 .....191 Brush Swee................ 371 Cylinder ng Steps .................... .............373 .... Dr Fork Truck Moun .... .... ted.... ......... 22 Belt Co ............ Baggag .... ldi ................ 189 .... Stand ................ ........................ .... Pallet Cage Floor .... s Store .... 321 468 Fo .... ........ ........ der hes 512 ... ers ck .... Truck ....... .... Drum ....... ........ ........ .... Cylin .... .... ........ Fork .... lever ........ e Sided .... rts 0 ........ ........ Stack .... 5 Benc hes Cantiad ........ ........ Singl.... d Tru Ca........ Tow Balls t............ ............ 295 ........ 513 ................ s ............13 le........ Drum Tiers porter ................ Duty Cylin um .......... 191 ... 192 rake .... rks ................ .............375 Forktruck Steps .............. ....9 ... 38 r derder.... ........ ............ ................ 39 Benc Lif Dr ................ 1 ........ .... Medium Stand ........ -Up Cage .... h Balance otb Trans .... ed 300 beCylin ..320 188 hesCr Steps .... ... .... Fo Paint lim Arrow ....29 .... Drum le Hig ........ r ........ Lock Benc rs ........ ls ........ Fort ge ........ Mobi ........irc 157 rre 159 Stora 5 le Corlettetaw s .... ................ ing Traile Sta 79Transporte 190 nd Heavy Duty ...321 ........ Aisle ........ ....... Sta ................ .... SteerBa ....... Cylinder Racks 199 ler ............ Steel Fo Fort .... 374 rman el Narrow ........ .......Drum ................ ............... Storage Palle ........ ........................ ... 124 ers der Drr um 219 r Ste Ball Table .................... .....321 .......... 28 BicycBag Cr ........ Drum Truck rsal Transporte ................ ............... 314 Units ........ Fol Acke Forged ........ ............ 6 dd Cylin ........... Four Whee ctors .... .............187, .... ........ ................ La Storage .... r ........ ........ 220 nds Emptying Skip ................ ms ........ 4Unive der ................................ ............ ........ 55 BigBins ........ge........Units les ve Drum .... ........ ........ ........ ......... 382 Cylinder ....ys Sta ....... 177 ste........ Front de Prote .... Sy........ s-O um 8 ................ ... 19 0 ..161 ric Stack der Trolle ... 310 .... Dr........ lleert ........ Drum UpenBasins ................ ........... 23 Bar Crad alanced Trucks Bin StoraCros .... ...........19 Full ElectPa ...........28 ................ .... Cylin.... Fork Bla sions ............ ................ ................ .................... 98 rage .... ............ 201 ............ 0–26 Reten 0tion ing ........................ 1 BollardsHole........ ............ ............ ........ rs ........ /B .............1 Funnels rds Sto ...............1 370 Castopb oa........ ........ Trolleys ........ ten ............ 375 um ... .... Sump Floor ts ................ ........ ............ D nd ......... 32 Dr........ ......... 188 FurnitureUnits Cu Barrows rs .................... .................... 28 Bolt ................ .... Shelving Fork Ex 106.... ............ ............ ............ Sump ................ Truck ........ ...... 213, 391 rage Boltless ............ 8PalleDrummpac ............ Sto rke ap........ 28 335 s ................Str ........ Floor Sta ............ 31 tor ........um......2 ............ ........... 200 t Cages nt Loader ........ .........187 Universal ......280 Boom ............ ed .............. Lif .... ........ Dr ................ er/Co .... CW .... Bay Ma ........ .... rk Sid 25 ........ 284 Crush s .... ........ .... Fo eyor .... G .... ........ ub.........le431 .......186–2 87 re .... ........ ...........402....Drum 0 Belt Conv 7 Boxe Sweeperlin lleys Do........ Sto8 r ........ 32Drive ............ 3 ................ um s ........ .....1 ................ unted Fro ............ closed Drum .. 200 ling Truckde........................ 332 ........ ling ........ ................ Dr .................... Cy ..410 Beam Tro lley ............ .................... 22 Brush ........ Bulk Hand Fully En ..........264 Fork Mo ted Jibs ........ Drum Hand ling Equipment ....................18 ........... 37 ys ers Day Care Trolle ............ ................ ................ nd .................... 34 7 res 1 ........................ ........um Trolley Tro ........r Lock Sto Tanks ........ .............2 ...Drum 32Hand or nSta ............ ............21 .. 85 Bulk ........ ........de 201 ........ un tal .... ........lin .. .... Flo .373 Trucks .... 470 89 on t Mo ..... ersCy ntaminatio ........................ .... tedDr Lifter 236 .... y .... .... Load ......1 .... riz Bedding ........ Deco rk Bump ....... Moun igh Drum .... dd .... ........ ........ ........ Fo .... Ca Deck Firm 34 ............ pers .... ................ 189 res Ho ................ 0 sleFork 9 eyor .... ........Sto s ........ Low He Desiccants ........ 363 .............2 .. Drum ........ ............ Galvanized ........................ 32Lifter Lock.... 1 Carrier ck Fork h Swee ................ 87 .... .502 l Code.... ................ ................ ............ um al............ ..364 ..... 222 Drum Mobi t Loader ........ Dr CylindeCr llet CageDigita .............1 Gantries Belt Conv .................... .................... 46 ............ ................ ........ ........ 37 s ........ ................ 282 Fork Tru Mounted Brus Vertic ................ ..........168 res ........ nd ............. 42 ............ Dispensers or Sta ........ Drum Palle 1 ........ Gantry Crane s Portable ........ .... ............ 9 ........ Sto r Pa s .... 468 2 Stand ........ .92... 32 Positioner Systems 213, .... 18 ................ ........ 139 391 ........ ck de y Crane ........ 51 ... ... .... ............ .... DisplayFloDusk Mask ........ ................ lin .... inment Drum Drum Tru .... Gantr ed .... ....... .... .... .... ........ Cy .... Conta Benche er rk iner .... .... Sid Disposablen/Packing Rails ........ 163 254 .... Fo lls Conta ................ ....ent.... ......... 272 ........ gle. 324 Drum Rack .287,.... s ........ ................................ ................ 189 rsGarm 9 ers &........ ............ ............ der Cage s Cantilev Duty ................ ...... 295 ............ Stack .... 279....Drum inment um k Tow Ba der........Sin Distributio .... ......137 ............ .. 191 Gas Cylin Trucks.... ................ .... 13 n Trucks ge Conta .... 513 Dr...................Tie 6 ........ Cyeslin Benche .... ................ Purporse ....ets ........................ 137 ........ m Distributio ................ge Forktruc Steps ............ s ............ Drum Stora porter ................ ................. 190 Gene ................ Cabin poralrte nd34–3132.... ............... ................ ............ 291 ys 149 ........ ........ Ca ........ Sta Bins Trans . 191 nsGeneral Storage 302 20 8 r s Mediu ........................ ........ 300 Cable bridg p ed ps DIY Trolle ........Tra s ........ Drum rs ........ d ........ ..3 18 .............. 49 ........ Flat Top de he -U int Rack ................ ge Pa um row Ste porte .... ........ ... lin nc ck 150 77 e Reel Ar ........ .... Dr Stora Trans Plate ........ r .... ........ .... ..... ....... e LoDock Be bil rs Cable Cy .... ........ Drum .... ........ r Zinc .... .............1 Generalrte ys ........ cades Fort ................ s ........ 188 nspoFibre Trolle lever Rack Trans ........ ... 334 ................ Door.... ............ ... 190 1Truckporte Dock Barri .... ..... 328 n.... Storag Duty Mo Steering Traile ... 159 ............ ....... 157 Canti Corlette r Tra 32 Glass Inserts le ............... y ................ ... 150 ...Drum ................ .... ................ le de PVC lin s Bug Scree ........um av Ais 88 334 ........ and yc ........ .... ck .... Dock .....1 w He ....... Dr Aisle ........ .... Card Cy ........ .... ........ 150 Drum Truck Narrow ........................ Bic .... rro ................ e Ra Dock BumperersRetra ............ Fort e ........ ........ ................rag rman .... ..... 328 r ........ Drum 4 Cargo Bars ................r ........ ....ctabl Sto.............. 21 Universal Drum Truck Na ............ 9 Pallet .... .... 359 Deckerslin eel Acke ip .................... ....... 314 ................ ......... 149 de................ Dock Shelt nsporte ........ Drum Truck ........ ....153.....3 ers ........ ................ ....... 21 Cyping ........ Big Bag ........................ ................... 12 Cargo e Units Strap Four Wh .... ........ ms ........ Dock Shelt c Syste.... rag... 374 ........... iversal Tra ............ ................ ........ .... ............ .... 280 r Sto ................ 7 ............ ptying Sk Dock Traffi .... . 382 Cargo de........ Carousels lin........ ................ 433 ........ s ........ Drum Un der ................ ................ 220 Cy........ Bins .... e Units ............ Poles ............ ................ ........ .......ys Front Em Stacker ........ ................... 17 Dockboard lle en .... 0 Carpett TrolleCarty ........ Tro ... 278 ........r........ ............ ic 0 .... ........ de ................ lin ....... 31 Carpe Drum Up Basins ............ ............... 198 Bin Storag .................... Carry-OutCy Nestable ........ Full Electr ........................ ................... 28 Carry ............ .... n .... .... 26 Cash & .... tio 98 .... .... 0– .... .1 rds ten .... .... .... .... ...1 Re Bolla Funnels ys ........ stors .... .................... oring .... ........................ . 188 lle 0 Ca Flo le 37 Tro e Ho ... mp .... .... Su .... Bolt Furnitur ts ........ ........................ 391 ............ elving lle 6 .... Sh Pa 10 .... ss ck D Sump 213, Boltle ............ 5 ............ .......... l Drum Tru ............ ............ Universa r/Compactor .... ..............228 ............ Booms .......... 33 ............ 4 ............ ........ ushe 25 Boxes .... per ................ ................. 28 G Drum Cr Conveyor ...............186–2 1 ee ........ ive Belt 87 ... 402 Brush Sw ling Trucks .... .................... 43 Drum Dr ling ................ .....................1 ............ 10 .... 2 .... 8 .... nd nd 33 .... .... ......4 Bulk Ha y .................... .................... Drum Ha ling Equipment .................... 18 lleys .... .................... .234 Tro lle .... nd .... re 217 64 .... s .... .... Day Ca Bulk Tro Drum Ha ............ ............ ............ tion Tank .................... 470 s ..........2 6 .... .... .... na .... .... mi ter 89 ad Truck ......... ............ Deconta Bumpers Drum Lif s Fork Mounted ..................1 Firm Lo ........... 23 nts ........ ........................ .........234 ter 3 ............ ........ 189 ed Deck s Desicca Drum Lif e Carrier .... .... ............ Galvaniz ........................ .................... 36 de Lock 02 ............ bil ............ 87 ............ Digital Co .................... .....................5 ......364 ntries Drum Mo t Loader ........ .....................1 .... .... Ga .... .... .... es 42 .... ers lle 68 2 .... an ........ C Dispens nd ................ ..................... ........ 28 Drum Pa ioner ............ stems ..........1 Gantry Cr es Portable .... ............ 1 Sta .92 y Cran um Posit ntainment Sy 213, 39 ............ ................ 139 Display Mask .... r ................ ntr Dr ... .... sk Ga .... .... Du .... Co 2 ine .... 3 ble .... ck t Rails ............ 87, 254 Disposa /Packing Conta ................. 27 Drum Ra ers ................ t ................ 16 Garmen .........2 Cages 9 4 on 9 ........ s ........ ..............137 Cylinder um Stack e & Containmen ............... 18 ......... 32 Distributi Trucks ........ .................... 27 ck s Dr .... Ga Tru .... se on .... rag ........ ........ ........ –36 Purpo . 190 137 Distributi .................... ............ ....... 34 2 Drum Sto porter ............ General Cabinets s ................ 2 ............ 9 ys dges .... ............ ns ............ ......... 191 Storage Bin 30 ........ 14 DIY Trolle Cable bri Racks ............ .................. 13 Drum Tra porters ........ General Flat Top ............ ............ .... el 49 ns ted ........ 77 ............ Storage ............ ..... 150 Dock Cable Re Rack ................ ................... Drum Tra porter Zinc Pla .....................1 General ys ........ ............ rricades .... er re Trolle Trans ........ ... 188 Fib Dock Ba Screen Doors .... ............... 334 s ........ ................. 328 .... .... um ss Cantilev ert .... Dr .... Gla Ins .... .... .... d PVC ............ ........... 150 ck Bug .188 Truck .... w Aisle ........ ... 334 .... Do .... ............ .... .... um Card an .... .... .... Dr .... ers .... .... .... mp rs .... ............ ck Narro ............ . 328 Dock Bu er Retractable ................ 150 Cargo Ba ers ................ Drum Tru Universal .... ............ elt .... 9 ck ck ............ . 149 Dock Sh ers ................ Cargo De ping ............ .......... 35 Drum Tru ............ elt 4 ap ............ ............ ... 153 Dock Sh Cargo Str ........................ .................. 37 Systems ............ ls ck Traffic ........................ 8:10 AM ............ ............. 280 Do .... Carouse .... 9 9:4 les .... 3/23/0 ards .... ............ 433 Dockbo Carpet Po lley ................ ........... 8 ............ Carpet Tro Cart ................ ................... 27 .... ut .... -O rry ble Ca sta Carry Ne Cash &
EX
T IND C U D O PR
3 Easy STEPS X
CT INDE
PRODU
STEP
SOURCING A PRODUCT?
Our easy to use Alphabetical Index (Page 500-502) will enable you to quickly search through all of our products with ease.
9:48:10 3/23/09
Xindex
STEP
1.indd
MATER IAL HAN DLING & LIFTING
GIC81Y
Model
HIGH LO
acity
GP166H
300 kg
Platform LxW x H mm
1185 x
580 x
315
Overall LxW x H mm 1220 x
690 x
900
Non Mar king Wheels 125 mm 2 Fixe Cushion d, 2 Swiv el
Weight (kg) 27
ALUMLN
GIC82Y
252 For Handling
1.indd
252
Model mor
e in fo
rma
tion
, vis i
GIC82Y t ww w
.loc
8.ae
or c all
toll
free
Maximum Load 300 kg
800-
LOC
Platform LxW x H mm
1500 x 8 (5 62
475 x
940
Weight (kg) 20
8)
3/23/09
LIAISON EXECUTIVE
15
IUM • Fold ing han FOLDING • Ligh dles tweight CompacPLATFORM • Non t design. TRUCK Markin Aluminium Fitted with 4 g Wheels x 125mm position manoeu ed fixed whe swivel whe els, and els, this vre. Folded 2 unit is Height: both stabx 125mm cen 275mm trall le and easy to y
Material
CALL AGENT
Weight (kg)
For a wi de se call lection, r 800-L OC 8
Retention Rod Stops etc. SlidinCartons g off platform the
ADING • High CASH AN platform • Rea D r neslinq for ease of load CARRY GP 100 of facility 166H these , allowin ing. nes occupie d by 25 table trolleys g easy acc ess to can be conven trolleys tional stor units (30m ed in the . space ). Model normally Cap
Simply call us on our freephone number 800-LOC8 (5628) and state the page number or model number where stated to our Call Agent.
CUSTOMER
S
LEY
Overall Dimensi ons LxW x H mm 960 x 570 x 950
GIC81Y
HD Attra ctive Plastic Platform
REQUEST FOR QUOTES
STEP
TROLLEY
E TROL
• Maxim • Hea um Load: 100 vy • Fold Duty Attract kg ing Top ive Pla Basket stic Pla tform The top addition ‘tip up’ basket easily al items. Wh is ideal for nes transpo en not in platform ted due to rting the tip use, the troll up tray Easily . eys manoeu and hing are swivel vrable ed bas rub on 4 x e Colour: ber castors 100mm , 2 with Red non-ma brake. rking
524
Xinde
CARRY
NESTABL
AM
d 524 x 1.ind
CASH &
ENQUIRY INFORMATION
10:06:28
AM
Our Call Centre Agent will log your enquiry into our CRM system and the relevant Liaison Executive will contact you to provide you with a detailed offer, delivery information or technical details, etc... Volume enquiries w ill improve un it prices in most cases .
FREEPHONE NO. : 800-LOC8 (5628) INTERNATIONAL : +971 4 3681565
FAX SERVICES : +971 4 3688017
EMAIL ADDRESS : contact@loc8.ae
ONLINE ACCESS : www.loc8.ae
CONTENTS PROJECTS 8-15
• Mezzanine • Shelving • Mobile Shelving • Racking • Mobile Racking • Workbenches
ENVIRONMENT 44-49
• Industrial Ceiling Fan • Airline Fabric Air Tunnel • Industrial AIR Coolers
LOADING DOCKS 50-59 • Loading Table • Dock Lift • Hydraulic Dock Leveler • Mechanical Dock Leveler • Air-Powered Dock Leveler • Under-Leveler Seal • Sectional Dock Door • Loading Dock Seals & Shelters • Scissor Dock Lift • Dock Lights
STORAGE 60-127
SHELVING 16-35
• Mesh Partitions • Anti-Collapse Systems • Industrial Netting • Wire Shelving • Plastic Storage • Cloakroom Equipment • Lockers • Security Cupboards • Storage Bins • Stack Nest Containers • Pallet Boxes • Storage Racks • Storage Vaults • Floor Slats • Archive Solutions • Roll Cages & Retention Units
• Boltless Shelving • Office Shelving • Shelf Ladders • Hand Pull/Push Drive • Mechanical Drive • Electrical Drive
SIGNS & IDENTIFICATION 128-141
• Numbers & Letters • Location Labelling • Stores Identification • Rack Holders • Label Holders • Document Pockets • Rack Identification
RACKING 36-39
• Mobile Racking • Drive-In Racking • Narrow Aisle Racking • Cable Reel Racks • Rack A-Frame • Pallet Racking
MEZZANINE 40-41 • Mezzanine Floors • Multi-Tier • Pallet Gates
WEAPONS STORAGE 42-43 • Military Weapons Storage
INDUSTRIAL PARTITIONING 142-143 • Double Skin Partitions • Mesh Partitions
WASTE MANAGEMENT 144-159 • Waste Containers • Runner Trolley • Mall Bins • Trash Cans • Spill Control & Containment • Skip Trucks • Hygiene Trolleys • Absorbent Rolls & Dispenser Stands
SPILL CONTAINMENT 160-179
• Spill Decks • Drum Rack Containment Systems • Stacking Shelf • Safety Cabinet Bladder Systems • Spill Drum Storage • Spill Pallet • Spill Tray • Spill Collectors • Spill Sump • Containment Berms
PACKAGING 364-373
• Packing & Workstation • Mini-Packing Station • Quality Management Station
SAFETY & SECURITY 374-375
• Security Wallets • Key Wallets • Reusable Security Pouch • Security Seals & Caters
WORKSHOP EQUIPMENT 376-411
DRUM HANDLING 180-203 • Fork Extensions • Drum Transporter • Drum Lifter • Drum Pallet Loader • Drum Stands • Drum Dollies • Drum Mesh Pallets • Drum Store • Drum Rack Stack • Drum Shelving • Stackable Drum Carriers • Drum Flooring • Drum Dumpers • Drum Grippers • Drum Controller • Drum Craddles • Drum Chocks
• Key Storage Box • Safety Matting • Headrail System • Drawer Cabinets • PVC Strip Curtains • Medium Duty Benches • Tool Trolleys • Cantilever Work Benches • Sliding Track • Mobile Tool Cabinet
CLOAKROOMS 412-415
• Leisure Products • Cloakroom Equipment • Benches
PREMISES 416-425
• Anti-Graffiti Wipers • Pacer System • General Purpose Absorbents • Line Marking & Paint
OFFICE 426-457 MATERIAL HANDLING 204-363
• Conveyors • Forklift • Tractors • Trolleys • Pallet Trucks • Netting • Pallet Wrapping Machines • Warehouse Doors • Dimensioning & Volumetrics • Strapping • Pushing Wheeled Load • Gantries • Sack Trucks • Cargo Trucks • Trailers • Garment Rails • Lifting Equipment • Yard Ramps • Bumps • Carousels • Electronic Weight Scales • Upholstery Element Cart • Automotive Container • Tyre Stacking Rack• Guard Rail Systems • Laundry Bags • Linen Cars • Mesh Pallets • Bicycle Corlette • Carts • Skates • Rolcontainers • Cylinders • Stabilizing Jacks
• Computer cabinet • Notice boards • White boards • Office Filing Systems • Noticeboards • Furniture • Office Screens • Cabinets • Drawing Hanger • Chair Mats • Seating • Canteen Tables
MAILROOM 458-465
• Whiteboards • Mailroom Benches • Sorting Systems • Distribution Trolleys
VISITOR MANAGEMENT 466-469 • Visitor Pass • Inspection System
ACCESS 470-491
• Kick Steps • Handy Steps • Folding Steps • Aluminium Steps • Ladders • Work Platforms • Office Steps • Tilt & Pull Steps • Mobile Platforms
HEALTH & ENVIRONMENT 492-499 • First Aid Kits • Trolleys • Hygiene Trolleys
LOC8 Projects LOC8 has an established projects division that has been carrying out warehouse refurbishment projects since 2005. This is a small selection of the products and services we can offer you in addition to the items in this catalogue. 1. Trakline™ PLUS The simple, low maintenance, high speed design for large openings up to 400 sq. ft. 2. Steel-Rite™ II Sectional Door Simple, straightforward, impactable design that helps reduce maintenance costs and downtime from sectional door damage. 3. Dock Levelers Designed for easy servicing and built to handle your most demanding dock operations. All models offer exceptional durability, reliability and the lowest lifetime ownership costs. 4. G-Flex™ Universal Door This modular dock door withstands most inadvertent fork truck impacts. Its flexible design allows for ventilation panels and/or Day-Lite translucent slats for natural light. 5. Eliminator-GapMaster™ II Soft-Sided Dock Shelter The industry’s only full access dock shelter that also provides high sealing efficiency and can save hundreds of dollars per year per dock position by preventing energy loss through exposed trailer door hinge gaps. 6. STR4000 Dok-Lok® Vehicle Restraint The industry’s only rotating hook restraint that stabilizes the truck trailer, which helps prevent catastrophic and chronic accidents and provides a smooth
loading dock. 10. DokSaver™ Dock Bumper Backed by a 10 year warranty, its revolutionary design protects your dock equipment and building wall by distributing trailer impacts over its entire back plate. 11. Dok-Lok® Vehicle Restraint Helps prevent all types of trailer separation using a unique rotating hook design, such as aggressive early departure, trailer creep and dock walk, as well as trailer tipover from landing gear collapse or trailer up-ending. 12. RainGuard™ Header Seal Exclusive weighted seal uses gravity to divert rain and melting snow off sides of trailer, keeping water out of the dock area. 13. ComboShelter™ II Dock Shelter Fully impactable dock shelter stands up to the unique challenges of docks that serve a variety of trailer traffic including trailers with liftgates and other rear extensions.
17. Thinman™ Truck Leveler Eliminates pit wall and bumper obstructions to efficiently access below-dock loads. Global Wheel-Lok Restraint comes standard. 18. Shelter Hoods Available in fabric or metal, hoods are designed to prevent damage to dock seals caused by ice and snow build-up or heavy rain. 19. TP II Series Dock Seal Constructed with durable foam side pads that cushion an incoming truck while providing the tightest seal possible between the truck and the loading dock. Standard Firefighter protection in header
14. Global Wheel-Lok™ Vehicle Restraint Secures
transition between the loading dock floor and trailer bed.
7. PitMaster™ Under-Leveler Seal The industry’s first and only seal to complete the job of the dock seal or shelter by simply and effectively sealing the 4th side of the dock opening, beneath and around the dock leveler. 8. Insulator™ Dock Sealing System with Firefighter™ Head Pad Provides extended life and highest performance, without the need for wear pleats. Includes the exclusive heat-dissipating Firefighter header seal to protect against burning from the heat of trailer marker lights. 9. Dok-Guardian™ Heavy-Duty Safety Barrier This simple, easy-to-use barrier helps prevent fork trucks, pallet jacks, and pedestrians from falling off the
trailers without ICC bars by engaging the trailer’s rear tire with one 20” barrier to provide safe engagement of virtually all trailer types. 15. Survivor™ Impactable Dock Shelter Affordable alternative to rigid shelters. Durable poly side frames can take a hit from off-center trailers without suffering costly damage. 16. BugShield™ Screen Door Screen mesh design blocks the infiltration of pests into a facility. Available in either a roll-up model, or a convenient sliding model for larger openings
prevents burning from trailer marker lights. 20. Safe-T-Strut™ Support System Unique through-the-lip design keeps strut in place to prevent the collapse of dock levelers during maintenance. 21. VBR-500 Dok-Lok® Vehicle Restraint Recessed vertical barrier stores beneath the dock leveler pit, providing a “clean” dock face and the flexibility to service a wide variety of trailers, including specially trailers and trailers with liftgates.
34
26
25
24 28
27
27
29 30
34
31 32
22. Barrier Systems Choose from several new heavy-duty or light-duty products to help separate and protect distinct areas of your facility. 23. FasTrax™ High Performance Door Designed around a single operational platform, these doors can match virtually any high cycle interior exterior, high-wind, cooler or freezer application. 24. Revolution™ HV/LS Fans This industrial ceiling fan makes employees more comfortable and productive, while driving down your energy costs. 25. Caljan Conveyors Telescopic belt and roller conveyors can be used to load/unload parcels, packages, boxes or any other form of loose-loaded cargo. 26. DuctSox® Fabric Air Dispersion System
Fabric design is used to distribute and disperse air in open ceiling architecture and are a cost effective and aesthetically attractive alternative to metal ductwork. 27. Barrier Glider Cold Storage Door Innovative design combines fast operation and a superior seal with multiple panel choices to fit your specific application requirements.
innovative, energy-efficient freezer door. 33
31. Barrier® Vertical Lift Cold Storage Door Seamless fiberglass panels are 4” or 6” thick for superior insulation and are designed to help maintain temperatures, reduce energy costs and ensure food safety. 32. RHV Vertical Dock Leveler Vertical design offers maximum environmental and security control and a smooth transition between the warehouse floor and the trailer bed.
28. Barrier® Infitting Cold Storage Door Insulated fiberglass personnel door assures environmental separation. Ideal for interior or exterior applications.
33. TS-2000 Trailer Stand Designed to help prevent landing gear collapse and trailer up-ending by providing secure support when placed under the nose of a trailer.
29. Safe-T-Sprint Power Door Fast-acting bi-roll door opens horizontally to provide immediate vision and material access.
34. Racking Solutions
30. FasTrox™ FR Cold Storage Door Combining the Thermal-Air™ System with the InsulMax R-4 insulated curtain provides an
projects Mezzanine Floors Mezzanine Flooring Mezzanine floors are designed to utilise the headroom available in a building to provide the largest floor space from the smallest foot print and enable expansion without the need to relocate. Should you choose to relocate in the future the advantage with a mezzanine floor is that you can dismantle mezzanines and move them with you we have 7 years experience of designing and installing mezzanines / raised storage areas to suit many different applications and we always deliver on time and within budget
8
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Mezzanine Floors
Projects
We also provide CAD designs and simulation
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
9
projects Mobile Shelving MOBILE SHELVING We have been designing and installing mobile storage systems for archives, medical records, office stationery / consumables, general filling, museums and many other different office warehouse and stockroom applications Mobile shelving or Roller Racks as they are sometimes called can either increase your storage capacity by up to 60% or reduce your storage footprint by 40-50% This space saving can reduce the need to relocate and often give you a very rapid return on investment
Manual Systems
QuickSpace Systems
10
Powered Systems
Mechanical Assist Systems
Modular Bi-File Systems
Mobile Art Rack Systems
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
shelving
Shelving Storage Systems
Projects
1 Boltless Shelving
Specializing in the design and installation of shelving and racking systems, over the years
2 Office shelving
we have provided solutions to many industry sectors, such as:
3 Shelf Ladders
Warehousing, General industry & manufacturing, Automotive,
4 Hand Pull/Push Drive
Medical & pharma, Museums and Banks & other financial institutions.
5 Mechanical Drive
We have a solution to fit your needs so call for a free consultation on 800-5628 6 Electrical Drive
Solve your storage problems with our flexible, versatile shelving systems & we also provide CAD designs
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
11
projects mobile racking MOBILE RACKING Mobile racks as they are some times called can either increase your storage capacity up to 100% or reduce your storage footprint by 40-50% This space saving can reduce the need to relocate and often give you a very rapid return on investment
How to get 100% more storage, and make better use of your space
12
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Racking
Projects
RACKING SYSTEMS 1 Drive in Racking 2 Narrow Aisle Racking 3 Cable Reel Racks 4 Rack A Frame 5 Pallet Racking
Solve your storage problems with our flexible, versatile racking systems & we also provide 2D + 3D designs and simulations
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
13
projects Workbenches & Cabinets WORKBENCHES & CABINETS INSTALLATION Providing workshop system designed for the most demanding of applications the Lista range covers drawer cabinets, cupboards, workbenches & storage and transport solutions.
ils r full deta Call us fo ) (5628 800-LOC8
14
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Workbenches & Cabinets
Projects
Workbenches see page 490 ff
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
15
ShelvingShelving
1 7
12
8
2
9
13
3 14 10 4
15 5
16
11 17
6
16
1 Starter Bay
10 MULTI-STABIL
SYSTEM COMPONENTS
2 Mesh Back Panel
11 Trough bin shelf with dividers
3 Mesh Shelf Dividers
12 Fully clad bay
4 Anti-spill trough shelf fronts
13 Back cladding
5 Plain shelf dividers
14 Drawer Block top with central locking
The shelving and small parts storage system for those applications where space utilisation is paramount. Our modular programme allows for easy specifying, quick delivery and a professional installation. From only two system components ( frames and shelves) combined with a comprehensive accessory range we can offer solutions from a simple bay of shelving to a custom built small part store.
6 Plinth
15 100 mm drawer
7 Add-on Bay
16 200 mm drawer
8 Open frame
17 Base for Drawer Block
9 Open fronted plastic storage
18 Door set
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Shelving
SHELVING
18
Standard frame heights: 2000, 2200, 2500, 3000, 3500, 4000, 4300, 4500 mm
Solve your storage problems with our flexible, versatile shelving systems Typical applications are parts stores, industrial, commercial and trade locations or even VMI (Vendor Maintained Inventory) applications where its versatility ensures the most efficient layout can be achieved. • Individual shelf capacity up to 400 kg udl • Bay load up to 3700 kg • Shelves adjustable at 25 mm vertical pitch • Shelves perforated at 50 mm centres to accept divider accessories • Stepped beams for flush inlay chipboard decks (perorated for divider accessories at 200 mm centres) • Shelves S100, MS 230 // and MS 330 // all with safety factor of 2X udl.
Standard frame depths: 300, 400, 500, 600, 800 mm
675 mm
Standard widths: 750, 1000, 1250, 1300 mm
875 mm 1.075 mm 1.275 mm 1.675 mm
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
17
Shelving Boltless Shelving
• Easily asssembled boltless system • Versatile shelving system for workshop, warehouse, store room, showroom, office etc. • Dealer tip: Use takeaway effect - META SET sale in your sales business with the META merchandise fixture • Easy handling, simple transport: fix and ready packed items Easy boltless assembly • Shelves prepared for system accessories like shelf dividers, mesh dividers etc. by perforation at 50 mm centres • Shelves adjustable at 25 mm vertical centres • Bay load capacity up to 1260 kg • Shelf-/bay loads based on uniformly distributed load and on runs of three or more bays • Finish RAL 7035 light grey possible on request Boltless shelving SET Standard 100 - Shelf load 115 kg
QUICK SET V150, pre-galvanised
Starter bay: 2 frames 4 shelves Fixing accessories Planning information: Shelf width + 56 mm Shelf depth + 36 mm Add-on bay: 1 frame 4 shelves Fixing accessories Planning information: Shelf width + 6 mm Shelf depth + 36 mm
Outer dimensions (H x W x D) 2000 x 3068 x 536 mm, 4 shelves and 150 kg per rack 1 Starter and 2 Add-on bays
Solve your storage problems with our flexible, versatile mobile shelving systems
• Standard Frame height: 2000 – 3000 mm • Standard Frame depth: 500, 600, 800 mm • Standard Bay widths 1000 mm 2000 mm
18
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Boltless Shelving
Shelving
We can design your warehouse according to your requirements!
Qualified advice, high-modern CAD and the personal assistance of our colleagues can help you to achieve your project quickly and effectively. The conception, planning and installation can transform your warehouse in no time at all. We would be very happy to provide you with an individualised planning suggestion and personal offer. For larger requests please enclose a draft with detailed specifications.
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
19
Shelving Wire SHELVING Wire Shelving ECLIPSE SHELVING Multi-purpose shelving systems full of advantages ESD Compliant with Optional Accessories - Call for Details Bolt Free Assembly Fully Adjustable Easy to Clean 300kg Shelf Loading Static or Mobile Options Accessories available - Call for Details
CHROME The open wire design offers improved lightpenetration & better air circulation making it an ideal system for Catering Retail Display Medical Authorities & Hospitals Electronic Engineering Industries Office
PERMA PLUS With the added bonus of an anti-bacterial additivethat will help fight the build up of germs & improvehygiene standards, making it an ideal system for Catering Medical Authorities & Hospitals Food Production Walk-In Freezers & Cold Rooms s Damp & Corrosive Environments price
r full o f s u ils Call nd deta a
COMPLETE 4 SHELF UNITS: 1625 MM HIGH Shelf Length
Depth 305mm
Depth 355mm
Model
Depth 460mm
Model
Depth 610mm
Model
Model
-
EC39
-
Eclipse Shelving - Chrome 460mm
-
610mm
-
-
EC40
EC47A
760mm
EC32
EC35
EC43
EC47
915mm
EC37
EC36
EC44
EC48
1070mm
EC34
EC33
EC51
EC54
1220mm
EC38
EC30
EC45
EC49
1370mm
-
-
EC53
EC56
1520mm
-
-
EC46
EC50
1820mm
-
-
EC52
EC55
EASY BUILD
Eclipse Shelving - Perma Plus 460mm
-
-
-
EPP40
610mm
-
-
EPP40
EPP47A
760mm
EPP32
EPP35
EPP43
EPP47
915mm
EPP37
EPP36
EPP44
EPP48
1070mm
EPP34
EPP33
EPP51
EPP54
1220mm
EPP38
EPP30
EPP45
EPP49
1370mm
-
EPP39
EPP53
EPP56
1520mm
-
EPP41
EPP46
EPP50
1820mm
-
EPP42
EPP52
EPP55
*Units are available with fewer or more shelves. Ask for details and prices.
20
Size (Diameter)
Model
Capacity
Wheel/Housing
75mm unbraked
R75UB
70kg
Rubber/Zinc
75mm braked
R75BR
70kg
Rubber/Zinc
100mm unbraked
R100UB
80kg
Rubber/Zinc
100mm braked
R100BR
80kg
Rubber/Zinc
120mm unbraked
R120UB
100kg
Rubber/Zinc
120mm braked
R120BR
100kg
Rubber/Zinc
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Hygienic Shelving
Shelving
FREEZERACK - ALUMINIUM & PLASTIC The ultimate non-corrosive, easy to clean, shelvingsystem. Pre-Assembled Aluminium frames & shelfsupports with Plastic, dishwasher proof, shelf panels NF Compliant Temperature Range: -20째c to +60째cBolt Free Assembly Designed for use in Medical Authorities & Hospitals Food Production areas Walk-In Freezers & Cold Rooms Loadings 60-100kg per shelf.udl Total capacity 600kg. udl. between 2 ladder frame
90 DEGREE CORNER SUPPORTS 425mm D eep U nit
Shelf Length mm 800
600mm D eep U nit
Model
Model
CS2/3
CS1/1
Complete 4 Shelf Unit - 1700mm High (2 Frames & 4 Shelves)
Add-on Unit (1 Frame & 4 Shelves)
425mm Deep Unit
600mm Deep Unit
425mm Deep Unit
Model
Model
Model
600mm Deep Unit Model
FR48
FR58
AFR48
AFR58
905
FR49
FR59
AFR49
AFR59
1015
FR410
FR510
AFR410
AFR510
1125
FR411
FR511
AFR411
AFR511
1230
FR412
FR512
AFR412
AFR512
1340
FR413
FR513
AFR413
AFR513
1450
FR414
FR514
AFR414
AFR514
1560
FR415
FR515
AFR415
AFR515
1665
FR416
FR516
AFR416
AFR516
PLASTIC PLUS SHELVING Easy to assemble shelving system which can be cleaned by a commercial or utensil dishwasher NSF accredited & is also approved as an alternative to Stainless Steel by the MOD under specification 42 Temperature Range: -30째c to +90째c Resistant to moisture, grease, acids & alkalis Loadings 60-90kg per shelf.udl Total capacity 360kg. udl
Vented Shelf
Call us for full prices and details Solid Shelves
Vented Shelves
Shelf Length mm
460mm Deep Unit
610mm Deep Unit
460mm Deep Unit
Model
Model
Model
Model
610
8168S
8184S
8168V
8184V
760
8169S
8185S
8169V
8185V
915
8170S
8186S
8170V
8186V
1070
8171S
8187S
8171V
8187V
1220
8172S
8188S
8172V
8188V
1370
8173S
8189S
8173V
8189V
1520
8174S
8190S
8174V
8190V
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
610mm Deep Unit
21
Shelving Adjustable Shelving RANGE OF ADJUSTABLE STEEL SHELVING UPRIGHTS- single sided, wall fixed Size
Model
430 mm (16 /4")
DU430
710 mm (28")
DU710
1000 mm (39 /4")
DU1000
1220 mm (48")
DU1220
1600 mm (63")
DU1600
1980 mm (78")
DU1980
2400 mm (941/4")
DU2400
3
1
Size
Model
120 mm (5")
DB120
170 mm (7")
DB170
220 mm (9")
DB220
270 mm (101/2")
DB270
320 mm (12 /2")
DB320
370 mm (141/2")
DB370
370 mm (14 /2")
DMDB370
470 mm (18 /2")
DB470
610 mm (24")
DB610
1 1
High gloss epoxy Polyester paintfinish to 50 microns ensuring impact & scratch resistance,durability & easy maintenance Safety feature to preventaccidental shelf dislodgement
STRAIGHT BRACKETS
1
Manufactured from high grade Steel to ensure maximum weight loading capacity. Uprights areproduced from 2mm thick Steel & the brackets from 1.6mm thick Steelloading capacity. Uprights areproduced from 2mm thick Steel & the brackets from 1.6mm thick Steel
Also suitable for Wood,composite & Glass shelves
STEEL SHELVES Size
Model
1m x 170 mm (39 /4" x 7")
DSS1017
1m x 220 mm (391/4" x 9")
DSS1022
1m x 270 mm (39 /4" x 10 /2")
DSS1027
1m x 320 mm (393/4" x 12")
DSS1032
1m x 370 mm (39 /4" x 14 /2")
DSS1037
1m x 470 mm (393/4" x 181/2")
DSS1047
1m x 610 mm (39 /4" x 24")
DSS1061
500 x 170 mm
DSS517
500 x 220 mm
DSS522
500 x 270 mm
DSS527
500 x 320 mm
DSS532
500 x 370 mm
DSS537
500 x 470 mm
DSS547
500 x 610 mm
DSS561
1
1
1
3
1
3
SHELF ENDS Size
Model
150 mm Shelf End Pair
DSE150
200 mm Shelf End Pair
DSE200
250 mm Shelf End Pair
DSE250
BOOK SUPPORTS
22
STRONGBEAM BRACKETS Manufactured from high grade Steel to ensure maximum weight loading capacity. Uprights areproduced from 2mm thick Steel & the brackets from 1.6mm thick Steelloading capacity. Uprights areproduced from 2mm thick Steel & the brackets from 1.6mm thick Steel Size
Model
100 x 75 mm
DRB10
Size
Model
150 x 125 mm
DRB15
Square
FSB150
200 x 150 mm
DRB20
Square
FSB200
250 x 200 mm
DRB25
Square
FSB250
200 x 200 mm
DMB200
(6") Spring Rod (Pairs)
DFB150
250 x 250 mm
DMB250
(73/4") Spring Rod (Pairs)
DFB200
300 x 300 mm
DMB300
(93/4") Spring Rod (Pairs)
DFB250
350 x 350 mm
DMB350
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
cantilever shelving
Shelving
COMBI UNIT
CSCODMY Combi Frame shownwith 6 x CS60T6C Series 1 Trays,2 x CSFWS6C Flat Writing shelves
SERIES 2 UNIT
CSCODMY Combi Frame shownwith 6 x CS60T6C Series 1 Trays,2 x CSFWS6C Flat Writing shelves
FRAME OPTIONS
Buy the frame & add the trays/shelves tosuit your need &application Trays & Tube Infil shelves incorporatetwo notches enabling them to be positioned flat or at an angle Combi Units willaccommodate anytray/shelf size option
Static Frames Weight Model kg Single Sided Frames
Description
Frame Size L x W x H mm
Series 1 Unit
890 x 500 x 1400
Series 2 Unit Combi Unit
1750 x 500 x 1400
Mobile Frames Weight kg
Model
15
CS60SSZ
-
-
18
CS12SSZ
-
-
20
CSCOSSZ
-
CS60DMY
Double Sided Frames Series 1 Unit Series 2 Unit Combi Unit
890 x 920 x 1400 1750 x 920 x 1400
18
CS60DSZ
20
20
CS12DSZ
25
CS12DMY
25
CSCODSZ
28
CSCODMY
TRAY & SHELF OPTIONS Overall Size L x W mm
Trays & Shelves to Suit Frames...
Series 1 Tray
865 x 410
Series 1 & Combi Units
CS60T6C
Series 2 Tray
1730 x 410
Series 2 & Combi Units
CS12T12C
Series 1 Tube Infil Shelf
865 x 410
Series 1 & Combi Units
CSTI6C
Series 2 Tube Infil Shelf
1730 x 410
Series 2 & Combi Units
CSTI12C
Flat Writing Shelf
865 x 410
Series 1 & Combi Units
CSFWS6C
Description
TRAYS & TUBE INFIL SHELVES CAN BE POSITIONED FLAT ORAT AN ANGLE TO MEET YOUR NEEDS
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Model
23
Shelving plastic or Aluminium Storage Systems Shelving Systems suitable for Food, Pharmaceutical or general Factory use Shelving Systems available with ananti-microbial finish - Call for Details 4Tier Units more or less tiers available 400mm clearance between shelves Load Capacity per unit: 900kg Colour options available
Beige
Red
Blue
Green
White
please specify when ordering
Mobile Unit
FLAT PACK FOR EASE OF TRANSPORTATION Height of racks: Static - 1495mm
Mobile Unit
Mobile - 1560mm L to R clearance between bays 1000mm Rack -
Call us for full prices and details
915mm
1200mm Rack - 1115mm 1500mm Rack - 2 x 687mm 2000mm Rack - 2 x 937mm 1000mm Long Single Bay Depth 400mm1 5" 500mm2 0" 600mm2 4" 1200mm Long Single Bay Depth 400mm1 5" 500mm2 0" 600mm2 4" 1500mm Long Double Bay Depth 400mm1 5" 500mm2 0" 600mm2 4" 2000mm Long Double Bay Depth 400mm1 5" 500mm2 0" 600mm2 4"
24
Plastic Static Model 4104 4105 4106
Aluminium Mobile Model 4104C 4105C 4106C
Static Model 4104A 4105A 4106A
Mobile Model 4124C 4125C 4126C
Static Model 4124A 4125A 4126A
Mobile Model 4154C 4155C 4156C
Static Model 4154A 4155A 4156A
Mobile Model 4204C 4205C 4206C
Static Model 4204A 4205A 4206A
Plastic Static Model 4124 4125 4126
Aluminium
Plastic Static Model 4154 4155 4156
Mobile Model 4124AC 4125AC 4126AC Aluminium
Plastic Static Model 4204 4205 4206
Mobile Model 4104AC 4105AC 4106AC
Mobile Model 4154AC 4155AC 4156AC Aluminium
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Mobile Model 4204AC 4205AC 4206AC
Boltless Shelving
Shelving
Ideal presentation for better sales. Ideal presentation for better sales. The final decision is made by the customer at the point of sale only. And particularly in the specialist trade it is apparent how the success of your business benefits from the professional storage- and presentation techniques. META retail market equipments are successful. Examples: • Tool- and machinery trade, sanitary industry • Wholesaler for industry at combined retail market and warehouse equipments Thus you will also always have the right solution in stock!
META market is a practical equipment concept for retail markets.
• Traditional sales forms now lose ground toward competition. Those who don‘t adapt to the changing conditions, fail on the market.
• META market means: More market by freedom with regard to the retailmarket design in form and colour in an environment where products and buying become an advanture.
• META market means: Analysis, advice, projection, delivery and assembly by META in cooperation with the customers, architects and planners.
• Example of use : 1. Counters with swing door
• Example of use : 2. Counters without swing door
Swing-door bay width : 800 - 1300 mm
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
25
Shelving Boltless Shelving COMPLETE RACKS WITH PLASTIC BINS • Complete racks with plastic bins • The plastic bins in polypropylene correspond to the food legislation
• Demounted, completely boltless META QUICK S3
3
frame
• Bay load capacity: 1100 kg • Shelf load capacity: 100 kg • All load capacities based on uniformly distributed load (u.d.l.)
• Bay loads based on runs of three or more bays • Pictures show each 1 starter- and 1 add-on bay 1
Kit 1: with 40 Euro containers 400 x 300 x 210 mm Kit 2: with 30 Euro containers 600 x 400 x 210 mm Kit 3: with 16 Euro containers 600 x 400 x 320 mm
1
All load capacities are uniformly distributed load . Euro containers made of polypropylene.
Planning information: Starter bay: Shelf length + 56 mm Shelf depth 36 mm
Complete Bays with plastic bins
Add-on bay: Shelf length + 6 mm Shelf depth + 36 mm
Height mm
Width mm
Depth mm
No. of levels
Assortment
Starter bay
Add-on bay
2000
1000
300
10
1
90231
90232
2000
1000
400
7
2
90233
90234
2000
1000
400
9
3
90235
90236
2000
1000
500
7
4
90237
90238
2000
1000
500
9
5
90239
90240
2
Safety Note: Racks with a height to depth ratio greater than 5:1 should be fixed to avert tipping by fixing to the floor or wall. Bay loads are based on runs of 3 or more bays.
2
3
4
Storage bins: 1 30 x PLK 3 blue (230x150x125) 30 x PLK 3 red (230x150x125) 2 12 x PLK 2a blue (350x213x200) 16 x PLK 2a red 3 16 x PLK 2 blue (330x213x150) 20 x PLK 2 red
5
4 12 x PLK 1 blue (500x315x200) 9 x PLK 1 red 5 12 x PLK 1c blue (500x315x150) 15 x PLK 1c red
META SPEED-RACK with Euro containers pre-galvanised
• Scope of delivery:
4 supporting profiles 16 / 20 stepped beams 8 / 10 A-cross support bars 4 clip-in feet 4 supporting sheet 4 / 5 chipboards/shelves
• red Euro containers according to table
26
Height mm
Width mm
Depth mm
No. of levels
Shelf load kg
Bay load kg
pre-galvanised Complete bays
1970
2500
400
4
400
2800
86995
1970
2500
600
4
400
2800
87005
1970
1700
600
4
500
3000
87006
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
OFFICE Shelving
Shelving
META COMPACT Bolted Shelving with and without top shelf • Bay heights : 1850, 2200, 2550 mm • Bay depths : 300 and 600 mm • Finishes : RAL 7035 light grey or pre-galvanised
META COMPACT Bolted Shelving with and without top shelf • Bay heights : 1850, 2200, 2550 mm • Bay depths : 300 and 600 mm • Finishes : RAL 7035 light grey or pre-galvanised
META COMPACT Bolted Shelving with and without top shelf • Bay heights : 1850, 2200, 2550 mm • Bay depths : 300 mm • Finishes : RAL 7035 light grey
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
27
Shelving SHELF LADDERS
Top roller fitting
Bottom roller fitting
28
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Frame WRX
Shelving
Frame WRX Count on the FrameWRX™ storage system from Spacesaver to give you the exact storage you need. Highly customizable and easily relocated, the unique design of this system means it freely adapts to meet your changing needs. Options, such as WRX Wheels™ transport system for easy mobility, FrameWRX™ HD (high density) storage system for ultimate capacity and EZ Rail™ element for added flexibility, offer unlimited storage possibilities. The FrameWRX storage system can be exactly what you need it to be now and in the future.
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
29
Shelving EZ Rail Element EZ Rail Element
Any time … Any space …
Any storage system …
key features Simple one-piece design Installs without fasteners Two versions allow horizontal or sloped installation of a variety of industry standard hanging bins Horizontal version fits a variety of pegboard and slatwall accessories Horizontal version fits many UWR storage system barrel and pistol supports Fits industry standard hanging bins and standard pegboard and slatwall accessories
Design variations for horizontal or 17-degree sloped installation
EZ Rail™ element provides innovation and opportunity
For 4-Post, Case and UWR storage systems
EZ Rail™ element adds flexibility to new installations. It offers renewed utility to existing storage. And it creates opportunities for creating enhanced, superior functionality in a range of applications
EZ Rail element multiplies your options, so customizing storage solutions is simple and cost-effective. And because your choices stay flexible, any future demands can be met easily, within tight budgets. Here’s a solution that won’t be obsolete tomorrow
Evidence processing work station
Easily changes between bins, barrel supports and more
30
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Mobile shelving
Shelving
MECHANICAL DRIVE Mechanical Drive system aisles by rotating ergonomic drive handles. Basic safety systems are available. Ideal for medium-sized storage systems with higher activity levels, heavier load factors, greater carriage lengths and a larger number of system ranges.
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628)
Load Carrying Capacity Each Modular Storage System carriage has a load capacity of 700 lb. (1,050 kg.) per linear foot (meter). Your local Area Contractor can provide weight analyses and offer structural strategies to accommodate system floor loads Standard Carriage Lengths For mechanical assist, the maximum length of Space saver Modular Mobile Storage System carriages is 15 feet (4.5m). For manual, the maximum length is 9 feet (2.7m). System widths will allow up to six movable carriages Modular Rail Design The system’s modular rail design is engineered to be placed directly on top of existing floors. To insure a proper match with its environment, the system’s modular floor can be installed using virtually any type of floor covering Flexible Rail Options Spacesaver Modular Mobile Storage Systems are available with two extruded rail options. Shown on the left is a levelable rail with modular floor and ramp that includes in-rail antitip devices. Shown on the right is a low-profile, floorless rail that provides additional system height clearance For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
31
Shelving Mobile shelving ELECTRICAL DRIVE Reconfiguring
Choose from a wide range
Lighting Add optional overhead lighting
The optional Power Link remote
of available colors, finishes
for safety and convenience.
PC interface capability ensures
and end-panel materials.
Open an aisle, and lights turn
fast, convenient reconfiguring
On request, we’ll customize
on automatically over just that
as your needs change for full
your Eclipse end panels
aisle or the entire system
operational flexibility
Design options
with a functional, aesthetic look that complements your environment
Housings Virtually any type of storage housing can be mounted on Eclipse mobile carriages – even your existing shelving and cabinets. Case-type, four-post and cantilever shelving is available, too, as well as drawers, bins, trays, lateral files, doors, industrial rack shelving and storage accessories
Control Available in standard lengths
Carriage length and load
from 3 feet (0.9 meters) up to
Available in standard lengths
81 feet (24.6 meters), each
from 3 feet (0.9 meters) up to
Eclipse Powered System car-
81 feet (24.6 meters), each
riage has a minimum load-
Eclipse Powered System car-
carrying capacity of 1,000
riage has a minimum load-
pounds per linear foot or 1,500
carrying capacity of 1,000
kilograms per linear meter
pounds per linear foot or 1,500 kilograms per linear meter
Safety A full range of standard and optional automatic
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628)
32
passive, in-aisle safety systems protect your personnel, from waist-high and aisle-entry sensors to photoelectric or mechanical floor-level sweeps
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Mobile shelving
Shelving
Eclipse Powered System Standard Features Standard Features Safety / Security • Light-Immune Photo Sweep • Programmable Carriage Follow Distance • Core Logic Accommodating up to 3 Safeties per Side Ease of Use / Productivity • Programmable Speed • Simple, Three-Button Control
Light-Immune Photo Sweep
Mechanical Safety Sweep
Aisle-Entry Safety Sensor
Zero Force Sensor System
PowerLink Remote 24/7 Monitoring
Auto Move Interface
Rechargeable Power Override Unit
Infrared-Capable Control with Remote User Key
Reliability • Sure, Dependable Connections • Static Discharge Protection • Fail-Safe Technologies • Non-Contact Distance Sensors
Reliability • Sure, Dependable Connections • Static Discharge Protection • Fail-Safe Technologies • Non-Contact Distance Sensors
Available Options Safety/Security • Zero Force Sensor Automatic Passive Safety System • Aisle-Entry Safety Sensor • Mechanical Safety Sweep • Building Interface Module (Fire/Sprinkler/ Security) • Environmental Monitoring • Automatic Brake Ease of Use / Productivity • Programmable Auto Moves • Carriage Lengths up to 81 Feet (24.6 Meters) • Split Carriages Capability to Maximize Storage • Auto Reset • Programmable Aisle • PowerLink Remote 24/7 Monitoring Convenience • Infrared-Capable Control with Remote User Key • Works-In-A-Drawer • “Plug-In-The-Wall” Power Reliability • Optional Drive & Guidance Systems • Automatic Battery Back-Up • Rechargeable Power Override Unit
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
33
Shelving Mobile shelving CoreSTOR patient server is designed to put 80% of the most frequently used supplies for patient care 10 steps from the bedside
Build a decentralized nurse station right into each patient’s room – equipping nurses to spend less time “hunting and gathering” and more time caring for patients Reduce traffic though the patient room by stocking supplies from outside the room – minimizing patient exposure and interruptions Optimize floor plan and patient-room design, yielding more usable space – maximizing cost-per-square foot
Reduce steps enable nurses to “go the distance” for patients, not supplies A nurse’s time should focus on patient care. But often, existing facility models actually take nurses away from direct patient care to spend hours “hunting and gathering” supplies every day
Totally accessible from inside the patient room. The entire shelf width is within easy sight and reach – just steps from the bedside.
34
Extends fully outside the room for easy stocking. The CoreSTOR unit’s patented slide design provides complete shelving access for increased efficiency.
Smooth starts and stops are ensured by durable bearings combined with a proprietary “smooth-stopping” device. This protects supplies and makes opening and closing the unit easy – even when fully stocked.
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Mobile shelving
Shelving
CORESTOR
Built for long service life, the sturdy carriage is engineered from lightweight aluminum and offers a 300 lb. load capacity
Flexible storage options let you design the storage that fits to a “T,” from traditional 4-Post shelving to productive innovations such as the patent pending EZ Rail™ and FrameWRX™ storage systems
Highly configurable, with a wide selection of carriage widths and lengths as well as shelving heights, to accommodate your floor plan and enable you to comply with building codes
Adaptable storage solutions can include shelves, bins, hooks, pegs in a variety of colors and styles – optimized for today’s needs, ready to change for tomorrow’s
Easy-care paint options are available in a broad range of standard colors to compliment any decor. The electrostatically applied powder-coat paint is durable and easy to clean – anti-microbial finishes are also available
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628)
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
35
Racking Racking
For all cking your ra nts me require OC8 -L call 800 us il or ema 8.ae lo t@ c contac
Giving you 100% accessibility to all pallets, first in first out principle and extremely dense storage, mobile racking can be the ideal space saving solution. Using 50% of warehouse space compared to conventional racking this can produce significant build cost savings. Particularly cost effective for a cold store environment.
How to get 100% more storage, and make better use of your space
RACK ACCESSORIES
Pallet support bar
Standard Flat
Fork entry bar
Shelf panel
36
Frame guard
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Wide upright
Racking
DRIVE-IN RACKING
Racking
NARROW AISLE SOLUTIONS
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
37
Racking Cable Reel Rack A-FRAME • META A-Frame Cable Reel Racks are
particularly suited to the storage and display of cabling and tubing in a Trade Wholesale environment.
• The META - Cable Reel rack system
enables the efficient storage, handling and visible control of all types of cable supplied from the reel.
• The bolted framed system allows racks adapted to meet varying requirements.
• Racks can be adjusted and supplemented
with extra components in a modular way to meet changing needs.
• All accessories are easy to install into the racks.
• All the components such as beams, cable reel holders, feet and ground fixings are included. The cable reel bars must be ordered separately.
• The standard units consist of: - Starter bay 2 A-Frames - Add-on bay 1 A-Frame
• The racks are delivered knocked-down for on-site assembly.
• A-Frame heights 3300 – 4900 mm • A-Frame base depths 900 – 1100 mm • Bay location widths 900, 1100, 1300 mm • Beams are powder coated RAL 2001 safety orange
• Frames with powder coated uprights
in RAL 5010 Enzian blue, Diagonal and horizontal cross bracing pre-galvanised
• The META - Cable Reel rack system enables the efficient storage, handling and visible control of all types of cable supplied from the reel.
• The bolted framed system allows racks adapted to meet varying requirements.
• Racks can be adjusted and supplemented
with extra components in a modular way to meet changing needs.
• All accessories are easy to install into the racks.
Planning information: Starter bay = beam length + 170 mm Add-on bay = beam length + 85 mm Only for manual operation
• Frame heights 2200 - 5500 mm • Frame depth 1100 mm • Bay location widths 900, 1100, 1300 mm • End Frames with powder coated uprights in RAL 5010 Enzian blue
• Diagonal and horizontal cross bracing pregalvanised
• Beams are powder coated RAL 2001 safety orange
• All the components such as beams, cable reel holders, feet and ground fixings are included. The cable reel bars must be ordered separately.
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628)
38
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Mesh safety fence
Racking
A Pallet rack mesh safety screen which helps prevent accidents whilst handling and storing goods.
Panels are available in 3 sizes with a choice of various mounting brackets.
Spec ific for p prices r are a ojects upon vailable call request, 800LOC 8
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
39
Mezzanine Mezzanine Floors
SINGLE LEVEL MEZZANINES MULTI-TIER MEZZANINES IN-RACK MEZZANINES RETAIL SHOP MEZZANINES
Safety hand and mid-height rails with kickboard
For all your mezzanine floor requirements, please call 800-LOC8 or email contact@loc8.ae
Flooring material in steel panel 38 mm
Sliding access load gate
Retail, Office, Production & Storage
Stairs with hand rails
Releasing dead or unused space by installing a mezzanine floor is often the ideal solution for companies needing to expand or consolidate its operations without the expense and disruption of relocating the business. The additional space can be used to accommodate offices as well as offering increased storage and production space. The secret to unlocking the wasted space most efficiently lies in good design and ensuring the mezzanine floor is specified most appropriately for its intended use.
40
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Multi-Tier
Mezzanine
Easy on site assembly and wide spans between columns
Pallet rack system with mezzanine floor
Wholesaler for industry
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
41
Mezzanine Mezzanine Pallet Gates weapons Storage UWR and UWR mini Storage Systems
Military Weapons Storage The Universal™ Weapons Rack (UWR™ storage system) and UWRmini™ storage system is ready for secure military weapons storage for a variety of purposes such as, M16 racks, pistol racks, gear bag cabinets, or optics cabinets all utilizing the same secure cabinet frame. Multiple weapons storage in one weapon cabinet, and doing so without the need to disassemble or zero the weapon is a huge boost to your operational and combat readiness. Spacesaver weapons racks combine thoughtful design and unmatched features to create a weapons storage system that’s thoroughly dependable and instantly deployable under any circumstance. Keeping operational readiness in mind, the Universal Weapons Rack storage system is both versatile and flexible.
Barrel Supports
Visibility
Security Handles Allow for easy comfortable lift
Barrel Supports
42
Easy to Carry
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
weapons Storage Mezzanine Easy to Travel
Weapons Mobile Storage
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
43
ENVIRONMENT Industrial Ceiling Fan
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628)
One revolution after another. With the Rite-Hite Revolution, you get more. More air movement. More employee comfort. More energy savings. All with the fewest blades of any HV/LS fan on the market. Traditional ways of moving air in a large facility just don’t cut it. High-volume air movement from conventional high-speed ceiling or industrial floor fans is unpleasant and disruptive. Air speeds beyond four or five miles per hour usually offer little, if any, added cooling benefit. High-speed fans are expensive to operate and many are required for effective cooling. And they can’t destratify air to keep temperatures consistent from floor to ceiling. Large, high-volume/low-speed (HV/LS) fans offer big benefits over high-speed ceiling or floor fans, by circulating and dispersing air more efficiently and effectively.
44
Increased employee comfort and productivity. In summer, air from a high-volume/low-speed fan gently passes over your employees to keep them cooler, comfortable and productive. In winter, the same fan pushes air from the ceiling down to the floor to keep employees warmer. Greater energy efficiency and cost savings. A large Revolution Fan costs just pennies an hour to operate and can lower your energy costs by as much as 30%. Better circulation and ventilation. A Revolution Fan continuously circulates air within a facility, helping keep floors and products drier where needed. At Rite-Hite, we’re putting a whole new spin on HV/LS fan performance.
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Industrial Ceiling Fan
ENVIRONMENT
• More air movement • More employee comfort • More energy savings
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
45
ENVIRONMENT Industrial Ceiling Fan Additional Benefits of Revolution Fans: • Cooler workers make less errors and work more safely. • Improved Air Circulation & Ventilation: • Reduce condensation on floors • Help keep products and packages dry • Minimize energy loss • Improve quality control for stored products by keeping temperatures consistent from floor to ceiling
• Eliminate smaller fans: • Provide a safer work environment • Reduce clutter and open up floor space • Reduce potential for eye injuries • Reduce noise • Reduce maintenance costs • Use less energy (see chart on opposite page) • Free up low voltage power
Move more air to every corner of your facility.
Unique Propell-Aire™ blade design • Made of strong, durable, lightweight aluminum • Varies in width along entire length of blade • Ideal contour and twist for maximum air movement • Complex jig-formed shape is not possible with extruded blades
Upward blade tilt • Increases airflow and reach • E xtends reach of air movement up to 85 feet from the fan's center in all directions • Directs air outward from fan’s center in a conical shape
Optimized airflow • Stronger, more uniform air velocity o dead air “holes” under center of fan • N • Moves more air than other fan designs • Available in 8', 12', 16', 20' and 24' diameters • Available in 2 or 4 blade configurations
Go “Green” with HV/LS fans. Stop Wasting Energy and Start Saving Money in Your Facility. Determine your Return on Investment. Your Rite-Hite Representative can perform a free energy savings analysis at your facility.
Winter Savings Reduce heating bills by 20–30% when you use a Revolution Fan to gently mix warm air from the ceiling with cooler air below.
After
Before 91° (32°C) at the ceiling
76° (24°C) at the ceiling
59° (16°C) on the floor
75° (23°C) on the floor
Generally, the temperature rises 0.5° to 1°F for every foot in ceiling height above the thermostat. The Revolution Fan helps keep temperatures consistent from floor to ceiling.
46
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Industrial Ceiling Fan
ENVIRONMENT
APPLICATIONS • Aviation Facilities • Gymnasiums/Athletic Facilities • Manufacturing Facilities • Warehouse/Distribution Centers • Automotive Repair Shops • Health Clubs/Fitness Centers
Resilient blade/hub connection • Vibration-absorbing material reduces stress to the hub by 50 to 75% • Rotationally balanced blade/hub • Used for over 40 years in the most demanding applications worldwide • Designed for over 10 times the force and stress generated by the Revolution Fan
Simple, easy-to-use controls • U L listed to U.S. and Canadian Safety Standards NEMA 12/13 control box • Solid State variable-frequency drive • Touch-Safe components • Remote mounted control options operate up to 30 fans
Robust mounting system • Stabilizing cables, beam clamp and motor housing • Extruded, precision-milled aluminum hub • Three-way motor-to-hub safety connection
Summer Savings Use Revolution Fans instead of air conditioning or to supplement Existing air conditioning for employee comfort. • The cooling effect of the breeze from a Revolution Fan at full speed is up to 15 degrees. • The wind from an HV/LS Fan allows up to a 5 degree increase in thermostat setting with no change in employee comfort. Electric bill savings is 4% for each degree, saving up to 20%.
For your free video demonstrati on, call 800-LO C8
Compare energy use when replacing ten less efficient fans. Type of Fan
Electricity Type
One 24’ Revolution Fan
Cost to run per week*
# of weeks
Total cost/year*
3.15A/460V
$4
26
$104
6.4A/115V
$21
26
$546
Ten 3’ Fans
8.1A/115V
$26
26
$676
Ten 4’ Fans
9.1A/115V
$29
26
$754
Ten 2’ Fans
* Based on $.07/kwh, 40 hours per week and fans running at full speed.
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
47
AIRLINE™
R I C A I R T fabric UNNEL ENVIRONMENTF A Bairline air tunnel
AIRLINE FABRIC AIR TUNNEL A new cooling sytem is about to get off the fround that’s causing people to rethink their floor plans by taking up l;ess space. It all starts with simple understanding : The best way to improve condition on the fl;oor is by improving them in the air. Introdcing , Airline - Fabric air Tunnels The AirLine Fabric Air Tunnel delivers balanced ambient airfl ow with SpotOn™ Air Outlets every 15” throughout the length of the fabric air tunnel. Available in lengths of 30’ to 80’, the AirLine reduces energy consumption, as well as eliminates airfl ow obstructions and noise associated with both fl oor and wall mounted fans. Unit shown with optional mounting installation.
Air Movement Guidelines Standard Spot-On ™ Air Outlet configuration LOWER ENERGY COSTS AND INCREASE EMPLOYEE PRODUCTIVIT Y.
15"
The AirLine Fabric Air Tunnel delivers balanced ambient airflow with Spot-On™ Air Outlets every 15" throughout the length of the fabric air tunnel. Available in lengths of 30' to 80', the AirLine reduces energy consumption, as well as eliminates airflow obstructions and noise associated with both floor and wall mounted fans.
1' 2' 3' 4'
8'
8' 5 o’clock
7 o’clock
Total AirLine Length Distance from Spot-On Air Outlets
30’
40’
50’
60’
70’
80’
1’
22
17
17
17
13
11
2’
15
12
12
10
8
6
3’
9
8
7
6
4
3
4’
5
5
5
4
3
2
Fan’s Types
48
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Industrial AIR Coolers
ENVIRONMENT
36” Three Speed Cooler 36”, 1/2 h.p. Three - Speed Motor Cools 2,500 Sq.ft 32 Gallon water capacity New easy rolling polyolefin caster Cord wrap • lowers temperatures up to 30 degrees • Energy efficient 11.2amps for pump and motor • 3/4” garden hose connection for longer running • Durable one-piece, rust-free, leak-proof molded polyethylene housing • Environmentally friendly efficient and effective resource use • Cools for a fraction of the cost of air conditioning • Cools without chemicals or refrigerants • Long-term dependability - near maintenance - free operation
48” Two Speed Cooler
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628)
48” , 1 h.p. Two-speed motor cools 4000 sq.ft Water Supply increased to 40 gallons quieter running fan easy rolling caster cord wrap
• lowers temperatures 15-25 degrees • Heavy-duty, easy rolling, polyolefin casters • New cord - wrap storage • Water capacity increased to 40 gallons • New three-blade, quieter operating fan blades • Expanded cooling areas - up to 4000 sq.ft • 3/4” garden hose connection for longer running • Durable one-piece, rust-free, leak-proof molded polyethylene housing • Environmentally friendly efficient and effective resource use • Cools for a fraction of the cost of air conditioning • Cools without chemicals or refrigerants • Long-term dependability - near maintenance - free operation
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
49
Loading Docks
Dock Lift
Loading Table
• Heavy duty design • For loading and unloading goods between ground and containers or trucks • Removable lifting eye to facilitate handling and loading table installation Model Capacity (kg)
HY2500 2500
Lowered Height (mm)
130
Raised Height (mm)
1700
Platform Size L x W (mm)
2000 x 2600
Base Frame Size (mm)
1900 x 2510
Lift Time (sec) Power Pack Net Weight (kg)
60~70 380V/50HZ, AC 2.2kw 1700
Dock Lift • Level
transfer from any dock height to any truck bed height • Leveler can go all the way down to grade level • No ramps or inclines • Capacities to 5000kgs
Model Capacity (kg)
5000
Lowered Height (mm)
600
Raised Height (mm)
2630
Platform Size L x W (mm) Net Weight (kg)
50
TL5000
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
2000 x 3000 1700
Loading Dock Leveler
Loading Docks
Hydraulic Dock Leveler Great performance and easy to use, Rite-Hite Hydraulic Dock Levelers require minima maintenance and have the lowest lifetime ownership costs.
2-1/2” lip cylinder Cylinder return lines Low pressure hydraulic system 4” main lifting cylinder
1 HP motor
• Push-button activation • Fully hydraulic platform positioning and lip extension • Free leveler movement through full working range • Heavy-duty toe guards • Advanced hydraulic system for full-range leveler float and automatic free-fall protection
• Exclusive SAFE-T-LIP barrier protects against vacant dock drop-off (optional) • Automatic recycle returns leveler to safe dock level position • Biodegradable fluid outperforms traditional industrial-grade fluid and is environmentally friendly • Hydraulic velocity fuse safety stop system halts rapid leveler descent within 3”
Mechanical Dock Leveler Rite-Hite Mechanical Dock Levelers provide an economical, reliable solution for basic dock leveler applications. • Simple operation with smooth, consistent walk-down • Superior design of heavy-duty ramp control system features the most proven hold-down device in the industry • Safe, positive lip extension provides consistent operation • Dual safety stops are provided to stop the leveler platform should the lip become unsupported
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628)
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
51
Loading Docks Loading Dock Leveler MECHANICAL EDGE-O-DOCK LEVELER • Saves time and space : Eliminates need to store, find and move portable plates to correct dock positions. • Easy, ergonomic operation : Leveler operating handle allows for simple operation without bending over the dock. • Easily upgradable tohydraulic operation : All mechanical units come ready for hydraulic upgrade. • High strength construction Ramp and lip made of high strength, low-alloy steel. • Grease fittings : Improve operation and reduce maintenance.
IDEAL FOR DOCKS SERVICING TRUCKS WITH MINIM AL HEIGHT DIFFERENC E, OR WHER E SPACE IS A PROBLEM.
Pitmaster UNDER-LEVELER SEAL Dirt. Debris. Pests. Heat. Cold. The many reasons you’ve installed a seal or shelter on your loading dock are the very same reasons you need a PitMaster Under-leveler Seal from Frommelt. • PitMaster is the industry’s first and only seal to complete the job of the dock seal or shelter by simply and effectively sealing the 4th side of the dock opening. With a variety of optional components, PitMaster can dramatically improve:
• Facility Cleanliness - Helps keep dirt, debris and refuse out of leveler pit; closes gaps around leveler that allow dirt, dust and insects into the building. Improves industrial hygiene and sanitation, and reduces white space to help pass AIB inspections. • Energy Savings - Seals gaps to prevent heating or cooling energy from escaping the building through air flow, and reduces heat transfer through steel leveler deck. Can save up to $900 per year per dock position in total energy savings, depending on climate. • Simple Installation and Maintenance - “One-sizefits-all” design installs easily on all Rite-Hite and Genisys levelers, and on many other leveler makes and models as well. Quick-disconnect feature allows main sealing curtain to be released for access to the leveler pit. PitMaster sealing components require no regular maintenance of their own.
52
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Loading Dock Door
Loading Docks
Steel Rite ii Sectional Dock Door Simple, straightforward design helps reduce maintenance costs and downtime from sectional door damage. • Rugged construction with durable Aketon™ facing and insulation added to the bottom two panels to provide enhanced impactability • Unique pivoting roller assemblies allow bottom two panels to separate from track upon impact -- simply reset the roller assemblies and the door continues to operate smoothly • True 24-gauge roll formed steel doors are ideal for moderateduty applications • Full perimeter seal and insulated inner core help minimize energy costs
FasTrax High Performance Doors Designed around a single operational platform, these highly versatile doors can match virtually any interior, exterior, high-wind, cooler or freezer high-cycle application - reducing the complexity of maintaining multiple door models in one facility. • Versatile track designs allow the door curtain to store in multiple track configurations and will fit in almost any application with fewer costly building modifications. • The industry’s safest door with multiple safety features including the standard Soft-Edge™ Technology, thru-beam photo eyes and optional I-Zone™ make FasTrax an easy choice for safety. • The industry’s highest operating speeds with operating speeds up to 100” per second, the fast cycle time maximizes productivity and energy savings.
For your free video demonstrati on, call 800-LO C8
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
53
Loading Docks Loading Dock Seals & Shelters Eliminator-GapMaster and Insulator SEALS & SHELTERS • Frommelt L-Pad dock seals are constructed with durable L-shaped foam side pads that flex against the sides of a truck as it backs in, creating an effective seal without causing foam to protrude into the trailer and obstruct access to loads. Plus, standard Firefighter™ Header Protection prevents the risk of burning from trailer marker lights. • Firefighter Header Protection - Ultra durable head pad or head curtain design features heat-dissipating, triple-layer foil construction between fabric layers, eliminating the risk of burning from trailer marker lights. Friction-resistant Durathon™ fabric face provides ultimate protection against wear. • Rugged ArmorPleats™ - Available on full length of side pads, ArmorPleats provide additional abrasion protection to extend the life of the dock seal. Available in high-strength, friction-resistant Durathon fabric for greatest resistance to wear. • Custom-Fit Design - All Frommelt dock seals are custommanufactured to fit the specifics of your dock and the trailer traffic you receive, to ensure the most efficient seal possible. • More Energy Savings at your Dock: Check out the PitMaster underleveler seal, to shave hundreds of dollars per year per dock position off your facility’s heating or cooling costs, while also preventing infiltration of dirt, debris and insects into your building and eliminating white space.
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628)
Unique, innovative designs offer sealing solutions to: • Trailer hinge gaps • Damage from trailer impact • Rain flowing off top of the trailer • Inadequate trailer access • Liftgate trailers • Damage from air-ride trailers
54
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Dock Lift
Loading Docks
Premium Truck Scissor Dock Lifts
OPTIONS
Save time and reduce man-hours where there are no docks. Pit or surface mount with the optional approach ramp. Engineered and designed for maximum safety and efficiency. Checkered plate deck is made of heavy gauge steel for years of use. Hydraulic cylinders feature emergency velocity fuse if line breaks. Complete with upper travel limit switch and overload relief valve. Push-button control is 24V AC on a 20 foot long coil cord. Prewired control box includes magnetic starter and overload fuse. High visibility removable handrails with fixed toeboards are standard. Includes beveled toe-guards and electric toe-guards around perimeter of platform. External 6.5 HP 208-230/460V, 3-phase, 60 Hz motor may be located up to 8 feet away from lift. OSHA and ANSI compliant.
REMOVABLE HANDRAILING AND TOEBOARDS model WL-RHT
STOP SIGNAL SIGN model WL-SSS
GALVANIZED FRAME AND DECK model SPO-WL-LS-ZRC
B
A A) ALUMINUM BRIDGE • WL-SATB B) STEEL BRIDGE • WL-SSTB
Shown with Optional Aluminum Bridge
MODEL NUMBER
PLATFORM SIZE )W x L(
LOWERED HEIGHT
RAISED HEIGHT
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
OVERALL FRAME )SIZE (W x L
.NET WT )POUNDS(
WL-100-5-48 WL-100-5-68 WL-100-5-78 WL-100-5-88 WL-100-5-610 WL-100-5-710 WL-100-5-810 WL-100-6-68 WL-100-6-78 WL-100-6-88 WL-100-6-610 WL-100-6-710 WL-100-6-810 WL-100-8-68 WL-100-8-78 WL-100-8-88 WL-100-8-610 WL-100-8-710 WL-100-8-810 WL-100-10-68 WL-100-10-78 WL-100-10-88 WL-100-10-610 WL-100-10-710 WL-100-10-810 WL-100-10-612 WL-100-10-712 WL-100-10-812 WL-100-12-68 WL-100-12-78 WL-100-12-88 WL-100-12-610 WL-100-12-710 WL-100-12-810 WL-100-12-612 WL-100-12-712 WL-100-12-812
"x 96 "48 "x 96 "72 "x 96 "84 "x 96 "96 "x 120 "72 "x 120 "84 "x 120 "96 "x 96 "72 "x 96 "84 "x 96 "96 "x 120 "72 "x 120 "84 "x 120 "96 "x 96 "72 "x 96 "84 "x 96 "96 "x 120 "72 "x 120 "84 "x 120 "96 "x 96 "72 "x 96 "84 "x 96 "96 "x 120 "72 "x 120 "84 "x 120 "96 "x 144 "72 "x 144 "84 "x 144 "96 "x 96 "72 "x 96 "84 "x 96 "96 "x 120 "72 "x 120 "84 "x 120 "96 "x 144 "72 "x 144 "84 "x 144 "96
"8 "8 "8 "8 "8 "8 "8 "10 "10 "10 "10 "10 "10 "10 "10 "10 "10 "10 "10 "12 "12 "12 "12 "12 "12 "12 "12 "12 "12 "12 "12 "12 "12 "12 "12 "12 "12
"68 "68 "68 "68 "68 "68 "68 "70 "70 "70 "70 "70 "70 "70 "70 "70 "70 "70 "70 "72 "72 "72 "72 "72 "72 "72 "72 "72 "72 "72 "72 "72 "72 "72 "72 "72 "72
5,000 5,000 5,000 5,000 5,000 5,000 5,000 6,000 6,000 6,000 6,000 6,000 6,000 8,000 8,000 8,000 8,000 8,000 8,000 10,000 10,000 10,000 10,000 10,000 10,000 10,000 10,000 10,000 12,000 12,000 12,000 12,000 12,000 12,000 12,000 12,000 12,000
"x 93 "41 "x 93 "62 "x 93 "62 "x 93 "86 "x 93 "62 "x 93 "62 "x 93 "86 "x 93 "62 "x 93 "62 "x 93 "86 "x 93 "62 "x 93 "62 "x 93 "86 "x 93 "62 "x 93 "62 "x 93 "86 "x 118 "62 "x 118 "62 "x 118 "86 "x 93 "62 "x 93 "62 "x 93 "86 "x 118 "62 "x 118 "62 "x 118 "86 "x 118 "62 "x 118 "62 "x 118 "86 "x 93 "62 "x 93 "62 "x 93 "86 "x 118 "62 "x 118 "62 "x 118 "86 "x 118 "62 "x 118 "62 "x 118 "86
3125 3485 3706 3952 3823 4027 4107 3648 3788 4167 3939 4038 4301 4396 4592 4698 4807 4913 5157 5804 5991 6177 6037 6224 6410 6504 6690 6876 6387 6573 6731 6620 6807 6993 7098 7225 7436
LIST PRICE EACH
$5,843.00 6,274.00 6,909.00 7,308.00 7,187.00 7,505.00 7,823.00 $6,551.00 7,171.00 7,788.00 7,607.00 7,798.00 7,836.00 $9,195.00 9,668.00 9,830.00 9,927.00 10,230.00 10,667.00 $11,097.00 11,714.00 12,030.00 12,052.00 12,229.00 12,601.00 12,782.00 12,889.00 14,657.00 $11,885.00 12,524.00 12,632.00 12,713.00 13,005.00 13,340.00 13,232.00 13,478.00 15,323.00
DC-20/FC-70
Premium Truck Scissor Dock Lift Options SPLIT ALUMINUM TRUCK BRIDGE: Standard steel bridge can be replaced with an aluminum bridge 72" wide x 18" long. Ideal for government applications. Model WL-SATB.
ADDITIONAL HYDRAULIC LINE: To order, tag model number with suffix WL-HH-(the amount of line needed in feet). Model WL-HH. (8 foot hose standard)
SPLIT STEEL BRIDGE: An additional split steel bridge can be added to opposite side of unit. 72" wide x 18" long. Model WLSSTB.
APPROACH RAMP FOR 8" LOWERED HEIGHT LIFTS: 60" wide x 65" long. 7° ramp angle. 308 lbs. Model WL-AR8.
REMOVABLE HANDRAILS/TOEBOARDS: When mounting this lift in a pit, this option allows platform to be flush with the floor for fork truck cross traffic. Deduct 7½" from overall width for usable width. Model WL-RHT. WARNING BEEPER & STROBE: Sounds and flashes during lifting and lowering operations. 80 decibels. Model WL-WB.
APPROACH RAMP FOR 10" LOWERED HEIGHT: 60" wide x 82" long. 7° ramp angle. 395 lbs. Model WL-AR10. APPROACH RAMP FOR 12" LOWERED HEIGHT: 60" wide x 98" long. 7° ramp angle. 474 lbs. Model WL-AR12. **APPROACH RAMPS MUST BE ANCHORED TO THE FLOOR**
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
55
Loading Docks Strip Curtains Vinyl Strip Doors • Helps to control noise, dust, fumes, and smoke • Reduces lost time opening and closing doors • Simple low cost design • Shipped ready to install - just unroll and attach • Easy to maintain
• Visual clarity provides speed without sacrificing safety • Fire resistant material is self-extinguishing • Minimizes drafts, reduces illnesses and accidents • Provides two way simultaneous traffic in larger doors • Reduce heating and cooling costs
MODEL FORMAT TG
-
SERIES
-
OVERLAP
-
MOUNTING
-
WIDTH (")
SERIES
SERIES STRIPS ARE 6" WIDE x 0.06" THICK "600" SERIES STRIPS ARE 8" WIDE x 0.08" THICK "800" SERIES STRIPS ARE 12" WIDE x 0.12" THICK "1200" SERIES STRIPS ARE 16" WIDE x 0.16" THICK "1600"
OVERLAP
S" FOR STANDARD 2/3 OVERLAP" F" FOR FULL OVERLAP"
MOUNTING
)W" FOR WALL MOUNT (EXTRA COST"
-
HEIGHT (")
)H" FOR HEADER MOUNT (STANDARD" DC-25/FC-85
HEADER MOUNT BRACKET
PRICE FORMULA )IN FEET(
TG-600-S TG-600-F TG-800-S TG-800-F TG-1200-S TG-1200-F TG-1600-S TG-1600-F
PRE-ASSEMBLED STRIP DOORS ALL DOORS ARE SHIPPED PRE-ASSEMBLED AND READY FOR INSTALLATION
STRIP DOOR MATERIAL STRIP DOOR OPTIONS
H - HEADER MOUNT W - WALL MOUNT RIBBED MATERIAL (8" & 12") LOW TEMPERATURE MATERIAL (-50°F) BRONZE WELD SCREEN MATERIAL (8" & 12") ORANGE OPAQUE MATERIAL (6", 8", 12" & 16")
STANDARD ADD 6% ADD 80% ADD 25% ADD 60% ADD 60%
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628)
STRIP DOOR NET WEIGHT FORMULA (IN FEET)
MOUNTING TG-600-S TG-600-F TG-800-S TG-800-F TG-1200-S TG-1200-F TG-1600-S TG-1600-F
(3.5 x WIDTH') (3.5 x WIDTH') (3.5 x WIDTH') (3.5 x WIDTH') (3.5 x WIDTH') (3.5 x WIDTH') (3.5 x WIDTH') (3.5 x WIDTH')
STRIPS + + + + + + + +
(0.75 x WIDTH' x HEIGHT') (1.00 x WIDTH' x HEIGHT') (1.00 x WIDTH' x HEIGHT') (1.25 x WIDTH' x HEIGHT') (1.30 x WIDTH' x HEIGHT') (1.60 x WIDTH' x HEIGHT') (1.75 x WIDTH' x HEIGHT') (2.15 x WIDTH' x HEIGHT')
STANDARD 2/3 OVERLAP
FULL OVERLAP
NOTE: WIDTH AND HEIGHT IS SIZE OF DOOR OPENING IN FEET REPLACEMENT STRIPS
TG
56
-
STRIP -
)WIDTH (6, 8, 12, 16 INCHES
-
LENGTH IN FEET
6 INCH x .06 INCH 8 INCH x .08 INCH 12 INCH x .12 INCH 16 INCH x .16 INCH
(300 FEET/ROLL) (300 FEET/ROLL) (200 FEET/ROLL) (100 FEET/ROLL)
76#/ROLL 135#/ROLL 172#/ROLL 156#/ROLL
8 INCH RIBBED 12 INCH RIBBED
(150 FEET/ROLL) (150 FEET/ROLL)
55#/ROLL 120#/ROLL
NOTE: STRIP DOORS ARE CUT TO SIZE, THEREFORE THEY ARE NON-RETURNABLE
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Yard Ramps
Loading Docks Aluminum Yard Ramps • 18" x 5" Mold-On-Rubber Tires (standard) • 4" Curb Height • Flow Control Valve • Service Height Range is 37" to 63" • Safety Anchor Chains • Hand Pump Hydraulic Lift • Fork Towbar Standard
ALUMINUM GRATING series AY
Portable Aluminum Yard Ramps have a unique design that allows one person to position, raise/lower, and then load/unload trailers from ground level. Available with steel or rust resistant aluminum grating.
STEEL GRATING series SY
ALUMINUM YARD RAMPS WITH STEEL GRATING MODEL CAPACITY OVERALL NUMBER (POUNDS) WIDTH
SY-167230 SY-168430 SY-169330 SY-167236-L SY-168436-L SY-169336-L SY-207230 SY-208430 SY-209330 SY-207236-L SY-208436-L SY-209336-L SY-257230 SY-258430 SY-259330 SY-257236-L SY-258436-L SY-259336-L SY-307230 SY-308430 SY-307236-L SY-308436-L
16,000 16,000 16,000 16,000 16,000 16,000 20,000 20,000 20,000 20,000 20,000 20,000 25,000 25,000 25,000 25,000 25,000 25,000 30,000 30,000 30,000 30,000
"72 "84 "93 "72 "84 "93 "72 "84 "93 "72 "84 "93 "72 "84 "93 "72 "84 "93 "72 "84 "72 "84
USABLE WIDTH
LENGTH (FEET)
NET WT. (POUNDS)
"66 "78 "87 "66 "78 "87 "66 "78 "87 "66 "78 "87 "66 "78 "87 "66 "78 "87 "66 "78 "66 "78
30 30 30 36 36 36 30 30 30 36 36 36 30 30 30 36 36 36 30 30 36 36
3518 4043 4515 4305 4830 5303 3623 4148 4620 4410 4935 5408 3675 4200 4725 4463 4988 5513 3728 4253 4515 5040
18" x 5" Mold-On-Rubber Tires are Standard
Hand Pump Hydraulic Lift Standard
DC-20/FC-TL
ALUMINUM YARD RAMPS WITH ALUMINUM GRATING
MODEL NUMBER AY-167230 AY-168430 AY-169330 AY-167236-L AY-168436-L AY-169336-L AY-207230 AY-208430 AY-209330 AY-207236-L AY-208436-L AY-209336-L AY-257230 AY-258430 AY-259330 AY-257236-L AY-258436-L AY-259336-L AY-307230 AY-308430 AY-307236-L AY-308436-L
CAPACITY (POUNDS) 16,000 16,000 16,000 16,000 16,000 16,000 20,000 20,000 20,000 20,000 20,000 20,000 25,000 25,000 25,000 25,000 25,000 25,000 30,000 30,000 30,000 30,000
OVERALL WIDTH "72 "84 "93 "72 "84 "93 "72 "84 "93 "72 "84 "93 "72 "84 "93 "72 "84 "93 "72 "84 "72 "84
USABLE WIDTH "66 "78 "87 "66 "78 "87 "66 "78 "87 "66 "78 "87 "66 "78 "87 "66 "78 "87 "66 "78 "66 "78
LENGTH (FEET) 30 30 30 36 36 36 30 30 30 36 36 36 30 30 30 36 36 36 30 30 36 36
NET WT. (POUNDS) 2783 3150 3465 3360 3728 3990 2888 3255 3570 3465 3833 4095 2940 3308 3675 3578 3885 4200 3092 3360 3570 3938
Pneumatic Tires OPTION Service Range will be 40" to 66" suffix PNTR
6" CURB HEIGHT OPTION suffix CRB6
YELLOW SAFETY CURBs OPTION suffix YEL
DC-20/FC-TL
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
57
Loading Docks Gas Model Gas Model Aluminum manual ramp with the assistance of a gas piston. The Ramp can’t move from it’s place ,but it rotates around an iron support that has to be solded on the platform
CODE CR-GAS120A CR-GAS160A CR-GAS200A CR-GAS120B CR-GAS160B CR-GAS200B
WIDTH mm 1650 1650 1650 2000 2000 2000
LENGHT mm 1200 1600 2000 1200 1600 2000
WEIGHT mm
H MIN/MAX mm
70 90
300/250 350/300
110 90 105
400/350 300/250 350/300
125
400/350
Gas Model Capacity Max 400 KG The ramp is supplied assembled and tested It is possible to place the ramp manually thanks to a lateral rigid pole this surface is very big and a gas piston bears the 90% of all the weight the ramp slide on an iron or aluminum rails WIDTH mm 1650 1650 1650
CODE GAS120A GAS160A GAS200A GAS120B GAS160B GAS200B
2000 2000 2000
LENGHT mm 1200 1600 2000 1200 1600 2000
WEIGHT mm
H MIN/MAX mm
70 90
300/250 350/300
110 90 105
400/350 300/250 350/300
125
400/350
Iron rail can be selled only by pieces of 3000mm
Aluminum rail can be selled only by pieces of 2400 mm and of 3000mm
58
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Dock lights
Loading Docks
CoolMan 2500 Trailer Fan Designed for manual parcel loading and unloading. Cool Man 2500 Trailer Fan swivels on unique bracketing to service two loading dock openings. Easily moves out of opening for full access fork truck traffic. Pivots for directional air flow. Conditions trailer environment to warmer or cooler facility temperature.
Specifications
• Frommelt /2 hp, 5 FLA, 3 speed motor • Low speed 1600 CFM, middle speed 2000 CFM, high speed 2500 CFM • Heavy-duty polyethylene housing • 25’ power cord • Heavy-duty 11 gauge positioning arm with swiveling and pivoting bracketing
Optional dock light for trailer lighting
HD-LED Dock Light
• 15 watts • Minimum life of 50,000 hours at 70% lumen maintenance • Always cool-to-the-touch • 5-year warranty
Standard Cool-Head
Flexible spring arm design
Flexible Spring Arm
Light Communication Kit Establish a clear line of communication between drivers and dock personnel • 12 1/8” high x 6 3/16” wide x 2” deep (light cover projects 3 5/8 “) • Clearly visible green and red lights • Black polypropylene housing • Two 12-volt automotive bulbs • Inside toggle switch manually changes lights between green and red • Middle switch position provides “red-red” safety condition • One inside and two outside caution signs • UL Listed
Flexible arm springs back from overhead door and fork truck impacts INSIDE CONTROL BOX
OUTSIDE LIGHT BOX
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628)
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
59
STORAGE GARMENT RAILS & UTILITY CUPBOARDS MEDIUM DUTY GARMENT RAILS Epoxy powder coated Black Welded tubular Steel construction Mobile models are mounted on4 x 50mm PVC swivel castors O/A Size LxWxH
Static Model Single Bar
Max Load
Mobile Model
80kg
1200 x 490 x 1800
GSG14Z
GSG14Y
1800 x 490 x 1800
GSG16Z
GSG16Y
Double Bar 1200 x 490 x 1800
GSG24Z
GSG24Y
1800 x 490 x 1800
GSG26Z
GSG26Y
GSG26Y
shelving &
GS8053
GSG16Z
2X GSG36N
NESTING FRAME RAIL
NESTING GARMENT RAIL
Overall Size L x W x H mm 1220 x 490 x 1800 1800 x 490 x 1800
Model GS8053
1220 x 500 x 1760
HEAVY DUTY RAIL
Z frame rails constructed from welded tubular SteelRail Height: 1770mm Mobile on 50mm PVC castors
Chrome, finished in Black paint Adjustable Centre Rail 990 / 1142 / 1295mm Mobile on 125mm cushion castors Overall Size L x W x H mm
GSG44R
Model GSG34N GSG36N
Welded tubular Steel construction Mobile on 125mm Rubber castors Rail Height: 1920mm Handle Height: 1030mm Overall Size L x W x H mm 1200 x 500 x 1930 1800 x 500 x 1930
Model GSG44R GSG46R
PLASTIC CUPBOARDS Manufactured from high quality PlasticIdeal Ideal for many applications including Kitchens/Cafeterias Janitorial Closets Schools, Offices etc Hygienic - easy to clean
Features 4 Shelves
Overall Size L x W x H mm Large Cupboard 650 x 450 x 1800
Weight kg
Model
17
CE1804
18
CE180U
Utility Cupboard 3 Half Shelves, 1 Full Shelf & Divider
650 x 450 x 1800
CE1804
60
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Wire Mesh Lockers
STORAGE
Bright Electroplated Zinclockers which offer full throughventilation & high visual security Single tier lockers come complete with a Hat Shelf & Coat Hook Single & two tier lockers comecomplete with a coat hook Powder coated in
Yellow Blue Red - please specify when ordering Other colours available - Call for Details
UNITS CAN BE MANUFACTURED TO YOUR SPECIFICATION - CALL FOR DETAILS Manufactured from 25 x 25 x 2.5welded mesh on a 8mm rod frame.Each locker is fitted with floorfixing brackets with provision tobe fitted back to back, to the wall& to the floor (fixings not included The Single & Double compartmentlockers have 3 point locking system& the rest of the lockers are fittedwith a Hasp & Staple for use witha padlock (not included
Description
Locker Size H x W mm 305mm Deep Lockers
Single Compartment - Nest of One 1980 x 305 Single Compartment - Nest of Two each Single Compartment - Nest of Three Two Compartment - Nest of One 1980 x 305 Two Compartment - Nest of Two each Two Compartment - Nest of Three Three Compartment - Nest of One 1980 x 305 Three Compartment - Nest of Two each Three Compartment - Nest of Three Four Compartment - Nest of One 1980 x 305 Four Compartment - Nest of Two each Four Compartment - Nest of Three Five Compartment - Nest of One 1980 x 305 Five Compartment - Nest of Two each Five Compartment - Nest of Three Six Compartment - Nest of One 1980 x 305 Six Compartment - Nest of Two each Six Compartment - Nest of Three 457mm Deep Lockers Single Compartment - Nest of One 1980 x 305 Single Compartment - Nest of Two each Single Compartment - Nest of Three Two Compartment - Nest of One 1980 x 305 Two Compartment - Nest of Two each Two Compartment - Nest of Three Three Compartment - Nest of One 1980 x 305 Three Compartment - Nest of Two each Three Compartment - Nest of Three Four Compartment - Nest of One 1980 x 305 Four Compartment - Nest of Two each Four Compartment - Nest of Three Five Compartment - Nest of One 1980 x 305 Five Compartment - Nest of Two each Five Compartment - Nest of Three Six Compartment - Nest of One 1980 x 305 Six Compartment - Nest of Two each Six Compartment - Nest of Three
Model WM305SD WM305SDN2 WM305SDN3 WM3052D WM3052DN2 WM3052DN3 WM3053D WM3053DN2 WM3053DN3 WM3054D WM3054DN2 WM3054DN3 WM3055D WM3055DN2 WS3055DN3 WM3056D WM3056DN2 WM3056DN3 WM450SD WM450SDN2 WM450SDN3 WM4502D WM4502DN2 WM4502DN3 WM4503D WM4503DN2 WM4503DN3 WM4504D WM4504DN2 WM4504DN3 WM4505D WM4505DN2 WM4505DN3 WM4506D WM4506DN2 WM4506DN3
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
61
STORAGE Wire Mesh Lockers • Electro galvanised finish. • Full through ventilation. •C ontents can be visually inspected. • 150 mm high legs as standard. • Three point locking on single and two compartment lockers.
Wire mesh lockers are ideal for most applications and offer excellent ventililation and high visual security. Manufactured from 25 mm x 25 mm x 2.5 mm weld mesh on a 8 mm rod frame. 1980 mm high x 305 mm wide x 305 mm or 450 mm deep. All lockers are fitted with legs as standard enabling easy access for cleaning. All lockers can be nested side by side or back to back and include floor fixing brackets. Doors are fitted with a hasp and staple for use with padlock. (padlock not included) Single and two compartment lockers are fitted with coat hooks.
Description Single Compartment - Initial Locker Single Compartment - Nest of Two Single Compartment - Nest of Three Two Compartment - Initial Locker Two Compartment - Nest of Two Two Compartment - Nest of Three Four Compartment - Initial Locker Four Compartment - Nest of Two Four Compartment - Nest of Three Six Compartment - Initial Locker Six Compartment - Nest of Two Six Compartment - Nest of Three Single Compartment - Initial Locker Single Compartment - Nest of Two Single Compartment - Nest of Three Two Compartment - Initial Locker Two Compartment - Nest of Two Two Compartment - Nest of Three Four Compartment - Initial Locker Four Compartment - Nest of Two Four Compartment - Nest of Three Six Compartment - Initial Locker Six Compartment - Nest of Two Six Compartment - Nest of Three
62
Dimensions H x W x D mm
Model
Price
1980 x 305 x 305 1980 x 305 x 305 1980 x 305 x 305 1980 x 305 x 305 1980 x 305 x 305 1980 x 305 x 305 1980 x 305 x 305 1980 x 305 x 305 1980 x 305 x 305 1980 x 305 x 305 1980 x 305 x 305 1980 x 305 x 305 1980 x 305 x 457 1980 x 305 x 457 1980 x 305 x 457 1980 x 305 x 457 1980 x 305 x 457 1980 x 305 x 457 1980 x 305 x 457 1980 x 305 x 457 1980 x 305 x 457 1980 x 305 x 457 1980 x 305 x 457 1980 x 305 x 457
CM010BZP0002 CM010BZP0004 CM010BZP0006 CM010BZP0020 CM010BZP0022 CM010BZP0024 CM010BZP0056 CM010BZP0058 CM010BZP0060 CM010BZP0074 CM010BZP0076 CM010BZP0078 CM010BZP0014 CM010BZP0016 CM010BZP0018 CM010BZP0032 CM010BZP0034 CM010BZP0036 CM010BZP0068 CM010BZP0070 CM010BZP0072 CM010BZP0086 CM010BZP0088 CM010BZP0090
POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA
The picture above shows a nest of three single compartment lockers. Nested Lockers are cost effective when runs of lockers are required. Check out the price table.
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Tool Cupboards
STORAGE
An extensive range of high quality tool cabinets for use in workshops, factories & warehouses All Steel construction - add extra drawers shelves to suit your application
984H x 915W x 505D mm
684H x 450W x 300D mm
Model: CH961EGU..29S12
Model: CA521EGU..00S11
Description
Width mm
Model
Sloping Top Desk Unit
480
CDE56TGU
Mobile Chassis for low cabinets Only Extra Drawer Extra Galvanised Shelf
480
480
984H x 915W x 505D mm Model: CH961TGU..29S37
1Adjustable 2 Shelves 984H x 480W x 505D mm
DW56THY
Model: CH661TGU..29S35
CSH56TGT
2Shelves, 2 Drawers 4Shelves 1820H x 480W x 505D mm
2Shelves, 2 Drawers
1820H x 480W x 505D mm
8Shelves
Model: C1661TGU..29S35
1820H x 915W x 505D mm
1820H x 915W x 505D mm Model: C1961TGU..29S44
Model: C1961TGU..29S32
Model: C1661TGU..29S31
Standard Colour Choice
984H x 480W x 505D mm Model: CH661EGU..29S12
1Adjustable & 1 Shelves
CCH56TGU
480C
2 Adjustable Shelves
1Adjustable Shelves
2Adjustable Shelves
BODY/DOOR COLOURO Light Grey (RAL 7035) Code GU
PTIONAL DOOR COLOURS Blue (RAL 5002) Code CF
Red (RAL 3020) Code RD
Green (RAL 6001) Code PD
Burgundy (RAL 3002) Code RM
Yellow (RAL 1003) Code YD
Dark Grey (BS 00 A 11) Code HY
Insert the code of the door colour required to the product code when ordering. For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
63
STORAGE Public Safety Lockers
FREE STYLE Lockers PEOPLE. EQUIPMENT. STORAGE REQUIREMENTS. Here’s a locker system that changes just as fast. Start with sizes that fit your space, and configurations that meet your demands. Then include a range of accessories that adapt to your needs.
Make it your own – it could be the last locker system
64
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Public safety lockers
STORAGE
EVIDENCE STORAGE Lockers
The pass-thru locker is built into the wall, allowing evidence to be deposited from one side and retrieved from another. The full-size rear door allows the evidence technician to efficiently remove items and reset the locker openings for use. To further enhance security, we offer an optional front-lock-out system. This feature will automatically lock the front doors when the rear door is opened preventing unauthorized access to the evidence and property room through a locker opening.
refrigerated Lockers Your local appliance distributor doesn’t understand the importance of the chain of custody of evidence. So why would you store your critical biological evidence in a standard residential refrigerator with a chain and padlock? Our refrigerated evidence lockers offer the same performance, reliability and security that our standard evidence lockers come with, both with pass-thru and non-pass-thru functionality.
The small refrigerator unit is designed to stand alone or fit into any lower ‘D’ size opening of our evidence lockers. Can be installed on-site into existing evidence lockers as well. Comes standard with four lockable compartments.
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
65
STORAGE PERSONNEL LOCKERS Personnel Lockers A comprehensive range of lockers with a superior finish designed and built to last. Ideal for schools, offices, factories and sports centres etc. Powder Coated as standard offering unbeatable value for money. Single Compartment Lockers 300 mm and 450 mm deep, fitted with hat shelf and double coat hook. Rail as standard on 450 mm deep lockers. Two compartment lockers fitted with double coat hook in each compartment.
Perforated Lockers Designed to allow the contents to be visually inspected and allow thorough ventilation.
Features - Semi-concealed hinges for security and clean line. Door stiffeners for added strength and security. Vents in top and bottom for improved air circulation. Recessed Camlock with plastic card holder. Plinth Base for rigidity. All lockers pre-drilled for nesting.
Specification - Riveted/Welded construction, cold rolled mild steel. Finish - Epoxy powder coating electrostatically applied, producing an exceptionally high quality chip-resistant finish in the following Colours:Light Grey/Light Grey, Light Grey/Blue, Light Grey/Red, Light Grey/Green. Other Colours available, please ask for details. HEIGHT WIDTH
DEPTH
Standard MODEL
SINGLE TIER 1800 mm 300 mm 300 mm
M3030/1
1800 mm 300 mm 450 mm
M3045/1
1800 mm 450 mm 450 mm
M4545/1
Single Tier
Two Tier
Three Tier
Six Tier
Perforated Locker
TWO TIER 1800 mm 300 mm 300 mm
M3030/2
1800 mm 300 mm 450 mm
M3045/2
1800 mm 450 mm 450 mm
M4545/2
THREE TIER 1800 mm 300 mm 300 mm
M3030/3
1800 mm 300 mm 450 mm
M3045/3
1800 mm 450 mm 450 mm
M4545/3
FOUR TIER 1800 mm 300 mm 300 mm
M3030/4
1800 mm 300 mm 450 mm
M3045/4
1800 mm 450 mm 450 mm
M4545/4
SIX TIER 1800 mm 300 mm 300 mm
M3030/6
1800 mm 300 mm 450 mm
M3045/6
1800 mm 450 mm 450 mm
M4545/6
* Prices available for Nest of 2/3 models. Four Tier
Clean & Dirty Locker Paint Finish Fitted with a central partition below shelf. A very useful locker for the factory or anywhere Door Colours with Light Grey body RAL 7035 where clean and dirty/wet and dry clothes are in use. Coat hooks fitted beneath shelf. Nurses Locker Has a central partition below shelf, one side fitted with coat rail and the other fitted with three fixed shelves. Two Person Locker Provides secure storage compartments for two. A small compartment 9� high for personal items and a 50� high compartment fitted with coat hooks. One key passes both compartments.
66
Nurses locker
Two Person locker
Red - RAL 3020
Green - RAL 6001
Grey - RAL 7035
DEPTH
MODEL INITIAL
CLEAN/DIRTY
1800 mm
450 mm
450 mm
CDL
AED 395.15
NURSES
1800 mm
450 mm
450 mm
NRL
AED 395.15
TWO PERSON
1800 mm
450 mm
450 mm
TPL
AED 395.15
HEIGHT
Clean & Dirty locker
Blue - RAL 5002
WIDTH
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Yellow - RAL 1003
-
VALUE RANGE
STORAGE
Value Range
Available in one Colour only. Delivered from stock. The ideal product when budgets are tight. A quality product at a value for money price. e ee th To s nge, a full r -LOC8 800 call
Specification - Riveted/Welded construction, cold rolled steel. HEIGHT WIDTH
DEPTH
MODEL
INITIAL
SINGLE TIER 1800 mm
300 mm
300 mm M3030/1V
1800 mm
300 mm
450 mm M3045/1V
TWO TIER 1800 mm
300 mm
300 mm M3030/2V
1800 mm
300 mm
450 mm M3045/2V
FOUR TIER 1800 mm
300 mm
300 mm M3030/4V
1800 mm
300 mm
450 mm M3045/4V
1800 mm
300 mm
300 mm M3030/6V
1800 mm
300 mm
450 mm M3045/6V
SIX TIER
Two Tier
Single Tier
Four Tier
Cube Lockers Ideal where space is limited, can be nested in any configuration. HEIGHT
WIDTH
DEPTH
MODEL
12” (305) 12” (305)
12” (305)
12C
15” (381) 15” (381)
15” (381)
15C
18” (457) 18” (457)
18” (457)
18C
Quarto Lockers
INITIAL
QUARTO lockers offer individual personal security in the workplace as ‘stacked’ units or to fill spaces above standard lockers. Units can be bolted together on the top
Six Tier
Garment Dispensers This range is ideal for the secure storage and distribution of clean garments with single and multi change of garments available from unmanned dispensers. The user is issued with a key to gain access to his or her own compartment. Two keys are supplied with each compartment. The service key is used to open the main door, this enables all compartments to be loaded. The service key also opens the collector. Collector Locker For the secure storage of soiled garments, avoiding losses and keeping the area tidy. Soiled garments are deposited through the opening in the top of the door. A galvanised anti-theft shelf is fitted below the opening.
HEIGHT WIDTH
DEPTH
70”(1778) 15” (381)
18” (457) 5 DOOR
70”(1778) 15” (381)
18” (457) 10 DOOR
70”(1778) 15” (381)
18” (457) 15 DOOR
70”(1778) 15” (381)
18” (457) Collector
MODEL
INITIAL
Postal Slot Locker Allows sorted mail to be posted via a slot into secure compartments which can only be accessed by the keyholder. HEIGHT WIDTH
DEPTH
MODEL
PRICE
Post Locker with 10 compartments HEIGHT
WIDTH
DEPTH
MODEL
511 mm 511 mm
300 mm 300 mm
300 mm 450 mm
MQ3030 MQ3045
INITIAL
457 mm POST 10 1778 mm 381 mm Post Locker with 15 compartments 1778 mm 381 mm
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
457 mm
POST 10
67
STORAGE LOCKERS SERIES 111
Traditional Locker Outfit of each compartment • Top shelf with coat-hanger rod • Umbrella holder with drip-tray • Card holder Closing systems • Nylon handle that can be padlocked • Metal handle that can be padlocked • Cylinder lock Model Dim W x D x H
111/01
111/02
111/03
35 x 35 x 180
70 x 35 x 180
105 x 35 x 180
SERIES 113
Double Tier Locker Equipment • Back coat-hanger • Card holder
Optionals • Plastic shell for feet • Door colours • Shelf for Shoes • Sloping roofs
Closing systems • Nylon handle that can be padlocked • Metal handle that can be padlocked • Cylinder lock Model Dim W x D x H
111/01
111/02
111/03
35 x 35 x 180
70 x 35 x 180
105 x 35 x 180
SERIES 717/P Changing-Room Locker Equipment • Top shelf with coat-hanger rod • Card holder • Clean/dirty clothes partition • Umbrella holder with drip-tray
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628)
Closing systems • Nylon handle that can be padlocked • Metal handle that can be padlocked • Cylinder lock Optionals • Plastic shell for feet • Door colours • Shelf for Shoes • Sloping roofs Model Dim W x D x H
68
717/01P
717/02P
717/03P
40 x 50 x 180
80 x 50 x 180
120 x 50 x 180
Volume
23
42
61
Article
0.36
0.72
1.08
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
INSIGHT LOCKERS
STORAGE
Insight lockers Insight lockers are designed for use in areas where there is a need for a visual inspection of contents without compromising the security of items stored. The clear polyethylene panels allow easy inspection of contents, acting as a deterrent to workplace pilfering or providing quick visual stocktaking of items stored. When used in public areas Insight Lockers provide security staff with the ability to check that items stored are not inappropriate or pose no security threat. 2 Door locker has double coat hook in each compartment.
HEIGHT
WIDTH
DEPTH
MODEL
INITIAL
2 DOOR 1800 mm
300 mm
300 mm
I3030/2
1800 mm
300 mm
450 mm
I3045/2
1800 mm
300 mm
500 mm
I3050/2
1800 mm
300 mm
300 mm
I3030/3
1800 mm
300 mm
450 mm
I3045/3
1800 mm
300 mm
500 mm
I3050/3
1800 mm
300 mm
300 mm
I3030/4
1800 mm
300 mm
450 mm
I3045/4
1800 mm
300 mm
500 mm
I3050/4
1800 mm
400 mm
450 mm
I4045/4
1800 mm
400 mm
500 mm
I4045/4
1800 mm
300 mm
300 mm
I3030/6
1800 mm
300 mm
450 mm
I3045/6
1800 mm
300 mm
500 mm
I3050/6
1800 mm
300 mm
300 mm
I3030/8
1800 mm
300 mm
450 mm
I3045/8
1800 mm
300 mm
500 mm
I3050/8
3 DOOR
4 DOOR
6 DOOR 2 Door
6 Door
4 Door
3 Door
8 Door
Paint Finish - Door Colours with Light Grey body - RAL 7035
8 DOOR Grey RAL 7035
Red RAL 3020
Blue RAL 5002
Green RAL 6001
Yellow RAL 1003
Personal Item Lockers Personal lockers can be supplied in singles or nests of two. The locker units can be hung on walls or bolted one on top of the other and side by side to form banks of lockers. All units are fitted with a standard deadlock and are available with either a solid or perforated doors and with or without sloping tops at no extra price. Please specify at the time of ordering. HEIGHT
WIDTH
DEPTH
MODEL
INITIAL
SINGLE - 4 DOOR WITHOUT GROMMETS
915 mm
250 mm
155 mm A10641A01
WITH GROMMETS
915 mm
250 mm
155 mm A10641A81
WITHOUT GROMMETS 915 mm
250 mm
155 mm A10681A01
915 mm
250 mm
155 mm A10681A81
SINGLE - 8 DOOR WITH GROMMETS
DOUBLE - 4 DOOR WITHOUT GROMMETS
915 mm
475 mm
155 mm A10642A01
WITH GROMMETS
915 mm
475 mm
155 mm A10642A81
DOUBLE - 8 DOOR WITHOUT GROMMETS
915 mm
475 mm
155 mm A10682A01
WITH GROMMETS
915 mm
475 mm
155 mm A10682A81
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
69
STORAGE LOCKER ACCESSORIES LOCKER STANDS are manufactured from 25 x 25 x 16 Swg square tube, epoxy polyester powder coated to match locker body. Hardwood slats fitted to seats and benches, finished with 2 coats of varnish. Delivered fully assembled with adjustable feet. A range of free - standing benches are also available on request. NUMBER OF LOCKERS WIDE SIZE mm
Sloping Tops for Lockers (factory Fitted) Keep your changing room clean and tidy. Eliminate the possibility of items being stored or left on top of lockers.
MODEL LS3030/3
LS3030/4
LS3045/2
LS3045/3
LS3045/4
1800h x 450w x 450d STAND
LS4545/1
LS4545/2
LS4545/3
LS4545/4
1800h x 300w x 300d ST/SEAT
LSS3030/1
LSS3030/2
LSS3030/3
LSS3030/4
1800h x 300w x 450d ST/SEAT
LSS3045/1
LSS3045/2
LSS3045/3
LSS3045/4
1800h x 450w x 450d ST/SEAT
LSS4545/1
LSS4545/2
LSS4545/3
LSS4545/4
12” CUBE
STAND
662001
662002
662003
NA
15” CUBE
STAND
662101
662102
662103
NA
18” CUBE
STAND
Number Plates available in a range of Colours with matching key ring if required.
662201
662202
Bridge Unit Packs Are designed to fit between two lockers and provide additional clothes hanging space or support for LOCKERS.
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628)
NA
MODEL
PRICE
LOCKER ACCESSORIES BRIDGE UNIT TOP
BUT
BRIDGE UNIT BOTTOM
BUB
IVORENE NUMBER PLATES
INP
NUMBERED KEY RINGS
NKR
CAPTIVE COAT HANGER - CHROME
CCHAC
CAPTIVE COAT HOOK - CHROME
CCHOC
PISTOL GRIP PADLOCK FITTING
PISTOL
COIN RETAIN LOCKS (FITTED)
Pistol Grip Lock For use with padlock (padlock not supplied). Numbering system available.
Cube Locker Stand
662203
four
LS3030/2
LS3045/1
three
LS3030/1
1800h x 300w x 450d STAND
two
Locker Stand/Seat
TYPE
1800h x 300w x 300d STAND
one
Locker Stand
COIN RETURN LOCKS (FITTED) 3 POINT LOCKING - 1 TIER LOCKER ONLY
3PL
SPARE KEY 95/97 AND 66/68 SERIES
SK
MASTER KEY 95/97 AND 66/68 SERIES
MK
COMBINATION LOCK
SLOPING TOP - FACTORY FITTED
Tool Lockers
300 x 300 mm
ST3030
300 x 450 mm
ST3045
450 x 450 mm
ST4245
Tool Locker ‘A’ with one adjustable shelf.
Tool Lockers ‘D’ with two adjustable shelves.
70
Tool Lockers ‘DDTL’ two adjustable shelves and three point locking.
HEIGHT
WIDTH
DEPTH
30” (762)
18” (457)
12” (305)
1
A
36” (914)
18” (457)
18” (457)
2
D
36” (914)
36” (914)
18” (457)
2
DDTL
No. OF SHELVES MODEL
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
PRICE
Mobile & Roller Shutter Cabinets
STORAGE
HEAVY DUTY ROLLER SHUTTER DOOR CABINETS Heavy Duty welded construction in 1.2mm sheet Steel Counter balanced Galvanised Steel Roller Shutter door Matching heavy duty security pin locks Modular construction to accommodate a wide range of accessories 5colour options available
Green
Blue
RAL3020 RAL6032
Red
RAL5015
Grey
Mid Grey
RAL7031
RAL7001
please specify when ordering
Description 3 Shelves 1/2 Louvre Panel, 2 Drawers & 2 Shelves 1/2 Louvre Panel, 6 Drawers & 1 Shelf Full Louvre Panel Extra Shelf to Suit 1000W Models3 Shelves 1/2 Louvre Panel, 2 Drawers & 2 Shelves 1/2 Louvre Panel, 6 Drawers & 1 Shelf Full Louvre Panel Extra Shelf to Suit 1200W Models-
Overall Size H x W x D mm 2000 x 1000 x 500
2000 x 1200 x 500
Model 90215A 90215C 90215D 90215E 90S15 902215A 902215C 902215D 902215E 90S25
MOBILE STORAGE CUPBOARDS Heavy Duty welded construction in1.2mm sheet Steel With 2 or 3 bolt in adjustable shelves 4colour options available
Red
Green
Blue
Grey
please specify when ordering
Strong full length piano type hinges Secured by a 3 point locking handle Tubular push/pull handle & 4 rubber corner buffers Mobile on 125mm castors, 2 fixed & 2 swivel braked
Overall Size H x W x D mm 900 x 900 x 600
No of Shelves 2
81996
1200 x 900 x 600
2
81296
1500 x 900 x 600
3
81596
900 x 1200 x 600
2
81926
1200 x 1200 x 600
2
81226
1500 x 1200 x 600
3
Extra Shelf to Suit 900 x 600 Units-
Extra Shelf to Suit 1200 x 600 Units-
Model
81S9
81526 91S12
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
71
STORAGE Tote Pans & Racks 1 STACKING RACK SYSTEM
11
Can be stacked up to 3 high, storing pans 4 wide Horizontal or tilted shelves for ease of component viewing
2 HIGH DENSITY RACK SYSTEM Allows for the most economical use of available space Stacking up to 2 racks high, storing 4 pans wide Safety stops allow access without the full withdrawal of pans
3 TILTED RACK SYSTEM Welded construction with pan retainers With tilted shelves for component viewing
4 HORIZONTAL RACK SYSTEM As the Tilted Rack System except with horizontal shelves for component viewing
GALVANISED TOTE PANS These are the classic pan for storage & work in progress Strong construction of Galvanised Steel with half-lift handles, card holders, re-inforced rim & stacking brackets Ideal for bulk storage & item picking Load Capacity: 25kg each
2
2x GST13 No of Pans High
Overall H x D x W mm
Weight kg
Suitable For Pan
Horizontal Model
Tilted Model
Stacking Rack System - Increase the height by 100mm for Tilted Racks
3
3 Pans
640 x 305 x 1350
15
12xGTP01
GSH01
GST11
640 x 455 x 1350
21
12xGTP02
GSH02
GST12
640 x 610 x 1350
27
12xGTP03
GSH03
GST13
High Density Rack System - Horizontal shelves only 5 Pans
GDR03
GRT13
900 x 305 x 1350
25
20xGTP01
GDR01
-
900 x 455 x 1350
35
20xGTP02
GDR02
-
900 x 610 x 1350
45
20xGTP03
GDR03
-
Horizontal/Tilted Rack System - Increase the height by 100mm for Tilted Racks 6 Pans
4
8 Pans
1230 x 305 x 1350
30
24xGTP01
GRH01
GRT11
1230 x 455 x 1350
42
24xGTP02
GRH02
GRT12
1230 x 610 x 1350
54
24xGTP03
GRH03
GRT13
1620 x 305 x 1350
40
32xGTP01
GRH04
GRT14
1620 x 455 x 1350
56
32xGTP02
GRH05
GRT15
1620 x 610 x 1350
72
32xGTP03
GRH06
GRT16
Galvanised Tote Pans
5x GTP03
GRH03
For use with totepans in transportingspare parts etc
72
Nylon Rubber
1040 x 610 x 980
Nylon Rubber
-
305 x 255 x 150
-
GTP03
-
GTP11
455 x 255 x 150
GTP12
610 x 225 x 150
GTP13
Easy to manoeuvreusing a push/pull handle
Mobile on 2 fixed &2 swivel 125mm castors N.B. Tote pans to beordered as additionalitems
1040 x 455 x 980
GTP02
610 x 305 x 150
Fitted with either 2 or 3shelves with 85mm sides
Framework paintedblue with 3 Galvanised sheet shelves
Wheels
GTP01
WORKSHOP TROLLEYS
TOTE PAN TROLLEY
Overall Size L x W x H mm
305 x 305 x 150 455 x 305 x 150
Mobile on 2 fixed& 2 swivel 125mmcastors
Weight kg
60
Model GTT21N GTT31R GTT41N GTT51R
No of Shelves
Overall Size L x W x H mm
Shelf Heights mm
Weight kg
Model
2
1015 x 635 x 805
150, 720
19
SS-WI202Y
150,435,720
25
SS-WI203Y
3
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Visible Storage Cabinets 2
1
A comprehensive range ofvisible storage cabinets
STORAGE
3
4
Available in two cabinet heights 290 & 550mm Strong Polypropylene frame Galvanised Steel shelves Crystal clear Polystyrenedrawers
Series 290
9
8
11
10
Price includes frame, drawers & self-adhesive labels
ACCESSORIES Cross & length dividers Bench top spacemiser Spacemiser Stands & trolleys Series 550
SPACEMISER Needs only 0,25 m2of floor space Unit includes ball bearing base, dividing trays & top plate
Frame Size D x W x H mm
Series 290 1 22
180 x 310 x 290
31
Clear Drawers
Model
Quantity
Type
30 pcs
DL-00
D290-3
4 pcs
DL-01
D291-3
2 pcs
DL-04
D294-3
pcs
DL-07
D297-3
60 pcs
DL-00
D550-3
8 pcs
DL-01
D551-3
24 pcs
DL-04
D554-3
12 pcs
DL-07
D557-3
46 Series 550
The assembly holds 12 cabinets of 550 high ordered separately Load capacity: 400 kg
8 94
180 x 310 x 550
10 11
Extra Clear Drawers
Size D x W x H:500 x 500 x 1730 mm
Cross Dividers
Outer dims Pack H x W x D mm pieces 37 x 55 x 175 120
DL-00
Model each DV-00
37 x 69 x 1759
6
DL-01
DV-01
48
DL-02
37 x 138 x 175 59 x 92 x 1754
Model
Price per pack
Pack drawer
10
Length Dividers Pack pieces -
DV-012
DV-02
5
DL-04
59 x 277 x 175
15
DL-06
DV-04 DV-06
81 x 138 x 175
24
DL-07
DV-07
Model pack -
10
DV-0456 DV-078
BENCH TOP SPACEMISER Includes a ball bearing base & abaseplate. This unit holds 2 cabinetsof series 290 or 550 which are ordered separately Load capacity: 50 kg Complete assembly’s Size D x W x H: 310 x 360 x 300/560 mm
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
73
STORAGE Stands & Trolleys 6
5
7
CABINET STANDS Effective storage of thousands of small components Ideal for Workshop, Production or Store use Includes 3 Aluminium rails
DOUBLE STANDS Holds 8 visible storage cabinets 550 high (ordered separately) Epoxy powder coated Steel free standing frame Includes 3 Aluminium rails Load Capacity: 100 kg Size - D x W x H:600 x 760 x 1585 mm
Series 290
12
14
13
Model: DBS-550T
SINGLE STAND Holds 4 visible storage cabinets 550 high (ordered separately) Construction as double stand Load Capacity: 50 kg Size - D x W x H:420 x 760 x 1585mm Model: DBS-550l
TROLLEY Series 550
Series 290 5 6
180 x 310 x 290
7 Series 550 12
Clear Drawers Quantity Type 12 pcs DL-02 4 pcs DL-06 12 pcs DL-01 3 pcs DL-04 1 pcs DL-06
Model D292-3 D296-3 D290C-3
24 pcs
DL-02
D552-3
13
8 pcs
DL-06
D556-3
14
24 pcs 6 pcs 2 pcs
DL-01 DL-04 DL-06
D550C-3
DBS-550T
74
Frame Size D x W x H mm
Holds 8 visible storage cabinets of 550 high (ordered separately) Construction as double stand Bottom shelf of 12 mm laminated board 4castors Ă˜ 100 mm, 2 with brakes Load Capacity: 150 kg Size - D x W x H:600 x 760 x 1700 mm Model: DBT-550
DBS-550L
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
DBT-550
Small Parts Storage
STORAGE
HIGH DENSITY STORAGE CABINETS Freestanding storage units for use in workshop, stores & many other applications A compact storage system, uses a floor area of only 0,25 m2 Robust construction: Steel frame holding Polypropylene bins Adjustable feet Backstops prevent the drawers from being pulled out of the frame Load Capacity: 240kg with castors 150kg
ROBUST & SPACE SAVING 2440-4840
Cabinet
Outer Size D x W x H mm
Model
Divider Pack
Bin Quantity
Red
Blue
Grey
Model
24
2440-5
2440-6
2440-3
D-20
48
4840-5
4840-6
4840-3
D-10
410 x 605 x 870
Castor Set
Set of 4 Castors (2 with Brake)
-
PS-LH
HIGH DENSITY STORAGE CABINETS Comprehensive range Depths of 300, 400, 500 & 600 mm Specifically designed for standard metric shelving, automated storage systems & “kanban” trolleys Smooth vertical sides allow maximum use of valuable shelf space Full width label with protective shield isincluded with the bin Corrugated base for easeof picking items Polypropylene withstands the effects of most oils, acids & solvents
HIGH DENSITY STORAGE CABINETS Crystal clear bins are of Polystyrene (PS), temperature tolerance of -40 ...+65°C Coloured bins of Polypropylene (PP), temperature tolerance of -20 ... +80°C
Bin
Outer Size D x W x H mm
Model
Pack
Clear 3010-1
3010-5 3010-6
3010-3
30
4010-1
4010-5 4010-6
4010-3
5010-1
5010-5 5010-6
5010-3
3015-1
3015-5 3015-6
3015-3
4015-1
4015-5 4015-6
4015-3
-
5015-5 5015-6
5015-3
-
6015-5 6015-6
6015-3
300 x 186 x 82
3020-1
3020-5 3020-6
3020-3
400 x 186 x 82
4020-1
4020-5 4020-6
4020-3
5020-1
5020-5 5020-6
5020-3
6020-1
6020-5 6020-6
6020-3
300 x 92 x 82 400 x 92 x 82 500 x 92 x 82 300 x 132 x 100 400 x 132 x 100 500 x 132 x 100 600 x 132 x 100
500 x 186 x 82 600 x 186 x 82
30 20 15
15
Red
Blue
Grey
Divider Pack
Model
10
D-10
10
D-15
10
D-20
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
75
STORAGE Turntable Assemblies HIGH DENSITY STORAGE CABINETS Easy assembly without toolsCompact storage systems for service, workshop, production & storage areas etc Space saving & practical Assemblies offer storage for up to 1,792 different items This unit holds 16 Bin Cabinets of Series 300 or 400 in four layers, which are ordered separately, see below Special offer kits include baseunit, 8 x 8 Drawer units &8 x 16 Drawer units
OFFERS STORAGE OF UP TO 1792 SEPARATE ITEMS
Overall Size D x W x H mm 700 x 700 x 1680 800 x 800 x 1680
Load capacity 800 kg 800 kg
For cabinets (ordered separately) 0830/1630 0840/1640
Model
D16-300 KIT
D16-300 D16-400
D16-400 KIT
BIN CABINETS Can be wallhung, stoodon a worktopor used with space saving turntables ComprisesSteel frame, shelf bins, labels& backstops Compact & robust
Cabinet
Type
Series 300
Series 400
76
Outer Size D x W x H mm
Bin Quantity
Clear
8
Model
Divider Pack
Red
Blue
Grey
Model
0830-1
0830-5
0830-6
0830-3
D-20
16
1630-1
1630-5
1630-6
1630-3
D-10
8
0840-1
0840-5
0840-6
0840-3
D-20
16
1640-1
1640-5
1640-6
1640-3
D-10
300 x 400 x 395
400 x 400 x 395
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
FIRE RESISTANT SECURITY CUPBOARDS/SAFES
STORAGE
• I deal in the office, for the safe keeping of paper documents and valuables.
FS1024
• Five versatile sizes available, for total flexibility.
FS1020
•H eavy-duty, 3-way locking mechanism & continuous ‘dog bar’ to protect hinge edge, for maximum security. •S tandard locking - CEN/VDS approved double bitted 8-lever safe lock & 2 keys. •D ouble walled construction filled with fire resistant material to DIN4102 & offering 30-minute protection at 750 degrees. omplete with shelve(s), which are adjustable every •C 25mm. •O ptions include: Electronic locking, inner compartments and pull-out frames. • Not suitable for computer media protection. • Finish - Light Grey. * Capacities shown are for A4 lever arch files, 80mm wide
FS1021 FS1022 FS1023
External (mm) HxWxD Internal (mm) HxWxD Weight No. of Shelves 860 x 600 x 520 690 x 490 x 405 87 1 1220 x 600 x 520 1050 x 490 x 405 110 2 1580 x 600 x 520 1410 x 490 x 405 135 3 1950 x 930 x 520 1780 x 820 x 405 205 4 1950 x 1200 x 520 1780 x 1090 x 405 235 4
Capacity - Lever Arch Files 12 18 24 50 65
Model Price FS1023 FS1022 FS1021 FS1020 FS1024
Fire Resistant Document Safes • Designed for office or home use. 1 hour fire resistant document safe, independently tested and certified in Sweden to NT Fire 017-60 Paper std. • Ideal for the safe keeping of paper records, insurance policies, deeds, passports etc... • Easy to use programmable digital keypad (4-14 digits), with dual user code option. • Access to the power supply is via a front panel. • Keypad features an anti tamper alarm which sounds in the event of an attack. • Includes a key storage hook bar on rear of door & sliding drawer for smaller items. • Supplied with non-invasive fixing system, Batteries, Installation and operating instructions. • Registration system to prevent lockout situation. • Safe will be replaced should the contents be destroyed in fire.
External (mm) HxWxD
350 x 410 x 360 415 x 350 x 430 520 x 405 x 440
Internal (mm) HxWxD
Weight
Adjustable Shelf
Model
260 x 320 x 235 320 x 260 x 305 410 x 300 x 300
41 48 65
0 1 1
FV0 FV1 FV2
Price
Fire Resistant Data Safes • Designed for office or home use. 1 hour fire resistant data safe Independently tested and certified in Sweden to NT 017-60 Data Std. Ideal for the safe keeping of backup tapes, floppy discs, CD’s & videotapes etc... • Easy to use programmable digital keypad (4-14 digits), with dual user code option. • Access to the power source is via a front panel. • Keypad features an anti tamper alarm which sounds in the event of an attack. • Supplied with non-invasive fixing system, Batteries, Installation and operating instructions. • Registration system to prevent lockout situation. • Safe will be replaced should the contents be destroyed in a fire.
External (mm) HxWxD
415 x 350 x 430 520 x 425 x 440
Internal (mm) HxWxD
Weight kg
Fixed Shelf
Model
213 x 153 x 172 303 x 193 x 172
47 66
1 1
DV1 DV2
Price
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
77
STORAGE STORAGE BINS Corrugated Fibreboard Storage Bins • Economical storage solutions. • Supplied flat packed for easy assembly. • Extensive range of sizes available, all ex-stock. • Incorporating K-Bins patented locking system.
K-Bins are supplied in flat form, saving valuable space prior to use. They are self-locking and assembled in seconds. All bin dimensions shown are External measurements, designed to fit metric and imperial shelf sizes to maximise the use of available space.
H
RANGE A All 100mm Height
D
W
DEPTH 150mm
DEPTH 200mm
DEPTH 300mm
DEPTH 400mm
DEPTH 450mm
DEPTH 500mm
DEPTH 600mm
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
For m ore ide call 8 as, 00-LO C
Width Model mm 50 A1505 75 A1507 100 A1510 150 A1515
Price Per Pack (50)
Width Model mm 50 A2005 75 A2007 100 A2010 150 A2015 200 A2020
Price Per Pack (50)
Width Model mm 50 A3005 75 A3007 100 A3010 150 A3015 200 A3020 250 A3025
Price Per Pack (50)
Width Model mm 100 A4010 150 A4015 200 A4020
Price Per Pack (50)
D
Width Model mm 50 A4505 75 A4507 100 A4510 150 A4515 200 A4520
Price Per Pack (50)
DEPTH 450mm
Width Model mm 100 A5010 150 A5015 200 A5020
Price Per Pack (50)
Width Model mm 50 A6005 75 A6007 100 A6010 150 A6015 200 A6020
Price Per Pack (50)
RANGE B 8
All 200mm Height
H W
D
D
DEPTH 400mm
W
W
D
DEPTH 500mm
W
D
DEPTH 600mm
W
Width Model mm 200 B4020 250 B4025 300 B4030
Price Per Pack (25)
Width Model mm 150 B4515 200 B4520 250 B4525 300 B4530
Price Per Pack (25)
Width Model mm 200 B5020 250 B5025 300 B5030
Price Per Pack (25)
Width Model mm 150 B6015 200 B6020 250 B6025 300 B6030
Price Per Pack (25)
25 PACK 50 PACK
D
78
•M atch your shelf depths. • A bin to fit all metric and imperial shelves. • No more wasted space.
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
POLYPROPYLENE STORAGE BINS
STORAGE
Polypropylene Bins
wider For a on, selecti OC8 -L 0 0 8 ll ca
RANGE TPA • Manufactured in strong twinwall fluted polypropylene.
All 100mm Height
• Self-adhesive labels are supplied loose with all TPA K-Bins, for front panel identification. • Wipe clean surfaces (inside and out).
H
• Oil, grease and moisture resistant. • Resistant to most chemicals. • Supplied flat packed for easy assembly.
W
D
• Incorporating K-Bins patented locking system. • Long shelf life. • Entire range available in four Colours Red, Blue, Silver/Grey and Orange, all ex-stock. (Other Colours available to special order) DEPTH 150mm
W
• These products are available to special order subject to a minimum order quantity. PLEASE ENQUIRE DEPTH 225mm
DEPTH 300mm
W
W
Please add the following letters to the code to indicate the Colour(s) required: DEPTH 450mm
W
Width Model mm 75 TPA1507
Price Per Pack (25)
Width Model Price mm Per Pack (25) 75 TPA2207 ✱ 100 TPA2210 150 TPA2215 200 TPA2220 Width Model Price mm Per Pack (25) 75 TPA3007 ✱ 100 TPA3010 150 TPA3015 200 TPA3020 Width Model mm 100 TPA4510 150 TPA4515 200 TPA4520
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Price Per Pack (25)
79
STORAGE ARCHIVE STORAGE BINS Economy Archive Storage Boxes
• Holds maximum 20kg • Large labelling area
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628)
Dimensions(External) W x D x H mm
Dimensions(Internal) Model Price W x D x H mm Per 20
350 x 445 x 265
325 x 405 x 255
AB02
POA
Business Boxes Dust free storage for documents • Strong corrugated fibreboard multi-use boxes • Supplied flat packed with pre-glued base- Simply squeeze the box to open, then fold down sides • Suitable for the storage of complete lever arch files or as filing module on shelving. Takes five A4 lever arch files with 75mm spine or seven with 50mm spine
Shown flat
•C omplete with self adhesive labels for box identification • Available in Green, Terracotta or Blue with or without black lids. Please state Colour required when ordering
80
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Cardboard Storage Trays
STORAGE
Cardboard Storage Trays Manufactured from a heavy duty Cardboard Supplied in flat pack form to save space when not in use Easy to assemble - No need for tapes or glue etc An ideal way to utilise the maximum shelf space Trays are designed with a finger hole to pull them off the shelf
H
D
W
Overall Size H x D x W mm
Model
110 x 300 x 115
T113011
110 x 300 x 175
T113017
110 x 300 x 235
T113023
110 x 300 x 355
T113035
HEAVY DUTY CARDBOARD
All the above trays can be manufactured in a ‘conductive’ material ideal for storage of electronic components, subject to minimum order quantities, price on application
CONDUCTIVE MATERIAL AVAILABLE (P.O.A) CALL FOR DETAILS
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
81
STORAGE HEAVY DUTY STORAGE UNITS 00701
Attached Lid containers • Plastic container with integral plastic lid that will not become separated and lost • Secure stacking up to 6 to 8 containers high – when full and lids are closed • Nests to save up to 75% of space when container is empty and lids are open • Tamper evident security seal availale • Most have Euro sizes in order to fit onto Euro Pallets 1200
00473
x 1000 or 1200 x 800mm
10020
10010
Capacity
10040
Ext dims (mm)
Int dims (mm)
1006B
10125
Colours
Weight (kg)
Model
Price
4 litres
300 x 200 x 130
245 x 160 x 101
Green/green
0.70
10005
POA
6 litres
300 x 200 x 200
235 x 152 x 174
Green/green
0.85
10010
POA
20 litres
400 x 300 x 252
325 x 246 x 222
Green/green
1.65
10020
POA
25 litres
400 x 300 x 320
321 x 244 x 295
Green/green
1.87
10025
40 litres
600 x 400 x 250
515 x 343 x 215
Green/green, grey/red, grey/yellow, grey/blue, grey/green
54 litres
600 x 400 x 320
508 x 335 x 285
Green/green, grey/red, grey/yellow, grey/blue, grey/green
POA 2.79 10040 POA 3.20 1005B POA
64 litres
00 x 400 x 365
501 x 328 x 330
Green/green
3.38
1006B
POA
80 litres
710 x 460 x 368
597 x 374 x 330
Green/green (drainage holes in base)
4.30
10082
POA
1130 litres 1160 x 480 x 360
1000 x 370 x 332
Grey/red
7.55
10125
POA
4.00
91005
POA
Dolly for one 600 x 400mm container or two 400 x 300mm containers (4swivel ø 100mm castors} Pack of 1000 green tamper evident seals
n/a
00701
Clear label cover for refs 10020/25/40/5B/6B and 10552 DISTRIBUTION/PiCKING CONTAINER Ideal for storage, distribution and picking. All the benefits of the attached lid containers (above) but also with drop front and flip back lid
Model. 10552 Ext dims Int dims Door aperture Weight Colour
82
54 litres 600 x 400 x 320mm 505 x 334 x 292mm 290 x 165mm 3.2kg Green/green
POA 00473
POA
ProducE trays
Stack/nest bale arm trays
18 & 36 litre trays for hygienic storage and distribution of fresh and frozen produce. Vented sides and base
5 litre plastic container stacks with metal 7 bale arms closed and nests to save space with bale arms open Seperate lid is available
15036
10552
n/a
Model. 15036 36 litres Ext dims 600 x 400 x 200mm Int dims 544 x 343 x 184mm Weight 1.50kg Colour Green Model. 15018 18 litres Ext dims 400 x 300 x 200mm Int dims 359 x 252 x 184mm Weight 0.70kg Colour Green
lid + 10076 61075
Model. 10076 Ext dims Int dims Nested height Weight Colour
75 litres 710 x 460 x 350mm 599 x 378 x 310mm 80mm 4.20kg Grey, red
Lid Model. 61075 Dims 717 x 480 x 43mm Weight 1.30kg Colours Grey, red
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
STACK NEST CONTAINERs Item No.
External/mm
STORAGE
Internal/mm Version Weight/kg Volume/l
Colour
Pallet unit
4130.760 600 x 400 x 350 490 x 340 x 345
A
2.5
66
4130.710 600 x 400 x 350 490 x 340 x 345
B
2.3
66
Green
68
4.0
87
Green
45
7931.860 800 x 400 x 350 690 x 340 x 340 A, K
Green, blue, white 68
LIDS
6410.820 Lid External 400 x 300 mm Weight 0.4 kg Colour Grey Carton unit 20
7907.823 Lid External 600 x 400 mm Weight 0.9 kg Colour Green Version G Carton unit 15
JUPITER™
Grey 502
Item No.
External/mm
Internal/mm
8100.760
600 x 400 x 200
457 x 335 x 177
A, E
8100.720
600 x 400 x 200
457 x 335 x 177
8101.760
600 x 400 x 300
8101.720
7907.820 Lid External 600 x 400 mm Weight 0.9 kg Colour Green, grey, white Carton unit 15
7907.822 Lid External 600 x 400 mm Weight 0.9 kg Colour Green, grey Version L Carton unit 15
7931.830 External Weight Colour Pallet unit
Lid 800 x 400 mm 1.1 kg Black 160
.Material: Polypropylene
Version Weight/kg
Volume/l
Colour
Pallet unit
1.6
32
Grey
60
C, E
1.4
32
Grey
60
457 x 335 x 274
A, E
2.2
50
Grey
100
600 x 400 x 300
457 x 335 x 274
C, E
1.9
50
Grey
100
8102.760
600 x 400 x 400
457 x 335 x 372
A, E
2.8
70
Grey
68
8102.720
600 x 400 x 400
457 x 335 x 372
C, E
2.5
70
Grey
68
2280.760
600 x 400 x 250
570 x 355 x 245
B, E
2.2
32
Grey
44
LIDS
8103.820 Lid External 600 x 400 mm Weight 0.7 kg Colour Grey Carton unit 30
8103.822 Lid External 600 x 400 mm Weight 0.8 kg Colour Grey Version L Carton unit 30
2280.820 Lid External 600 x 400 mm Weight 1.0 kg Colour Grey Version L Carton unit 22
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
83
STORAGE STACK NEST CONTAINERs Integra™ – the complete secure returnable packaging solution The Integra range has several design features, which dramatically improves productivity and reduce distribution costs in retail, wholesale and industrial applications. It is designed for both automated and manual handling. The containers secure the distribution of all sorts of valuable goods with an easy-to-attach security seal that guarantees that the container can not be opened without detection. When nested the .containers save up to 70% in return transport. The Integra containers are UN certified
Flat base Reinforced base Attached lid for security seals Detachable lid for security seals
Blue 626
A B C D
Orange 207 1325.830 Seal for Integra Classic, min. qty: 4000 pcs. 1826.830 Seal for Integra QSB, min. qty: 500 pcs.
INTEGRA CLASSIC Pallet unit
Colour
Volume/l
Weight/kg
Version
Internal/mm
External/mm
.Item No
90
Blue
21
1.6
A, C
x 237 x 235 328
x 300 x 250 400
1325.850
90
Blue
25
1.7
A, C
x 235 x 285 327
x 300 x 300 400
1325.851
64
Blue
46
3.0
A, C
x 344 x 235 529
x 400 x 250 600
1310.851
64
Blue
55
3.3
A, C
x 342 x 285 527
x 400 x 300 600
1311.851
64
Blue
64
3.6
A, C
x 341 x 335 526
x 400 x 350 600
1312.851
INTEGRA QSB
84
1826.100 (QSB M3) 300 x 200 x 120
280 x 156 x 112
A, D
0.8
4.8
Orange
384
1827.100 (QSB M4) 400 x 300 x 236
320 x 224 x 215
A, D
1.7
15.5
Orange
152
1828.100 (QSB M6) 600 x 400 x 325
460 x 320 x 293
A, D
3.6
43
Orange
172
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
STACK NEST CONTAINERs
STORAGE
Euro containers – for logistical efficiency Our broad range of Euro containers offer many opportunities for efficient materials handling. The multitude of sizes and designs means that they can be tailored to the flow of goods in most situations. The design of the containers gives stability in transport, while their straight For a wider selec call 8 tion, 00-LO C8
sides and modular sizes simplify stacking and storage.
A Solid base and walls B Solid base and perforated walls C Perforated base and walls D Reinforced base E With handholes
Grey 502
Red 215
F Integrated label holder, one short side G Integrated label holder, one long and one short side H Lid with hooks I Attached lid for 87-series J Lid for 64-series Black 930
Item No.
External/mm
Internal/mm
Version
Weight/kg
Volume/l
Colour
Pallet unit
6496.760
200 x 150 x 145
160 x 110 x 140
A
0.3
3
Grey
224
8715.005
300 x 200 x 120
257 x 158 x 117
A, G
0.5
4
Grey
272
6487.760
300 x 200 x 145
260 x 155 x 142
A
0.5
6
Grey
112
8700.000
400 x 300 x 75
356 x 256 x 62
A
0.6
6
Grey
240
8701.005
400 x 300 x 120
365 x 265 x 115
A, G
0.7
9
Grey, red
80
2340.720
400 x 300 x 120
365 x 265 x 115
C, D
0.6
9
Grey
80
6468.001
400 x 300 x 145
355 x 255 x 142
A
0.9
13
Grey
56
8702.005
400 x 300 x 175
365 x 265 x 170
A, G
0.8
15
Grey
48
2341.720
400 x 300 x 175
365 x 265 x 165
C, D, E
0.7
15
Grey
48
6469.001
400 x 300 x 230
355 x 255 x 225
A
1.3
20
Grey
48
6469.760
400 x 300 x 230
355 x 255 x 225
A, E
1.3
20
Grey
48
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
85
STORAGE STACK NEST CONTAINERs Item No.
86
External/mm
Internal/mm
Version
Weight/kg
Volume/l Colour
Pallet unit
8703.005
400 x 300 x 235 356 x 256 x 222
A, G
1.1
20
Grey
80
8703.720
400 x 300 x 235 356 x 256 x 222
C, E
0.9
20
Grey
80
2343.750
400 x 300 x 270 365 x 265 x 265
A, E
1.3
23
Grey
72
2343.720
400 x 300 x 270 365 x 265 x 255
C, D, E
1.1
23
Grey
72
2344.400
400 x 300 x 320 365 x 265 x 305
A, D, E
1.6
27
Grey, red
56
2344.720
400 x 300 x 320 365 x 265 x 305
C, D, E
1.2
27
Grey
56
6497.500
600 x 400 x 75 With fixed dividers
A
1.8
14
Grey
136
6497.000
600 x 400 x 75
555 x 355 x 70
A
1.1
14
Grey
136
6499.000
600 x 400 x 75
555 x 355 x 65
C
1.0
13
Grey
132
8707.005
600 x 400 x 75
556 x 356 x 62
A, F
1.2
12
Grey
136
6470.750
600 x 400 x 100
555 x 355 x 95
A
1.3
19
Grey
96
6471.750
600 x 400 x 100
555 x 355 x 90
C
1.1
18
Grey
96
8708.005
600 x 400 x 120 556 x 356 x 107
A
1.3
21
Grey, red
84
2361.720
600 x 400 x 120 560 x 360 x 108
C, D, E
1.1
21
Grey
84
6472.750
600 x 400 x 145 555 x 355 x 140
A, E
1.8
25
Grey
64
6474.750
600 x 400 x 145 555 x 355 x 140
C, E
1.5
25
Grey
64
8710.005
600 x 400 x 175 556 x 356 x 162
A, F
1.6
32
Grey 56
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
STACK NEST CONTAINERs Item No.
External/mm
Internal/mm
Version
Weight/kg
Volume/l Colour
2362.720
600 x 400 x 175
560 x 360 x 165
C, D, E
1.3
33
Grey
56
2362.750
600 x 400 x 175
560 x 360 x 170
A, E
1.7
33
Grey
56
6479.750
600 x 400 x 230
555 x 355 x 225
A, E
2.2
44
Grey, red
40
8711.005
600 x 400 x 235
556 x 356 x 222
A, F
1.9
45
Grey
40
8711.720
600 x 400 x 235
556 x 356 x 222
C, E
1.5
45
Grey
40
6476.750
600 x 400 x 280
555 x 355 x 275
A, E
2.7
55
Grey, red
32
6478.750
600 x 400 x 280
555 x 355 x 270
C, E
2.1
55
Grey
32
8712.005
600 x 400 x 320
556 x 356 x 307
A, F
2.6
61
Grey
28
8712.760
600 x 400 x 320
556 x 356 x 307
A, E, F
2.6
61
Grey, red
28
2367.720
600 x 400 x 320
560 x 360 x 310
C, D, E
2.4
60
Grey
28
3640.750
600 x 400 x 410
555 x 355 x 400
A, E
3.7
80
Grey
20
3640.720
600 x 400 x 410
555 x 355 x 400
C, E
2.8
80
Grey
20
8713.005
600 x 400 x 410
556 x 356 x 397
A, F
3.4
80
Grey
20
STORAGE
Pallet unit
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
87
STORAGE STACK NEST CONTAINERs Item No.
External/mm
Internal/mm
Version
Weight/kg
Volume/l
Colour
Pallet unit
2368.750
600 x 400 x 440 560 x 360 x 420
A, D, E
3.7
87
Grey
20
2368.720
600 x 400 x 440 560 x 360 x 420
C, D, E
3.6
87
Grey
20
6488.005
800 x 400 x 200 760 x 360 x 196
A, F
2.7
54
Grey
33
6489.750
800 x 600 x 200 750 x 550 x 195
A, E
4.1
80
Grey
22
6491.750
800 x 600 x 300 750 x 550 x 290
A, E
4.5
123
Grey
14
6440.000
800 x 600 x 415
750 x 550 x 400
A
8.1
165
Grey
14
6440.750
800 x 600 x 415
750 x 550 x 400
A, E
8.1
165
Grey
14
8716.005
1000 x 400 x 214 947 x 350 x 210
A, F
3.4
67
Grey
33
LIDS
4160.820 Lid External 300 x 200 x 27 mm Weight 0.3 kg Colour Grey Carton unit 68
5787.820 Lid External 400 x 300 mm Weight 0.4 kg Colour Grey Version H, J Carton unit 36
8705.820 Lid External 400 x 300 x 26 mm Weight 0.4 kg Colour Grey Version I Carton unit 40
8705.821 Lid External 400 x 300 x 26 mm Weight 0.4 kg Colour Grey Version H, I Carton unit 40
5786.820 Lid External 600 x 400 mm Weight 0.8 kg Colour Grey Version H, J Carton unit 15
8714.820 Lid External 600 x 400 x 26 mm Weight 0.8 kg Colour Grey Carton unit 20
8714.821 Lid External 600 x 400 x 26 mm Weight 0.8 kg Colour Grey Version H, I Carton unit 20
2626.800 Lid External 800 x 600 mm Weight 2.6 kg Colour Black Carton unit 70
INSERT TRAYS
8717.005 Insert Tray, 176 x 92 x 56 mm 4591.000 Divider, 600 x 85 mm Weight 0.08 kg. Colour Grey Colour Grey Volume 0.7 l. Carton unit 60 Carton unit 100
88
4507.830 4508.830 4509.830
Insert Tray, 274 x 174 x 110 mm Weight 0.40 kg. Carton unit 24 Insert Tray, 174 x 137 x 110 mm Weight 0.25 kg. Carton unit 48 Insert Tray, 137 x 87 x 110 mm Weight 0.15 kg. Carton unit 96 Colour Grey
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Small Parts Storage & Bin Units
STORAGE
THE ORGANISER CARRY CASE Ideal for all yourD.I.Y. needs: nuts,bolts, fuses, screws etc
MSC18H
Complete with 18individual removable containers which have their own divider& belt clip
Individual containers complete with dividers & belt clip
MSC18H MSC18H
Overall Size L x W x H mm 330 x 330 x 130
Weight kg 1.6
Model MSC18H
BIN STANDS & TROLLEYS Model GILR2Y is mobile on 4 swivel castors, 2 with brakes Length of the hanging strip: 840mm Height between hanging strips: 130mm Ideal when small parts storage is anessential part of the day to day operations Fully assembled
Overall Size L x W x H mm Single Sided - Static 940 x 280 x 1150 Double Sided - Mobile 940 x 500 x 1250 Description
Wt kg 22 23
GILR1Z with additional bins
Model
GILR1Y with additional bins
GILR1Z GILR2Y Size 1322
MAXI BINS
Size 3730
Size 4145
Size 1012
All bins have slots for labels/barcodes Available in; Red, Green, Blue & Yellow please specify when orderingSize 1012 is available in Blue or Red only Overall Size W x D x H mm
Load Cap. kg
Volume Pack Litres Size Maxi Bins
100 x 125 x 60
2.3
0.4
12
GDM1012
100 x 175 x 85
4.5
0.75
12
GDM1017
135 x 225 x 125
9
2.1
12
185 x 300 x 145
13
4.25
185 x 450 x 145
13
370 x 300 x 145
18
410 x 450 x 215
27
Divider
To fit Bin:
Pack Size Dividers
1332
12
GDMDL1322
Side - Side
1830
6
GDMDL183
GDM1322
1845
6
GDMDL184
6
GDM1830
1830
12
GDMDF183
7.2
6
GDM1845
1845
12
GDMDF184
10
6
GDM3730
3730
12
GDMDF373
21
6
GDM4145
4145
6
GDMDF414
Model
Front - Back
Model
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
89
STORAGE Storage Bin Racks MAGNA BIN RACKS These units come complete with Polypropylene bins These units incorporate a unique magneticstrip at the top of the unit which isideal for storing your tools
GIL16Z
No of Bins
Bin Quantity
Bins Sizes W x D x H mm
7
4 Small & 3 Large
16
12 Small & 4 Large
Small - 100 x 165 x 75 Large - 150 x 235 x 130
Overall Size W x D x H mm
Weight kg
Model
460 x 240 x 405
4
GIL07Z
640 x 250 x 560
5
GIL16Z
GIL07Z
Organise your small parts easily & efficiently BIN RACKS
BIN RACKS These units come complete with Polypropylene bins
This unit comes complete with 24 Polypropylene bins
No of Bins
Bins Size W x D x H mm
Overall Size W x D x H mm
Weight kg
Model
24
95 x 280 x 100
790 x 300 x 600
9
GIL24Z
LOUVRED PANEL WITH BINS
No of Bins 15 26
90
Bin Quantity
Bins Size W x D x H mm
Overall Size W x D x H mm
Small 540 x 255 x 405 100 x 165 x 75 Large 16 Small 900 x 305 x 765 & 10 Large 150 x 235 x 130 15 Small
Weight kg
Model
5
GIL15Z
7
GIL26Z
Manufactured from 2mm cold rolled Steel Louvres securely support the bins Complete with 15 Bins(5 Red, 5 Yellow &5 Blue) - 140L x105W x 75H mm Overall Size L x W x H mm 550 x 200 x 355
Weight kg 4
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Model WMS09Z
Storage Bin Rack & Trolleys BIN RACK
STORAGE
BIN TROLLEY
This units comes complete with 47Polypropylene bins; 32 small & 15 large:Small Bins: 100W x 165D x 75H mmLarge Bins: 150W x 235D x 130H mm
This unit comes complete with 46 Polypropylene bins; 30 medium & 16 large: Medium Bins: 120W x 175D x 100H mm Large Bins: 150W x 240D x 120H mm Mobile on4 x 75m swivel castors,2 braked
GIL46Y GIL47Z
No of Bins
Overall Size W x D x H mm
Weight kg
Model
No of Bins
Overall Size W x D x H mm
Weight kg
Model
47
930 x 285 x 1150
17
GIL47Z
46
660 x 560 x 1120
20
GIL46Y
BIN TROLLEY These units come complete with Polypropylene bins.GIL60Y comes with 24 small bins, 20 medium bins& 16 large bins & the GIL90Y comes with 36 small bins,30 medium bins & 24 large bins
GIL60Y
Small Bins:90W x 135D x 50H mm Medium Bins:120W x 175D x 100H mm Large Bins:150W x 240D x 120H mm Mobile on 4 x 75mmswivel castors, 2 braked
No of Bins
Overall Size W x D x H mm
Weight kg
Model
60
660 x 570 x 1120
20
GIL60Y
90
660 x 570 x 13202
8
GIL90Y
GIL90Y
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
91
STORAGE PANEL TROLLEYS PANEL TROLLEYS Panel trolleys allow components & tools to be easily transported around the workplace The panels can be fitted into two positions - upright or at a slight incline to suit your requirement Available in 2 heights, all models are supplied with push/pull handle & 125mm castor set 2 fixed, 2 swivel brake
C A
D
B
4 x Perforated
Overall Size W x D x H mm 1000 x 650 x 1200
4 x Perforated 6 x Perforated
Panels
A B C D
92
Accessories
Model
Empty
10403033.11
1000 x 650 x 1200
40 piece Hook Kit
07002132.11
1000 x 650 x 1600
Empty
14026013.11
6 x Perforated
1000 x 650 x 1600
60 piece Hook Kit
07002134.11
4 x Louvred
1000 x 650 x 1200
Empty
14026022.11
4 x Louvred
1000 x 650 x 1200
108 piece Bin Kit
13031181.11
6 x Louvred
1000 x 650 x 1600
Empty
14026015.11
6 x Louvred
1000 x 650 x 1600
108 piece Bin Kit
14026017.11
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Storage Cabinets
STORAGE
Hook-on bins are manufactured from durable Polyethylene with moulded-in back hooks for secure hanging. Front edges are lowered for easy visibility & picking Complete withlabel holder
CABINET COMPLETE WITH HOOK-ON BINS 14Gauge Steel Fully welded Steel construction Flush style double doors 152mm base which raises the unit off the floor Complete with either 137 or 171 hook-on bins Description Cabinet c/w 137 Hook-on Bins Cabinet c/w 171 Hook-on Bins
Overall Size L x W x H mm 1219 x 610 x 1981
Sturdy 3-point locking handle with 2 keys
Weight kg
Model
236
JC482478-BDLP 137-3S-95
236
JC482478-BDLP 171-95
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
93
STORAGE STACK NEST CONTAINERs Safe and secure transportation Pallet covers are available in two sizes, 1200 x 800 and 1200 x 1000 mm. They fit over the contents of a pallet to create a secure unit for either storage or distribution. The covers can be etched or marked with, for example, a company logo.
Q With grooves S With grooves and 4 straps T With raised safety corners U With raised safety corners and 4 straps
Black 900
94
Blue 626
Item No.
External/mm
Version
Weight/kg
Colour
Pallet unit
6015.830
1205 x 808 x 94
Q
6.1
Black
25
6015.831
1205 x 808 x 94
-
6.1
Blue
25
6015.833
1205 x 808 x 94
S
6.1
Black
25
6018.820
1230 x 817 x 87
Q
5.8
Black
40
6018.823
1230 x 817 x 87
S
7.5
Black
40
6017.830
1229 x 1030 x 84
T
7.2
Black
35
6017.833
1229 x 1030 x 84
U
7.2
Black
35
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
STACK NEST CONTAINERs
STORAGE
foldable small containers The design and construction of PreLog makes it Europe’s leading returnable container. PreLog is an efficient, hygienic distribution tool for either manual or automated handling. PreLog has a minimum of recesses outside and inside, making it easy to wash and keep clean. Smooth walls and base protect the contents, whilst perforated sides ensure a good air flow to promote produce freshness. The upper rim is manufactured by using gas-assisted injection moulding and designed with reinforcement ribs. This gives a rigid container with the lowest possible weight. A Solid base and walls C Perforated base and walls E With handholes F With frame grips G Integrated label holder, one long and one short side H Integrated labelholder on short side Green 481
Grey 515
Item No.
External/mm
Internal/mm
Version
3220.750 (43170 P) 400 x 300 x 170 366 x 266 x 151 C, E, H
Weight/kg Volume/l Colour 1.2
15
Green
Pallet unit 200
Capacity 12 kg. Max. stack load 250 kg (dynamic).
3225.750 (43235 P) 400 x 300 x 235 360 x 260 x 220
C, E
1.6
20
Green
144
Capacity 15 kg. Max. stack load 250 kg (dynamic).
3213.750 (64115 P) 600 x 400 x 115 566 x 366 x 101 C, E, H 1.6
21 Green 100
Capacity 15 kg. Max. stack load 250 kg (dynamic).
3218.750 (64165 P) 600 x 400 x 165 566 x 366 x 151 C, E, H 1.8
30 Green 100
Capacity 15 kg. Max. stack load 250 kg (dynamic).
3212.750 (64190 P) 600 x 400 x 190 566 x 366 x 176 C, E, H 1.9
36 Green 100
Capacity 20 kg. Max. stack load 250 kg (dynamic).
3211.750 (64235 P) 600 x 400 x 235 566 x 366 x 221 C, E, H 2.1
47 Green 100
Capacity 20 kg. Max. stack load 250 kg (dynamic).
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
95
STORAGE STACK NEST CONTAINERs Magnum™ – foldable large containers Magnum is the complete returnable packaging system, which offers many advantages and gives significant cost savings over one trip alternatives. The containers also increases safety in transportation and provides for improved hygienic handling. The magnum containers are made of expanded PEHD or solid PP and 100% recyclable. When folded for storage or return transport they saves up to 60% of valuable space. The container can be supplied with access doors and with different pallet versions.
A Solid, flat base with drain holes B Solid base C Perforated base D Solid long side walls E Solid short side walls F Perforated long side walls G Perforated short side walls H Solid door short side wall I Solid door long side wall
J Solid door long side walls K Perforated door short side walls L Perforated door long side walls M No doors N 2 skids O 2 skids and feet P 9 feet Q Wheels
Green 481 Grey 502 Grey 540 Black 930
Item No. 2620.410 (SH 760 P)
External/mm 800 x 600 x 760
Internal/mm
Version
Weight/kg Volume/l Colour
750 x 550 x 620 C, F, G, K, L, N
17
250
Green
Max. load per container 150 kg. Stacking: Static 2 on 1. Dynamic 2 on 1.
2620.450 (SH 760 S)
800 x 600 x 760
750 x 550 x 620
B, D, E, H, I, N
18
250
Grey
Max. load per container 150 kg. Stacking: Static 2 on 1. Dynamic 2 on 1.
2620.460 (SH 780 SW) 800 x 600 x 780
750 x 550 x 620 B, D, E, H, I, N, Q
21
250
Grey
Max. load per container 150 kg. Stacking: Static 2 on 1. Dynamic 2 on 1.
2640.110 (SH 680 HD) 800 x 600 x 680
740 x 540 x 530
B, D, E, M, N
20
212
Grey 540
Max. load per container 700 kg. Stacking: Static 3 on 1. Dynamic 1 on 1.
2630.610 (SH 835 HD) 800 x 600 x 835
740 x 540 x 705
B, D, E, J, N
22
282
Grey 540
Max. load per container 700 kg. Stacking: Static 3 on 1. Dynamic 1 on 1.
96
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
STACK NEST CONTAINERs
STORAGE
Big Box™ – hygienic and stable Big Box has straight, smooth double-skinned walls which make them easy to stack. Our Big Box is designed with rounded rims and corners. This gives maximum load capacity and protection of the goods. Accessories include access doors, castor wheels, skids and lid as well as drainage plugs and taps. Perforated sides and base can also be specified.
A Solid base and walls C Perforated base and walls D 4 feet Grey 554
E 4 wheels F 3 skids G With door
Grey 502
Item No.
External/mm
Internal/mm
Version
Weight/kg
Volume/l
Colour
Pallet unit
4403.100
1200 x 800 x 760
1110 x 710 x 610
A, D
34.5
535
Grey
3
Max. load per container 500 kg. Max. stack load 4500 kg (dynamic).
4403.105
1200 x 800 x 915
1110 x 710 x 610
A, E
47.0
535
Grey
3
Max. load per container 500 kg. Max. stack load 500 kg (dynamic).
4403.150
1200 x 800 x 760
1110 x 710 x 610
A, D, G
34.5
535
Grey
3
Max. load per container 500 kg. Max. stack load 500 kg (dynamic).
4403.300
1200 x 800 x 790
1110 x 710 x 610
A, F
41.0
535
Grey
3
Max. load per container 500 kg. Max. stack load 4500 kg (dynamic).
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
97
STORAGE STACK NEST CONTAINERs Item No. 4401.100
External/mm
Internal/mm
1200 x 1000 x 760 1110 x 910 x 610
Version
Weight/kg
Volume/l
Colour
Pallet unit
A, D
39.5
670
Grey
4
Max. load per container 500 kg. Max. stack load 4500 kg (dynamic).
4401.105
1200 x 1000 x 915 1110 x 910 x 610
A, E
44.0
670
Grey
3
Max. load per container 500 kg. Max. stack load 500 kg (dynamic).
4401.150
1200 x 1000 x 760 1110 x 910 x 610 A, D, G
39.5
670
Grey
4
Max. load per container 500 kg. Max. stack load 4500 kg (dynamic).
4401.300
1200 x 1000 x 790 1110 x 910 x 610
A, F
45.5
670
Grey
4
Max. load per container 500 kg. Max. stack load 4500 kg (dynamic).
4401.600
1200 x 1000 x 790 1110 x 910 x 610
C, F
45.5
670
Grey
4
Max. load per container 500 kg. Max. stack load 4500 kg (dynamic).
4401.400
1200 x 1000 x 760 1110 x 910 x 610
C, D
38.5
670
Grey
4
Max. load per container 500 kg. Max. stack load 4500 kg (dynamic).
BIG BOX ACCESSORIES
BIG BOX LIDS
4409.820 Lid External 1200 x 800 mm Weight 6.5 kg Colour Grey Pallet unit 30
98
4410.820 Lid External 1200 x 1000 mm Weight 7.8 kg Colour Grey Pallet unit 30
A 192701000 Drain tap for 1” opening
A 192704000 Plug for 1” opening
A 192702000 Drain tap for 2” opening
A 192706000 Plug for 2” opening
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
PALLETS Item No. 1881.004 (BiPP 1210 MR+ 5R)
STORAGE
External/mm
Version
Weight/kg
Colour
Pallet unit
1200 x 1000 x 160
B, C, H
14
Black
15
Max. dynamic load 1250 kg. Max. racking load 750 kg.
2712.510 (BiPP 0890 MCD)
1200 x 800 x 140
A, C, L
9.4
Grey
15
Grey
15
Max. dynamic flat load 500 kg.
2714.510 (BiPP 0833 MCD)
1200 x 800 x 165
A, C, E
18.5
Max. dynamic load 1250 kg. Max. racking load 1000 kg.
BiPP HEAVY
1871.005 (BiPP 1140 HR 6R)
1140 x 1140 x 170
B, C, I
24.5
Black
14
Max. dynamic load 1500 kg. Max. racking load 1250 kg.
1872.002 (BiPP 1208 HR 3R)
1200 x 800 x 160
B, C, E
15.5
Black
15
Max. dynamic load 1250 kg. Max. racking load 750 kg.
8550.200 (BiPP 1208 HR 3R II)
1200 x 800 x 191
B, C, E
22
Grey
12
Max. dynamic load 1250 kg. Max. racking load 1000 kg.
1923.002 (BiPP 1208 HR 3R III)
1200 x 800 x 160
B, C, E
15.5
Black
15
Max. dynamic load 1250 kg. Max. racking load 750 kg.
8550.200 (BiPP 1208 HR 3R II RG)
1200 x 800 x 191
B, C, E
22
Black
12
Max. dynamic load 1500 kg. Max. racking load 1000 kg.
1873.002 (BiPP 1210 HR 3R)
1200 x 1000 x 165
B, C, E
20.5
Black
15
Max. dynamic load 1500 kg. Max. racking load 1250 kg.
1921.002 (BiPP HI)
1200 x 800 x 160
B, C, E
18
Grey
15
Max. dynamic load 1250 kg. Max. racking load 800 kg. For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
99
STORAGE PALLETS A Closed deck B Open deck C Deck rim
BiPP HEAVY Item No. 8551.200 (BiPP 1210 HR 3R II)
E 3 skids F 4 skids H 5 skids
I 6 skids J 4 feet K 6 feet
Black 930/093 (recycled)
L 9 feet M Double feet N Nestable
Green 041
External/mvm
Version
Weight/kg
Colour
Pallet unit
1200 x 1000 x 191
B, C, E
22
Black
12
Max. dynamic load 1500 kg. Max. racking load 1250 kg.
8551.200 (BiPP 1210 HR 3R II RG)
1200 x 1000 x 191
B, C, E
26
Grey
12
Max. dynamic load 1500 kg. Max. racking load 1250 kg.
1873.005 (BiPP 1210 HR 6R)
1200 x 1000 x 165
B, C, I
21.0
Black
15
Max. dynamic load 1500 kg. Max. racking load 1250 kg.
1875.005 (BiPP 1311 HR 6R)
1300 x 1100 x 165
B, C, I
23.5
Black
15
Max. dynamic load 1500 kg. Max. racking load 1250 kg.
1876.002 (BiPP Europal 800)
1200 x 800 x 150
A, C, E
23.0
Black
23*
Max. dynamic load 1250 kg. Max. racking load 500 kg.
1887.002 (BiPP Recypal 1208 HR 3R)
1200 x 800 x 150
A, E
23.0
Black
15
Max. dynamic load 1250 kg. Max. racking load 1250 kg.
1878.002 (BiPP Recypal 1210)
1200 x 1000 x 150
A, C, E
28.0
Black 23*
Max. dynamic load 1250 kg. Max. racking load 1250 kg.
1879.005 (BiPP Recypal 1210 HR 5R)
1200 x 1000 x 165
A, C, H
25
Black
14
Max. dynamic load 2000 kg. Max. racking load 1250 kg.
BiPP CLEANROOM 1907.102 (Trans BiPP 0833 C)
1200 x 800 x 160
A, C, E
17.6
Anthracite/Green reinforced skids
16
Max. dynamic load 1500 kg. Max. racking load 1250 kg.
8634.100 (BiPP Everest 1208 HR 3R II) 1200 x 800 x 150 (handholes, lips, antislip)
A, C, E
18
Black
16
Max. dynamic load 1250 kg. Max. racking load 1000 kg.
1902.102 (Trans BiPP 1033 C)
* Stacked upside down
100
1200 x 1000 x 160
A, C, E
22.6
Anthracite/Green reinforced skids
16
Max. dynamic load 1500 kg. Max. racking load 1250 kg.
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Grey 502
Grey 564
Modular Bins
STORAGE
Modular bins Bins with large inner volume for depths 300, 400, 500 and 600 mm. The easy-access open fronts may be fitted with transparent flaps. Convenient handgrips front and back. The sturdy profiled design allows stacking whenever needed. Material polypropylene. Red 215
Blue 624
p.q = pack quantity
Yellow 316 Item No. 9067.000
9068.000
Green 415 External mm
300 x 230 x 150
400 x 230 x 150
Volume l
Weight kg
8.0
0.5
11.0
0.6
Colour
Pallet unit
Red, blue, yellow 192
9067.300 Width-way divider (p.q 50) 9069.500 Length-way divider (p.q 50) 9067.400 Transparent flap (p.q 50) 9067.830 Label (p.q 100) 4534.835 Adhesive label 102 x 25 mm. (p.q 2000)
Red, blue, yellow 144
9067.300 Width-way divider (p.q 50) 9068.500 Length-way divider (p.q 50) 9067.400 Transparent flap (p.q 50) 9141.835 Adhesive label 70 x 24 mm (p.q 3600)
9069.005
500 x 230 x 150
14.0
0.8
Red, blue, yellow
90
9069.500 Width-way divider (p.q 50) 9067.300 Length-way divider (p.q 50) 9067.400 Transparent flap (p.q 50) 9067.830 Label (p.q 100) 4534.835 Adhesive label 102 x 25 mm. (p.q 2000)
9070.000
600 x 230 x 150
17.0
0.9
Red, blue, yellow
80
9067.300 Width-way divider (p.q 50) 9070.500 Length-way divider (p.q 50) 9067.400 Transparent flap (p.q 50) 9067.830 Label (p.q 100) 4534.835 Adhesive label 102 x 25 mm. (p.q 2000)
Storage bins Our spacious storage bins provide maximum strength and stability. They fit panels and rails with handgrips front and back. Optional flaps, dividers and labels. Material polypropylene. Some bins also available in conductive or recycled material.
Ergoget (p.q 20)
Carrybox with 9 bins 9075 (p.q 8)
Width-way divider Length-way divider Transparent flap
Colour
Label
Item No.
External mm Volume l Weight kg
Pallet unit
9076.000
96 x 105 x 45
0.2
0.04 Red, blue, yellow, green 1920
9075.000
170 x 105 x 75
1.0
0.1 Red, blue, yellow, green
640
9074.005
250 x 148 x 130
3.7
0.3 Red, blue, yellow, green
512
9073.005
350 x 206 x 150
8.8
0.5 Red, blue, yellow, green
160
9073.500 Divider (p.q 36) 9073.400 Transparent flap (p.q 72) 9073.830 Label (p.q 100)
9063.000
350 x 206 x 200 11.0
0.6
120
9063.400 Transparent flap (p.q 56) 9073.830 Label (p.q 100) 4534.835 Adhesive label 102 x 25 mm. (p.q 2000)
9071.000
500 x 310 x 200 25.0
1.2 Red, blue, yellow, green
48
9071.500 Divider (p.q 32) 9071.400 Transparent flap (p.q 70) 4534.835 Adhesive label (p.q 2200)
9072.000
500 x 310 x 250 33.0
1.6 Red, blue, yellow, green
48
9072.500 Divider (p.q 24) 9072.400 Transparent flap (p.q 50) 9072.830 Label (p.q 100) 9143.835 Adhesive label 190 x 30 mm. (p.q 900)
9050.000
370 x 175 x 300
9075.200
width 105
Red, blue, yellow
9075.400 Transparent flap (p.q 300) 9075.830 Label (p.q 100)
9074.400 Transparent flap (p.q 120) 9074.830 Label (p.q 100) 4534.835 Adhesive label 102 x 25 mm. (p.q 2000)
Grey with red bins
Grey
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
101
STORAGE Storage Trays Three ranges of storage trays
Our storage trays with a flat profile.
Our storage trays, available in three heights, are superior space savers for handling small parts, and excellent for shelves and paternoster systems. Fitted with labels and dividers these trays can easily be adapted to any shelf and storage system. Certain sizes are also available in conductive material, black (ESD) and recycled material (Grey 050). Red 215
Blue 624
91-SERIES
92-SERIES Item No.
Ext. mm
Vol. l W. kg Colour P.q
9221.760 500 x 115 x 62 2.3 0.3
Blue
520
9223.760 500 x 230 x 62 4.8 0.5
Blue
260
9231.760 600 x 115 x 62 2.9 0.4
Blue
390
9233.760 600 x 230 x 62 5.9 0.6
Blue
195
Item No.
Ext. mm
Vol. l W. kg Colour P.q
9101.760 300 x 115 x 100 2.4 0.3 Blue, red 560
9103.760 300 x 230 x 100 4.9 0.4 Blue, red 280
9111.765 400 x 115 x 100 3.4 0.3 Blue, red 480
9113.765 400 x 230 x 100 7.1 0.5 Blue, red 240 Divider 115 mm Transp. 660 9241.760 Divider 230 mm Transp. 330 9243.760
9121.765 500 x 115 x 100 4.4 0.4 Blue, red 320
Label w. protector 115 mm 9241.830 100 Label w. protector 230 mm 9243.830 100
9123.765 500 x 230 x 100 8.7 0.6 Blue, red 144
45-SERIES 4533.760 300 x 94 x 80 1.5 0.2
Blue
840
4531.760 300 x 188 x 80 3.1 0.3
Blue
420
4532.760 400 x 94 x 80 2.4 0.3
Blue
600
9131.765 600 x 115 x 100 5.2 0.5 Blue, red 320
9133.765 600 x 230 x 100 10.2 0.7 Blue, red 160
115 mm Transp. 480 9141.761 Divider Divider 230 mm Transp. 240 9143.761
4530.760 400 x 188 x 80 4.3 0.4
Blue
300
4537.760 500 x 94 x 80 3.0 0.3
Blue
480
4536.760 500 x 188 x 80 5.3 0.5
Blue
240
Divider 94 mm 4535.760
Blue
480
Divider 188 mm Blue 4534.760
500
Label w. protection 94 mm 4535.830
Blue
240
Label w. protection 188 mm Blue 4534.830
500
Label w. protector 115 mm 9141.830 500 Label w. protector 230 mm 9143.830 500 Adhesive label 70 x 24 mm 9141.835 3600 Adhesive label 190 x 30 mm 9143.835 900
Adhesive label 102 x 25 mm 4534.835 2200
102
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Storage Bins
STORAGE
System 9000™ – a complete storage system whithout limitations System 9000 is a complete storage system for efficient small parts handling in industry and trade. Based on a wide range of durable bins and storage trays, System 9000 provides outstanding versatility. The design of our bins and trays assures easy identification of and access to the contents, as well as full utilisation of space. The system also includes complete bin cabinets, racks, panels, trollies etc.
BIN CABINET with 80 storage trays 9221 and 44 storage trays 9223. Size 2000 x 980 x 500 mm. Pack quantity 1. Item No. 9008.832
BIN CABINET
Storage and modular bins with transparent front flaps.
with 16 storage trays 9111, 12 storage trays 9113 and 4 modular bins 9068. Size 1000 x 960 x 400. Pack quantity 1. Item No. 9041.831
Length and width way dividers.
Labels for identification on tray fronts and dividers.
BIN CABINET
BIN CABINET
BIN CABINET
with 48 storage trays 9111, 32
with 40 modular bins 9068.
with 72 storage bins 9074.
storage trays 9113.
Size 2000 x 980 x 400 mm.
Size 2000 x 950 x 250 mm.
Size 2000 x 980 x 400 mm.
Also available in depth
Pack quantity 4.
Also available in depth
500 mm. Optional.
Item No. 9006.830
500 mm. Optional.
Pack quantity 1.
Pack quantity 1.
Item No. 9007.830
Item No. 9007.831
The shelf supports the back edge of the tray for easier picking.
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
103
STORAGE Anti Static Containers Products in conductive material - for the electronic industry The electronic industry demands precision and cleanliness. The ideal solution is to deliver components directly from the supplier to the clean production area, without unpacking. The containers have to be made from approved conductive material. Schoeller Arca Systems supplies a range of selection of containers, pallets, storage bins and trays in antistatic material.
A Solid base and walls H Lid with hooks J Lid for 64-series
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628)
Black 920
Item No.
External/mm
Internal/mm
Version Weight/kg Volume/l
Colour
Pallet unit
6487.900
300 x 200 x 145
260 x 155 x 142
A
0.5
6
Black
112
6468.900
400 x 300 x 145 355 x 255 x 142
A
0.9
13
Black
56
6469.900
400 x 300 x 230 355 x 255 x 225
A
1.3
20
Black
48
6470.900
600 x 400 x 100
555 x 355 x 95
A
1.3
19
Black
96
6472.900
600 x 400 x 145 555 x 355 x 140
A
1.8
25
Black
64
6479.900
600 x 400 x 230 555 x 355 x 225
A
2.2
44
Black
40
6476.900
600 x 400 x 280 555 x 355 x 275
A
2.7
55
Black
32
LIDS
5787.920 External Weight Colour Version Carton unit
104
Lid 400 x 300 mm 0.4 kg Black H, J 36
5786.920 External Weight Colour Version Carton unit
Lid 600 x 400 mm 0.8 kg Black H, J 15
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
4591.900 External Weight Colour Carton unit
Divider 600 x 85 mm 0.4 kg Black 100
freestanding Panel Racks
STORAGE
PERFO WALL Perfo Wall is a freestanding tool storage system utilising upright members to provide support to standard Perfo Panels Perfo Wall makes an ideal workshop divider Start with an initial bay then add any amount of additional bays to form your custom layout Please note: All bays should be firmly fixed to the floor using the footplates supplied Economical workshop divider wall Freestanding, no additional support required Single or double sided 90oturns possible in any direction T & + junctions can be achieved from standard bays Simple design allows quick & easy assembly - full instructions are supplied Available in 500mm & 1000mm widths, all models 1850mm high Tool holding accessories are not supplied, see page 157 for details Width mm 500
Rack Type Single sided
Bay Type Starter
500
Double sided
Starter
140 35 020.11
500
Single sided
Additional
140 35 027.11
Model 140 35 019.11
500
Double sided
Additional
140 35 028.11
1000
Single sided
Starter
140 35 043.11
1000
Double sided
Starter
140 35 044.11
1000
Single sided
Additional
140 35 051.11
1000
Double sided
Additional
140 35 052.11
LOUVRED PANEL PACK These louvre panel racks are designed tobe totally stable when fixed to the floor The sturdy endplates ensure that the louvred panels & bins are supported to take the heaviest of loads Single & double versions available Can be used as independent bays, or built into longer runs Supplied flat packed with detailed assembly instructions Perfect for use where wall space is limited Ideal partitioning for manufacturing cells Available as a starter bay or additional bays Please note, for maximum stability & safety all units must be firmly fixed to the floor The storage rack is shown fully kitted outwith Plastic storage bins The Plastic bin kit represents the bins requiredto fit out a single side of the storage rack.It contains 32 No. 2 bins, 36 No. 3 bins,8 No. 4 bins, colours as shown Bins Sizes No 2 - 103W x 165D x 83H mm No 3 - 148W x 240D x 128H mm No 4 - 209W x 356D x 164H mm
Single
Starter
Overall Size W x D mm 1015 x 455
Single
Additional
1013 x 455
121 02 093.11
Double
Starter
1015 x 905
121 02 094.11
Double
Additional
1013 x 905
121 02 095.11
Rack Type
Bay Type
Plastic Bin Kit
Model 121 02 092.11
13031145
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
105
STORAGE ROLL CAGES & RETENTION UNITS XtraWall™ heavy-duty double-sided panel systems are designed to hold a large amount of tools and parts, using a fraction of the wall space normally required. These turnkey systems offer dense tool storage on minimal wall surface by expanding the pegboard storage surface when wall space is at a premium. Each unit comes with 1/4” perforated and tempered pegboard that attaches to a heavyduty powder coated steel frame system. (Model W1- D uses 1/4” durable polypropylene pegboard for heavy power and hand tools or large items.) Steel pivot wall brackets can be mounted to cement block or wood stud walls. Wood stud installation will require 2” x 6” headers (not provided). Wall mounting bracket and hardware are included (requires assembly). For best holding results on XtraWall™ swing panels, use DuraHook™ 70000 series locking hooks. B1/B1-2 1 or 2 - 24” x 48” Panels (Assembly Required)
P/N
Finished Size
Load Rating
B1
1
16 sq. ft.
33”
24” W x 48” H
275 lbs.
B1- 2
2
32 sq. ft.
33”
(2) 24” W x 48” H
275 lbs. ea.
D1
1
32 sq. ft.
56”
48” W x 48” H
475 lbs.
W1
1
48 sq. ft.
56”
48” W x 72” H
575 lbs.
W1- D
1
48 sq. ft.
56”
48” W x 72” H
575 lbs.
No. of Panels Total Surface Area Swing Radius
MagClip™ magnetic storage products are the ideal solution for storing long and short sockets of all sizes (standard and metric) and hand tools, using magnetic technology to keep all items in place. These strong, commercial grade magnetic storage products hold sockets and tools tight without magnetizing them. They stay put in a tool chest drawer or expand your storage space by mounting vertically on the outside of a tool chest, steel cabinet workbench. Power Mat™(s) are for
Mag-Clip • Will not magnetize sockets • Securely holds shallow or deep, standard or metric sockets on any smooth metal surface
• Magnets retain strength permanently • Grease, oil and chemical resistant • Tough polymer base • Rust resistant
P/N
72401 2 1/4” x 9” Mag-Clip Strip
72402
Description
interchangeable Power Pegs for socket storage, or to keep hand tools in place, even when opening and closing tool chest drawers. Mag Mounts lock onto any 1/4” or 1/8” pegboard to hold hard to store tools.
Color Drive Sz.
2” x 15 5/8” Mag-Clip Strip
72403 1 7/8” x 16 5/8” Mag-Clip Strip
Red
1/4”
Red
3/8”
Red
1/2”
POWER MAT
72405
• Use with Power Pegs (sold separately) in any combination • of 3 drive sizes – 1/4”, 3/8”, or 1/2” – to customize your workspace.
Mag-Clip Strips with INTERCHANGEABLE PEGS P/N
• Place in drawers to
Color
D rive Sz.
72400 1 7/8” x 16 5/8” Mag-Clip Strip
Red
1/4”
72404 1 7/8” x 16 5/8” Mag-Clip Strip
Red
3/8”
72405 1 7/8” x 16 5/8” Mag-Clip Strip
Red
1/2”
Description
organize sockets or store a variety • of hand tools.
72401 72402 72403 P/N
Includes 10 interchangeable Power Pegs - use any combination in 3 drive sizes to customize your work space!
Power Pegs P/N
Description
Drive Sz.
72441 Power Pegs - Pk. of 10 1/4” 72442 Power Pegs - Pk. of 10 3 /8”
72426• Flexible design allows the • Power Mat to be used Color • almost anywhere!
Description
72424 12 1/8” x 10 1/4” 2-Panel Mat
Black
72425 18 3/8” x 10 1/4” 3-Panel Mat
Black
72426 18 3/8” x 10 1/4” 3-Panel Mat
Black
(Includes 84 Asst. Power Pegs)
72443 Power Pegs - Pk. of 10 1/2”
Mag-Clip Strip UNIVERSAL MAGNETIC TOOL HOLDER
Mag Mounts
Holds screwdrivers, pliers and other Color tools while keeping P/N Description them right at your 72453 Mag Mounts - 3 pcs. per pk. Black fingertips!
P/N Description
Color
72460 1 7/8” x 16 5/8” Magnetic Tool Holder
106
Socket Caddy
Interchangeable steel posts in 1/4”, 3/8” and 1/2” drive sizes – use with power mat, socket caddy and mag-clip strip for the ultimate tool storage system!
Black
72455
Mag Mounts - 5 pcs. per pk. Black
Magnetic tool storage mounting system for use with 1/4” or 1/8” pegboard. Holds tool securely without the use of hooks or bars.
P/N
Description
Color
Drive Sz.
72421 6 1/8” x 10 1/4” Socket Caddy R ed 72422 6 1/8” x 10 1/4” Socket Caddy R ed 72423 6 1/8” x 10 1/4” Socket Caddy R ed
72453
Customize the storage of some of the messiest areas of the average tool box... the socket drawer. Made of high impact plastic magnetic grid, this Socket Caddy includes 28 interchangeable Power Pegs. (Additional Power Pegs in 3 drives sizes sold separately.)
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
1/4” 3/8” 1/2”
ROLL CAGES & RETENTION UNITS
STORAGE
Material Handling and Storage Solutions For Insdustry SECURE, DURABLE, DEPENDABLE! Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628)
Think Outside the Toolbox...
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
107
STORAGE Dura Hook DuraBoard is a heavy-duty white polypropylene pegboard. 4 times greater holding power over traditional pegboard. Durable, weather resistant and washable. Available in 2’ x 4’ and 4’ x 8 ’ sheets. Full 1/4” thick for maximum holding capacity.
DURABOARD
P/N 73210
Spring Clip - Standard P/N 76528
Double Closed End Loop P/N 76342
Spring Clip /Spray Can Holder P/N 71613
Single Rod
DuraBoard
Accommodates entire line of 70000 series DuraHook™ locking pegboard hooks and 1/4” standard pegboard hooks. Mount with 70015 Spacer Kit (page 4).
P/N
Description
Color
Qty./Pk.
DB-2
White
16’ sq. ft.
1” o.c.
2
DB-4
(4) 24” x 48” x 1/4” DuraBoards
White
32’ sq. ft.
9 /32”
1” o.c.
4
DB-96
(1) 48” x 96” x 1/4” DuraBoards
White
32’ sq. ft.
9 /32”
1” o.c.
1
CUSTOM SIZES AVAILABLE
*
DuraBoard KITS P/N
Hole Spacing
*
Hole Size 9 /32”
Total Sq. Ft.
(2) 24” x 48” x 1/4” DuraBoards
Description
Storage
THE TOTAL STORAGE SOLUTION... Asst. Hooks & BinClips
Plastic Hanging Bins
P/N 70015 Spacer Kits
DB-2 Kit
(2) 24” x 48” x 1/4” DuraBoards
16 Sq. Ft.
48
4
1
DB-4 Kit
(4) 24” x 48” x 1/4” DuraBoards
32 Sq. Ft.
96
8
2
An assortment of DuraHook™ locking pegboard hooks, plastic hanging bin system, wall mounting hardware and Tempered Wood COMMERCIAL PEGBOARD spacer system. Tempered hardwood 1/4” commercial grade pegboard P/N Description Storage will not fray or dry out like standard paper based pegboard. TPB-2 (2) 24” x 48” x 1/4” Heavy Duty Tempered Pegboard 16 sq. Ft. Holds 2 times the weight of standard pegboard and is comTPB-4 (4) 24” x 48” x 1/4” Heavy Duty Tempered Pegboard 32 sq. Ft. patible with all DuraHook™ products.
* CUSTOM SIZES AVAILABLE IN QUANTITY*
108
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Dura Hook Board surface is ideal for creating silhouettes of tools to be stored and managed. For a better way to install, DuraHook™ pegboard spacer kits eliminate framing hassles and expense. Suitable for cold and food environments. Ideal for DuraHook pegboard hook and standard pegboard hooks.
STORAGE
Spacer System For Pegboard, Plywood & Duraboard ™
WALL MOUNT SPACER KIT totally eliminates framing hassles and expense, requiring no special tools. Includes 15 pieces of each: #12, 2” length wood screws, plastic wall anchors and 3/8” steel wall spacers.
Double Closed End Loop
P/N
Creates Space
Spacer Diameter
3/8” 1 3 /16” 70015
Qty. / Pack 15 Sets
BINKIT “The first complete hanging bin systems that enable users to store small tools and loose parts on any 1/8” or 1/4” pegboard.”
P/N BK-210
P/N BK-220
P/N BK-235
P/N
BK-210
5 3 /8” L x 4 1/8” W x 3” H
Size of Bins
Yellow
Color
Pkg. Qty. 24
Qty. of BinClips 24
Divider P/N 4-210
BK-220
7 3 /8” L x 4 1/8” W x 3” H
Yellow
24
24
4-220
BK-235
10 7/8 ” L x 11” W x 5” H
Yellow
6
18
4-235
DBC-4
DuraBoard
DuraBoard
XTRA WALL™ SWING PANEL WALL STORAGE SYSTEM
TOOL CART with TRAY W1-D
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
109
STORAGE LOCBOARD LocBoard “A heavy-duty steel pegboard system with square holes!” • Offering heavy-duty storage solutions that will
always ensure the ultimate in holding strength.
• All steel boxed construction with hidden • mounting flanges. • Highest industry load ratings.
• Surface of board is ideal for silhouetting • of tools and other stored items. • Boards can be securely mounted • horizontally or vertically. • Mounting hardware is hidden from sight • for a clean, durable appearance. • Attaches to walls, benches, tool carts, • wire cages and other vertical surfaces. • Accommodates all 50000 series Loc Hooks. • Epoxy powder coated finish. • 3 board sizes to choose from.
2 & 4 POINT CONTACT
P/N 55230
LocHook Curved Hook P/N 56660
LocHook Multi-Prong Tool Holder P/N 53130
LocHook Extended Spring Clip P/N 56528
P/N 57500
LocBoard LocHook BinClip™
LocHook Double Closed End Loop
LB2-W
LocBoard
LB18-W
The steel pegboard with square holes. Use in conjunction with 50000 series LocHook™
P/N
LB1-W
Description (2) 24” x 24” x 9/16” LocBoards
TOOL CARTS with TRAY (LBC-4 & LBC-18 Featured on
LB1-W
**
Finish
Total Sq. Ft.
Gauge
Load Rating
White Epoxy
8’ sq. ft.
18 ga.
300 lbs. Each
LB2-W
(2) 24” x 42 1/2” x 9/16” LocBoards
White Epoxy
14.1” sq. ft.
18 ga.
400 lbs. Each
LB18-W
(2) 18” x 36” x 9 /16” LocBoards
White Epoxy
9’ sq. ft.
18 ga.
350 lbs. Each
LB-MHK 12 pc. Mounting Hardware Kit for LB1-W, LB2-W and LB18-W
LocBoard KIT A COMPLETE STORAGE SOLUTION...
P/N LB18-CK
Description (2) 18” x 36” x 9 /16” LocBoards
Storage
Asst. Hooks & BinClips
Plastic Hanging Bins
9 Sq. Ft.
28
2
LB-MHK Mounting Kit 1
** LocBoard load ratings are based on proper mounting to solid concrete wall systems.
110
Includes an assortment of LocHook™ locking hooks for steel pegboard with square holes, plastic hanging bin system and mounting hardware.
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
LOCHOOK
“Designed to meet the toughest commercial and industrial applications when combined with LocBoard”
LOCHOOK
• Special LocScrews hold hooks securely in place
• Patented 2 and 4 point contacts attach
horizontally and vertically while preventing any accidental removal. • Heavy-duty steel construction, zinc plated with chromate dip to offer years of secure holding power. • Use with LocBoard™ steel pegboards with square holes.
to LocBoard™ for metal to metal holding confidence. • Hooks can be mounted vertically or horizontally and can be combined with other hook styles to create custom storage solutions for virtually any tool shape or weight.
LocHook Pegboard Shelf
LocHook Single Rod
LocHook Double Rod
Length Material
Degree/ Height/Bend
P/N
Description
“A”
Bend “B”
51013
Single Rod
Bright Zinc Plated Steel
1/2”
30
51110
Single Rod (Straight)
Bright Zinc Plated Steel
1 1/2”
0
51113
Single Rod
Bright Zinc Plated Steel
1”
51119
Single Rod
Bright Zinc Plated Steel
Qty.
Qty.
Per Pack
Per Case
“E”
3 /4”
3 /16”
N/A
5
25 Pk.
0
3 /16”
N/A
5
25 Pk.
30
1/2”
3 /16”
N/A
5
25 Pk.
1”
90
5 /8”
3 /16”
N/A
5
25 Pk.
51219
Single Rod
Bright Zinc Plated Steel
2”
90
5 /8”
3 /16”
N/A
5
25 Pk.
51310
Single Rod (Straight)
Bright Zinc Plated Steel
3”
0
0
3 /16”
N/A
5
25 Pk.
51323
Single Rod
Bright Zinc Plated Steel
3”
30
1/2”
1/4”
N/A
5
25 Pk.
51413
Single Rod
Bright Zinc Plated Steel
4”
30
1/2”
3 /16”
N/A
5
25 Pk.
51629
Single Rod
Bright Zinc Plated Steel
6”
90
3 /4”
1/4”
N/A
5
25 Pk.
51813
Single Rod
Bright Zinc Plated Steel
8”
30
1/2”
1/4”
N/A
5
25 Pk.
52113
Double Rod
Bright Zinc Plated Steel
1”
30
1/2”
3 /16”
1 11/32”
5
25 Pk.
52119
Double Rod
Bright Zinc Plated Steel
1”
90
3 /4”
3 /16”
1 11/32”
5
25 Pk.
52213
Double Rod
Bright Zinc Plated Steel
2”
30
1/2”
3 /16”
1 11/32”
5
25 Pk.
52313
Double Rod
Bright Zinc Plated Steel
3”
30
1/2”
3 /16”
1 11/32”
5
25 Pk.
52319
Double Rod
Bright Zinc Plated Steel
3”
90
3 /4”
3 /16”
1 11/32”
5
25 Pk.
52419
Double Rod
Bright Zinc Plated Steel
4”
90
3 /4”
1/4”
1 5 /8”
5
25 Pk.
52628
Double Rod
Bright Zinc Plated Steel
5 3 /4”
80
3 /4”
1/4”
1 5 /8”
5
25 Pk.
P/N
Description
Material
Hold
Projection
53105 Spring Clip - Extended
Zinc Plated / Chromate Dipped Steel
7/8”
53107
Spring Clip - Extended
Zinc Plated / Chromate Dipped Steel
2 ”
53120
Spring Clip - Extended
Zinc Plated / Chromate Dipped Steel
2
53130
Spring Clip Extended /
Range
Qty.
Qty.
Per Pack
Per Case
1 /4” - 1/2” 3 /4” - 1 1/4” 3 /4” 1” - 2”
5
25 Pk.
5
25 Pk.
5
25 Pk.
Spray Can Holder
Zinc Plated / Chromate Dipped Steel
3 3 /4”
1 1/2” - 2 3 /4”
5
25 Pk.
53205
Spring Clip - Standard
Zinc Plated / Chromate Dipped Stee
1 1/4”
1/4” - 1/2”
5
25 Pk.
53210
Spring Clip - Standard
Zinc Plated / Chromate Dipped Stee
1 1/2”
1/2” - 1”
5
25 Pk.
P/N
Description
Length
Material
Rod Thickness Inside Dia.
“A”
“D”
“E”
3 /16”
Qty.
Qty.
Per Pack
Per Case
54105
Single Ring Tool Holder
Bright Zinc Plated Steel
1 1/8”
1/2”
5
25 Pk.
54110
Single Ring Tool Holder
Bright Zinc Plated Steel
1 5 /8”
3 /16”
1”
5
25 Pk.
54117
Single Ring Tool Holder
Bright Zinc Plated Steel
2 1/2”
3 /16”
1 3 /4”
5
25 Pk.
55200
Curved Hook
Bright Zinc Plated Steel
2 1/4”
3 /16”
2”
5
25 Pk.
55230
Curved Hook
Bright Zinc Plated Steel
3 3 /4”
1/4”
3 3/32”
5
25 Pk.
56201
Closed Hammer / Pliers Holder
Bright Zinc Plated Steel
1 3 /8”
3 /16”
1 3 /4”
5
25 Pk.
LocHook Multi-Ring Tool Holder
P/N
Description
Material
I.D.
Load
Depth
Width
Rating
Rod Thickness
Inside Dia.
Qty.
Qty.
“D”
“E”
Per Pack
Per Case
**
56186
LocBoard Shelf
Gray Epoxy Powder Coated
6 1/2”
1 8”
7/16” & 13 /16”
1 Unit
6 Units
56660
Multi-Prong Tool Holder
Bright Zinc Plated Steel
1 13 /32”
9”
3 /16”
3 /4”
1
50 Pk.
56666
Multi-Ring Tool Holder
Bright Zinc Plated Steel
1 5/8”
9”
3 /16”
3/4”
2
25 Pk.
57500
BinClip™
Bright Zinc Plated Steel
Rated 100 lbs.
5 50 Pk.
NOTE: BinClips accommodate all types of bins designed for hanging systems and are compatible with ALL steel LocBoard.
P/N
Length
Description
Material
“A”
Degree/
Height/
Bend “B”
Bend “C”
Rod Thickness
I nside Dia.
“D”
“E”
Qty.
Qty.
Per Pack
Per Case
56528
Double Closed End Loop
Bright Zinc Plated Steel
5”
80
2”
3 /16”
2 3/4”
5
25 Pk.
56828
Double Closed End Loop
Bright Zinc Plated Steel
8”
30
2”
3 /16”
2 3/4”
5
25 Pk.
LocHook Assortment Kits
LocHook Extended Spring Clip
Inside Dia.
“D”
LocHook Curved Hook
LocHook Standard Spring Clip
Rod Thickness
“C”
LocHook Double Closed End Loop
STORAGE
Dimension Reference “A”
P/N
Description
LH1-Kit
46 Pc. LocHook Assortment
1
LH2-Kit
63 Pc. LocHook Assortment
1
LH3-Kit
28 Pc. LocHook Assortment and 2 Plastic Hanging Bins
1
“E” “C”
Qty.
“B”
“D”
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
“A” “E” “E”
111
STORAGE LocBoard™ Stainless Steel LocBoard
“The ultimate commercial pegboard wall storage system that ensures maximum ” holding strength, even in extreme temperatures!
• Constructed of 304 brushed stainless steel with square holes that accommodate stainless steel LocHook™(s). • Perfect storage solution for sterile or harsh environments in health, medical, food, marine industry and commercial applications. • Sturdy mounting flanges make it easy to attach LocBoard™(s) to almost any wall or other vertical surface. • Box construction eliminates the need for spacers between board and wall.
• Stainless steel LocBoard™(s) have a lifetime warranty and will not rust or corrode in extreme hot or cold temperatures. • Includes stainless steel mounting screws that will be hidden from sight after installation, providing a clean and attractive appearance. • Commercial construction allows for years of heavy duty use, while maintaining a shiny, polished surface.
P/N
Description
LB-18S
(2) 18” x 36” x 1/2” 304 Stainless Steel LocBoard w/Wall Mounting Hardware
LB18S-KIT Stainless Steel Kit with 32 LocHook Assortment & 3 Plastic Bins
66186
Total Sq. Ft.
Gauge
Load Rating
9 sq. ft.
18 ga.
800 lbs.
9 sq. ft.
18 ga.
800 lbs.
N/A
18 ga.
100 lbs.
(1) 18” x 6 1/2” Stainless Steel LocBoard Shelf
**
STAINLESS STEEL LOCBOARD SHELF PROVIDES A SECURE LOCKING STORAGE SHELF SOLUTION... Designed for use with stainless steel LocBoard™(s) to offer a flat surface storage shelf with a front lip, ideal for keeping bottles, cans, instruments, etc. in place. Patented 4 point locking system holds the shelf securely fastened, making it ideal for most commercial applications. Also compatible with Triton stainless steel mobile tool carts. Lifetime warranty.
“Stainless steel LocHook™ industrial strength hooks offer the ultimate building block for secure organization and storage.”
Stainless Steel Lochook • Patented stainless steel LocHook™(s), with 2 and 4 point interlocking tabs attach vertically or horizontally, locking to stainless steel LocBoard™ with stainless metal screws. Repositioning hooks will not damage the board. • LocHooks are offered in unique styles, including extended and standard spring clips, and Bin Clip™(s) to mount plastic hanging bins. • Heavy-duty boxed stainless steel construction offers years of dependable holding power - especially for heavy or oddshaped items.
• Stainless steel LocHook™(s) used with stainless steel LocBoard™(s) provide a stainless storage solution, ideal for medical, health care, restaurant, food, marine and commercial applications. Made from 304 brushed stainless steel. • Lifetime warranty - won’t rust or corrode, even in extreme temperatures.
Multi-Prong Tool Holder
Single Rod Hook
Standard Spring Clip
Multi-Ring Tool Holder Curved Hook
Extended Spring Hook
Double Rod Hook
Hold
Qty.
Qty.
Projection
Range
Per Pack
Per Case
Stainless Steel Spring Clip - Extended
7/8”
3 /4” - 1 1/4”
3
50 Pk.
Stainless Steel Spring Clip - Extended
2 ”
1” - 2”
3
50 Pk.
2 3 /4”
1/4” - 1/2”
3
50 Pk.
Length
Degree/
Height/
Rod Thickness
Inside Dia.
Qty.
Qty.
P/N
Description
“A”
Bend “B”
Bend ”C”
“D”
“E”
Per Pack
Per Case
61113
Stainless Steel Single Rod Hook
1”
30
1/2”
3 /16”
N/A
3
50 Pk.
61323
Stainless Steel Single Rod Hook
3”
30
1/2”
1/4”
N/A
3
50 Pk.
61629
Stainless Steel Single Rod Hook
6”
90
3 /4”
1/4”
N/A
3
50 Pk.
4”
90
3 /4”
1/4”
1 5 /8”
3
50 Pk.
2 1/4”
N/A
N/A
3 /16”
2”
3
50 Pk.
Inside Dia.
Qty.
Qty.
62419
Stainless Steel Double Rod Hook
65200
Stainless Steel Curved Hook
P/N
Description
63107
63120
63205
Spring Clip - Standard
P/N
Description
66660
Stainless Steel Multi-Prong Tool Holder
66661
Projection
Width
Degree/
Height/
Bend “B”
Bend ”C”
“E”
Per Pack
Per Case
3 /8”
13 /32”, 3/4”
1
50 Pk.
1 13 /32” 8 5 /32” 30 1 7/8”
Stainless Steel Multi-Ring Tool Holder
9”
N/A
3 /4”
N/A
1
50 Pk.
P/N
Description
67500
Stainless Steel BinClip Hanging Bin Holder
Qty.
Qty.
Projection
Height
Per Pack
Per Case
3 /8”
2 1/2”
3
50 Pk.
P/N
LB-MHKS Stainless Steel LocBoard Mounting Hardware Kit
Description
Dimension Reference “A”
“E” “C”
“B”
“A”
Stainless Steel
“E”
“D”
“E”
LocBoard TOOL CARTS with TRAY
**LocBoard load ratings are based on proper mounting to solid concrete wall systems.
112
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Use stainless steel BinClips to mount LocBins onto stainless steel LocBoards.
LOCBIN
STORAGE
“The first hanging and stacking bins that interlock using a patented dual channel system!
LocBin • Channeling system allows users to stack and lock bins together or connect and hang bins one below the other using the Triton wall hanger system (5-600). • Interlocking feature guarantees bins will not collapse, cave in or topple into one another, spilling or mixing contents. • Anti-slide stops in the channels ensure stacked or hanging interlocking bins will not slide out from the front. • Durable, water repellent LocBin™(s) are available in red, yellow or blue high density polypropylene, in a variety of sizes. Suitable storage for corrosive environments. • Unique nesting feature allows bins to be stacked, maximizing counter and wall space.
• Sloped front allows for trouble-free removal of stored items. • Extra deep groove system accepts bin dividers and keeps them in place. • Built-in rear-hanging tab enables bins to be mounted on pegboard with Triton wall hangers, louvered panels, hanging rails, or bin cabinets. BinClip™(s) can also be used to attach LocBins securely to pegboard. • LocBins are easily transportable in the stacked, interlocked position. • Front of each bin is molded to hold a storage identification label (included).
3-235Y and 3-235B LocBins being interlocked.
“Their uses are endless!!”
3-235Y LocBins stacked and interlocked, sitting on a sloped surface.
3-235Y and 3-235B LocBins, interlocked and hung on wall with 5-600 wall hanger.
Model
No.
Description
Material
Outside Dimensions
Inside Dimensions
Load
Divider
Qty.
L x W x H
L x W x H
Capacity
Slot Qty.
Per Case
3-210Y
Yellow LocBin High Density Polypropylene
5 3/8” x 4 1/8” x 3”
4 3/4” x 3 9/16” x 2 13 /16”
12 lbs.
1
24
3-210B
Blue LocBin
High Density Polypropylene
5 3/8” x 4 1/8” x 3”
4 3/4” x 3 9/16” x 2 13 /16”
12 lbs.
1
24
3-210R
Red LocBin
High Density Polypropylene
5 3/8” x 4 1/8” x 3”
4 3/4” x 3 9/16” x 2 13 /16”
12 lbs.
1
24
3-220Y
Yellow LocBin High Density Polypropylene
7 3/8” x 4 1/8” x 3”
6 3/4” x 3 9/16” x 2 13 /16”
12 lbs.
1
24
3-220B
Blue LocBin
High Density Polypropylene
7 3/8” x 4 1/8” x 3”
6 3/4” x 3 9/16” x 2 13 /16”
12 lbs.
1
24
3-220R
Red LocBin
High Density Polypropylene
7 3/8” x 4 1/8” x 3”
6 3/4” x 3 9/16” x 2 13 /16”
12 lbs.
1
24
3-235Y
Yellow LocBin High Density Polypropylene
10 7/8” x 11” x 5”
10 1/4” x 10 1/8” x 4 3/4”
55 lbs.
3
6
3-235B
Blue LocBin
High Density Polypropylene
10 7/8” x 11” x 5”
10 1/4” x 10 1/8” x 4 3/4”
55 lbs.
3
6
High Density Polypropylene
3-235R
Red LocBin
10 7/8” x 11” x 5”
10 1/4” x 10 1/8” x 4 3/4”
55 lbs.
3
6
3-240Y
Yellow LocBin High Density Polypropylene
14 3/4” x 8 1/4” x 7”
14” x 6 11/16” x 6 3/4”
65 lbs.
1
6
3-240B
Blue LocBin
High Density Polypropylene
14 3/4” x 8 1/4” x 7”
14” x 6 11/16” x 6 3/4”
65 lbs.
1
6
3-240R
Red LocBin
High Density Polypropylene
14 3/4” x 8 1/4” x 7”
14” x 6 11/16” x 6 3/4”
65 lbs.
1
6
Model
No.
Description
Material
4-210
Black LocBin Divider for 3-210 LocBin
ABS Thermoplastic
Load
Qty.
Qty.
Capacity
Per Pk.
Per Case
N/A
6
12
4-220
Black LocBin Divider for 3-220 LocBin
ABS Thermoplastic
N/A
6
12
4-235
Black LocBin Divider for 3-235 LocBin
ABS Thermoplastic
N/A
6
12
4-240
Black LocBin Divider for 3-240 LocBin
ABS Thermoplastic
N/A
6
12
5-600
Black LocBin Wall Hangers
ABS Thermoplastic
50
2
12
3-210Y LocBins stacked and interlocked, with identification labels added.
3-220R LocBins with 4-220 divider.
Triton offers the ONLY wall hangers that hold multiple bins!
NOTE: 5-600 Wall Hangers hang (4) 3-210 & 3-220 or (2) 3-235
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628)
3-210R and 3-235R LocBins mounted to wall with 5-600 wall hangers... with space left for attaching additional bins!
3-210Y LocBins, nested and interlocked.
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
113
STORAGE Mobile Tool Carts “A flexible and secure storage solution that enhances maintenance operations, service performance • Dual-sided storage allows users to efficiently organize, and aids in plant-wide standardization.” manage and store precision tools, hand tools, equipment and
Mobile Tool Carts
small parts without clutter. • Tools and equipment can be transported virtually anywhere within a plant or service environment; a secure locking system ensures items stay in place. • Pull handle and durable neoprene casters (2 fixed and 2 swivel locking) make it easy to roll the mobile tool carts anywhere across flat surfaces. • Fully visible storage system improves tool accountability and proper • tool usage while increasing overall performance. • Narrow base allows the user to transport tools around tight corners and through narrow door openings.
• Items can be secured on the tool cart with Triton’s patented locking DuraHook™(s) for DBC-4 or LocHook™(s) with 2 and 4 point contact locking features for LBC LocBoard™ tool carts. • Cart frames are made of extra heavy-duty 10 gauge aluminum and equipped with a sturdy aluminum bottom tray for tool boxes, paint cans, lumber and large items. • Highest load rating in the industry!
LBC-4
LocBoard
DBC-4
TOOL CARTS with TRAY Equipped with heavy-duty, epoxy powder- coated steel LocBoards with square holes, the LBC-4 tool cart is load rated at 850 lbs., has a total of 28.3 sq. ft. of storage surface and 8 sq. ft. of space on the tray located at the bottom of the cart!
LBC-18
The LBC-18 has a load rating of 800 lbs., a total storage surface of 18 sq. ft., 4.9 sq. ft. of bottom tray storage, plus an additional top storage tray. 5000 Series LocHooks, with 2 and 4 point contact locking features (see page 6), securely hold all types of tools and equipment in place and on the move!
DuraBoard TOOL CART with TRAY
DuraBoard™ mobile tool cart is equipped with industrial strength, impact resistant, 1/4” thick polypropylene pegboards and has a 650 lb. load rating, 32 sq. ft. of storage space and 8 sq. ft. of tray space. Use P/N Description Frame Assembled Dimensions with Triton’s 70000 series DuraHook™ DBC-4 DuraBoard Tool Cart Aluminum 48”L x 511/2”H x 29 3 /4”W double-locking pegboard hooks for secure LBC-4 LocBoard Tool Cart Aluminum 48”L x 46”H x 26 5/8”W storage solutions that can be conveniently LBC-18 LocBoard Tool Cart Anodized Alum. 36 3/4”L x 39 1/4”H x 211/4”W transported within a service environment. LBC-18S Stainless Steel LocBoard Tool Cart Anodized Alum. 36 3/4”L x 39 1/4”H x 211/4”W
Load Rating
Ship Wt.
32 sq. ft./8 sq. ft. Tray
Storage
650 lbs.
80 lbs.
28 1/3 sq. ft./8 sq. ft. Tray
850 lbs.
92 lbs.
18 sq. ft./4.9 sq. ft. Tray
800 lbs.
61 lbs.
18 sq. ft./4.9 sq. ft. Tray
800 lbs.
56 lbs.
Stainless Steel
LBC-18S
LocBoard
TOOL CART with TRAY
MOBILE Tool Cart SYSTEMS
P/N
Description
The LBC-18S stainless steel tool cart is LBC-18H LocBoard Tool Cart with Anodized Aluminum Frame, manufactured to be the ideal mobile storage 56 Pc. LocHook Assortment and 4 Hanging Bins solution for medical, food and marine LBC-18SH Stainless Steel LocBoard Tool Cart with Anodized Aluminum Frame, 60 pc. Stainless Steel LocHook Assortment and 3 Hanging Bins environments when used with stainless steel 60000 series stainless LocHooks. The sturdy frame is constructed of anodized aluminum and the stainless steel LocHook pegboards are made of 304 brushed aluminum that will not corrode or rust, even in extreme temperature changes! Storage surface =18 sq. ft with 4.9 sq. ft. of tray storage and a convenient storage shelf at the top of the cart. Load rating is the highest in the industry at 800 lbs!
114
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Wall Storage & Accessories Modular Wall Storage & Accessories • Storability™ Modular Wall Storage is an expandable, versatile and interchangeable wall mounted storage system, with accessories that fasten and lock securely on a 14-gauge epoxy coated steel frame system. • Modular systems feature remarkable holding strength and provide years of heavy-duty use. • Storability™ offers a wide choice of accessory items to expand your system to any size wall space available. • Change placement of accessories on the frame from one area to another in seconds. • Storability™ is the ideal commercial storage solution for maintenance, back room, janitorial and tool crib areas, factory floor and more. • Utilize empty wall space for tools, equipment and other large and heavy items currently sitting on floors, workbenches and work areas, or in office and service areas. • Modular design makes it easy to install, simple to expand and cost effective.
STORAGE
“Storability™ offers wall storage options never before available to fit all of your organization requirements! ”
1785
1795
Complete Modular Wall Storage Kits
P/N
1785
Projection Description
Load
Qty. Per
from Wall
Kit Includes
Capacity
Case
16”
1- Top Track; 2 - 64”L 3 pcs. Hang Rail; 1 each: 31”L Wire Shelf, Combo Rail,
500 lbs.
1
450 lbs.
1
36”L x 64”H Modular Wall System Kit
Wire Basket, LocBoard Toolboard; 3 - Hang Bins; 3 - Assorted Combo Rail Hooks,
and 11 Assorted Toolboard Hooks
1-Top Track; 2-64”L 3 pcs Hang Rails, 3-31” Wire Shelves
1795
34”L x 32”H Wall Mount Unit
16”
Framing System Components
Projection
1700
Qty. Per
P/N
Description f rom Wall
Case
1700
34”L Top Track Frame w/Wall Mounting Hardware
1 1/4”
8
1701
63”L 3 pc. Vertical Hang Rail w/Wall Mounting Hardware
1 1/4”
8
1702
32”L Vertical Hang Rail Height Extender
1 1/4”
8
1701
Modular Accessory Items
1705
Projection
Qty. Per
P/N
Description
from Wall
Case
1705
31”L x 19”H Epoxy Coated Steel LocBoard
1 1/4”
6
1710
31” Combination Rail for Hanging Bins or Accessory Hooks
2”
6
1715
31”W Wire Basket w/2 Lock-on Hang Brackets
8”
6
1720
31”W Wire Shelf w/2 Lock-on Hang Brackets
16”
6
1725
31”W Adj. Universal Storage Rack/Tire Holder
17 3/4” – 25 1/2”
3
1735
10 pc LocHook Assortment for Steel LocBoard
4 7/8”
8
1738
2 pk. Large Tool Keepers - Mount on Top Track
6 1/4”
6
1740
Wall Mount Unit with Storage Board & Hooks
16”
1
1745
4 pc. Combo Hook Set for Combination Rails –
5”
12
15 1/2”
6
16”
1
Round, Single, Double, Clamp
1748
Hang Rail Hooks (2 per pk.)
1750
Wall Unit w/2 Storage/Recycle bags, Shoe Racks
& Clothes Hanger
1755
31” W Large Steel Shelf
16”
1
1760
Wall Mount Unit w/Large Tool Hooks & 1 Storage/Recycle Bag
16”
1
1770
15” Combination Rail
2”
6
1775
15” W Small Wire Basket with 2 Lock-on Hang Brackets
8”
6
1780
15” W Wide Steel Shelf with 2 Lock-On Hang Brackets
16”
6
1720
1710
1725
1735
1738
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
115
STORAGE STORAGE RACK
GVR01 GVR24
VERTICAL STORAGE RACK
• Distance between support bars: 250 mm Designed to provide organised storage facilities for lengths of bar, pipe, timber and similar materials. Fully welded construction, finished in stove enamel blue. Pre-drilled ready for bolting to the floor (fixings not supplied). Overall Height x Depth mm
Overall Number of Weight Length mm Sections Kg
Model
VERTICAL SHEET RACK
Ensures the safe storage of sheet steel, plywood, etc. Bolted and welded construction. Supplied Knock Down - flatpack - welded sections. Flatpack size: L x W x H 1240 x 1530 x 120 mm. Size L x W x H: 2120 x 1240 x 1530 mm.
Price
1500
1200
4
70 GVR24 AED 1,372.15
x
1800
6
100 GVR26 AED 1,621.95
600
2400
8
120 GVR28 AED 1,906.50
For use with Sheet Size 21/2 m x 11/2 m
Opening mm
Weight Kg
Model
Price
150
140
GVR01
AED 3,703.60
GSR34
SHEET RACKING • Distance between uprights: 160 mm Designed for the vertical storage of sheet materials. An all welded unit available with a choice of 4 - 10 bays. Units have intermediate floor bracing for supporting the sheet materials.
GVR31
VARIABLE HEIGHT SHEET RACK • Distance between uprights: 160 mm Designed for the vertical storage of different height sheet materials, with 5 support bars at heights of 400, 550, 700, 850, and 1000 mm. Fully welded construction, finished in stove enamel blue.
116
Overall Dimensions L x W x H mm
Weight kg
Model
Price
1400 x 800 x 1000
70
GVR31
AED 1,603.40
Overall Height Overall Number x Length mm Width mm of Bays 1200 4 1400 5 1050 1600 6 x 1800 7 2040 2000 8 2200 9 2400 10
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Weight Kg Model Price 135 GSR34 AED 4,958.10 160 GSR35 AED 5,953.70 180 GSR36 AED 7,000.80 200 GSR37 AED 7,826.90 215 GSR38 AED 8,665.10 235 GSR39 AED 9,660.35 255 GSR40 AED 11,598.95
Cantilever Rack
STORAGE
the see To range, 8 full 0-LOC 80 call
GCR120
CANTILEVER RACKING
Ideal for the storage of pipes, tubes, bars etc. Available single sided or double sided and with a choice of ‘parallel’ arms or ‘tapered arms’ of welded construction, each arm has end stops to help prevent items slipping. • We suggest loading heavy materials at lower levels.
GCR110
Description
Overall Size L x W x H mm
Weight kg
Model
Price
Parallel Arms Single Sided - 2 Bay Single Sided Extra Bay i.e. One upright & 3 support stays Double Sided - 2 Bay Double Sided Extra Bay i.e. One upright & 3 support stays
2580 x 610 x 2100
106
GCR110
Increases Length by 1225 mm per bay
38
GCR111
2580 x 1110 x 2100
143
GCR210
Increases Length by 1225 mm per bay
51
GCR211
AED AED AED AED
3,252.15 1,479.65 3,671.45 1,717.65
AED AED AED AED
4,049.10 1,875.10 3,915.80 1,815.70
Tapered Arms Single Sided - 2 Bay Single Sided Extra Bay i.e. One upright & 3 support stays Double Sided - 2 Bay Double Sided Extra Bay i.e. One upright & 3 support stays
2580 x 650 x 2030
93
GCR120
Increases Length by 1225 mm per bay
34
GCR121
2580 x 1190 x 2030
125
GCR220
Increases Length by 1225 mm per bay
44
GCR221
GSR01 2 x GSR11
4 x BRP11Z
BRP11Z
BAR PalletS
A versatile and flexible bar storage system of an all welded construction, stacks 5 high. Load capacity of 1000kg per unit - maximum load of 5000kg. Internal Size mm
Overall Size mm
Weight
Model
620 x 400
700 x 480
19 kg
BRP01Z
920 x 400
1000 x 480
22 kg
620 x 520
700 x 600
22 kg
920 x 520
1000 x 600
24 kg
BAR STORAGE RACKS
Free standing, storage racks with horizontal storage arms. Space between arms is 250 mm, each arm having a load capacity of 1000 kg. Single or double racks are available. • We suggest loading heavy materials at lower levels. Overall Size L x W x H mm
Tiers Single / Per Unit Double 5
BRP02Z
AED 898.00 1150 x 575 x 1500 AED 913.15 1150 x 575 x 1870
BRP11Z
AED 919.60 1150 x 1000 x 1500
BRP12Z
AED 935.45 1150 x 1000 x 1870
Weight
Model
Price
Single
40 kg
6
Single
60 kg
GSR01 AED 1,887.95 GSR02 AED 1,959.50
5
Double
50 kg
GSR11 AED 2,230.45
6
Double
80 kg
GSR12 AED 2,329.95
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
117
STORAGE HEAVY DUTY STORAGE UNITS
SSC02Z
SSC01Z
Storage Cabinet - SSC01Z
• Lockable handle on double doors. • Clear space between shelves, 550 top, 540 bottom shelf. • Two removable storage shelves of 25 x 25 mm mesh, • 1115 x 520 mm. • Finish stove enamel red. Designed to comply with the Flammable Liquid Storage Regulations (1972) as appropriate and the Factory Inspection Guide HSG51. Adjustable vent meets the requirements of both Flammable Storage (vent closed) and Agrochemicals (vent open). All welded unit conforming to the A. P. E. A. Construction requirements. Produced from 1.6 mm sheet steel and provides a half hour protection from collapse and the passage of fire. Overall Size W x D x H mm
1125 x 560 x 1535
Drip Tray Capacity 1 drip tray located within the base. 85 ltr.
Weight 120 kg
Model
Price
SSC01Z AED 3,935.95
petroleum cupboard
• Constructed from 1.6mm steel with spot welded seams. • Fitted with 150 mm deep, leak proof sump to contain spillage. • Doors fitted with vapour seal. • Finish stove enamel red. Suitable for “CLASS A” storage (1986) and labelled in accordance with Petroleum Consolidation Act 1928, conforming to BS5378 & E.C. Directive 92/58 EEC. Designed and constructed to comply with A.P.E.A. requirements. The shelves within the unit are adjustable to 75 mm centres with the doors fitted with a locking handle. Units are provided with a floor stand which raises the cupboard by 610 mm from the ground. The floor stand has a fixed shelf which is 310 mm from the ground. N.B - A Fork Lift will be needed to unload these units Overall Size W x D x H mm 1220 x 610 x 1220 915 x 560 x 1219 915 x 560 x 915 915 x 560 x 762 610 x 560 x 915 610 x 560 x 762
No of Shelves 2 2 2 1 2 1
Weight kg 201 104 80 71 53 47
Model SSC07Z SSC02Z SSC03Z tSSC04Z SSC05Z SSC06Z
Price AED 4,868.40 AED 4,329.90 AED 4,100.20 AED 3,858.75 AED 3,827.75 AED 3,573.80
Petroleum Storage chests SSB10Z
Suitable for “Class A” storage (1986) and labelled in accordance with Petroleum Consolidation Act 1928, conforming to BS5378 & E. C. Directive 92/58 EEC. Designed and constructed to comply with A. P. E. A. requirements. Fitted with a hasp and staple to enable padlocking. Produced with a sloping roof to aid protection against the weather. To assist in the cleaning of any spillages, each unit is fitted with a removable sump. General Specification • Constructed from 1.6mm steel with spot welded seams. • Fitted with 150 mm deep leak proof sump to contain spillage. • Finish stove enamel red.
Overall Size mm Weight L x W x H front H rear kg
118
Capacity
Model
610 x 630 x 655 - 810
46
.25 cubic metres SSB09Z
965 x 630 x 655 - 810
64
.34 cubic metres SSB10Z
1270 x 630 x 655 - 810
85
.4 cubic metres
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
SSB11Z
Price
STORAGE VAULTS
STORAGE
STORAGE VAULTS Designed to comply with the Flammable Liquid Storage Regulations (1972) as appropriate and the Factory Inspection Guide HSG51. Adjustable vent meets the requirements of both Flammable Storage (vent closed) and Agrochemicals (vent open). All welded units conforming to the A.P.E.A. Construction requirements. Produced from 2.5 mm sheet steel. These vaults provide a half hour protection from collapse and the passage of fire. Multi-lockable for high security, and fitted with a lift up action lid assisted by gas struts. For extra protection and fork lifting the units have skids on the base. Middle shelves pivot on models SSV01Z and SSV02Z to enable larger items to be stored on the base level. Model SSV03Z has a central partition and four shelves.The two middle shelves fold away and the two top shelves are made in 3 sections. The back section is fixed in position and the front two sections removable. All models have a liquid-tight base to contain spillage.
N.B. A Fork Lift will be needed to unload all these vaults
SSV02Z
Safety Note Before storage of herbicides and petroleum based products takes place the advice of the following should be sought for specific guidance. • Health & Safety Inspector • Trading Standards Officers • Environmental Health Officers • Fire Officers
SSV03Z
Overall Dimensions Liquid Tight Sealed L x W x H mm Base Unit Capacity 700 x 850 x 1270 120 Litre 1370 x 850 x 1270 250 litre 2500 x 1080 x 1270 550 Litre
Shelves mm 2 x Shelves: Top: 690 x 400 fixed Middle: 690 x 400 pivots 2 x Shelves: Top: 1360 x 400 fixed Middle: 1360 x 400 pivots 4 x Shelves: 1220 x 500
Weight kg 180
Model SSV01Z
AED 5,375.85
260
SSV02Z
AED 7,493.10
460
SSV03Z
AED 14,127.20
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Price
119
STORAGE HEAVY DUTY STORAGE UNITS HEAVY DUTY CABINETS Made from 1.2mm Sheet Steel
HEAVY DUTY Storage Cabinets General Specification • A robustly constructed range of cabinets providing safe storage for Flammable Liquids. • Manufactured from 1.2mm sheet steel for extra strength and improved protection from fire penetration.
ider aw For ction, 8 sele 0-LOC 80 call
• Designed to comply with Flammable Liquid Storage Regulations (1972) as appropriate and Health and Safety Guidance notes HSG51 and CS19. • Comply with Factory Inspectorate Certificate of Approval No. 1 Parts 3 and 4. • All formed welded seams. Doors are fitted with vertical reinforcement panels to prevent distortion. • Produced with return flange around doors and joints to prevent the passage of flame. • Fitted with all metal security locks and two keys. • Adjustable galvanised shelves to 75 mm centres. Shelves are also reversible which allows them to be used as a Tray. • Base of each unit is fitted with a large capacity removable sump to contain any spillage. • Floor stands are available for the five smallest sizes, raising the units by 450 mm.
FSC Range
Highly Flammable Storage Cabinets •F inished in stove enamel yellow. • Supplied with appropriate labels to BS5378 standard. • All other details as general specification.
Acid Storage Cabinets • • • • •
Supplied with the Acid warning label conforming to BS5378 and 92/58 EEC. Stove enamel carcase with the shelves and sump tray finished in white polyester powder coating which is impervious to most Acids & Alkalis. All other details as general specification.
Overall Size
No of
Shelf Depth
Sump
Doors
D x L x H mm Shelves (as a tray) Capacity
ASC Range
120
Weight g k
Highly Flammable Model
Price
Acid Model
Price
*483 x 458 x 765v
1
38mm
14 litres
Single
25
FSC01Z
ASC01Z POA
POA
*483 x 458 x 915
1
38mm
14 litres
Single
35
FSC02Z
POA
ASC02Z
POA
*306 x 610 x 610
1
24mm
12 litres
Double
23
FSC03Z
ASC03Z POA
POA
*483 x 915 710
1
34mm
33 litres
Double
45
FSC04Z
POA
ASC04Z
POA
*483 x 915 x 915
2
34mm
33 litres
Double
55
FSC05Z ASC05Z POA
POA
483 x 915 x 1220
2
34mm
33 litres
Double
65
FSC06Z ASC06Z POA
POA
483 x 915 x 1500
3
34mm
33 litres
Double
80
FSC07Z POA
ASC07Z
POA
483 x 915 x 1830
3
34mm
33 litres
Double
100
FSC08Z POA
ASC08Z
POA
POA FSC09Z
ASC09Z
POA
* Floor stand (available for the 5 smallest sizes)
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
HEAVY DUTY STORAGE UNITS
STORAGE
SAFETY NOTE Before storage of herbicides or petroleum based products takes place the advice of the following should be sought for specific guidance. • Health & Safety Inspector • Trading Standards Officers • Fire Officers
PSC Range
HEAVY DUTY Storage Cabinets
General Storage Cabinets
GSC Range
•F inished in stove enamel grey. • Supplied complete with general purpose labelling. • All other details as general specification.
Pesticide / Agrochemical Cabinets • • • • • • • •
General Storage Flat Top Bins
Finished in stove enamel red For the safety of the users the doors of the cabinets are fitted with louvre vents. This enables air to circulate freely dispersing any poisonous vapours which may have escaped from one of the stored containers Supplied with the currently approved labels to BS5378 and EEC directive 92/58 All other details as general specification.
Overall Size No of Shelf Depth Sump Doors Weight
General Price
Pesticide Model
kg
*483 x 458 x 765
1
38mm
14 litres Single
25 GSC01Z POA PSC01Z
POA
*483 x 458 x 915
1
38mm
14 litres Single
35 GSC02Z POA
POA
*306 x 610 x 610
1
24mm
12 litres Double 23 GSC03Z POA PSC03Z POA
*483 x 915 710
1
34mm
33 litres Double 45 GSC04Z POA PSC04Z
POA
*483 x 915 x 915
2
34mm
33 litres Double 55 GSC05Z POA PSC05Z
POA
483 x 915 x 1220
2
34mm
33 litres Double 65 GSC06Z POA PSC06Z
POA
483 x 915 x 1500
3
34mm
33 litres Double 80 GSC07Z POA PSC07Z
POA
483 x 915 x 1830
3
34mm
33 litres Double 100 GSC08Z POA
PSC08Z
POA
POA GSC09Z
PSC09Z
POA
PSC02Z
The base of each unit is fitted with skids to prevent deterioration. Finished in grey stove enamel and labelled to comply with current regulations.
Manufactured for the storage of flammable materials from 1.2mm sheet steel with all formed welded seams. The flanged lid is fitted with a hasp and staple for locking. Each unit is supplied with a removable 100 mm liquid tight drip tray for ease of cleaning.
D x L x H mm Shelves (as a tray) Capacity
* Floor stand (available for the 5 smallest sizes)
Model
• • • •
Price
Overall Size D x L x H mm 625 x 335 x 508 610 x 610 x 610 1220 x 610 x 610
Weight kg 32 34 70
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Model GSB10Z GSB20Z GSB30Z
Price POA POA POA
121
STORAGE HAZARDOUS STORAGE UNITS HAZARDOUS MATERIALS STORAGE CABINETS General Specification • Manufactured from 0.9mm sheet steel with formed and welded seams • Doors are fitted with vertical reinforcement panels to prevent distortion. • Produced with return flange around doors and joints to prevent the • passage of flame. • Fitted with security locks and two keys. • Removable galvanised, self Colour shelves and drip tray. • Shelves can be used as flush shelves or as a tray and are • adjustable to 75mm centres. • Meets requirements of COSHH Regulations • Locks and handles are all metal to eliminate melting under fire attack • Stove enamel yellow
HSC02Z
HSC08Z
HSC03Z
HAZARDOUS MATERIALS STORAGE CABINETS Designed for the safe storage of hazardous substances. Clearly identify the hazard, and meet the requirements of COSHH and other regulations.
Overall Size No of Doors Weight D x L x H mm Shelves kg Model 483 x 458 x 915 1 Single 27 HSC02Z 306 x 610 x 610 1 Double 18 HSC03Z 483 x 915 x 915 2 Double 50 HSC05Z 483 x 915 x 1830 3 Double 83 HSC08Z
122
Price POA POA POA POA
HSC05Z
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
CYLINDER STORAGE
STORAGE
GAS CYLINDER CAGES • Galvanised or Painted finish
• Provision for Padlock
• Complete with ‘Highly flammable’ sign • Usable distance between shelves - 720mm Frame manufactured in angle iron with sides, end and top infilled with metal strip. Base of inverted angle. These complete security cages have hinged lockable doors. Mobile models have a push handle at one end. All models to carry a maximum of 16 calor-gas type cylinders. Available with either stove enamel blue paint or galvanised finish.
GCC01N Description
Finish
Overall Dimensions
Static Unit Mobile Unit 2 fixed, 2 swivel
Internal Size Weight
Model
Price
80
GCC02Z
POA
x
80
GCC12G
POA
840
80
GCC01N
POA
80
GCC11G
POA
L x W x H mm
L x W mm
kg
Painted
1610 x 890 x 1800
1560
Galvanised
1610 x 940 x 1800
Painted
1690 x 890 x 1900
Galvanised
1690 x 940 x 1900
GCC12G
200mm Nylon
cylinder storage lock-up cages • Galvanised or Painted • Provision for Padlock • Permanently fixed or Pallet Based unit • Complete with ‘Highly flammable’ sign Frame is constructed in angle iron, infilled with tough iron mesh. The base is drilled for fixing points. The cylinders are held in position with a retaining chain. Available with either stove enamel blue paint or galvanised finish.
CP601Z
Overall Dimensions
Description
L x W x H mm
Cage only
1360 x 1095 x 1840
Cage with Pallet Base
Painted finish Model
Price
Galvanised finish Model
Price
CS501Z POA
CS511G
POA
1360 x 1095 x 1990
CP601Z
CP611G
Cage only
1360 x 1715 x 1840
CS502Z POA
CS512G
Cage with Pallet Base
1360 x 1715 x 1990
CP602Z
CP612G
POA
POA
POA POA POA
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
CS511G
123
STORAGE Wire Baskets Wire Baskets • For warehouse/bulk storage • The simplest & most effective way to display stock • Tough & durable, constructed from welded Steel wire with Plastic coating to prevent corrosion • Designed by engineers & built to withstand the rigours of harsh environments • Safe & stable, the interlocking design of these baskets ensures safe stacking • Plastic coating which protects the goods from scratches & other damage
• Open front containers which allow easy access to even bulky goods • 3 colour options available: Red
Green
Blue
• Finish: Durable Plasticcoating • Dividers available
External Size WxDxH mm 660 x 460 x 350 980 x 460 x 350 980 x 680 x 480 1220 x 680 x 480
124
Mesh Size mm
24 x 46
46 x 46
Weight kg
Cap. kg
Model
60
0.088
MT8
90
0.140
C12
0.300
C2DS
Model Divider
D1
120
D2 0.400
C4
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Retail Display Baskets DUMP BASKETS
DISPLAY BASKETS
• White Plastic coated
• Top quality build & finish • Bright Zinc finish • Space utilisation • Self stacking • Free standing
D2400
STORAGE
D1600
Description
• D2100: Round Dump Bin • D1600 & D2400: Square collapsible basket with adjustable base
475 x 300 x 250 475 x 400 x 250 Basket A 475 x 450 x 300 475 x 500 x 300 Plinth to Suit 475 x 500 580 x 300 x 250 580 x 400 x 250 Basket B 580 x 450 x 300 580 x 500 x 300 Plinth to Suit 580 x 500 980 x 300 x 250 980 x 400 x 250 Basket C 980 x 450 x 300 980 x 500 x 400 Plinth to Suit 980 x 500 Data Strip - 450L x 39H mm Data Strip - 550L x 39H mm Data Strip - 950L x 39H mm Hook On Price Tag1 20 x 40 Hook On Price Tag 165 x 80P EPOS Strip 980 x 60Colour Insert-
D2100
Overall Size W x D x H mm
Model
400 x 400 x 726
D1600
600 x 600 x 726
D2400
533 dia. x 635 height
D2100
Overall Size W x D x H mm
Model SB475-300 SB475-400 SB475-450 SB475-500 PLINTH-A SB580-300 SB580-400 SB580-450 SB580-500 PLINTH-B SB980-300 SB980-400 SB980-450 SB980-500 PLINTH-C
PPB PA -
SHOPPING BASKETS
Universal Plinth
Description
Overall Size W x D x H mm
Plastic Shopping Basket (Red, Blue or Green) 430 x 300 x 230
Model Code PSB4330
Wire Shopping Basket (Red, Blue or Green)
450 x 320 x 190
WSB4532
Plastic Trolley Basket (Red, Blue or Green)
460 x 350 x 400
PTB4635
Universal Plinth
-
UPSB
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
125
STORAGE FLOOR SLATS Floor slats – a good surface is important Our floor slats have a specially designed cushioned profile. This reduces the strain placed on the back and legs from constant standing. The slats can be combined and interlocked as you choose. Ramps and corners, for dolly and trolley traffic, are available. The slats withstand most chemicals, oils and weak acids and are suitable to use in temperatures between -10°C and +80°C.
Green 403
Blue 630
Orange 230
Item No.
External/mm
Weight/kg
Colour
Pallet unit
1200 x 600 x 25
4.0
Green, blue, orange
80
External/mm
Weight/kg
Colour
Carton unit
6401.500 Corner
112 x 112
0.1
Green, blue, orange
30
6401.400 Ramp
600 x 112
0.3
Green, blue, orange
30
External/mm
Weight/kg
Colour
Pallet unit
600 x 600 x 15
0.9
Beige, brown
220
6401.000 Floor slat
Item No.
Item No. 4500.000 Floor slat
Beige 340
Floor slat lightweight (4500) suitable for wet areas, changing rooms and lighter industrial environments.
126
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Brown 820
STORAGE
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
127
SIGNS & IDENTIFICATION
location labelling
• Design, manufacture and installation of code labelling • Custom printed to your design • Can include bar codes and colour coding • Free on-site consultations • Installed by our in-house team The management of a modern warehouse needs clear and precise identification that can be quickly and easily understood by all concerned. As specialists in the design, manufacture and installation of code labels we provide a cost effective solution to your labelling needs.
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628)
A wide variety of base materials are available for the manufacture of hard wearing code labels including: • Coloured Vinyl’s • Polypropylene • Over Laminated • Deep Freeze
128
• Magnetic • PVC • Styrene
Colour coding offers an additional quick check facility that the operator has picked the correct stock item.
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
STORES IDENTIFICATION
SIGNS & IDENTIFICATION
Magnetic Numbers and Letters • Magnetic tiles supplied on sheets as a combination of mixed alpha or numeric digits • Two tile heights, either 43mm with a 39mm high digit or 23mm with a 17mm high digit • Available with black digits on a white or yellow background. • Allows for fast and easy labelling on any steel surface
Ref
Tile (h)
Characters Per Sheet
Colour
M43MIXW/N
43mm
5 x (23456789) 9 x(1)10x(0)
White
M43MIXW/L
43mm
1 x (JKQWXY) 2 x (BCDFGHLMOPVZ) 3 x (AINRSTU) 4 x (E)
White
M23MIXW/N
23mm
9 x (9) 17 x (2345678) 9 x (1) 10 x (0)
White
M23MIXW/L
23mm
2 x (XY) 3 x (QW) 5 x (KP) 6 x (BHV) 7 x (DFGLU) 8 x (CMST) 9 x (R) 12 x (AO) 14 x (J) 21 x (E) 11 x (N)
White
M43MIXY/N
43mm
5 x (23456789) 9x(1) 10x (O)
Yellow
M43MIXY/L
43mm
1 x (JKQWXY) 2 x (BCDFGHLMOPVZ) 3 x (AINRSTU) 4 x (E)
Yellow
M23MIXY/N
23mm
9 x (9) 17 x (2345678) 9 x (1) 10 x (0)
Yellow
M23MIXY/N
23mm
2 x (XY) 3 x (QW) 5 x (KP) 6 x (BHV) 7 x (DFGLU) 8 x (CMST) 9 x (R) 12x(AO) 14x(J)21 x(E)11 x (N)
Yellow
Consecutive Number Tiles • Sets of high visibility self-adhesive labels from 01 through to 100, • Printed black on yellow
Ref
Size (hxw)
Pack
CN23
30 x 25 mm
100
CN50
50 x 50 mm
100
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
129
SIGNS & IDENTIFICATION
RACK holders
Self Adhesive and Magnetic Ticket Holder • Ideal for identifying locations on shelving and pallet racking • Pull-forward front allows easy loading and updates of information • Barcodes can be scanned without removing the insert • Pre-cut sizes from stock • Special sizes on request - up to 3M lengths With a choice of 4 heights this clear PVC strip is supplied with either an aggressive adhesive backing for permanent locations, or with a magnetic option which offers the flexibility to change locations and is suitable for cold storage applications.
Magnetic
Self adhesive Size (hxw)
Pack
Size (hxw)
Pack
•
TS210
25mm x 100mm
100
•
TS210M
25mm x 100mm
100
•
TS220
25mm x 200mm
50
•
TS220M
25mm x 200mm
50
•
TS25M/10
25mm x 1M
10
TS25M/20
25mm x 2M
10
Ref
•
130
Ref
TS25/10
25mm x 1M
10
TS25/20
25mm x 2M
10
TS25/60
25mm x 2M
30
•
TS310M
38mm x 100mm
100
TS25/100
25mm x 2M
50
•
TS320M
38mm x 200mm
50
TS25/250
25mm x 2M
125
•
TS38M/10
38mm x 1M
10
TS38M/20
38mm x 2M
10
•
TS310
38mm x 100mm
100
•
TS320
38mm x 200mm
50
•
TS510M
54mm x 100mm
100
•
TS38/10
38mm x 1M
10
•
TS520M
54mm x 200mm
50
TS38/20
38mm x 2M
10
•
TS54M/10
54mm x 1M
10
TS38/60
38mm x 2M
30
54mm x 2M
10
TS38/100
38mm x 2M
50
•
TS810M
80mm x 100mm
100
TS38/250
38mm x 2M
125
•
TS820M
80mm x 200mm
50
•
TS80M/10
80mm x 1M
10
TS80M/20
80mm x 2M
10
•
TS510
54mm x 100mm
100
•
TS520
54mm x 200mm
50
•
TS54/10
54mm x 1M
10
TS54/20
54mm x 2M
10
TS54/60
54mm x 2M
30
TS54/100
54mm x 2M
50
TS54/250
54mm x 2M
125
•
TS810
80mm x 100mm
100
•
TS820
80mm x 200mm
50
•
TS80/10
80mm x 1M
10
TS80/20
80mm x 2M
10
TS80/60
80mm x 2M
30
TS80/100
80mm x 2M
50
TS80/250
80mm x 2M
125
TS54M/20
Additional white card inserts are available for all of the above. Ref
Size (hxw)
Pack
TS210
25mm x 100mm
100
TS220
25mm x 200mm
50
TS250
25mm x 1000mm
10
TS310
38mm x 100mm
100
TS320
38mm x 200mm
50
TS350
38mm x 1000mm
10
TS510
54mm x 100mm
100
TS520
54mm x 200mm
50
TS550
54mm x 1000mm
10
TS810
80mm x 100mm
100
TS820
80mm x 200mm
50
TS850
80mm x 1000mm
10
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
LABEL holders
SIGNS & IDENTIFICATION
• Instant and highly visible identification • Easy to update and cut to size • Standard sizes supplied from stock Our magnetic and self-adhesive label holders are supplied from stock in pre-cut lengths but special sizes can be supplied on request. Each holder is supplied with white card inserts and a cover strip (Other colours available please specify). Pre-printed inserts can also be supplied for each of the holders incorporating barcodes and location codes. Please contact our sales office for further details.
Magnetic Label Holders
Magnetic are ideal for applications where regular changes are required, easier and quicker to move then adhesive backed holders. They are also suitable for use in cold stores.
Self-adhesive Label Holders
Self-adhesive offers a long term option of fixing label holders and more stability in environments where the labels need to be changed frequently. Also suits areas where magnetic holders may be accidentally knocked off by personnel or boxes/pallets.
Ref
Size (hxw)
Pack
Ref
Size (hxw)
Pack
ML18
15mm x 80mm
100
AL18
15mm x 80mm
100
ML28X
20mm x 80mm
100
AL38
30mm x 80mm
100
ML28
25mm x 80mm
100
AL58
50mm x 80mm
100
ML38
30mm x 80mm
100
AL1/10
15mm x 1M
10
ML48
40mm x 80mm
100
AL3/10
30mm x 1M
10
ML58
50mm x 80mm
100
AL5/10
50mm x 1M
10
ML150
15mm x 500mm
20
ML250X
20mm x 500mm
20
ML250
25mm x 500mm
20
ML350
30mm x 500mm
20
ML450
40mm x 500mm
20
ML550
50mm x 500mm
20
MLR1
15mm x 50M
1
MLR2X
20mm x 50M
1
MLR2
25mm x 50M
1
MLR3
30mm x 50M
1
MLR4
40mm x 50M
1
MLR5
50mm x 50M
1
card and PVC inserts
Additional card and PVC inserts are available for the label holders. Please specify the colour of the card and whether it is to be used with the self adhesive or magnetic holders. Size (hxw)
Pack
Card / PVC Ref
15mm x 80mm
100
LC18
20mm x 80mm
100
LC28X
25mm x 80mm
100
LC28
30mm x 80mm
100
LC38
40mm x 80mm
100
LC48
50mm x 80mm
100
LC58
15mm x 500mm
20
LC150
20mm x 500mm
20
LC250X
25mm x 500mm
20
LC250
30mm x 500mm
20
LC350
40mm x 500mm
20
LC450
50mm x 500mm
20
LC550
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
131
SIGNS & IDENTIFICATION DOCUMENTS POCKETS FRAMES4DOCS Frame any sign, chart ordocument in seconds Colour coded frames.Colours conform with British Safety Standards Self-adhesive or Magnetic fixings Ideal for displaying importantmessages in 5S & Lean Manufacturing Frames can be used verticallyor horizontally Suitable throughout industry todisplay all types of literature,certificates & information. Suitablefor documents up to 1.5mm thick colour options available Red
Green
Blue
Yellow
Black
Available as pack of the same colour or a mixed pack of 2 of each colours please specify when ordering
Self-adhesive frames have an aggressive adhesivethat has been selected to adhere to most surfaces Magnetic frames have a very strong pull force & can be applied to any flat Steel surface Offers 2 way viewing on glass surfaces
To Suit Documents
Quantity per Pack
A5 A4 A3
10
Magnetic Model MFD5/10 MFD4/10 MFD3/10
Self-Adhesive Model SFD5/10 SFD4/10 SFD3/10
DOCUMENT POCKETS
WRAP-A-ROUND POCKETS Three information pockets made from tough Plastic, with a Magnetic header that is designed to wrap around the meshof an industrial cage or trolley handle
Self-adhesive pockets have an aggressive tape on reverse for permanent fixing Magnetic pockets for Steel cabinets or racking & shelving Manufactured in tough clearPolypropylene with welded edges, providing ample room forA3, A4, A5, A6 & A7 documents Pockets supplied in packs of 10 except A7 size which is supplied in packs of 100 Overall Size H x W mm 316 x 436 436 x 316 215 x 310 310 x 220 155 x 230 215 x 160 110 x 155 150 x 110 60 x 110 110 x 110 110 x 220
132
Self-Adhesive Model AP3H/10 AP3V/10 AP4H/10 AP4V/10 AP5H/10 AP5V/10 AP6H/10 AP6V/10 AP7H/100 AP1111/10 AP1122/10
Magnetic Model MP3H/10 MP3V/10 MP4H/10 MP4V/10 MP5H/10 MP5V/10 MP6H/10 MP6V/10 MP7H/100 MP1111/10 MP1122/10
Size H x W mm 297 297 148 148 105 105
x x x x x x
210 210 210 210 210 210
Type A4 Vertical A5 Horizontal A6 Horizontal
Pack
Model
10 50 10 50 10 50
WRP4V/10 WRP4V/50 WRP5H/10 WRP5H/50 WRP6H/10 WRP6H/50
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
RACK IDENTIFICATION
SIGNS & IDENTIFICATION
Magnetic Easy Wipe Racking Strip • Write on - wipe off • Easily cut to size • Cost effective The magnetic easy wipe racking strip provides a fast and cost effective updating system for identifying product codes and stock level information, etc.
Ref
Size (hxw)
Pack
MSR1
10mm x 10M
1
MSR15
15mm x 10M
1
MSR2
20mm x 10M
1
MSR25
25mm x 10M
1
MSR3
30mm x 10M
1
MSR4
40mm x 10M
1
MSR5
50mm x 10M
1
MSR6
60mm x 10M
1
MSR7
70mm x 10M
1
MSR8
80mm x 10M
1
MSR9
90mm x 10M
1
MSR10
100mm x 10M
1
WET Wipe MARKERS PEN
Our black marker pens allow for easy updates and text can be wiped clean with a damp cloth Supplied in packs of 5 or 10. Ref
Colour
Pack
PB/5
Black
1
PB/10
Black
1
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628)
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
133
SIGNS & IDENTIFICATION AISLE & BAY Aisle Markers • Markers to identify aisles or bays • Supplied pre-drilled unless stated • Improves identification • Prices include printing of required characters up to the maximum allowed Our range of robust end of aisle identification markers are available in various sizes and designs for instant product and aisle locating. Suitable for use in the factory, warehouse or office environments.
AM2/2
AM3/3
AM4
AM1T
AM6
Custom made markers can also be produced to show company logos, various colours, different sizes and markers for external use, please contact our sales offices for further details. Ref
134
Size (hxw)
No of Characters
Colour
Fixing
AM1
95mm x 160mm
With up to 3
White/Yellow
Drilled 4 corners
AM1F
95mm x 130mm
With up to 3 each on side
White/Yellow
Self-adhesive
AM1FM
95mm x 130mm
With up to 3 each on side
White/Yellow
Magnetic
AM1T
95mm x 130mm x 130mm
With up to 3 each on side
White/Yellow
Self-adhesive
AM1TM
95mm x 130mm x 130mm
With up to 3 each on side
White/Yellow
Magnetic
AM2/1
220mm x 270mm
With 1 x 180mm
White/Yellow
Drilled 4 corners
AM2/2
220mm x 270mm
With 2 x 180mm
White/Yellow
Drilled 4 corners
AM3/1
220mm x 450mm
With 1 x 180mm
White/Yellow
Drilled 4 corners
AM3/2
220mm x 450mm
With 2 x 180mm
White/Yellow
Drilled 4 corners
AM3/3
220mm x 450mm
With 3 x 180mm
White/Yellow
Drilled 4 corners
AM3X/1
300mm x 300mm
With 1 x 180mm
White/Yellow
Drilled 4 corners
AM3X2
300mm x 300mm
With 2 x 180mm
White/Yellow
Drilled 4 corners
AM4
660mm x 343mm
With 1 x 180mm
Yellow
Drilled 4 corners
AM6/1
600mm x 600mm
With 1 x 180mm
White/Yellow
Drilled 4 corners
AM6/2
600mm x 600mm
With 2 x 180mm
White/Yellow
Drilled 4 corners
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
AM1F
AM1
AISLE & BAY
SIGNS & IDENTIFICATION
Bay Markers
• Clear Identification • Fixed or relocated in seconds • No drilling required Our high visibility bay and aisle markers offer clear identification throughout the warehouse. A formed aluminium section with either a magnetic or self-adhesive edge, enables the marker to be easily mounted onto steel racking without drilling. When locations need to be changed the magnetic marker can simply be lifted and relocated. High Visibility Black on Yellow vinyl characters for above. Specify letter or number and quantity required. Ref
Size (hxw)
F8
230mm x 140mm
Ref
Size (hxw)
Accommodates (per side)
Type
BA1
260mm x 167mm
One Character
Self-adhesive
BA2
260mm x 310mm
Two Characters
Self-adhesive
BM1
260mm x 167mm
One Character
Magnetic
BM2
260mm x 310mm
Two Characters
Magnetic
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
135
SIGNS & IDENTIFICATION WAREHOUSE Floor Lane Marking Tape • Tough, durable self-adhesive tapes • Highlights hazards or restricted areas • Easy to use applicator available Our range of lane marking tapes can be used to mark stairways, colour code walkways, workstation or storage areas within the stores and warehouses. Available in a range of colours, with general uses as follows: Black/yellow highlights general hazard areas and obstacles Red/white highlights fire protection equipment Green/white highlights medical stores/safety equipment Ref
Colour
Size (hxw)
Pack
LMT/B
Blue
50mm x 33mm
1
LMT/G
Green
50mm x 33mm
1
LMT/R
Red
50mm x 33mm
1
LMT/W
White
50mm x 33mm
1
LMT/Y
Yellow
50mm x 33mm
1
LMT/BY
Black/Yellow
50mm x 33mm
1
LMT/GW
Green/White
50mm x 33mm
1
LMT/RW
Red/White
50mm x 33mm
1
Lane Marking Applicator
• Easy to apply tapes without the necessity to bond down • Ensures accurate and quick delineation of areas Ref
Description
FTA1
Tape Applicator
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628)
136
Pallet Marker • Enables quick and easy identification of pallets • Adjustable fit • Water, grease and oil resistant Identifying stock on pallets has always been a problem. Our Pallet Marker is designed to fit securely around the corner upright of a Euro pallet, yet will adjust to fit most other pallets. Manufactured in flexible white PVC, this unique Pallet Marker can be written on with a marker pen, or labels can be adhered to the smooth surface Ref
Size
Pack
PM/50
75 x 470mm
50
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
FLOOR IDENtification
SIGNS & IDENTIFICATION
Floor Signalling • A simple but effective solution for marking areas on the warehouse floor • Tough PVC with an aggressive adhesive • Capable of withstanding everyday traffic of a fully operational warehouse A range of inexpensive high visibility yellow signals to highlight walkways, fork truck routes and pallet positions on the warehouse floor. The range includes circles for walkways, directional arrows as route markers to indicate traffic flow. L’ shape corner for marking out block stack pallet areas, T for between pallets and a ‘+’ for centre pallet positions.
Floor Location Labels
Ref
Size (hxw)
Pack
FS/+
300mm x 300mm
10
FS/T
200mm x 300mm
10
FS/L
200mm x 200mm
10
FS/O
90mm x 300mm
100
FS/A
300mm x 300mm
100
To obtain a price please simply provide the following information: size, colour,
text, any barcodes or graphics and quantity to contact@loc8.ae • High visibility location labels • Designed totally to your specification • Can include alpha, numerics, graphics and barcodes Our high visibility floor location labels are suitable to identify areas of the warehouse or factory floor. The labels can be totally customised for identification of pallet positions, item numbers and any specific area such as packing and quarantine areas, etc. Printed to your design with black text on either a white or yellow background. The labels have an aggressive self-adhesive backing to withstand the everyday traffic in the workplace.
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
137
SIGNS & IDENTIFICATION FLOOR IDENTIFICATION
Floor Graphic Markers
Ref
Dimensions
FM01 - FM15
430mm • Hi-visibility graphic floor signs • Designed to highlight warnings or special requirements • Independently tested for slip resistance • Each sign is 430mm diameter Each of the highly visible markers are printed onto the underside of a clear PVC film and then laminated on the back surface with an aggressive permanent adhesive. They are suitable for use on dry, clean, flat se’aled surfaces and although designed for the floor, the markers can be used on walls or anywhere a tough permanent sign is required.
Floor Identification Markers A-Z or 0-9 • Hi-visibility floor markers • Designed to identify aisle, bay or other warehouse floor areas • Each marker is 190mm diameter Manufactured to the same high standards as our graphic markers these 190mm diameter floor markers are printed with a bold black alpha or numeric digit of your choice on a yellow background. They are suitable for use on dry, clean flat sealed surfaces and have been independently tested for slip resistance, performing well in all conditions.
138
Ref
Dimensions
FMC/ - (State digit)
190mm
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
EXTERNAL
SIGNS & IDENTIFICATION TRAFFIC SIGNS
The signs are available either as ground mounted or even wall mounted. Used extensively in the car parking areas of major Hotels and Malls, These signs are manufactured with a strong visual appeal. Functional, sleek and durable. These traffic signs effectively serve the purpose they are intended to.
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628)
SAFETY SIGNS
Our range includes different materials like brass, stainless steel. Aluminium or glass. These can be wall mounted, ceiling suspended or simply projected. Using SPD’s stainless steel components gives these internal signs a look of style, elegance and functionality.
HEALTH CARE SIGNS
These white on green signs are associated with ‘Green for Go’. They are used to show the way to safety in time of emergency.
SPDHC 007
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
139
SIGNS & IDENTIFICATION
LINE MARKING / CODING
Line Marking Tape Easyline® Line Marking Tape is a highly visible, hard-wearing PVC film that can be used to create internal demarcation lines. Available in a range of colours (50mm width) it is suitable for use on a vast range of internal floors and produces up to 33 metres of a line from a single roll. The tape can be easily applied using the Easyline® Line Marking Tape Applicator. Features and Benefits • Manufactured from a hard wearing PVC film
which produces highly durable, conformable
bright lines.
• Available in a range of solid colours and
stripes to meet all your demarcation line
requirements.
• The Easyline® Line Marking Tape Applicator
enables demarcation lines to be created quickly
and easily with negligible down-time.
• Can be removed in minimum time and with
minimum effort enabling re-routing of
demarcation lines.
Line Marking Paint Easyline® Line Marking Paint is a two component, water based epoxy, suitable for application by hand using a brush or roller. It produces up to 150 metres of a low odour, solvent free paint line. Easyline® Line Marking Paint is extremely durable and chemical resistant, making it suitable for both indoor and outdoor application. It is ideal for providing durable, high quality sight lines on steps and demarcation lines in factories, warehouses and car parks. Easyline® Line Marking Paint is suitable for use on concrete, tarmac, metal and timber. Features and Benefits • A two part epoxy paint which provides superior
durability and chemical resistance.
• Suitable for use in heavy traffic areas with a life
expectancy of up to three years.
• A water based, low odour paint which is solvent free and
can be applied directly onto damp substrates. Suitable for
use in solvent sensitive areas (e.g. food processing).
• A usable life of two hours once mixed, ensures that a
150 metre long, 50mm wide line can be painted in one
application.
• Available in white or yellow and suitable for both
internal and external concrete, tarmac, metal or timber.
Available in 8 colours Caution / Hazard
General Marking
Danger / Prohibited
Information / Direction
Mandatory / Protection
Physical Hazard
Fire Protection Equipment
Safety Hazard
140
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628)
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
SIGNS & IDENTIFICATION
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
141
Industrial Partitioning DOUBLE SKIN PARTITIONS Excalibur Ideal for offices, facility areas, machine enclosures etc, where sound reduction and insulation are important. Options: • • • •
Fire Rating Double Glazing Ceilings Venetian Blinds
Spec ific for p prices r are a ojects upon vailable call request, 800LOC 8
Standard Powder Coated Colours: • Sandstone • Medium Grey • Light Grey • White
142
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
MESH PARTITIONS
Industrial Partitioning
Scimitar A necessity for all storage and security applications where mesh walls and ceilings are required. AVAILABLE OPTIONS
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628)
• Powder coated or galvanised finish • Hinged or sliding doors • Variety of locking arrangements (AMF Eurofile; lock barrel; padlock)
ces pri ific jects c e Sp r pro lable fo avai est, u are n req OC8 L upo 800l cal
*Only applicable for standard Grey RAL 7037 finish and a nominal 2200mm standard height.
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
143
WASTE MANAGEMENT waste receptacles
144
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Litter bins
WASTE MANAGEMENT
push flap bin •
Manufactured in Zintec Steel & powder coated in different colours:
•
Lift-off top assembly incorporates a lightly sprung flap
•
Optional easy lift-out Galvanised liner available- Call for Details
•
Self closing swivel top prevents a fire by excluding the air flow
Blue
Green
Cream
Yellow
White
Grey
SWIVEL TOP BIN •
Body & lift-off top assembly, manufactured in bright polished Stainless Steel or Zintec powder coated Blue
Green
Cream
Silver
White
Grey
•
Optional easy lift-out Galvanised liner available- Call for
•
Details Self closing swivel top prevents a fire by excluding the air flow Description Push Flap Bin Swivel Top Bin Swivel Top Bin Stainless Steel
Capacity Litres 54 60 51 60 51 60
Complete With With Liner Without Liner With Liner Without Liner With Liner Without Liner
SACK HOLDER
Size D x H mm
Model 555PFL 555PF 882L 882 882SSL 882SS
310 x 895 360 x 720 360 x 720
CHROME STEEL BIN
•
Enclosed sack holder solid body
•
Steel construction - pedal operated
•
Dome top litter bin, lift-off top, incorporates a large sprung flap
•
VARIOUS COLOURS AVAILABLE CALL FOR DETAILS
Moulded plastic location ring to keep the bag in place
SWING TOP BIN
SHSB Description Sack Holder Swing Top Bin6
555 ST
•
Fire Retardant
•
Zintec Steel & powder coated
•
Easy swing lid
•
Optional Steel liner
Capacity Litres 70 0
Overall Size W x D x H mm 410 x 230 x 820 310 x 310 x 895
Model
Capacity Litres 50
SHSB 555 ST
Overall Size D x H mm 405 x 832
Model 3385
litter bin
MESH BIN
REFUSE SACKS
•
• •
• • •
• •
Optional Galvanised Metal liner & powder coated in a range of colours- Call for Details Manufactured in zintec Steel An easy to use hingedlid top
•
Supplied with fixing kit
•
Pack of 2
Capacity Litres 20
Overall Size W x D x H mm 395 x 190 x 480
Model 464T
Silver powdercoated Pack of 12
Capacity Litres
Size D x H mm
Model
18
295 x 350
WLB 290
In a wide range of colours Liner bags Heavy duty, clinical waste, sack holder & clear recycled bags available
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Model SACK/C
145
WASTE MANAGEMENT Bins & Containers WASTE BINS • Hygienic wipe-clean Plastic • Push flap opening with clear lettering & directional arrow • Ideal for use in kitchens, offices,shops, warehouses etc
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628)
Capacity Litres 20
Overall Size L x W x H mm 355 x 255 x 500
Weight kg 1.2
50
430 x 310 x 600
2
RCY43Z
60
455 x 320 x 750
2.5
RCY57Z
Model
RCY57Z
RCY43Z
RCY29Z
RCY29Z
‘TIDY’ CONTAINERS • Built in handles for easy lifting • Hygienic wipe-clean pale Grey Plastic • Optional bag turns a bin into a janitorial trolley
GIT893, GID812, GIB811 & GIL861
GID812 GIT893 & GIL861
GIT893, GID812 & GIL861 Capacity Litres 37 76 120 167
External Size Dia. x H mm 400 500 560 610
x x x x
Weight kg
430 580 820 930
1.5 3 8.5 13.5
Container Model GIT843 GIT858 GIT882 GIT893
SWING LID DUSTBINS
Lid To Suit Model GIL840 GIL850 GIL856 GIL861
Dolly To Suit Model -
Bag Model GIB811
GID812
HALF ROUND HEAD BINS • Hygienic wipe-clean pale Grey Plastic
• Hygienic wipe-cleanpale Grey Plastic • Push flap opening with clear lettering & directional arrow
GIH808
146
GI5831 Capacity Litres 30
External Size L x W x H mm 380 x 280 x 510
42
430 x 300 x 660
GI5832 Weight kg 1.5 2
GI5832
Capacity Litres 60
External Size Dia x H mm 510 x 800
Weight kg 3
GIH808
GI5831
100
580 x 900
3.5
GIH807
Model
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Model
Litter bins
WASTE MANAGEMENT
STUDLEY RANGE
SIGMA RANGE
• Solid, high quality, fire retardant,retreated Steel construction • 4 standard Lid Colour Options available:
• Stainless Steel construction witha painted Galvanised Steel liner • 4 standard Liner Colour Options available:
Blue
Green
Red
Yellow Blue
• Other lid colours available upon request
Black
Red
Yellow
• Other liner colours available upon request
Capacity Litres
Overall Size H x Dia. mm
Model
30
610 x 245
374
60
710 x 340
544
90
750 x 390
644
120
780 x 440
701
Capacity Litres
Overall Size H x Dia. mm
Model
Double Liner Recycling Bin 2 x 45 Liners
750 x 390
644RC/DB
Triple Liner Recycling Bin 2 x 22 & 1 x 45 Liners
750 x 390
644RC/TR
ERA RANGE
RECYCLING BINS
• Slim-line & stylish construction with either a Stainless Steel or painted Zintec body • 6 standard Body/Lid Colour Options available:
• Self-closing, fire retardant binsmanufactured in Zintec Steel • Available in a choice of colours & supplied with wrap logo on the flap only. Wording & artworkis an optional extra - Call for Details
Blue
Black
Red
Yellow
Grey
Green
• Other body/lid colours available upon request • Lid graphics are available - Call for Details
Capacity Litres
Overall Size H x L x W mm
Painted Zintec Body Model
Stainless Steel Body Model
860 x 290 x 260
ERA-60
ERA-SS-60
Capacity Litres
Overall Size H x L x W mm
Single Unit
60
Model
Model
100
860 x 385 x 260
ERA-100
ERA-SS-100
60
895 x 310 x 310
555PF/RC1
555PF/RC4
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Set of 4 Units
147
WASTE MANAGEMENTOffice Recycling Bins INTERNAL
D
THE ENVIROBIN RANGE
A
C B The Envirobin ‘Family’ range of recycling bins has capacities which range from a compact 55 litres to a generous 140 litres
A
C
ENVIROBIN 100
• Capacity: 100 Litres • Size: 448W x 448D x 807H mm • Liner: Sack retention • Labels: Choice of WRAP compliant lids & labels • Colour: Warm Grey body Type
Colour
Model
Plastic
Red
81155/1041
Cans
Grey
81155/1021
MIDI ENVIROBIN
• Capacity: 82 Litres • Size: 302W x 541D x 866H mm • Liner: Sack retention • Labels: Choice of WRAP compliant lids & labels • Colour: Warm Grey body
Type
Colour
Model
Plastic
Red
81720/11/81 81720/11/62
Paper
Blue
81155/1000
Cans
Grey
General
White
81155/1202
Paper
Blue
81720/1/11
Mixed
Lime Green
81155/1060
General
White
81720/21/04
Split
Please Specify
81155/2001
Mixed
Lime Green
81720/51/80
B
MINI ENVIROBIN
• Capacity: 55 Litres • Size: 302W x 523D x 660H mm • Liner: Sack retention • Labels: Choice of WRAP compliant lids & labels • Colour: Warm Grey body Type
148
CAVALIER - CATERING BINS
D
Maxi ENVIROBIN
• Capacity: 140 Litres • Size: 550W x 615D x 1220H mm • Liner: Sack retention • Labels: Choice of WRAP compliant lids & labels • Colour: Warm Grey body
Colour
Model
Type
Plastic
Red
81691/11/81
Cans
Grey
81691/11/62
Paper
Blue
General Mixed
Colour
Model
Plastic
Red
81692/21/81
Cans
Grey
81692/21/62
81691/1/11
Paper
Blue
81692/1/11
White
81691/21/04
General
White
81692/1/04
Lime Green
81691/41/80
Mixed
Lime Green
81692/61/80
• Heavy Duty & Robust • Suitable for Catering applications • Capacity: 100 Litres • Liner: Sack Retention • Choice of colours.(see chart below) Overall Size W x D x H mm 448 x 448 x 899
COLOURS
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Model 81155/1
Recycling Bins
WASTE MANAGEMENT
CONFIDENTIAL RECYCLING BIN
polo triple recycling bin
• Manufactured in Zintec Steel • Self closing, fire retardant Metal bins • Large, lightly sprung flap for ease of use • Available with easy lift Galvanised liner,self-adhesive wording & lock- Call for Details
• Robust construction, manufactured in powder coated Zintec Steel • Self closing, fire retardant metal bins • Security Triangle LockUnique Bag Tidy Rings • Tops in any colour & recycling logo- Call for Details
Description Push Bin Recycling Bin
Capacity Litres
Overall Size W x D x H mm
60
310 x 310 x 895
With Lock
Model 555PF 555CB 555CB/K
Capacity Litres 270
Overall Size W x D x H mm 1120 x 420 x 810
Model POLOTRIPLE
RECYCLING CENTRE
RECYCLING CENTRE
• Fire retardant metal bins • Manufactured in Zintec Steel • For paper, general waste & cans/bottles • Available with easy lift Galvanised liner &self-adhesive wording - Call for Details • Other colours available- Call for Details • Supplied as a set of 3 - singles available
• Manufactured in Zintec Steel with Stainless Steel tops • Separate your waste prior to disposal • For paper, general waste & cans/bottles • Galvanised liner included • Self-adhesive wording- Call for Details • Supplied as a set of 3 - singles available
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628)
Description Without Liner With Liner
Capacity Litres 60
Overall Size W x D x H mm
Model
310 x 310 x 895
555 RCT 555 RCTL
Capacity Litres 120
Overall Size Dia. x H mm 455 x 760
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Model 701 REC
149
WASTE MANAGEMENT Recycling Bins RECYCLING PEDAL BINS
RECYCLING CENTRE BINS - SET OF 3
• Recycling centre ideal for office & industrial use • Stainless Steel casing & Plastic pedal bin lids make these bins easy to clean & hygienic • Removable Plasticinners for easy cleaning
• Supplied as a set of 3 bins • Suitable for Paper, Plastic & Can/Tin waste • Manufactured from Steel
RCJ30Z
Compartments 23 34
Capacity Litres 04 5
Overall Size L x W x H mm 10 x 340 x 485
Weight kg 4.5
RCJ30Z
605 x 340 x 485
6.4
RCJ45Z
Model
Overall Size Top Ø x Capacity Weight Litres each Bottom Ø x H mm each kg each 8 49 390 x 320 x 580
RCJ49Z
RECYCLING BINS - SET OF 3
RECYCLING BINS - SET OF 3
• Manufactured from 100% recycled material • Supplied as a set of 3 complete with 5 stickers: General Waste (White), Paper (Blue), Plastic (Red), Food & Drinks Cans (Dk Grey) & Glass (Green) Simply select the ones you want to use • Hygienic wipe-clean Plastic
• Supplied as a set of 3 complete with 5 stickers: General Waste (White), Paper (Blue), Plastic (Red), Food & Drinks Cans (Dk Grey) & Glass (Green)Simply select the ones you want to use • Ideal for offices, warehouses & factories etc • Hygienic wipe-clean Plastic
Set of 3 RCY63Z
Set of 3 RCY33Z
Capacity Litres each 30
150
Model
Overall Size L x W x H mm each 430 x 310 x 600
Weight kg each 1.75
Model RCY33Z
Capacity Litres each 60
Overall Size L x W x H mm each 320 x 455 x 800
Weight kg each 2.75
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Model RCY63Z
External Banks & Bins
WASTE MANAGEMENT
ECO options, look out for the ‘recycled logo’ below which means that the bin liner has been manufactured using recycled Plastic materials. Plus choose our 100% recycled Black colour to cut down on virgin material usage
A
A D
HERITAGE
• Capacity: 100 Litres • Liner: Recycled Plastic • Stability: Integral ballast filling or ground fixing
B
Overall Size H x Dia mm
Model
1072 x 570
81440/2
METRO
C
• Size Midi: 965H x 460 dia. mm • Size Maxi: 1025H x 575 dia. mm • Stability: Integral ballast filling or ground fixing Item
Model
Midi - 84 Litres
85053/1
Maxi - 120 Litres
85054/1
E
• Capacity: 100 Litres • Liner: Galvanised Steel • Stability: Integral ballast filling or ground fixing Overall Size H x Dia mm
Model
1082 x 547
81495/2
CONSORT
• Capacity: 100 Litres • Liner: Recycled Plastic • Stability: Integral ballast filling or ground fixing Overall Size H x Dia mm
Model
1075 x 560
81192/2
H
H
OCTAPLUS
F A
HIPPO
• Liner: Steel • Stability:Integral ballast filling or ground fixing
F
MONARCH
• Capacity: 96 Litres • Liner: Recycled Plastic • Stability: Integral ballast filling or ground fixing Item
Model
Free Standing Model
80836/3
Decorative Mounting
85037/5
VARIOUS COLOURS AVAILABLE CALL FOR DETAILS
• 30L: 395W x 235D x 525H mm • 50L: 430W x 290D x 645H mm • Liner: Galvanised Steel • Including fixings but no post or banding Capacity
Model
30 Litres
85700/1
50 Litres
85701/1
Model
1100 x 700
86050/1
ECO PIONEER
G
• Capacity: 130 Litres • Size: 1170H x 680W mm • Liner: Galvanised Steel • Stability: Integral ballast filling or ground fixing Item
Colour
Model
ECO Pioneer Recycle
Lime Green & Black
81485/32
ECO Pioneer Litter
Black
81485/1
I
REGENT OPEN
Overall Size H x Dia mm
REGENT HOODED
• Size: 440W x 320D x 760H mm • Liner: Polyethylene Sack • Including fixings but no post or banding
I
Capacity
Model
50 Litres
87003/1
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
151
WASTE MANAGEMENTExternal Litter Bins OUTDOOR OPEN TOP LITTER BINS • Capacity: 75 Litres • Open top bin range which has a smooth easy to clean surface • Comes complete with Zinc coated liner, lock & base • 4 Colour Options Available: Blue
Black
Red
Yellow
• Optional Concrete ballast base orfloor fixings are available - seebelow for details
SOC75Z
Overall Size H x dia. mm
Description Coloured Bin
745 x 485
Victorian Bin
SOV75Z
Model SOC75Z SOV75Z
Fixing Plate & 4 Fixing Bolts
-
SOF75Z
Concrete Ballast Base
-
SCB75Z
SOC75Z
OUTDOOR HOODED TOP LITTER BINS
SHB75Z
SHV75Z
• Capacity: 75 Litres • Hooded bin range which has a smooth easy to clean surface & prevents ingress of rainwater • Comes complete with liner, lock & base. The body is removable for easy cleaning • 4 Colour Options Available:
SHB75Z
Overall Size H x dia. mm
Description Coloured Bin
1000 x 485
Victorian Bin
152
Model SHB75Z SHV75Z
Fixing Plate & 4 Fixing Bolts
-
SHF75Z
Concrete Ballast Base
-
SHC75Z
Blue
Black
Red
Yellow
• Floor fixings are available - see table for details
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
SKIP TRUCKS
WASTE MANAGEMENT
Heavy Duty Industrial Waste Truck SK206Y
• Load Capacity: 300 kg • Fitted as standard with a DEFLECTOR panel at the base of the waste truck to allow gradual safe and controlled emptying. This heavy duty, sturdy waste truck is fitted with 6 x 4" Nylon Swivel Castors for mobility whilst also being fork liftable under the handles. It features a hinged drop away base for easy emptying and can be supplied with a rodent-proof lid.
SK206Y
Overall Overall height mm width mm
Internal Load Bin height Capacity x width mm
Weight
Model
Price
1210 x 720
100 kg
SK206Y
POA
17 kg
SK206Z
POA
1460
1150
0.8 cu m
Lid for above
Tilting Skip • Maximum Load Capacity: 300kg Chassis produced from welded square hollow sections, fitted to a sheet steel body with reinforced edges. The body has a tubular steel handle to aid the manoeuvring and safe tipping of the skip. Safety catch avoids accidental tipping of the body. Paint finish Blue.
Swarf Skip SK202Y • Maximum Load Capacity: 300kg Manufactured to the same specification as the tilting skip SK201Y but produced with an internal drain. Liquid contents can be drained off through the waste pipe at the base of the unit and solid waste can then be tipped away by the use of the tilting body facility.
SK201Y
Overall Size Weight Wheels Description Capacity Model Price L x W x H mm kg mm 2 x Swivel 150 mm Tilting Skip 1350 80 SK201Y POA Cushion Tyred Castors x 930 .49 cu m 2 x 200 mm Cushion Swarf Skip x 1105 82 SK202Y POA Tyred roller bearing Wheels
Side Emptying Skip • Four way entry fork pockets. • Load Capacity of 400 kg (0.3 cum) • Fully Welded Construction. This side emptying skip is capable of tipping its contents from either side. The balanced tipping action is engaged by the use of a foot operated release mechanism and incorporates a dampening system for controlled emptying. SK204Y
Overall dim L x W x H mm
SK204Y
Internal dim L x W x D mm
Weight kg
Wheels mm
2 fixed 2 swivel 1335 x 800 x 1110 1000 x 750 x 600 78 125 mm Nylon wheels
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Model Price SK204Y
POA
153
WASTE MANAGEMENTSKIP TRUCKS fork guide. 1⁄2 Cubic metre - side entry 1 Cubic metre - back entry
TILTING SKIP/TRUCK • Extremely Robust
r wide For a tion, c sele -LOC8 800 call
• Safe • Including Fork Pockets Chassis of all welded construction from heavy gauge steel. Skips of all welded construction from 12 gauge. Skip top press formed for additional rigidity and safety giving no sharp edges. The unit is fitted with a positive skip lock mechanism. Unit fitted with integral sideguards as standard, which totally encloses tip skid. The skip truck has fork lift pockets fitted as standard, complete with retaining bars. Ideal for handling swarf or any waste materials safely.
Mobile model SK101Y
1 Load Capacity: ⁄2 Cubic Metre / 300 kg Overall Body Size Wheels Height mm Length 1220 mm Width 600 mm 1115 Height 700 mm 1080
Weight
Model
Price
2 fixed 160 mm Nylon 2 swivel 160 mm Nylon
85 kg
SK101Y
POA
—
85 kg
SK103Z
POA
Weight
Model
Price
2 fixed 200 mm Nylon 2 swivel 200 mm Nylon
116 kg
SK102Y
POA
—
116 kg
SK104Z
POA
Load Capacity: 1 Cubic Metre / 500 kg Overall Body Size Wheels Height mm Length 1220 mm Width 1200 mm 1150 Height 700 mm 1080
Static Model SK104Z
FRONT EMPTYING SKIP
• Sturdy Robust Construction • Including Fork Pockets • Load Easily Discharged • Stackable — 2 High. Chassis welded from heavy gauge construction. Highly adaptable, each load can easily be discharged. The front emptying action allows discharging without the operator leaving vehicle. Auto release built into base for emptying into a larger skip. Load Capacity: 1 Cubic Metre / 500 kg Internal Skip Size L x W x H mm
154
1420 x 1320 x 1020
Overall Size Weight L x W x H mm kg
Nylon Wheels mm
1600 x 1500 130 x 1260
2 fixed 152 2 swivel 152
Model
Price
SK105Y
POA
SK105Y
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
HYGIENE TROLLEYS
WASTE MANAGEMENT JANITORIAL CLEANING TROLLEY Manufactured from durable plastic this janitorial trolley is available in either blue or grey. Fitted with 2 x 200 mm wheels at the back and 2 x 75 mm swivel castors at the front. Complete with a strong yellow PVC sack.
HI318Y Description Janitorial Trolley Blue
HI308Y
Janitorial Trolley Grey
Overall Size Shelf Load Weight Model Price L x W x H mm Heights Capacity 1140 x 500 x 972
580, 100 kg 9 kg 970mm
HI308Y
POA
HI318Y
POA
MH102Z
MH101Z HI101Y
HI102Y
MOPPING TROLLEYS
The lightweight aluminium mop handle is suitable for both mops. The mops are made from 70% cotton, 30% polyester to ensure maximum absorption and long life.
A range of 4 mopping trolleys suitable for heavy duty use. Fitted with 4 x 75 mm swivel wheels and a heavy duty plastic wringer. Models HI102Y and HI202Y have plastic corner buffers for added protection. Models HI201Y and HI202Y have two buckets which sit within a frame. The frame on these two units has a push handle making the unit easily manoeuvrable. Model HI101Y HI102Y HI201Y HI202Y
Overall Size (excluding Handle) L x W x H mm 480 x 285 x 560 680 x 410 x 720 540 x 440 x 670 840 x 430 x 700
Load Capacity 20 litre 36 litre 36 litre 60 litre
Weight kg
Price
5 kg 8 kg 7 kg 13 kg
POA POA POA POA
MHD24Z
HI201Y
Description
Model
Mop Handle
MHD24Z
1250 mm long Mops MH101Z Pack of 10
HI202Y
Mops MH102Z Pack of 10 CAUTION BOARDS • Supplied in packs of any 2 - Please specify when ordering • Fold flat for storage • Overall Size (open) H x W x D mm 610 x 310 x 340 These double sided caution signs are lightweight and easy to use. Designed for use in areas where a hazard or restriction exists.
Description
‘Out of Service’
Model
Price
CB001Z POA
‘Repair In Progress’ CB002Z POA ‘Cleaning in Progress’ CB003Z POA ‘No Entry’ CB002Z
CB004Z
CB001Z
CB003Z
CB004Z POA
‘Caution Wet Floor’ CB005Z POA
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
155
WASTE MANAGEMENTSPILL CONTROL & CONTAINMENT Fork Lift Chemical Kit (with drain cover) & Fork truck Oil & Fuel Kit (with drain cover)
Emergemcy Spill Kits Handy Battery Acid Kits & Handy Oil & Fuel Kits • 20 Litre Capacity • Contains socks, pads, disposal bag and instruction card • Model CSK 2 ideal for battery recharge areas and fork trucks • Model OSK 2 ideal for fork trucks and oil fuel storage areas
• 45 Litre Capacity • Contains socks, pads, disposal bag, drain cover and instruction card • Model CSK 4 ideal for battery recharge areas and fork trucks • Model OSK 4 ideal for fork trucks and oil fuel storage areas
OSK2
CSK4
OSK2
CSK2
Description
Description
Model
Model
Handy Battery Acid Kit
CSK2
Fork Lift Chemical kit - with drain cover
CSK4
Handy Oil & Fuel Kit
OSK2
Fork Lift Oil & Fuel Kit - with drain cover
OSK4
Large Chemical Spill Kit
OSK9
Fuel Bowser/Bulk Tank Kit with drain Cover
OSKM
• 90 Litre Capacity
• 255 Litre Oil and Fuel kit
• Contains socks, pads, disposal bag
• Contains socks, pads, disposal bag, drain cover and instruction card
and instruction card • Ideal for battery recharge areas
Description Model Large Chemical CSK9 Spill Kit
• Ideal for bulk oil and fuel storage areas
Price
Description Model Fuel Bowser/ OSKM Bulk Tank kit with drain cover
Drum Storage & Containment Products 619SO Containment Floor Tiles
• Interlocking floor tiles • Each tile 50cm square • 8 tiles per box • Each tile can contain 2.5 litres of spill Description
Model
Containment Floor Tiles
619SO
DT95/619S2
BJS00
WSA07
25 Litre Container Tray
IBC Containment Pallet
Two Drum Spill Pallet
Four Drum Spill Pallet
• Useful 65 Litre Capacity
• Compliant 1100 litre capacity
• Compliant 225 litre capacity
• Compliant 240 litre capacity
• Can store up to 5 x 25 litre
• Size 1850 x 1850 x 660mm
• Size 1300 x 800 x 380mm
• Size 1300 x 1300 x 280mm
• Compatible with most chemicals
• Can store up to two 205 litre drums
• Can store up to four 205 litre drums
• Compatible with most chemicals
• Compatible with most chemicals
containers • Compatible with most chemicals • Size 1000 x 550 x 150mm Description Model 25 Litre container tray DT95/619S2
156
QS00
Price
Description IBC Containment pallet
Model BJS00
Price
Description Two Drum Spill pallet
Model QS000
Price
Description Four drum Spill pallet
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Model WSA07
Price
UNIVERsAL ABSORBENT
WASTE MANAGEMENT
Absorbent Rolls & Dispenser Stands • Available in four widths • Durable metal construction • Floor standing or wall mounted • Rolls are double weight, perforated, quality absorbent with low lint finish
AWRD/50
Description
Model AWRD/38 AFRD/38 GRS38/TP AWRD/50 AFRD/50 GT150/TP AWRD/76 AFRD/76 GRS76 AWRD/100 AFRD100 GRSW
380mm Wall Stand 380mm Floor Stand Twin Pack of 380mm Rolls 500mm Wall Stand 500mm Floor Stand Twin Pack of 50cm Rolls 760mm Wall Stand 760mm Floor Stand 760mm Roll 1000mm Wall Stand 1000mm Floor Stand 1000mm Roll
AFRD/50
Absorbent Socks (Mini Booms) • Two lengths available • Brilliant absorbent capacity • Ideal for water and oil leaks and spills
Loose Wood Fibre Absorbent • Can be used as a dispenser • Can be used as a drip pan • Massive 14 litre capacity • Supplied in a case of three • Leight weight and easy to use
GS20
LW14/T
Description
Model
Loose Wood Fibre Absorbent LW14/T
GP25
AWRD/76
• Flexible Sock fits snugly around machine • GS20 and GS08 supplied in a durable dispenser box • Can be incinerated GS16
Descrition
Model
Price
Box of 20 x 1200mm Socks Bulk Box of 40 x 1200mm Socks Box of 8 x 3000mm Socks Bulk Box of 16 x 3000mm Socks
GS20 GS40 GS08 GS16
£39.00 £75.00 £39.00 £75.00
GB100
GRS38/24
Dispenser Pack of Universal Pads
Bulk Pack of Universal Pads
Four-way Rip & Place Roll
• 25 Quality double weight pads
• Multiuse double weight roll
• Pre cut & perforated 1 litre pads
•V alue pack of 100 double weight precut and perforated pads
• Suitable for oils, fuels & mild liquids
• Suitable for oils, fuels & mild liquids
• Fully perforated 24 meter roll
• Supplied in a durable dispenser box
• Supplied polywrapped
• Supplied in a portable dispenser box
Description Dispenser Pack of Universal Pads
Model
Price
GP25
£17.00
Description
Model
Bulk Pack of Universal Pads
GB100 £57.00
Price
• Use as a pad, roll or wiper
Description Four-way Rip & Place Roll
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Model
Price
GRS38/24 £29.00
157
WASTE MANAGEMENT RACK SACK RACK SACK • Easy collection of warehouse waste • Helps waste segregation • Simple fixing and trouble-free handling • Reusable Available Designs • General Waste • Mixed Paper & Card • Plastic Only
The problem of managing warehouse waste is easily and quickly disposed of by hanging the new Beaverswood ‘racksack’ to the end frames around the warehouse. The ‘racksack’ fixes neatly onto most racking and shelving systems that are between 900mm to 1100mm deep by means of two strong ‘S’ locators. The locators simply hook into the holes of the side profile of the end frames and allow the sack to be quickly removed and emptied. (Locators are supplied) The ‘racksack’ is made from tough woven polypropylene that will withstand the rigours of a modern warehouse and features three strong handles, one on each side for carrying and one on the base for emptying. The ‘racksack’ is printed with one of three designs to allow for waste segregation – Mixed Paper & Card, Plastic Only and General Waste. Dimensions: 800mm high x 920mm wide x 400mm deep. Ref
Pack Quantity
RS1
1
RS5
5
RS10
10
Please suffix : /MP for mixed waste /P for Plastics /GW for General Waste
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628)
158
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
WASTE MANAGEMENT
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
159
SPILL CONTAINMENT SPILL DECKS Low Profile, Modular SpillDecks Allow You To Design And Create A Containment System That Meets Your Specific Needs Ultra-SpillDecks are available in 1, 2 and 4-drum modules. Modules are easily connected together with bulkhead fittings to allow a virtually unlimited number of customized configurations.
Bulkhead fittings allow spills to flow to adjacent sump areas, increasing containment capacity while maintaining a low profile.
All Ultra-SpillDecks offer slip-resistant grating to reduce OSHA slip hazards.
• Polyethylene construction meets a wide range of chemical compatibility needs. • Low profile, 5 3/4” height offers safe and convenient loading/unloading of drums. • Applications include hazardous waste collection, storage of virgin chemicals, drum dispensing and battery storage. • Optional Loading Ramps provide added drum handling safety and convenience. Part No. 1090 Polyethylene P6 System Part No. 1086
Part No. 1072
Part No. 1321
Part No. 1089
Connect your choice of 1, 2 and 4-drum SpillDeck modules to custom design your own secondary containment storage pad.
The bulkhead fittings not only “lock” connected modules together, but allow spilled liquid to flow from one module to the next. Ultra-SpillDeck Containment Systems meet SPCC, EPA and Uniform Fire Code Spill Containment Regulations when assembled in configurations of six (6) drums or more. Ultra-SpillDeck P1 Module
Ultra-SpillDeck P2 Module
Ultra-SpillDeck P4 Module
Ultra-SpillDeck Loading Ramp
Part No. 1321
Part No. 1086
Part No. 1072
Part No. 1089
Dimensions: 25 7/8” x 25 7/8” x 5 3/4”
Dimensions: 52” x 25 7/8” x 5 3/4”
Dimensions: 52” x 52” x 5 3/4”
Dimensions: 24” x 32” x 5 3/4”
Weight: 23 lbs.
Weight: 40 lbs.
Weight: 62 lbs.
Weight: 17 lbs.
Uniformly Distributed Load: 1,500 Lbs.
Uniformly Distributed Load: 3,000 Lbs.
Uniformly Distributed Load: 6,000 Lbs.
Containment Capacity: 11 gallons
Containment Capacity: 22 gallons
Containment Capacity: 44 gallons
Options: 26” T-Strip, 2 required/long side Bulkhead Fitting Sidewall Plug
Available in 6-drum and 8-drum models, Ultra-SpillDecks are perfect for satellite collection of hazardous wastes or storage of virgin chemicals. • One-piece, molded sump with elevated 2’ x 4’ black grates. • Polyethylene grates feature slip resistant, ”diamond plate” surface design. • Deck holds up to 1,500 lbs. per drum UDL (uniformly distributed load). • Designed for use with Ultra-SpillDeck Loading Ramp (Part# 1089)
160
Ultra-SpillDeck P6
Ultra-SpillDeck P8
Part No. 1175
Part No. 1075
Dimensions: 74 1/4” x 50” x 5 1/4”
Dimensions: 98 1/2” x 50” x 5 1/4”
Weight: 86 lbs.
Weight: 110 lbs.
Uniformly Distributed Load: 9,000 lbs.
Uniformly Distributed Load: 10,000 Lbs.
Containment Capacity: 66 gallons
Containment Capacity: 75 gallons
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
SPILL DECKS
SPILL CONTAINMENT
Combine High-Strength And Low-Profile Features While Meeting EPA Container Storage Regulations • Low profile positions drum funnels below eye level — significantly reduces the potential for hazardous fluids to splash into the eyes or face. • Nearly 50% lower than standard spill pallets, drum handling is safer and less strenuous. • Forkliftable, all-polyethylene construction. • Removable grates feature a non-slip surface. • Available in 1, 2, 3 and 4-drum configurations.
Superior weight capacity of the 4-drum model also allows use with IBC tanks.
Ultra-Spill Pallet P1 Plus Part# 9606: no drain Part# 9607: with drain Dimensions: 40” x 40” x 12” (1,016 mm x 1,016 mm x 305 mm) Weight: 51 lbs. (23 kg) Uniformly Distributed Load: 800 lbs. (364 kg) Containment Capacity: 62 gallons (235 L) Ultra-Spill Pallet P2 Plus Part# 9610: no drain Part# 9611: with drain Dimensions: 65 1/2” x 40” x 8 3/4” (1,664 mm x 1,016 mm x 222 mm) Weight: 88 lbs. (40 kg) Uniformly Distributed Load: 4,500 lbs. (2,045 kg) Containment Capacity: 66 gallons (250 L) Ultra-Spill Pallet P3 Plus Part# 9626: no drain Part# 9627: with drain Dimensions: 83” x 34.5” x 8 3/4” (2108 mm x 876 mm 222 mm) Weight: 90 lbs. (41 kg) Uniformly Distributed Load: 4,500 lbs. (2,045 kg) Containment Capacity: 66 gallons (250 L) Ultra-Spill Pallet P4 Plus Part# 9630: no drain Part# 9631: with drain Dimensions: 62” x 62” x 8 3/4” (1,575 mm x 1,575 mm x 222 mm) Weight: 140 lbs. (63.5 kg) Uniformly Distributed Load: 9,000 lbs. (4,091 kg) Containment Capacity: 75 gallons (284 L) Optional Loading Ramp: Part# 0678 Fits P1 Plus. Part# 0676 fits P2, P3 and P4 Plus.
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
161
SPILL CONTAINMENT Drum Rack Containment DRUM RACK CONTAINMENT SYSTEMS
Polyethylene Drum Racks Capture Spills, Keep Your Workplace Clean And Safe • All DrumRack Models tilt the drums slightly forward, allowing maximum drainage — optimize your use of chemicals while minimizing waste. • Ultra-DrumRack Systems improve worker safety by keeping slippery chemicals and oils off the plant floor.
Part No. 2383
Part No. 2380
1-Drum System
2-Drum System
4-Drum System
Part No. 2386 : no drain Part No. 2387 : with drain
Part No. 2383 : no drain Part No. 2384 : with drain
Part No. 2380 : no drain Part No. 2381 : with drain
Dimensions: 52” x 29” x 49 1/2”
Dimensions: 53” x 53” x 44 3/4”
Dimensions: 53” x 53” x 77 3/4”
Weight: 93 lbs.
Weight: 137 lbs.
Weight: 189 lbs.
Load Capacity: 750 lbs.
Load Capacity: 1,500 lbs.
Load Capacity: 3,000 lbs.
Containment Capacity: 66 gallons
Containment Capacity: 66 gallons
Containment Capacity: 66 gallons
Includes : SpillPallet and DrumRack P1
Includes : SpillPallet and DrumRack P2
Includes : SpillPallet & (2) DrumRack P2s
Options: Dispensing Shelf Part No. 2390 DrumRack P1 Part No. 9030 DrumRack P2 Part No. 2389 Locator Pins Part No. 2391
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628)
Part No. 1031: 12” x 48” x 4 3/4”ID Part No. 1034: 24” x 36” x 4 3/4”ID Part No. 1032: 24” x 48” x 4 3/4”ID Part No. 1035: 36” x 36” x 4 3/4”ID Part No. 1033: 30” x 48” x 4 3/4”ID
ULTIMATE TRAY
Keep Messy Drips and Spills Off Warehouse and Factory Floors • Heavy-duty polyethylene construction — will not rust or corrode. • Ribbed bottom keeps cans, pails and other containers elevated above any spills or leaks. • Stackable for easy storage when not in use. • Available in five sizes for a variety of applications.
162
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
SPILL BERM & Rack
SPILL CONTAINMENT Part No. 2101 Black Connector Part No. 2102 90° Orange Corner
Decide what shape or configuration is required and use optional Connectors and 90° Corners to complete the area.
Part No. 2100
SPILL BERM
Temporary Berm Seals Off Spills From The Environment, Nearby Drains And Door Stake Wall Model Containment Berms feature a unique design that allows the sidewalls to collapse in either direction and spring back automatically to their upright position! Roll drums over the sidewalls, drive trucks through them, and the sidewalls always return to vertical without assistance. • Standard 10-foot sections can be cut to various lengths to meet custom needs. • Unique, urethane material “weeps” into small cracks and crevices to seal off liquid flow. • SpillBerm is non-absorbing and is easily cleaned for repeated use. • Applications include: • Spill response • Temporary secondary containment • Sealing off of doorways during washdown operations • Flexible Ultra-SpillBerm will bend and turn to form almost any shape while temporarily “bonding” to any smooth surface.
Part No. 2100: Orange • Part No. 2050: Black Dimensions: 10’ x 4” x 2 1/4”
Weight: 31 lbs. per unit Material: Non-absorbing polyurethane Optional Connectors (Part No. 2101) used to connect 10’ sections Optional Corners (Part No. 2102) are used with Connectors to make 90° corners
Rack Containment Tray
Capture Leaks And Spills Underneath Pallet Racking • Low-profile (2 3/4”) slides easily under pallet racking and shelving. • Small leaks and spills from palletized contents above are captured — keeping floors clean and free from slip hazards. • Black, all-polyethylene construction provides excellent chemical compatibility and corrosion resistance. • Multiple tray systems available to fit any size rack or shelf. Additional trays and/ or connectors may be added for larger applications or revised configurations.
Part No. 2370: Single Tray
Part No. 2371: Two Tray System
Part No. 2372: Three Tray System
(Includes two trays and one connector)
(Includes three trays and two connectors)
Dimensions: 23 1/2” x 44” x 2 3/4”
Dimensions: 48” x 44” x 2 3/4”
Dimensions: 72” x 44” x 2 3/4”
Weight: 8 lbs.
Weight: 16 lbs.
Weight: 27 lbs.
Capacity: 16 gallons
Capacity: 24 gallons
Capacity: 8 gallons
Option: Connector — Part No. 2373
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
163
SPILL CONTAINMENTSPILL DRUM storage
Part No. 9612
HARDTOP p2 PLUS
Store Hazardous Drums Safely Outdoors With Pumps And Funnels In Place! • Tall 23 3/4” head space easily accommodates rotary drum pumps and large conical funnels. • Low profile (8 3/4”) containment pallet positions drum-top funnels at a safe, convenient level to pour hazardous wastes. • 100% polyethylene construction will not rust or corrode.
“Swing out” lower doors provide full access to drums for loading and unloading — optional ramp features a non-slip surface. Loading Ramp (Part No. 0676) stores neatly inside the containment unit when not in use.
Ultra-HardTop P2 Plus is lockable with a standard padlock, and can be safely lifted by forklift with drums in place.
164
Ultra-HardTop P2 Plus
Loading Ramp
Part No. 9612: no drain Part No. 9613: with drain
Part No. 0676
Dimensions: 67 1/4” x 41 1/4” x 74”
Dimensions: 46” x 28” x 8 3/4”
Weight: 260 lbs.
Weight: 25 lbs.
Uniformly Distributed Load: 4,500 lbs.
Surface: Non-slip
Containment Capacity: 66 gallons
Construction: Polyethylene
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
SPILL DRUM storage
SPILL CONTAINMENT
Part No. 9652
HARDTOP PLUS
Safely Store Multiple Drums Outdoors • Available in 8, 12, 16 and 20-drum models. Extender Kits are available to expand capacity beyond 20-drums. • All polyethylene construction — offers excellent chemical resistance, will not rust or corrode. • Separate, lockable compartments feature a unique “2-way” entry system — allows quick access to all four (4) drums. • Roll-top covers can be easily lifted from waist height to access drum tops. • Swing-out doors provide safety and convenience for loading or unloading drums. • Low-profile (8-3/4” height) containment pallet positions drum-tops at a safe, convenient level to pour wastes into funnels or to use drum pumps. • Rugged, 9,000 lb. uniformly distributed load (UDL) capacity per compartment allows safe storage of IBC tanks as well as drums. • Units ship partially unassembled for freight savings.
Part No. 9654
Part No. 9650: HardTop P8, no drain, 815 lbs. Part No. 9651: HardTop P8, with drain, 815 lbs. Dimensions: 126” x 62” x 79” Capacity: (8) 55-gallon drums
Part No. 9652: HardTop P12, no drain, 1190 lbs. Part No. 9653: HardTop P12, with drain, 1190 lbs. Dimensions: 188” x 62” x 79” Capacity: (12) 55-gallon drums
Part No. 9654: HardTop P16, no drain, 1565 lbs. Part No. 9655: HardTop P16, with drain, 1565 lbs. Dimensions: 250” x 62” x 79” Capacity: (16) 55-gallon drums
Part No. 9656: HardTop P20, no drain, 1940 lbs. Part No. 9657: HardTop P20, with drain, 1940 lbs. Dimensions: 312” x 62” x 79” Capacity: (20) 55-gallon drums.
Use optional Ramp (Part No. 0676) for easier drum handling — stores inside HardTop when not in use.
Part No. 9658: 4-Drum HardTop Extender Kit, no drain, 375 lbs. Part No. 9659: 4-Drum HardTop Extender Kit, with drain, 375 lbs.
Weight Capacity: 9,000 lbs. UDL per compartment Containment Capacity: 75 gallons per compartment Options: Polyethylene Loading Ramp — Part No. 0676
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
165
SPILL CONTAINMENT SPILL PALLET IBC SPILL PALLET
Part No. 1057
Double Stack IBC Tanks And Save Valuable Floor Space! • 16,000 lb. weight capacity accommodates up to twofull IBCs. • 100% polyethylene construction has no metal parts — rust and corrosion are things of the past. Inner polyethylene supports feature a dense pattern of vertical ribs which provide superior strength. Rated at 16,000 lbs. UDL capacity, the Ultra-IBC SpillPallet will provide years of service under rigorous conditions.
Part No. 1057: no drain Part No. 1058: with drain
Containment Capacity: 400 gallons
Dimensions: 58 3/4” x 58 3/4” x 33” 52” x 52” Usable Grating Surface
Uniformly Distributed Load: 16,000 lbs.
Weight: 444 lbs.
Options: Outdoor PullOver Cover, Separate Purchase of 400-Gallon Sump
Part No. 1157
IBC SPILL PALLET Plus
Economical And Portable Containment For IBCs • Low profile, 28” overall height — allows safe and convenient IBC tank handling and dispensing. • All polyethylene construction — offers excellent chemical resistance and will not rust or corrode. • Forkliftable — allows convenient positioning to desired locations. • Low-cost design with value-added feature and benefits. • Large 52” x 52” deck allows safe and convenient placement of IBC tanks. • Small footprint — 62” x 62” unit requires minimal floor space. • Available with optional Bucket Shelf (Part no. 1160) — catches leaks or spills during dispensing.
Part No. 1160 (Bucket Shelf)
Part No. 1159 Optional PullOver Cover keeps rainwater out of sump and helps comply with Stormwater Management Regulations.
Four inner polyethylene columns support uniformly distributed loads of up to 8,500 lbs. All components are easily removed for cleaning.
Ultra-IBC SpillPallet Plus
166
Spills from dispensing that exceed 3 gallons are channeled into the 360-gallon sump through a bulkhead fitting.
Ultra-BucketShelf
Part No. 1157: no drain Part No.1158: with drain
Containment Capacity: 360 gallons
Part No. 1160
Dimensions: 62” x 62” x 28”
Uniformly Distributed Load: 8,500 lbs.
Dimensions: 19 1/2” x 16” x 14 1/2”
Weight: 324 lbs.
Meets EPA Container Storage Regulation 40 CFR 264.175, 264.177(c) and 265.177(c).
Weight: 10 lbs.
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
SPILL PALLET NESTABLE
SPILL CONTAINMENT
SPILL PALLET NESTABLE MODEL
Low-Profile, Nestable Spill Pallet Reduces Shipping Costs and Storage Space • Large, 66-gallon sump captures leaks and spills from steel or poly drums. • Nestable design allows multiple pallets to be shipped (or stored) in a minimal amount of space. • 100% polyethylene construction — compatible with a broad range of chemicals, including acids and corrosives. • Low-profile (10” height) makes drum handling safer and easier. • 2-way forkliftable — provides easy positioning and relocation. Part No. 1230: no drain | Part No. 1231: with drain Dimensions: 51” x 51” x 10” (1,295 mm x 1,295 mm x 254 mm) Weight: 80 lbs. (36 kg)
Containment Capacity: 66 gallons (250 L) 6,000 lbs. (2,722 kg)
SPILL PALLET
Spill Pallets Are Built For Heavy Loads And Convenient Handling • High load capacity — 6,000 lbs. for 4-Drum Model, 3,000 lbs. for 2-Drum Model. • Bright, safety yellow sidewalls are translucent, offering convenient visual leak detection. • 100% polyethylene construction — compatible with a broad range of chemicals, including acids and corrosives. Ultra-Spill Pallet P4 Part No. 1000: no drain | Part No. 1001: with drain Dimensions: 53” x 53” x 11 3/4” (1,347 mm x 1,347 mm x 299 mm) Weight: 90 lbs. (41 kg) Containment Capacity: 66 gallons (250 L) Uniformly Distributed Load: 6,000 lbs. (2,727 kg) Optional Pull Over Covers, Part No. 1006 Optional Loading Ramp, Part No. 0678
Ultra-Spill Pallet P2 Part No. 1010: no drain | Part No. 1011: with drain
Part No. 1010
Dimensions: 53” x 29” x 16 1/2” (1,347 mm x 737 mm x 419 mm) Weight: 63 lbs. (29 kg) Containment Capacity: 66 gallons (250 L) Uniformly Distributed Load: 3,000 lbs. (1,364 kg) Optional Pull Over Covers, Part No. 1016
Part No. 1000
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
167
SPILL CONTAINMENT SPILL COLLECTOR & OVER PACKS SPILL COLLECTOR
Mobile Secondary Container Provides Maximum Protection For The Inner Drum
Part No. 1040
• Applications include satellite waste collection, general storage of chemical drums and portable drum pumping stations. • Rugged design allows Flat Bottom Model and Pallet Jack • Model to be safely handled by forklift under top flange. • 66 gallon containment capacity.
Part No. 1041
Part No. 1041: Pallet Jack Model
Part No. 1040: Flat Bottom Model
Dimensions: 32 1/2” outside diameter 24 1/4” diameter opening 28 5/8” outside height
Dimensions: 34” outside diameter 24 1/4” diameter opening 27 1/4” outside height
Containment Capacity: 66 gallons
Containment Capacity: 66 gallons
Weight: 28 lbs.
Weight: 27 lbs.
Handling: May be handled with narrow pallet jack. May be lifted with forklift under top flange.
Handling: May be lifted with forklift under top flange. May be wheeled with optional dolly.
Options: Drain Fitting, Dolly (Fits Flat Bottom Model Only)
Part No. 0417 (Optional Dolly)
OVER PACKS
Versatile Ultra-Over Packs Offer The Highest UN And DOT Certifications Available • 95-, 55-, 30- and 20-gallon models comply with UN Packaging Group 1 (X-Rating) and are certified for use as DOT Salvage Drums, 49 CFR 173.3 (c).* • High-density polyethylene construction offers excellent chemical resistance, including acids, caustics and corrosives. • Convenient, “no-tools-required” closures are perfect for clean-up and spill response activities. • Nestable design and low tare weight allow convenient storage and reduced transportation costs.
Part No. 0500 95 gallon
Applications Include: • Overpacking of Damaged or Leaking Packages • Collection and Transport of Soiled Sorbents • Clean-up of Contaminated Sites • Emergency Response • Direct Containment and Transport of Hazardous Solids • Use as Spill Kits
Part No. 0526 55 gallon
Part No. 0510 30 gallon
Part No. 0600, 20 gallon
168
Part No. 0500: 95 Gallon
Part No. 0526: 55 Gallon
Part No. 0510: 30 Gallon
Part No. 0600: 20 Gallon
Top Outside Dia: 31” (788 mm)
Top Outside Dia: 24 7/8” (632 mm)
Top Outside Dia: 21 3/4” (552 mm)
Top Outside Dia: 21 3/4” (552 mm)
Bottom Outside Dia: 25 1/8” (638 mm)
Bottom Outside Dia: 20” (508 mm)
Bottom Outside Dia: 17” (432 mm)
Bottom Outside Dia: 17 3/4” (451 mm)
Outside Height: 43 1/4” (1,098 mm)
Outside Height: 37 1/2” (952 mm)
Outside Height: 28 1/4” (717 mm)
Outside Height: 16 3/4” (425 mm)
Weight: 49 lbs. (22 kg)
Weight: 24 lbs. (11 kg)
Weight: 17 lbs. (7.5 kg)
Weight: 16 lbs. (7.5 kg)
Rated Capacity: 95 gallons (360 L)
Rated Capacity: 55 gallons (208 L)
Rated Capacity: 30 gallons (113.5 L)
Rated Capacity: 20 gallons (761 L)
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
FUNNELS & DRUM TRUCK
SPILL CONTAINMENT
Bung Access Funnel
The Bung Access Ultra-Funnel allows access to the 3/4” drum bung. Installation of our pop-up liquid level gauge in the 3/4” bung allows visual monitoring of waste level in the drum and helps you plan ahead for drum removal. It also eliminates the mess caused by overfilling! Part No. 0482
Part No. 0484
Unique zig-zag channeled surface diffuses splashing. Level surfaces allow filters, paint cans, buckets and bottles to remain upright while draining passively. Part No. 0482: with spout Part No. 0484: with hinged cover, with spout Dimensions: 23 5/8” OD x 5 1/2” (600 mm x 140 mm) 29” x 26 3/4” x 9 1/2” (737 mm x 679 mm x 241 mm) with hinged cover Weight: 10 lbs. (4.5 kg) 17 lbs. (7.5 kg) with hinged cover Capacity: 6 gallons (23 L) Options: Snap-on Cover, Part No. 0485 PopUp Fill Gauge, Part No. 9985
Optional hinged cover keeps dirt and unwanted materials out of your waste stream. It’s also lockable for secure drum management.
Burp-Free Funnel
Part No. 0651
Burp-Free Ultra-Funnels feature a built-in vent. No more splashing or “burping” when pouring liquids! • Threaded brass insert screws into 2” drum bung or tank cap. • All polyethylene construction won’t rust or corrode — provides excellent chemical resistance. • Hinged, lockable lid prevents unauthorized access. • Larger style (Part No. 0656) provides bigger pouring area and easy access. Part No. 0651: Standard
Weight: 6 lbs. (3 kg)
Dimensions: 13 3/8” dia. x 11” H (340 mm dia. x 279 mm H)
Part No. 0656: Large
Weight: 8 lbs. (3.5 kg)
Dimensions: 22” dia. x 11 1/2” H (559 mm dia. x 292 mm H)
DRUM TRUCK
Drum Handling, Dispensing and Containment in One Unit • Rugged polyethylene construction offers excellent chemical resistance. • Unlike alternative products, the open containment sump does not require spills to flow inside the double walls to meet EPA regulations — easy to clean; eliminates residue concerns as related to compatibility. • Can be used with 55- or 30-gallon drums — nylon strap keeps drums secure. • Ergonomically designed for safe and easy handling. • Large 10” wheels roll easily over shop and factory floors. • Part No. 1312 has large, pneumatic wheels for soft or uneven surfaces. Part No. 1310: indoor and smooth surfaces Part No.1312: all terrain use Containment Capacity: 66 gallons
Dimensions: 32” x 72 1/4” x 27” Weight: 118 lbs. Weight Capacity: 600 lbs.
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
169
SPILL CONTAINMENTCONTAINMENT BERMS Part No. 8506
ULTIMATE MODEL
Unique, “Living Hinge” Design Allows Hands-Free Drive In/Drive Out — No Need To Manually Raise Or Lower The Endwalls • Entry and exit walls are supported every 12” with a patented “living hinge”. • Once a vehicle has entered or exited, the walls automatically spring back to their vertical position. • Both long sidewalls are held upright by PVC sidewall assemblies. Simply swivel the feet to lower the sidewalls for storage or transport to another location.
Two-way “living hinge” design allows convenient, hands-free drive in/drive out. Dimensions
Part #
Weight
Containment Capacity
12’ x 60’ x 1’
8505
309 lbs.
5,385 gallons
15’ x 50’ x 1’
8506
326 lbs.
5,610 gallons
15’ x 66’ x 1’
8506
405 lbs.
7,405 gallons
Drive-in/drive-out endwalls teamed up with Collapsible sidewalls offer the Ultimate combination — “Hands Free” convenience and an affordable design!
Options: Ground Tarps, Track Belts. Self-Bailer
170
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
CONTAINMENT BERMS
SPILL CONTAINMENT
Part No. 8437
Rapid Rise Model
Sidewalls Stay Lowered And Out Of The Way Until They Are Needed • Sidewalls remain down during normal operations, loading and unloading. Vehicles and equipment can drive in and out from any angle, with no sidewall set-up or take-down required. • In the case of a spill, the foam ring around the top perimeter of the Containment Berm rises with the level of spilled liquid. • Custom sizes available. • Standard material of construction is Copolymer 2000™. Dimensions
Part #
Weight
Containment Capacity
4’ x 6’ x 1’
8430
29 lbs.
179 gallons
4’ x 6’ x 1’
8431
35 lbs.
269 gallons
10’ x 10’ x 1’
8432
63 lbs.
748 gallons
12’ x 26’ x 1’
8437
149 lbs.
2,333 gallons
15’ x 50’ x 1’
8433
278 lbs.
5,385 gallons
15’ x 66’ x 1’
8434
357 lbs.
5,610 gallons
Options: Ground Tarps, Track Belts. Self-Bailer,
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
171
SPILL CONTAINMENT CONTAINMENT BERMS
Part No. 8612
COMPACT MODEL
Compact Design Folds Into A Tight Package – Minimal Space Required To Store Onboard Trucks And Hazmat Response Vehicles • Compact, lightweight, portable design — no inflation required. • Protect heavy equipment from spills during filling, discharging, cleaning and maintenance. • Smaller sizes provide total containment of drums, tanks, generators, compressors and other equipment prone to leaks and spills. • Sidewalls lower quickly to allow drive in/drive out.
STEP 2: Insert the sidewall struts into their pockets. Compact Berms are ready to go!
STEP 1: Unfold onto the desired location... (note: 12’ x 60’ x 1’ pictured)
172
Dimensions
Part #
Weight
Containment Capacity
4’ x 6’ x 1’
8609
34 lbs.
179 gallons
6’ x 6’ x 1’
8610
39 lbs.
269 gallons
10’ x 10’ x 1’
8611
72 lbs.
748 gallons
12’ x 60’ x 1’
8612
335 lbs.
5,385 gallons
15’ x 50’ x 1’
8613
317 lbs.
5,610 gallons
15’ x 66’ x 1’
8614
404 lbs.
7,405 gallons
Options: Ground Tarps, Track Belts, Protective Storage Bags. Self-Bailer
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
CONTAINMENT BERMS
SPILL CONTAINMENT
Part No. 8310
STAKE WALL MODEL
Portable Secondary Containment For Drums, Tanks, Equipment And Vehicles Stake Wall Model Containment Berms feature a unique design that allows the sidewalls to collapse in either direction and spring back automatically to their upright position! Roll drums over the sidewalls, drive trucks through them, and the sidewalls always return to vertical without assistance. • Does not rely on inflation, hinged straps or cumbersome frames to keep sidewalls up. • No set-up required — unfold and the sidewalls automatically spring into their vertical position. • Helps comply with federal and local stormwater regulations. • Custom sizes available. Dimensions
4’ x 6’ x 1’
Weight
10’ x 10’ x 1’
15’ x 50’ x 1’
15’ x 66’ x 1’
Part
8609
8309
8310
8337
8332
Weight
44 lbs.
50 lbs.
100 lbs.
438 lbs.
563 lbs.
Containment Capacity
179 gallons
269 gallons
748 gallons
5,610 gallons
7,405 gallons
Material of Construction
XR5, an ethylene copolymer, is standard. Copolymer 2000TM, polyurethane and other materials are also available on a custom basis.
Options
Track belts, ground tarps, protective storage bags, PullOver Covers. Self-Bailer
Sidewalls collapse, offering convenient loading / unloading on remote locations.
Containment Berms deploy in only seconds, no assembly required... excellent for off-site containment of generators, transformers, fuel tanks, vehicles, etc.
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
173
SPILL CONTAINMENT PoP UP POOLS Pop Up Pools Instantly Expand To Capture Leaks From Saddle Tanks, Pipes, Hydraulic Lines And Many Other Industrial Incidents Ultra-Pop Up Pools are available in 400, 250, 150, 100, 66 and 20 gallon sizes. Choose Sprung Steel or Economy Models to meet your needs. Simply remove them from their protective carrying case and give them a quick shake — they instantly expand and are ready for response to any emergency. • Unique, patented design — foam ring rises with level of liquid to raise sidewalls. • Compact folded size — stores efficiently inside spill kits; handles on storage bag* can also be used to hang on a wall near shipping/ receiving docks. • All polyethylene construction — offers excellent chemical resistance, including diesel fuel, antifreeze, acids, caustics and corrosives.
Part No. 8150 or 8153
Economy Models are easily rolled into a tight package. Store them inside the optional Ultra-Cab Mount Container, which can be bolted to the back side of a truck cab
Ultra-Pop Up Pools are perfect for providing temporary secondary containment for drums, leaking packages, etc.
• Helps minimize environmental damage and related clean-up costs. • Excellent for response to damaged saddle tanks and cross-over lines, hazmat spills, leaking containers, machinery and piping. • Other applications include use as a decontamination pool and collection pool for soiled sorbents.
Part No. 8020, 8022
Part No. 8066, 8068
Part# 8100, 8102
Part# 8150, 8153
Part# 8160
Part# 8162
20 gallon capacity (76 L)
66 gallon capacity (250 L)
100 gallon capacity (379 L)
150 gallon capacity (568 L)
250 gallon capacity (946 L)
400 gallon capacity (1514 L)
Filled: Wall 8”, Top 28”, Bottom 35” (204 mm, 711 mm, 889 mm)
Filled: Wall 12”, Top 42”, Bottom 53” (305 mm, 1,067 mm, 1,347 mm)
Filled: Wall 12”, Top 53”, Bottom 64 1/2” (305 mm, 1,347 mm, 1,638 mm)
Filled: Wall 12”, Top 64”, Bottom 76” (305 mm, 1,626 mm, 1,930 mm)
Filled: Wall 12”, Top 73”, Bottom 85” (305 mm, 1,855 mm, 2,159 mm)
Filled: Wall 20”, Top 73”, Bottom 85” (508 mm, 1,855 mm, 2,159 mm)
All Models: Chemical-resistant, 10 mil. polyethylene construction. Reusable after proper decontamination. Note: 250 and 400 gallon Pop Up Pools are orange in color.
CAB MOUNT CONTAINERS
Store Pop Up Pools Behind The Cab — Out Of The Way, But Ready For Any Emergency • Durable, all-polyethylene construction will resist harsh weather effects. • Cover is lockable for security purposes. • Store Pop Up Pools outside of the cab, preserving valuable interior space for other necessities.
Part No. 8155 Dimensions: 28 1/4” x 13” x 10 3/4” (717 mm x 330 mm x 273 mm) Weight: 8 lbs. (3.5 kg) Material: Polyethylene 15’ x 50’ x 1’ 15’ x 66’ x 1’
Part No. 8155
174
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
DRAIN SEALS
SPILL CONTAINMENT
DRAIN SEALS
Stop Spills From Going Down The Drain • Reinforcing mesh is “sandwiched” between layers of polyurethane — increases durability and resistance to tearing. • Unique, urethane construction allows the pad to deform and seal off most drains — temporarily “seals” to any smooth surface. • A valuable addition to any emergency response plan, spill kit, SPCC or stormwater management program. • Unlike some alternative products, BOTH sides will quickly seal drains — there is no specified “top” or “bottom.” Part No. 2124
Flexible, non-absorbing material with reinforced, tear-resistant mesh One unit per box, easily cuts to special shapes and sizes Resists oil, water and most aggressive chemicals, cleans with soap and water Prevents contaminants from entering drain Helps comply with SPCC Helps comply with NPDES
Square: Part# 2126: 18” x 18” x 3/8” • 5 lbs. Part# 2127: 24” x 24” x 3/8” • 9 lbs. Part# 2130: 36” x 36” x 3/8” • 10 lbs. Part# 2131: 42” x 42” x 3/8” • 20 lbs. Part# 2132: 48” x 48” x 3/8” • 34 lbs. Part# 2133: 54” x 54” x 3/8” • 41 lbs.
Part# 2140: Fits 18” x 18”, 24” x 24”, 12” dia. and 20” diameter DrainSeals Part# 2142: Fits 36” x 36” and 30” diameter DrainSeals Part# 2143: Fits 42” x 42”, 48” x 48” and 42” diameter DrainSeals
Circular: Part# 2134: 12” dia. x 3/8” • 2 1/2 lbs. Part# 2135: 20” dia. x 3/8” • 5 lbs. Part# 2136: 30” dia. x 3/8” • 10 lbs. Part# 2137: 42” dia. x 3/8” • 20 lbs.
Made of durable polyethylene.
Rectangular: Part# 2124: 18” x 58” x 3/8” • 16 lbs. Part# 2125: 36” x 58” x 3/8” • 30 lbs.
Non-slip handle for easy carrying.
Velcro strap allows quick and easy access.
Mounting hardware included.
Part No. 2134
Part No. 2142
Reinforcing mesh resists tearing.
Optional Ultra-DrainSeal WallMount Units allow quick response to any spill — just “grab and go”!
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
175
SPILL CONTAINMENT Universal Absorbent GENERAL PURPOSE
BX0004 BX0003
BX0005
Description
Sheet/Roll Size L x W mm
Quantity
Model
Centre-feed Roll in a Dispenser Box
200 x 380
175 Sheet Roll
BX0002
Dispenser box with 2-ply perforated Paper Roll
200 x 15,000
1 Roll
BX0003
Dispenser box of Quick-rip perforated Absorbent Roll
310 x 3100
1 Roll
BX0004
Dispenser box of Absorbent Pads
310 x 380
75 Pads
BX0005
OIL & FUEL
IDEAL FOR OIL & FUEL SPILLS
BX0665
BX0664
Description
Sheet/Roll Size L x W mm
Dispenser box of Quick-rip perforated Absorbent Roll Dispenser box of Absorbent Pads
Quantity
Model
310 x 3100
1 Roll
BX0664
310 x 380
75 Pads
BX0665
CHEMICAL
IDEAL IDEALFOR FOR CHEMICAL OIL & FUELSPILLS SPILLS
176
Description
Sheet/Roll Size L x W mm
Dispenser box of Quick-rip perforated Absorbent Roll Dispenser box of Absorbent Pads
Quantity
Model
310 x 3100
1 Roll
BX0774
310 x 380
75 Pads
BX0775
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Spill Control & Containment TANKER & VEHICLE SPILL KIT
SHOULDER BAG SPILL KIT
20Litre or 30 Litre Capacity Contains
50Litre Capacity Contains
• 2 (120cm) Socks • 12 Pads • 1 Disposal Bags
• 2 (300cm) Socks • 20 Pads • 4 Disposal Bags
Oil & Fuel Kit
General Kit
Model
Model
Model
20 Litre Kit
OSK20
GSK20
CSK20
30 Litre Kit
OSK30
GSK30
CSK30
Description
Chemical Kit
90Litre capacity Contains • 4 (300cm) Socks • 30 Pads • 3 Cushions • 3 Disposal Bags
90 Litre Kit
Description
Oil & Fuel Kit
General Kit
Model
Model
Model
OSK50
GSK50
CSK50
50 Litre Kit
Chemical Kit
OIL STORAGE AREA SPILL KIT
WORKSHOP SPILL KIT
Description
SPILL CONTAINMENT
200Litre capacity Contains • 8 (300cm) Socks • 100 Double-weight pads • 3 Disposal Bags
Oil & Fuel Kit
General Kit
Chemical Kit
Model
Model
Model
OSK90
GSK90
CSK90
Description 200 Litre Kit
Oil & Fuel Kit
General Kit
Model
Model
Model
OSK200
GSK200
CSK200
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Chemical Kit
177
SPILL CONTAINMENT CONTAINMENT BOOMS
• Total height 20cm x 7.5 m longitudinal section • 5 mm Chain • Ribbed connector (7.5 cm out of the water and 12.5 cm under the water).
Mini Boom
It is an easy to handle boom for emergency situations. Its lightness and manoeuvrability make it particularly suitable for containing small spills of pollutant liquids in small creeks, streams and lakes. Particularly useful to fire brigades and emergency squads. Easy to transport on normal pick-ups. Ifs compact size make it the right solution for road and water transport companies, who may need emergency kits but who have very little storage space. Characteristics • Easy maneuvrability also by just 1 person • Portable. Ideal to reach remote areas by just 1 person • Easy and quick to assemble • Easy transport thanks to a comfortable carry bag
178
Model
Dimensions
Fabric
Chain
BMB 2075
7.5 mt. x h 20 cm
730 g/m2 PVC
5 mm.
BM BAG
-
730 g/m2 PVC
-
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
CONTAINMENT BOOMS
SPILL CONTAINMENT
Junior Boom
High resistance floating boom with a total height of 45 cm, designed to be long lasting and guarantee reliability, requiring minimum maintenance in spite of many years use. Ideal for frequent use and in the case of exposure to deterioration caused by atmospheric agents and abrasion. It is the perfect floating boom for calm and protected waters with weak tidal currents, suitable for petroleum plants, industries and government organisations of emergency environment aid.
• Total height 45cm x 15 m longitudinal section • 6 mm Chain • ASTM connector (15 cm out of the water and 30 cm under the water).
Characteristics Clamp to hold the fabric with high resistance Rings to allow both towing and anchorage Double fabric to ensure longer durability Handles for easier handling on water and easier recovery
Model
Dimensions
Fabric
Chain
BJB 1210
30 mt. x h 60 cm
730 g/m2 PVC
6 mm.
BJB 1205
15 mt. x h 60 cm
730 g/m2 PVC
6 mm.
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
179
Drum Handling DRUM HANDLING EQUIPMENT FORK EXTENSIONS A simple and effective way of lengthening your forks to handle longer loads. Of welded steel construction with a steel retaining strap to prevent fork extensions from sliding off the forks during use. Fits onto forks up to 50mm thick. Extensions should not exceed the length of the fork on which they are installed by more than 50%. Finish: Powder coated yellow
DH622Z Shown with hook in 3rd position
Fork Extension Min.Fork Length Length
Fit Fork Width
102 mm 43 127 mm 49 127 mm 152 mm
1524 mm 1524 mm 1830 mm 1830 mm
1016 mm 1016 mm 1220 mm 1220 mm
Weight
Model
Price
FKE1510 FKE1212 FKE1812 FKE1815
DH623Z Shown with hook in 3rd position
FORK MOUNTED JIBS
• Gives increased versatility • CE Marked and plated Of robust construction, these units convert fork lift trucks into mobile cranes. This gives greater versatility to fork lift trucks, enabling access to items usually not reachable by standard fork lift access. The jib is locked into place by pins behind the fork heels. Overall L x Wx H mm
Load Capacity in pre-set hook positions Load Capacity
Weight 1st@1240mm
2nd@1490mm
3rd@1740mm
Price
Model
4th@1990mm
2050 x 640 x 750
2000 kg
2000
1500
1000
500
100 kg
DH622Z
2050 x 640 x 755
3000 kg
3000
2500
2000
1500
150 kg
DH623Z
DRUM POSITIONER
DH629Z
DH629Z
180
• Can be operated without leaving the fork lift truck • CE Marked and plated This unit is ideal for loading / unloading drums stored horizontally. Designed to lift 210 litre steel and ‘L’ Ring Plastic Drums from the horizontal to the vertical position and vice versa. The positioner is locked into place by pins behind the fork heels. Finish: Stove enamel Red Overall L x Wx H mm
Load Capacity
Weight
Model
x 740 x 700 2190
kg 350
kg 60
DH629Z
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Price
DRUM HANDLING EQUIPMENT
Drum Handling DRUM LIFTER • Safe • Robust • Unique • Maximum Load Capacity: 300 kg • Overall Width: 725mm
This unit has a unique system. Once the drum is in position the operator is able to grip the drum and lift it vertically by pumping the handle. Once lifted the drum is held securely in this position allowing safe transportation. Suitable for use with standard 205/210 litre steel drums.
Max Lift Minimum Lift Lift Height mm Height mm Distance mm DL100Z
375
265
110
Model Price DL100Z POA
DH657S
DH658S
DRUM TRUCK UNIVERSAL
DRUM TRUCK NARROW AISLE
• Maximum Load Capacity: 250 kg
• Maximum Load Capacity: 250 kg
• Dispensing Height: 410 mm
• Dispensing Height: 410 mm
• Handle Height (Upright): 850 mm
• Handle Height (Upright): 985 mm
• Horizontal Drum Clearance: 320 mm Use as a drum transporter and also as a dispenser. Suitable for standard 210 litre drums. Fitted with a webbing strap (50mm wide) with quick release snap buckle and tensioning. Finish: Stove Enamel Blue. This unit is balanced / produced in such a way that it should only be used with full or empty drums.
Narrower than a standard 210 litre drum - ideal for use in narrow aisles. Use as a drum truck or dispensing stand without removing the drum. Operators hands are always inboard for safety protection. Finish: Stove Enamel Blue. This unit is balanced / produced in such a way that it should only be used with full or empty drums.
Overall Dimensions H x W x D mm
Wheels mm
Weight kg
Model
Price
Overall Dimensions H x W x D mm
Wheels mm
Weight kg
Model
Price
1450 x 610 x 560
2 x 200, 2 x 250 Cushion Tyred RB
40
DH657S
POA
1600 x 510 x 505
4 x 200 mm Polyurethane Tyred RB
34
DH658S
POA
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
181
Drum Handling DRUM HANDLING EQUIPMENT
DH482L
DH492Z
DRUM pallet loader
• Load Capacity: 250 kg Designed to load and unload standard 210 litre drums safely and efficiently from a pallet. Large hooped handles for easy handling. Drum is held in position by the use of a sliding hook located down the centre of the trolley frame. Two models available, either a hard wearing blue paint finish or zinc plated finish for extra protection in damp areas. The Pallet Loader is balanced/produced in such a way that it should be only used with full or empty drums.
Description
Overall size Weight Wheels Model Price L x W x H mm mm Painted Finish 2 x 200 cast iron centre rubber tyred wheels 1800 x 610 x 1225 46 kg POA 2 x 250 steel centre rubber tyred wheels DH482L 2 x 200 zinc plated centre rubber tyred Zinc Finish 1800 x 610 x 1225 46 kg DH492Z POA 2 x 250 rubber tyred wheels • Locks in vertical or horizontal position.
DH555Z
DH455L
DH454L
drum transporter
• Load Capacity: 250 kg Three wheeled drum transporter suitable for moving standard 210 litre steel drums. The drum sits firmly in the frame for safe transportation. Available in either painted blue finish or zinc plated for extra protection. Overall Size: 890 x 810 mm
182
Model
Price
Painted Finish 24 kg 2 x 200 rubber tyred wheels DH455L 1 x 125 mm cushion swivel castor
Description
Weight
Wheels
POA
Zinc Finish 24 kg
POA
2 x 200 rubber tyred 1 x 125 cushion swivel castor
DH555Z
Drum Mobile Carrier The cradle is clamped around the standard 210 litre steel drum whilst stood in the vertical position. The drum is lifted off the ground by pulling the main handle back into the horizontal position. By the release of two sprung loaded locking levers the drum can be rotated through 360°. Overall Ht. Handle Down
Overall Ht. W x L Capacity Handle up 870 x 1050 mm 1700 mm 1100 mm 360 kg
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Weight
Model
Price
52 kg
DH454L
POA
DRUM TRANSPORTERS
Drum Handling
DH446L
DH446L
DH480L
DRUM TRANSPORTERS
DH462B
• Maximum Load capacity 200 kg.
DH462B
DH446L - Designed to carry standard 210 litre steel drums. Constructed from tubular
steel, with drum forks and a sturdy central support column. The adjustable retaining hook slides up and down the central column enabling the firm handling of varying drum sizes. Maximum drum height 1575 mm. DH480L - Similar to the DH446L but fitted with a set of rear castors. These support the full weight of a loaded trolley for the ease of transporting over longer distances. For compact storage the castors fold away into the body of the trolley. This unit is produced/balanced in such a way that it should only be used with full or empty drums Overall Overall Width mm Height mm 1575 with 705 handle vertical 705 1575 with handle vertical 700 1520 700 1520
Wheels mm 2 x 350 x 75 cushion roller bearing 2 x 350 x 75 cushion roller bearing and 2 x 125 cushion swivel castors 2 x 400 x 100 cushion roller bearing 2 x 400 x 100 Pneumatic 2 ply roller bearing
Weight kg
Model
Price
31
DH446L
POA
31
DH480L
POA
GENERAL PURPOSE DRUM LIFTERS DH461M/2B. 35
DH461M
POA
30
DH462B
POA
DRUm UNIVERSAL TRANSPORTER DH481L
• Specially suitable for plastic barrels. • Suits any 200 litre size, steel, plastic or fibreboard drum/barrel. • Fitted with restraining chain. DH481L
• Suitable for use with standard 210 litre steel drums. Please note, this unit is produced/balanced in such a way that it should only be used with full or empty drums. • Can be used to load and unload steel drums from pallets, easily, safely and efficiently. • Rear castor arrangement is fitted with a load damper to prevent shock loading to the drum and facilitates easy transportation over uneven ground. • Drum is held securely in position during use by a clamp. (fig 1).
— TO LOAD DRUM.
• Drum must be vertical, enabling the clamp (as seen in fig 1) to be positioned with the lifting plate • under the rim of the drum. • Push handle ➁ to lock clamp in position. • Drop hook ➂ over the lip of the drum. • Pull back on handles while applying foot pressure to slide the toes of the truck under the barrel. • Continue pulling until drum clears the ground - ease swivel castor to the ground for transporting. To release the drum - return the loaded unit to the vertical position. Push firmly on the handle to release the toes from under the drum, release hook ➂ and move away. NB When moving drums at the same height. The clamp when set ➁ does not need to be reset.
➁
➂
Fig 1
➀
DH481L
verall dimensions O Wheels Weight Model Price L x W x H mm mm kg 2 x 350 x 75 1780 x 720 x 950 cushion roller bearing 32 DH481L POA 1 x 125 Cushion swivel castor
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
183
Drum Handling DRUM HANDLING EQUIPMENT
DH451S
DH467Y
drum handler all purpose • Load Capacity 240 kg When positioned vertically the drum handle will lock on to the drum rim. By levering back on the handle the drum rests into position as the toes engage the base. With drum in horizontal position the handle may be returned to transit position. Designed to carry standard 210 litre steel drums. Overall size
Wheels
LxWxH 800 x 635 x
450 mm
Weight
Model
Price
2 fixed, 200 x 50 mm cushion tyred roller bearing 2 swivel 75 mm nylon castors
32 DH451S
DRUM STAND HIGH LIFT Designed for the easy dispensing of liquids and chemicals. The robust steel ‘A’ frame construction is finished in blue epoxy coating.
Overall size Castors H x W x D mm
Weight kg Model Price
1000 x 870 x 800 – 13 2 x fixed, 2 swivel with 1150 x 870 x 800 16.5 brake, 125mm rubber tyred
DH466Z
POA
DH467Y
POA
DH483J
DH493Z
DRUM TRANSPORTER PAINTED
Drum Transporter ZINC PLATED
• Load Capacity 400 kg Tubular steel construction drum transporter designed to carry standard 210 litre steel drums. The drum is held in place by an adjustable hook on the centre beam. 2 x 250 mm solid rubber tyres with 2 x 160 mm supporting castors. Blue Painted finish. This unit is balanced / produced in such a way that it should only be used with full or empty drums.
• Load Capacity 400 kg
Tubular steel construction drum transporter designed to carry standard 210 litre steel drums. Drum is held in place by an adjustable hook on the centre beam. Zinc plated finish for extra protection in damp areas.
Overall Size H x W mm Support Height mm Weight kg Model
Overall Size H x W mm
184
1600 x 740
830
20
DH483J
Price POA
1500 x 630
Wheels mm
Weight kg Model
2 x 250 rubber tyred
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
20
DH493Z
Price POA
DRUM HANDLING EQUIPMENT
Drum Handling
DH430Z
DH440Z ST440Z Shown with DH439Z Drum handle lever.
DH443Z
DH432S
DH442S
DH445S
DRUM STANDS FOR STEEL BARRELS • Suitable for standard 210 litre steel Drums
• Static or Mobile
All welded tubular steel construction. Finished in either hard wearing Blue paint finish or bright zinc plate for protection against dampness. A stainless steel version of the standard stand is also available. Models DH440Z, DH430Z and ST440Z. - Static storage stands, with steel shoes fitted to the base preventing the wearing of tubes. Model DH443Z - As model DH440Z but with nylon top rollers which allow drainage and discharge of liquids from the side bung of the drum. Models DH442S and DH432S - Mobile drum stands on 2 fixed and 2 swivel wheels. Ideal for the moving of drums between machines and narrow aisles. Model DH445S - As mobile model DH442S but fitted with nylon top rollers for discharging liquids from the side bung of the drum. Finish Overall Height Height under Wheel Roller Weight size mm mm side of drum mm diam. mm diameter kg 865 x 595 350 280 — — 5.4 Blue 865 x 595 385 315 100 Fixed 75 Castor — 14 Painted 865 x 595 350 290 — 75 mm 7.2 865 x 595 385 325 100 Fixed 75 Castor 75 mm 15.4 Drum Handle Lever - Designed for use with above Drum Stands. Zinc 865 x 595 350 280 — — 5.4 Plated 865 x 595 385 315 100 Fixed 75 Castor — 14 Zinc Plated Drum Handle Lever Designed for use with above Drum stands Stainless Steel 865 x 595 350 280 — — 5.4
Model Price DH440Z DH442S DH443Z DH445S DH439Z DH430Z DH432S DH539Z ST440Z
POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA
DRUM DOLLIES • Suitable for moving standard 210 litre drums All welded construction from either steel or stainless steel. Fitted with 4 x 75 mm Nylon swivel castors. Height: 100 mm Diameter mm Weight Description Model Price Internal External Kg DH460Y
ST720N
Steel
610
Stainless Steel 610
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
720
10
720
10 ST720N POA
DH460Y POA
185
Drum Handling HANDLING CANS
DA496Z
DA101Z and DA011Z
DA500Z
Description Size Polyethylene Safety Can 4 litre (oval) Polyethylene Safety Can 10 litre (Round) Polyethylene Safety Can 20 litre (Round) Slip-on funnel Metal Safety Can 1 litre Metal Safety Can 4 litre Metal Safety Can 10 litre Metal Safety Can 20 litre Slip-on PE funnel Plunger Can 1 litre Plunger Can 2 litre Plunger Can 4 litre Dispenser Can 250 ml Dispenser Can 1 litre
Model PC140Z PC251Z PC501Z PC201Z MC101Z MC301Z MC555Z MC801Z MC200Z PC108Z PC208Z PC308Z DC004Z DC010Z
Price POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA
DRUM TAP MODEL - DA910Z
A self closing tap with internal flame arrester should be used to draw flammable liquids from a drum. The adjustable model tap can be screwed tightly into the drum, then the spout adjusted to the vertical without risk of leakage or stripping the treads.
DRUM VENT MODEL - DA101Z and DA011Z
This relieves excess internal pressure due to heat build-up. It also prevents creation of a vacuum when liquid is drained off.
DRUM - CAN ANTISTATIC BONDING WIRE - MODEL DA500Z and DRUM - EARTH ANTISTATIC WIRE - MODEL DA496Z
DA910Z
To prevent danger of sparks from electrostatic charges generated by flow of flammable liquids, bonding between the container and the drum and earthing of the drum by antistatic wires should be assured to meet H.S.E. guidelines.
MC555Z DRUM ACCESSORIES
186
Description Model Drum tap - 3/4 Brass tap adjustable, with flame arrester DA910Z Drum vent - 2” vent c/w fitting DA101Z & DA011Z 3’ Drum - Can antistatic bonding wire dual alligator clips DA500Z 10’ Drum - Earth antistatic wire hand clamp + 1 1/4” terminal DA496Z
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Price POA POA POA POA
MESH PalletS
Drum Handling
PalletS METAL Available in 2 Colours Blue Red Please specify Colour when ordering. Upright posts and base frame constructed in rolled steel angle section, base of sheet steel, with stacking feet (can be stacked 5 high). Ground clearance 152 mm. Available with sides and base infilled with sheet steel or 50 x 50 x 10 gauge mesh. Available with half drop gate. Finish POWDER COATED. Description Qty Length x Width x Effective Height x Ground Length x Width x Effective Height x Ground Length x Width x Effective Height x Ground Clearance 915 x 609 x 609 x 152 mm Clearance 915 x 915 x 609 x 152 mm Clearance 1220 x 915 x 609 x 152 mm Max Weight Max Weight Max Weight Load kg Model Price Load kg Model Price Load kg Model Price
1-9
Post Pallet
10+
1000 kg
34
PP02Z
POA
1000 kg
46
PP03Z
POA
1000 kg
56
PP04Z
POA
1-9
Box Pallet
10+
Box Pallet
1-9
With 1/2 Drop Side 10+
1000 kg 1000 kg
62 62
BP02Z BP02ZH
POA
1000 kg
72
BP03Z
POA
1000 kg
86
BP04Z
POA
POA
1000 kg
72
BP03ZH
POA
1000 kg
86
BP04ZH
POA
1-9
Mesh Pallet
10+
1000 kg
46
MP02Z
POA
1000 kg
58
MP03Z
POA
1000 kg
66
MP04Z
POA
Mesh Pallet 1-9 With 1/2 Drop Side 10+ 1000 kg 46 MP02ZH POA 1000 kg 58 MP03ZH POA 1000 kg 66 MP04ZH POA
Pallet STACKING SYSTEM Loaded Pallets can be removed without affecting those above. The Pallets sit neatly onto a framework, with sockets at each corner housing the removable posts. Special sizes are available on request. Removable Dimension Quantity Size Capacity Post Height between Weight Model Price mm kg mm Stubposts mm kg 1-9 10+ 800 x 1200 4 x 750 1220 635 x 1300 34 GPS31Z POA 1-9 10+ 800 x 1200 4 x 750 1372 635 x 1300 35 GPS41Z POA 1-9 10+ 800 x 1200 4 x 750 1524 635 x 1300 37 GPS51Z POA 1-9 10+ 1000 x 1200 4 x 750 1200 735 x 1300 35 GPS32Z POA 1-9 1372 735 x 1300 36 GPS42Z POA 10+ 1000 x 1200 4 x 750 1-9 10+ 1000 x 1200 4 x 750 1524 735 x 1300 37 GPS52Z POA 1-9 10+ 1000 x 1200 3 x 750 1677 735 x 1300 39 GPS62Z POA 1-9 10+ 1000 x 1200 3 x 750 1829 735 x 1300 40 GPS72Z POA
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
187
Drum Handling DRUM STORAGE SUMPS Floor sump Pallets • Comply to Control of Pollution (Oil Storage) (England) Regulations 2001 This range safeguards the contents of the drums from potentially contaminating work areas should a drum fail. Contents of a failed drum are captured within the seam welded sump enabling safe disposal, eliminating the possibility of polluting the environment.
• All steel construction finished in chemical resistant anticorrosive paint • Can be used in multiples to provide larger storage area • Fitted with dual purpose feet and fork guides for ease of moving • Removable galvanised mesh grid • SP1221 full height back panel with retaining side sections and webbing strap to retain the drums during transportation SP1522
SP2023
SP1221
sump flooring The 3 standard floor panel section with optional extras enables flexibility in meeting individual requirements. • Available with optional steel loading ramp & safety barriers • Flush fitting seam welded floor panels
2 x SF1001, 1 X SF2301, 1 X SR1051
Sump floor section fitted with 2 x SR1000 and 1 x SR1051
N.B. A Fork Lift will be needed to unload the SP2023, SP2523, SF2301, and SF2831
Model
SP0884 SP1582 SP2073 SP1522 SP1221 SP2023 SP2523 SF1001 SF2301 SF2831 SR1051 SR1000 SR1250
Sump Sump Sump Sump Sump Sump Sump Sump Sump Sump Optional Optional Optional Type Pallet Pallet Pallet Pallet Pallet Pallet Pallet Flooring Flooring Flooring Ramp Safety rail Safety rail Drums per sump 1 2 3 4 4 6 8 Sump cap lts 250 240 225 275 297 563 703 273 362 546 - - Length mm 800 1500 2000 1500 1250 2000 2500 1400 2300 2800 1000 1000 1250 Width mm 800 800 750 1220 1250 1250 1250 1300 1050 1300 500 40 40 Height mm 470 280 230 230 1210 305 305 160 160 160 160 1000 1000
188
Price
POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
DRUM STORAGE
Drum Handling
DRUM STORAGE Pallet SYSTEMS • Comply to Control of Pollution (Oil Storage) (England) Regulations 2001 A safe and secure system for storage and transportation of liquids. Designed to hold the contents of drum spillage. A wide range of drum storage options for storing either 2 or 4 drums. Fork guides combine to give a safe and secure lift when stacking. The two sump trolleys are mobile on 125 mm rubber castors, 2 fixed, 2 swivel braked. Model DH951S holds one drum horizontally. The drum cradle is fitted with four rollers which enables the drum to rotate. Model DH952S holds two drums vertically.
• Fork centres 550 mm
DH904S
• All swivel castors
DH914S
DH904Z
DH914Z
DH952S
DH951S
Static Model Mobile Model Overall Overall Sump Overall Ground Overall Ground Description Weight Weight Width Length Capacity mm mm Litres Height Clearance Kg Model Price Height Clearance Kg Model Price mm mm mm mm Drum Storage Pallets - Stored Vertically - Non Stackable When Loaded 2 Drum 850 1360 247 540 150 66 DH902Z POA 580 190 81 DH902S POA 4 Drum 1480 1360 432 540 150 110 DH904Z POA 580 190 125 DH904S POA Drum Storage Pallets - Stored Vertically - Stackable 3 High - 3 removable Sides 2 Drum 850 1360 247 1470 150 90 DH912Z POA 1510 190 105 DH912S POA 4 Drum 1480 1360 432 1470 150 150 DH914Z POA 1510 190 165 DH914S POA Drum Storage Pallets - Stored Horizontal - 2 fixed sides - rear opening door 2 Drum 1360 1500 432 1300 150 245 DH922Z POA 1340 190 260 DH922S POA 4 Drum 1360 1500 432 1960 150 290 DH924Z POA 2000 190 305 DH924S POA SUMP TROLLEYS 1 Drum 700 1500 247 1000 200 80 DH951S POA 2 Drum 700 1500 247 1000 200 70 DH952S POA For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
189
Drum Handling STACKABLE DRUM CARRIERS SUpports to store drums horizontally Model
SPF 452
Dimensions
Volume Litres
A
B
C
SPF 451
600
600
380
1 x 200 l. drum
SPF 452
1180
600
380
2 x 200 l. drums
SPF 453
1180
600
380
3 x 30 l. drums
Stackable drum carriers for drums up to ø 600
ECO 304
SPF 048
SPF 048
SPF 452
ECO 304
ECO 404
370
750
190
1170
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
STACKABLE DRUM CARRIERS
Drum Handling
stackable supports to store drums horizontally
SPF 352 SPT 011 Galvanized support for transfer operations
SPF 352 SPF 353
ECO 308 F
Model
Dimensions A
B
C
Volume Litres
SPF 351
835
600
810
1 x 200 l. drum
SPF 352
1335
600
810
2 x 200 l. drums
SPF 353
1335
600
810
3 x 60 l. drums
SPF 373
1960
600
810
3 x 200 l. drums
SPF 373
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628)
ECO 308 F
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
191
Drum Handling STACKABLE DRUM CARRIERS
SPF 383
SPK 383
SPG 383
SPK 383
ECO 365
ECO 365
Shelving for drums and containers consisting of : 1 tank ECO 365, 1 support SPG 383 and 1 support SPF 383
Shelving for cans consisting of : 1 tank ECO 365, 2 supports SPF 383
SPK 383
SPF 362
SPG 383
SPF 362
ECO 363
ECO 365
Shelving for containers and cans consisting of : 1 tank ECO 365, 1 support SPG 383 and 1 support SPF 383 Model
Support SPF 383
Support SPK 381
Support SPK 383
Support SPG 381
Support SPG 383
Measurement W x D x H (mm)
1335 x 600 x 790
835 x 600 x 790
1335 x 600 x 790
835 x 1120 x 790
1335 x 1120 x 790
Collection volume Volume Litres Load-bearing capacity (kg)
192
Shelving for 200 litre drums consisting of : 1 tank ECO 363, 2 supports SPF 362
-
-
-
-
-
3 x 60 l. drums
3 x 30 l. or 2 x 60 l. baskets
4 x 30 l. or 3 x 60 l. baskets
containers
containers
400
350
400
300
400
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
STACKABLE DRUM CARRIERS
Drum Handling
Flammable substances storage deposits
OUTdoor storage deposits
ECO 714 Equipped with • 1 pair of uprights • 2 pairs of shelves • 2 pairs of drum supports Suitable for flammable substances. Louvered sides for air intake to ensure required ventilation. Can be padlocked to protect contents from unauthorized persons. ECO 714 The dangerous substance storage deposit us used for storing up to four 200 l drum. When fitted with internal shelving it is possible to store 60 I. drums horizontally as well as small containers.
Model
D
Dimensions
Volume Litres
A
B
C
D
ECO 712
1350
860
1570
1080
2 drums directly on grille or on europallet 1200 x 800
ECO 714
1350
1260
1540
1080
4 drums directly on grille or on europallet 1200 x 1200
C
B A
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
193
Drum Handling STACKABLE DRUM CARRIERS
ECO 320
STORAGE FOR SMALL 1,000 litre tanks On all models it is possible to fit a special raised tilted shelf to facilitate transfer and dosing operations and ensure complete tank emptying. Versions ECO 320 - ECO 321 are ideal work stations which allow for completely safe transfer operations as they direct any possible liquid spillage to the collection tank. Specifically designed for the storage of polluting substances. Galvanised sheet splash guard sides are supplied on request.
Model ECO 320
194
Dimensions A
B
C
Collection volume/litres
2720
1315
420
1000
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
STACKABLE DRUM CARRIERS
Drum Handling
STORAGE FOR SMALL 1,000 litre tanks
2710
1160
These versions are for the storage of two 1000 l. small tanks and can be fitted with suitable raised tilted shelves which allow for the setting up of versatile stations for simultaneous transfer operations and storage. Collection volume is 1000 times. The ECO 320 - ECO 321 versions are ideal work stations which allow for completely safe transfer operations as they direct any possible liquid spillage to the collection tank. Specifically designed for the storage of polluting substances. Galvanised sheet splash guard sides are supplied on request.
1290
Model ECO 321
Dimensions A
B
C
Collection volume/litres
2720
1650
350
1000
Combination consisting of: 1 ECO 321 tank 1 splash guard side SPS 020 2 tilted supports SPC 100
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
195
Drum Handling Drum shelving SHELVING FOR DRUMS
ECO 252.9
• The shelving, suitable for the storage of 200 l. drums and 60 l. bins both vertically and horizontally. • Ideal for hazardous, toxic, harmful or flammable substances. • Thanks to its modules and range of accessories it can be modified, extended and assembled to suit different situations. • Highly stable,easy to assemble slot joint structure. • Reduced transport cost a the shelving is supplied disassembled. • Storage shelf adjustable in height. • Collection tank with galvanized bottom grille. • Wide range of accessories. Model Storage Capacity Uprights H x D Cross bars length Tank W x D x H Collection Volume l.
196
ECO 201.4
ECO 201.4V
ECO 201.6
ECO 202.6
4 x 200 l. horizontally
2 x 200 l. horizontally 2 x 200 l. vertically
6 x 60 l. horizontally
6 x 200 l. horizontally
2000 x 830
2000 x 830
2000 x 830
2000 x 830
1400
1400
1400
2200
ECO 304 1340 x 1250 x 250 + 100 foot
ECO 304 1340 x 1250 x 250 + 100 foot
ECO 304 1340 x 1250 x 250 + 100 foot
ECO 323 1340 x 1250 x 260 + 100 foot
285
285
285
615
Shelving can be assembled for all requirements with this modular system
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
ECO 201.4
Steel Flooring
Drum Handling steel flooring system with collection tank
Fasteners
Ramp
Flooring Element Model W x D (mm) Collection volume litres
ECO 14.14
ECO 19.14
ECO 29.14
ECO 29.19
1400 x 1400 h = 53
1900 x 1400 h = 53
2900 x 1400 h = 53
2900 x 1900 h = 53
80
110
170
225
Capacity (Kg/sq.m)
5000
5000
5000
5000
Driveover load per wheel
2000
2000
2000
2000
EG 14
EG 19
EG 29
45 x 1360
45 x 1860
45 x 2860
These flooring systems are suitable for the temporary storage and handling of toxic, hazardous and flammable substances in conformity to European Standards. They safeguard underground water beds and are thus an integral part of ecological storage management. The modular system can be adapted to any floor plan.
Joint Model W x D (mm)
Ramp Model W x D (mm)
RA 14
RA 19
RA 29
1380 x 470
1880 x 470
2880 x 470
Spacer
Edge fasteners
Cross Elements
Corner
25 x 120
20 x 100
130 x 130
450 x 460
Fasteners Components W x D (mm)
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
197
Drum HandlingCompacting Units “SATELLITE” COMPACTING SYSTEM Improved compacting effeciently throughout your facility. Our uninque “Satellite” compacting system features one centralized compactor for your whole facility. Remote collection containers may then be used where needed. When the collection containers are full, simply wheel them into the compactor. Eliminates the need for the multiple ineffecient trips to a central compactor throughout the day. Like having multiple compactors without the cost.
COLLECTION CONTAINER model SAT-CON
The compactor features over 16,000 lbs. of crushing force. Ideal for compacting cardboard plastic and other similar types of materials. The portable heavy-duty steel collection containers features 5” x 2” poly-on-steel casters, two rigid and two swivel. Each containers is rated at 4,000 lbs. capacity and features double-hinged swing doors and a dual locking mechanism for safety.
MODEL NUMBER
SAT-2 SAT-CON
OVERALL SIZE )W X L X H(
DESCRIPTION
SATELLITE COMPACTOR COLLECTION CONTAINER
52” X 37” X 921/2” 321/2” X 381/2” X 451/2”
CRUSHING POWER
NET WT. (POUNDS)
16,000 ----
1641 31 DC-20/FC-100
Hydraulic Drum Crusher/Compactor
Removable drum crushing platen and a two position key switch to .select crush or compact
Crushes 55 gallon steel drums to approximately 6” high and resets automatically to crush another drum in only 25 seconds. 38,000 pounds of crushing power. The included drum compacting feature allows you to compact contents inside the drum by simply removing the drum crushing platen. Crushing feature will work with any drum size up to 55 gallons. Compacting feature will only work with 55 gallon drums. This convenient design gives you two pieces of equipment in one. Safety features include a pressure relief valve, which prevents overload, and a door interlock system that will prevent the motor from running unless the door is closed. 6.5 Hp motor is 208230/460V, 3-phase, 60 Hz. Meets OSHA and JIC standards. Built-in fork pockets aid in transporting. Aluminum Drip Pan, model HDC-DPN, is available for catching any excess liquid that may be expelled during the crushing operation. The pan holds 7½ gallons and measures 30"W x 20"D x 3"H. Crating is recommended for international shipments. MODEL NUMBER
HDC-900IDC HDC-DPN HDC9-1 Crushes 55 gallon steel .drums to only 6" high
NET WT. (POUNDS)
DESCRIPTION
DRUM CRUSHER/COMPACTOR
1641
ALUMINUM DRIP PAN SINGLE PHASE, 3HP POWER UNIT
31
)OPTION FOR HDC-900-IDC( REQUIRES 50 AMP BREAKER) CYCLE TIME INCREASES TO APPROX 70 SECONDS(
DC-20/FC-100
Hydraulic Drum Stackers
The Drum Stacker is perfect for positioning 55 gallon steel, plastic and fiber drums horizontally on shelves. The solid steel construction provides stability during transit. Drums are held in place with a ratchet mechanism. Drums may easily rotate 360° with rotation method. Unit rolls easily on (2) 8" x 2" phenolic casters and (2) 5" x 2" swivel polyurethane casters. Comes standard with hydraulic foot pump. Optional power units available for the lifting operation. MODEL NUMBER
HDC-450-60 HDC-450-72 HDC-450-84 HDC-450-96 HDC-DC HDC-AC HDC-AIR
DRUM ROTATION METHOD
LIFT HEIGHT
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
HAND CRANK 60" 800 PULL CHAIN 72" 800 PULL CHAIN 84" 800 PULL CHAIN 96" 800 12V DC POWER UNIT OPTION 115V AC POWER UNIT OPTION AIR/OIL OPERATED POWER UNIT OPTION
NET WT. (POUNDS)
604 659 709 798 36 36 36 DC-20/FC-250
Stackable Drum Racks
These steel racks have two-way fork truck access. Not recommended for stacking more than two racks high. All steel construction with ¼" formed steel cradles. Bolt together assembly with hardware included. Works well with the Hydraulic Drum Stacker and the Drum Positioner. MODEL NUMBER
DRUM-RACK-2 DRUM-RACK-3
DRUM CAPACITY
OVERALL SIZE )W x D x H(
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
NET WT. (POUNDS)
(1) 55 GAL. (2) 55 GAL.
45" x 30" x 25½" 71" x 30" x 25½"
1,600 2,400
60 95 DC-20/FC-250
model DRUM-RACK-3 shown )2(
198
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Drum Lifters
Drum Handling
Automatic Eagle Beak™ Drum Lifters This time tested and proven design allows a fork truck operator to easily secure, move and release drums without leaving the seat of the fork truck. For use with open and closed head 30 and 55 gallon plastic, steel and fiber drums with a top lip strong enough to support the weight of the drum. Choose single-drum or doubledrum configuration. Includes safety chain and T-locks to secure unit to the fork truck. Welded steel construction. Powder coat finish. Fork pockets measure 6½" wide x 2½" high usable. MODEL NUMBER
NUMBER OF DRUMS
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
OVERALL SIZE )W x L x H(
NET WT. (POUNDS)
FMDL-1 FMDL-2
1 2
1,000 2,000
26½" x 46½" x 29" 42" x 49½" x 29"
240 340
model FMDL-1
DC-20/FC-70
model FPDL-8-L
model FMDL-2
Fork Mounted Poly Drum Handlers These easy to use plastic drum handlers are designed to handle odd-shaped plastic drums. Includes safety chain and T-locks for securing unit to the fork truck. Durable powder coat finish. Model FPDL-8-L has adjustable arms that are designed to fit 55 gallon round bottom plastic drums. Low drum attachment point allows for use with both open and closed head drums. Model FPDL-11-H is a top lip plastic drum lifter for use with 30 and 55 gallon plastic closed head drums. 6½" wide x 2½" high usable fork tubes on 19½" centers. High drum attachment point for use with top lip at least 3/16" high. Will also work with steel and fiber drums.
model FPDL-11-H
MODEL NUMBER
DESCRIPTION
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
OVERALL SIZE )W x L x H(
NET WT. (POUNDS)
FPDL-8-L FPDL-11-H
BOTTOM GRIP TOP GRIP
800 1,100
26½" x 56½" x 23" 26½" x 48½" x 23"
160 185 DC-20/FC-70
Deluxe Combination Fork Mounted Drum Lifter Deluxe Combination Fork Mounted Drum Lifter includes attachments to lift any type of drum; 30 and 55 gallon, steel, plastic, fiber and open or closed head drums. Includes single Eagle Beak™ unit and both bottom and top lip Poly Drum Lifters. Capacity will vary depending upon which attachment you are using. Fork pockets have an inside measurement of 6½" wide by 2½" high. Includes safety chain and T-locks for securing unit to fork truck. Welded steel construction. Powder coat finish. MODEL NUMBER
DESCRIPTION
OVERALL SIZE )W x L x H(
NET WT. (LBS)
DFDL-3
DELUXE COMBO DRUM LIFTER
26½” x 52” x 30”
313 DC-20/FC-70
Drum Positioners Allows fork truck driver to invert standing drums to the horizontal racking position and vice-versa. Positive latching system ensures safe handling of drums weighing up to 800 lbs. Slide the positioner extensions over the vertical drum. With the aid of the Drum Positioner rotate drum to horizontal position. Latching system will engage to allow horizontal positioning of drum. It’s now ready to slide into the rack. Mechanical operation relies on fork truck to rotate and lift drums. Fork pockets measure 6½"W x 2½"H usable on 19½" centers. MODEL NUMBER
DESCRIPTION
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
NET WT. (POUNDS)
DRUM-P-55 DRUM-P-30
55 GALLON STEEL DRUMS 30 GALLON STEEL DRUMS
800 800
321 315 DC-20/FC-70
Horizontal Drum Carrier Designed to load and unload open or closed head drums horizontally in racks. "T" handle locks secure cradle to the forks to maximize safety and productivity. Drum lock engages and disengages automatically as a function of the fork angle. Fork pockets measure 7½" wide by 2½" high. MODEL NUMBER
DESCRIPTION
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
HORIZ-70
OPEN OR CLOSED 55 GALLON STEEL DRUMS
650
NET WT. (POUNDS)
191 DC-20/FC-70
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
199
Drum Handling Drum Grippers Drum Grippers The Drum Gripper makes it easy to pick up one or two steel drums without leaving the seat of the fork truck. Simply slip the forks into the fork tubes and the Drum Gripper is ready to go. The knuckle gripping system is lowered around the drum, gripped tightly, and then lifted into the air. Drum is automatically released by lowering the forks. All models feature hinged folding design for storage. Models DGS-A and DGD-A feature adjustable-width arms for use with both 30-gallon and 55-gallon steel drums. Welded steel construction. Powder coat finish.
model DGS-A
model DGS-55-D
model DGD-A
model DGD-55-D
MODEL NUMBER
ACCEPTABLE DRUM SIZE
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
OVERALL SIZE )W x D x H(
FORK POCKET CENTERS
FORK POCKET )SIZE (W x H
NET WT. (POUNDS)
DGS-A DGS-55-D DGD-A DGD-55-D
(1) 30 & 55 GAL. (1) 55 GALLON (2) 30 & 55 GAL. (2) 55 GALLON
800 1,500 1,500 2,000
26" x 35" x 8" 28¼" x 24" x 8" 45" x 36" x 8" 46" x 24¼" 9½"
13½" 13½" 24" 24"
7¼" x 2½" 6¼" x 2" 7¼" x 2½" 7¼" x 2¼"
105 109 96 185 DC-20/FC-70
Electric Hydraulic Fork Mounted Drum Grippers When only the maximum in performance and control is required. The Electric Hydraulic Fork Mounted Drum Grippers accommodate 30 and 55 gallon steel, plastic and fiber drums. Available in single or double drum designs. 12V DC power standard. Battery included. Allows for lifting and moving of drums in the vertical position only. Includes hand control on coil cord for controlling the gripping arms from the seat of the fork truck. Safety chain is included to secure the gripper to the fork truck. Welded steel construction. Painted finish. MODEL NUMBER
ACCEPTABLE DRUM SIZES
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
DRUM-HYD-1 DRUM-HYD-2
55 & 30 GALLON 55 & 30 GALLON
1,000 2,000
model DRUM-HYD-1 model DRUM-HYD-2
OPERATION
12V DC 12V DC
NET WT. (POUNDS)
525 611 DC-20/FC-70
Drum Lifters Fork Mounted Fork truck attachments utilize a light duty single automatic clamping mechanism for handling any size steel or plastic chimed drum. Model FMDL-850 is a knockdown unit that bolts together. Fork pockets and safety chain provide quick and easy installation. Model FMDDL-1700 attaches to the carriage of most fork trucks and walkie stackers. The following are fork mounted drum lifters that enable fork truck operators to install or remove the attachment in seconds without any tools. Totally enclosed fork pockets with attached safety chain and cam lock secures the attachment to the fork truck.
model FMDL-850
model FMDL-1500
model FMDDL-3000
model FMDL-2000
FMDL-1500 & FMDL-3000 - Fork truck attachments utilize a heavy duty single automatic clamping mechanism for handling steel, fiber and plastic chimed drums in high volume applications. Models FMDL-2000 & FMDDL-4000 feature heavy-duty double articulating clamping mechanisms for handling any steel, plastic or fiber chimed drums in high volume applications. Each drum is gripped with two upper and lower jaws in heads that are spaced about 6 inches apart. MODEL NUMBER
ACCEPTABLE DRUM TYPES
CAPACITY POUNDS(
OVERALL SIZE )W x L x H (
NET WT. (POUNDS)
*FMDL-850 FMDL-1500 FMDL-2000 *FMDDL-1700 FMDDL-3000 FMDDL-4000
(1) STEEL, POLY OR FIBER (1) STEEL, POLY OR FIBER (1) STEEL, POLY OR FIBER (2) STEEL, POLY OR FIBER (2) STEEL, POLY OR FIBER (2) STEEL, POLY OR FIBER
750 1,500 2,000 1,500 3,000 4,000
31" x 34" x 35" 33" x 47" x 37" 33" x 47" x 37" 38" x 34" x 35" 33" x 47" x 37" 33" x 47" x 37"
160 340 366 207 430 483
LIGHT-DUTY UNIT TO HANDLE 100 OR FEWER DRUMS PER MONTH *
200
DC-20/FC-70
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
model FMDDL-4000
Dollies
Drum Handling
Multi-Purpose Dollies These multi-purpose dollies have a high polished bright zinc finish for corrosion resistance and (4) 3" x 1¼" swivel casters. Each unit comes with a 4 foot long nylon pull strap that helps in transporting down aisles or over thresh holds. Rubber-coated hook allows strap to hook on top of drum for storage Quad Dolly, series DRUM-QUAD, can transport a 5 gallon pail, 30 or 55 gallon drum or LP gas tank. Available with hard rubber or cast iron wheels. Stainless Steel, model DRUM-QUAD-CS-SS, also available.
series DRUMQUAD
series DRUM-TRI
Tri Dolly, series DRUM-TRI, will transport 5 gallon pails, 30 gallon drums or LP gas tank. MODEL NUMBER
CASTER TYPE HARD RUBBER CAST IRON HARD RUBBER HARD RUBBER CAST IRON
DESCRIPTION BRIGHT ZINC FINISH BRIGHT ZINC FINISH STAINLESS STEEL BRIGHT ZINC FINISH BRIGHT ZINC FINISH
DRUM-QUAD-H DRUM-QUAD-C DRUM-QUAD-CS-SS DRUM-TRI-H DRUM-TRI-C
MOBILE DRUM DOLLIES
CAPACITY NET WT. )POUNDS( (POUNDS) 900 30 1,200 31 900 30 900 30 1,200 31 DC-20/UPS/FC-70
Transport ordinary or specialty styled drums easily with these multipurpose Drum Dollies. Various construction, design, caster type and sizes to accommodate your application.
series DDO-P103
model DRUM-DRH-HR
MODEL NUMBER
DDO-P103-HT3 DDO-P103-SS3 DRUM-DRH-HR DRUM-DR-55-9-H DRUM-DR-55-12-C DRUM-SS-55-H DDO-P105-SS3
model DRUM-DR-55-12-C
model DRUM-SS-55-H
model DDO-P105-SS3
DESCRIPTION
DRUM TYPE )GALLON(
CASTER TYPE
APPROX. HEIGHT
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
NET WT. (POUNDS)
CAST IRON CAST IRON WITH HANDLE STEEL STEEL STAINLESS STEEL DRUM HALO
55 & 30 55 & 30 55 55 55 55 55
HARD RUBBER SEMI-STEEL HARD RUBBER HARD RUBBER CAST IRON HARD RUBBER SEMI-STEEL
4½" 4½" 6" 5" 5" 6" 4½"
1,100 1,200 1,000 900 1,200 800 750
29 32 34 20 24 22 57 DC-20/FC-70
Octo & Heavy Duty Drum Dollies The Octo Drum Dolly, model OCTO-55, will transport 55-gallon drums weighing up to 2,000 pounds. Rolls on (8) 4" x 1¼" cast iron swivel casters for maximum stability. Transport 55-gallon drums with the Heavy-Duty Drum Dolly, model DRUM-HD. With a capacity of 2,000 lbs., this dolly will transport your heavier drums from location to location. (4) 4" x 2" locking swivel phenolic casters with brakes standard.
model OCTO-55
MODEL NUMBER
model DRUM-HD
OCTO-55 DRUM-HD
ACCEPTABLE DRUM TYPES
CASTER TYPE
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
NET WT. (POUNDS)
55 GALLON 55 GALLON
CAST IRON PHENOLIC
2,000 2,000
51 57
DC-20/UPS/FC-70
Polyethylene Drum Dollies Manufactured from high impact strength polyethylene, these drum dollies are lightweight yet strong. Dollies come standard with (4) 3" swivel poly casters, and they are suited for both indoor and outdoor applications. Specify color when ordering. Choose from blue, black, green, red, yellow or white. MODEL NUMBER
ACCEPTABLE DRUM TYPES
POLY DIAMETER
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
NET WT. (POUNDS)
POLY-D-30 POLY-D-55
30 GALLON 55 GALLON
20" 24"
600 600
6 7 DC-20/UPS/FC-250
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
201
Drum Handling Drum Chocks Drum Chocks Eliminate the need for expensive specialty racks and stands to store your drums horizontally. Now with the Drum Chock you can store your drums horizontally on standard pallet racks or on wooden pallets. The chock eliminates rolling while drums are stored on their side. Models are also available to tilt drums forward for better drainage from standard faucets. Front stops are included on tilted models to eliminate drum slide off. Constructed of recycled polyethylene.
model VDRCH-1
model VDRCH-2
model VDRCH-3
model VDRCH-4
MODEL NUMBER
DESCRIPTION
WIDTH
DEPTH
HEIGHT
PIECES PER BOX
NET WT. (POUNDS)
VDRCH-1 VDRCH-2 VDRCH-3 VDRCH-4
MINI CHOCK SHELF CHOCK INCLINED SHELF INCLINED SHELF W/FORK OPTION
15" 15" 15" 18"
6" 29½" 36" 36"
2" 2" 4" 5½"
4 2 1 1
2 5 9 12 DC-20/UPS/FC-100
Manual Drum Deheaders Convert your closed head steel drums into storage containers with our Drum Deheaders. The DD-9 can be adjusted to open steel drums with different thicknesses. The blade is angled for maximum penetration and flattens the cut edge so there are no sharp or jagged edges. Replacement blades available, model DDB-1. Quickly remove the head of a steel drum in less than 30 seconds with our new Express-Open Drum Deheader! Unique design, model D-HEAD-1, is similar to a household can-opener and is very easy to use. Comfortable handle configuration allows for maximum operator comfort. Includes vice-grip style mechanism for securely attaching unit to drum. A standard ½" ratchet drive (manual or pneumatic) must be used to operate the deheader (ratchet drive not included). Inside cutting blade does not leave a sharp edge on the drum. Replacement blades available separately, model D-HEAD-1-B. Both styles open 30 & 55 gallon steel drums and 5 gallon pails. MODEL NUMBER
DESCRIPTION
NET WT. (POUNDS)
DD-9 DDB-1 D-HEAD-1 D-HEAD-B D-HEAD-GK
STANDARD DRUM DEHEADER REPLACEMENT BLADE FOR DD-9 EXPRESS-OPEN DRUM DEHEADER REPLACEMENT BLADE FOR D-HEAD-1 REPLACEMENT GEAR/BUSHING KIT FOR D-HEAD-1
11 1 10 1 1
model DD-9
model D-HEAD-1
DC-20/UPS/FC-70
Steel Drum Tops Drum Tops are steel covers that fit over 55 gallon drums. They are used for recycling and general waste disposal. General Waste Disposal Tops, series TRASH-TOP features powder coated finish with ultra violet stabilizer and screws for securing cover to drum. Recycling Top, model CAN-CAP, includes a “CANS ONLY” decal. The disposal hole measures 3½".
model TRASH-TOP-R
model CAN-CAP
MODEL NUMBER
DESCRIPTION
COLOR
OVERALL SIZE )H x D(
NET WT. (POUNDS)
TRASH-TOP-R TRASH-TOP-G TRASH-TOP-B CAN-CAP
GENERAL WASTE TOP GENERAL WASTE TOP GENERAL WASTE TOP RECYCLING TOP
RED GREEN BLACK BLUE
8½" x 24½" 8½" x 24½" 8½" x 24½" 24½" DIA.
14 14 14 8
DC-20/UPS/FC-65/250
Refuse Containers Durable polyethylene construction with stands subzero cold and extreme summer heat. Great for high traffic areas such as: warehouses, fairs, ball parks, schools, etc. Each container includes two wheels for easy portability. Hinged lip keeps rain out. Keep your waste out of eyesight in our heavy duty and easy to move refuse containers.
model TH-64
202
model TH-32
MODEL NUMBER
VOLUME CAPACITY
COLOR
OVERALL SIZE )W x D x H(
NET WT. (POUNDS)
TH-64 TH-32
64 GALLONS 32 GALLONS
GREY GREEN
23" x 29" x 41" 18½" x 22" x 37½"
55 35 DC-25/FC-250
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Drum Handling
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
203
MATERIAL HANDLING CONVEYORS Gravity conveyors the cost effective solution for transporting unit loads. • Can be installed horizontally wherever movement of the load is manually controlled. • A shallow decline can be created by adjusting the stand height, allowing loads to be moved under the force of gravity. • Can also be used in combination with powered conveyors in integrated systems. • Cost effective solutions to materials handling needs. • Rollers reduce surface friction allowing goods to move manually. • Suits flat based goods or those transported in flat based containers. • Can supported loads up to 110kg per meter
Roller Straight • Available in medium duty, heavy duty and extra heavy duty. • Lengths 2.0m and 3.0m • 300, 400, 450, 500, 600, 800BB 800* * (heavy duty & extra heavy duty only • Pitch: • Medium Duty 42, 83, 125 & 167mm Heavy Duty 83, 125, • 167 & 250mm Extra Heavy Duty 83, 125, 167 & 250mm
A full range of accessories is available including: • Facia • Endstops • Blade and roller stops • Side Guides • Stands • Spurs
Roller Curve • Available in medium duty, heavy duty, extra heavy duty and tapered roller curves. • 30, 45. 60, and 90 degrees. • 300, 400, 450, 500, 600, 800BB 800* * (heavy duty & extra heavy duty only • Pitch: • Medium Duty 45mm and 90mm Heavy Duty 55mm and • 110mm Extra Heavy Duty 55mm and 110mm
Ball Tables The ball units are mounted in a square infill section that is designed to locate between the channel frames of gravity roller conveyor at any position along the track length. They may be joined together to form a continuous length of ball table. 300, 400, 450, 500, 600, 800BB
PITCH
Roller Personnel Gate Available in medium duty, heavy duty and extra heavy duty. 300, 400, 450, 500, 600, 800BB 800* *(heavy duty & extra heavy duty only) Pitch: Medium Duty 42mm and 83mm Heavy Duty 83mm and 125mm Extra Heavy Duty 83mm and 125mm
Package
Weight Kg
Gravity Roller Fall (F) in mm per metre
mm per 90
Cartons
2
*
*
Wooden Cases
PITCH
• Loads must always be in full contact with at least three rollers; to ascertain the maximum pitch required between rollers, divide the length of the load by 3.5. • Flexible loads, cardboard cartons and fragile loads should be on reduced roller pitches. Loads with uneven surfaces can be carried on flat trays or pallets. * Loads under 5kg when used on gravity roller should be tested prior to installation. Please note: Loads in excess of 50kg are dangerous when allowed to run away on a gradient
204
Tote Boxes
5
50
125
10
40
125
20
30
90
2
50
125
5
30
100
10
20
100
25
15
75
5
40
125
10
30
100
25
20
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628)
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
CONVEYORS
MATERIAL HANDLING
Powered conveyors the effective solution for transporting unit loads. Belt Conveyor G Flow systems range of powered belt conveyors is designed for applications where improved load control and speed of operation are important factors. They are particularly useful when a conveyor is required to carry fragile loads or a wide range of load weights or sizes. Level Belt Level Belt conveyors are for the horizontal transportation of items and assembly line operations. They are available in lengths from 2m up to 30m in 0.5m increments. They are constructed using cold formed steel and powder coated channels with two bed type options - Monobed and Roller bed.
Inclined Belt Inclined belt conveyors are used to deliver packages or boxes from one floor to another and when fitted with a reversing control can operate in either direction. They can be used as stand alone units or as integrated elements of a conveyor system.
• Centre Driven belt speeds 9, 14, 18, 24 and 30m per minute. • End Driven by a motorised drum, belt Speeds -15.6, 18.6 and • 21.6m per minute - up to 10m long. • Robust and durable 2-ply transmission belt. • Level belt conveyors can be used with the majority of package • conveyor accessories • Low noise operation
• Centre Driven belt speeds 9, 14, 18, 24 and 30m per minute. • Robust and durable 2-ply feeder transmission belt and gripface • incline belt. • Incline belt conveyors can be used with the majority of package • conveyor accessories • Powered feeder for positive transfer from horizontal to incline. • Top curve for smooth transfer from incline to horizontal Lineshaft • Conveyor
Lineshaft Conveyor For packages as small as 250mm in length. Handles packages up to 30kg at speeds of up to SOm/min. A full range of accessories is available including: • Facia • Spurs • Guides • Wallaby • Under Guards • Switch • Crossdrive Unit • Roller Stop • Blade Stop • Stands • Transfer
• Slave and driving straights available • Modules up to 3 metres in length • 83mm,125mm and 167mm roller pitch
• Full range of widths. • 30, 45, 60 and 90 degree curves • Tapered rollers
• Full range of widths. • 90 and 180 degree corner turns • Available in 600mm2 and 900mm2
Straight These modules are supplied as a driving straight or slave straight. With the slave straight being the most commonly used of all the modules, when using a Lineshaft Conveyor System.
Curve Rollers are tapered and multi-grooved to facilitate the driving belts and jump belts. Each drive shaft is connected by flexible precision universal joints, fitted with needle roller bearings for smooth quiet running, governed by the length of belt itself.
Corner Turn The corner turn module allows a 90° change of direction in a space of 600mm or 900mm square; the outside rollers rotate faster than the inside rollers, to help drive the packages through the turn. Two modules may be assembled together where a 180° turn is required. A 600mm square corner turn is used for conveyors having back to back sizes of 300, 400, 450, and 500mm. A 900mm square corner turn is used for conveyors 600mm and 800mm square back to back.
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
205
MATERIAL HANDLING CONVEYORS • Manufactured to the highest specifications. • 2 ply smooth top PVC blet with vulcanized joint. • Fully underguarded. • Finish - Blue 18 -E-53 • Mild steel folded slider bed, 120mm deep. • Complete with stop/start control. • Support legs allow adjustment or blet height from • 750 - 1150mm.
DRUM DRIVE BELT CONVEYOR • Loading - 25kg per metre U.D.L. • 2Drive - 0.15kw, 415v 3ph. • Fixed speed - 15 metres per minute. • Single direction
VEHICLE LOADER/UNLOADERS • Extremely versatile and easy to move powered belt • conveyor. • Can reduce loading/off loading by up to 50% • With the optional Flexible Tongue it can extend up • to 7 metres into the vehicle. • Capable of handling loads up to 50kg per minute. • Hydraulic adjustment on main boom. • Single phase 240v with controls top and bottom. • Belt width - 600mm.
206
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Fo converya tailored r so call 8o 00-LOluCtion, 8
CONVEYORS
MATERIAL HANDLING
Flexible CONVEYOR • Choice of 50mm diameter plastic skate wheels. • Can be used alone or together with other conveyor systems. • Simply wheel to any area for use, extend to required length and lock castors for stability. • All metal parts zinc plated steel. • Roller pitch when extended - 125mm.
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628)
• Support stands fitted with 100mm diameter swivel braked castors. • Support stands adjustable in height from 650 - 1100mm. Standard duty SKATE WHEEL flexible conveyor
Standard duty roller flexible conveyor
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
207
MATERIAL HANDLING CONVEYORS The lightweight, portable UNI-LOADA offers fast loading / unloading of tyres, wheels, boxes etc... Even direct from lorry / container to mezzanine...
...Ideal even for shredders.
Technical Specifications: • Two Lengths (5m or 6m) • Overall weight 100 kgs. • 0.550 kw drum motor. 240V 13 amp. • 2 speed - forward & reverse • 270mm wide griptop rubber belt with flights. • Belt speed 20m/minute slow, 26m/minute fast. • Remote handset at top. • Complete with base stand. • Maximum working angle 45 degrees. • Maximum vertical lift 4m or 5m (depending on product). • Maximum payload 80 kg • Lightweight aluminium protable construction with locking wheels. • 12 months warranty.
208
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
PALLET WRAPPING MACHINES
MATERIAL HANDLING
ROTOPLAT 106 / FRD • Turntable 1650mm diameter for pallets up to 1000 x 1200mm. • Standard load capacity 2 tonnes. • Rugged construction for durability and strength. Spool carriage with mechanical roller stretch system. Stretch ratio adjustable from 0% up to 200% by electromagnetic brake. Brake coupling after cycle start for easy film binding to pallet base.
FS Spool carriage with electromagnetic brake on return roller. Stretch tension adjustable from panel board. Brake coupling after cycle start for easy film binding to pallet base.
FR Spool carriage with electromagnetic brake on return roller. Manually adjustable stretch tension. Carriage fitted with a device for easy film binding to pallet base.
FRD
ROTOPLAT 506 / PFS TOP OF THE RANGE MODEL FOR HIGH VOLUME USERS Spool carriage with powered frictioned stretch system. Stretch ratio adjustable from 0% up to 250% by electromagnetic brake. Force to the load controlled by patented electronic device and adjustable from panel board.
PFS
• Models to suit wet and corrosive environments. • Available with mast heights up to 2.8 metres. • Top clamp option for use with unstable products. • Standard load capacity 2 tonnes. • Heavy-duty version for 3+ tonnes. Also available in the “TP” version, designed to facilitate direct loading by pallet truck. No need for a forklift operator to load the pallet onto the turntable.
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
209
MATERIAL HANDLING PALLET WRAPPING ROBOPAC START The entry level Start turntable machine combines simplicity of operation with quality of construction, so although it is a low cost model, the specifications are impressive: • Maximum turntable load 1200 kgs. • Working height 2100mm (including pallet). • Turntable 1500mm diameter for pallets up to 800 x 1200mm. • Soft start & stop to ensure no product “toppling”. • “FRD” spool carriage. • Height sensing photocell. • Available with ramp for pallet truck loading.
ROTOPLAT JOLLY Semi-autOMATIC STRETCH WRAPPING TURNTABLE • Maximum turntable load 2000 kgs. • Working height 2400mm (including pallet). • Turntable 1650mm dia. for pallets up to 1000 x 1200mm. • Soft start & stop to ensure no product “toppling”. • Spool carriage stop button for reinforcing wraps. • “FRD” spool carriage. • Height sensing photocell. • Available with ramp for pallet truck loading. • Top and bottom wrapping rounds selection.
STARTAPE® M
• A new range of taping machines, giving • the best solution to the most difficult applications in • handling, folding and sealing of carton boxes with • adhesive paper or tape. • Easy and rational technical solutions, such as the drive • motor located below the feeding conveyor and the • adjusting systems all in one side and make the machines • easy to use.
• Side box pressing wheels with adjustable • height to ensure taping even on • small sized boxes.
• 3 top flaps-folding device (option)
• Idle rollers conveyor section
210
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
load securing systems
PRODUCTS
MATERIAL HANDLING
APPLICATION
CORDSTRAP® CC STRAP • Re-Tensionable • As strong as steel • High abrasion resistence • Chemical resistant
CORDSTRAP® CW STRAP • Extremely flexible • Will not split • Will not rush • Safe handling
CORDLASH®
• Heavy Duty “One way” securing lashings • Safe and secure • Easier to handle than steel banding or wire • Cost effective compared to conventional • load securing materials • Elimination of damage to products • Faster to work with
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628)
cordstrap DUNNAGE BAGS ACCESSORIES
• Fast and effective method of preventing movement and thus damage of goods during transportation in containers, rail wagons, ship holds & trucks. Available in numerous sizes for all applications. • Plastic • Recycled • Card Board • Environmentally friendly & safe to use
Edge Protection
• Manual hand tools • Pneumatic tools • Heavy duty lashing tools
Tensioners • Prevents moisture damage • High absorption
Desiccants
• Lightweight • One hand operation • Tensioning & welding • Clear LED indication
Orgapack Battery Tooling • Static dispensers • Mobile dispensers • For all sizes of straps
• All sizes • Smooth & embossed • Manual & machine grade
Pet Strapping
Dispensers For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
211
MATERIAL HANDLING load securing systems Cordstrap® strapping applications
Timber Industry
Metal Goods
Glass Industry
Building Materials
Machine Industry
• Bale Press
Doors & Window Frames
Benefits • Cordstrap®, it is designed to protect your employees and customer • from injuries while providing maximum load containment strength. • There are no sharp edges when cut, and it does not spring back like • steel banding. This quality offers protection for employees, customers and machinery.
• Cordstrap® is as strong as steel with comparable break strengths • to conventional steel banding. Due to the elongation properties and • shock absorbance capacities, Cordstrap® Corded Polyester • Strapping requires more energy to break. It is also five times lighter • allowing for ease and flexibility of use. • Corded polyester strapping will not stain your products.
cordlash® applications
CORDSTRAP® DUNNAGE BAG applications
Containers
Ships
Containers
Reefer
Containers
Road Transport
Railway Wagons
Road Transport
Cordstrap® Composite Lashing • Similar to Cordstrap® Composite Strapping, it is the latest • technology in flexible, non-metallic lashing and most commonly • used. Cordstrap® Composite lashings are available in a variety of • widths and strengths up to 5,000 DaN (11,000 lbs). • Composite lashings are widely used to secure cargo in trucks, • railcars and ISO containers for various commodities including, but • not limited to, chemicals, machinery, paper reels and food goods. • Breaking strengths of all composite lashings are independently • certified by Germanischer Lloyd’s and adhere to European Railway • regulations. In addition, Cordstrap® CC 105 is approved by the • American Association of Railroads for use in closed car loading • applications.
212
Chemical Industry
Cordstrap® Dunnage Bags • Cordstrap® Dunnage Bags are specially designed inflatable bags • used for stabilising and securing cargo inside containers, railcars, • trucks, and ships, preventing transit damage • Cordstrap® Dunnage Bags are placed in the void between the • cargos. When inflated they form a 3-dimensional bulkhead thus • preventing the cargo from shifting. • Cordstrap® Dunnage Bags are constructed of one or more layers • of wet-strength kraft paper with a polyethylene liner. The bags are • available in different strengths and a wide variety of sizes from • 60 x 60 cm (24” x 24“) to 120 x 225 cm (48” x 96”) and special sizes • are available upon request.
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
PORTABLE GANTRIES
MATERIAL HANDLING
Portable GantRIes • Easy to assemble - No spanners required • Foldaway design - Comes complete with assembly instructions • Gantries are complete with castors • Gantries can be supplied with optional extras, wheel brakes, polyurethane tyred wheels, parking jacks, taut wire or track festoon electrics. Please ask for details Description 3 Metre Height/3 Metre Span
Capacity 250kgs
3 Metre Height/3 Metre Span 3 Metre Height/3 Metre Span 3 Metre Height/3 Metre Span 3 Metre Height/3 Metre Span 3 Metre Height/3 Metre Span 3 Metre Height/3 Metre Span 3.5 Metre Height/3 Metre Span 3.5 Metre Height/3 Metre Span 3.5 Metre Height/3 Metre Span 3.5 Metre Height/3 Metre Span 3.5 Metre Height/3 Metre Span 3.5 Metre Height/3 Metre Span 3.5 Metre Height/3 Metre Span
500kgs 1000kgs 1500kgs 2000kgs 3000kgs 5000kgs 250kgs 500kgs 1000kgs 1500kgs 2000kgs 3000kgs 5000kgs
Description
Capacity
3.5 Metre Height/3.5 Metre Span 3.5 Metre Height/3.5 Metre Span 3.5 Metre Height/3.5 Metre Span 3.5 Metre Height/3.5 Metre Span 3.5 Metre Height/3.5 Metre Span 3.5 Metre Height/3.5 Metre Span 3.5 Metre Height/3.5 Metre Span 4 Metre Height/4 Metre Span 4 Metre Height/4 Metre Span 4 Metre Height/4 Metre Span 4 Metre Height/4 Metre Span 4 Metre Height/4 Metre Span 4 Metre Height/4 Metre Span 4 Metre Height/4 Metre Span
250kgs 500kgs 1000kgs 1500kgs 2000kgs 3000kgs 5000kgs 250kgs 500kgs 1000kgs 1500kgs 2000kgs 3000kgs 5000kgs
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Price £684.00 £706.00 £793.00 £1015.00 £1076.00 £1119.00 £1138.00 £867.00 £889.00 £979.00 £1035.00 £1096.00 £1143.00 £1165.00
213
MATERIAL HANDLING TROLLEYS Compact all-rounders For multi-functional use
With safety handles, application with tubular footplate for transporting e.g. large crates and parcels.
With dog-ear handles, application with short, flat footplate for easy insertion under heavy loads.
Chair trucks For use in hotels and congress venues Height-adjustable loading frame for transporting stacked chairs
With bags Accessory
Baggage and four-wheel trolleys Professional equipment – elegant and convenient • This multifunctional four-wheel trolley is available with one or two side walls or with two end walls. • This baggage trolley ensures fast and trouble-free baggage handling in the hotel lobby, even if large groups are checking in or out.
214
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Lightweight Trucks
MATERIAL HANDLING
SUPER COMPACT TRUCKS • Lightweight • Simple to Use • Unfold in seconds! • Easy to carry
GI025Y Shown folded
Three versions available, the original super compact truck model G1033Y which is approved to the European GS Standard, the ‘mini’ model G1025Y and alternatively the heavy duty version model G1043Y. All units are of Aluminium construction and fold and unj seconds. These units can be stored or transported y confined spaces making them ideal for deliveries.
Model GI025Y is with elasticated load retaining straps
GI025Y
GI033Y Shown folded
Model GI033Y is GS Approved and has elasticated load retaining straps
GI033Y
Close up of padded handles and easy to use extending button on Model GI043Y. Handles shown folded flat for compact storage.
Model GI043Y has a large folding foot
GI043Y Shown folded
GI033Y
Model
Decription
Load Capacity (kg)
Dimensions H x W x D mm when folded
Dimensions H x W x D mm when open
Toe Plate W x D (mm)
Wheels (mm)
Weight (kg)
GI025Y
‘Mini’ Compact Truck
60
650 x 390 x 60
1000 x 400 x 420
390 x 240
2 x 120
3
GI033Y
Super Compact Truck
100
700 x 490 x 60
1000 x 490 x 450
490 x 270
2 x 180
4
GI043Y
Large Compact Truck
200
1010 x 595 x 97
1255 x 620 x 600
590 x 335
2 x 200
10
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
215
MATERIAL HANDLING Stairclimbers TELESCOPIC STAIRCLIMBER WITH SKIDS Toe Plate Size:290 x 350mm Mounted on 150mm wheels on a ‘3 star’ system Max Load:50kgon stairs 150kgas a sack truck Fitted with knuckleguard hand grips& wheel guards
WIDE STAIRCLIMBER Fixed & folding toe plates Complete with adjustable strap Folding Toe Plate Size: 395 x 460mm Mounted on160mm wheels on a ‘3 star’ system Max Load 50kg on stairs 150k as truck
GI390Y Folded
GI390Y Overall Size H x W x D mm 1230 x 500 x 680
Folded Size H x W x D mm 830 x 500 x 430
Weight kg 15.5
Overall Size H x W x D mm 1160 x 605 x 795
Model
GI360Y
Fixed Toe Plate Size W x D mm 410 x 200
Weight kg 22
Model GI360Y
GI390Y
STAIRCLIMBER WITH SKIDS
STAIRCLIMBER WITH SKIDS
Toe Plate Size:395 x 460mm Mounted on150mm wheels on a ‘3 star’ system Max Load:60kgon stairs 150kgas a sack truck Fitted with knuckle guard hand grips& wheel guards
Toe Plate Size:395 x 460mm Mounted on150mm wheels ona ‘3 star’ system Max Load: 60kgon stairs Max Load: 150kgin sack truck mode Fitted with knuckle guard hand grips & wheel guards
SKIDS ENABLE THESE STAIRCLIMBERS TO BE LOADED OR UNLOADED HORIZONTALLY &VERTICALLY
GI370Y Overall Size H x W x D mm all x 600 e 1180 x 480 D
216
Weight kg 11
Model GI370Y Model
GI380Y Overall Size H x W x D mm ize 1180 x 500 x 550 Hx x mm
Weight kg W 8.5
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Model GI380Y
Handling Equipment
Adjustable Strap holding items in place
STAIRCLIMBERS
MATERIAL HANDLING
TS250Z Wider Foot Iron
TS154Y With Wheel Lock
TS152Y
TS155Y
HEAVY DUTY STAIRCLIMBERS • Max Load 200 kg in Sack Truck Position • Safe Working Load on Stairs: 50kg • Foot iron size 200 x 300 mm (D x W) • 150 x 50 mm Rubber Plain Bearing Wheels. A multi-purpose stairclimbing sack truck designed with safety in mind. Retarding brake for safe handling on stairs. Wheel lock converts truck to a 2-wheel sack truck. Standard folding foot.
TS265Y Compactly Folded
Description
Height x Width mm
Depth mm (toe folded)
Weight
Model
Price
Basic tri-wheel model
1200 x 470
430
20 kg
TS152Y
POA
Basic stairclimber with wheel lock
1200 x 470
430
23 kg
TS154Y
POA
Basic stairclimber with lock & retarding brake
1200 x 470
430
25 kg
TS155Y
POA
Wider foot iron size 250d x 430w (mm)
—
—
—
TS250Z
POA
TS165Y Compactly Folded TCS60Y Folded
TS160Y
TS260Y
Light weight STAIR CLIMBERS
STAIRCLIMBERS
• Max Load 150 kg in Sack Truck Position • Max Load 110 kg in Sack Truck Position • Safe Working Load on Stairs: 50kg • Safe Working Load on Stairs: 50kg • Foot iron size 355 x 395 mm (D x W) • Foot iron size 345 x 260 mm (D x W) • 150 x 50 mm Rubber Plain Bearing Wheels Ideal for safe handling on stairs. Both models • 160 x 40 mm Rubber Plain Bearing Wheels This lightweight stairclimber is available as either have a large folding foot iron. Compact model a standard or compact model. Compact model TS165Y has a folded height of 670mm TS265Y has a folded height of 670 mm. Description Height x Width Weight Model Description
Height x Width
Weight
Model
Standard
1092 x 432 mm
13 kg
TS260Y
Compact
1092 x 432 mm
13 kg
TS265Y
Standard
1150 x 610 mm
20 kg
TS160Y
Compact
1150 x 610 mm
20 kg
TS165Y
TCS60Y
Lightweight STAIRCLIMBER • Max Load 150 kg in Sack Truck Position • Safe Working Load on Stairs: 50kg • Foot iron size 340 x 260 mm (D x W) • 140 x 34 mm Rubber Wheels A lightweight stairclimber with a folding toe for compact storage. Height x Width
Weight
Model
1110 x 430 mm
11 kg
TCS60Y
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
217
MATERIAL HANDLING
Light weight Compact Trucks
HAND pallet truck - 2000 kg Unfold in seconds Lightweight, simple to use & easy to carry Three versions available GI025Y - the ‘mini’ model GI033Y - the ‘super’ model GI043Y - the ‘heavy duty’ model All units are of Aluminium construction These units can be stored or transported in confined spaces making them ideal for deliveries ‘HEAVYDUTY’ COMPACT TRUCK
‘SUPER’ COMPACT TRUCK
MINI’ COMPACT TRUCK
GI033Y
GI043Y
GI025Y
Fitted with elasticated load retaining straps
GI033Y
GI025Y Folded
Description
218
Fitted with elasticated load retaining straps
Large folding toe
GI043Y Folded
GI033Y Folded Load Capacity kg
Overall Size H x W x D mm when folded
Overall Size H x W x D mm when open
Toe Plate W x D mm
Wheels mm
Weight kg
Model
Mini Compact
60
650 x 390 x 60
1000 x 400 x 420
390 x 240
2 x 120
3
GI025Y
Super Compact
100
700 x 490 x 60
1000 x 490 x 450
490 x 270
2 x 180
4
GI033Y
Heavy Duty Compact
200
1010 x 595 x 97
1255 x 620 x 600
590 x 335
2 x 200
10
GI043Y
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Folding Sack Trucks
MATERIAL HANDLING
‘THE PRO’ HEAVY DUTY FOLDING ALUMINIUM SACK TRUCK Quickly & easily folds for compact storage & transportation The toe plate, wheels & handles fold into the sack truck with a simple move of the handles 2x200mm puncture-proof Rubber wheels Folding Toe Plate Size: 310W x 310D mm Fitted with large wheel guards
THIS
TO THIS
TO THIS
Easy tilt mechanism
Max Load
270 KG
Simply turn the handles towards the sack truck. This will then allow the toe plate to lift & the wheels to fold in to the compact mode - ideal for storage / transportation Overall Size - Open Overall Size - Folded H x W x D mm H x W x D mm 1150 x 480 x 520 1165 x 435 x 145
Weight kg 6
Model
GI270H
GI270H
COMPACT SACK TRUCK Aluminium frame with a folding Steel toe plate Easily folded to fit in your car/van boot Easily carried & stored once folded 2x150mm solid Rubber wheels
Max Load
FOLDED IN SECONDS EASY TO CARRY & STORE
90 KG
MANUAL HANDLING OPERATIONS REGULATIONS 1992 recommends helping to reduce the riskof injury from those operations so faras is reasonably practicable i.e wherepossible provide mechanical assistance,for example a sack truck Overall Size - Open H x W x D mm 1090 x 412 x 406
Overall Size - Folded H x W x D mm 715 x 412 x 190
Toe Plate Size W x D mm 360 x 250
GI960Y Folded
Weight kg 7
Model GI960Y
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
219
MATERIAL HANDLING LIGHTWEIGHT TROLLeYS ECONOMY FOLDING TROLLEYS • Excellent Value An economy range of folding patform trucks. Sheet steel base covered with an attractive non-slip red PVC surface. The folding handle allows compact storage. Model
Overall L x W x H mm
Load Capacity (kg)
Castor Diameter (kg)
Weight (kg)
GI102Y
730 x 470 x 830
150
100
8
GI103Y
910 x 610 x 880
250
120
15
Max Load 150kg
Max Load 250kg
GI102Y
GI103Y
FOLDING TROLLEYs
• Non marking wheels • High quality finish Flat pressed sheet steel base, covered with non-slip, non-marking PVC surface. Trolleys fold and unfold in seconds, and can be stored in a limited amount of space
LARGE WHEELED FOLDING TROLLEY
• Heavy Duty wheels Platform trolley ideal for Heavy Duty use. The large pnuematic wheels make it ideal for rough terrain. The unit also folds to make it easy to store.
Max Load 150kg
GI099P Folded
GI002Y
GI003Y
GI099P
Model
Overall L x W x H mm
Load Capacity (kg)
Castor Diameter (kg)
Weight (kg)
GI002Y
734 x 480 x 790
170
100
14
GI003Y
920 x 620 x 890
250
130
25
Model
Overall L x W x H mm
Wheels
Weight (kg)
GI009P
870 x 560 x 900
4 x 300 mm Pneumatic 2 x swivel, 2 x fixed
22
HEAVY DUTY PLASTIC PLATFORM TROLLEYS
• Tough, industrial grade honeycomb plastic platform - will not rust, dent or chip • Removable handles • Anti-slip surface • Hard wearing 160mm polypropylene wheels • Strong and easy to clean Models HI904C and HI974C have 2 fixed, 2 swivel wheels. Models HI906C and HI976C have 2 fixed, 4 swivel wheels, giving increased load capacity and manoeuvrability. Model
Description
Max Load 350kg
Max Load 1000kg HI904C
Load Capacity (kg)
Platform L x W (mm)
Overall L x W x H mm
Weight (kg)
4 wheeled units HI904C
Single End
1000
1510 x 750
1700 x 750 x 965
62
HI974C
Double End
1000
1510 x 750
1780 x 750 x 965
64
6 wheeled units
220
HI976C
HI906C
Single End
1500
1510 x 750
1700 x 750 x 965
67
HI976C
Double End
1500
1510 x 750
1780 x 750 x 965
69
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Max Load 1500kg
SHELF TROLLEYS
HI834Y
MATERIAL HANDLING
SHELF TROLLEY • Easy to clean • Clearance between shelves: 280mm An attractive shelf trolley with hard wearing black plastic shelves and grey aluminium uprights. The shelves have a 25mm lip to 3 sides and a 5mm rim to one side making items easier to get to. Fitted with 4 swivel non-marking rubber castors. Optional plastic buckets can be purchased for the shelf trolley to give added versatility. Model
Overall L x W x H mm
Wheel Size (mm)
Weight (kg)
HI834Y
840 x 430 x 910
75
9
Max Load 90kg
DEEP SHELF TROLLEYS • Mallet for easy assembly • 70mm deep trays • Will not rust, dent or chip Super strong polyethylene moulded trolleys ideal for a variety of environments - storerooms, offices schools etc. Constructed from a non-conductive material and resistant to most substances. Fitted with 4 x 100 mm swivel castors, 2 with brake.
Model
Overall L x W x H mm
Dimensions Between Shelves (mm)
Weight (kg)
610 x 460 x 980
660
10.5
610 x 460 x 1000
305
14
2 Shelf Unit GI627L 3 Shelf Unit GI637L
GI637L
Max Load 120kg
GI627L
PLASTIC SERVICE TROLLEYS
• Multi purpose, impact resistant, moisture resistant trolleys • 2 fixed, 2 swivel non-marking 125mm rubber castors • Ergonomic Push / Pull Handle Of heavy duty plastic construction, these units are tough enough for most environments. The units are easy to clean and will not chip or dent. The push / pull handle has storage facilities for those small easy to lose items.
Model
Description
Overall L x W x H mm
Shelf Heights (mm)
Weight (kg)
HI924C
2 Shelf
950 x 440 x 850
150, 850
18
HI934C
3 Shelf
950 x 440 x 850
150, 500, 850
22
HI925C
2 Shelf
1100 x 650 x x 850
150, 850
23
HI935C
3 Shelf
1100 x 650 x x 850
150, 500, 850
30
HI925C
Max Load 225kg
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
HI934C
221
MATERIAL HANDLING Plastic Trolleys SERVICE TROLLEYS WITH STRONG SQUARE LEGS Strong Polyethylene Moulded Trolley Easy to clean - will not rust, dent or chip Manufactured from a non-conductive Polyethylene which will not passan electrical current & is unaffectedby battery acid, solvents & cleaning solutions Mobile on 4 x 100mm swivel castors, 2 with brakes
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628) Max Load
90 KG
Overall Size LxWxH 610 x 458 x 864
Description 3 Shelf, 3 Flat Shelves
GI391L
Size Between Shelves Top / Bottom mm 305 / 305
Weight kg 12
Model GI391L
SERVICE TROLLEYS WITH STRONG SQUARE LEGS Strong Polyethylene Moulded Trolleys Easy to clean - will not rust, dent or chip 3Colour Options Available Blue
Green
Red
please specify when ordering
Manufactured from a non conductive Polyethylene which will not pass an electrical current & is unaffected by battery acid, solvents & cleaning solutions Mobile on 4 x 100mm swivel castors, 2 with brakes
Max Load
150 KG
Description 2 Shelf - top flat shelf, bottom storage trays 3 Shelf - top & middle flat shelves & bottom storage trays
Size Between Shelves Top / Bottom mm 660
610 x 458 x 980
Weight kg 11
GI851L
Model
305 / 305
12
GI852L
3 Shelf - top, middle & bottom storage trays
305 / 305
13.5
GI853L
2 Shelf - top flat shelf, bottom storage trays
635
19.5
GI861L
280 / 280
26
GI862L
280 / 280
28
GI863L
3 Shelf - top & middle flat shelves & bottom storage trays 3 Shelf - top, middle & bottom storage trays
222
Overall Size LxWxH
813 x 610 x 915
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Plastic Trolleys
MATERIAL HANDLING
GI334L GI335L
Max Load
150 KG
GI237L
GI337L
GI488CL
Super Strong Polyethylene Moulded Trolleys Easy to clean, versatile - will not rust, dent or chip Ideal for use in workshops, storerooms, warehouses, chemical & pharmaceutical industries Manufactured from a non conductive Polyethylene which will not pass an electrical current& is unaffected by battery acid, solvents & cleaning solutions Models GI337L & GI237L have a higher load capacity as the shelves are re-inforced with a Steel bar Depth of storage trays: 100mm Mobile on 4 x 100mm non marking Rubber swivel castors, 2 with brakes
2 Shelf Trolley
Overall Size L x W x H mm 890 x 610 x 880
Size Between Shelves Top / Bottom mm 650
Weight kg 16
GI334L
3 Shelf Trolley
890 x 610 x 865
292 / 292
22
GI335L
Top flat shelf, cupboard with flat shelf
895 x 615 x 1230
480 / 388
39
GI488CL
2 Storage Trays
920 x 640 x 960
635
20
GI237L
3 Storage Trays
920 x 640 x 975
280 / 280
24
GI337L
Description
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Model
223
MATERIAL HANDLING Shelf Trolleys
GI534L Max Load
150 KG
GI541L
GI543L GI538L
GREY SHELF TROLLEYS Super Strong Polyethylene Moulded Trolleys Will not rust, dent or chip - easy to clean These easy to manoeuvre units are ideal for use in offices, schools, workshops, maintenance departments, storerooms etc Constructed from a non conductive material which is resistant to most substances Mobile on 4 x 100mm swivel castors, 2 with brakes
GI536L
LARGER RANGE
STANDARD RANGE No of Shelves 36
No of Shelves
Overall Size L x W x H mm
Clearance Between Shelves
Weight kg
10 x 458 x 840
46
10 x 458 x 915
222 mm
13
GI542L
48
13 x 610 x 915
203
24
GI536L
56
10 x 458 x 915
159 mm
17
GI543L
58
13 x 610 x 1220
203
29
GI537L
66
10 x 458 x 1143
159 mm
19
GI544L
68
13 x 610 x 1423
203
34
GI538L
Overall Size L x W x H mm
Weight kg
Model
28
90 x 610 x 880
650
16
GI534L
11
GI541L
38
90 x 610 x 865
292
22
GI535L
FOUR & FIVE SHELF TROLLEYS Clearance between shelves: 280mm Mobile on 4 x 100mm non marking swivel Rubber castors These trolleys are available in 2 colours Buttermilk & Grey Both colours come with Grey Aluminium uprights Description Buttermilk 4 Shelf Trolley Grey 4 Shelf Trolley Buttermilk 5 Shelf Trolley Grey 5 Shelf Trolley
224
Model
Clearance Between Shelves 305 mm
Overall Size Weight L x W x H mm kg
Model
863 x 500 x 1200
26
HI614Y
26
HI624Y
863 x 500 x 1555
32
HI714Y
32
HI724Y
HI624Y
Max Load
HI714Y
160 KG
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
TRAY TROLLEYS GREY SHELF TROLLEYS
MATERIAL HANDLING
ADJUSTABLE HEIGHT TROLLEYS
Sturdy, easy to fold & neat to store Ideal for use in shops, schools etc Can be folded in one simple move Mobile on 4 x 100mm swivel Rubber tyred castors, 2 with brakes Size when folded: 580L x 100W x 1080H mm Clearance between shelves: 300mm Max Load
80 KG
Colour Options Available please specify when ordering
Blue
Green
Red
Mobile on 4 x 100mm swivel castors, 2 braked Perfect for colour co-ordinating company depts etc Shelves are manufactured from 20 gauge Steel with smooth rounded edges for extra strength, with the legs constructed from 14 gauge Steel Top shelf is easily adjustable from 660 up to 1070mm in 100mm increments & comes complete with a ribbed Rubber mat Max Load 150 KG
CI203Y Folded
CI203Y GI942W
Overall Size L x W x H mm 580 x 450 x 890
Weight kg 14
Model CI203Y
REVERSIBLE TRAY/SHELF TROLLEYS Reversible shelves enable use as either a smooth shelf or as a tray with surrounding lip The height of the centre shelf on the 3 shelf model is adjustable Mobile on 2 fixed, 2 swivel 100mmgrey non-marking castors
Overall Size L x W mm 610 x 460
Weight kg 20
Model GI942W
HEAVY DUTY TRAY TROLLEYS Chassis is of square tubular Steel with round tubular Steel handles Three Steel shelves with a 40mm lip Mobile on 2 fixed, 2 swivel roller bearing Cushion castors Platform Size: 900L x 500W mm
Max Load
150 KG Max Load
350 KG
TI246Y
Description 2 Shelf 3 Shelf
KT832Y
KT831Y
TI357Y Overall Size L x W x H mm 670 x 400 x 910
Weight kg 17
TI246Y
Tray Heights Total mm Height mm 210/520/8108 50
820 x 500 x 910
20
TI257Y
265/570/8609
670 x 400 x 910
20
TI346Y
215/665/1110
820 x 500 x 910
23.5
TI357Y
265/715/1160
Model
Wheels mm 150
Weight kg 40
KT831Y
200
43
KT831H
1150
150
42
KT832Y
1200
200
45
KT832H
00
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Model
225
MATERIAL HANDLING STAINLESS TRAY / TROLLEYS SHELF TROLLEYS
• Lightweight • Hygienic • Non-marking wheels Two models available - a 3 tray unit, and a two tray unit with rod surround. Fitted with 4 non-marking 100 mm braked swivel castors Tray size: 775mm long x 400mm wide.
SI812Y
SI803Y
Max Load 100kg
No of Shelves
Overall Dimensions L x W x H mm
Distance Between Shelves
Weight (kg)
SI803Y
3
850 x 445 x 895
260
14
SI802Y
2 with rod surround
850 x 445 x 895
345
10
Model
STAINLESS STEEL TRAY TROLLEYS
STAINLESS STEEL SHELF TROLLEYS
Available either as full Grade 304 Stainless Steel units or with Tubular Steel Blue Painted Frames. Grade 304 Stainless Steel removable tray with raised edges -suitable for use where hygiene is important, e.g. the catering and food industry. Handle Height: 980 mm
Robust construction - ideal for use in areas where cleanliness is important. Food grade 304 Stainless Steel -suitable for use in the catering and food industry. Smooth shelves are fixed in position and fitted with a raised rod surround to 3 sides. Handle Height: 980 mm
SS1302 SS1103
Max Load 125kg
Number of Trays
Tray Heights
165 mm
Wheels
127mm Cushion
2
226
Tray size 755 x 450 Number Tray Wheels of Trays Heights Painted Stainless Weight Model Model 24 kg
Tray size 1065 x 610 Weight
Painted Model
Stainless Model
SS1103 165 mm
127mm ST1203 Cushion
37 kg
830 mm SS1104
127mm ST1204 Nylon
35 kg
SS1114
ST1214
127mm ST1223 Cushion
46 kg
SS1133
ST1233
127mm ST1223 Nylon
44 kg
SS1134
ST1234
SS1113
ST1213
2 830 mm
3
Max Load 100kg
SS1223
165 mm 500 mm 830 mm
127mm Nylon
22 kg
127mm Cushion
28 kg 3
127mm Nylon
26 kg
SS1123 165 mm 500 mm 830 mm SS1124
Number of Trays
Shelf Heights
2 2 with drawer
165 mm
3 3 with drawer
165 mm 500 mm 830 mm
830 mm
Shelf size 660 x 460 Wheels
4 x 125 mm Swivel Rubber Tyred
Weight
Model
18 kg
SS1302
21 kg
SS1322
22 kg
SS1303
25 kg
SS1323
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Models ST1322 and ST1323 are fitted with a centre drawer as standard. Size of drawer : (L x W x H) External : 358 x 350 x 80 mm
DOLLIES
MATERIAL HANDLING
PLASTIC DOLLY
• Load Capacity: 250 kg • Versatile • Lightweight yet strong Strong and robust unit, available either as a dolly only or a complete unit with yellow painted steel handle. Mobile on 4 x 100mm swivel wheels. Ideal for use with 600 x 400mm containers.
PD064S
Model
Description
Overall Dimensions L x W x H mm
Weight (kg)
PD064S
Dolly only
600 x 400 x 300
4
PDT63S
Dolly with handle
610 x 400 x 930
9
PDT63S (Containers not included) PDT63S
FURNITURE TROLLEY
• Load Capacity: 200 kg per unit • Versatile • Lightweight • Supplied in pairs Multi purpose units ideal for moving furniture, boxed items etc. Fitted with 4 swivel 100 mm nylon castors. The flush top is fitted ith a protective ribbed green carpet cover.
PLASTIC DOLLY
• Load Capacity 350 kg Constructed from heavy duty plastic and fitted with 4 x 75 mm poly swivel castors this Dolly is ideal for moving heavy loads. Wheels supplied loose for easy fixing before use.
FD201N PD350N
Model
Overall Dimensions L x W x H mm
Weight (kg)
Model
Overall Dimensions L x W x H mm
Weight (kg)
FD201N
600 x 300 x 130
5
PD350N
610 x 405 x 125
6
DOLLIES
• Load Capacity 250 kg Robust angle iron construction. Model GS1912 is fitted with a removable plywood deck. Fitted with four 100 mm swivel castors.
DOLLIES
These dollies are made from a hardwood construction with carpeted ends that ensures durability and Strength. Ideal for use with heavy goods. FD900Y
GS1913
FD400Y
Model
Overall Dimensions L x W mm
Platform Height L x W x H mm
Weight (kg)
Model
Overall Dimensions L x W x H mm
Load Capacity
Weight (kg)
GS1912
622 x 486 mm
150 mm
10
FD400Y
400 x 400 mm
450 kg
5.5
GS1913
622 x 486 mm
150 mm
9
FD750Y
450 x 750 mm
380 kg
8
FD900Y
600 x 900 mm
545 kg
10
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
227
MATERIAL HANDLING Order Picking Trolleys
Max Load
300 KG
Max Load
250 KG
GI230H
KTI13Y
2 TIER SHELF TROLLEY
ORDER PICKING TROLLEYS Manufactured in angle steelwith fixed painted Steel trays Tray Sizes: KTI13Y - 900 x 500mm KTI14Y - 1000 x 700mm Mobile On 2 Fixed, 2 Swivel Braked Castors
This unit has a push/pull handle Mobile on 2 fixed, 2 swivel 150mm Rubber castors
Overall Size L x W x H mm
Platform Size mm
1100 x 700 x 980 1000 x 700
Shelf Heights mm
Weight kg
Model
320 / 960
55
GI230H
Overall Size L x W x H mm
Shelf Heights mm
1330 x 500 x 1070
ORDER PICKING TROLLEYS
1430 x 700 x 1070
220/800
Wheels 125mm Rubber
Weight kg
Model
43
KTI13Y
53
KTI14Y
HEAVY DUTY ORDER PICKING TROLLEY
Mobile on 4 swivel 125mm castors See pages 51 to 54 for suitable containers
No. of Trays:4 Tray Size: 1270 x 615mm Mobile on 2 fixed,2 swivel 150mm Rubber castors
Max Load
150 KG Max Load
250 KG
MS5702 Max Load
400 KG Containers Overall Size Tray Held L x W x H mm Size mm 4 1360 x 620 x 1230 820 x 620 6
228
1760 x 620 x 1230 1220 x 620
Weight kg 40
MS5701
51
MS5702
Model
MS5722
No of Steps
Tray Type
Overall Size L x W x H mm
Weight kg
Model
4
Galvanised
1650 x 615 x 1950
107
MS5722
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Order Picking Trolleys
MATERIAL HANDLING
ORDER PICKING TROLLEYS Ergonomically designed handrails positioned 580mm higher than the top step for increased safety & comfort Top Step Size 350W x 210Dmm Top Step Height - 3 Step Units: 720mm 4 Step Units: 960mm Sprung loaded steps with ribbed Rubber treads
STANDARD ORDER PICKING TROLLEYS Mobile on 4 x 125mm Rubber tyred swivel castors
GS APPROVED ORDER PICKING TROLLEYS Mobile on 2 fixed & 2 swivel braked 125mm Rubber tyred castors
GS5633
WS5603
No of Steps
No of Trays
WS5613
Tray Material
Overall Size H x W x L mm
Shelf Heights mm
Weight kg
Model
Standard Order Picking Trolleys 2 3
3 2 3
Steel 1320 x 520 x 1320 Plywood
200 / 1000
29
WS5602
200 / 600 / 1000
40
WS5603
200 / 1000
28
WS5612
200 / 600 / 1000
39
WS5613
GS Approved Order Picking Trolleys 3 4 3 4
2 3 2
1320 x 520 x 1320 Steel 1560 x 520 x 1520
3 2 3 2 3
1320 x 520 x 1320 Plywood 1560 x 520 x 1520
200 / 1000
31
GS5602
200 / 600 / 1000
42
GS5603
200 / 1240
41
GS5622
200 / 720 / 1240
46
GS5623
200 / 1000
30
GS5612
200 / 600 / 1000
41
GS5613
200 / 1240
38
GS5632
200 / 720 / 1240
43
GS5633
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
229
MATERIAL HANDLING Order Picking Trolleys HEAVY DUTY CASH & CARRY TROLLEYS • Load Capacity: 1000kg • Handles are easily removable for compact storage when not in use These strong Cash & Carry trolleys have steel chequer plated decks and tubular steel removable handles. Model GIC83Y is epoxy powder coated Blue and has kick plates at each end to help avoid trapped feet. Model GIC84Y is epoxy powder coated Grey.
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628)
Max Load 1000kg
Max Load 1000kg
GIC83Y
GIC84Y
Model
Description
Platform Height (mm)
Handle Height (mm)
Platform LxW (mm)
GIC83Y
Blue - Narrow
270
1830
1610 x 410
GIC84Y
Grey - Wide
270
1520
1520 x 610
Wheels
4 swivel 110mm rubber 2 fixed 220mm Polyurethane
Weight (kg) 80 124
CASH & CARRY NARROW • Load Capacity: 250kg • Platform Size: 1525 x 380mm Specially designed for cash and carry warehouses with narrow passage ways and restricted turning space.
Model
Platform Height (mm)
Effective end depth (mm)
Overall Height (mm)
Wheel size (mm)
Wheel type
Weight (kg)
GP162H
230
985
1209
200, 125
4 swivel, 2 fixed solid rubber roller bearing
39
GP162H
230
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
GENERAL PURPOSE TRUCKS
MATERIAL HANDLING
HEAVY DUTY PLATFORM TRUCK • 250mm dia rubber, steel centred Heavy Duty wheels • Handle Height: 1070mm • 4 Sided Unit Sides: 180mm A strong, durable and rugged turntable truck unit ideal for use in warehouses, factories, schools, garden centres etc. The unit incorporates a Heavy Duty handle) operated park brake. Lift the handle up and it operates the stoppers on the wheels shown on the image below.
TI802B
Handle Operated Park Brake
Max Load 700kg
Hard Wearing Veneer Finish
Model
Description
TI802B
Flat Deck Unit
TI801B
4 Sided Unit
Platform L x W mm 1250 x 700
Weight (kg) TI801B
65 86
PLASTIC PLATFORM TRUCK • 330mm dia pneumatic steel centred wheels • Easy to clean • Frame Size: (LxWxH) 1170x760 x 229mm An attractive green plastic platform truck, ideal for use in warehouses, laboratories, schools, garden centres etc. The corners are rounded to help prevent damage to walls.
TI204B
Max Load 350kg Model
Platform L x W x H mm
Weight (kg)
TI204B
1315 x 765 x 1090
29
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
231
MATERIAL HANDLING PLASTIC BASED TRUCKS • Robust and Durable • Superior Appearance • Easy to clean • Strength with Lightness • Unaffected by most substances • Hygienic Ideal for moving goods of all types, in offices, factories, store rooms, etc. Platform and base are produced in an attractive one-piece silver-grey polypropylene structural foam moulding with smooth, hard surfaces which are very durable and easily cleaned. Mesh size: 50 x 50mm bright zinc or stainless steel.
General Specification PL212H/PL232H PL252S/PL272S
980 mm.
Handle Height (from base):
275 mm.
Platform Height:
500 mm. Effective end and side depth (from base) -10°C to 50°C. Temperature extremes 2 fixed, 2 swivel Wheel equipment 200mm rubber
PL211H/PL231H PL251S/PL271S
PL214H/PL234H PL254S/PL274S
Overall
Description
Height
232
mm
PL215H/PL235H PL255S/PL275S
Platform Size 1000 x 600 mm Zinc Finish Weight
Model
Platform Size 1000 x 700 mm
Stainless Steel
Zinc Finish
Price
Model
Price
Weight
Model
—
—
Price
Stainless Steel Model
Price
Wheeled base only
295
23 kg
PL210H
AED 1,604.50 POA
25 kg
PL230H
AED 1,652.95 — POA
Single mesh end
995
28 kg
PL211H
AED 1,956.85 PL251S AED 3,950.70 POA POA
31 kg
PL231H
AED 2,005.65 PL271S AED 4,021.47 POA POA
Two mesh ends
995
32 kg
PL212H
AED 2,309.15 PL252S AED 6,089.55 POA POA
38 kg
PL232H
AED 2,357.95 PL272S AED 6,211.76 POA POA
Three mesh sides (box body)
995
36 kg
PL213H
AED 2,568.00 PL253S AED 7,145.35 POA POA
41 kg
PL233H
AED 2,616.80 PL273S AED 7,267.56 POA POA
Four mesh sides (box body)
995
39 kg
PL214H
AED 2,826.80 PL254S AED 8,193.20 POA POA
44 kg
PL234H
AED 2,875.65 PL274S AED 8,321.08 POA POA
Table top unit
915
36 kg
PL215H
AED 2,809.01 PL255S AED 4,239.85 POA POA
39 kg
PL235H
AED 2,906.65 PL275S AED POA 4,349.94 POA
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
—
Security Trolleys
MATERIAL HANDLING
SECURITY TROLLEYS Lockable lid for full security Half drop gate for easy access Wheels: 4 x 200mm Rubber 2 fixed / 2 swivel Model GIS71M has 50 x 50mm mesh sides Model GIS72S has a ‘pop-in’ mechanism on the lid which keeps the lid in position whilst in use
Max Load
350 KG
pop-in’ mechanism which stops the lidfrom closing whilst the unit is in use
‘ Key Locking Mechanism
Overall Size L x W x H mm
Description GIS72S
GIS71M
Mesh Solid
1000 x 700 x 800
Weight kg 81 103G
Model GIS71M IS72S
SECURITY BOX TROLLEYS Heavy Duty - Bigger Storage Space Handle Height: 1000mm Units have a lockable lid for full security, & a half drop front to aid access to the contents Padlock not supplied Mobile on 2 fixed, 2 swivel 200mm Rubber tyred castors
Max Load
500 KG
BT272S
BT271M
Description
Overall Size W x D x H mm
Steel Box Truck
1320 x 770 x 1140
Wooden Box Truck
BT273W
Mesh Box Truck
Useable Body Size Weight W x D x H mm kg 130 1150 x 715 110 x 850 85
Model BT272S BT273W BT271M
SECURITY DISTRIBUTION TROLLEY Colour Options Available Red
Grey
Blue
Green Max Load
400 KG
please specify when ordering
Shelf Size: 1120 x 430mm Handle Height: 1000mm Constructed from Steel angle with 50 x 50mm mesh sides & centre shelf The trolley has a security latch with padlock facility not supplied Mobile on 2 fixed, 2 swivel 125mm Blue non-marking quiet running castors
NA700R
Overall Size Shelf L x W x H mm Heights mm 1220 x 480 x 1100 180, 635, 1070 2 Braked Castors - Factory Fitted
Weight kg 60
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Model NA700R GM003Z
233
MATERIAL HANDLING PLASTIC TROLLEYS
GI340Y
GI152Y
pLASTIC PLATFORM Trolley • 4 Colour Options Available Blue
Red
Green
Yellow
Please specify colour when ordering
• Hygienic • Lightweight
A lightweight platform truck ideal for use in offices, shops, schools, warehouses etc. Available in 4 different colours it is ideal for colour coded departments. Platform is made from injected moulded plastic with 2 fixed, 2 swivel 100 mm rubber tyred castors.
• Platform Height 140 mm
Platform Size mm
Handle Height mm
710 x 460
825
Weight kg 8.5
Model Price GI152Y
GI153Y
POA
GI154Y
“Mini” plastic platform trolley / dolly • Hygienic • Lightweight
• Easy carrying handle
Red
Grey
White
Please specify colour when ordering
Similar to the GI152Y detailed above. A lightweight platform trolley / dolly, ideal for use in offices, shops, schools etc. The injected moulded plastic platform is available in 4 different colours, ideal for departmental coding. Model GI153Y has a folding handle for storage and 2 fixed, 2 swivel 100mm rubber tyred castors. Model GI154Y has 4 swivel 80 mm plastic castors.
234
Description
• 4 Colour Options Available Blue
Folding Handle Blue/Red/Grey
Platform L x W x H mm
Handle Height mm
Weight kg
Model
Price
600 x 385 x
820
6
GI153Y
POA
820
6
GI153YW
POA
3.5
GI154Y
POA
3.5
GI154YW
POA
Folding Handle 150 White
Dolly Blue/Red/Grey
600 x 400 x -
Dolly 110 White
-
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
SERVICE TROLLEYS
MATERIAL HANDLING
NA700R KT099R
security distribution trolLey 4 colour options available. Please specify colour when ordering.
ORDER PICKING TROLLEY 4 colour options available.
Red
Blue
Green
Yellow
• Shelf Size: 1120 x 430 mm • Handle Height: 1000 mm
Ideal for transporting high value goods. Mesh sides provide permanent visual identification of the contents at all times. Constructed from steel angle with 50 x 50 mm mesh sides and A heavy duty trolley with an angle steel frame and sheet steel shelves with a 30 mm upstand. centre shelf. The trolley has a security latch with padlock facility Fitted with a fixed writing shelf for easy working in warehouses, with a push/pull handle. Fitted (padlock not supplied) Fitted with 2 fixed, 2 swivel 125mm resilex with 2 fixed, 2 swivel castors. non-marking quiet running castors.
Please specify colour when ordering. • Shelf Size: 450 x 900 mm
Overall Dimensions L x W x H mm
1230 x 460 x 1070
Red Blue Green • Handle Height: 950 mm
Shelf Heights mm Wheels 180, 880
Weight kg
125 mm Rubber
36
2 Braked Castors - Factory Fitted
Yellow
Model
Price
KT099R
POA
GM003Z
POA
Overall Dimensions L x W x H mm
Shelf Heights mm
Weight kg
Model
1220 x 480 x 1100
180, 635, 1070
60
NA700R
POA
GM003Z
POA
2 Braked Castors - Factory Fitted
Price
GP205H GW900Y
GW901Y
HIGH LEVEL SHELF TROLLEY
SHELF TRUCKS
• Epoxy Powder Coated • Comfortable Working Height
• Epoxy Powder Coated
Tubular steel construction with shelves set in angle iron. Choice of varnished plywood or galvanised sheet steel shelves. Fitted with 2 fixed, 2 swivel 125 mm non-marking blue resilex castors. Ideal for use in warehouses, assembly workshops etc. Upstand height on top shelf 80 mm.
Manufactured from tubular steel with the base and top shelf of varnished plywood set in angle iron. Fitted with 2 fixed, 2 swivel 200 x 50 mm cushion tyred roller bearing castors.
Overall Dimensions L x W x H mm
Shelf Heights mm
Shelf Shelf Weight Dimensions Material kg mm
855 x 630
220 &
800 x
Galvanised sheet steel
39
GW900Y
POA
Overall Dimensions L x W x H mm 1150 x 710 x 900
x 1285
1120
600
Varnished plywood
39
GW901Y
POA
1350 x 810 x 900
Model
Price
Base/shelf size mm 1000 x 700
Shelf Heights Weight mm kg 275 - 900 56
1200 x 800
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
67
Model
Price
GP205H
POA
GP225H
POA
235
MATERIAL HANDLING SERVICE TROLLEYS
GI436L
SHELF TrolleyS
• Super Strong Polyethylene Moulded Trolleys • Reinforced top shelf Either 4 or 5 shelf unit with a 12 mm retaining lip and self adhesive safety strips which prevents equipment from sliding. Top shelf has been reinforced with two steel bars for extra strength. Complete with integral safety push handle moulded into the shelf. Fitted with 4 x 100 mm swivel castors - 2 braked.
GI437L
Overall
Description
Dimensions
Dimensions
Between
Weight
L x W x H mm
Shelves mm
kg
4 Shelf Trolley
610 x 457 x 1185
305
18
GI436L AED £129.00 950.65
5 Shelf Trolley
810 x 610 x 1525
295
40
GI437L AED £265.00 2,242.90
Model
Price
GI439L GI438L
LONG SHELF TROLLEYS
• Super Strong Polyethylene Moulded Trolleys • Maximum Load Capacity: 200kg • Easy to clean Constructed from heavy duty polyethylene, with flat shelves, ideal for use in storerooms, warehouses etc. Model GI438L has 4 x 100mm swivel castors and GI439L has 2 fixed, 2 swivel braked 125mm plate fixing castors.
236
Overall Shelf Dimensions Heights L x W x H mm mm
Wheels Weight Model Price mm kg
1220 x 610 x 915
140, 458
100
33
2,558.30 GI438L AED £319.00
1220 x 610 x 940
165, 483
125
36
GI439L AED £349.00 2,824.20
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
SERVICE TROLLEYS
MATERIAL HANDLING
GI341L
GI343L
GI332CL
GI346L
GI409L
GI347L
• Super Strong Polyethylene Moulded Trolleys • Free mallet for easy assembly • Will not rust, dent or chip • Versatile • Easy to clean Ideal for use in workshops, maintenance departments, storerooms, warehouses, the automotive and electronics industries etc. Multi purpose trolleys constructed from a non conductive material and unaffected by battery acid, solvents and cleaning solutions. Available in a combination of flat shelves and deep storage trays. Fitted with 4 x 100 mm non marking rubber swivel castors, 2 with brake. Depth of storage trays: 95 mm. Colour: Black Metal Cupboard: Grey
Overall Dimensions L x W x H mm
Dimensions Between Shelves Top / Bottom mm
Maximum Load kg
Weight kg
Top storage tray, cupboard with flat shelf 3 Shelf, Top & Middle storage tray, bottom flat shelf.
610 x 470 x 1030
235 / 445
120
24
610 x 468 x 864
235 / 235
120
14
GI343L
AED 1,057.50
3 Shelf, Top storage tray, Middle & Bottom flat shelves
610 x 468 x 864
235 / 280
120
14
GI346L
AED 990.40
2 shelf, Top storage tray, Bottom flat shelf
610 x 468 x 864
598
120
12
GI347L
AED 893.65
3 shelf, Top & Bottom flat shelves, Middle storage tray
610 x 477 x 1025
290 / 405
120
16
GI409L
AED 1,060.90
3 Shelf, 3 flat shelves
610 x 458 x 840
305 / 305
120
11
GI341L
AED 757.02
Description
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Model
Price
GI332CL AED 2,134.55
237
MATERIAL HANDLING SERVICE TROLLEYS LARGE FOLDING BOX TRUCKS • Lightweight • Load capacity 35kg • Hold Foolscap Lever Arch Files and Box Files • Ideal for Deliveries • Opens and Folds in Seconds! These compact folding trucks are very easy to use. Of durable moulded construction they fold flat for easy carrying and storage. Model GI042Y comes complete with its own lid.
GI042Y Both models hold foolscap lever arch files and box files
GI041Y shown folded GI042Y comes complete with lid
GI041Y Description
Dimensions H x W x D mm when folded
Dimensions H x W x D mm When open
Internal Dimensions of Box H x W x D mm
wheels mm
Weight kg
Model
PRICE
Blue/Yellow
470x460x85
990x460x390
350x395x330
2x75
4
GI041Y
POA
Grey/Red with lid
470x460x85
990x460x390
350x395x330
2x75
5
GI042Y
POA
ALUMINIUM PLATFORM TRUCK • Ergonomically designed handle – for improved posture • Load Capacity: 300kg • Handle folds for efficient storage • Easy clean • Lightweight aluminium platform • 2 fixed, 2 swivel 180mm rubber wheels An attractive unit of aluminium construction with black painted steel handle and black wheels with yellow plastic centres. The handle folds allowing the unit to be stored in car boots etc.
GI066Y shown folded Overall Platform Size L x W mm
Handle Height (upright) mm
Dimensions Folded L x W x H mm
wheels mm
Weight kg
Model
Price
470x460x85
990x460x390
350x395x330
2x75
4
GI066Y
POA
GI066Y
238
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Lightweight Trolleys
MATERIAL HANDLING
GI001Y shown folded • Lightweight • Foldable • Portable • GS Approved
MULTI POSITION TROLLEY
GI001Y
• Fits Easily Into a Car Boot
• Corner buffers for extra protection A multi position trolley for a multitude of uses with a telescopic handle and an expanding/contracting base. Made in aluminium, it won’t rust. Suitable for a wide range of work places, from the office to the factory floor, from retail shops to the warehouse. Dimensions Dimensions Castor Fully Extended Folded Diameter Weight Model L x W x H mm L x W x H mm mm kg
GI001Y
725 x 420
570 x 420
x 960
x 230
100
8.5
GI001Y
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Price
POA
239
MATERIAL HANDLING SHELF AND PLATFORM TRUCKS
GM803Y
GM620Y
• 2 Colour Options Available
please specify when ordering
Blue
Red
GM624Y
GM733Y
Description
MEDIUM DUTY SHELF AND PLATFORM TRUCKS
A range of trolleys to suit numerous applications. Narrow width design makes them ideal for use in narrow aisles and for clear passage through standard doorways. Fitted with non-marking blue resilex wheels with roller bearings and thread guards. Quiet running and extremely durable. GENERAL SPECIFICATION Overall length x width x height 1060 x 600 x 1200 mm. Platform size L x W 1000 x 570 mm. Chassis: Made from strong tubular steel. Shelves: Timber set into a steel protective surround. Castors: Heavy duty 125 mm diameter 2 fixed, 2 swivel.
Weight kg
Model
2 Shelf Trolley - Shelf Heights: 300 - 870 mm 2 open ends 35 GM620Y 2 mesh ends 36 GM622Y 3 mesh sides 39 GM623Y 2 mesh ends 4 shelf sides 40 GM624Y 3 Shelf Trolley - Shelf Heights: 300 - 585 - 870 mm 44 GM730Y 2 open ends 2 mesh ends 45 GM732Y 3 mesh sides 48 GM733Y Platform Trolley 2 mesh ends 28 GM802Y 31 GM803Y 3 mesh sides Optional Factory Fitted Braked Castors (on swivel end) GM003Z
Price POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA
GM803Y
GD752H
GD751H GD755H
GALVANISED DECK FIRM LOAD TRUCKS • 2 Colour Options Available please specify when ordering Blue Red
A bright, hard wearing galvanised sheet base gives a smooth, easy to clean non-splinter finish. The all welded steel frame has straight handles for easy manoeuvrability. There are two deck sizes available and side panels are removable. GENERAL SPECIFICATION Handle Height 950 mm Platform Height 280 mm Effective End/ Side Depth 520 mm Effective half Side Depth 285 mm Wheels dia x width 200 mm x 50 mm Wheel Equipment 2 swivel, 2 fixed cushion tyres, roller bearing steel centred Wire mesh 50 mm x 50 mm
240
Description
kg
Platform Size
Model
Single Mesh 39 1000 x 700 mm GD751H End 43 1200 x 800 mm GD851H Double Mesh 44 1000 x 700 mm GD752H Ends 48 1200 x 800 mm GD852H Three Mesh Sides 46 1000 x 700 mm GD753H (box body) 51 1200 x 800 mm GD853H Four Mesh Sides 49 1000 x 700 mm GD754H (box body) 54 1200 x 800 mm GD854H Four Mesh Sides 50 1000 x 700 mm GD755H One half drop side 57 1200 x 800 mm GD855H Double Mesh 46 1000 x 700 mm GD756H Sides 51 1200 x 800 mm GD856H Optional Factory Fitted Corner Buffers (4 off) GD001Z Optional Factory Fitted Braked Castors (on swivel end) GD003Z
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Price POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA
NARROW PLATFORM TRUCKS
MATERIAL HANDLING
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628)
NA504H
NA501H
• Versatile • Manoeuvrable • Extremely Strong 2 Colour Options Available Blue Red Please specify colour when ordering.
NA507H
Suitable for use in confined areas i.e. narrow doorways and aisleways. Fully welded construction with fixed ends, sides of either exterior grade plywood or 50 x 50 mm mesh, including one half drop mesh side. Available with firm load or easy steer configuration. Finish: Blue or red epoxy powder coated. General Specification Handle height (from base) Platform size Platform height Overall Width Effective end depth (from base) Height from base of horizontal bar Effective side depth (from base) Effective half side depth (from base) Wheel dia x width Wheel equipment 2 fixed 2 swivel cushion tyres roller bearing.
745 1200 x 600 275 615 530 480 530 290 200 x 50
mm mm mm mm mm mm mm mm mm
FIRM LOADING MODELS EASY STEER MODELS
Description Kg Wheeled base only 31 Single End Horizontal bar 34 Single Plywood end 36 Single Mesh end 37 Double End Horizontal bar 37 Double Plywood ends 42 Double Mesh ends 40 Double Plywood sides 42 Double Mesh sides 43 Three Plywood sides (box body) 44 Three Mesh sides (box body) 42 Four Plywood sides (box body) 46 Four Mesh sides (box body) 45 Four Mesh sides one half dropside 46
Model NA500H NA501H NA502H NA503H NA504H NA505H NA506H NA507H NA508H NA509H NA510H NA511H NA512H NA513H
Price POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA
Kg Model Price 35 NA520H POA 38 NA521H POA 39 NA522H POA 41 NA523H POA 41 NA524H POA 45 NA525H POA 43 NA526H POA 46 NA527H POA 47 NA528H POA 48 NA529H POA 47 NA530H POA 50 NA531H POA 48 NA532H POA 50 NA533H POA
NA529H
OPTIONAL EXTRAS FACTORY FITTED
Description
Model
Clipboard (Clip on fixing)
NA002Z
Braked Castor (2 off fitted to swivel castors) (only available on Firm Load Trucks)
NA003Z
NA533H
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
241
MATERIAL HANDLING PLATFORM TRUCKS
GE101H
GE102H GE133H
• Economical • Easily Manoeuvrable
• Versatile
This range of platform trucks will meet every possible use in stores, warehouse or factory. Available with firm load or easy steer configuration wheels. Fully welded construction with fixed ends and sides infilled with 50 x 50 mm wire mesh complete with straight handles. The deck is of exterior grade plywood. Finish: Red. General Specification Handle height
960 mm
Platform height
275 mm
Effective end depth
520 mm
Effective side depth
520 mm
Effective half side depth
200 x 50 mm
Wheel equipment
2 fixed, 2 swivel, cushion tyres, roller bearing
GE134H
270 mm
Wheel dia x width
Firm Loading Models Easy Steer Models Description
Kg
Model
Price
Kg
Model
Price
Single mesh end
36
GE101H
POA
39
GE131H
POA
Double mesh end
40
GE102H
POA
43
GE132H
POA
Three mesh sides (box body)
42 GE103H
POA 47 GE133H
POA
Four mesh sides (box body)
45 GE104H
POA 48 GE134H
POA
Four mesh sides one half dropside
46 GE105H
POA 50 GE135H
POA
Single mesh end
40
GE121H
POA
43
GE141H
POA
Double mesh end
44
GE122H
POA
48
GE142H
POA
Three mesh sides (box body)
47 GE123H
POA 52 GE143H
POA
Four mesh sides (box body)
50 GE124H
POA 54 GE144H
POA
Four mesh sides one half dropside
53
POA
POA
Platform size 1000 x 700 mm
Platform size 1200 x 800 mm
GE125H
242
GE125H
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
54
GE145H
PLATFORM TRUCKS
MATERIAL HANDLING
platform trucks - Budget Range • Protected wood edges • Manoeuvrable • Strong In this budget range of Platform trucks there are a choice of models available to suit different applications.
PI208Y
Decking is of varnished plywood, supported by a steel frame, and sides and ends are fixed in position. Finish: Epoxy powder coated Blue. PI200Y
GENERAL SPECIFICATION Handle Height Platform Height Effective Plywood Side/End Depth: Wheels:
880 mm 220 mm 450 mm 4 x 150 mm 2 fixed, 2 swivel rubber, except model PI208Y which has 125 mm wheels.
PI207Y
PI205Y
Platform
Size mm
kg
Model
Price
Single Bar End
1000 x 700
28
PI200Y
POA
4 Corner Uprights
1000 x 700
27.5
PI205Y
POA
2 Tubular bar Sides
1000 x 700
35.5
PI207Y
POA
4 Plywood 1/2 Sides
850 x 500
25.5
PI208Y
POA
Description
Weight
heavy duty platform truck • Platform Size: 1300 x 800 mm • Handle Height: 975 mm A heavy duty single ended platform truck. Deck is of varnished plywood and the single end has tubular steel uprights. Mounted on 4 x 200 mm heavy duty rubber wheels, 2 fixed and 2 swivel. Finish: Epoxy powder coated Blue.
Description
Heavy Duty Platform Truck
Weight kg
Model
Price
50
PI401J
POA
PI401J
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
243
MATERIAL HANDLING
PLATFORM TRUCKS STURDY TRUCKS • Smooth Finish Plywood Platform • Robust and Versatile • 200mm Rubber castors, 2 fixed, 2 swivel These sturdy platform trucks are manufactured from tubular steel with a smooth finish plywood platform set within a heavy duty angle frame. PC702H
Model PC780H has 3 removable rails with 7 different positions. Rail Heights (from platform: - 320, 630 and 930mm. Model PC726H has the addition of 3 shelves which will take 40kg each, and also has 2 braked castors.
PC701H
PC780H
PC812H
PC811H
PC726H
PC707H
244
Platform Size mm
Platform Height mm
Overall Height mm
Weight kg
Model
Price
Single Bar End
Description
1200 x 700
310
1000
32
PC701H
POA
Double Bar Ends
1200 x 700
310
1000
34
PC702H
POA
Single Plywood End
1200 x 700
310
1000
33
PC811H
POA
Double Plywood Ends
1200 x 700
310
1000
35
PC812H
POA
Tubular Sided
1200 x 700
310
1000
35
PC707H
POA
Base with 3 Dividing Rails
1200 x 700
310
1240
30
PC780H
POA
Shelf Truck, Base with 3 Shelves
1200 x 700
310
1800
69
PC726H
POA
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
ORDER PICKING TROLLEYS
MATERIAL HANDLING
• Strong • Steel framed • Epoxy Powder Coated BLUE Ideal for use in warehouses and stores for order picking from low up to a high level of shelves/racks. Available with either plywood or galvanised trays. Tubular steel construction with spring loaded steps. Non-slip rubber treads. The steps act as a brake when the trolley is in operation.
General Purpose models • Distributed load capacity:150 kg • Tray Size 785 x 475 mm
MS5703
Available with either galvanised sheet steel or plywood trays. Ideal for use in shops, stock rooms etc.
MS5709
MS5706
MS5704
MS5705 MS5705
Heavy Duty
Narrow Aisle
MODEL: MS5722
MODELS: MS5711 and MS5712
• Strong • Construction
• Distributed load • capacity: 200 kg
• Distributed load • capacity: 400 kg
• Tray size 750 x • 455 mm
• Large tray size • 1270 x 615 mm
• Galvanised or • Plywood trays These 5 step units enable you to order pick from high levels and are designed for use in narrow aisles or confined areas.
Constructed from fully welded angle iron this 4 tray unit is ideal for heavy industrial applications.
MS5712
MS5722 Overall Length Description Width, Height (mm) 3 Steps, 2 plywood trays 1310 x 480 x 990 3 Steps, 3 plywood trays with high handles 1310 x 480 x 1480 3 Steps, 2 plywood trays with high handles 1310 x 480 x 1480 3 Steps. 2 galvanised trays 1310 x 480 x 990 3 Steps, 3 galvanised trays with high handles 1310 x 480 x 1480 3 Steps. 2 galvanised trays with high handles 1310 x 480 x 1480 3 Steps, 3 plywood trays 1310 x 480 x 990 3 Steps, 3 galvanised trays 1310 x 480 x 990 5 Steps, 3 plywood trays with high handles 1505 x 470 x 1940 5 Steps. 3 galvanised trays with high handles 1505 x 470 x 1940 4 Steps, 4 galvanised trays with high handles 1650 x 615 x 1950
Clearance between trays (mm) 510 510 510 510 510 510 210 210 440 440 310
Height of Top shelf (mm) 815 1380 815 815 1380 815 815 815 1105 1105 1130
Height of Top Step (mm) Wheels mm 690 690 690 690 690 690 690 690 1090 1090 990
125 x 4 Swivel rubber 125 x 4 Swivel rubber tyred castors 127 x 2 fixed, 2 swivel blue resilex wheels 150 x 2 fixed, 2 swivel rubber
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Weight kg Model 25 32 29 25 32 29 28 28 52 52 107
MS5703 MS5704 MS5705 MS5706 MS5707 MS5708 MS5709 MS5710 MS5711 MS5712 MS5722
Price POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA
245
MATERIAL HANDLING SHELF/DISTRIBUTION TRUCKS HEAVY DUTY SHELF TRUCKS
Available open sided or with a 50 x 50mm Mesh Infil on 3 sides. A 4th hook-on side is also available, as is a padlockable security version. • 32mm Tube • Load Capacity Per Shelf 75 kg • Varnished Plywood Removable Shelves • 2 fixed, 2 Swivel Castors, 200 x 50 mm Cushion
GP512H
GP509H
Units with 50 x 50mm Mesh infil sides:
GP206H
Shelf
Description
Mesh Sides
Base and
3 sides
Base and
Base / Shelf Overall Size Weight size (mm) L x W x H mm Kg 1000 x 700 1010 x 710 x 1770 70 1200 x 800 1210 x 810 x 1770 81
Model GP206H GP226H
1240-1530
3 sides + 4th
Price POA POA
L x W x H mm
1200 x 800 1350 x 815 x 1900
275-660-950- 1000 x 700 1150 x 755 x 1900
with 4 shelves hook-on side Base and
Size mm
275-660-950- 1000 x 700 1150 x 715 x 1900
with 4 shelves
Base with 3 shelves only, no sides: (Shelf heights: 275 . 650 . 1020 . 1390)
Base/Shelf Overall dimensions Weight
heights mm
1240-1530
3 sides + 4th hook-
1200 x 800 1350 x 855 x 1900
275-660-950- 1000 x 700 1150 x 755 x 1900
with 4 shelves on side + mesh top
1240-1530
Full security 3 sides + mesh top
1200 x 800 1350 x 855 x 1900
275-660-950- 1000 x 700 1150 x 755 x 1900
with 4 shelves 2 mesh doors for padlock
1240-1530
1200 x 800 1350 x 855 x 1900
kg
Model
84
GP509H
Price POA
95
GP529H
POA
96
GP510H
POA
111
GP530H
POA
97
GP511H
POA
112
GP531H
POA
98
GP512H
POA
113
GP532H
POA
NARROW AISLE SHELF TROLLEYS WITH PLYWOOD BASES For detail and general Specification please see next page.
NA601R
Description
Open Ended
Rod Infil
NA607R fitted with NA004Z
Number of
NA617R
Model without Shelves
Weight
Model
Price
Shelves
Weight
Model
2
-
-
-
2 x Plywood
64 kg
NA601R
POA
2
47 kg
NA606R
POA
2 x Plywood
69 kg
NA609R
POA
Price
3
53 kg
NA607R
POA
2 x Plywood
75 kg
NA610R
POA
4
59 kg
NA608R
POA
2 x Plywood
81 kg
NA611R
POA
-
70 kg
NA616R
POA
2 x Plywood
88 kg
NA617R
POA
Weight
Model
Price
Bolt in Plywood Shelf
11 kg
NA620S
Braked Castors (2 off fitted to swivel castors)
NA004Z
POA
Full Security Mesh Infil
OPTIONAL EXTRAS - FACTORY FITTED
246
Model with Shelves
Ends / Sides
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
POA
DISTRIBUTION TRUCKS
MATERIAL HANDLING
NA603R NA614R
NA615R
NA612R
NA604R
NA618R
NARROW AISLE SHELF TROLLEY
GENERAL SPECIFICATION • Overall Size L x W x H - 1180 x 690 x 1850 mm • Deck / Shelf size - 600 x 1100 mm • Castors - 2 fixed, 2 swivel 150 mm rubber tyred • Load Capacity - 75 kg per shelf .Available in 3 colour options .Please specify colour when ordering Red Blue Green • 4 shelf height options - 590, 890, 1190, 1490 mm Adaptable to suit every type of use in warehouses, workshops, hospitals etc. Manufactured from 25mm tubular steel, with either rod infil, mesh infil or just open ended. Plywood Base models are shown on previous page. Epoxy Powder Coated Finish.
AED 2,850.64
NARROW AISLE SHELF TROLLEYS WITH ROD BASE Description
Open Ended
Rod Infil
Number of
Model without Shelves
Model with Shelves
Ends / Sides
Weight
Model
Price
Shelves
Weight
Model
2
-
-
-
2 x Zinc Plated
52 kg
NA602R
Price POA
2
43 kg
NA603R
POA
2 x Zinc Plated
57 kg
NA612R
POA
3
49 kg
NA604R
POA
2 x Zinc Plated
63 kg
NA613R
POA
4
55 kg
NA605R
POA
2 x Zinc Plated
69 kg
NA614R
POA
-
66 kg
NA615R
POA
2 x Zinc Plated
80 kg
NA618R
POA
Weight
Model
Price
Bolt in Zinc Plated Rod Shelf
7 kg
NA621S
Braked Castors (2 off fitted to swivel castors)
NA004Z
POA
Full Security Mesh Infil
OPTIONAL EXTRAS - FACTORY FITTED
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
POA
247
MATERIAL HANDLING DISTRIBUTION TRUCKS
Close up of bolt holding shelf in folded position
CI9002 shown folded
CI9003
CI9002
FOLDING SHELF TRUCK • Ideal for use where storage space is a premium • Load Capacity: 100kg Folding shelves and sides enable the units to fold flat when not in use. Sides are constructed from tubular steel and epoxy powder coated blue. The two shelves are steel, finished in white. Fitted with 2 fixed, 2 swivel braked rubber castors
No of Shelves 2 3
Overall size in use L x W x H mm 850 x 460 x 1028 850 x 460 x 1490
Overall size Folded L x W x H mm
Weight kg
850 x 150 18.5 CI9002 x 1028 850 x 180 27 CI9003 x 1490
RB9502 fitted with RC9502, RH9502 & RS9502
248
HEAVY DUTY ROLCONTAINERS
Description
• Load Capacity: 500 kg • Strong Construction • Units Demountable and bases stackable for storage • Hard Wearing Red Epoxy Powder Coated • Three sizes available Constructed from tubular box section these heavy duty rolcontainers are suitable for industrial applications. Extra sides and shelf available as optional extras. Fitted with 2 fixed, 2 swivel 100 mm nylon castors with roller bearings. The fixed castors are inset. making the unit easily manoeuverable.
Base and 2 ends Optional Extras Full side Half drop side Rod infil shelf
Model
Price POA POA
RB9502 fitted with RC9502 Internal size mm L x W x H 1000 x 800 x 1500 1440 x 800 x 1500 2000 x 800 x 1500
Overall size mm L x W x H 1100 x 848 x 1690 1540 x 848 x 1690 2100 x 848 x 1690
Weight kg 36 46 60
RB9501 RB9502 RB9503
POA POA POA
to suit RB9501 to suit RB9502 to suit RB9503 to suit RB9501 to suit RB9502 to suit RB9503 to suit RB9501 to suit RB9502 to suit RB9503
990 x 25 x 1500 1430 x 25 x 1500 1990 x 25 x 1500 990 x 25 x 1500 1430 x 25 x 1500 1990 x 25 x 1500 980 x 730 x 25 1420 x 730 x 25 1980 x 730 x 25
9 12 17 10 14 20 5 7 10
RC9501 RC9502 RC9503 RH9501 RH9502 RH9503 RS9501 RS9502 RS9503
POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Model Price
Demountable Rolcontainers
MATERIAL HANDLING Demountable Rolcontainers Bright Zinc Electroplated finish Re-inforced wire base Hygienic - steam clean or pressure wash Detachable rod infil sides for easy storage Mobile on 2 fixed & 2 swivel 100mmNylon castors with roller bearings
Max Load
500 KG
RB1692
RB1693
MANY SIZES &MODELS AVAILABLE TO SUIT YOUR APPLICATION
RB1835 & RC7180
RB1694
4 Sided ( 1/2 Drop Side) Security (50x50mm Mesh)
External Size L x W x H mm
Internal Height
2 Sided & Straps
3 Sided
4 Sided
Model
Model
Model
Model
Model
715 x 800 x 1690
1530mm
RB1692
RB1693
RB1695
RB1694
-
715 x 800 x 1815
1630mm
RB1812
RB1813
RB1815
RB1814
-
715 x 800 x 1830
1640mm
-
-
-
-
RB1835
Shelf to Suit Above Rolcontainers - 715 x 800mm For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
RC7180
249
MATERIAL HANDLING Rolcontainers LARGE SIZE ROLCONTAINERS Bright Zinc Plated finish Stackable bases Mobile on 2 fixed & 2 swivel 100mm Nylon castors Robust & durable construction
Max Load
500 KG
RB8623 & 4 x RC8613
RB8621
Overall Size Internal Weight Rolcontainer (2 Ends) H x W mm Length mm kg Model 1680 x 800
930 x 800 RB8624 & 2 x RC8611
LARGE SIZE ROLCONTAINERS Bright Zinc Electroplated finish
Optional Half Side
Optional Full Side
Model
Model
1000
23
RB8621
RC8611
-
1500
35
RB8622
RC8612
-
2000
47
RB8623
RC8613
-
1000
23
RB8624
-
RC8611
1500
35
RB8625
-
RC8612
2000
47
RB8626
-
RC8613
RB1725: on this model the front gate opens through 270o
Mobile on 2 fixed & 2 swivel 125mm Nylon castors with roller bearings
Re-inforced wire base
Max Load
500 KG
250
External Size L x W x H mm
Internal Height mm
735 x 830 x 1720
1430
RB1725 & RC7383
RB1723
Units Nesting 3 Sided
4 Sided
Model
Model
Security (50x50mm Mesh) Model
Model
RB1723
RB1724
RB1725
RC7383
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Shelf to Suit
CONTAINER/PICKING TROLLEYS
MATERIAL HANDLING
three tier order picking trolleys • Load Capacity 150 kg, 50 kg per shelf
• Shelf Heights: 210, 750, 1200mm
Choose from 3 designs: Fitted with plywood shelves or used with a combination of solid or slotted plastic containers which have a choice of depths. Containers supplied as additional items (see the container trolleys page shown later in this section). Red epoxy powder coated finish. Fitted with 2 fixed, 2 swivel 125 mm rubber tyred castors.
GC4407 Each tier fitted with a varnished plywood shelf.
GC4408
Description 3 tier trolley with fixed tiers & drop in plywood shelves
Overall Dimensions L x W x H mm 850 x 520 x 1290
Weight kg 28
Frame Size mm 610 x 410
Model
Price
GC4407
POA
3 tier trolley with fixed tiers to fit 3 x drop in containers
850 x 520 x 1290
27
610 x 410
GC4408
POA
3 tier trolley with 2 upper tiers able to tilt. To fit 3 x drop in containers
850 x 520 x 1290
27
610 x 410
GC4409
POA
GC4400
POA
Optional Extra - 2 Braked Castors - Factory Fitted
GC4409 With the 2 upper tiers able to tilt either side, secured by springbolts.
• Height Adjustable 750 - 1130 mm • Load Capacity 70 kg, 35 kg per shelf • Tilt Adjustable 0˚, 30˚, 45˚ and 60˚
CT230Y
CONTAINER TROLLEY
GC5000
Mobile Parts Stand
• Complete with containers • Load Capacity: 200kg
Top angle bay holds one 600 x 400 mm container, bottom tray has sheet steel infil and holds two 400 x 300 mm containers. Containers supplied as additional items. Fitted with 4 braked 100 mm swivel castors. Red epoxy powder coated finish.
Welded tubular steel with angle support frame for the containers. Fitted with 4 x 100 mm swivel non-marking grey rubber castors. Supplied complete with 30 containers: 12 x size: 300 x 150 x 100 mm colour red and 18 x size: 300 x 100 x 100 mm colour Blue.
Overall Dimensions L x W
Height of Bottom Tray
Weight kg
Model
Price
410 x 680 mm
180 mm
18
GC5000
POA
Overall Trolley Size L x W x H mm
Weight kg
Model
700 x 350 x 1140
21
CT230Y
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Price
251
MATERIAL HANDLING STAINLESS STEEL TRUCKS
STAINLESS STEEL TRUCKS
• Hygienic • Easy to Clean Constructed from grade 304 stainless steel - ideal for use in areas where hygiene is of the utmost importance. Available in a choice of models from single end to ‘Table Top’ version. Handles are manufactured from tubular stainless steel with 50 x 50 mm mesh stainless steel infil on sides and ends. Sides are easily removable to allow access to the platform. The table top model has square section stainless steel uprights. All models are fitted with 2 fixed, 2 swivel 200 mm rubber tyred castors. GENERAL SPECIFICATION Handle Height (from base) Platform Height Platform Size Effective mesh side depth (from base)
720 mm 250 mm 1000 x 600mm 525 mm
ST680H
ST682H
ST683H
ST681H
Overall Description
Height Weight kg mm
Model
Price
Single Mesh End
970
29
ST681H
POA
Single Mesh End
970
32
ST680H
POA
with Box Rail
252
Two Mesh End
970
33
ST682H
POA
Three Mesh Sides
970
36
ST683H
POA
Four Mesh Sides
970
39
ST684H
POA
Table Top Unit
990
53
ST685H
POA
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
ST685H
ALUMINIUM TRUCKS
MATERIAL HANDLING
GA821R
GA823R
GA822R
• Versatile FIRM LOAD ALUMINIUM TRUCKS • Hygienic • Non Sparking • Rounded corners for damage prevention Ideal for use within industrial and commercial food and textile production. Platform sides and ends are of heavy duty aluminium chequer plate. Frame and superstructure of heavy duty aluminium R.H.S. Fitted with corner buffering as standard. GENERAL SPECIFICATION Platform Height: 300 mm. Wheel Equipment: 2 fixed, 2 swivel 200 mm roller bearing castors.
GA824R
Weight
Overall Dims (including buffers)
kg
L x W x H mm
Single end
33
1440 x 645 x 950
GA611R
POA
GA611H
POA
Double end
42
1540 x 645 x 950
GA612R
POA
GA612H
POA
2 ends and 1 removable side
49
1540 x 645 x 950
GA613R
POA
GA613H
POA
2 ends and 2 removable sides (box body)
57
1540 x 645 x 950
GA614R
POA
GA614H
POA
Single end
44
1440 x 845 x 950
GA821R
POA
GA821H
POA
Double end
55
1540 x 845 x 950
GA822R
POA
GA822H
POA
2 ends and 1 removable side
62
1540 x 845 x 950
GA823R
POA
GA823H
POA
2 ends and 2 removable sides (box body)
70
1540 x 845 x 950
GA824R
POA
GA824H
POA
Description
Model with Price Resilex wheels
Model with cushion cushion wheels
Price
PLATFORM SIZE 1210 x 610 mm
PLATFORM SIZE 1210 x 810 mm
ALUMINIUM turntable TRUCKS • A versatile range ideal for use within industrial and commercial • food and textile production. • High tech and engineering industries. • Highly combustible working environments. • Aesthetically pleasing. • Non sparking. • Odourless.
• Hygienic. • Non contaminating. • Easy to clean.
Optimum weight reduction whilst giving maximum load capacity. Turntable steering – Aluminium turntable assembly fitted with stainless steel bearing plate. GA910C
General specification – Framework of all welded aluminium RHS. Steel axles, zinc plated.
Maximum Platform Without sides & ends With Aluminium sides & ends Wheels distributed size All with roller bearing load kg L x W x H Weight Model Price Weight Model Price 250 x 50 mm 4-ply Pneumatic 56 kg GA910P POA 71 kg GA930P POA 500 1210 x 810 x 330 mm 250 x 50 mm Cushion 57 kg GA910J POA 72 kg GA930J POA 400 x 100 mm 4-ply Pneumatic 60 kg GA910C POA 75 kg GA930C POA 750 1210 x 810 x 480 mm 400 x 100 mm Cushion 88 kg GA910M POA 103 kg GA930M POA 400 x 100 mm 4-ply Pneumatic 118 kg GA920C POA 140 kg GA940C POA 750 2000 x 1000 x 480 mm 400 x 100 mm Cushion 146 kg GA920M POA 168 kg GA940M POA
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
253
MATERIAL HANDLING CASH & CARRY TROLLEYS HIGH LOADING CASH AND CARRY GP166H • High platform for ease of loading. • Rear nesting facility, allowing easy access to trolleys. 100 of these nestable trolleys can be stored in the space normally occupied by 25 conventional units (30m). Capacity
Platform Size mm
Overall Size mm
Overall Platform Height mm Height mm Wheels
300 kg 1185 x 580 1220 x 690 900 315
Weight kg Model Price
125 mm Cushion 2 Fixed 2 Swivel
27
GP166H
POA
CASH & CARRY NESTABLE • Platform Size: 1130 x 620mm 100 nestable trolleys can be stored in the space normally occupied by 27 conventional units (37m). Both models with roller bearing wheels. Capacity
Overall Overall Platform Size Height Height Wheels Weight Model mm mm mm mm kg
Price
STANDARD 2 fixed 125 300 kg 1230 x 700 950 215 2 swivel 125 HEAVY DUTY 2 fixed 200 500 kg 1230 x 750 975 292 2 swivel 125 Bottle Basket
23
GP1633
POA
29
GP164H
POA
GP701A
POA
500 x 203 mm
GP166H
GP1633 Shown nesting with Bottle Basket GP701A
GP164H Shown nesting with Bottle Basket GP701A
C & C STANDARD • Load Capacity 300 kg • Platform Size: 1100 x 600mm
Basic model, used in a wide range of applications for order picking and distribution. GP161H Platform Effective end Overall Wheel Weight Height mm depth mm Height mm size mm Wheel type kg Model Price 2 swivel, 2 fixed 280 520 915 200, 125 solid rubber 38 GP161H POA roller bearing
CASH & CARRY NARROW • Load Capacity: 250kg • Platform Size: 1525 x 380mm Specially designed for cash and carry warehouses with narrow passage ways and restricted turning space. Platform Effective end Overall Wheel Weight Height mm depth mm Height mm size mm Wheel type kg Model Price
GP162H
254
4 swivel, 2 fixed 230 985 1209 200, 125 solid rubber 39 GP162H POA roller bearing
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
DIY TROLLEYS
MATERIAL HANDLING
GS194H
GS197H GS195H
DIY TROLLEYS This range of trolleys are ideal for a variety of uses. Model GS197H, Heavy Duty DIY and Timber Trolley, is suitable for large heavy duty timber products and heavy bagged/boxed materials. Model GS194H, Timber and Fence Panel Trolley, is suitable for boxed or bagged products such as cement, composts and building materials plus large sheet materials/doors/fence panels. Model GS195H, Board/DIY Trolley is suitable for carrying lightweight boxes and rolled materials plus lightweight boards/panels/doors etc. The plastic coated basket on models GS194H and GS195H is ideal for small packets, bottles, tins and jars. Overall Size L x W x H (mm)
Platform Height (mm)
Platform Size (mm)
Basket Size (mm)
Wheels (mm)
Load Capacity
Weight
Model
Price
915 x 685 x 1000
190
840 x 685
840 x 330 x 155
127 mm Cushion Swivel Castors
400 kg
24 kg
GS194H
POA
865 x 485 x 965
140
795 x 485
790 x 150 x 150
102 mm Cushion Swivel Castors
250 kg
16 kg
GS195H
POA
30 kg
GS196N
POA
30 kg
GS197H
POA
310 x 710 x 1055 1 255 1210 x 710 Nylon Plain Bearing 1310 x 710 x 1055 255 1210 x 710 Cushion Roller Bearing
2 x 200 mm wheels 500 kg and 4 x 150 mm Swivel Castors 500 kg
wheeled board trolley 2
GS130D
GS180H
ADJUSTABLE BOARD TROLLEYS • Maximum load capacity: 250 kg. Available with diamond formation or firm load wheelbase. Four locating positions for the safe transportation of GS182H Overall Size
Platform
Platform
Wheels mm
Formation L x W x H mm Height mm Size mm
plates, boards etc.
Weight Diamond Formation Model
Price
Model
Price
1070 x 706 x 970
295
1000 x 700 200 x 50 Cushion Roller Bearing 47
GS180H
POA
GS182H
POA
1270 x 806 x 970
295
1200 x 800
GS181H
POA
GS183H
POA
2 Fixed, 2 Swivel
kg
Firm Load
54
TWO-WHEEL BOARD TROLLEY For transporting thin sheet-steel, plywood, plasterboard, etc. Maximum load capacity: 100kg Overall Size L x W x H mm
Carrying Frame L x W mm
2134 x 455 633 x 152 x 1020
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Wheels mm
Weight
Model
Price
Cushion 200 x 45 Plain Bore
13.5 kg
GS130D
POA
255
MATERIAL HANDLING SPECIAL TROLLEYS
BH908Y BH794M
BAGGAGE TRUCK Designed for use at hotels and stations/ports for the handling of luggage. Manufactured in an all welded construction with 32 mm 14 gauge tube, fitted with a 1.2 mm galvanised sheet platform on an exterior grade plywood base. The 250 mm deep ends can also serve as a nameplate if required.
Overall Handle Height Load Platform Length When Level Wheels Capacity Weight Model 810 mm x 16 x 4 1465 mm 1840 mm 970 mm 4 ply pneum 600 kg 95 kg BH794C 810 mm x 1465 mm 1840 mm 970 mm
16 x 4 cushion
750 kg
Price POA
100 kg BH794M
POA
FD201N
BH908Y Shown Nesting
NESTING BAGGAGE TROLLEY
Originally designed for international passenger shipping lines and now used in vast quantities in port terminals and on board ships, where space is restricted. Their nestability is a great asset as it enables 50 trolleys to be stored in an area of 72 sq ft. Fitted with 4 x 127 mm swivel cushion castors.
Overall L x W mm 760 x 510
Weight kg 16
Model BH908Y
Price POA
STACKABLE FURNITURE TROLLEY
• Maximum Load 300 kg When empty these furniture trolleys can be stacked to save space. • Load Capacity: 200 kg per unit • Versatile They are able to be fork lifted complete with suite and stacked on • Lightweight • Supplied in pairs Pallet Racking. Bottom Frame Size: 2020 long x 1080 deep. Top Frame Multi purpose units ideal for moving furniture, boxed items etc. Fitted Size: 2010 long x 620 deep. Finish: Midnight Blue. with 4 swivel 100 mm nylon castors. The flush top is fitted with a protective ribbed green carpet cover. Overall Dimensions Wheel Type Weight Model Price
FURNITURE TROLLEY
Overall Size L x W x H mm
Weight kg
Model (Sold in pairs)
Price per pair
600 x 300 x 130
5
FD201N
POA
BEDDING TROLLEY
L x W mm
2020 x 1150
& Size
kg
4 x 127 mm 35 cushion swivel
GS8003
POA
CARPET TROLLEY
• Maximum Load 300 kg • Maximum Load 500 kg Specifically designed for transporting Beds. It is a balanced unit fitted Specially manufactured to move rolls of carpet. with 4 braking swivel castors and 2 wheels. Platform Height: 241 mm The height to the ‘V’ of the cradle is 475 mm. Overall Dimensions L x W x H mm 1813 x 1050 x 1309
256
Wheel Type & Size 2 x 200 x 50 mm cushion wheels 4 x 127 mm swivel rubber castors
Weight kg 69
Model
GS840H
Price
POA
Overall Dimensions L x W x H mm
Wheel Type & Size
Weight kg
Model
Price
1515 x 555 x 533
400 x 100mm 2 ply pneumatic
17
GS820B
POA
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
MATERIAL HANDLING
SPECIAL TROLLEYS
PB100Y
PM102Y
plate bogie
LIGHTWEIGHT panel mover
A simple and effective way of moving sheets easily. Adjusts automatically to take sheets up to 115 mm thick. Fitted with 2 x 125 mm nylon wheels the Bogie can easily move loads of up to 250 kg.
A lightweight unit, ideal for moving drywall, plywood or any other panels. Able to move 2 sheets at a time. Fitted with 2 x 100mm rubber wheels.
• Heavy Duty • Maximum Load Capacity: 250 kg
• Makes moving panels simple and easy • Maximum Load Capacity: 100 kg
Overall Dimensions L x W x H mm
Weight kg
Model
285 x 270 x 280
6
PB100Y
Price
POA
Overall Dimensions L x W x H mm
Weight kg
Model
530 x 300 x 730
2
PM102Y
Price POA
Beam Trolleys Welded tubular steel construction and fitted with steel ‘shoes’ to prevent wear. Ideal for transporting beams and cylindrical objects. Top Frame Size: 1000 x 400 mm. Wheels mm Roller bearing
Model
Price
Load Capacity 200 kg
200 x 50 cushion
GS860H
POA
400 kg
200 x 50 nylon
GS861N
POA
400 kg
350 x 75 cushion
GS862L
POA
400 kg
400 x 100 cushion
GS863M
POA
400 kg
400 x 100 2 ply Pneumatic
GS864B
POA
GS860H GS1913
GS1912 Dolly with removable plywood deck
PD350N
plastic dolly
Dollies
• Load Capacity 350 kg Constructed from heavy duty plastic and fitted with 4 x 75 mm poly swivel castors this Dolly is ideal for moving heavy loads. Wheels supplied loose for easy fixing before use.
• Load Capacity 250 kg Robust angle iron construction. Model GS1912 is fitted with a removable plywood deck. Fitted with four 100 mm swivel castors.
Platform Size L x W x H mm 610 x 405 x 125
Weight kg 6
Model
PD350N
Price
POA
Overall Size
Platform Height
Weight
Model
Price
622 x
150 mm
10 kg
GS1912
POA
486
150 mm
9 kg
GS1913
POA
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
257
MATERIAL HANDLING GARMENT RAILS GARment rails • Lightweight Lightweight and ideal for light duty use. Both units are easily manoeuvrable on 4 x 44mm swivel polypropylene wheels. Model CGR01Y has a wire hat rack for additional storage space. Model CGR02Y is adjustable in height from 1020mm to 1700mm and has a base storage rack for storing shoes, bags, boxes etc. Finish: Epoxy powder coated white.
Overall Size mm Fixed
CGR02Y
970 x 490 x 1670
Model
Price
CGR01Y
POA
CGR02Y
POA
Adjustable 950 x 500 x 1020 to 1700
CGR01Y
GARMENT RAILS
• Epoxy Powder Coated Black • Load Capacity: 80kg Welded tubular steel construction. Two sizes available, either static or mobile, and either Single or Double Bar. Mobile models are mounted on 4 swivel castors with 50 mm PVC wheels. Dims LxWxH
Single Bar 1200 x 490 x GSG14Z 1800mm
GSG16Z
GSG26Y
GS8053
Mobile Model Price
Static Model Price
1800 x 490 x GSG16Z 1800mm Double Bar 1200 x GSG24Z 490 x 1800mm 1800 x GSG26Z 490 x 1800mm
GSG36N x 2
POA GSG14Y
POA
POA
GSG16Y
POA
POA
GSG24Y
POA
POA
GSG26Y
POA
GSG44R
NESTABLE GARMENT RAIL
NESTING FRAME RAIL
HEAVY DUTY RAIL
Chrome garment rail finished in eggshell black paintwork to withstand the heaviest use. Centre rail adjustable at 990, 1142 and 1295 mm. Fitted with 125 mm Cushion Wheels.
‘Z’ frame rails constructed from welded tubular steel and finished in black epoxy powder coating. Fitted with 50 mm P.V.C. wheels
Fitted with 125 mm grey rubber wheels. Welded tubular steel construction, powder coated black, with 4 rubber handgrips
• Space Saving
Dimensions L x W x H mm
258
1220 x 500 x 1760
Model GS8053
Price POA
• Storage Shelf • Rail Height: 1920 mm • Handle Height: 1030 mm
• Space Saving • Rail Height: 1770 mm
Dimensions L x W x H mm 1220 x 490 x 1800 1800 x 490 x 1800
Model GSG34N GSG36N
Price POA POA
Dimensions L x W x H mm 1200 x 500 x 1930 1800 x 500 x 1930
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Model GSG44R GSG46R
Price POA POA
WAREHOUSE TRUCKS
MATERIAL HANDLING Warehouse Trucks • Strong Welded Construction • Very Manoeuvrable • Up to 500 kg Capacity A well designed range of trucks comprising of firm load and balanced trucks. There are varying sizes and styles to suit individual applications. Balanced Trucks Designed to pivot on the centre wheels thus aiding manoeuvrability. The end wheels slide along axles and are re-centralised by two spiral return springs. Plywood infil depth on models GW144H and GW145Y of 680 mm. Overall height 1105 mm.
GW144H GW131H
Firm Load Trucks Firm Load Truck models GW121Y and GW122Y have an overall height of 1030 mm, and models GW131H and GW132H have an overall height of 1090 mm.
GW121Y
Description
Platform Size L x W x H mm
Load Capacity
Weight
Wheels
Model
Price
FIRM LOAD Single end
1065 x 600 x 230
300 kg
38 kg
2 Fixed 2 Swivel
GW121Y
POA
Double end
1065 x 600 x 230
300 kg
40 kg
160 mm Nylon
GW122Y
POA
Single end reinforced end uprights
1500 x 760 x 300
500 kg
45 kg
2 Fixed 2 Swivel
GW131H
POA
Double end reinforced end uprights
1500 x 760 x 300
500 kg
49 kg
200 mm Cushion
GW132H
POA
1220 x 685 x 285 1220 x 685 x 285
500 kg 500 kg
46 kg 46 kg
200 mm Cushion 200 mm Nylon
GW144H GW145Y
POA POA
BALANCE TRUCKS - Plywood Ends Double end reinforced end uprights Double end reinforced end uprights
HB572Y
GW311H
HEAVY DUTY BALANCE TRUCKS
WIRE MESH CONTAINER TRUCKS
Inset with a Plywood Platform, this unit has tubular push handles at each end. Wheels: 200 mm 2 fixed centre castors / 2 end wheel-axles with special return springs to centralise sliding wheels.
Produced from 50 x 50 x 10 mm gauge mesh, the internal container size is 920 x 670 x 650 mm. Wheels: 200 mm 2 central on axle / 2 sliding wheel-axles with special return springs to centralise sliding wheels.
• Maximum Distributed Load 500 kg.
• Maximum Distributed Load 300 kg.
Description
Platform size Lx W
Weight
Model
Price
Description
Single end
1000 x 700 mm
56 kg
HB571Y
POA
3 sides
Double end
1000 x 700 mm
56 kg
HB572Y
POA
+ 1 x 1⁄2 side
Single end
1200 x 800 mm
61 kg
HB581Y
POA
3 sides
Double end
1200 x 800 mm
61 kg
HB582Y
POA
+ 1 x 1⁄2 drop side
Overall H x L
Wheels
Weight
Model
Price
890 x
Cushion
40 kg
GW301H
POA
970 mm
Nylon
40 kg
GW302Y
POA
890 x
Cushion
45 kg
GW311H
POA
970 mm
Nylon
45 kg
GW312Y
POA
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
259
MATERIAL HANDLING WAREHOUSE TRUCKS BULK HANDLING TRUCKS High quality trucks especially designed for either manual or power towing. The optional rear towing hitch and towbar attachment enables the units to be successfully towed in a train. Fully welded construction with the four corners of the frame rounded to prevent structural damage to surrounding premises. This feature also enhances the appearance and the hygiene maintenance of the truck. Available in four varying platform sizes with either mesh or GENERAL SPECIFICATION tubular superstructure. • Overall height 1190 mm • Internal body height 900 mm • Load Capacity 500 kg • Finished in stove enamel Moondust grey • 18 mm exterior grade plywood deck - varnished • 2 fixed & 2 swivel 200 mm rubber castors
BH270H fitted with 2 x BS271Z, BH004Z and BH002Z
• All units are fitted with double “D” bumper strip as standard
BH271H fitted with BH005Z 4th half side
Optional Extras
Platform Size mm
3 sided Mesh Superstructure 3 sided Tubular Superstructure Optional Centre Shelf Model Weight Price Model Weight Price Model Price Weight
1000 x 700
BH170H
45 kg POA
BH171H
37 kg
POA
BS171Z
7 kg
1200 x 700
BH270H
50 kg POA
BH271H
44 kg
POA
BS271Z
7 kg
1200 x 1000
BH210H
60 kg POA
BH211H
50 kg
POA
BS211Z
1500 x 1000
BH510H
70 kg POA
BH511H
60 kg
POA
BS511Z
POA
Braked Castor (2 off fitted with swivel & wheel lock) Rear towing Hitch
Model BH002Z
POA
Towbar
BH003Z
7 kg
POA
4th Side with half drop hinged
7 kg
POA
4th half side (not
BH001Z
BH004Z
available in mesh)
BH005Z
THREE SIDED SLOPING SHELF TRUCKS • Load Capacity 500 kg • 3 Shelf Sizes All welded construction finished in stove enamel yellow. Fitted with 3 fixed re-inforced shelves and deck which all slope from front to rear to prevent items sliding off. Vertical push / pull handles are fitted at both ends for easy manoeuvrability. Clearance between shelves: 350 mm. Fitted with 4 swivel 150 mm castors.
GP580H Shelf Size
mm
260
Shelf Heights mm
Overall L x W x H Wheels mm
Weight kg
Model
Price
POA POA POA POA POA POA
915 x 559
280, 660, 1040, 1420
1185 x 589 x 1560
Cushion Nylon
58 58
GP559H GP560Y
1200 x 580
280, 660, 1040, 1420
1470 x 610 x 1560
Cushion Nylon
84 84
GP580H GP581Y
1524 x 762
280, 660, 1040, 1420
1794 x 792 x 1560
Cushion Nylon
131 131
GP762H GP763Y
GL1453
These lightweight trucks have a load capacity of 250 kg. Available with either easy steer or firm load formation wheels. Platform size: 900 x 600 mm. Platform height: 165 mm. Container height: 550 mm, Overall height: 900 mm. Effective half side depth: 240 mm. Wheels 127 mm cushion, 2 fixed 2 swivel.
Easy Steer Wheels
Firm Load Wheels
Description
Weight Kg
Model
Price
Model
Price
4 Mesh Sides
31
GL1043
POA
GL1443
POA
4 Mesh Sides 1 x 1⁄2 drop side
35
GL1053
POA
GL1453
POA
Full Security
40
GL1063
POA
GL1463
POA
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
BALANCED TRUCKS
WB612B
MATERIAL HANDLING
WB659M
WATER BARROWS
Heavy Duty Wheelbarrows
Capacity 136 litres (30 gals). Overall size 1270 x 787 x 700 mm high fitted with heavy galvanised water bins with wire edges and pouring lip. Body-Galvanised. Frame-Painted
Model
Wheels
WB612M
Cushion
WB612B
Pneumatic
Weight
Strongly constructed, available with either a painted or galvanised body. All metal bodies are bolted to the frame. Smooth insides, free from projections. Wheels 400 x 100 mm roller bearing.
Cubic
Overall Size
Body Size
Capacity
L x W x H
(top)
Price
Body Depth Weight Wheels (front, back)
Painted Body
Galvanised Body
Model Price Model Price
43 kg
POA
425 1956 x 75 kg 1524 x
Cushion /Twin wheel
WB609M
WB659M
29 kg
POA
Pneumatic /Twin wheel
WB609B
WB659B
litres/ 15ft3
889 x 838 mm 457 mm 61 kg 1050 mm
BALANCED TRUCKS • Highly Manoeuvrable • Strong Construction
HB348B
HB342B
HB349B
• Easy to Handle • Roller Bearing Wheels A range of well-balanced trucks that handle with minimum manual effort — even over rough ground, making them ideal for Garden Centres and similar activities. Platforms of 2-wheel models are of exterior grade plywood as are the easily removed hinged sides, where fitted. The chassis assembly is made from all-welded rolled steel and tubular sections. Also available in knock-down form for export.
Platform size mm
Two-wheel Trucks without sides
1500 x 800
Overall size mm
Platform Height
2085 x 810
420 mm
65 kg
Cushion 400 x 100 mm
HB342M
POA
with Handles
420 mm
51 kg
2-ply pneumatic 400 x 100 mm
HB342B
POA POA
Weight Wheels
Model
Price
1770 x 810
420 mm
62 kg
Cushion 400 x 100 mm
HB348M
Max. Distributed Load 400 kg
without Handles
420 mm
48 kg
2-ply pneumatic 400 x 100 mm
HB348B
POA
205 mm drop down sides and
2085 x 810
420 mm
74 kg
Cushion 400 x 100 mm
HB345M
POA
with Handles
420 mm
60 kg
2-ply pneumatic 400 x 100 mm
HB345B
POA
fixed ends
1770 x 810
420 mm
71 kg
Cushion 400 x 100 mm
HB349M
POA
without Handles
420 mm
57 kg
2-ply pneumatic 400 x 100 mm
HB349B
POA
1470 x 710
420 mm
62 kg
Cushion 400 x 100 mm
HB351M
POA
without Handles
420 mm
48 kg
2-ply pneumatic 400 x 100 mm
HB351B
POA
Max. Distributed Load 400 kg
1500 x 800
1200 x 700
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
261
MATERIAL HANDLING BALANCED TRUCKS
HB750J HB800J
HB600B
• Easy to Handle • Strong Construction
Description
Strong robust timber decked trucks, suitable for rough and uneven ground, able to be handled with minimum effort. Manufactured from all welded rolled steel and tubular sections. Models HB750J and HB600M/B have hinged steel sides that can easily be removed if required. The balanced wheel arrangement allows the truck to be completely turned round within its own body length.
HB650B Platform Size L x W x H
Side Height
Weight
Wheels
Model
Price
Four-wheel Truck without sides Max Distributed Load 350 kg
1145 x 800 x 420 mm
1500 x 800 — 52 kg mm
2 x 250 2 x 200 mm Solid rubber tyred
HB800J
POA
Four-wheel Truck with hinged steel sides Max Distributed Load 350 kg
1145 x 750 x 420 mm
1500 x 800 300 mm 59 kg mm
2 x 250 2 x 200 mm Solid rubber tyred
HB750J
POA
2 x 400 x 100 mm cushion
HB650M
POA
440 650 mm 52 kg mm
2 x 400 x 100 mm Pneumatic
HB650B
POA
1500 x 62 kg 600 x 1900 x 225 mm
2 x 400 x 100 mm cushion
HB600M
POA
2 x 400 x 100 mm Pneumatic
HB600B
POA
Two-wheel Truck without sides Max Distributed Load 400 kg Two-wheel Truck with hinged steel sides Max Distributed Load 400 kg
1500 x 58 kg 650 x 1900 x —
440 650 mm 56 kg mm
HB323L
HB320B
BALANCED TRUCKS Models HB320L/M/B have a single wheel and a distributed load capacity of 200kg. General purpose model HB323L has twin wheels and takes a distributed load of 250kg. All models have cushion wheels except model HB320B which is fitted with 4 ply pneumatic.
262
Overall Dimensions L x W
Model
Platform size mm
Overall size mm
Platform Height
Weight kg
Wheels
HB320L
1525
1955
413 mm
39.5
355 x 75
POA
HB320M
x
x
440 mm
42
400 x 100
POA
Price
HB320B
660
660
440 mm
35.4
400 x 100
POA
HB323L
1020 x 610
1730 x 660
sides/ends 200 mm
38
355 x 75
POA
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
GENERAL PURPOSE TRUCKS
MATERIAL HANDLING
TI201B
PLATFORM TRUCK WITH MESH SIDES Ideal for the transportation of boxes, containers etc. The truck has a 1200 x 600 mm mesh platform and 2 x 180 mm drop down mesh sides and ends. Fitted with 340 mm pneumatic steel centred wheels. Mesh size: 50 x 25 mm Diamond Pattern. Sides and ends interlock together. Finish: Epoxy coated Blue
Overall Dimensions L x W x H mm
1235 x 615 x 1035
TI202B
Model
Price
1200 x 600 x 360
43
TI201B
POA
TWO TRAY PLATFORM TRUCK
Ideal for the transportation of boxes, containers etc. Fitted with 250 mm pneumatic steel centred wheels. Mesh size: 50 x 25 mm Diamond Pattern. Finish: Epoxy coated Blue.
Weight kg
TI203B
PLATFORM TRUCK
Platform Dimensions & Size
Platform Dimensions L x W x H mm
Weight kg
Model
Price
1220 x 610 x 360
35
TI202B
POA
A two shelf platform truck designed for the transportation of boxes, tools etc. Fitted with 250mm pneumatic steel centred wheels. Platform / Shelf mesh size: 50 x 25 mm Diamond Pattern: Finish: Epoxy coated Blue. Top Tray Height: 825 mm.
Platform Dimensions L x W x H mm
Weight kg
Model
Price
980 x 510 x 335
30
TI203B
POA
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
263
MATERIAL HANDLING ROUGH TERRAIN TRUCKS low load turntable trucks • 3 models available: Aluminium Chequer Plate, Sheet Steel or Expanded Metal Deck • Cushion or Pneumatic Wheels. • Red Stove Enamel finish. Three models available in this range of multi purpose turntable trucks. A 250 mm deep box body is optional on the Solid Steel or Expanded Metal Deck models. The box body is manufactured from 18mm thick exterior grade plywood with metal reinforcement corners. Finish: Polyurethane Varnish. The Aluminium Deck model has an all tubular steel deck surround with radiussed corners and a 4.5 mm aluminium chequer plate and is fitted with a ball bearing turntable plate. The handle is spring loaded to return to upright position. The Sheet Steel model has a 12 swg sheet steel deck with a 35 mm lip all round. The Expanded Metal model has a flattened expanded metal deck with a 35 mm lip all round. GP998P
GP896K
GP717J Platform
Platform
Max
Weight
Load
kg
Model
Price
500
33
GP716P
POA
500
36
GP717J
POA
200 mm Pneumatic
180
33
GP896K
POA
200 mm Cushion
350
35
GP897H
POA
Description
Size
mm mm
kg
Aluminium
1000
250 mm Pneumatic
Deck
x 650
250 mm Cushion
Sheet
Steel
Deck
910 x
Height
320
Wheels
300
250 mm Pneumatic
450
36
GP898P
POA
250 mm Cushion
450
39
GP899J
POA
Expanded
200 mm Pneumatic
180
25
GP996K
POA
200 mm Cushion
350
27
GP997H
POA
250 mm Pneumatic
450
28
GP998P
POA
250 mm Cushion
450
31
GP999J
POA
12
GP890Z
POA
Metal
Deck
610
910 x
280
610
Optional Box Body to suit Sheet Steel or
GP998P fitted with GP890Z
264
Expanded Metal Models. Size 900 x 600 x 250 mm
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
HAND DRAWN TRUCKS
MATERIAL HANDLING
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628)
TP522C
Turntable/ Ackerman Steering Stable and Strong
Turntable Steering — fitted with ball-bearing turntable assembly. Easy steering when fully loaded.
Ackerman Steering — from a central pivot and transmitted by adjustable track
rods. No possibility of tipping when turning since wheels are located under and support each corner at all times. General Specification — All welded tubular steel and heavy angle sections with platforms of either tongue and groove timber boards or exterior grade plywood. Friction Parking Brake This optional extra can be factory fitted to all new trucks. It is operated by a foot pedal at the rear of the platform
Ref
TP709A
Price fitted
Wire mesh Superstructure Suitable for Turntable or Ackerman with or without half drop side. Height 915 mm infilled with 50 x 50 mm mesh. Box construction with 1 lift out long side. Platform Size mm Box Suffix
TP502C
Box with half drop side Suffix / WG
1200 x 700
/ WM
1500 x 800
/ WM
/ WG
2000 x 1000
/ WM
/ WG
Add-on prices for trucks without sides and ends.
Turntable Trucks *Depth of Sides and Ends 300 mm Maximum Without Sides and Ends Distributed Load 750 kg 1000 kg
Platform size
Platform Height
1200 X 700 1500 x 800 mm
505 mm
2000 x
Wheels (mm) (All Roller Bearing) Weight
Timber Model Price
Plywood Model Price Weight
With Sides and Ends* Timber Plywood Model Price Model
Price
400 x 100 4-ply pneumatic 62 kg
TP500C
POA
TP600C
POA 88 kg
TP520C
POA
TP620C
POA
400 x 100 Cushion
105 kg
TP501M
POA
TP601M
POA
133 kg
TP521M
POA
TP621M
POA
400 x 100 4-ply pneumatic 77 kg
TP501C
POA
TP601C
POA
105 kg
TP521C
POA
TP621C
POA
400 x 100 Cushion
132 kg
TP502M
POA
TP602M
POA
165 kg
TP522M
POA
105 kg
TP502C
POA
TP602C
POA
138 kg
TP522C
POA
1000 mm 400 x 100 4-ply pneumatic
TP622M TP622C
POA POA
Ackerman Type Trucks *Depth of Sides and Ends 300 mm Maximum Without Sides and Ends Distributed Load
Platform size
Platform Height
Wheels (mm) (All Roller Bearing) Weight
Timber Model Price
Plywood Model Price Weight
With Sides and Ends* Timber Plywood Model Price Model
1500 X
400 x 100 Cushion
106 kg
TP503M
POA
TP603M
POA
137 kg
TP523M
POA
800 mm
400 x 100 4-ply pneumatic 79 kg
TP503C
POA
TP603C
POA
109 kg
TP523C
POA TP623C
POA
2000 x
400 x 100 Cushion
126 kg
TP504M
POA
TP604M
POA
160 kg
TP524M
POA
TP624M
POA
400 x 100 4-ply pneumatic 99 kg
TP504C
POA
TP604C
POA
133 kg
TP524C
POA
TP624C
POA
1000 kg
505 mm
1000 mm
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
TP623M
Price
POA
265
MATERIAL HANDLING INDUSTRIAL TRAILERS
IT560C
Industrial Trailers • Up to 2000 kg loads • Rugged Construction • Many Safety Features Up to 1000 kg loads, the ball-bearing turntable design assures easy turning, even by hand, with a fully laden load. Up to 2000 kg loads, the large, ring-type turntables make the trailers easily manoeuvrable, and the heavy king-pins ensure safe towing in trains. All platforms are of tongue and groove boards. Special Safety Features: A ‘stop’ prevents the drawbar from dropping below 230 mm from the ground. A ‘lock’ holds drawbar vertically when not in use. A spring-loaded retaining ball in the rear coupling pin eliminates self-releasing when using a towing hitch. Optional Extras Friction Parking Brake For trailers which are likely to be parked on ramps or slopes. Operated by a foot pedal at the rear of the platform. Towing Hitch When several trailers are to be used in a train, a rear towing hitch can be fitted to all models.
Ref
IT709A
Price fitted Ref
IT710A
Price fitted
Industrial Trailers - Depth of Sides and Ends 300 mm
Standard Wire Mesh Superstructures Suitable for Industrial Trailers with or without half drop side. Wire mesh sides and ends. Height 915 mm infilled 50 x 50 mm mesh. Box construction with 1 lift out long side.
Platform Size Box
mm
1500 x 800
Box with half drop side Suffix
Suffix / WM
/ WG
2000 x 1000 / WM
/ WG
2500 x 1250 / WM
/ WG
Add-on prices for trucks without sides and ends.
Maximum Without Sides and Ends Distributed Platform Platform Wheels Load size Height (All Roller Bearing) Weight Model Price
1500 x
800 mm
1000 kg
2000 x
1000 mm
2500 x
2000 kg
1250 mm
Weight
Model
Price
110 kg
IT540M
POA
138 kg
IT560M
POA
4-ply pneumatic 400 x 100 mm 82 kg
IT540C
POA
110 kg
IT560C
POA
Cushion 400 x 100 mm
138 kg
IT541M
POA
171 kg
IT561M
POA
4-ply pneumatic 400 x 100 mm
110 kg
IT541C
POA
143 kg
IT561C
POA
Cushion 460 x 125 mm
243 kg
IT542N
POA
283 kg
IT562N
POA
6-ply pneumatic 460 x 125 mm
203 kg
IT542E
POA
243 kg
IT562E
POA
Cushion 400 x 100 mm
505 mm
580 mm
With Timber Sides and Ends*
Model IT550
Long Load Trailers • Maximum Load Capacity: 2000 kg A very rugged and reliable trailer. Easy steering by a ring-type turntable. Rear carriage can be moved along the centre pole to vary the length between bolsters from 2.1 m to 3.9 m. Loading
Overall Height width
Wheels (All Roller Bearing)
660 mm 1200 mm
266
Weight
Model
Price
Solid Rubber 460 x 125 mm
267 kg
IT550N
POA
6-ply pneumatic 460 x 125 mm
227 kg
IT550E
POA
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
INDUSTRIAL TRAILERS
MATERIAL HANDLING
HEAVY DUTY TRAILERS • Up to 10,000 kg Loads • Rugged All welded Construction • Easily Manoeuvrable
As with our standard industrial trailers this range includes two special safety features. A ‘Stop’ prevents the drawbar from dropping below 230 mm from the ground — eliminating risk of injury to operator’s feet. A ‘Lock’ holds drawbar vertically when not in use. A spring-loaded retaining ball in the rear coupling pin eliminates self-releasing when using a towing hitch. Towing eye diameter 50 mm (alternative size on request).
FOUR WHEEL ACKERMAN STEERING trailers The ball bearing turntable transmits thrust and traction forces over a large surface and does not have any friction
• The ACKERMAN STEERING enables tight turning circles without threatening the stability of the load. • The drawbar is detachable and may be used at either end of the trailers enabling power towing from either end. • A special safety feature prevents the drawbar from passing the horizontal point, eliminating risk of injury to operators feet. • Available with a load capacity of upto 3000 kg with the option of either chequer plate or timber platform. • Reinforced ackerman with rear support. • Heavy duty steering turrets fitted with thrust bearing and phosphor bronze bushed.
heavy duty INDUSTRIAL TRAILERs Maximum Distributed Load
Platform Wheels Height
Approx. Weight
570 mm
460 x 125 mm 6-ply pneumatic
300 kg
Steel – Chequer Plate
HT873E
POA
2500 x
620 mm
35 mm Ball Bearing
250 kg
Timber – Tongue & Grooved
HT883E
POA
1250 mm
570 mm
460 x 125 mm Cushion
340 kg
Steel – Chequer Plate
HT873N
POA
620 mm
35 mm Ball Bearing
290 kg
Timber – Tongue & Grooved
HT883N
POA
Add Suffix
/LS3
Steel – Chequer Plate Hardwood – Tongue & Grooved
HT875P HT895P
Add Suffix
/LS5
Steel – Chequer Plate Hardwood – Tongue & Grooved
HT8710P HT8910P
POA POA
HT710A
POA
Platform Type
Model
Price
Steel Chequer Plate Timber Tongue & Grooved Steel Chequer Plate Timber Tongue & Grooved Steel Chequer Plate Timber Tongue & Grooved Steel Chequer Plate Timber Tongue & Grooved Steel Chequer Plate Timber Tongue & Grooved Steel Chequer Plate Timber Tongue & Grooved
HA571M HA581M HA571C HA581C HA572N HA582N HA572E HA582E HA573N HA583N HA573E HA583E
POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA
3000 kg
Platform Size L x W
Link turntable steering for above 300 x 76 mm cast centred 5000 kg 2500 x 420 mm Polyurethane Tyres 350 kg 1250 mm 470 mm 32 mm Taper Roller Bearing 350 kg ink turntable steering for above L 300 x 102 mm cast centred 10,000 kg 3000 x 495 mm Polyurethane Tyres 550 kg 1500 mm 520 mm 32 mm Taper Roller Bearing 550 kg Link steering for above
Add Suffix
Platform Type
Model
Price
POA POA
/LS10
Rear towing hitch for all models
FOUR WHEEL ACKERMAN STEERING TRAILERS Maximum Platform Platform Approx. Distributed Size Height Wheels Weight Load L x W 1000 1000 2000 2000 3000 3000
kg kg kg kg kg kg
2000 x 1000 mm 2000 x 1000 mm 2500 x 1250 mm 2500 x 1250 mm 2500 x 1250 mm 2500 x 1250 mm
500 550 500 550 580 630 580 630 580 630 580 630
mm mm mm mm mm mm mm mm mm mm mm mm
400 x 100 mm Solid rubber 243 kg tyred 25 mm roller bearings 400 x 100 mm x 4 Ply Pneumatic 203 kg 25 mm roller bearings 450 x 125 mm Solid rubber 300 kg tyred 30 mm roller bearings 450 x 125 mm x 6 Ply Pneumatic 280 kg 30 mm roller bearings 450 x 125 mm Solid rubber 350 kg tyred 30 mm roller bearings 450 x 125 mm x 6 Ply Pneumatic 330 kg 30 mm roller bearings
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
267
MATERIAL HANDLING Turntable Trucks FOUR WHEEL ACKERMAN TRUCKS Available in 3 Wheel Options Ackerman, dual axle trolley - enables tight turning circles without threatening the stability of the load Detachable sides & ends are available as options
ACKERMAN STEERING FOR TIGHTER TURNING CIRCLES
AT901J & AT901S
AT901L
Description Flat Deck Unit
Wheels 250mm Pneumatic
Platform Size L x W mm
250mm Cushion
1200 x 600
350mm Cushion
Detachable Sides & Ends
-
Platform Load Weight Height mm Capacity kg kg 250 38 310 250 42
Model AT901P AT901J
435
400
60
AT901L
-
-
-
AT901S
HEAVY dUTY TURNTAbLE TRUCKS
250mm dia Rubber, Steel centred Heavy Duty wheels Handle Height: 1070mm 4Sided Unit Sides: 180mm This unit incorporates a Heavy Duty handle operated park brake Lift the handle up & it operates the stoppers on the wheels shown on the image on the left hand side
IDEAL FOR THE MOST DEMANDING JOBS
TI802B Max Load
700 KG
Handle Operated Park Brake
Hard Wearing Veneer Finish
268
Description
Platform Size L x W mm
Flat Deck Unit 4 Sided Unit
1250 x 700
Weight kg 65 86
ACKERMAN STEERING LINKAGE
Model TI802B TI801B
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
General Purpose Trucks
MATERIAL HANDLING
General Purpose Trucks
Max Load
250 KG
TI202B
GENERAL PURPOSE TRUCKS IDEAL FOR USETHROUGHOUT INDUSTRY
Max Load
250 KG
TI206B
Description Mesh Base Plywood Base
Platform Size L x W x H mm 1220 x 610 x 310
Weight kg 35
TI202B
36
TI206B
Model
PLATFORM TRUCKS Fitted with 250mm Pneumatic Steel centred wheels TI202B - mesh size: 50 x 25mm Diamond Pattern TI206B - 15mm Exterior Grade Plywood
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
269
MATERIAL HANDLING General Purpose Trucks General Purpose Trucks
Max Load
400 KG
GENERAL PURPOSE TRUCKS IDEAL FOR USETHROUGHOUT INDUSTRY
Max Load
400 KG
PLATFORM TRUCK WITH MESH SIDES Platform Size: 1200 x 600mm &2 x 275mm drop down mesh sides & ends. TI201B - Mesh Base Diamond Pattern Description TI205B - 15mm Exterior Grade Plywood Base Mesh Base Mobile on 340mm Pneumatic Steel centred wheels Plywood Base Sides & ends interlock together
270
Platform Size L x W x H mm 1200 x 600 x 360
Weight kg 43
TI201B
44
TI205B
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Model
WAREHOUSE TROLLEY
MATERIAL HANDLING
The Furnibox FurniBoxes are the tailored solution for the furniture industry. Optimally suited for low-level warehouses and block stores and with additional equipment also for high-bay warehouses. Sturdy tubular steel frame construction. 1 inch = 34 mm thick. High-quality synthetic paint, blue RAL 5012, set of wheels: 100 mm polypropylene, 3 swivel castors and 1 directional roller. Expandable thanks to special accessories.
All Furniboxes can be folded up by means of the “foldup trick”. Space when folded-up 75%
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
271
MATERIAL HANDLING Upholstery Element cart
Upholstery Element cart The Upholstery Set Cart moves upholstered furniture elegantly and with ease to any place desired. In spite of its light weight, it is made of rugged tubular steel and specially geared to upholstered furniture. High-quality synthetic paint, blue RAL 5012, set of wheels: 100 mm polypropylene, 3 swivel castors and 1 directional roller. The pull-out bars are galvanized and can be extracted (Âą) to a variable length from 2200 to 2800 mm and even up to 3100 mm (3 level Cart). They can thus be adapted to the specific upholstered furniture load. Model
Exterior Dimensions ( W x D x H )
Interior Dimensions ( W x D x H )
Weight
Load Cap.
Upholstery Set Cart
2800 x 1100 x 1260 mm
2200 x 700 x 920 mm
26 kg
300 kg
Upholstery Element Cart, 2 Levels
2800 x 1100 x 1260 mm
2200 x 700 x 920 mm
36 kg
300 kg
Upholstery Element Cart, 3 Levels
3100 x 894 x 1850 mm
2400 x 860 x 1850 mm
62 kg
300 kg
The Upholstery Set and Element Carts can be folded up when empty to save space. The bar supports are galvanized and can be pulled out to an infinitely variable length so as to adapt the support surface to the specific upholstered furniture.
272
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
STACKABLE CONTAINERS
MATERIAL HANDLING
330
330
1015
335
Sides in mesh - Bottom in sheet metal
Stacking dimensions applicable for all 4 models
stackable collapsible containers HIGHLY PRACTICAL WHEN OPENING AND CLOSING Fully collapsed it has a height of 1/3 of an open container, making it possible to optimize space in storage and handling.
Model
Dimensions A
B
C
D
E
Cap. kg
SR 159
1000
800
620
100
45
1000
SR 160
1200
800
620
100
45
1000
SR 161
1200
1000
820
100
45
1000
SR 162
1500
1000
970
100
45
1000
1
2
3
4
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
273
MATERIAL HANDLING STACKABLE CONTAINERS
Available on request with sides in sheet metal
Version with flat steel skid in anti roll-over plate
stackable collapsible containers
Stackable
Any size can be made on request
274
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
STACKABLE CONTAINERS
MATERIAL HANDLING
stackable collapsible containers Model SR 194
Dimensions A
B
C
D
1240
800
810
150
Cap. kg 800
C
D
A
B
Zinc electro-plating
COLLAPSIBLE METAL WIRE SIDES Collapsible mesh sides for “EUR” type boards
The mesh sides are practical and economical, easily transforming the boards into practical containers. Collapsible and stackable, they solve problems of space and order in production, for transporting, inside the warehouse and when selling. Stackable 3+1 Model
C
SR 195
Dimensions
Cap. kg
A
B
C
1215
815
1015
800
B A Zinc electro-plating
C
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628)
B
A Model SR 196
Dimensions A
B
C
1215
815
535
Cap. kg 800
Zinc electro-plating
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
275
MATERIAL HANDLING COLLAPSIBLE CONTAINERS
Model SR 156
Dimensions A
B
C
D
E
1215
815
800
100
40
Cap. kg 800
Available on request with sides in sheet metal
STACKABLE COLLAPSIBLE CONTAINERS B
A
E
C
40
D
G
F
2 sides closed 310
240
Model
276
Dimensions A
B
C
D
E
F
G
Cap. kg
SR 157
1200
800
800
150
50
1290
890
800
SR 158
1200
1000
800
150
50
1290
1090
800
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
BIG BAG PALLET
MATERIAL HANDLING
Big bag pallet with demountable structure
1350
1070 1070
Stackable Big Bag Pallet • Mesh bottom with removable uprights • Hot-galvanised carbon steel construction • Suitable for holding 1000 litre Big Bags (or flexible bag) Article Code
Dimensions (mm)
Capacity (kg)
Volume Litres
BBAG 0700 ONU
900 x 900 x 1000 H
1000
700
BBAG 1000 ONU
900 x 900 x 1200 H
1000
1000
BBAG 1500 ONU
900 x 900 x 1700 H
1000
1500
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
277
MATERIAL HANDLING BIG BAG PALLET Big bag pallet with SAFETY TRAY & demountable structure
1850
Big Bag holder pallet • Featuring a watertight safety tray for liquids with removable galvanised grid. • Construction made in 3 and 4 mm carbon steel. • Four pull-out uprights. • Upper Big Bag holder frame that snaps into the four pull-out uprights. • Corrosion proof exterior treatment and safety labelling.
1000 1000
Big bag pallet openable container with gas dampers • Big Bag safety container for the temporary storage of scraps. • Quadrangular layout construction with carbon steel load-bearing casing. Rainproof door. Hinged upper door servo-assisted with 2 gas pistons. • On request, optional safety labels and symbols available for product identification.
278
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
GLASS FIBRE TROLLEYS
MATERIAL HANDLING
1 x GFJ32Y
3 x GFK53Y
•Three Colour Options Available. Please specify when ordering. Blue Green Red • A range of robust trucks with rolled top edges which add to strength and durability. • Square or diamond wheel formation. • Rigid, does not soften or distort in higher temperatures. • Smooth easy clean internal finish very hygienic no dust traps, no timber. • Worn castors may be replaced. • Security models available.
1 x GFK23Y with GFZ002
ON LARGER MODELS • There is a half drop front panel to make loading easy, Depth 610 mm x • Width 610 mm tapering to 578 mm across the hinge. • Lids slope - so the rain drains off when kept outdoors. OPTIONAL EXTRAS - See page opposite for price details. • Post box style lid with additional lock, provides a secure and practical means of storing • and transporting confidential information prior to shredding. • All standard hinged lids can be manufactured with a lock. • Two braked 125mm nylon castors factory fitted available to the square wheel formation • units only. • Name plates (as shown on next page) can be produced to meet customers • individual requirements. Price on Application. Description
Internal Load Dimensions Capacity L x W x H mm kg
1 x GFM35Y
Overall Weight Square Wheel Diamond wheel Dimensions Kg formation Price formation L x W x H mm wheels wheels
Price
1168 x 660 SKIP WITH 1⁄2 DROP FRONT PANEL CUBIC CAPACITY 855 Litres (30 ft3) x 1067 600 CASTORS 125 mm NYLON
Skip only With removable sloping lid With hinged sloping lid
1245x750x1295 1245x750x1370 1245x750x1370
50 GFM15Y 58 GFM25Y 58 GFM35Y
POA GFM45Y POA GFM55Y POA GFM65Y
POA POA POA
SKIP WITH 1⁄2 DROP FRONT PANEL 991 x 648 CUBIC CAPACITY 598 Litres (21 ft3) x 813 600 CASTORS 125 mm NYLON
Skip only With removable sloping lid With hinged sloping lid
1090x750x1040 1090x750x1115 1090x750x1115
28 GFL14Y 35 GFL24Y 35 GFL34Y
POA GFL44Y POA GFL54Y POA GFL64Y
POA POA POA
SKIP WITHOUT 1⁄2 DROP FRONT PANEL 838 x 533 CUBIC CAPACITY 270 Litres (91⁄2 ft3) x 622 600 CASTORS 125 mm NYLON
Skip only With removable lid With hinged lid
915x610x850 915x610x850 915x610x850
13 GFK13Y 17 GFK23Y 17 GFK33Y
POA GFK43Y POA GFK53Y POA GFK63Y
POA POA POA
SKIP WITHOUT 1⁄2 DROP FRONT PANEL 533 x 381 CUBIC CAPACITY 114 Litres (4 ft3) x 637 300 CASTORS 65 mm NYLON
Skip only With removable lid With hinged lid
610x455x780 610x455x780 610x455x780
8 GFJ12Y 10 GFJ22Y 10 GFJ32Y
POA POA POA
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
- - -
- -
279
MATERIAL HANDLING GLASS FIBRE TROLLEYS • Smooth easy to clean internal finish • Stackable • Stain Resistant • Non Porous • Lightweight
GSF11Z
GFF06Y
GFD04Y
GFB02Y
GFA01Y
GFB22Y
OPTIONAL EXTRAS FACTORY FITTED
OPTIONAL EXTRA’S ALL FACTORY FITTED
GFK33Y - Shown above with - Braked Castors GFZ002 - Post Box slot GFZ003, Locking Mechanism GFZ004. GFJ32Y - Shown above with - Post Box slot GFZ003 Locking Mechanism GFZ004 Name Plate Price on application
280
O/all
Internal
L x W x H
Dimensions
mm
L x W x H mm
575 x 415 x 380
575 x 415 x 388
610 x 457 x 610
610 x 457 x 618
610 x 381 x 760
610 x 381 x 768
610 x 457 x 745
610 x 457 x 753
914 x 381 x 605
914 x 381 x 613
x 483
200
914 x 610 x 760
838 x 533
914 x 610 x 840
x 622
686 x 457 x 542
686 x 457 x 550
610 x 457 x 430
610 x 457 x 438
540 x 388 x 496
200
546 x 318 x 635
200
534 x 381 x 622
200
851 x 305
GFZ002
Post Box style slot only - additional to models with lids only
GFZ003
Lock Mechanism, available with hinged lid only
GFZ004
Wheels
Weight kg
Skip Only
Price
Model
Weight kg
Skip with removable lid
Price
Model
Skip with hinged lid
Price
Model
Nylon 50 mm
6
GFA01X
POA
7
GFA21X
POA
GSA14X
POA
Rubber 64 mm
6
GFA01Y
POA
7
GFA21Y
POA
GSA14Y
POA
Nylon 50 mm
6
GFB02X
POA
7
GFB22X
POA
GSB15X
POA
Rubber 64 mm
6
GFB02Y
POA
7
GFB22Y
POA
GSB15Y
POA
Nylon 50 mm
6
GFC03X
POA
7
GFC23X
POA
GSC16X POA
Rubber 64 mm
6
GFC03Y
POA
7
GFC23Y
POA
GSC16Y
Nylon 50 mm
6
GFD04X
POA
7
GFD24X
POA
GSD17X
POA
Rubber 64 mm
6
GFD04Y
POA
7
GFD24Y
POA
GSD17Y
POA
POA
Nylon 50 mm
6
GFE05X
POA
7
GFE25X
POA
GSE18X
POA
6
GFE05Y
POA
7
GFE25Y
POA
GSE18Y
POA
200
Nylon 64 mm
10
GFF06Y
POA
11
GFF26Y
POA
GSF10Y
POA
500
Nylon 125 mm
16
GFF07Z
POA
17
GFF27Z
POA
GSF11Z
POA
200
540 x 388 x 318
Two Braked Castors - only available on 125 mm castors
Rubber 64 mm
610 x 381 x 419
GFZ001
kg 200
Model
Drain Plug
Load Capacity
508 x 356 x 254
GFE05Y
200
Nylon 50 mm
6
GFG08X
POA
7
GFG28X
POA
GSG12X
POA
Rubber 64 mm
6
GFG08Y
POA
7
GFG28Y
POA
GSG12Y
POA
Nylon 50 mm
6
GFH09X
POA
7
GFH29X
POA
GSH13X
POA
Rubber 64 mm
6
GFH09Y
POA
7
GFH29Y
POA
GSH13Y
POA
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
CONTAINER TRUCKS
MATERIAL HANDLING
• 5 Colour Options Available Blue
Red
Green
Yellow
Natural
Please specify colour when ordering.
Dimensions (L x W x H) mm‑ Internal External
Capacity Litres Kg
NESTING MOBILE TRUCKS Wt
Nylon Castors
Model
610 x 400 x 550 700 x 485 x 660 135
45
8 kg 4 x 50 mm Swivel GC9414
560 x 400 x 700 680 x 485 x 750 150
45
8 kg 4 x 50 mm Swivel GC9424
760 x 400 x 550 875 x 495 x 620 165
45
8 kg 4 x 50 mm Swivel GC9434
610 x 560 x 550 720 x 670 x 620 185
45
8 kg 4 x 50 mm Swivel GC9444
915 x 330 x 550 1030 x 430 x 620 165
45
8 kg 4 x 50 mm Swivel GC9454
Price
• • • • •
Economically priced range of plastic trucks. Moulded in medium density food grade polyethylene. Fully nestable when empty for easy storage and transport. Moulded in anti-jam design. Bighead mesh plates moulded in to the base of the truck with castors fitted separately - now completely watertight.
• 5 Colour Options Available Blue
Red
Green
Yellow
Natural
Please specify colour when ordering. Dimensions (L x W x H) mm Capacity Static
Internal Litres kg 460 x 320 x 515 65 150 445 x 445 x 660 120 200 585 x 380 x 590 130 250 LID ONLY FOR MODEL GC8403 730 x 370 x 580 160 250 LID ONLY FOR MODEL GC8404 605 x 605 x 535 190 250 800 x 770 x 625 350 300 600 x 600 x 1015 360 350 780 x 780 x 800 445 450
Model External GC8401 505 x 370 x 555 GC8402 480 x 480 x 680 GC8403 660 x 460 x 595 GC8003 GC8404 810 x 450 x 595 GC8004 GC8405 680 x 680 x 540 GC8406 920 x 860 x 645 GC8407 695 x 695 x 1030 GC8408 860 x 860 x 820
Wt Kg Price 4.5 5.3 5.6 1.5 7 1.5 9.5 13 15 14
Mobile Wt Model External Kg GC8411 510 x 370 x 675 8 GC8412 480 x 480 x 800 10 GC8413 660 x 460 x 715 11 GC8013 1.5 GC8414 810 x 450 x 690 13 GC8014 1.5 GC8415 680 x 680 x 660 15 GC8416 920 x 860 x 780 22 GC8417 695 x 695 x 1165 20 GC8418 860 x 860 x 955 18
Price
MOBILE/STATIC CONTAINERS Manufactured from food grade polyethylene, these containers can either be static or mobile. Suitable for use in temperatures of -20°C to +60°C. The mobile version is fitted with reinforced 12 mm plywood base with corner mounted 75 mm, 2 fixed, 2 swivel nylon castors on the smaller models and 100 mm, 2 fixed 2 swivel nylon castors on the larger ones. Both mobile and static models have two zinc plated metal handles.
Static models should not be moved when fully loaded.
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
281
MATERIAL HANDLING STORAGE CONTAINERS TAPERED AND INTERSTACKING BINS
GC5414 Shown with Dolly GD544Y
GC5412 Shown with Lid GC0402 and Dolly GD542Y
GC5422 & GC5421 Shown stacked
GC5424
Manufactured in food grade polyethylene. Inert to most acids and alkalies and can withstand a temperature of - 20˚C to + 60˚C. Drop on lids available. Blue Steel dollies available for all models fitted with 75 mm swivel castors. 5 Colour Options Available Blue Red Green Yellow Natural Please specify colour when ordering. STORAGE BINS -Tapered Models Dimension Dia D x H (mm) Internal
External
Capacity Litres kg
Wt
Model
Price
kg
Lid
Price
to suit
Dolly to suit
305 x 380
350 x 390
20
10
1.66
GC5411
GC0401
GD541Y
400 x 510
460 x 520
45
20
2.72
GC5412
GC0402
GD542Y
440 x 570
510 x 585
65
25
4.09
GC5413
GC0403
GD543Y
485 x 635
540 x 645
85
30
4.54
GC5414
GC0404
GD544Y
505 x 640
575 x 650
110
30
5.45
GC5415
GC0405
GD545Y
480 x 765
540 x 775
110
45
5.45
GC5416
GC0406
GD546Y
610 x 870
700 x 890
215
55
7.5
GC5417
GC0407
GD547Y
Price
STORAGE BINS - INTERSTACKING Models Dimensions Dia D x H (mm) Capacity Wt
Model Internal External Litres Kg Kg 380 x 180 430 x 185 15 12 1.82 380 x 305 430 x 310 25 15 2.72 380 x 430 430 x 435 40 20 2.27 380 x 635 430 x 640 60 28 3.18 Lid to suit above Models GC0400 Dolly to suit above Models
Price GC5421 GC5422 GC5423 GC5424 POA GD548Y
POA POA POA POA POA
POLYETHYLENE DOLLY
• Dolly Load Capacity 420 kg
This dolly is manufactured from 100% food grade polyethylene. Suitable for use with the range of interstacking bins shown above. It is extremely easy to clean making it ideal for food related environments. 5 Colour Options Available Blue Yellow
Red
Green
Natural
Please specify colour when ordering.
External Internal Weight Dimensions Diameter kg mm mm 440 x 440 GC5424
282
PD001Y
PD001Y Shown with GC5422
380
5
Castors Model Price
4 x 75 mm PD001Y Swivel
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
POA
CONTAINER TROLLEYS
MATERIAL HANDLING
Manufactured to a high specification in tubular steel and finished in a hard wearing red epoxy powder coating. Complete with removable heavy duty grey polypropylene containers. Ideal for use within the food industry. Model CT3303 is fitted with 4 swivel castors and non marking wheels & comes complete with 3 x EC0019 Containers
Model CT3306 is fitted with 2 fixed & 2 swivel castors with non marking blue resilex wheels & corner buffers. The unit comes complete with 6 containers 2 x EC0021 & 4 x EC0019
Model CT3305 is fitted 4 x non marking swivel castors and is available either complete with 5 containers as shown 2 x EC0021, 2 x EC0019, 1 x EC0018 or as a trolley only. Model CT 3405 Full details & prices of containers available are shown with the Container Racks in this section.
CT3305
CT3306 CT3303
Description Overall Dimension L x W x H mm Shelf Heights mm Load Cap Weight Wheels mm Container Trolley Complete with 3 containers 600 x 455 x 1020 300 / 600 / 900 150 kg 20 kg 4 x 100 non marking Swivel Castors Container Trolley Complete with 5 containers 600 x 455 x 1610 200 / 490 / 780 / 1070 / 1360 150 kg 26 kg 4 x 100 non marking Swivel Castors 2 x fixed 2 Swivel Castors fitted with Container Trolley Complete with 6 containers 910 x 650 x 1065 325 / 625 / 925 200 kg 37 kg 125 non marking blue resilex wheels Container Trolley only 600 x 455 x 1610 200 / 490 / 780 / 1070 / 1360 150 kg 18 kg 4 x 100 non marking Swivel Castors 2 Braked Castors for Models CT3303 / CT3305 + CT3405 Factory Fitted 2 Braked Castors for Model CT3306 (Blue Resilex Wheels) Factory Fitted
• 3 Colour Options Available please specify colour when ordering • Complete with plastic containers
Blue
Red
Green
Price POA POA
CT3306 CT3405 CT003Z CT006Z
POA POA POA POA
CT408Y
DMR25Y
mobile container trolley
Model CT3303 CT3305
CT404Y
CONTAINER storage trolley • Maximum Load: 150 kg • Complete with plastic containers • Container size: 415 x 370 x 185 (L x W x H)
All-welded steel angle, fitted with 4 x 100 mm swivel nylon castors. Supplied with 10 heavy duty interstackable grey polypropylene containers with solid base and sides. Container Dimensions (mm). Ext: 600 x 400 x 175 mm Int: 555 x 355 x 164 mm
These trolleys are fitted with non-slip rubber matting on the top shelf and 4 grey plastic buffer wheels to protect walls. Easily manoeuvrable on 4 swivel 100 mm rubber non-marking wheels.
Overall Dimensions Load Capacity Weight L x W x H mm kg kg 940 x 640 x 1110 250 53 2 Braked Castors optional extra factory fitted
Number of Containers
Overall Dimensions L x W x H mm
Weight kg
Model
Price
4
490 x 575 x 1120
22
CT404Y
POA
8
490 x 1020 x 1120
37
CT408Y
POA
Model DMR25Y MR003Z
Price
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
283
MATERIAL HANDLING CONTAINER TROLLEYS CONTAINER TROLLEYS Model GC666Y comes complete with 20 Store Bins and provides a very efficient system of mobile storage. Model GC667Y has a shelf depth of 400 mm enabling the store bins and the containers to be placed length-ways enabling a combination of store bins or solid/ slotted containers to be used.
GC666Y
SPECIFICATION Max load capacity: 300 kg (Load per shelf 75 kg) Overall Dimensions (L x W x H) 1300 x 450 x 1440 Castors: 125 mm rubber tyres non marking 2 fixed 2 swivel Finish: Blue epoxy coated. Shelves: Size: 1250 x 600 mm - Varnished exterior grade plywood.
Weight kg
Model
Price
Small parts container trolley complete with 20 store bins
60
GC666Y
POA
Narrow aisle trolley only
54
GC667Y
POA
Stacking store bin - colour blue
0.3
GC0016
POA
Description
GC667Y
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628)
STOCK TROLLEY • Easy to Handle • Load Capacity: 300kg • Adjustable Shelves
Manufactured in square section steel and finished in a hard wearing blue epoxy powder coating. The four shelves have a varnished plywood insert, with the two centre shelves adjustable to three heights. Fitted with 4 swivel castors (two with brakes) with 125 mm blue resilex wheels. N.B. Bins sold separately. O/all Dims L x W x H mm
700 x 530 x 1280
Shelf Heights mm
Shelf Size L x W mm
Weight kg
Model
Price
Shelf 1 - 200, Shelf 2 - 510/580/650 Shelf 3 - 815/890/960, Shelf 4 - 1270
630 x 415
30
GC669Y
POA
STOCK TROLLEY BINS - GC0017 Manufactured in high strength polypropylene co polymer. These grey containers are lightweight yet incredibly strong and come with a large label slot for quicker stock picking. Other features include - reinforcing ribs to allow stacking without distortion and a full width lip for secure locating. GC669Y Shown with 9 x GC0017
284
Overall Dimensions
Weight
L x W x H mm
kg
Model
455 x 210 x 230
1
GC0017
Price
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
GENERAL PURPOSE CASTORS
MATERIAL HANDLING Top Plate Castors Range of Rubber Tyred Castors from 80 to 200mm. Swivel wheel brakes available on swivel castors only. Add suffix BR to end of castor code
SWIVEL
FIXED
Wheel Dia.
Castor Type
80 mm 100 mm 125 mm 160 mm 200 mm
Swivel Fixed Swivel Fixed Swivel Fixed Swivel Fixed Swivel Fixed
BR
Overall Height 108 108 128 128 155 155 200 200 240 240
Capacity
mm 50 kg mm mm 75 kg mm mm 100 kg mm mm 150 kg mm mm 200 kg mm
Bolt Hole Spacing
Bearing Type
Castor Code
Price
80 x 60 mm 80 x 60 mm 80 x 60 mm 105 x 80 mm 105 x 80 mm
Roller Roller Roller Roller Roller Roller Roller Roller Roller Roller
MSC080RP1B MFC080RP1B MSC100RP1B MFC100RP1B MSC125RP1B MFC125RP1B MSC160RP1B MFC160RP1B MSC200RP1B MFC200RP1B
£7.75 £6.70 £9.45 £6.25 £12.00 £7.60 £13.40 £8.20 £12.65 £9.25
Bolt Hole Castors A range of Rubber Tyred Castors from 80 to 160mm. Swivel wheel brakes available. Add suffix BR to end of castor code
SWIVEL
SWIVEL with brake
Wheel Dia.
Castor Type
Overall Height
Capacity
Bolt Hole Size
Bearing Type
Castor Code
Price
Swivel
108 mm
50 kg
13 mm
Roller
MSC080RP1BBH
£8.40
80 mm
100 mm
Swivel
128 mm
75 kg
13 mm
Roller
MSC100RP1BBH
£9.40
125 mm
Swivel
155 mm
100 kg
13 mm
Roller
MSC125RP1BBH
£9.65
160 mm
Swivel
200 mm
150 kg
13 mm
Roller
MSC160RP1BBH
£13.95
Stainless Steel Castors MSS – swivel castors.
MFS – matching fixed castors
Footbrake Swivel wheel brakes available on swivel castors only. Add suffix BR to end of castor code
Single bolt hole castors available to special order. Price and delivery on request. MSS
MFS
BR
Wheel Dia. Castor Type Overall Height Capacity Swivel 117 mm 80 mm 120 kg Fixed 117 mm Swivel 127 mm 100 mm 150 kg Fixed 127 mm Swivel 156 mm 125 mm 160 kg Fixed 156 mm Swivel 180 mm 150 mm 190 kg Fixed 180 mm
Bolt Hole Spacing
Nylon
80 x 60 mm 80 x 60 mm 80 x 60 mm 80 x 60 mm
mss080ny mfs080ny mss100ny mfs100ny mss125ny mfs125ny mss150ny mfs150ny
Poly Tyred, Nylon MSS080PN MFS080PN MSS100PN MFS100PN MSS125PN MFS125PN MSS150PN MFS150PN
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
285
MATERIAL HANDLING MEDIUM DUTY STEEL CASTORS MS – swivel castors.
MF – matching fixed castors Footbrake Footbrakes are available on rectangular top plate MS Series swivel castors with 75 and 100 mm type RN and NY wheels. 100 mm castors have double ended brake. 75 mm castors have single ended brake. To order add suffix ‘BR’ to swivel castor codes.
MS Castor
Wheel Dia.
Swivel /Fixed
Overall Height
Bolt Hole Bearing Spacing
MF Castor
Poly Tyred Cast Iron Cast Iron Nylon
Poly Tyred Nylon
Rubber Tyred Nylon
Swivel 64 54 x 25 Plain – – 50
MSD050NY 40kg
MSD050CI – – 54 kg
MSD050RN 27 kg
Fixed 64 54 x 25 Plain – –
MFD050NY 40 kg
MFD050CI – – 54 kg
MFD050RN 27 kg
Swivel 78 76 x 44 Plain – – 63
MSD063NY 85kg
MSD063CI – – 85 kg
MSD063RN 45 kg
Fixed 78 76 x 35 Plain – –
MFD063NY 85 kg
MFD063CI – – 85 kg
MFD063RN 45 kg
Swivel 95 80 x 60 Plain 75
MSE075PC 115 kg
MSE075NY 140 kg
MSE075CI – – 140 kg
MSE075RN 90 kg
Fixed 95 83 x 35 Plain
MFE075PC 115 kg
MFE075NY 140 kg
MFE075CI – – 140 kg
MFE075RN 90 kg
Plain 100 Swivel 125 105 x 80 Roller
– – 250 kg MSE100PC1B
MSE100NY 230 kg – –
MSE100CI 250 kg – –
MSE100PN 230 kg – –
MSE100RN 160 kg –
–
Plain – – Fixed 125 100 x 48 250 kg Roller MFE100PC1B
MFE100NY 230 kg – –
MFE100CI 250kg – –
MFE100PN 230 kg – –
MFE100RN 160 kg –
–
Plain 125 Swivel 154 140 x 105 Roller
– – 270 kg MSE125PC1B
MSE125NY 300 kg – –
MSE125CI MSE125PN MSE125RN 300kg 300 kg 180 kg – – – – –
–
Plain Fixed 154 100 x 48 Roller
– – 270 kg MFE125PC1B
MFE125NY 300 kg – –
MFE125CI 300 kg – –
–
Plain 150 Swivel 181 140 x 105 Ball
– – MSE150NY 540 kg 400 kg MSE150PC2B MSE150NY2B
MSE150CI MSE150PN – 540kg 400 kg 300 kg – – MSE150PN2B MSE150RN2B
–
Plain Fixed 181 133 x 67 Ball
– – MFE150NY 540 kg 400 kg MFE150PC2B MFE150NY2B
MFE150CI MFE150PN – 540 kg 400kg 300 kg – – MFE150PN2B MFE150RN2B
–
MFE125PN 300kg – –
MFE125RN 180 kg –
Threaded stem and nut fitting Stem M12 x 25 mm LG. To order add suffix ‘ST’ to castor code. Available on 63 and 75 mm castors.
Triangular plate fitting Available on 63, 75 and 100mm dia. type RN and NY plain bearing swivel wheels. Plate details: 63 and 75 mm castors. Plate size: 140 x 140 mm. Bolts: 8 mm at 73 to 102 mm centres (variable), 19 mm from edge of plate.
100 mm castors. Plate size: 150 x 150 mm. Bolts: 10 mm at 96 to 114 mm centres (variable), 19 mm from edge of plate. To order add suffix ‘V’ to swivel castor codes.
286
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Pallet Trucks
MATERIAL HANDLING
HAND pallet truck - 2000 kg • Load Capacity 2000 kg • Lowered height of forks 75 mm
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628)
• Fork width 150 mm • 160 mm Nylon Steering Wheels • 70 mm Nylon front rollers • All models are complete with an entry and exit roller • Ergonomically designed handle with a 3 position control lever • Manufactured and approved to European GS Standards • Raised height of forks 190 mm • Repair and Maintenance service available, see below Fork Length
Width over Forks
Weight kg
Model
Price
1000 mm
520 mm
55
GZE11N
POA
1000 mm
685 mm
58
GZE12N
POA
1150 mm
520 mm
56
GZE13N
POA
1220 mm
685 mm
59
GZE14N
GZE11N
NARROW AISLE Pallet Trucks • • • • • •
2000 kg capacity Highly manoeuvrable, steers through full 180° Fork width 160 mm Fork height when lowered 85 mm Fork height when raised 200 mm Overall height 1160 mm
Fork length mm
Width over forks mm
Approx Weight kg
Nylon Roller / Steering Wheels
Price
810
58
GX205N
POA
910
58
GX206N
POA
1000
59
GX207N
POA
1220
60
GX209N
POA
450
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
287
MATERIAL HANDLING Weigh Scale Pallet Trucks HAND pallet truck - 2000 kg Large 25mm LCD display for easy reading keyboard with Zero & Tare functions Powered by 4 x AA easily available batteries Operating time of approximately 80 hours in continuous use or 3 months in normal use thanks to its auto switch-off function Polyurethane coated steering wheels & front rollers
Large 25mm LCD Display with 4 easily available AA batteries
MAX CAPACITY OF 2000KG BY 1KG INCREMENTS Fork Length mm 1150
Width over Forks mm 550
Weight kg 120
Optional ISO:9000 Calibration Certificate
Model GTPWN
GTPWN
ISO-CERT
HEAVY DUTY WEIGH SCALE PALLET TRUCK Extremely accurate, triple weigh range, which changes automatically: 0 - 500kg by 0.2kg increments 500 - 1000kg by 0.5kg increments 1000 2000kg by 1kg increments Large swivelling LCD display in IP65 rated waterproof indicator housing Supplied with 230Vac battery charger which gives an operating time of approx.50 hours in continuous use, thanks to its auto switch-off function Rubber steering wheels & Polyurethane double loading front rollers Optional built in Thermal Printer with lowpower consumption available - Call for Details Fork Length mm 1150
Width over Forks mm 550
Weight kg 125
Optional ISO:9000 Calibration Certificate
ATEX MODELS AVAILABLE CALL FOR DETAILS Max Load
2500 KG
Model GTPWA ISO-CERT
Large 25mm LCD Display with optional thermal printer
GTPWA
STAINLESS STEEL WEIGH SCALE PALLET TRUCK Constructed from High Grade Stainless Steel Extremely accurate, triple weighrange, which changes automatically :0 - 500kg by 0.2kg increments 500 - 1000kg by 0.5kg increments1000 2000kg by 1kg increments Supplied with 230Vac battery charger which gives an operating time of approx.40 hours in continuous use, thanks to its auto switch-off function Nylon steering wheels & double loading front rollers Optional built in Thermal Printer with lowpower consumption available - Call for Details
IDEAL FOR FOOD, HEALTHCARE &PHARMACEUTICAL INDUSTRIES
Max Load
2500 KG
Fork Length mm 1182
Width over Forks mm 550
Weight kg 135
Optional ISO:9000 Calibration Certificate
288
Model GTPWI ISO-CERT
Large 25mm LCD Display
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
GTPWI
Specialist Trucks
MATERIAL HANDLING
ROUGH TERRAIN PALLET TRUCK
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628)
Adjustable forks from 220mm to 740mm Ideal for rough terrain outdoor applications suchas building sites, agricultural environments etc Raised Height of Forks: 240mm Lowered Height of Forks: 70mm Mobile on 250mm steering wheels & 380mm front fork wheels Low maintenance
ideal for rough outdoor applications
GZR01N Overall Size W x H mm 1605 x 1270
Fork Length mm 800
Weight kg 192
Model GZR01N
ROUGH TERRAIN PALLET TRUCK Load is raised & can be easily moved aroundin any direction, even in the tightest of areas Incorporates a 5M securing strap tosecure your loads to the units
IDEAL FOR BULKY &HEAVY WEIGHT ITEMS
LLM18H LLM06M Load Capacity kg 600 1800H
Manual3
Max Lift Height mm 00
Toe Plate Size D x W mm 120 x 225
ydraulic
250
60 x 600
Lift
Wheels 125mm Polyurethane 150mm Polyurethane6
Overall Size L x W x H mm 570 x 390 x 780 80 x 420 x 1070
Weight kg 25
Model (pairs) LLM06M
86
LLM18H
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
289
MATERIAL HANDLING Static Lift Tables STATIC LIFT TABLES (MAINS OPERATED) Comply to BS EN 1570 & BS EN 60204-1 Remote power system, easy for controlling, convenient for maintenance Electronic Control Box with Up,Down & Emergency buttons PSL82U: Specially designed in ‘U’ shapefor handling pallets & boxes Platform Cut Out - 1050L x 585Wmm Lifting Speed with Load: 42mm/sec
PSL80F
PSL82U
Load Capacity kg 1000
Lowered Platform Height mm 80 82
Raised Platform Height mm 760
Platform Size L x W mm 1450 x 1140
Lifting Time 18 secs.
Motor kw 0.75
Weight kg 235
PSL80F
250
PSL82U
Model
STATIC LIFT TABLES (MAINS OPERATED) Comply to BSEN 1570 & EN 60204-1 Can be floor or pit mounted Robustly constructed for arduous applications Emergency check valve for controlleddescent in system failure Fully interlocked arrestors HELP ALLEVIATE MUSCULOSKELETAL INJURIES
PSL29D Lowered
290
Load Capacity kg 1000
Min. Platform Height mm 190
Max. Platform Height mm
2000
190
3000
220
1020
2000
360
1780
1010
PSL29D
Platform Size L x W mm 1300 x 800 1300 x 850
Lifting Time 25 secs.
Lowering Time 20 secs.
Motor kw
40 secs.
30 secs.
26 secs.
22 secs.
1.5
320
PSL32S
40 secs.
35 secs.
2.2
295
PSL29D
0.75
Weight kg 220
PSL22S
280
PSL28S
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Model
semi-electric Stacker
MATERIAL HANDLING
Semi-Electric Stacker (MS SERIES)
• Heavy duty design and top quality mast construction • Safety guard on load roller and steering wheel • Light and easy manual steering system MS1516
MS1524
MS1529
MS1531
MS1533
Capacity (kg)
Model
1500
1500
1500
1500
1500
Max. Fork Height h3 (mm)
1600
2450
2900
3100
3300
Min.Fork Height (mm)
90
Load Center C (mm)
400
Wheels Base Y (mm)
1132
Load Distance X (mm)
450
Truck Length incl. Fork Face L2 (mm)
670
Lifting Speed (with/without load) (mm/s)
64/94
Lowering Speed (with/without load) (mm/s)
106/74
Fork Length I (mm)
1150
Fork Overall Width M (mm)
540
Single Fork Width (mm)
160
Front Wheel (mm)
Ф 82 x 70
Rear Wheel (mm)
Ф 180 x 50
Turning Radius Wa (mm)
1500
Power Pack (KW/V)
1.6/12
Battery (Ah/V)
180 x 2 / 12
Charger (A/V)
12 / 12
Overall Length L (mm)
1820
Overall Width B (mm)
800
800
800
1000
1000
Overall Height h1 (mm)
2125
1800
2025
2125
2225
Net weight (with battery) (kg)
480
540
580
595
610
Semi-Electric Stacker (PY SERIES)
• Ergonomic design with handle for easy pulling and pushing the stacker • Special frame design for heavy load 1000kg and 1500kg
• Strong brake castor for safety • Maintenance free battery
PY1025
PY1030
PY1525
PY1530
Capacity (kg)
Model
1000
1000
1500
1500
Load Center (mm)
600
600
600
600
Lifting Height (mm)
90-2500
90-3000
90-2500
90-3000
Fork Length (mm)
1150
1150
1150
1150
Fork Width (mm)
560
560
560
560
Min. outside turning radius (mm)
2000
2000
2000
2000
Max. Lifting Speed With Full Loading (m/min)
≥ 3.6
≥ 3.6
≥ 3.6
≥ 3.6
Lower Speed (mm)
Controllable
Controllable
Controllable
Controllable
Lifting Motor (W/V)
1600/200
1600/200
1600/200
1600/200
Battery (Ah/V) Charger Overall Length (mm)
120/12
120/12
120/12
120/12
220V/12V
220V/12V
220V/12V
220V/12V
1770
1770
1770
1770
Overall Width (mm)
700
700
700
700
Overall Height (mm)
1770
2020
1770
2020
Load Wheel Diameter (mm)
80
80
80
80
Steering Wheel Diameter (mm)
200
200
200
200
Net weight (kg)
375
405
400
430
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
291
MATERIAL HANDLING Full Electric Stacker Semi-Electric Stacker (PYJ SERIES)
• Ergonomic design with handle for easy pulling and pushing the stacker • Straddle leg and adjustable for lifting lower pallet and special size pallet • Special frame design for heavy load 1000kg and 1500kg
• Strong brake castor for safety • Maintenance free battery
PYJ1025
PYJ1030
PYJ1525
PYJ1530
Capacity (kg)
Model
1000
1000
1500
1500
Load Center (mm)
400
400
400
400
Lifting Height (mm)
75-2500
75-3000
75-2500
75-3000
Fork Length (mm)
915
915
915
915
Min. outside turning radius (mm)
2200
2200
2300
2300
Outside Width Between Legs (mm)
1080-1360
1080-1360
1080-1360
1080-1360
Inside Width Between Legs (mm)
960-1240
960-1240
960-1240
960-1240
Outside Width Between Forks (mm)
210-800
210-800
210-800
210-800
Inside Width Between Forks (mm)
10-600
10-600
10-600
10-600
≥ 3.6
≥ 3.6
≥ 3.6
≥ 3.6
Controllable
Controllable
Controllable
Controllable
1600-12
1600-12
1600-12
1600-12
Max. Lifting Speed With Full Loading (m/min) Lower Speed Lifting Motor (W/V) Battery (Ah/V)
120/12
120/12
120/12
120/12
220V/12V
220V/12V
220V/12V
220V/12V
Overall Length (mm)
1550
1550
1550
1550
Overall Width (mm)
1080-1360
1080-1360
1080-1360
1080-1360
Overall Height (mm)
1770
2020
1770
2020
Load Wheel Diameter (mm)
100
100
100
100
Steering Wheel Diameter (mm)
200
200
200
200
Net weight (kg)
440
470
465
490
Charger
FN1225
FN1229
FN1233
FN1525
FN1529
FN1533
Capacity (kg)
Model
1200
1200
1200
1500
1500
1500
Lifting Height (mm)
2450
2900
3300
2450
2900
3300
Min.Fork Height (mm)
90
90
90
90
90
90
Load Center (mm)
600
600
600
600
600
600
Fork Length (mm)
1150
1150
1150
1150
1150
1150
Fork Overall Width (mm)
540
540
540
540
540
540
Driver Wheel
Ф 250 mm, 1200 W/24V
Power Rack (KW/V)
2.2 / 24
Traction Battery (Ah/V)
165/24
Net weight (kg)
Dimension
292
648
670
691
658
680
701
X2 (mm)
190
190
190
190
190
19
L2 (mm)
774
774
774
774
774
774
h1 (mm)
1800
2025
2025
1800
2025
2025
h4 (mm)
3094
3546
3946
3096
3546
3946
X (mm)
455
455
455
455
455
455
Y (mm)
1279
1279
1279
1279
1279
1279
L (mm)
1924
1924
1924
1924
1924
1924
N (mm)
160
160
160
160
160
160
h3 (mm)
2450
2900
3300
2450
2900
3300
Wa (mm)
1540
1540
1540
1540
1540
1540
FN
FN-B
FULL ELECTRIC STACKER (FN SERIES)
• Tiller arm is mounted on one side for optimum control and visibility. • High-comfort tiller grip reduces fatigue, improving productivity. • Heavy-duty design with top quality mast construction. • Powerful drive and power unit made in Europe. • Top quality electronic control system from Curtis. • Multi-fuction handle includes crawl button, butterfly travel speed controls and lift/lower control offer variable speed adjustment.
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Full Electric Stacker
MATERIAL HANDLING
FULL ELECTRIC STACKER (FN-AC SERIES)
• Tiller arm is mounted on one side for optimum control and visibility • High-comfort tiller grip reduces fatigue, improving productivity • Heavy-duty design with top quality mast construction • Powerful power pack with European technology • Drive unit with electromagnetic brake, maintenance free AC technology • Top quality electronic control system from Curtis • Multi-fuction handle includes crawl button, butterfly travel speed controls and lift/ lower control offer variable speed adjustment Model
FN1225AC
FN1229AC
FN1233AC
FN1525AC
FN1529AC
FN1533AC
Capacity (kg)
1200
1200
1200
1500
1500
1500
Lifting Height (mm)
2450
2900
3300
2450
2900
3300
90
90
90
90
90
90
Min.Fork Height (mm) Load Center (mm)
600
600
600
600
600
600
Fork Length (mm)
1150
1150
1150
1150
1150
1150
Fork Overall Width (mm)
540
540
540
540
540
540
Driver Wheel
Ф 250 mm, 1200 W/24V AC
Power Rack (KW/V)
1.2 / 24
Traction Battery (Ah/V)
165/24
Net weight (kg) X2 (mm)
Dimension
FN-AC
648
670
691
658
680
701
190
190
190
190
190
19
L2 (mm)
774
774
774
774
774
774
h1 (mm)
1800
2025
2025
1800
2025
2025
h4 (mm)
3094
3546
3946
3096
3546
3946
X (mm)
455
455
455
455
455
455
Y (mm)
1279
1279
1279
1279
1279
1279
L (mm)
1924
1924
1924
1924
1924
1924
N (mm)
160
160
160
160
160
160
h3 (mm)
2450
2900
3300
2450
2900
3300
Wa (mm)
1540
1540
1540
1540
1540
1540
FN-B (AC)
Forklift Maintenance Platform (NK Series) • For overhead access and maintenance with safety • Spring loaded inward opening door with safety latch for safety entry • Unit is secured to the fork with heel pins and chain • Slip-resistant floor with drainage holes • Conforms to Health and safety Guidanie mte PM28 and GN48 standard • Less strorage space, portable and easy to assemble • Wheel fitted for easy manoeuvering Model NK30A NK30B NK30C Max. Capacity (kg) Deck Size (mm)
300
300
300
950 x 950
1200 x 1000
1000 x 1000
Max. Height (mm)
2000
2000
2000
Fork Spread (mm)
600/690
600/690
600/690
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628)
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
293
MATERIAL HANDLING FORK LIFT CAGES General Specification - MAINTENANCE PLATFORM Provides safe working access to inaccessible places, accommodating two people plus their tools and equipment. • Safety gate opens inwards, closing automatically through the use of a tension spring • loaded retention latch. • Non-slip steel floor plate with lip preventing tools etc. rolling off. • Platform is locked to the forks by 2 pins behind the heel of the forks. • Robust, all welded construction. • Finish in bright safety yellow with drivers warning plate at rear. • Available with castors for ease of parking. • Complies with Health and Safety guidance note PM28 - 2nd Edition. • Units are appropriately CE marked and supplied with user guide. • Fitted with an internal grab rail and safety harness anchor points • The maximum number of people permitted within these cages is two. • The capacity of the Fork Lift Truck must be double the weight of the cage and load, or greater
Fork POCKET General Specification mm wide x 83 mm deep, with inside 184 clearance 545 mm and overall clearance .921 mm
mm
.Fo
rk
NOTE Fork pocket specification can be altered to meet customers requirements. - Please specify when ordering otherwise the .above dimensions will apply
tine
65 ent
ry
Floating toggle to prevent .accidental withdrawal of pin Pin locks behind heel .of fork tines
MODELS FLC01Z and FLC11Y • Mesh back and 1/2 sides preventing tool droppage. • Optional tool box is available to hook on to the side rail of the • cage Model FLC09Z Size 455 x 205 x 210 mm high. • Front opening gate. Model
Evenly Dist
x 990 POA
FLC01Z
250
70 — 1040
swivel 4 POA
FLC11Y
250
74
Price Load, kg
Weight Internal Overall Platform kg Wheels Height of Height at Size gates mm Rear mm mm
nylon 125
1780
x 990 1040 1830 990
Optional Tool Box, Fitted with two hooks to enable the box to hang on the side
FLC03Z
990
FLC02Z
FLC01Z Shown with optional tool box FLC09Z
FLC04Z
MODELS FLC02Z TO FLC14Y INCLUSIVE As general specification detailed above. • Complete with a large tool container as shown. • Side opening gate. • Cages are fitted with mesh back and perimeter safety rail. Models FLC04Z and FLC14Y are also fitted with mesh sides and ends.
294
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Work Platform
MATERIAL HANDLING
Single Mast Aerial Work Platform (XP SERIES)
• A revolutionary design of mast provides the most stable and compact mast in the industry • Provides access to overhead fixture and stocked shelves much safer than traditional ladders or scaffolding • Available in AC or DC power • Suitable for single person to work upraised • Maximum platform height: 6m and 8m Model Max. Platform Height H1 (m)
XP1006
XP1008
6
8
Max. Working Height H2 (m)
7.7
9.7
Loading Capacity (kg)
160
136
630 x 650
630 x 650
2060 x 1900
2300 x 2180
AC220/50
AC220/50
Platform Size L2 x W2 (mm) Outrigger Footprint L1 x W1 (mm) Voltage (V/Hz) Power Pack Lifting (KW)
0.75
0.75
Power Pack Self-propeller (KW)
N/A
N/A
Stored Dimensions (L x W x H)
1290 x 880 x 1740
1290 x 880 x 2060
300
300
Net Weight (kg)
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
295
MATERIAL HANDLING SAFETY CABINETS SAFETY CABINETS FOR CHEMICALS
SAFETY CABINETS FOR CHEMICALS
Complying with EN 61010-1 and CEI 66-5 regulations. Constructed in FEP01 grade, 10/10 thick, electro-galvanized steel sheet (Skin passat) cold pressed and coated, following pre-treatment for removing grease, with an initial epoxy base application and two further thermo-hardening powder applications, oven set at 200°C. “Monolithic” design, with adjustable feet at the base to allow the structure to be properly levelled. “Sandwich-wall”, reversible doors are constructed in the same materials and come complete with handles incorporating safely closures and locks. Doors open 100°C so the shelves can be removed without having to tilt them. Multilingual safety signs indicate the presence of dangerous and toxic products to highlight contents and storage limitations.
SAFE 103 SAFE 106
SAFE 106 • External dimensions: 1140x600x1900 (1600+300)mm (WxDxH) • Internal dimensions: 1080x550x1500 mm (WxDxH) • Weight: 125 kg approx • 3 x full-width, 10/10 mm thick steel, tray-type shelves for retaining potential spilt liquid in the event of container breakage or leakage due to expansion of contents • Fully adjustable shelf height • Shelf dimensions: 1030x550x30 mm (WxDxH) • Shelf capacity: 80 kg • Internal overheating protection; IP 54 ingress protection level, double insulated • Fuse protection: 5x20mm, 1A quick blow • Extraction fan capacity: 275 cu.m/h maximum • Power supply: 220-230V 50Hz, single phase • Rating: 55 W • Activated carbon filter with a large filtering surface and prefilter, suitable for acids • Easy filter replacement behind a hinged panel with keylock • Handles fitted with lock and key
SAFE 107
SAFE 101 SAFE 107 SAFETY CABINET FOFt STORING POISONS • External dimensions: 500x300x400 mm (WxDxH) • Internal dimensions: 480x270x390 mm (WxDxH) • Volume: 44 litres approx • Weight: 10 kg • 2x10/10 mm thick steel, tray-type shelves for • retaining potential spilt liquid in the event of • container breakage or leakage due to expansion • of contents • Fully adjustable shelf height • Shelf dimensions: 470x270x20 mm (WxDxH) • Handles fitted with lock and key SAFE 101
• External dimensions: 600x500x700 mm (WxDxH) • Internal dimensions: 550x450x550 mm (WxDxH) • Weight: 32 kg approx • 2x10/10 mm thick steel, tray-type shelves for retaining potential spilt liquid in the event of container breakage or leakage due to expansion of contents • Fully adjustable shelf height • Shelf dimensions: 490x450x30 mm (WxDxH) • Adapted for use with external extraction systems • Handles fitted with lock and key
296
SAFEGLASS 106
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
SAFEGLASS 103 R
CYLINDER LOCKERS
MATERIAL HANDLING lockers for lpg cylinders • Completely hot-dipped galvanized, sturdy construction • Contents are protected against the weather for storing indoors as well as outdoors • Protected again unauthorised taking • Fitted with indicator labels with the danger symbol • Supplied disassembled • For preparing and emptying compressed gas containers in storing LPG cylinders • The locker is kept well ventilated thanks to air slits in the door and sides Model
Outer Measurements
Door
Cylinder Capacity
AB 010 Z
460 x 400 x 750 H
1
1 x 11 kg
AB 020 Z
840 x 400 x 750 H
1
2 x 11 kg
AB 023 Z
840 x 400 x 1500 H
1
2 x 33 kg
AB 040 Z
1680 x 400 x 1500 H
2
4 x 33 kg
STEEl TROLLEYS FOR CYLINDERS CABO 12 RZ
• Trolleys for safely handling gas cylinders • Sturdy construction is hot-dip galvanised steel • Support for the cylinders and safety steel chain
CABO 23 RZ
• Steel trolley for 2 cylinder, solid rubber wheels ø 350 mm, with supporting wheel
• ø max. cylinder 250 mm • Measurements : W x D x H (mm) 780 x 770 x 1290
CYLINDER basket • Hot-galvanised basket for storing and holding empty and full cylinders
• Can be handled with crane or forklift truck • Capacity : 12 x 50 l cylinders • Dimensions W x H x D (mm) : 805 x 1052 x 1100 • Collapsible ramp
• Steel trolley for 1 cylinder, solid rubber wheels ø 200 mm
• ø max. cylinder 250 mm • Measurements : W x D x H (mm) 490 x 460 x 1260
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
297
MATERIAL HANDLING Polyethylene cover
SMALL 1,000 litre tanks • Vessel in high-density UV-stabilised (neutral) polyethylene, made by blowing, with capacity 1055 litres, with 150 mm load opening (220 mm on request) • High-density UV-stabilised (neutral) bottom valve, made by injection moulding; featuring 4 seals available in different materials (FPM, EPDM, PTFE, NBR, PE) depending on the application. • High-density UV-stabilised polyethylene cover (black), made by injection moulding. ø 150 mm (220 mm on request), vent (on request) with hydrophobia membrane on cover • Galvanised steel tubular frame (18 x 18 mm), made by automatic electric welding • Stacking: 1+1 (dynamic, meaning during transport): 1+2 (static) • Stowage in ISO container: 18 pcs (20’ ISOcont.): 40 pcs (40’ ISOcont.) • UN type-approved: 31HA1/Y/D/FPL/BAM 6849/3775/2014 (according to international transport regulations - ADR road RID rail - IMO sea) Precautions: • In case of re-use, good conditions must be checked. • If necessary, replace the valve at each small tank use rotation. • Do not fill with products whose temperature exceeds 60°C • For uses above 18 months, store away from sunlight.
Model Polybox 1000
298
Dimensions A
B
C
Collection volume/litres
1000
1200
1150
1000
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
load securing systems
MATERIAL HANDLING
CR353G
CB210Z/CB200Z cambuckle clamping wall RACKS
CYLINDER STORaGE RACKS Wall fixing racks, complete with safety security chains to hold cylinders in place. Painted or Galvanised finish.
Wall fixing racks with individual quick release webbing straps with adjustable cambuckle which hold each cylinder firmly in place. Can be used in pairs top and bottom, for secure movement of cylinders in transit.
Cylinder No of Painted Finish Galvanised Finish Dia mm Cylinders Model Price Model Price up to 2 CR301Z POA CR351G POA
Cylinder Dia mm 180 -
No of Cylinders 2
Dimensions W x D mm 720 x 190
Model CB200Z
Price POA
180
3
CR302Z POA CR352G
POA
3
1036 x 190
CB300Z
POA
up to
2
CR303Z POA CR353G
POA
4
1352 x 190
CB400Z
POA
270
3
CR304Z POA CR354G
POA
205-305
2
835 x 230
CB210Z
POA
270
CYLINDER LOw height floor stand Fully welded double sided stand specifically designed for use with smaller type cylinders. Complete with individual securing chains for each cylinder. Epoxy powder coated blue. Cylinder Dia mm
No of Cylinders
Dimensions W x D x H mm
Model
Price
100 - 4
440 x 465 x 610
CR740Z
POA
180 6
656 x 465 x 610
CR760Z
POA
CYLINDER - double sided floor stand Fully welded robust construction, complete with individual securing chains to hold each cylinder in place. Epoxy powder coated blue.
Cylinder Dia mm
CR740Z
CR765Z
No of Cylinders
Dimensions W x D x H mm
Model
Price
180 - 4
618 x 544 x 922
CR745Z
POA
270 6
924 x 544 x 922
CR765Z
POA
CYLINDER - single sided floor stand Fully welded single sided floor stand suitable for use with full height cylinders. Complete with individual securing chains to hold each cylinder in place. Epoxy powder coated blue. Cylinder Dia mm
No of Cylinders
Dimensions W x D x H mm
Model
Price
180 - 2
618 x 350 x 922
CR725Z
POA
270 3
924 x 350 x 922
CR735Z
POA
double sided floor stand Designed to hold 4 or 6 cylinders. Supplied complete with securing chains to keep cylinders in place. Painted or Galvanised finish. Cylinder No of Painted Finish Galvanised Finish Dia mm Cylinders Model Price Model Price up to 4 CR401Z POA CR451G POA
CR725Z
CR452G/CR454G
180
6
CR402Z
POA CR452G
POA
up to
4
CR403Z
POA CR453G
POA
270
6
CR404Z
POA CR454G
POA
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
299
MATERIAL HANDLING load securing systems
TS180L
TS179L
TS178L
OXYGEN CYLINDER TROLLEYS
Manufactured in accordance with BS2718, 1979, especially designed for carrying oxygen cylinders - ideal for use in hospitals. Tubular frame has a sheet steel base and retaining straps to hold the cylinder in position. Fitted with Anti-static metal centred wheels and front 100 mm nonmarking corner buffers. Maximum cylinder size mm
140
2 x CSU11Z and CBU01Z
CYLINDER STORAGE UNITS
Each storage unit has a capacity for 11 cylinders stored horizontally. Stackable, with or without the slanting base which allows 4 way entry for loading and unloading by fork lift. N.B. Cylinders containing dissolved or liquified gases should be stored vertically.
Overall Size Dimensions L x W x H mm
Retaining Strap Heights mm
Wheels mm
Weight kg
Model
Price
Overall Size Cylinder Cylinder Description W x L x H mm Weight Diameter mm Length mm
420 x 400 x 1100
220 / 675
125
8
TS178L
POA
875 x
1590 x Rear 200 35 kg
175
460 x 410 x 1100
220 / 675
250
13
TS179L
POA
230
470 x 480 x 1100
270 / 920
250
14
TS180L
POA
Storage Unit 880 x 1590 x 385
GCP01Z
Base
—
—
CBU01Z
POA
100 to 178
1220 Max.
CSU11Z
POA
CYLINDER STAND • Base Size:- 520 x 400 mm.
Models GCP01Z and GCP02Z are suitable for transporting cylinders by using a pallet truck, with width across forks of 680 mm, or fork lift. Model GCP03Z is suitable for transportation by fork lift only. Platform size 1220 x 690 mm. Overall Size Qty of cylinders held L x W x H mm
Price
CS202Z
• Fully welded construction with supporting sides and central sections. • Non-slip steel floor to aid the safe loading and unloading of cylinders. • Complete with retaining chain / strap.
300
50 kg
GCP03Z
CYLINDER PALLET CAGE
Model
Front 360
Weight kg
Model
Price
555 x 480 x 1010
2 - Max Dia. 275mm
20
GCP01Z
POA
1100 x 480 x 1010
4 - Max Dia. 275mm
40
GCP02Z
POA
1200 x 1050 x 995
9 x 286 ø 12 x 229 ø 20 x 178 ø
120
GCP03Z
Flat steel construction with a solid sheet steel base. Hinged latches at the front enable easy positioning of the cylinder. To Suit Cylinder dia mm
Height mm
Weight kg
Model
Price
178
605
20
CS201Z
POA
230
605
21
CS202Z
POA
285
605
23
CS203Z
POA
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
CYLINDER EQUIPMENT
TS177L
CT277L
MATERIAL HANDLING
TS171L
CT201L
WELDERS TROLLEY
CYLINDER TROLLEYS Painted finished TS177L and Zinc plated CT277L are designed to carry a maximum cylinder size of 286 mm dia. x 1575 mm height. Tubular steel frame and fitted with two 125 mm rubber tyred rear support castors and 265 mm steel centred rubber tyres. The cylinder is held in place with a retaining chain for added security when in use. The CT201L is zinc plated and gives protection to the unit when used in a damp environment. The unit is also available with 200mm pneumatic wheels, model CT201P
Designed with safety in mind with 2 rear castors for extra stability, castors support the laden trolley enabling full operator control when manoeuvring. Frame is fitted with cylinder retaining chains and a welding rod holder. Unit is suitable for carrying 2 cylinders: 1 x oxygen cylinder 230mm dia x 1560mm high; and 1 x acetylene cylinder 236mm dia x 1200mm high.
Cylinder Dia mm 286 286 140 - 250
Cylinder Cap Lt 40 40 10 / 20 / 40
Wheels mm 265 - 125 cushion 265 - 125 Cushion 200 Cushion
Frame Finish Painted Zinc Plated Zinc Plated
Model
Price
Length Width Height Weight mm mm mm kg
TS177L CT277L CT201L
POA POA POA
140 - 250
10 / 20 / 40
200 Pneumatic
Zinc Plated
C T201P
POA
760 760 1090 31
CT102L
CT101L
PROPANE CYLINDER TROLLEYS Tubular steel powder coated trucks designed to safely manoeuvre 47 kg Propane cylinders. The maximum diameter of cradle supports is 380 mm.  Model CT103L is able to carry one cylinder of 380 mm and one 230 mm.  Models CT102L and CT103L are fitted with a rear castor which supports the laden trolley enabling full operator control when manoeuvring.
Wheels mm
Model
Price
350 x 75 Cushion TS171L POA Roller Bearing
CT103L Overall Dimensions Wheels mm Cap Weight Model L x W x H mm front / rear kg kg 570 x 550 x 1310
265
Price
150
20
CT101L POA
730 x 530 x 1310 265 / 150 150
26
CT102L POA
920 x 810 x 1440 400 / 200 150
50
CT103L POA
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
301
MATERIAL HANDLING Cable bridges Fabricated Aluminum Hose & Cable Bridges Protect hoses and cables from carts and other traffic. Constructed of lightweight durable aluminum treadplate. All welded. The opening is available in spans of 4" to 16". MODEL NUMBER
FHCR-24-36-4 FHCR-24-40-8 FHCR-24-44-12 FHCR-24-48-16 FHCR-48-36-4 FHCR-48-40-8 FHCR-48-44-12 FHCR-48-48-16
OVERALL SIZE (W x L) 24" x 36" 24" x 40" 24" x 44" 24" x 48" 48" x 36" 48" x 40" 48' x 44" 48" x 48"
USABLE SPAN (W x H) 4" x 3" 8" x 3" 12" x 3" 16" x 3" 4" x 3" 8" x 3" 12" x 3" 16" x 3"
CAPACITY (POUNDS) 2,000 2,000 2,000 2,000 2,000 2,000 2,000 2,000
NET WT. (POUNDS) 55 58 62 66 85 92 102 108
DC-25/UPS/FC-100
Extruded Aluminum Hose & Cable Bridges The Extruded Aluminum Hose & Cable Bridge protects air lines, electrical cords and computer cables from damage by fork trucks, carts, and personnel. These ramps have serrated edges for maximum traction and are lightweight for easy portability. Contact factory for special lengths up to 25 feet. MODEL NUMBER
OVERALL (W x H) 2-7/8" x 7/16" WR-24 2-7/8" x 7/16" WR-36 2-7/8" x 7/16" WR-48 7" x 1-1/8" HCR-24 7" x 1-1/8" HCR-36 7" x 1-1/8" HCR-48 9-1/8" x 1-1/2" LHCR-36 9-1/8" x 1-1/2" LHCR-48 9-1/8" x 1-1/2" LHCR-60 9-1/8" x 1-1/2" LHCR-72 DC-25/UPS/FC-100
USABLE SPAN (W x H) 1-1/4" x 5/16" 1-1/4" x 5/16" 1-1/4" x 5/16" 2-1/2" x 3/4" 2-1/2" x 3/4" 2-1/2" x 3/4" 2-1/2" x 1-1/4" 2-1/2" x 1-1/4" 2-1/2" x 1-1/4" 2-1/2" x 1-1/4"
LENGTH 24" 36" 48" 24" 36" 48" 36" 48" 60" 72"
SINGLE-WHEEL CAPACITY (LBS.) 2,500 2,500 2,500 10,000 10,000 10,000 10,000 10,000 10,000 10,000
NET WT. (LBS.) 2 4 5 7 11 14 14 19 24 29
Molded Rubber Hose & Cable Bridges model MRBR-24
model RHCB-12
Designed to protect cables and hoses from pedestrian and rolling traffic. The top surface of each bridge includes serrations for extra traction. Optional connectors may be used to interlock individual units together to form wider bridges. Simply lock together as many units as required. Model MRBR-24 has carry handles molded into the ramp. Fits over cables to protect hoses from punctures and kinks. Series RHCB is a ideal for people who are always switching out cables but do not want to move the ramp. The model RHCB-A features an aluminum treadplate insert to protect hoses and cables (for light traffic and slow applications only). MODEL NUMBER
model RHCB-12A
Connectors
OVERALL SIZE USABLE SPAN CAPACITY (W x L) (W x H) (POUNDS) 24" x 24" 2¾" x 1½" 2,400 CONNECTOR (ORDER 2 PER CONNECTION) 12" x 32¾" 3½" x 3" 2,400 12" x 32¾" 3½" x 3" 2,400 CONNECTOR (ORDER 2 PER CONNECTION)
MRBR-24 MRBR-CON RHCB-12 RHCB-12A RHCB-CON
NET WT. (POUNDS) 40 2 32 42 1
DC-25/UPS/FC-55
Urethane Hose & Cable Bridges Protect hoses and cables from everyday foot traffic. Handles loads up to 100 PSI (2,400 lbs.) with less than 10% deflection. Constructed of durable urethane material with traction cleats on ramp surface to prevent slippage (for light traffic and slow applications only). MODEL NUMBER
URTH-24 URTH-36 URTH-48
302
OVERALL SIZE (W x L) 24" x 24" 24" x 36" 24" x 48"
USABLE SPAN (W x H) 3" x 3" 3" x 3" 3" x 3"
CAPACITY (POUNDS) 2,400 2,400 2,400
NET WT. (POUNDS) 20 30 40 DC-25/UPS/FC-55
LE
NG
TH
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
TH
ID
W
Ramps
MATERIAL HANDLING
Aluminum Walk Ramps Enables delivery men, shippers, and receivers to load and unload trucks when docks are unavailable. Ramps feature a 1½" high safety curb on each side. Heavy duty steel chains with steel grab hooks are attached to each side of ramp for safely securing ramp to truck. Constructed of strong aluminum alloy with non-skid tread surface. The ramp is lightweight and easy to handle. Available in either an overlapping style that rests on the truck bed, suffix "A", or steel hook style that mounts onto the truck extensions, suffix "B". Adjustable Height Wheel Option, model AWR-WHL, is ideal for use with longer walk ramps. Height is adjusted with a manual hand crank mechanism. Wheels are 10" x 3½" pneumatic and are located at balance points on ramp allowing for one-person positioning. Simple bolt-on installation may be added to any aluminum walk ramp 8 feet or longer. Minimum ramp lowered height with this option is 12". Walk ramp sold separately. Ramp Cart Option, model AWR-R-CART, provides for easy one-person ramp positioning and transportation. Pull handle up to vertical position to rotate and lock wheels in down position to allow for easy ramp movement. Push handle down to unlock and lift wheels so ramp can be used to service lower trailers. Pneumatic wheels are 10" x 3½". Minimum ramp service height is 14" with this option. Easy bolt-on installation. Walk ramp sold separately. Type A - Overlap
ADJUSTABLE HEIGHT WHEEL • model AWR-WHL Shown with and without Walk Ramp
TYPE
A A A A A A A A B B B B B B B B
HEIGHT RANGE 6" - 21" 6" - 25" 6" - 29" 6" - 33" 6" - 38" 6" - 46" 6" - 54" 6" - 62" 6" - 23" 6" - 27" 6" - 31" 6" - 35" 6" - 40" 6" - 48" 6" - 54" 6" - 64"
LENGTH 6' 7' 8' 9' 10' 12' 14' 16' 6' 7' 8' 9' 10' 12' 14' 16'
RAMP CART OPTION • model AWR-R-CART Shown with and without Walk Ramp
Type B - Steel Hooks
Deck cross-section ribs for strength and grooved deck for positive all-weather traction
CAPACITY (POUNDS) 28" WIDE / 26" USABLE 38" WIDE / 36" USABLE 4-WHEEL 2-WHEEL MODEL NET WT. MODEL NET WT. CART CART NUMBER (LBS.) NUMBER (LBS.) 2,800 2,000 76 97 AWR-28-6A AWR-38-6A 2,800 1,800 88 112 AWR-28-7A AWR-38-7A 2,500 1,650 100 125 AWR-28-8A AWR-38-8A 2,500 1,600 112 142 AWR-28-9A AWR-38-9A 2,200 1,500 124 157 AWR-28-10A AWR-38-10A 1,900 1,400 148 187 AWR-28-12A AWR-38-12A 1,600 1,200 172 217 AWR-28-14A AWR-38-14A 1,000 1,000 196 227 AWR-28-16A AWR-38-16A 2,800 2,000 76 97 AWR-28-6B AWR-38-6B 2,800 1,800 88 112 AWR-28-7B AWR-38-7B 2,500 1,650 100 125 AWR-28-8B AWR-38-8B 2,500 1,600 112 142 AWR-28-9B AWR-38-9B 2,200 1,500 124 157 AWR-28-10B AWR-38-10B 1,900 1,400 148 187 AWR-28-12B AWR-38-12B 1,600 1,200 172 217 AWR-28-14B AWR-38-14B 1,000 1,000 196 227 AWR-28-16B AWR-38-16B ADJUSTABLE HEIGHT WHEEL OPTION, model AWR-WHL, DC-25/FC-100 RAMP CART OPTION, model AWR-R-CART,
Aluminum Pick-Up/Van Ramp Lightweight aluminum ramp works great for large and small wheeled equipment. When using with small wheeled equipment add ¼" plywood (not included) to ramp surface. Folds up to 12" wide for storing between ATV wheels in truck. Includes adjustable safety straps to hook ramp safely to trailer. MODEL NUMBER
LENGTH 69" RAMP-5077
FOLDED UNFOLDED GROSS SINGLE WHEEL NET WT. WIDTH WIDTH CAPACITY CAPACITY (POUNDS) 15" 45" 1,500 lbs. 250 lbs. 40
Steel Pick-Up/Van Ramps
DC-25/UPS/FC-100
These economical serrated ramps provide minimum slippage. Overlapping lip provides smooth transition into cargo area. Single piece construction with bolt-on lip. MODEL NUMBER
RAMP-72 RAMP-96
LENGTH 72" 96"
WIDTH PER RAMP 9" 9"
GROSS CAPACITY 500 lbs. 500 lbs.
SINGLE WHEEL NET WT. CAPACITY (POUNDS) 300 lbs. 50/pr. 300 lbs. 60/pr. DC-25/UPS/FC-100
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
303
MATERIAL HANDLING Ramps Heavy Duty Fiberglass Walk Ramps Load and unload equipment from trucks using these Heavy Duty Fiberglass Walk Ramps. Reinforced fiberglass construction provides up to 5,000 pounds capacity. Abrasive surface provides good traction either wet or dry. 1" high curb on each side of ramp. Not for use with fork trucks or pallet trucks. MODEL NUMBER
FWR-3010-50 FWR-3012-50
OVERALL WIDTH 30" 30"
OVERALL LENGTH 10' 12'
FWR-3610-50 FWR-3612-50 FWR-3614-50
36" 36" 36"
10' 12' 14'
CAPACITY MAXIMUM (POUNDS) WORKING HEIGHT 5,000 30" 5,000 35" 5,000 5,000 5,000
NET WT. (POUNDS) 124 161
30" 35" 45"
ROUGH TEXTURE
156 180 204 DC-25/FC-85
Fiberglass Autoloader Ramps The Autoloader Ramp can be separated in half to provide two ramps that may be used to load automobiles and other vehicles. Each half is 18" wide. To separate simply remove center hinge pins.
MODEL NUMBER
OVERALL WIDTH
FAL-3610-50 FAL-3612-50 FAL-3614-50 FAL-3616-50
36" 36" 36" 36"
OVERALL CAPACITY LENGTH (POUNDS) 10' 12' 14' 16'
5,000 5,000 5,000 5,000
MAXIMUM WORKING HEIGHT 30" 35" 45" 50"
NET WT. (POUNDS) 162 186 210 264 DC-25/FC-85
Aluminum Vehicle Twin Ramps Provide a safe means for driving vans, pick-up trucks and some passenger vehicles from ground level into and out of high building entrances. Ramps can be securely fastened to dock with pin locks. To avoid hang-ups measure under clearance and wheelbase of vehicle. The overall width is 18" with a usable width of 14". Side curbs are 1¼" high. Welded aluminum construction. MODEL NUMBER
LOAD CAPACITY PER PAIR (LBS.)
VTR-7-14-8 VTR-5.5-14-10 VTR-7-14-12 VTR-6-14-14 VTR-5.5-14-16 VTR-6-14-18 VTR-5.5-14-20 VTR-5.5-14-24
7,000 5,500 7,000 6,000 5,500 6,000 5,500 5,500
WORKING HEIGHT (MAX TO MIN) 17½" to 12½" 22½" to 16" 27" to 19" 32" to 22½" 36½" to 25½" 41" to 29" 46" to 32½" 55½" to 39"
LENGTH 8' 10' 12' 14' 16' 18' 20' 24'
NET WT. (LBS. EACH) 62 77 126 144 166 201 228 288 DC-20/FC-100
Wheel Alignment Curbs Ideal for properly aligning trailers at loading docks. All welded steel construction suitable for indoor or outdoor use. Units may be bolted to surface or secured into concrete. Heavy-duty welded-steel construction with yellow powder-coat finish.
MODEL NUMBER
SWAC-92 SWAC-144 SWAC-ABK
304
HEIGHT LENGTH DIAMETER 11" 92" 5" 11" 144" 5" (8) ¾" x 4" CONCRETE ANCHOR BOLTS
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
NET WT. (POUNDS) 133 193 4 DC-20/FC-60
Wheel Risers
MATERIAL HANDLING
Aluminum Wheel Risers Elevate semi-trailers to loading docks for maximum serviceability during loading and unloading operations. Manufactured from heavy-duty aluminum treadplate for positive traction. Welded all aluminum construction. 30,000 lbs. capacity per pair. Wheel Risers are designed to facilitate compliance with OSHA requirements for a 10% maximum grade of ascending or descending loaded fork trucks. WIDE "18 HEIGHT
6"
8"
10"
12"
OVERALL LENGTH
48" 54" 60" 102" 54" 60" 66" 108" 60" 66" 72" 114" 66" 72" 78" 120"
LEVEL LENGTH
30" 36" 42" 84" 30" 36" 42" 84" 30" 36" 42" 84" 30" 36" 42" 84"
MODEL NUMBER
WIDE "24 .NET WT )EACH(
ATWR-18-6-48 ATWR-18-6-54 ATWR-18-6-60 ATWR-18-6-102 ATWR-18-8-54 ATWR-18-8-60 ATWR-18-8-66 ATWR-18-8-108 ATWR-18-10-60 ATWR-18-10-66 ATWR-18-10-72 TWR-18-10-114 ATWR-18-12-66 ATWR-18-12-72 ATWR-18-12-78 TWR-18-12-120
70/UPS 80/UPS 87/UPS 155 90/UPS 98 109 187 108 121 130 227 133 142 179 261
MODEL NUMBER
WHEEL RISERS ARE PRICED AND SOLD EACH
NET WT. (EACH)
ATWR-24-6-48 ATWR-24-6-54 ATWR-24-6-60 ATWR-24-6-102 ATWR-24-8-54 ATWR-24-8-60 ATWR-24-8-66 ATWR-24-8-108 ATWR-24-10-60 ATWR-24-10-66 ATWR-24-10-72 ATWR-24-10-114 ATWR-24-12-66 ATWR-24-12-72 ATWR-24-12-78 ATWR-24-12-120
87/UPS 100/UPS 108 194 112 121 135 233 133 151 160 279 164 174 223 321
ADD A WHEEL TO A SINGLE ALUMINUM WHEEL RISER FOR PORTABILITY. MODEL ATWR-WL, $48.00 EACH PORTABLE WHEEL RISER CADDY, MODEL R-CAD-18, for 18" wide units PORTABLE WHEEL RISER CADDY, MODEL R-CAD-24, for 24" wide units PAIR OF BOLT-ON BRACKETS AND HARDWARE, MODEL R-CAD-KIT ANCHOR BRACKETS (4 PER RISER) TO BOLT RISER TO GROUND, MODEL ATWR-ABRK
Portability Kit, model
DC-25/UPS/FC-100
ATWR-WL, allows one person to transport and place wheel riser. Features 5" x 2" mold-on-rubber wheels. For use with aluminum wheel risers only.
WHEEL RISERS ARE PRICED AND SOLD EACH NOTE: DUAL WHEELS ON SEMI-TRAILERS ARE 18" WIDE. THE 24" WHEEL RISERS WORK BEST FOR THIS APPLICATION.
LEVEL LENGTH HEIGHT OVERALL LENGTH
Steel Wheel Risers Equipped with fork slots for ease in fork truck transporting. Ramps may be stacked for compact storage when not in use. Fork pockets are 7½" wide by 2½" high usable. This features adds approximately 15" to the overall width of the riser. Wheel Risers are designed to facilitate compliance with OSHA requirements for a 10% maximum grade of ascending or descending loaded fork trucks. Heavy-duty welded steel construction. Capacity per pair 40,000 lbs. Painted neutral earth-tone brown. 18" WIDE OVERALL LEVEL HEIGHT LENGTH LENGTH
6¼"
8¼"
10¼"
12¼"
48" 60" 72" 84" 60" 72" 84" 96" 60" 72" 84" 96" 72" 84" 96" 108"
24" 36" 48" 60" 28" 40" 52" 64" 20" 32" 44" 56" 24" 36" 48" 60"
MODEL NUMBER
SWR-18-6-48 SWR-18-6-60 SWR-18-6-72 SWR-18-6-84 SWR-18-8-60 SWR-18-8-72 SWR-18-8-84 SWR-18-8-96 SWR-18-10-60 SWR-18-10-72 SWR-18-10-84 SWR-18-10-96 SWR-18-12-72 SWR-18-12-84 SWR-18-12-96 SWR-18-12-108
model R-CAD-KIT
24" WIDE NET WT. (LBS.)
183 221 261 299 246 293 339 385 268 322 375 428 349 408 469 528
MODEL NUMBER
SWR-24-6-48 SWR-24-6-60 SWR-24-6-72 SWR-24-6-84 SWR-24-8-60 SWR-24-8-72 SWR-24-8-84 SWR-24-8-96 SWR-24-10-60 SWR-24-10-72 SWR-24-10-84 SWR-24-10-96 SWR-24-12-72 SWR-24-12-84 SWR-24-12-96 SWR-24-12-108
NET WT. (LBS.)
222 272 320 369 301 359 415 471 329 394 458 523 427 498 571 644
PORTABLE WHEEL RISER CADDY, MODEL R-CAD-18, for 18" wide units DC-25/FC-60 PORTABLE WHEEL RISER CADDY, MODEL R-CAD-24, for 24" wide units PAIR OF BOLT-ON BRACKETS AND HARDWARE, MODEL R-CAD-KIT CENTRAL PICKUP LOOP, MODEL SWR-CPL
PORTABLE WHEEL RISER CADDY, series R-CAD, move steel or aluminum risers out of the way with this easy to use mover. Snap roller into riser and away you go.
Central Pick-Up Loop, model SWR-CPL are prealigned, prespaced parallel ramps, attached by a pickup connector. Fork trucks simply lower the unit in place. Overall width is 102".
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
305
MATERIAL HANDLING Cargo Bars Cargo Bars • Keep trailer contents in place -- eliminate damaged goods • Simple mechanical lock - will not vibrate loose When trucks move, keep trailer contents securely in place with these easy to use Cargo Bars. Constructed of 1½" square tubing, unless specified, 14 gauge construction won't bend or give. 4" square articulating steel end plates feature rubber pads for positive gripping action. Fits between trailer walls.
A) CB-5 & CB-7
Easy to use ratchet mechanism allows one person to adjust and C) EB-96 & EB-102 ratchet into place. works in conjunction with E-TRACK )E-TRACK sold separately( L) E-TRACK
B) CB-7-R
D) CB-7-S
E) CL-15 & CL-16
TYPE A A
MODEL NUMBER CB-5 CB-7
B
CB-7-R
C C
EB-96 EB-102
D E E F G
CB-7-S CL-15 CL-16 CL-17 CL-18
H I J K L
CL-20 CBH-32 CH-7 CH-3 E-TRACK
F) CL-17
G) CL-18
SERVICE RANGE 88" to 103" 89" to 104"
NET WT. (LBS.) 11 13
89" to 103"
16
85" to 96" 91" to 102"
19 22
ONE PIECE STEEL (ROUND TUBE) ONE PIECE STEEL ONE PIECE STEEL GALVANIZED TWO PIECE STEEL GALVANIZED (FOLDING) TWO PICE STEEL GALVANIZED (TELESCOPIC)
88½" to 103" 87" to 119" 87" to 119" 88" to 116" 90" to 139"
14 20 22 22 33
TWO PIECE STEEL E & A TRACK END PADS ONE PIECE STEEL WITH FULL HOOPS GALVANIZED HOOPS (FOR CB SERIES ONLY) GALVANIZED HOOPS (FOR CL SERIES ONLY) 10' SECTION OF E-TRACK FOR TRAILERS
87" to 116" 87" to 116" 24"W x 29"H 24"W x 35"H 10 FOOT
22 42 15 19 17
DESCRIPTION ONE PIECE ALUMINUM (ROUND TUBE) ONE PIECE ALUMINUM (ROUND TUBE) ONE PIECE ALUMINUM RATCHET (ROUND TUBE) ONE PIECE ALUMINUM (E-TRACK) ONE PIECE ALUMINUM (E-TRACK)
H) CL-20
I) CBH-32 Top Hoop 70"W x 9"H Bottom Hoop 78"W x 9"H
)J) CH-7 (for CB-series only Cargo Bar sold separately
DC-35/UPS/FC-85 )K) CH-3 (for CL-series only Cargo Bar sold separately
Cargo Strapping • Guard against damages from slipping and shifting loads while moving products • Tough strapping fabric is made of a polyester webbing Tighten securely around cargo to help prevent damage and load shifting during transit. Spring loaded E-Track fittings provide quick one-handed connection to anchor point. Both ratchet and cam buckle models tighten and release quickly.
306
MODEL NUMBER
STRAP WIDTH
WORKING LENGTH
WORKING LOAD (LBS)
TIGHTENING MECHANISM
FASTENER
NET WT. (LBS.)
STRAP-12-E STRAP-12-CE STRAP-12-RE STRAP-16-CE STRAP-16-RE STRAP-27-RH STRAP-27-FH
1¾" 2" 2" 2" 2" 2" 2"
12½' 12' 12' 16' 16' 27' 27'
800 835 1,000 1,200 1,200 3,325 3,325
RETRACTABLE CAM RATCHETING CAM RATCHETING RATCHETING RATCHETING
E-CLIP E-CLIP E-CLIP E-CLIP E-CLIP ROD HOOK FLAT HOOK
6 4 4 4 4 10 10
STRAP-6-RTO
2"
6"
800
---
E-CLIP
1 DC-25/UPS
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
model STRAP-27-FH
model STRAP-27-RH
Load Handling
MATERIAL HANDLING
Load Binders • Provides 5,400 lbs. working load limit • Ideal for trailers, campers or farmers Used for chain binding applications in trucking and marine industries. Heavy-duty, forged steel construction. Meets US DOT and C.V.S.A. requirements. Proof capacity is 10,000 lbs. while the ultimate capacity is 19,000 lbs. Accommodates 3/16" to 3/8" chain. MODEL NUMBER
DESCRIPTION
LBDR-9 LBDR-13
LEVER RATCHET
TAKE UP 3¾" 3"
NET WT. (LBS.) 10 15
DC-25/UPS
RATCHET TYPE model LBDR-13
LEVER TYPE model LBDR-9
Truck Mounted Strap Winches Tighten down loads to eliminate shifting. Choose from either weld or bolt on design. Strap and chrome plated winch bar sold separately. Low profile design available. Accommodates 4" straps up to 30' long. MODEL NUMBER SW-4-PSW SW-4-PSB SW-BAR FOOT STRAP 30 model STRAP-30
SW-BAR-PT STRAP-30
DESCRIPTION WELD ON WINCH BOLT ON WINCH MULTI-TASK WINCH BAR PAINTED WINCH BAR 30 FOOT STRAP
OVERALL SIZE (W x L x H) 3½" x 7¾" x 6¼" 3½" x 7¾" x 6¼"
NET WT. (LBS.) 12 14
1¼"DIA. x 36½"L
7
1¼" x 33"
5
4"W x 30'L
7 DC-25/UPS
Skid Buster & Wrecking Bars Get rid of broken or unsightly pallets or open crates quickly and safely. Lightweight and easy to use. MODEL NUMBER
DESCRIPTION
LENGTH
HANDLE DIAMETER
COLOR
SKB-7 WB-18-Y WB-24-Y WB-30-Y WB-36-Y WB-18-B
SKID BUSTER WRECKING BAR WRECKING BAR WRECKING BAR WRECKING BAR WRECKING BAR
41½" 18" 24" 30" 36" 18"
1¼" ¾" ¾" ¾" ¾" ½"
BLUE YELLOW YELLOW YELLOW YELLOW BLUE
NET WT. (LBS.) 8 2 3 4 5 2 DC-25/UPS
Quilted Moving Pads
WRECKING BAR series WB
SKID BUSTER model SKB-7
Cushion and protect furniture, machinery and electronic equipment. Each pad measures 72" wide by 80" long. Units are sold a dozen at a time. Model QPC-7280-UP is water and mildew resistant. Weight reflects a dozen units.
GENERAL DUTY model QPC-7280-VP
MODEL NUMBER QPC-7280-VP QPC-7280-UP QPC-7280-DP
DESCRIPTION GENERAL DUTY 100% COTTON ALL WEATHER 100% POLYESTER HEAVY DUTY MULTI-COLOR 100% COTTON
NET WEIGHT )POUNDS( 75 40 78 DC-25/UPS/FC-150
Interlocking Pallet Puller The PAL-2 is a simple, strong, lightweight tool for hooking hard to reach 2-way stringer pallets. Simply slide the Pallet Puller under the upper deck board and place around the first two-way stringer. Pull back on the Pallet Puller to lock in place with positive grip. Attach the puller to the fork truck with a proof coil chain, PPC-20 or PPC-40.
MODEL NUMBER PAL-2
PULLING CAPACITY (LBS.) 4,000
HEIGHT 2¼"
PLACE AROUND THE FIRST TWO-WAY STRINGER
ATTACH PROOF COIL CHAIN (MODEL PPC-20 )OR PPC-40
PULL LOADS UP TO 4,000 LBS.
NET WT. (LBS.) 2
DC-25/UPS
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
307
MATERIAL HANDLING Wheel Chocks Pallet Pullers Pallet pullers are used to pull pallets to rear of trailers for easy fork lift access. Rugged steel construction. Heads are self-cleaning and unaffected by wood particles, paint or grease. Pallet pullers are NOT designed for lifting. PAL-12 and PAL-16 - Single scissor action allows for wider jaw opening. PAL-14 - Cam closing action provides maximum gripping strength and reduces pinch points. Safety handle enables easier positioning and removal. PAL-12 Grips both metal and wood pallets with biting action. PAL-21 and PAL-LP - One piece curved heads have integral spurs for gripping pallet stringers. MODEL NUMBER
DESCRIPTION
PAL-12 PAL-16 PAL-14 PAL-21 PAL-LP PPC-20 PPC-40
SINGLE SCISSOR SINGLE SCISSOR HEAVY DUTY CAM ACTION DOUBLE SCISSOR DOUBLE SCISSOR - LOW PROFILE 20' OF ¼" CHAIN W/GRAB HOOKS 40' OF ¼" CHAIN W/GRAB HOOKS
PULLING CAPACITY (LBS.) 5,000 6,000 5,000 5,000 5,000 5,000 5,000
PAL-16
JAW JAW HEIGHT OPENING 2¾" 1½" 1½" 2¾" 2" -----
7" 5" 3" 3" 3¼" -----
NET WT. (LBS.) 14 16 17 25 24 17 32
PAL-14
PAL-21 PAL-LP
NOT FOR LIFTING DC-25/UPS/FC-85
Prylever Bars Provide dock workers, riggers, and freight handlers with the leverage to get underneath heavy objects for lifting with fork truck, hand truck or other types of trucks. Two 5" x 2" poly-on-steel wheels. 6"W x 8"L x ½" thick steel nose plate with beveled edge is bolted on the wood handle units and welded on the steel units. Steel units feature powder coat blue finish. MODEL NUMBER PLB-5 PLB-6 PLB-7 PLB/S-5 PLB/S-6 PLB/S-7 PLB/TS-5 PLB/TS-6 PLB/TS-7
BAR LENGTH 5' 6' 7' 5' 6' 7' 5' 6' 7'
DESCRIPTION WOOD PRYLEVER BAR WOOD PRYLEVER BAR WOOD PRYLEVER BAR STEEL PRYLEVER BAR STEEL PRYLEVER BAR STEEL PRYLEVER BAR SELF-SUPPORTING STEEL SELF-SUPPORTING STEEL SELF-SUPPORTING STEEL
CAPACITY (POUNDS) 4,250 4,250 4,250 5,000 5,000 5,000 5,000 5,000 5,000
WOOD HANDLE series PLB
STEEL HANDLE series PLB/S
NET WT. (LBS.) 36 41 46 37 42 47 60 65 70
DC-25/UPS/FC-70
Wheel Chocks Rubber Constructed of reinforced rubber to provide a sure grip on virtually any surface. Curved surface contours to fit tires. Rubber resists tearing, abrasion, ozone weathering, etc. Functional designed to be durable in all weather conditions. The Airline Chock is suitable for small and large aircraft. Includes a 9" polypropylene rope with handle and reflectors connected to chocks.
A) LWC-15
B) LWC-14
C) LWC-14M
D) RWC-8
E) RWC-8-HDL
F) RWC-9-U
A B
MODEL NUMBER LWC-15 LWC-14
C
LWC-14M
D E F G
RWC-8 RWC-8-HDL RWC-9-U RWC-11
MOLDED RUBBER (EYEBOLT) MOLDED RUBBER (HANDLE) MOLDED RUBBER ("U" HANDLE) MOLDED RUBBER (WHC-MR)
7½" x 8" x 8½" 9½" x 6" x 8" 9¾" x 6" x 7½" 7" x 7¾" x 10"
10 12 11 13
H I J K
RMC-4 EX-4 EX-11 EX-13
EXTRUDED RUBBER EXTRUDED RUBBER EXTRUDED RUBBER EXTRUDED RUBBER
6½" x 4¾" x 4¼" 10" x 3¾" x 4½" 8½" x 6" x 8½" 12" x 5¾" x 6½"
16 12 13 16
AC-13
AIRLINE CHOCK WITH ROPE
10" x 4½" x 5"
16
TYPE
L
DESCRIPTION LAMINATED RUBBER LAMINATED RUBBER LAMINATED RUBBER (RUBBER GRIPS)
DIMENSIONS (W x H x D) 8" x 8" x 8" 10" x 5½" x 10"
NET WT. (LBS.) 18 17
10" x 5½" x 10"
17
G) RWC-11
DC-25/UPS/FC-55
308
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
H) RMC-4
I) EX-4
J) EX-11
K) EX-13
L) AC-13
Wheel Chocks
MATERIAL HANDLING
Aluminum Wheel Chocks
For a w id selecti er call 80 on, 0-LOC 8
Lightweight and easy to handle extruded aluminum chocks. Also available with a 36" high handle and/or sign.
TYPE A B C D E F
F) CWS-13
C) EALUM-7-YEL
B) EALUM-7-HNDG
MODEL NUMBER
DESCRIPTION
DIMENSIONS* (W x H x D)
NET WT. (LBS.)
EALUM-7 EALUM-7-HNDG EALUM-YEL EALUM-7-H EALUM-7-HS CWS-13
CHOCK CHOCK WITH HAND GRIP YELLOW CHOCK CHOCK WITH HANDLE CHOCK W/HANDLE & SIGN ALUMINUM CHOCK W/FLAG
7" x 8" x 10" 7" x 8" x 10" 7" x 8" x 10" 7" x 8" x 10" 7" x 8" x 10" 7" x 8" x 10½"
8 8 19 18 19 18
*DIMENSIONS OF CHOCK ONLY - NOT INCLUDING HANDLE & SIGN
A) EALUM-7
D) EALUM-7-H
DC-25/UPS/FC-85
E) EALUM-7-HS
Steel Wheel Chocks Textured treadplate to provide maximum traction. Open face radius allows chock to be used with any size tire. Formed chock utilizes a saw tooth bottom for traction. Features grip slot for easy pick up and positioning. Slope design contours to truck wheel. Rugged all welded construction. Works in mud, sand or concrete. TYPE A B C D E F
MODEL NUMBER FAB-8 FAB-10 FAB-11 MS-15 SSC-17 SWC-22
DESCRIPTION WELDED STEEL CHOCK FABRICATED STEEL CHOCK FORMED STEEL CHOCK MOLDED STEEL CHOCK STEEL SLOPE CHOCK STEEL WHEEL CHOCK
A) ) B C) D) E) F)MS-15 D)
B) FAB-10
DIMENSIONS (W x H x D) 7½" x 8½" x 7½" 10½" x 10" x 7½" 8" x 9" x 10¾" 9" x 8½" x 8" 8½" x 8" x 15" 6" x 8½" 17"
C) FAB-11
A) FAB-8
NET WT. (LBS.) 10 12 13 18 20 26
DC-25/UPS/FC-50
F) SWC-22
E) SSC-17
Urethane Wheel Chocks Bright orange for greater visibility. Incoming and outgoing drivers can easily see chock for added safety. Safety tread on chock face provides better grip and reduces slippage. Molded-in hole through width of chock for attaching security chain and hanger, sold separately. MODEL NUMBER URWC-2 URWC-15 URWC-25 URWC-25-SS URWC-45
DESCRIPTION MINI-URETHANE CHOCK URETHANE WHEEL CHOCK JUMBO URETHANE CHOCK JUMBO CHOCK W/STEEL STUDS MEGA URETHANE CHOCK
DIMENSIONS (W x H x D) 7" x 6" x 8" 8" x 8" x 11" 14½" x 14½" x 17" 14½" x 14½" x 17" 18" x 18" x 24"
Wheel Chock Accessories
CHAIN & HANGER model OH-15
WARNING SIGN model SA-1012
NET WT. (LBS.) 2 5 30 32 54 DC-25/UPS/FC-55
Chain and Hangers - Discourage theft and misplacement of wheel chocks, and facilitate safety in the dock area. 15 foot chain attaches wheel chocks to hanger which bolts directly to dock, securing chock permanently to the dock. Ergo-Handle - Ergonomically designed to make it easy to move wheel chocks in and out of position under trailer wheels. Reduce the risk of back, knee, and foot injuries. Factory installed only. Yellow powder coat finish. Wheel Chock Warning Signs - Warn truck drivers and dock workers to chock their wheels as required by law. Weather resistant. Bright red lettering provides high visibility. Sign has four mounting holes. Reflective sign is available for docks open at dawn and dusk. Signs and Vinyl Sticker measure 11¾"W x 9¾"H. MODEL NUMBER
DESCRIPTION
OH-15 OH-15R OH-HD HANDLE SA-1012 SF-1012 SV-1012
#2 DOUBLE LOOP COIL CHAIN (.091" THICK) WITH HANGER #2 CHAIN & HANGER, 15 FOOT LONG WITH REFLECTOR HD PROOF COIL CHAIN (3/16" THICK) 15' LONG W/HANGER 36" ERGO-HANDLE MOUNTS TO ANY WHEEL CHOCK ALUMINUM ENAMEL WHEEL CHOCK SIGN REFLECTIVE ALUMINUM ENAMEL WHEEL CHOCK SIGN VINYL WHEEL CHOCK STICKER
NET WT. (LBS.) 4 4 14 5 1 1 1
DC-25/UPS/FC-100 ERGO-HANDLE model HANDLE )wheel chock sold separately(
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
309
MATERIAL HANDLING Jacks / Safety Guides Trailer Stabilizing Jacks Jacks are used to prevent up-ending semi-trailers when they are not connected to a tractor during loading and unloading operations. Also used to level trailers parked on sloped ground and to prevent landing gear from sinking into a soft surface. High strength steel construction. Flushtype zerk fitting for lubricating ACME screw. Meets OSHA regulations when used with wheel chocks. Powder coat safety yellow finish. Includes reflective collar for visibility at night.
model SJS-1012
A
B
F
model SAJ-1012
C
G
D
E
H
I
TYPE
MODEL NUMBER
DESCRIPTION
STATIC CAPACITY (LBS)
LIFTING CAPACITY (LBS)
SERVICE RANGE
WHEEL DIAMETER
NET WT. (LBS.)
A B C D E F G H I
BFSJ-2748 LO-J-BEAM H-LO-J-BEAM LO-J HI-J SP-TOP SP-TOP-R SJ-35 SJ-35-EF
BIG FOOT JACK RATCHET BEAM HYDRAULIC BEAM RATCHET RATCHET SPIN TOP RATCHET ECONOMY ECONOMY
100,000 100,000 100,000 100,000 100,000 100,000 100,000 50,000 50,000
40,000 40,000 40,000 40,000 40,000 40,000 40,000 5,000 5,000
39½" to 51" 39½" to 51" 41" to 47" 39" to 51" 45" to 57" 39½" to 51" 41" to 50" 44" to 51" 41" to 57½"
10" 10" / 3" 10" / 3" 10" 10" 10" 10" N/A 8"
125 160 228 110 115 110 115 45/UPS 60/UPS
DC-25/UPS/FC-70 TRAILER STABILIZING JACK OPTIONS MODEL DESCRIPTION NUMBER JACK-100 50,000 LBS. LIFTING CAPACITY (NOT AVAILABLE ON SJ series) SJS-1012 ALUMINUM STABILIZING JACK TRAILER INSTRUCTION SIGN SAJ-1012 ALUMINUM DRIVERS BEWARE INSTRUCTION SIGN
NET WT. (LBS.) 18 1 1 DC-25
Dock Safety Guides Highly visible reflective caution signs are constructed from aluminum. Bolt directly to your loading dock to help guide drivers as they back in to the loading dock. MODEL NUMBER DSR-28
NET WT. (LBS.) 12
DESCRIPTION (2) REFLECTIVE ALUMINUM SIGNS
DC-25/UPS/FC-100 • 3/8" MOUNTING HOLES • 5/8" ACCESS HOLE FOR FASTENERS
Extruded Bumpers Protect against the heavy impact and damaging results of semi-trailers and trucks with these Extruded Fender Bumpers. Made of all weather and abrasion resistant rubber. The half-oval shape allows for effective fendering action over a wide radius. A metal plate is located inside 4" and 6" projection bumpers for support while the 2" unit comes with one washer per hole. Custom lengths available up to 10 feet. Installation hardware not included.
TYPE A • M-2-SERIES • 5/8" MOUNTING HOLES • 1-1/4" ACCESS HOLE FOR FASTENERS
TYPE B • M-4-SERIES • 5/8" MOUNTING HOLES • 1-1/4" ACCESS HOLE FOR FASTENERS
TYPE C • M-6-SERIES
310
TYPE
MODEL NUMBER
DESCRIPTION
NET WT. (LBS.)
A A A A A B B B B B C C C C C
M-2-12 M-2-18 M-2-24 M-2-36 M-2-120* M-4-12 M-4-18 M-4-24 M-4-36 M-4-120* M-6-12 M-6-18 M-6-24 M-6-36 M-6-120*
12"L x 2"W x 1¾"H EXTRUDED BUMPER 18"L x 2"W x 1¾"H EXTRUDED BUMPER 24"L x 2"W x 1¾"H EXTRUDED BUMPER 36"L x 2"W x 1¾"H EXTRUDED BUMPER 120"L x 2"W x 1¾"H EXTRUDED BUMPER (NO HOLES) 12"L x 4¼"W x 4"H EXTRUDED BUMPER 18"L x 4¼"W x 4"H EXTRUDED BUMPER 24"L x 4¼"W x 4"H EXTRUDED BUMPER 36"L x 4¼"W x 4"H EXTRUDED BUMPER 120"L x 4¼"W x 4"H EXTRUDED BUMPER (NO HOLES) 12"L x 6"W x 6"H EXTRUDED BUMPER 18"L x 6"W x 6"H EXTRUDED BUMPER 24"L x 6"W x 6"H EXTRUDED BUMPER 36"L x 6"W x 6"H EXTRUDED BUMPER 120"L x 6"W x 6"H EXTRUDED BUMPER (NO HOLES)
2 4 6 8 20 6 8 11 17 60 11 16 20 31 110
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Dock Bumpers
MATERIAL HANDLING
Laminated Dock Bumpers Laminated style dock bumpers provide durable, economical protection for your loading dock and trailers. Units are constructed of fabric reinforced rubber from recycled truck tires. Pads are laminated between painted structural angles and held together with ¾" steel tie rods. Installation is quick and easy by bolting or welding units to dock. Width is bolt hole center to bolt hole center. Bolt holes are 13/16" in diameter. Installation hardware available separately, see below. Recommended installation with laminated pads in vertical position as shown. 4.5" PROJECTION LAMINATED DOCK BUMPERS NET MODEL SHIPS OVERALL SIZE WT. TYPE NUMBER (H x W x P) VIA (LBS.) A 1012-4.5 10" x 12" x 4½" UPS 29 A 1014-4.5 10" x 14" x 4½" UPS 32 A 1018-4.5 10" x 18" x 4½" UPS 36 A 1024-4.5 10" x 24" x 4½" UPS 47
HORIZONTAL BUMPER TYPE A
VERTICAL BUMPER TYPE B
ANGLE FLAT BUMPER
TYPE C
6" PROJECTION LAMINATED DOCK BUMPERS NET MODEL OVERALL SIZE SHIPS WT. TYPE NUMBER (H x W x P) VIA (LBS.) A 1012-6 10" x 12" x 6" UPS 32 A 1014-6 10" x 14" x 6" UPS 35 A 1018-6 10" x 18" x 6" UPS 40
A A A
1030-4.5 1036-4.5 1096-4.5
10" x 30" x 4½" 10" x 36" x 4½" 10" x 96" x 4½"
UPS UPS TRUCK
60 72 216
A A A
1024-6 1030-6 1036-6
10" x 24" x 6" 10" x 30" x 6" 10" x 36" x 6"
UPS UPS UPS
62 73 84
A A A A
1212-4.5 1214-4.5 1218-4.5 1224-4.5
12" x 12" x 4½" 12" x 14" x 4½" 12" x 18" x 4½" 12" x 24" x 4½"
UPS UPS UPS UPS
30 35 42 57
A A A A
1212-6 1214-6 1218-6 1224-6
12" x 12" x 6" 12" x 14" x 6" 12" x 18" x 6" 12" x 24" x 6"
UPS UPS UPS UPS
36 46 55 66
A A A
1230-4.5 1236-4.5 1296-4.5
12" x 30" x 4½" 12" x 36" x 4½" 12" x 96" x 4½"
UPS UPS TRUCK
66 85 333
A A A
1230-6 1236-6 1296-6
12" x 30" x 6" 12" x 36" x 6" 12" x 96" x 6"
UPS TRUCK TRUCK
87 105 280
A A
624-4.5 636-4.5
6" x 24" x 4½" 6" x 36" x 4½"
UPS UPS
32 45
C C
1014-4.5F 1214-4.5F
10" x 14" x 4½" 12" x 14" x 4½"
UPS UPS
32 36
B B B B
V-1120-6 V-1124-6 V-1130-6 V-1136-6
20" x 11" x 6" 24" x 11" x 6" 30" x 11" x 6" 36" x 11" x 6"
TRUCK TRUCK TRUCK TRUCK
68 82 105 127
B B B B
V-1120-4.5 V-1124-4.5 V-1130-4.5 V-1136-4.5
20" x 11" x 4½" 24" x 11" x 4½" 30" x 11" x 4½" 36" x 11" x 4½"
UPS UPS TRUCK TRUCK
48 57 72 86
DC-25/UPS/FC-55
DC-25/UPS/FC-55
Specialty Molded Dock Bumpers TYPE A • High Impact Resistance • Will Not Warp, Rust, Rot or Harden Manufactured from fiber reinforced prime rubber containing nylon and polyester. These molded bumpers are built to endure years of abusive pounding. All units have predrilled countersunk mounting holes for easy installation. Units are drilled to accept 3/4" anchor bolts. Plastic face bumper, model B-1213-4PF, features two piece construction fully assembled and ready for installation.
TYPE
MODEL NUMBER
DESCRIPTION
NET WT. (LBS.)
A A B
B-1224-3 B-1224-6 T-22
24"W x 12"H x 3"P - RECTANGULAR SHAPED BUMPER 24"W x 12"H x 6"P - RECTANGULAR SHAPED BUMPER 22"W x 22"H x 3"P - T-SHAPED MOLDED BUMPER
33 55 43
C D D
B-1213-4 B-1213-4PF RF
12"W x 13"H x 4"P - MOLDED BUMPER 12"W x 13"H x 4"P - PLASTIC FACE MOLDED BUMPER REPLACEMENT FACE (FOR B-1213-4PF ONLY)
24 24 1
E F G
L-1818-4 B-516 B-818
18"W x 18"H x 4"P - L-SHAPED MOLDED BUMPER 16"W x 5"H x 2"P - RECTANGULAR SHAPED BUMPER 18"W x 8"H x 2"P - RECTANGULAR SHAPED BUMPER
36 7 14
-----
B-516-SF B-818-SF
5"W x 16"H x 2"P - STEEL FACED MOLDED BUMPER 8"W x 18"H x 2"P - STEEL FACED MOLDED BUMPER
24 44
TYPE C
TYPE D
TYPE E
TYPE F
TYPE G
DC-25/UPS/FC-55
Installation Hardware Installing bumpers is no longer a chore with concrete anchor bolts. Use 4" long anchors with Laminated Bumpers and 6" long anchors for Molded Bumpers. Sold individually.
TYPE B
MODEL NUMBER AS-344 AS-346 AS-584 BIT-3/4
CONCRETE ANCHOR BOLTS SIZE & BUMPER IT ACCOMMODATES LAMINATED BUMPERS, 3/4" x 4" MOLDED BUMPERS, 3/4" x 6" EXTRUDED BUMPERS, 5/8" x 4" MASONRY BIT 3/4" DIAMETER
NET WT. (LBS.) 1 1 1 1 DC-25/UPS
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
311
MATERIAL HANDLING Cargo Deckers Trailer Crane Bumpers • Resists Abrasion, Impact, Wear and Corrosion • Impervious to Weather Damage Manufactured from fiber reinforced prime rubber containing nylon and polyester. All models have predrilled, countersunk mounting holes for easy installation. Bolt hole diameter is ½" with the exception of model TB-90 at ¾". Installation hardware not included. MODEL NUMBER TB-10 TB-20 TB-70 TB-90
WIDTH 2½" 3½" 2¼" 5¼"
LENGTH 6" 6" 16" 8"
NET WT. (LBS.) 2 4 5 6
PROJECTION 3½" 3½" 2" 3½"
TB-10
TB-20
TB-90
TB-70
DC-25/UPS/FC-55
Extruded Bumper Stops
• Protect Vehicles in Parking Lots and Trucks at Docks • Use Vertically or Horizontally Ideal for building and machinery protection. Bumper Stops are excellent for protecting vehicles when parking places are located next to building walls. Made of strong, durable, high impact resistant solid rubber. Easy installation either horizontally or vertically. Accepts a 3/8" flat head anchor bolt. Installation hardware not included.
BS-18
MODEL NUMBER BS-12 BS-18 BS-24 BS-36
WIDTH 5½" 5½" 5½" 5½"
LENGTH 12" 18" 24" 36"
PROJECTION 1¼" 1¼" 1¼" 1¼"
DBE-10-1
4 5 7 11 DC-25/UPS/FC-55
Hardened Molded Bumpers
DBE-30-1
NET WT. (LBS.)
• High Impact Resistance • Immune to all Weather Conditions These predrilled bumpers are constructed of fiber reinforced rubber containing nylon and polyester. Steel reinforcement rings are molded into each bumper for installation. Uses 3/4" anchor bolts. Sold individually. Installation hardware not included. MODEL NET WT. NUMBER WIDTH LENGTH PROJECTION (LBS.) DBE-10-1 4½" 10" 3" 7 DBE-20-1 4½" 20" 3" 14 DBE-30-1 4½" 30" 3" 20 DC-25/UPS/FC-55
Pallet Cargo Decker • Reduce Freight Damage • Increase Trailer Load Volume • Protect Delicate Freight Optimize your trailer space with Pallet Cargo Decker. Fits into your standard semi-trailers. Holds boxes, pallets and other bulky freight up to 5,000 pounds. Wood platform not included. MODEL NUMBER PCD-92 PCD-92D PCD-92DS PCD-92DSB PCD-STL
OVERALL SIZE DESCRIPTION )W x H x D( SINGLE 90" x 57" x 48" DOUBLE 90" x 57" x 48" DOUBLE WITH SIDES 90" x 57" x 48" DOUBLE W/SIDES & BACK 90" x 57" x 48" OPTIONAL STEEL PLATFORM
NET WT. (LBS.) 144 228 253 287 150
model PCD-92
DC-25/UPS/FC-60
Magnetic Push Sweepers
• Pick up spilled nails, tacks and metal shavings quickly and easily • Clean up workstations, garages, or machine shops quickly Type A - Economical Manual Push Sweeper Powerful magnets, quick release and improved adjustable wheel brackets make the best magnet around even better. Comes with 7" diameter wheels and a stainless steel magnetic box for easy clean up. The 30" long handle folds up easy for storage. Type B - Heavy Duty Drop Lever Pan Easy to use Push Magnet features stainless steel face plates. Deep permanent magnetic field never needs recharged. Features a 30" long steel handle with an easy to use release lever.
TYPE
MODEL NUMBER
REMOVAL PROCESS
SWEEP WIDTH
OVERALL WIDTH
NET WT. (LBS.)
A B
MPS-30 MPS-24
MANUAL DROP LEVER PAN
30" 24"
34" 28"
24 48
TYPE A MANUAL PUSH SWEEPER
DC-25/UPS/FC-100
312
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Sweepers/Mirrors
MATERIAL HANDLING
Manual Brush Sweeper The Janitor II is not only lightweight, but also faster and more efficient than cleaning with a conventional push broom. The rotation of the wheels causes the brushes to rotate and pick up material in a 27" wide path. The side broom allows for cleaning along curbs, walls and in corners. Contains no electric motor. Reservoir holds up to 10 gallons of material and can be emptied easily. Use the sweeper anywhere, indoors or out, on concrete, asphalt, tile and commercial carpets. Great for parking lots, gas stations, theaters, warehouses, schools, etc. Steel construction. MODEL NUMBER JAN-II
NET WT. (LBS.) 85
DESCRIPTION MANUAL BRUSH SWEEPER
DC-25/UPS/FC-100
Floor Tape Applicators & Floor Tape • Apply Marking Tape Accurately & Securely to Floors • Tape Sold Separately Type A - Economy Designed to apply tape as you walk. Solid steel construction with comfortable hand grips and durable rubber wheels allow for easy operation and maintenance. Features a soft rubber applicator head. Holds tape rolls with a 3" diameter core and widths between 1" minimum to 4½" maximum. Type B - Deluxe Applicator head adjusts quickly to apply tape in circular path or in a long straight line. Rear stabilizer adjusts right and left to allow for marking next to walls and pallet racks. Holds tape rolls with a 3" core and a widths of 2", 2-1/2", 3", 3-3/8" and 3-5/8". FLOOR TAPE APPLICATOR TYPE
MODEL NUMBER
MAXIMUM ROLL DIAMETER
TAPE WIDTHS
NET WT. (LBS.)
A
TPA-10
6½"
18
B
TPA-20
7"
1" - 4½" 2", 2½", 3", 3-3/8" & 3-5/8"
TYPE A ECONOMY
24
YELLOW/BLACK STRIPED FLOOR TAPE MODEL NUMBER
WIDTH
LENGTH
COLOR
NET WT. (LBS.)
YB-282-R YB-382-R
2" 3"
82 FT. 82 FT.
YELLOW/BLACK YELLOW/BLACK
1 1 DC-25/UPS/FC-100
TYPE B DELUXE
Industrial Acrylic Convex Mirrors Lightweight design made from the finest quality materials, using Grade A Optical Glass. Comes standard with hanging hardware. MODEL NUMBER
DESCRIPTION
OVERALL DIAMETER
DISTANCE COVERED
NET WT. (LBS.)
CNVX-12 CNVX-18 CNVX-26 CNVX-30 CNVX-2616
ROUND ROUND ROUND ROUND RECTANGULAR
12" 18" 26" 30" 26"W x 16"H
12' 20' 26' 30' 24'
5 9 14 20 12 DC-25/UPS
Aluminum Treadplate Portable Tool Boxes • Constructed of 1/8" thick diamond treadplate material • Two sturdy handles for transporting Safety latch for padlock securing. Padlock is not included. MODEL NUMBER
WIDTH
DEPTH
HEIGHT
THICKNESS
NET WT. (LBS.)
APTS-2448 APTS-3648 APTS-2460 APTS-3060 APTS-3660
48" 48" 60" 60" 60"
24" 24" 24" 24" 24"
24" 36" 24" 30" 36"
1/8" 1/8" 1/8" 1/8" 1/8"
97 132 114 117 162
CASTERS 5" x 2", MODEL APTS-C )4( FORK POCKETS 7-1/2" x 2-1/2", MODEL APTS-F
DC-25/UPS/FC-250
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
313
MATERIAL HANDLING Scissor Lifts Electric Hydraulic Scissor Lift Tables Full featured electric hydraulic scissor lift tables are used by all types of manufacturing and warehouse facilities. Safety features include: electric toe guard to protect pinch points during lowering of the table, brass velocity fuse to maintain platform height regardless of hydraulic pressure, 24V AC push-button hand control, maintenance prop, and upper travel limit switch to stop table at maximum height reducing motor wear. 2HP, 460V, 3 phase, 60 Hz totally enclosed motor standard, other voltages available. 3000 psi hydraulic component rating. QUICKSHIP (460V 3 PHASE ONLY)
Contact Factory for Special Design Requirements
MODEL NUMBER
PLATFORM SIZE (W x L)
LOWERED HEIGHT
RAISED HEIGHT
CAPACITY (POUNDS)
VOLTAGE PHASE
NET WT. (POUNDS)
LIST PRICE EACH
EHLT-2448-3-43 EHLT-3060-3-43 EHLT-4048-3-43 EHLT-4848-3-43 EHLT-4872-3-43
24" x 48" 30" x 60" 40" x 48" 48" x 48" 48" x 72"
7" 7" 7" 7" 7"
43" 43" 43" 43" 43"
3,000 3,000 3,000 3,000 3,000
460/3 460/3 460/3 460/3 460/3
700 725 800 825 975
$2,430.00 2,430.00 2,430.00 2,430.00 2,705.00
EHLT-2448-4-43 EHLT-3060-4-43 EHLT-4048-4-43 EHLT-4848-4-43 EHLT-4872-4-43
24" x 48" 30" x 60" 40" x 48" 48" x 48" 48" x 72"
7" 7" 7" 7" 7"
43" 43" 43" 43" 43"
4,000 4,000 4,000 4,000 4,000
460/3 460/3 460/3 460/3 460/3
775 800 850 910 1005
$3,080.00 3,080.00 3,080.00 3,080.00 3,427.00 DC-20/FC-70
Model Number Format EHLT - (width)(length) - capacity - raised height STANDARD FEATURES • Patented Pinch Point Perimeter Guards for OSHA Compliance • Fused 24 Volt Hand Held Pendant Control on 8 ft. Cord • Adjustable Upper Travel 24V Limit Switch • Internal Brass Velocity Fuse • 2HP 56 Frame Electric Motor • New Improved Pressure Plated Pump & Manifold System • New Improved Robust Heavy Capacity Tables • Displacement Style Hydraulic Cylinder • State-of-the-Art Lifetime Lubricated Bearings • Hinged Maintenance Prop
• Optional Foot Control model EHLT-FC
36" 36" 36"
24" - 48" 24" - 48" 24" - 48"
48" - 72" 48" - 72" 48" - 72"
1,000 2,000 3,000
43" 43" 43"
LOWERED HEIGHT 7" 7" 7"
36" 36" 36"
24" - 48" 36" - 48" 36" - 48"
48" - 72" 48" - 72" 48" - 72"
4,000 5,000 6,000
43" 44" 44"
7" 8" 8"
11 16 16
1008 1029 1050
$3,269.00 3,477.00 3,891.00
36" 33" 33"
36" - 48" 40" - 60" 40" - 60"
48" - 72" 48" - 72" 48" - 72"
*8,000 *10,000 *12,000
44" 43" 43"
8" 10" 10"
10 15 15
1281 1438 1596
$5,956.00 6,624.00 7,127.00
48" 48" 48"
24" - 48" 24" - 48" 24" - 48"
64" - 90" 64" - 90" 64" - 90"
1,000 2,000 3,000
55" 55" 55"
7" 7" 7"
7 8 11
1155 1176 1197
$3,397.00 3,426.00 3,678.00
48" 48" 48"
36" - 48" 36" - 48" 36" - 48"
64" - 96" 64" - 96" 64" - 96"
4,000 5,000 6,000
56" 56" 56"
8" 8" 8"
16 16 24
1218 1239 1260
$3,818.00 3,941.00 4,143.00
48" 45" 45"
36" - 48" 40" - 60" 40" - 60"
64" - 96" 64" - 96" 64" - 96"
*8,000 *10,000 *12,000
56" 55" 55"
8" 10" 10"
15 15 20
1501 1659 1816
$7,394.00 7,798.00 8,318.00
60" 60" 60"
24" - 48" 24" - 48" 24" - 48"
84" - 108" 84" - 108" 84" - 108"
1,000 2,000 3,000
67" 67" 67"
7" 7" 7"
11 14 16
1785 1806 1827
$4,579.00 4,713.00 4,961.00
60" 60" 60"
48" - 72" 48" - 72" 48" - 72"
96" - 120" 96" - 120" 96" - 120"
*4,000 *5,000 *6,000
68" 68" 70"
8" 8" 10"
26 26 30
1848 1869 1890
$5,720.00 6,611.00 7,109.00
60" 60" 60"
62" - 72" 62" - 72" 62" - 72"
96" - 120" 96" - 120" 96" - 120"
*8,000 *10,000 *12,000
70" 72" 72"
10" 12" 12"
30 30 30
2131 2289 2446
$8,370.00 9,160.00 9,582.00
72" 72" 71½"
24" - 48" 24" - 48" 48" - 72"
102" - 120" 102" - 120" 120" - 144"
1,000 2,000 *3,000
79" 79" 82"
7" 7" 10½"
12 16 16
2047 2068 2089
$5,470.00 5,867.00 6,426.00
71½" 71½" 71½"
48" - 72" 48" - 72" 48" - 72"
120" - 144" 120" - 144" 120" - 144"
*4,000 *5,000 *6,000
82" 82" 82"
10½" 10½" 12"
26 26 30
2110 2131 2152
$6,478.00 7,567.00 7,988.00
30
2415
VERTICAL TRAVEL
PLATFORM PLATFORM CAPACITY WIDTH LENGTH (POUNDS)
RAISED HEIGHT
71½" 62" - 72" 120" - 144" *8,000 82" 12" TRAVEL TIME BASED ON 460V THREE-PHASE MOTOR )^( )DENOTES 6.5 HP 208-230/460V 3 PHASE (EXTERNALLY MOUNTED*
314
TRAVEL (^) TIME (SEC)
NET WT. (POUNDS)
LIST PRICE EACH
7 7 8
945 966 987
$2,423.00 2,584.00 2,961.00
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
DC-20/FC-70
Scissor Lifts
MATERIAL HANDLING
Manual Built-In Carousels for Scissor Tables Rotate pallets, boxes or crates without ever stepping around the table. This sleek flush mounted carousel smoothly rotates 360°. Easy to use operation. Capacity is 4,000 lbs. Carousel adds 1" to scissor table service range. Platform size is 48" x 48". Scissor table not included. MODEL NUMBER
DESCRIPTION
ROTATE
MANUAL BUILT-IN CAROUSEL FOR SCISSOR TABLE
Accordion Skirting Accordion Skirts have a functional purpose as well as a safety purpose. Complies with the OSHA pinch point specifications. The functional advantage is minimizing dirt and debris accumulation under the platform. Dirt can contaminate electrical and hydraulic components. Life expectancy of both can be substantially reduced by this contamination. Debris such as raw materials, boards, or pallets can restrict the scissor or table movement. Accordion skirts serve to keep debris from damaging the operating mechanism, hydraulic components, or electrical parts. Safety is enhanced by keeping arms, legs, fingers, and toes out from under the table. Standard electric toe-guards are not included when scissor table is fitted with accordion skirt option. TABLE SPECIFICATIONS: 1) TABLE WIDTH, W = ________________________" 2) TABLE LENGTH, L = _______________________" 3) TABLE RAISED HEIGHT, H =________________" 4) TABLE LOWERED HEIGHT, D =______________" CALCULATION FORMULA: (3" convolutions) All Dimensions are in Inches
W = Width of Platform
L = Length of Platform
H = Raised Height
ACCORDION SKIRTING CUSTOMER INSTALLED (including hardware) ACCORDION SKIRTING FACTORY INSTALLED (includes extra packaging) WEIGHT: 0.5 lbs./ft²
REPAIR KIT FOR ACCORDION SKIRTING model AC-RK
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628)
Rigid PVC and Roller Curtains Also Available - Contact Factory
OUTSIDE MOUNTING )STANDARD(
Wireless Remote Controls Put the power in your hands with the Wireless Remote Control System, series RC-460. This lightweight, two-button, remote control gives you the freedom to control your scissor table from a range up to 150 feet (range can be adjusted for optimum signal strength and can be reduced if required). Unit is also available in a four-button model for lift and tilt tables. The remote control measures 4" wide x 6" high x 2" thick. Approved to meet part 15 of the Federal Communications Code, FCC (this means that you can transmit at the 300 MHz frequency). Designed to prevent crosstalk and false triggering from stray radio frequency. Scissor table not included. MODEL NUMBER
RC-460-2 RC-460-4
DESCRIPTION )2-BUTTON CONTROL (LIFT-HOLD-LOWER CIRCUIT )4-BUTTON CONTROL (LIFT AND TILT CIRCUIT
NET WT. (POUNDS) 1 1
WIRELESS REMOTE CONTROL IS FACTORY INSTALLED
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
315
MATERIAL HANDLING Scissor Lifts Integral Scale for Scissor Tables • • • • • •
Validate Number of Pieces or Parts Know Exactly How Much Weight is on Your Table No Holes or Bolting Required Installs and Removes in Seconds Expedite Your Shipping & Palletizing Process Available in Any Size to Fit an Existing Table (Rests on Top of Table) • Adds approximately 3" to Overall Height • Scale Functions: Zero Weight and Tare Weight • Weighing Units: Pounds or Kilograms • Scale Capacity: 5,000 lbs. • Mettler Toledo™ Scale • Scissor Table Not Included
INTEGRAL SCALE model SCALE
MODEL NUMBER
DESCRIPTION
SCALE
INTEGRAL SCALE
Auto Sense and Height Index with Integral Scale • Load and Unload Heavy Loads Easier, Faster and More Efficiently • Minimum Lifting, Bending and Reaching • One Touch Auto Height • Fully Automatic Controller • Combines precise positioning and weighing capabilities in a single unit • Fully programmable and automatic: Set height function: Programmable up to four preset heights. Increment Function: When X amount of weight is removed, the table will raise Y inches. 2X amount of weight is removed, the table will raise 2Y inches. Decrement Function: When X amount of weight is added, the table will lower Y inches. 2X amount of weight is added, the table will lower 2Y inches. Scale Functions: Zero weight, Tare (net) weight, and Tare (gross) weight. Raise/Lower Push Buttons on Keypad • Fully integrated controller with a large display 2 lines of 20 characters with display function (messages and values) • A 16-button keypad for programming, editing, and modifying - using all 16 buttons on the panel display • Scale Capacity: 5,000 lbs. • Adds approximately 3 inches to the overall lowered height • Hybrid technology linear sensor is used to control positions at any preset height • Scissor Table Not Included MODEL NUMBER
DESCRIPTION
SENSE
AUTO SENSE & HEIGHT INDEX WITH INTEGRAL SCALE
AUTO SENSE HEIGHT INDEX & model SENSE
Programmable Height Eliminate unnecessary bending and "land control jogging" by presetting multiple working heights at the touch of a button • Set height function: Programmable up to 4 preset heights • Incremental height adjustment for jogging lift at preset increments • Raise/lower push button on the keypad • Fully integrated controller with LCD display • A 15-button keypad for programming, editing, and modifying all 15 buttons on the panel display • Excellent for repeat repositioning applications • Hybrid technology linear sensor is used to control positions at any preset height • Scissor Table Not Included MODEL NUMBER
PROGRAMMABLE HEIGHT model PROGRAM
DESCRIPTION
PROGRAM
PROGRAMMABLE HEIGHT
Rotary Air/Hydraulic Scissor Lift Tables Utilize the efficiency of factory air to power this lift table. Simply connect a ½" NPT air line, filter, regulator and lubricator and you now have the most efficient lift table manufactured. Features pneumatic upper travel limit switch, toe guards, internal brass velocity fuse, hinged maintenance prop, two button hand control and state-of-the-art precision pins and bearings.
316
MODEL NUMBER
PLATFORM )SIZE (W x L
LOWERED HEIGHT
RAISED HEIGHT
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
NET WT. (POUNDS)
AHLT-3060-3-43
30" x 60"
7"
43"
3,000
987
AHLT-4048-3-43
40" x 48"
7"
43"
3,000
987
AHLT-4848-3-43
48" x 48"
7"
43"
3,000
987
AHLT-4872-3-43
48" x 72"
7"
43"
3,000
1214
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Scissor TABLES
MATERIAL HANDLING
Work Station Electric Hydraulic Scissor Tables Designed to raise products up to an ergonomic working height. The EHLT-WS maximizes safety with minimum space requirements. Ideal for all types of manufacturing and warehouse facilities. External power unit and hand control standard. MODEL NUMBER
PLATFORM SIZE )W x L(
LOWERED HEIGHT
RAISED HEIGHT
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
TRAVEL TIME
NET WT. (LBS.)
EHLT-WS-2436-1.5-29 EHLT-WS-2448-1.5-36 EHLT-WS-3248-1.5-36 EHLT-WS-4048-1.5-36
24" x 36" 24" x 48" 32" x 48" 40" x 48"
8-5/8" 7" 7" 7"
31" 36" 36" 36"
1,500 1,500 1,500 1,500
6 sec. 8 sec. 8 sec. 8 sec.
700 720 750 780
TRAVEL TIME BASED ON 3 PHASE POWER
DC-20/FC-70
Shorty Scissor Lift Tables Built with the same quality as all our lift tables, the EHLTS and EHLTSD maximize safety and durability. Designed to raise products up to an ergonomic working height. When tight spaces are what you have, consider a Shorty Scissor Table. Available in both a single and double leg style these tables offer smaller deck sizes customized to your space requirements. Design features include full perimeter pinch point guard and emergency internal brass velocity fuse. External power unit and hand control standard. Model Number Format: EHLTS - (width)(length) - capacity - raised height SINGLE LEG SET VERTICAL TRAVEL
PLATFORM WIDTH
PLATFORM LENGTH
CAPACITY (POUNDS)
RAISED HEIGHT
24" 24" 24"
24" - 48" 24" - 48" 24" - 48"
36" - 48" 36" - 48" 36" - 48"
1,000 2,000 3,000
31" 31" 31"
24" 24" 24"
24" - 48" 36" - 48" 36" - 48"
36" - 48" 36" - 48" 36" - 48"
4,000 5,000 6,000
31" 31" 31"
LOWERED HEIGHT
TRAVEL TIME (SEC)
NET WT. (POUNDS)
5 5 5
668 691 730
7" 8" 8"
10 10 10
721 744 792
7" 7" 7"
DC-20/ FC-70
TRAVEL TIME BASED ON 3 PHASE POWER
Model Number Format: EHLTSD - (width)(length) - capacity - raised height e the To se ge, n a r full C8 00-LO 8 ll a c
DOUBLE LEG SET VERTICAL TRAVEL
PLATFORM WIDTH
PLATFORM LENGTH
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
RAISED HEIGHT
1,000 2,000 3,000 4,000 5,000
"51 "51 "51 "51 "51
"42 "48 - "34 "48 - "36 "42 "48 - "34 "48 - "36 "42 "48 - "34 "48 - "36 "42 "48 - "34 "48 - "36 "42 "48 - "34 "48 - "36 TRAVEL TIME BASED ON 3 PHASE POWER
LOWERED HEIGHT "10 "10 "10 "10 "10
TRAVEL TIME )(SEC 4 7 8 11 16
NET WT. (POUNDS) 882 892 903 955 966 DC-20/FC-70
Double Scissor Lift Tables Achieve the extra reach you're looking for with our Double Scissor Lift Tables. These full featured electric hydraulic scissor lift tables are used by all types of manufacturing and warehouse facilities. Safety features include: electric toe guard to protect pinch points during lowering of the table, brass safety velocity fuse to maintain platform height regardless of hydraulic pressure, 24V AC push-button hand control, maintenance prop, and upper travel limit switch to stop table at maximum height reducing motor wear. 2 HP, 460V, 3-phase, 60 Hz totally enclosed motor standard, other voltages available. 3000 psi hydraulic component rating. Model Number Format: EHLTD - (width)(length) - capacity - raised height VERTICAL TRAVEL
PLATFORM WIDTH
PLATFORM LENGTH
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
RAISED HEIGHT
LOWERED HEIGHT
TRAVEL TIME )(SEC
NET WT. (POUNDS)
60" 60" 60" 60" 60" 72" 72" 72" 72" 72"
34" - 48" 34" - 48" 34" - 48" 34" - 48" 34" - 48" 34" - 48" 34" - 48" 34" - 48" 34" - 48" 34" - 48"
48" - 72" 48" - 72" 48" - 72" 48" - 72" 48" - 72" 64" - 88" 64" - 88" 64" - 88" 64" - 88" 64" - 88"
1,000 2,000 3,000 4,000 5,000 1,000 2,000 3,000 4,000 5,000
70" 70" 70" 70" 70" 84" 84" 84" 84" 84"
10" 10" 10" 10" 10" 12" 12" 12" 12" 12"
7 11 11 16 16 10 11 12 16 23
1470 1575 1680 1890 1942 1576 1680 1785 1968 2021
TRAVEL TIME BASED ON 460V THREE-PHASE POWER
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
DC-20/FC-70
317
MATERIAL HANDLING Scissor TABLES Foot Pump Scissor Lift Tables Foot pump activated lift tables. Used by all types of manufacturing and warehousing facilities. Features torsion tubes for side to side stability, pressure flow control valve for controlled lowering and foot pump. Optional power-lift feature available. Scissor tables can be made mobile with the optional handle and caster kit. Rugged welded steel construction. Painted blue finish. MODEL NUMBER
SCTAB-400 SCTAB-500 SCTAB-750D SCTAB-800D SCTAB-1000 SCTAB-2000
SCTAB-400 )SCTAB-800D (double) (not shown
SCTAB-500
SCTAB-1000 SCTAB-2000
PLATFORM SIZE )W x L(
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
RAISED HEIGHT
LOWERED HEIGHT
OF PUMPS AT # HIGH/LOW SPEED
NET WT. (POUNDS)
17½" x 27½" 20" x 33" 20" x 40" 20" x 35½" 20" x 40" 42" x 42"
400 500 750 800 1,000 2,000
29" 28" 35" 51" 32" 32"
8¼" 6" 7" 13" 8" 8"
19 13 / 26 8 / 16 12 / 39 8 / 16 16 / 32
164 274 284 274 270 386 DC-20/FC-70
FOOT PUMP SCISSOR TABLE OPTIONS MODEL NUMBER
NET WT. (POUNDS)
DESCRIPTION
*SCTAB-DC *SCTAB-AC *SCTAB-AIR *SCTAB-CHK-1 *SCTAB-CHK-2
12V DC HAND CONTROL WITH DEEP CYCLE BATTERY 24V AC HAND CONTROL WITH 115V 1 PHASE POWER FACTORY AIR OVER OIL WITH FOOT TREADLE CONTROL CASTER & HANDLE KIT (400, 500, 750D, 800D & 1000 only) CASTER & HANDLE KIT (2000) (FACTORY INSTALLED ONLY) ADD 6½" TO RAISED AND LOWERED HEIGHTS
54 36 18 18 18
SCTAB-HDS *SCTAB-BC *SCTAB-BC-OB *SCTAB-BCI
HIGH DENSITY PVC SURFACE BENCH TOP STYLE BATTERY CHARGER ON-BOARD STYLE BATTERY CHARGER BATTERY CHARGE INDICATOR
4 8 9 1
SCTAB-750D shown with caster( )handle kit
NOT AVAILABLE ON THE SCTAB-400 AND SCTAB-800D*
Ground Lift Scissor Tables Designed for use when fork trucks are not available. Pallets can be loaded onto table with pallet trucks and raised to an ergonomic working height. Safety features include; front-side electric toe guard to protect pinch points during lowering of the table velocity fuse to maintain platform height regardless of hydraulic pressure, foot control, maintenance prop, and upper travel limit switch to stop table at maximum height reducing motor wear. 2HP, 208-230/460V, 3-phase, 60 Hz totally enclosed motor is remote and can be located up to eight feet away from table. 3000 psi hydraulic components rating. Optional accordion skirting available.
MODEL NUMBER
PLATFORM )SIZE (W x L
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
RAISED HEIGHT
EHLTG-4450-2-36 EHLTG-4450-4-36 EHLTG-5250-2-36 EHLTG-5250-4-36 EHLTG-4470-2-48 EHLTG-4470-4-48 EHLTG-5270-2-48 EHLTG-5270-4-48
44" x 50" 44" x 50" 52" x 50" 52" x 50" 44" x 70" 44" x 70" 52" x 70" 52" x 70"
2,000 4,000 2,000 4,000 2,000 4,000 2,000 4,000
36" 36" 36" 36" 48" 48" 48" 48"
LOWERED HEIGHT
1/2" 1/2" 1/2" 1/2" 1/2" 1/2" 1/2" 1/2"
OVERALL SIZE )W x L x H(
NET WT. (POUNDS)
67" x 56" x 8½" 67" x 56" x 8½" 75" x 56" x 8½" 75" x 56" x 8½" 67" x 78" x 10" 67" x 78" x 10" 75" x 78" x 10" 75" x 78" x 10"
1620 1690 1690 1890 1995 2310 2205 2520 DC-20/FC-70
PALLET TRUCK ACCESSIBLE
Hydraulic Motorcycle Lift Manual foot pump activated stationary lift. Ideal for the casual and professional rider to work on their motorcycles. Features a front tire cradle to hold wheels up to 6" wide. The hinged ramp measures 27½" wide by 21½" long. MODEL NUMBER
MOTOLIFT-1100
MAINTENANCE DOOR
OVERALL SIZE )W x L(
BASE FRAME )W x L(
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
SERVICE RANGE
35" x 108"
26¾" x 65"
1,100
7" to 32"
NET WT. (POUNDS)
517 DC-20/FC-70
318
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
MATERIAL HANDLING
Lift & Tilt TABLES
Low Profile Electric/Hydraulic Scissor Lift Tables Load and unload skids with a pallet jack without the need for a pit when using the optional approach ramp. Superior engineering features rugged dependability. Safety features include electric perimeter pinch point guard, emergency stop velocity fuse in cylinders, fused 24V AC hand held control and maintenance supports. Remote power unit comes complete with a plastic cover to protect motor from dust and debris. Note motor voltage and phase when ordering. Model Number Format EHLTX - (width)(length) - capacity - raised height VERTICAL TRAVEL
PLATFORM WIDTH
PLATFORM LENGTH
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
RAISED HEIGHT
35¾" 35¾" 35¾" 35¾"
36" - 60" 36" - 60" 36" - 60" 36" - 60"
53" - 60" 53" - 60" 53" - 60" 53" - 60"
1,000 2,000 3,000 3,500
39" 39" 39" 39"
LOWERED HEIGHT
3¼" 3¼" 4¼" 4¼"
TRAVEL TIME )(SEC
7 14 22 22
NET WT. (POUNDS)
1470 1627 1680 1869
APPROACH RAMPS FOR LOW PROFILE SCISSOR TABLES MODEL NUMBER
WIDTH
LENGTH
HEIGHT
NET WT. (POUNDS)
ARX-3617-3 ARX-3623-3 ARX-3622-4 ARX-3630-4
36" 36" 36" 36"
17" 23" 22" 30"
3¼" 3¼" 4¼" 4¼"
108 186 138 206
Remote Power Unit measures 24"W x 24"L x 8"H
)DC-20/FC-70 (ARX SHIP FC-60
Lift & Tilt Scissor Tables Performs both lifting and tilting operations. 45° tilt standard. Restraining chain and 12" high lip keep load in place during tilting. Safety features include: electric toe guard to protect worker from pinch points during lowering of table, velocity fuses to stop travel due to loss of hydraulic pressure, 4 pushbutton hand pendant control on an 8 foot coil cord, upper limit switch to stop travel at maximum height reducing motor wear and maintenance prop. End tilt standard, side tilt available. Optional accordion skirting available for both the lifting and tilting portions of the table. MODEL NUMBER EHLTT-3648-1-47 EHLTT-4848-1-47 EHLTT-3648-2-47 EHLTT-4848-2-47 EHLTT-3648-3-47 EHLTT-4848-3-47 EHLTT-3648-4-47 EHLTT-4848-4-47
PLATFORM )SIZE (W x L "x 48 "36 "x 48 "48 "x 48 "36 "x 48 "48 "x 48 "36 "x 48 "48 "x 48 "36 "x 48 "48
CAPACITY )POUNDS( 1,000 1,000 2,000 2,000 3,000 3,000 4,000 4,000
RAISED HEIGHT "47 "47 "47 "47 "47 "47 "47 "47
LOWERED OVERALL HEIGHT )SIZE (W x L "11 "x 53 "36 "11 "x 53 "48 "11 "x 53 "36 "11 "x 53 "48 "11 "x 53 "36 "11 "x 53 "48 "11 "x 53 "36 "11 "x 53 "48
NET WT. (POUNDS) 1060 1113 1181 1296 1249 1365 1312 1433
STANDARD END TILT SHOWN
LIFT & TILT SCISSOR TABLE OPTIONS DESCRIPTION
NET WT. (POUNDS)
FOUR PEDAL FOOT CONTROL (LIFT & TILT PRODUCTS) *)AIR/OIL POWER W/PNEUMATIC PUSH BUTTON (FRL REQ'D
12 36
MODEL NUMBER
EHLTT-FCH EHLTT-HCA
FILTER - REGULATOR - LUBRICATOR REQUIRED TO OPERATE UNIT*
DC-20/FC-70
Zero Lift & Tilt Tables Designed to lift products to an ergonomic working position, and then tilt them to reduce operator bending. Products may be loaded and unloaded with the use of a standard hand pallet truck. No pit mounting required! Maximum tilt angle is 45°. Lift and tilt controlled separately. Remote power unit with hand-held control standard. MODEL NUMBER
PLATFORM )SIZE (W x L
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
RAISED HEIGHT
ZLTT-4452-2-36 ZLTT-4452-4-36 ZLTT-5252-2-36 ZLTT-5252-4-36 ZLTT-4472-2-48 ZLTT-4472-4-48 ZLTT-5272-2-48 ZLTT-5272-4-48
44" x 52" 44" x 52" 52" x 52" 52" x 52" 44" x 72" 44" x 72" 52" x 72" 52" x 72"
2,000 4,000 2,000 4,000 2,000 4,000 2,000 4,000
36" 36" 36" 36" 48" 48" 48" 48"
LOWERED HEIGHT
FOOT CONTROL, MODEL ZLTT-FC RAISED HEIGHT NOTED WITH PLATFORM IN LEVEL POSITION
½" ½" ½" ½" ½" ½" ½" ½"
OVERALL SIZE )W x L x H(
NET WT. (POUNDS)
69" x 59" x 24" 69" x 59" x 24" 77" x 59" x 24" 77" x 59" x 24" 69" x 79" x 24" 69" x 79" x 24" 77" x 79" x 24" 77" x 79" x 24"
2121 2173 2205 2257 2950 3013 3045 3129 DC-20/FC-70
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
319
MATERIAL HANDLING
Pallet Inventors
Pallet Inverters Engineered to reduce your costs in production, storage, retrieval and distribution. The 180° rotation makes pallet exchange quick and simple while reducing product damage. Easy load transfer from wood pallet to plastic pallet, slip sheet or rental pallet. Features safety rails and guards. Units can be loaded and unloaded easily with a fork truck. Video available.
MODEL NUMBER
MAXIMUM LOAD )SIZE (W x L
MINIMUM JAW OPENING HEIGHT
MAXIMUM JAW OPENING HEIGHT
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
NET WT. (POUNDS)
PI-51 PI-61
50" x 50" 50" x 50"
37" 43"
61" 73"
4,400 4,400
4048 4268
LEVER CONTROL STANDARD / NEMA 12 RATING STANDARD
DC-20/FC-70
Manual Tilt Master SKID
PALLET
Lift, tilt and transport crates, boxes and pallets with an open bottom. Designed to give the user an ergonomically correct position to reach loads easily without the need for bending down or excessively reaching over. Forks can be tilted to 90°. Rolls smoothly on 6" x 2" polyurethane swivel casters with brake and foot protectors. Width between forks is 9½". The overall fork width is 22". The individual fork width is 6½". MODEL NUMBER
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
TM-22-M
2,200
VERTICAL LIFT HEIGHT
11¼"
LOWERED FORK HEIGHT
3½"
FORK LENGTH
OVERALL WIDTH
NET WT. (POUNDS)
31½"
25¼"
425 DC-25/FC-70
Tilt Master & Tilt Master Straddle Lift and position filled tote boxes or baskets without the need of a fork truck or lift table using the newly designed heavy-duty Tilt Master. These 90° tilters will function as a transporter by moving completed products from work station to work station without waiting for a fork truck. A folding ergonomic handle has dual steering grips for quick and easy maneuverability. Unit has a thin profile to allow the user to get as close to the load as possible. Units roll easily on 8" x 3" phenolic steering wheels and feature a floor lock. Series TM are to be used with open bottom pallets or skids only while the Tilt Master Straddle units, series TMS, can be used with virtually any kind of container or pallet. Units are powered with a 12V DC electric motor including an on-board battery charger standard. AC or *AIR/OIL power units available contact factory (*filter - regulator - lubricator required). Comes standard with a push-button hand control on an 8 foot coil cord.
SKID
PALLET
SKID
TILT MASTER STRADDLE With Only 13½" of Reach
TILT MASTER With Only 10½" of Reach MODEL NUMBER
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
FORK ADJUSTMENT
TILT MASTER TM-20 2,000 FIXED AT 26" (OD) TM-40 4,000 FIXED AT 26" (OD) TM-60 6,000 FIXED AT 27" (OD) TILT MASTER STRADDLE TMS-20 2,000 ½" TO 26½" (ID) TMS-40 4,000 ½" TO 26½" (ID) TMS-60 6,000 ½" TO 26½" (ID)
PALLET
OPERATOR REACH
FORK WIDTH
ROTATED HEIGHT
LOWERED HEIGHT
OVERALL SIZE )W x L x H(
NET WEIGHT )POUNDS(
10½" 10½" 10½"
6" 6" 6½"
33" 33" 33"
3-5/8" 3-5/8" 3-5/8"
40½" x 68" x 28½" 40½" x 68" x 28½" 40½" x 68" x 28½"
715 770 851
13½" 13½" 13½"
4" 4" 4"
37" 37" 37"
2-5/8" 2-5/8" 2-5/8"
57" x 61" x 28½" 57" x 61" x 28½" 57" x 61" x 28½"
840 1155 1365 DC-25/FC-70
TILT MASTER & TILT MASTER STRADDLE OPTIONS MODEL NUMBER
TM-CHUTE TM-PTDS TM-BCI
320
DESCRIPTION
RETROFIT CHUTE OPTION POWER TRACTION DRIVE SYSTEM BATTERY CHARGE INDICATOR GAUGE
NET WEIGHT )POUNDS(
18 156 10
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Trash Can Dumpers
MATERIAL HANDLING
Trash Can Dumpers Minimize lifting and dumping heavy trash cans with the rugged all steel Trash Can Dumper. One person can easily and safely empty trash cans weighing up to 300 lbs. into dumpsters. The automatic container clamp securely holds the trash can container. Hand crank or 115V, 1 Phase push button actuation rotates containers to 135° angle (60" dump height) above dumpster. Each unit comes with four casters for easy maneuverability and heavy duty mesh sides for safety. One Trash Can, model 95GLT, comes standard with each unit. MODEL NUMBER
T-DUMP-E T-DUMPHC 95-GLT
DESCRIPTION
OVERALL SIZE )W x L x H(
NET WT. (POUNDS)
LIST PRICE EACH
115V PUSH BUTTON ELECTRIC WINCH
42½" x 61" x 79"
840
$2,059.00
HAND OPERATED WINCH WITH BRAKE
42½" x 61" x 79"
1150
1,929.00
ADDITIONAL 95 GALLON POLY TOTE SPECIFY BLUE, BROWN, GRAY OR GREEN
27" x 34" x 45½"
50
$158.00
THE T-DUMP SERIES HAS A DUMP HEIGHT OF 60" AND A DUMP ANGLE OF 135°
DC-20/FC-100
Manual & Electric Hydraulic Trash Can Dumpers Trash Can Dumper is designed so one person can easily dump contents of trash cans no matter how heavy they are. Versatile adjustable unit works with only the trash cans listed below or approved equal. Available in manual foot pump or DC powered operation with hand control. Heavy-duty steel construction with two rigid and two swivel casters for portability. Maximum dump angle is 135°. MODEL NUMBER
TCD-M TCD-DC BC BC-OB BCI TH-32 TH-64 95-GLT
DESCRIPTION
MAXIMUM DUMP ANGLE
MAXIMUM DUMP HEIGHT
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
NET WT. (POUNDS)
LIST PRICE EACH
386 420 8 9 1
$1,985.00 2,760.00 $122.50 195.00 75.00
35 55 50
$48.20 64.30 158.00
FOOT PUMP 135° 48" 400 12V DC POWERED 135° 48" 400 REMOTE BATTERY CHARGER ON-BOARD BATTERY CHARGER BATTERY CHARGE INDICATOR GAUGE TRASH CANS 32 GALLON GREEN (18½"W x 22"D x 37½"H) 64 GALLON GRAY (23"W x 29"D x 41"H) 95 GALLON BLUE (27"W x 34"D x 45"H)
DC-20/FC-100/TRASH CANS FC-250
Fork Truck Mounted Trash Can Dumper Save time and reduce work-related injuries caused by lifting and dumping heavy waste containers. This innovative product will allow a fork truck driver to lift and dump refuse containers weighing up to 1,000 lbs. without ever leaving the seat of the fork truck! Secure dumper to fork truck with safety chain and run cable to drivers seat. Align trash can with dumper and lock into place. Once locked in place, transport trash can to refuse container, align and pull chain to dump refuse container contents. Only for use with 64 gallon trash can, model TH-64, or approved equal. Fork pockets are 2¼" high by 7¼" wide usable. Steel construction for years of dependable use. MODEL NUMBER
DESCRIPTION
FM-T-DUMP TH-64
FORK TRUCK DUMPER TRASH CAN
OVERALL SIZE )W x L x H(
CAPACITY
40" x 52" x 41" 1,000 lbs. 23" x 29" x 41" 65 gal.
NET WT. (POUNDS)
400 55
LIST PRICE EACH
$752.00 $64.30 DC-20/FC-70
Transportable Stacker This stacker will allow you to lift and move boxes and containers with ease. The unique design will also allow you to load it into the back of your truck or van without the need for heavy lifting or an overhead crane or hoist. To load into your truck, raise forks above truck bed and push the unit forwards completely over truck bed. Push the lower button and hydraulic system will lower forks to truck bed and then begin to raise the rest of the stacker automatically! Features 12V DC battery powered operation with push-button operation. Includes two rigid and two swivel casters. Steel construction. MODEL NUMBER
OVERALL SIZE )W x L x H(
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
SERVICE RANGE
NET WT. (POUNDS)
LIST PRICE EACH
T-LIFTER
38½" x 63" x 56¼"
2,000
3½" x 43"
700
$3,468.00
)"½FORK SIZE: 23¼"W x 46"L (INDIVIDUAL FORK WIDTH IS 6
SKID
PALLET
DC-20/FC-100/150
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
321
MATERIAL HANDLING Scisor Lift Trucks High Rise Lift Trucks Ergonomic lift truck increases worker and machine efficiency and productivity. Reduces muscle fatigue and body injuries by bringing material closer to actual worker height. 12V DC power with onboard battery charger standard. Heavy loads can be lifted by electric hydraulic power and manually moved without use of fork truck. Foot brake may be set while loading and unloading for added safety. Push buttons to raise and lower lift are located on power unit. Optional hand control on coil cord available. Key-operated ON/OFF control for better security is built into the power unit. MODEL NUMBER
HIPM-2748 HIPM-2048
FORK SIZE )W x L(
SERVICE RANGE
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
OPERATION
NET WT. (POUNDS)
27" x 48" 20" x 48"
3½" to 31" 3½" to 31"
2,500 2,500
DC BATTERY DC BATTERY
530 515 DC-20/FC-70
HIGH RISE LIFT TRUCK OPTIONS MODEL NUMBER
HIPM-PLATE HIPM-HC HIPM-FC HIPM-AC HIPM-PTDS HIPM-BCI
NET WT. (POUNDS)
DESCRIPTION
SOLID PLATFORM TO FIT OVER FORKS HAND HELD Pendant CONTROL ON 8 FT. COIL CORD FOOT TREADLE AIR/HYDRAULIC OIL OPTION 24V HAND HELD CONTROL, 110V AC POWER OPTION POWER TRACTION DRIVE SYSTEM BATTERY CHARGE INDICATOR GAUGE (DC UNITS ONLY)
36 1 24 48 156 1
SKID PALLET Applies to All Products on this Page
Tote Lifters
Designed to lift open bottom skids, boxes and baskets. Two operations available: hand pump and 12V DC power with rocker switch to raise or lower. Hand pump design features an ergonomic pump handle with two lifting speeds to accommodate for light or heavy loads. Side stabilizers provide balance to the unit when the load is lifted. Suffix "SS" stands for stainless steel units.
HAND PUMP L-220-HD & L-270-HD
12V DC POWERED & L-220-DC-HD L-270-DC-HD
MODEL NUMBER
OPERATION
FORK SIZE )W x L(
SERVICE RANGE
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
NET WT. (POUNDS)
L-220-HD L-270-HD L-270-HD-SS L-220-DC-HD L-270-DC-HD L-270-DC-HD-SS
HAND PUMP HAND PUMP HAND PUMP 12V DC POWERED 12V DC POWERED 12V DC POWERED
20" x 43" 27" x 43" 27" x 45" 20" x 45" 27" x 45" 27" x 45"
3½" to 31½" 3½" to 31½" 3½" to 31½" 3½" to 31½" 3½" to 31½" 3½" to 31½"
3,000 3,000 3,000 3,000 3,000 3,000
320 340 340 253 427 427 DC-25/FC-70
TOTE-LIFTER OPTIONS MODEL NUMBER STAINLESS STEEL 12V DC POWERED L-270-DC-SS
NET WT. (POUNDS)
DESCRIPTION
BC BC-OB BCI L-PLATE
REMOTE BATTERY CHARGER ON-BOARD BATTERY CHARGER BATTERY CHARGE INDICATOR GAUGE SOLID PLATFORM TO FIT OVER FORKS
8 9 1 36
Tote-A-Loads Designed to lift open bottom skids, boxes and baskets. The manually operated lift is easy to operate. The foot pump operated lift travels approximately 1/2" per stroke. To lower unit simply squeeze the bicycle style grip located on the white push bar. The battery operated lift is ideal for positioning products at workstation height for increased productivity. The up/down lever control is conveniently located on power unit. Polyurethane swivel casters with brake are standard on all units. MODEL NUMBER
DESCRIPTION
FORK SIZE )W x L(
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
SERVICE RANGE
NET WT. (POUNDS)
TAL-220-HD TAL-260-HD TAL-220-DC TAL-260-DC
FOOT PUMP FOOT PUMP 12V DC POWERED 12V DC POWERED
21" x 43" 27" x 43" 21" x 43" 27" x 43"
2,200 2,200 2,200 2,200
3½" to 33" 3½" to 33" 3½" to 33" 3½" to 33"
315 336 415 440
FOOT PUMP model TAL-260-HD
DC-20/UPS/FC-100 12V DC POWERED model TAL-260-DC
TOTE-A-LOAD OPTIONS MODEL NUMBER
BC BC-OB TAL-PLATE
322
DESCRIPTION
REMOTE BATTERY CHARGER ON-BOARD BATTERY CHARGER SOLID PLATFORM TO FIT OVER FORKS
NET WT. (POUNDS)
8 9 36
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Order Picker & Stackers
MATERIAL HANDLING
Electric Order Picker Reduce strain while increasing safety and productivity during repeated order picking applications. Manually pushed unit is easy to position. The lift operates with a 12V DC battery. Includes an on-board charger. The material platform measures 21½" wide by 23½" deep. Dual interlocking hand controls require the operator to have both hands on the hand rails during raising and lowering. MODEL NUMBER
OVERALL SIZE )W x L x H(
SERVICE RANGE
TOTAL CAPACITY
NET WT. (POUNDS)
EOP-440
24¾" x 47½" x 41"
26" to 59"
440 lbs.
333 DC-25/FC-70
Fully Portable Aluminum Load Lifter Ideal for the traveling salesperson as well as service and installation crews. Weighs a modest 59 pounds yet safely lifts and positions up to 220 pounds. Stores easily in a truck or a car. Rolls smoothly on 4" x 2½" rear swivel casters and 3" x 1" front wheels. The overall size of the unit is 22¾"W x 30¾"L x 55"H. MODEL NUMBER
PLATFORM )SIZE (W x L
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
SERVICE RANGE
LOAD CENTER
STRADDLE WIDTH
NET WT. (POUNDS)
KLIFT-220
21¾" x 19¾"
220
6½" to 47"
9¾"
21½"
59 DC-20/FC-100
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
323
MATERIAL HANDLING Hand Pallet Trucks Pallet Trucks with Digital Scale The Pallet Truck with Digital Scale allows you to weigh your load on the spot for maximum efficiency. The frame uses heavy-duty steel construction for maximum strength and durability. This model is very user friendly and is suitable for low height lifting. The built in scale allows you to weigh your load as you are handling it. The scale is selectable in a variety of increments to adjust to the size of your load. It has keyboard calibration and functional setup with automatic zero capabilities. Digital filtering is used to help compensate for vibration and motion to make the Scale Head Pallet Truck with Digital Scale smooth and accurate. Forks are 7" wide each. Factory calibrated shown with Printer for shipping destination. model PM-2748-SCL-LP-PT MODEL NUMBER
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
OVERALL FORK DIMENSIONS
5,000 5,000 5,000
22-3/8"W x 47-1/2"L 27-1/2"W x 47-1/2"L 27-1/2"W x 47-1/2"L
PM-2048-SCL-LP PM-2748-SCL-LP *PM-2748-SCL-LP-PT
FORK SERVICE RANGE
NET WT. (POUNDS)
3" to 7½" 3" to 7½" 3" to 7½"
338 371 378
* PALLET TRUCK WITH SCALE AND PRINTER
DC-25/FC-70/175
"Freight Saver" Pallet Trucks with Analog Scale A quick and economical way to weigh your pallets. This easy to read and operate push button scale has a +/- 6% weighing accuracy. Steel construction with a white gauge face and black weight indicator. To use simply load your pallet, raise forks completely, and push yellow lever with your foot to read weight. Weight must be evenly distributed across the fork width and length. A retrofit kit is available for field installation onto model PM5-2748 or PM5-2048 pallet trucks only. MODEL NUMBER
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
DESCRIPTION
OVERALL FORK DIMENSIONS
SERVICE RANGE
NET WT. (POUNDS)
PM-FS-2048 PALLET TRUCK W/ANALOG SCALE 5,000 20"W x 48"L 2-7/8" to 7-3/4" PM-FS-2748 PALLET TRUCK W/ANALOG SCALE 5,000 27"W x 48"L 2-7/8" to 7-3/4" PM-FS-RFK ANALOG SCALE GAUGE FIELD RETROFIT KIT. FIELD INSTALLABLE ONTO PALLET TRUCK MODELS PM5-2048 AND PM5-2748 ONLY
282 317 1 DC-25/FC-70/92.5/175
Ergonomic Power Assist Pallet Truck Anyone who has operated a fully loaded pallet truck knows the most strenuous part is starting the wheels rolling. This Pallet Truck solves this back breaking problem. Pumping the handle of the pallet truck serves two purposes; first, it serves the traditional purpose of lifting the forks, second, switch to the power drive accumulator and by pulling the handle back, the pallet truck begins to roll automatically thus reducing the pulling force. Each full stroke provides over 2 feet of power driving momentum. MODEL NUMBER
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
OVERALL FORK DIMENSIONS
FORK SERVICE RANGE
PM5-2748-PA
5,500
27"W x 48"L
2-7/8" to 7-3/4"
NET WT. (POUNDS)
300 DC-25/FC-70/175
Specialized Pallet Trucks (with nylon wheels) • Pallet Trucks for Corrosive and Sanitary Environments STAINLESS STEEL AND STAINLESS STEEL FRAME & FORKS Ideal for sanitary, pharmaceutical, medical, food and wet environments. Choose either type 304 stainless steel frame and forks only or 100% type 304 stainless steel pallet truck for long life in even the most harsh environments. Galvanized, Zinc and Chrome Plated Designed for corrosive or wet environments, these full-featured pallet trucks were designed for chemical, pharmaceutical and washdown applications. MODEL NUMBER
DESCRIPTION
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
OVERALL FORK DIMENSIONS
FORK SERVICE RANGE
NET WT. (POUNDS)
PM5-2048-SS PM5-2748-SS PM5-2748-SFF PM5-2748-S-G PM5-2748-S-Z PM5-2748-CP
STAINLESS STEEL STAINLESS STEEL STAINLESS FRAME & FORKS GALVANIZED ZINC COATED CHROME PLATED
5,500 5,500 5,500 5,500 5,500 5,500
20"W x 48"L 27"W x 48"L 27"W x 48"L 27"W x 48"L 27"W x 48"L 27"W x 48"L
2-7/8" to 7-3/4" 2-7/8" to 7-3/4" 2-7/8" to 7-3/4" 2-7/8" to 7-3/4" 2-7/8" to 7-3/4" 2-7/8" to 7-3/4"
300 327 327 327 322 322 DC-25/FC-70/92.5/175
324
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Hand Pallet Trucks
MATERIAL HANDLING
Pallet Truck All Terrain • Inside Straddle is 50" / Outside Straddle is 64" • Pneumatic Tires have Sealed Bearings for Outside Durability This lightweight yet strong tubular frame design handles evenly distributed loads up to 2,000 lbs. (2,000 lbs. at 12" horizontal load center and 1,500 lbs. at 15" horizontal load center). Large wheels allow for movement over most surfaces. Use at construction sites, gravel pits and nurseries. Features large 17" front pneumatic tires and 10" pneumatic steering wheels. Individual forks are 4"W x 2"H. Easy to operate with three position handle, UP, DOWN and NEUTRAL. Optional Tow Bar package allows the All Terrain Pallet Truck to be towed by an ATV or small utility tractor.
Adjustable Width Forks
MODEL NUMBER
CAPACITY* )POUNDS(
ALL-T-2 ALL-TTB
2,000
OVERALL FORK WIDTH
FORK LENGTH
SERVICE RANGE
"to 26 "½9 "32 "to 9 "3 OPTIONAL TOW BAR PACKAGE
OVERALL SIZE )W x L x H(
NET WT. (POUNDS)
"x 50" x 51 "64
410 62
lbs. at 12" horizontal load center and 1,500 lbs. at 15" horizontal load center 2,000*
DC-25/FC-70/175
Pallet Truck Big Wheel •Steering Wheels are 8" x 2" Poly-on-Steel • Load Rollers are 5½" x 2" • Does Not Work with Standard Pallets Use less pushing or pulling force when transporting large heavy loads across floors with the Big Wheel Pallet Truck. An alternative to fork trucks, this unit makes it easier to move loaded tubs weighing up to 4,500 pounds. The raised height of 16-1/8" and the lowered height 6-1/2" enables the pallet truck to service high bottom tubs. The Big Wheel Pallet Truck retains all of the quality workmanship of our other Pallet Master Pallet Trucks. MODEL NUMBER
BW-PJ
CAPACITY DESCRIPTION )POUNDS(
BIG WHEEL
4,500
OVERALL FORK )SIZE (W x L
SERVICE RANGE
26-3/4" x 51-1/2"
6-1/2" to 16-1/8"
NET WT. (POUNDS)
299 DC-25/FC-70/92.5/175
Pallet Truck Side Winder • Move Long Loads Down Narrow Aisles • Moves FORWARD, BACKWARD, LEFT, and RIGHT • Capacity is 3,000 lbs. Transport long loads down narrow aisles with this heavy duty Sidewinder Pallet Truck. This versatile Pallet Truck retains all the quality workmanship of a standard pallet truck in addition to providing lateral movement. Simply place the forks into the pallet then elevate to approximately seven inches, rotate handle and lock detent into place. The second set of rollers, right/left, are actuated. Now push the Side Winder perpendicular to the traditional direction. Nose Wheel
MODEL NUMBER
DESCRIPTION
SW-PJ
SIDE WINDER
CAPACITY OVERALL FORK )POUNDS( )SIZE (W x L
3,000
27" x 48"
SERVICE RANGE
3-1/2" to 8"
NET WT. (POUNDS)
311 DC-25/FC-70/92.5/175
Right/Left Wheels Forward/Back Wheel
Pallet Truck Wheel Nose • Take the Guess Work Out of Close Pallet Placement • Optimize Floor and Truck Space with this Innovative Pallet Truck The Wheel Nose Pallet Truck is designed to position pallets or skids closely together. The fork end is set back from the front rollers allowing for one pallet pick up at a time. The unit has a rubber grip handle with a three position lever for easy operation and maneuvering. This heavy-duty unit is rated at 5,000 pounds capacity and has a service range from 3½" to 8". Unit includes two articulating steering wheels and two front load rollers. Spring loaded loop handle automatically returns to vertical position when not in use. 38" forks are used for maneuvering in tight spaces.
MODEL NUMBER
DESCRIPTION
PM5-2038-WN WHEEL NOSE PM5-2738-WN WHEEL NOSE
CAPACITY OVERALL FORK )POUNDS( )SIZE (W x L
5,000 5,000
20" x 38" 27" x 38"
SERVICE RANGE
NET WT. (POUNDS)
3½" to 8" 3½" to 8"
260 280 DC-25/FC-70/92.5/175
Standard Pallet Truck Wheel Nose Pallet Truck
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
325
MATERIAL HANDLING Manual Turntables Turntables Heavy Duty Manual
A) TT-7/8
B) TT-4
Maximize workspace and minimize wasteful motion. Benchtop turntables allow workers to stay in one position and rotate items for access from all sides. No need to walk around the table to access areas out of view. Easy, smooth rotation. More than one person can work on projects without getting in each other's way. Use for hundreds of applications; displays, paint spraying, assembly units, repairs, etc. Rugged ½" steel plate construction. Easy, smooth rotation won't jostle delicate parts. The double tier units, suffix DPED and CDPED, feature a stationary shelf for storing parts and tools. Series PED and DPED feature a turn knob height adjustment operation while the CPED and CDPED feature a gas cylinder up and down mechanism (like found in office chairs).
MODEL NUMBER
TYPE
C) TT-PED
D) TT-DPED
A B A B A B C D E F A B C D E F A B C D
TT-8-7/8 TT-8-4 TT-12-7/8 TT-12-4 TT-18-7/8 TT-18-4 TT-18-PED TT-18-DPED TT-18-CPED TT-18-CDPED TT-24-7/8 TT-24-4 TT-24-PED TT-24-DPED TT-24-CPED TT-24-CDPED TT-30-7/8 TT-30-4 TT-30-PED TT-30-DPED
DIAMETER
HEIGHT RANGE
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
NET WT. (POUNDS)
8" 8" 12" 12" 18" 18" 18" 18" 18" 18" 24" 24" 24" 24" 24" 24" 30" 30" 30" 30"
7/8" 4" 7/8" 4" 7/8" 4" 21" TO 32" 25" TO 36" 20" TO 30" 24" TO 34" 7/8" 4" 21" TO 32" 25" TO 36" 20" TO 30" 24" TO 34" 7/8" 4" 21" TO 32" 25" TO 36"
500 500 500 500 1,000 500 300 300 300 300 1,000 500 300 300 300 300 1,000 500 300 300
4 6 11 13 35 40 60 95 50 85 75 90 95 170 90 165 123 150 160 280 DC-25/UPS/FC-60
E) TT-CPED
F) TT-CDPED
Turntables Powered Keep tedious material handling at your fingertips. Easy, smooth clockwise rotation for hundreds of applications. Rotation speed is non-adjustable. These Powered Turntables are wired to 115V, 1 phase. An on/off selector switch incorporated in a 3 foot cord provides power to the unit. A foot control is available. A side skirt to protect items from getting into the rotating mechanism is standard. Rotation is clockwise. MODEL NUMBER
DIAMETER
HEIGHT
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
.R.P.M
NET WT. (POUNDS)
PT-100 PT-250 PT-750
12" 18" 18"
4-1/2" 5-1/2" 6-3/8"
100 250 750
3-1/2 3 2
114 132 156 DC-20/UPS/FC-60
FOOT CONTROL, MODEL PT-FC OPTIONAL 1 OR 2 R.P.M., model PT-1/2RPM COUNTER-CLOCKWISE ROTATION, model PT-CCW
Turntables with Powered Height Adjustment • Allows operator to raise or lower turntable to an ergonomic height • Each unit has a 360° manual turntable • AC power, 110V, 1 Phase with hand control for height adjustment • Height is adjusted with an electric linear-actuator MODEL NUMBER
TT-18-LA TT-24-LA TT-30-LA
DIAMETER
HEIGHT RANGE
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
NET WT. (POUNDS)
18" 24" 30"
27" TO 43" 27" TO 43" 27" TO 43"
750 750 750
232 267 295 DC-20/FC-60
326
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Stretch Wrappers
MATERIAL HANDLING
Hand Held Stretch Wrappers These hand held, lightweight, freewheeling dispensers maintain precision tension control assuring a tight, smooth application. Ergonomic design reduces both bending and fatigue. Now even the bottom row can be wrapped as tightly as the top with help from its ergonomic foam bent handle. Accommodates rolls up to 8" in diameter. The compact Stretch Wrap Knife is small enough to fit in your pocket. Specially angled cutting head easily slices through stretch wrap material without sticking or binding. Safety design will not cut user or products. Made of high-density plastic. Replacement blades available. MODEL NUMBER
DESCRIPTION
ROLL WIDTH
CORE SIZE
NET WT. (POUNDS)
SW-HAND-R SW-HAND-BG
ROUND STYLE ERGO STYLE
12" TO 20" 12" TO 20"
2" & 3" 1/2", 2" & 3"
6 6
MODEL NUMBER
SW-KNIFE SW-RB SRF-18
SW-HAND-BG
.NET WT )POUNDS(
DESCRIPTION
STRETCH WRAP FILM KNIFE REPLACEMENT BLADES (BOX OF 100 BLADES) FILM FOR HAND HELD WRAPPER 18" WIDE x 1,500 FEET (80 gauge) 4 ROLLS PER CASE
SW-HAND-R
1 6 46 DC-20/UPS
SW-KNIFE
Powered Carousel Low-Profile The Low-Profile Powered Carousel features a heavy duty steel non-skid treadplate platform 48" in diameter. This unit handles loads up to 4,000 lbs. Standing only 2-3/8" tall, this system is easily accessible with a fork truck; optional approach ramp is required for pallet truck use. Foot control operation with a variable speed control, cushion start/stop, and rugged ¾ HP motor with chain drive standard. Wall plug standard 115V/single phase/20 amp. Optional approach ramp measures 48" wide by 36" long. Manual Air Bearing Carousel is also available, contact factory.
model POW-CAR
APPROACH RAMP model SWA-R-4836
MODEL NUMBER
DESCRIPTION
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
.R.P.M
NET WT. (POUNDS)
POW-CAR SWA-R-4836
115V AC POWER APPROACH RAMP
4,000 4,000
3-12 --
569 253
REVERSE OPTION, MODEL SWA-REV
DC-20/FC-60
Powered Carousel Stand Alone Easily rotate pallets, skids and other large objects with these rugged powered carousels. Each unit includes a 48" diameter round smooth turntable. Turntable is supported with inverted casters for use as bearings. Units are complete with turntable, base, 115V single-phase power unit and variable-speed control (electric/hydraulic unit has fixed speed control). Turntable is operated with a foot control. Heavy-duty steel construction. Painted finish. model STPC-CD MODEL NUMBER
STPC-CD STPC-EHD
DESCRIPTION
115V AC (CHAIN DRIVEN) 115V AC (ELECTRIC HYDRAULIC DRIVEN)
.R.P.M
HEIGHT
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
3-12 8
24" 12"
4,000 4,000
NET WT. (LBS.)
788 788 DC-20/FC-60
Pallet Cart & Carousel This unique cart serves as two products in one. First, use cart to transport products to where they are needed. Then, once at desired location, a simple flip of a switch on the casters will allow the cart to manually rotate 360° like a carousel for easy unloading and improved efficiency. The cart features a 48" diameter round platform with a ¼" thick treadplate deck. The handle is removable to allow for full deck access from any position. Includes four swivel 8" x 2" phenolic casters with swivel locks. Steel construction. MODEL NUMBER
DIAMETER
PLATFORM HEIGHT
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
CASTER TYPE
NET WT. (LBS.)
CC-48
48"
10"
2,000
8" PHENOLIC
336
DC-25/FC-70
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
327
MATERIAL HANDLING Scales Electronic Digital Floor Scale Low-profile scale is only 3-1/2" off the floor, allowing easy loading and unloading of heavy equipment weighing up to 5,000 lbs. Rugged design has a steel diamond treadplate top surface. The LCD digital display stands 42" high. Meets US standard 99-054 and Canadian standard AM-5318. Optional Approach Ramp for pallet truck accessibility - order two for drive-on, drive-off convenience. MODEL NUMBER
DESCRIPTION
OVERALL WIDTH
OVERALL LENGTH
OVERALL HEIGHT
NET WT. (POUNDS)
SCALE-S SCALE-R
SCALE APPROACH RAMP
48" 48"
48" 48"
3½" 3½"
355 120
DC-20/FC-70
Parts Scales - Mettler Toledo™ Highly accurate, user friendly scales. These scales capture a stable weight reading in less than one second. Features a rugged aluminum housing, stainless steel weighing pan and a simple keyboard. Switches between lbs. and kgs. Operates on 120V AC.
series V-PL
MODEL NUMBER
V-PL-3 V-PL-6 V-PL-12 V-SL-12 V-SL-30 V-SL-60 series V-SL
PLATFORM SIZE
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
RESOLUTION )POUNDS(
NET WT. (POUNDS)
7.9" x 9.5" 7.9" x 9.5" 7.9" x 9.5" 9.5" x 13.8" 9.5" x 13.8" 9.5" x 13.8"
7.5 12 24 24 75 120
0.0005 0.001 0.002 0.002 0.005 0.01
13 13 13 21 21 21
DC-20/FC-70
Pallet Trucks with Digital Scale
Scale Head shown with Printer model PM-2748-SCL-LP-PT
The Pallet Truck with Digital Scale allows you to weigh your load on the spot for maximum efficiency. The frame uses heavy-duty steel construction for maximum strength and durability. This model is very user friendly and is suitable for low height lifting. The built in scale allows you to weigh your load as you are handling it. The scale is selectable in a variety of increments to adjust to the size of your load. It has keyboard calibration and functional setup with automatic zero capabilities. Digital filtering is used to help compensate for vibration and motion to make the Pallet Truck with Digital Scale smooth and accurate. Forks are 7" wide each. Factory calibrated for shipping destination. MODEL NUMBER
PM-2048-SCL-LP PM-2748-SCL-LP *PM-2748-SCL-LP-PT
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
OVERALL FORK DIMENSIONS
5,000 5,000 5,000
22-3/8"W x 47-1/2"L 27-1/2"W x 47-1/2"L 27-1/2"W x 47-1/2"L
FORK SERVICE RANGE
3" to 7½" 3" to 7½" 3" to 7½"
NET WT. (POUNDS)
338 371 378 DC-25/ FC-70/175
* PALLET TRUCK WITH SCALE AND PRINTER
Multi-Station Transportable Jib Cranes Designed for use in multiple locations, includes jib crane and one base socket. Extra base sockets may be purchased for use in other locations. Friction brake design allows positive locking and controlled rotation of heavy loads. 360° continuous rotation of heavy loads. Handle most applications up to 1,000 lbs. and up to 120" radius reach. Standard 4" high I-beam on all units with 2.663" flange width. Rugged welded steel construction. Hoist and trolley sold separately, see pages 84-85 for details. MODEL NUMBER
JIB-P-10-6-6 JIB-P-10-6-8 JIB-P-10-6-10 JIB-P-10-8-6 JIB-P-10-8-8 JIB-P-10-8-10 JIB-P-10-10-6 JIB-P-10-10-8 JIB-P-10-10-10 JIB-P-B
328
SPAN )FEET(
USABLE HEIGHT )(FEET
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
6 6 1,000 6 8 1,000 6 10 1,000 8 6 1,000 8 8 1,000 8 10 1,000 10 6 1,000 10 8 1,000 10 10 1,000 EXTRA BASE SOCKET, 31"H WITH 12" x 12" BASE
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
NET WT. (POUNDS)
284 304 324 300 320 340 316 336 356 75
DC-20/FC-70
Cranes
MATERIAL HANDLING
Fixed and Adjustable Steel Gantry Cranes Industrial Steel Gantry Cranes are designed for transporting and positioning materials. Solid steel construction will provide years of service. Choose from a variety of sizes. Large 8" diameter 4 position locking swivel phenolic casters with roller bearings will facilitate easy mobility from one area to another. More economical and flexible than permanent cranes. Features quick setup design. Order optional Lever Ratchet for easy one-person height adjustment (not for fixed-height models). Height is adjustable in 6" increments on adjustable-height models. Blue finish. Hoist and trolley sold separately, see pages 84-85. Note: All products should be inspected frequently to insure safe operation. Final testing and inspection is left to end user after final assembly has been completed. For further details see ASME B30.7.
ADJUSTABLE HEIGHT GANTRY CRANE • series AHS
FIXED HEIGHT STEEL GANTRY CRANES MODEL NUMBER
FHS-50
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
OVERALL BEAM LENGTH / HEIGHT
UNDER I-BEAM TO GROUND
BASE WIDTH
FLANGE WIDTH
NET WT. (POUNDS)
500
8' / 4"
5'9"
48"
2.66"
530
FHS-2-10 FHS-2-15 FHS-2-20
2,000 2,000 2,000
10' / 5" 15' / 6" 20' / 8"
10' 10' 10'
60" 60" 60"
3" 3.33" 4"
655 710 890
FHS-4-10 FHS-4-15 FHS-4-20
4,000 4,000 4,000
10' / 8" 15' / 8" 20' / 10"
10' 10' 10'
60" 60" 60"
4" 4" 4.66"
815 903 1142
ADJUSTABLE HEIGHT STEEL GANTRY CRANES MODEL NUMBER
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
OVERALL BEAM LENGTH / HEIGHT
UNDER I-BEAM USABLE HEIGHT
BASE WIDTH
FLANGE WIDTH
NET WT. (POUNDS)
AHS-2-10-12 AHS-2-10-14
2,000 2,000
10' / 5" 10' / 5"
7'6" to 12' 8'6" to 14'
78" 90"
3" 3"
890 996
AHS-2-15-12 AHS-2-15-14
2,000 2,000
15' / 6" 15' / 6"
7'6" to 12' 8'6" to 14'
78" 90"
3.33" 3.33"
978 1084
AHS-2-20-12 AHS-2-20-14
2,000 2,000
20' / 8" 20' / 8"
7'6" to 12' 8'6" to 14'
78" 90"
4" 4"
1066 1172
AHS-4-10-12 AHS-4-10-14
4,000 4,000
10' / 8" 10' / 8"
7'6" to 12' 8'6" to 14'
78" 90"
4" 4"
967 1071
AHS-4-15-12 AHS-4-15-14
4,000 4,000
15' / 8" 15' / 8"
7'6" to 12' 8'6" to 14'
78" 90"
4" 4"
1059 1264
AHS-4-20-12 AHS-4-20-14
4,000 4,000
20' / 10" 20' / 10"
7'6" to 12' 8'6" to 14'
78" 90"
4.66" 4.66"
1291 1395
AHS-6-10-12 AHS-6-10-14
6,000 6,000
10' / 8" 10' / 8"
7'7" to 12'1" 8'6" to 14'
78" 90"
4" 4"
998 1101
AHS-6-15-12 AHS-6-15-14
6,000 6,000
15' / 10" 15' / 10"
7'7" to 12'1" 8'6" to 14'
78" 90"
4.66" 4.66"
1195 1298
AHS-6-20-12 AHS-6-20-14
6,000 6,000
20' / 10" 20' / 10"
7'7" to 12'1" 8'6" to 14'
78" 90"
4.66" 4.66"
1322 1425
AHS-8-10-12 AHS-8-10-14
8,000 8,000
10' / 10" 10' / 10"
7'7" to 12'1" 8'6" to 14'
78" 90"
4.66" 4.66"
1103 1206
AHS-8-15-12 AHS-8-15-14
8,000 8,000
15' / 10" 15' / 10"
7'7" to 12'1" 8'6" to 14'
78" 90"
4.66" 4.66"
1230 1333
AHS-8-20-12 AHS-8-20-14
8,000 8,000
20' / 12" 20' / 12"
7'7" to 12'1" 8'6" to 14'
78" 90"
5" 5"
1485 1588
"USABLE DISTANCE BETWEEN UPRIGHTS IS OVERALL BEAM LENGTH MINUS 12 "USABLE TROLLEY TRAVEL LENGTH IS OVERALL BEAM LENGTH MINUS 20
AHS-2/4-TLC AHS-6/8-TLC **AHS-2/4-V **AHS-6/8-V AHS-KIT
FESTOON SYSTEM model AHS-FES-KIT
TOTAL LOCKING CASTERS model AHS-2/4-TLC (FOR 2,000 AND 4,000 LB. CAPACITY CRANES ONLY)
model AHS-6/8-TLC (FOR 6,000 AND 8,000 LB. CAPACITY CRANES ONLY)
DC-20/FC-70
STEEL GANTRY CRANE OPTIONS MODEL NUMBER
FIXED HEIGHT STEEL GANTRY CRANE series FHS
DESCRIPTION
TOTAL LOCKING CASTERS (FOR 2,000 & 4,000 LBS. CAPACITY CRANES ONLY) (SET OF 4) TOTAL LOCKING CASTERS (FOR 6,000 LB. & 8,000 LBS. CAPACITY CRANES ONLY) (SET OF 4) 8" x 2" V-GROOVE CASTERS FOR 2,000 & 4,000 LBS. UNITS (SET OF 4) 8" x 3" V-GROOVE CASTERS FOR 6,000 & 8,000 LBS. UNITS (SET OF 4) (2) COME-A-LONGS FOR HEIGHT ADJUSTMENT (NOT FOR LIFTING)
V-GROOVE CASTERS model AHS-2/4-V FOR 2,000 AND 4,000 LB.( )CAPACITY CRANES ONLY
model AHS-6/8-V
FOR 6,000 AND 8,000 LB.( )CAPACITY CRANES ONLY
4-POSITION V-GROOVE CASTERS AVAILABLE UPON REQUEST**
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
329
MATERIAL HANDLING Cranes Adjustable Height Aluminum Gantry Cranes The Adjustable Height Aluminum Gantry Crane combines lightweight and rigid construction into one unit. The all aluminum construction of this gantry crane makes it corrosion resistant and perfect for outdoor use. The lightweight I-beam allows height adjustment without the need of a hoist or fork truck. All pinned connections make it possible for two people to set up. Height is adjustable in 6" increments. Hoist and trolley sold separately. Note: All products should be inspected frequently to insure safe operation. Final testing and inspection is left to end user after final assembly has been completed. For further details see ASME B30.7.
FESTOON SYSTEM model AHA-FES-KIT
ADJUSTABLE SPAN
PNEUMATIC CASTERS model AHA-PNU
"V" GROOVE model AHA-2/4-V
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
OVERALL BEAM LENGTH / HEIGHT
UNDER I-BEAM RANGE
BASE WIDTH
FLANGE WIDTH
NET WT. (POUNDS)
AHA-2-8-10 AHA-2-8-12
2,000 2,000
8' / 6" 8' / 6"
7'8" to 10'2" 9'6" to 12'
54" 54"
3.75" 3.75"
280 295
AHA-2-10-10 AHA-2-10-12
2,000 2,000
10' / 6" 10' / 6"
7'8" to 10'2" 9'6" to 12'
54" 54"
3.75" 3.75"
294 310
AHA-2-12-10 AHA-2-12-12
2,000 2,000
12' / 8" 12' / 8"
7'8" to 10'2" 9'6" to 12'
54" 54"
4" 4"
325 340
AHA-4-8-10 AHA-4-8-12
4,000 4,000
8' / 8" 8' / 8"
7'8" to 10'2" 9'6" to 12'
54" 54"
4" 4"
360 375
AHA-4-10-10 AHA-4-10-12
4,000 4,000
10' / 8" 10' / 8"
7'8" to 10'2" 9'6" to 12'
54" 54"
4" 4"
405 431
AHA-4-12-10 AHA-4-12-12
4,000 4,000
12' / 8" 12' / 8"
7'8" to 10'2" 9'6" to 12'
54" 54"
4.125" 4.125"
421 446
MODEL NUMBER
ADJUSTABLE HEIGHT
TOTAL LOCKING model AHA-2/4-TLC
"USABLE DISTANCE BETWEEN UPRIGHTS IS OVERALL BEAM LENGTH MINUS 12 "USABLE TROLLEY TRAVEL LENGTH IS OVERALL BEAM LENGTH MINUS 20
DC-20/FC-70
ALUMINUM GANTRY CRANE OPTIONS MODEL NUMBER
STANDARD 4-POSITION PHENOLIC SWIVEL "8 CASTER
DESCRIPTION
AHA-2/4-TLC AHA-PNU AHA-PNU-RF AHA-2/4-V AHA-2/4-V4 AHA-KIT
TOTAL LOCKING CASTERS (FOR 2,000 & 4,000 LBS. CAPACITY CRANES ONLY) (SET OF 4 )FOUR-WAY LOCK 12" x 3½" PNEUMATIC CASTERS (1,500 LBS. CAPACITY )RETROFIT FOUR-WAY LOCK PNEUMATIC CASTERS (1,500 LBS. CAPACITY )8" x 2" V-GROOVE WHEELS (FOR 2,000 & 4,000 LBS. UNITS) (SET OF 4 )8" x 2" V-GROOVE WHEELS (FOR 2,000 & 4,000 LBS. UNITS) (W/4-POSITION LOCK) (SET OF 4 )(2) COME-A-LONG FOR HEIGHT ADJUSTMENT (NOT FOR LIFTING )
AHA-FES-KIT
FESTOON KIT, 115V AC POWER
Festoon System Designed to keep power cords out of danger when using electric trollies and/or hoists. Easily retrofits to any gantry or jib crane up to 240" (20 ft.) in length. 115V AC cord supplied. MODEL NUMBER
DESCRIPTION
NET WT. (POUNDS)
FES-KIT
KEEP POWER CORDS OUT OF DANGER
15 DC-20/FC-70
Work Area Gantry Cranes Portable Designed to maximize material handling requirements in light-duty lifting applications. Lightweight fixed height design allows for easy mobility. Includes four polyurethane-on-steel swivel casters. Welded steel construction. The straddle width and base width is 68". Powder coat finish. Hoist and trolley not included. MODEL NUMBER
FPG-3 FPG-6 FPG-10 FPG-20
UNDER I-BEAM TO GROUND
BASE WIDTH
STRADDLE )WIDTH (ID
I-BEAM )FLANGE x HEIGHT(
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
NET WT. (POUNDS)
90" 90" 90" 90"
68" 68" 68" 68"
68" 68" 68" 68"
2.66" x 4" 2.66" x 4" 2.66" x 4" 2.66" x 4"
300 600 1,000 2,000
288 300 329 340 DC-20/FC-70
330
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Jibs
MATERIAL HANDLING
Mini Overhead Cantilever Jibs Utilize this unique jib in work cells and work areas. Unique fixed-height design allows for outriggers to be mounted underneath a work bench. Easily lift product from cart to workbench. Straddle width is 48" (ID). Hoist and trolley are not included. Steel construction. MODEL NUMBER
CJIB-3 CJIB-6 CJIB-10 CJIB-20
UNDER I-BEAM TO GROUND
I-BEAM USABLE LENGTH
I-BEAM )FLANGE x HEIGHT(
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
NET WT. (POUNDS)
84" 84" 78½" 78½"
54" 54" 54" 54"
2.66" x 4" 2.66" x 4" 3.33" x 6" 3.33" x 6"
300 600 1,000 2,000
204 216 299 414
DC-20/FC-70
Extra Travel Tri-Post Jibs This unique jib was designed for use in workstations. Place over the top workbench. Extra travel fixed-height I-beam overhangs workbench to allow lifting of products from cart to bench. Straddle width is 40" (ID). Hoist, trolley and cart not included. Will not work with the Eye Manual Trollies. Steel construction. MODEL NUMBER
UNDER I-BEAM TO GROUND
TJIB-3 TJIB-6 TJIB-10 TJIB-20
I-BEAM USABLE I-BEAM CAPACITY LENGTH )FLANGE x HEIGHT( )POUNDS(
76" 76" 76" 76"
80" 80" 80" 80"
2.66" x 4" 2.66" x 4" 2.66" x 4" 2.66" x 4"
300 600 1,000 2,000
Floor Mounted Jibs
NET WT. (POUNDS)
248 260 343 458
DC-20/FC-70
This fixed height floor mounted jib adapts well to many applications. Full 360° rotation allows personnel to completely utilize their workstation. Solid steel construction will assist workers in lifting awkward material. The overall I-beam length is 80" with a usable length of 70". Requires reinforced concrete pad for installation. Hoist and trolley not included. MODEL NUMBER
JIB-FM-3 JIB-FM-6 JIB-FM-10 JIB-FM-20
UNDER II-BEAM BEAM FLOOR )FLANGE x HEIGHT(
OVERALL HEIGHT
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
NET WT. (POUNDS)
99-1/2" 99-1/2" 99-1/2"
2.660" x 4" 3.332" x 6" 3.332" x 6"
103½" 105½" 105½"
300 600 1,000
627 542 750
"99-1/2
"x 8 "4.000
"½107
2,000
624 DC-20/FC-70
Wall Jibs (for low ceilings) Designed to assist workers in the maneuvering of materials as well as achieving maximum headroom where low ceilings are of concern. This cantilever style jib crane mounts to true vertical wall members. Increase personnel productivity by lifting awkward materials. The overall I-beam length is 92" with a usable length of 80". Hoist and trolley not included. MODEL NUMBER
UNDER I-BEAM TO BOTTOM FRAME
I-BEAM )FLANGE x HEIGHT(
OVERALL HEIGHT
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
NET WT. (POUNDS)
JIB-LC-3 JIB-LC-6 JIB-LC-10 JIB-LC-20
48" 48" 48" 48"
2.660" x 4" 3.332" x 6" 3.332" x 6" 4.000" x 8"
57" 57" 57" 57"
300 600 1,000 2,000
164 215 265 378
DC-20/FC-70
Tie Rod Jibs (for high ceilings) Achieve maximum floor space and utilize wasted air space. Mount to walls or columns to increase hook coverage over workstations. Unit rotates 180°. All steel construction provides years of service. Hoist and trolley not included. MODEL NUMBER
OVERALL LENGTH
CABLE SUPPORT LENGTH
OVERALL HEIGHT
I-BEAM )FLANGE x HEIGHT(
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
NET WT. (POUNDS)
JIB-HC-3 JIB-HC-6 JIB-HC-10 JIB-HC-20
89" 89" 89"
85" 85" 85"
43" 43" 43"
2.66" x 4" 2.66" x 4" 2.66" x 4"
300 600 1,000
144 180 204
”89
"85
"43
"x 4 "2.66
2,000
216 DC-20/FC-70
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
331
MATERIAL HANDLING Hoists Quick Install Manual Trollies These trollies are dependable, easy and safe to use. Designed to easily adjust to the width of virtually any S, H, W and M type I-beam. Width is adjusted with manual screw mechanism. Includes locking ring to prevent trolley width from changing accidentally. Manual screw mechanism may also be tightened to prevent trolley from moving (similar to a Beam Clamp). Each trolley includes four rollers with sealed bearings for long life. A lifting eye is located at the bottom of the trolley for attaching a hoist (not included). Steel construction and painted finish. MODEL NUMBER
FITS BEAM FLANGE WIDTH
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
NET WT. (LBS)
QIT-1 QIT-2 QIT-4 QIT-6 QIT-8
2½" - 4" 2½" - 4" 2½" - 7" 3" - 7½" 3¼" - 11½"
1,000 2,000 4,000 6,000 8,000
15 20 25 45 70 DC-25/UPS/FC-70
Eye Manual Trollies
PLAIN EYE MANUAL TROLLEY model E-MT-1
GEARED EYE MANUAL TROLLEY model E-MT-1-C
These trollies have been designed to quickly install on virtually any S type I-beam. The width of the trolley is adjusted by rotating the center rod with lifting eye clockwise or counterclockwise. Once hoist (not included) is attached, center rod cannot be rotated which prevents trolley width from accidentally changing. Choose either plain trolley or geared trolley. Geared trolley is ideal for use when precise positioning of the trolley is required. The trolley includes four rollers with sealed bearings for long life. A lifting eye is located at the bottom of the trolley for attaching a hoist (not included). Steel construction and painted finish. MODEL NUMBER
DESCRIPTION
I-BEAM FLANGE
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
NET WT. (LBS)
E-MT-1 E-MT-2 E-MT-4 E-MT-6 E-MT-8 E-MT-1-C E-MT-2-C E-MT-4-C E-MT-6-C E-MT-8-C
PLAIN PLAIN PLAIN PLAIN PLAIN GEARED GEARED GEARED GEARED GEARED
2" - 7" 2" - 7" 2½" - 7" 3" - 9" 3" - 9" 1¾" - 8¾" 2½" - 8¾" 2½" - 7" 3" - 7" 3" - 7"
1,000 2,000 4,000 6,000 8,000 1,000 2,000 4,000 6,000 8,000
20 25 35 60 105 25 30 45 70 100
DC-25/UPS/FC-85
Electric Chain Hoists Ruggedly built with power to handle most industrial lifting applications. Standard with push-button hand control with up and down controls. Single and three phase power available - specify when ordering. Optional Chain Container stores surplus chain overhead to keep from interfering with operation. MODEL NUMBER
ECH-03 ECH-06 ECH-10 ECH-20 ECH-40 ECH-CC
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
300 600 1,000 2,000 4,000
FEET PER MINUTE
16 8 30 16 14 CHAIN CONTAINER
LIFT )FEET(
NET WT. (LBS.)
10 10 10 10 10
26 32 86 90 150 5 DC-20/FC-85
Air Chain Hoists
Heavy duty air chain hoist can be used as a workstation hoist or as a production line hoist. Lightweight, rugged and compact design - for ease of portability - makes this hoist perfect for most air hoist lifting applications. Standard lift is 10 feet assuming 90 PSI air pressure. Variable flow, two lever pendant for precise load spotting.
series ECH Shown with optional chain container
series ACH Shown with optional chain container
MODEL NUMBER
ACH-25 ACH-50 ACH-CC
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
250 500
.F.P.M RISE W/ LOAD
.F.P.M LOWER W/LOAD
42 48 29 53 CHAIN CONTAINER
FULL LOAD LOWERING SPEED
83 42
NET WT. (LBS)
19 19 2 DC-20/FC-85
332
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
MATERIAL HANDLING
Hoists
Hand Chain Hoists These portable, lightweight hoists are durable and easy to operate. Compact design and low headroom allow installation in confined areas. Enclosed double ratchet pawls with self adjusting disc brake standard. Designed with a safety factory 4 times rated capacity. Individually tested at 150% rated capacity. Features grade 80 black chain tempered to ISO 3077, galvanized pull chain, hardened two-stage gears and forged steel upper and lower hooks with safety latches. Constructed of high quality steel components ideal for industrial applications. Meets ANSI B30.16-2003 requirements. MODEL NUMBER
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
LIFT )FEET(
HEADROOM )INCHES(
NET WT. (POUNDS)
HCH-1-10 HCH-1-15 HCH-1-20 HCH-2-10 HCH-2-15 HCH-2-20 HCH-4-10 HCH-4-15 HCH-4-20
1,000 1,000 1,000 2,000 2,000 2,000 4,000 4,000 4,000
10 15 20 10 15 20 10 15 20
11 11 11 12 12 12 14½ 14½ 14½
22 26 30 26 34 42 45 54 63
YEAR 1 WARRANTY
HAND CHAIN HOIST series HCH
DC-25/UPS/FC-85
Professional Lever Hoists (disc brake)
Each unit comes standard with a rugged storage bag. Additional bags are available, model BAG-12
5 YEAR WARRANTY
PROFESSIONAL LEVER HOIST series PLH
• 50% wider hardened ratchet gear • Grade 100 alloy chain for more strength with less weight • Chain guide system allows for horizontal operation • High impact resistant gear case and brake cover • Precision Bearings
• Disc Brake • Braking capacity is 4 times rated capacity • Manufactured to ISO-9002 quality standard • Triple chain guide for consistent up and down FREE WHEELING with one hand
MODEL NUMBER
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
STANDARD )LIFT (FEET
MINIMUM DISTANCE BETWEEN HOOKS
HANDLE LENGTH
NET WT. (POUNDS)
PLH-15-5 PLH-15-10 PLH-15-20 PLH-30-5 PLH-30-10 PLH-30-20 PLH-60-5 PLH-60-10 PLH-60-20
1,500 1,500 1,500 3,000 3,000 3,000 6,000 6,000 6,000
5 10 20 5 10 20 5 10 20
11" 11" 11" 15-1/2" 15-1/2" 15-1/2" 22-7/16" 22-7/16" 22-7/16"
11" 11" 11" 16" 16" 16" 16" 16" 16"
15 18 22 23 27 35 35 42 49
ADDITIONAL 12 POCKET TOOL STORAGE BAG, model BAG-12
DC-25/UPS/FC-85
Economy Lever Hoists (weston brake) • Completely enclosed Weston-Type brake • Deformation indicators on throat opening of both hooks • Drop forged hooks have durable latches and swivel 360 degrees • Written test certificate for 150% of rated capacity with individual serial numbers.
MODEL NUMBER
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
STANDARD )LIFT (FEET
ELH-05-5 ELH-15-5 ELH-15-10 ELH-15-20 ELH-30-5 ELH-30-10 ELH-30-20 ELH-60-5 ELH-60-10 ELH-60-20
500 1,500 1,500 1,500 3,000 3,000 3,000 6,000 6,000 6,000
5 5 10 20 5 10 20 5 10 20
• Free wheeling chain in neutral position to quickly take up chain slack • Alloy steel chain grade 80
YEAR 1 WARRANTY
MINIMUM DISTANCE BETWEEN HOOKS
ADDITIONAL 12 POCKET TOOL STORAGE BAG, model BAG-12
9.45" 12.8" 12.8" 12.8" 15.0" 15.0" 15.0" 19.0" 19.0" 19.0"
MIGHTLY-MINI LEVER HOIST model ELH-05-5
HANDLE LENGTH
NET WT. (POUNDS)
6" 11" 11" 11" 16" 16" 16" 16" 16" 16"
5 18 21 25 30 35 45 52 59 72 DC-25/UPS/FC-85
Each unit comes standard ECONOMY LEVER HOIST with a rugged storage series ELH bag. Additional bags are available, model BAG-12
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
333
MATERIAL HANDLING Hoists Portable Cantilever Hoists • Swivel Crane for Side Loading • Outriggers to Increase Stability • Double Acting Manual Hydraulic Hand Pump • Controlled Lowering • Adjustable Swing Outriggers with Leveling Jacks to Stabilize Unit to Front or Side • Expedited & Increased Cable Down Reach • Provided With or Without Counterbalancing Ballast • When Ordering Without Ballast, Empty Sand Bags are Provided CAPACITY AT ARM LENGTH
MODEL P-JIB-2 )POUNDS(
MODEL P-JIB-4 )POUNDS(
27" 34" 41" 48"
2,000 1,600 1,300 1,100
4,000 3,200 2,600 2,200
Double-Acting Hand Pump
:Lift Arm Projections "Beyond Frame: 48 "Ouriggers: 40 Casters: 8" Phenolic
Leveling Jack MODEL NUMBER
OVERALL SIZE )W x L x H(
ARM LENGTH BEYOND FRAME
MAXIMUM CAPACITY
PHENOLIC CASTERS
NET WT. (LBS.)
P-JIB-2 P-JIB-4
34" x 84" x 63" 34" x 84" x 63"
48" 48"
2,000 lbs. 4,000 lbs.
8" x 2" 8" x 2"
850 1050
OPTIONAL BALLAST, MODEL P-JIB-BALL, NET WEIGHT 1,850 LBS.
Outrigger
DC-20/UPS/FC-125
Lifter Jibs Lift items from the ground to van floor height, then rotate into cargo area. Hand crank winch is standard, battery powered winch is optional. Battery powered winch includes 36" long leads - battery not included. Van floor to raised hook height is 38". Double-pivot arm for use in tight spaces. Swing reaches 22" minimum to 42" maximum. Overall height is 46". Mounting plate measures 8" x 8". Steel construction. Painted finish. MODEL NUMBER
SWING REACH )MINIMUM(
VAN-J VAN-J*DC BC
SWING REACH )MAXIMUM(
OVERALL HEIGHT
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
22"
42"
46"
400
120
22"
42"
55"
400
160
BENCH TOP STYLE BATTERY CHARGER
*VAN-J-DC INCLUDES BATTERY-POWERED WINCH
Hoist Trailer
NET WT. (LBS.)
8 DC-20/FC-70
Unique hoist may be towed behind a car or truck to job site and then used for hundreds of applications. Includes a class 2 ball coupler and safety chains for use with most common hitches. Features (2) large 18" diameter pneumatic wheels, (2) swivel casters 4" x 2" in rear, (2) rigid 5" x 2" in front and one swivel clevis hook with safety latch at the end of the boom. Telescoping lift arm and legs and a removable jack handle standard. Welded steel construction with painted finish. MODEL NUMBER
UP/DOWN STROKE
ARM LENGTH
OVERALL SIZE )W x L(
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
H-TRAIL H-LK
30" to 91" 53½" to 77½" 47½" x 72" 4,000 OPTIONAL BRAKE LIGHT KIT WITH WIRING HARNESS
NET WT. (LBS.)
465 15 DC-20/FC-125
Counter Balanced Floor Cranes This Counter Balanced Floor Crane has an adjustable boom to allow for maximum adjustment and versatility to lift a variety of loads. Boom is raised with a manual hydraulic hand pump. Boom also telescopes out for greater reach. The counterbalance design eliminates the need for front legs. This makes the unit easier to maneuver and allows the crane to reach tight, hard to reach areas. Counterbalance included. Welded steel construction. MODEL NUMBER
CBFC-500 CBFC-1000 CBFC-2000
MAXIMUM CAPACITY AT BOOM HEIGHT
500 lbs. @ 24"-86" 1,000 lbs. @ 24"-90" 2,000 lbs. @ 34"-96"
RIGID LOAD WHEEL
8" 8" 8"
SWIVEL REAR CASTER
6" 6" 6"
NET WT. (LBS.)
1089 1508 2610 DC-20/FC-125
334
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Lifting Booms
MATERIAL HANDLING Lift Master Booms
Unique performance, convenience and safety features are built into every Lift Master Boom. Fabricated from structural steel with welding to meet AWS creates a rugged and durable boom that will provide long term service. ECONOMY BOOM Telescopic units extend to 144" and come with an infinitely model LM-EBT adjustable locking screw (exception LM-OBT which features a spring loaded detent). Fork pockets for 4,000 lbs. capacity models measure 7½"W x 2½"H usable on 24" centers. Usable fork pockets are 7¼"W x 2¼"H for 6,000 and 8,000 lbs. capacity option. A 36" safety chain secures LIFT MASTER BOOM the boom to the fork truck for safe operation. Each unit includes two lifting hooks. model LM-1T
ORBITING BOOM model LM-OBT
MODEL NUMBER
HIGH-RISE BOOM model LM-HRT
DESCRIPTION
OVERALL HEIGHT
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
NET WT. (LBS.)
LM-1T LM-OBT LM-HRT LM-EBT
TELESCOPING LIFT MASTER ONE ORBIT TELESCOPING BOOM HIGH-RISE TELESCOPING BOOM TELESCOPING ECONOMY BOOM
28" 28" 70" 11"
4,000 4,000 4,000 4,000
424 500 875 370
LM-1NT LM-OBNT LM-HRNT LM-EBNT
NON-TELESCOPING LIFT MASTER BOOM NON-TELESCOPING ORBIT BOOM NON-TELESCOPING HIGH-RISE BOOM NON-TELESCOPING ECONOMY BOOM
28" 28" 70" 11"
4,000 4,000 4,000 4,000
403 558 627 431 DC-25/FC-70
MODEL NUMBER
LM-6 LM-8 LM-8-OBT LM-FP
NET WT. (LBS.)
DESCRIPTION
6,000 POUND CAPACITY UPGRADE 8,000 POUND CAPACITY UPGRADE (AVAILABLE ON LM-EBT AND LM-1T) 8,000 POUND CAPACITY UPGRADE (AVAILABLE ON LM-OBT,) LARGER FORK POCKETS 8¼"W x 4¼"H (INSIDE DIMENSION)
70 190 234 23
LIFT MASTER BOOM model LM-1T-8
Polyester Lifting Slings - Double Ply For medium to heavy-duty lifting, these double-ply lifting slings are the practical, economical answer to many lifting problems. TYPE III style, with fabric ends, has flat tapered eyes at both ends and can be used for all hitch types. Double capacity when used basket-style. Reduce capacity 20% when used chocker-style. These slings meet DIN-EN 1492-1, ANSI standard B30.9 and OSHA requirements. MODEL NUMBER
STRAIGHT LIFT CAPACITY (LBS.)
WIDTH )INCHES(
COLOR CODE
1 2 3
PURPLE GREEN YELLOW
)SL-2-F-(length )SL-4-F-(length )SL-6-F-(length
METAL ENDS - TYPE 1 2,000 4,000 6,000
)SL-2-F-(length )SL-4-F-(length )SL-6-F-(length
REINFORCED FABRIC LOOP ENDS - TYPE -III 2,000 1 4,000 2 6,000 3
PURPLE GREEN YELLOW
DC-25/UPS/FC-70
Swivel Hooks with Shackle Easily connects to Hoisting Hooks, Hook Plates or Booms. Variety of capacities available. Forged steel construction.
MODEL NUMBER
OVERALL HEIGHT
OVERALL WIDTH
THROAT OPENING
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
NET WT. (LBS.)
HOOK-4 HOOK-6 HOOK-10
10" 12" 14½"
3½" 4¾" 6½"
7/8" 1-3/8" 1-7/8"
4,000 6,000 10,000
4 7 9 DC-25/UPS/FC-70
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
335
MATERIAL HANDLING Lifting Hooks Hoisting Hooks Convert your fork truck into a swivel hook in a matter of seconds. The easy to attach Hoisting Hook does not require the assistance of special tools. Secured to the fork truck by means of a 36" long safety chain and screw clamps. Available in single or double fork design. The single fork attachment is powder coated blue, while the double fork attachment is zinc plated. Hook with shackle included. MODEL NUMBER
HOOK TYPE
SINGLE FORK ATTACHMENT RIGID S-FORK-4-R S-FORK-4-S SWIVEL S-FORK-5-R RIGID S-FORK-5-S SWIVEL S-FORK-6-R RIGID S-FORK-6-S SWIVEL DOUBLE FORK ATTACHMENT RIGID D-FORK-4-R D-FORK-4-S SWIVEL D-FORK-10-R RIGID D-FORK-10-S SWIVEL
FORK POCKET )SIZE (W x H
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
NET WT. (LBS.)
4¼" x 2¼" 4¼" x 2¼" 5¼" x 2¼" 5¼" x 2¼" 6¼" x 2¼" 6¼" x 2¼"
3,000 3,000 3,000 3,000 3,000 3,000
18 18 22 22 29 29
6¾" x 2½" 6¾" x 2½" 6¾" x 3½" 6¾" x 3½"
4,000 4,000 10,000 10,000
41 41 46 46
DOUBLE FORK Series D-FORK
SINGLE FORK Series S-FORK
DC-25/UPS/FC-70
Hook Plates
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628)
Hook Plates enable any fork truck to safely lift a load using chains, cables or slings. Features slanted fork openings, measuring 6¼"W x 1¾"H, to prevent the hook plate from being used upside down. A hook with anchor shackle is included. MODEL NUMBER
HOOK TYPE
OVERALL HEIGHT
OVERALL WIDTH
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
NET WT. (LBS.)
LM-HP4-S LM-HP4-R LM-HP6-S LM-HP6-R
SWIVEL RIGID SWIVEL RIGID
6" 6" 6" 6"
24" 24" 24" 24"
4,000 4,000 6,000 6,000
26 26 27 27 DC-25/UPS/FC-70
Forktruck Tow Balls, Pintle Hook and Rigid Hooks Convert your fork truck into a tow truck for moving trailers and other portable equipment. Simple design slides onto forks and secures into place with safety pins. Welded steel construction with powder coat blue finish. Optional pintle hook, tow balls and rigid hooks available. Bolt on design. MODEL NUMBER
HOOK-BASE-32 HOOK-BASE-38 HOOK-BASE-44
FORK LENGTH
LENGTH TO CENTER OF BALL
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
NET WT. (LBS.)
36" 42" 48"
32" 38" 44"
4,000 4,000 4,000
84 100 118
BALL DIAMETER
SHANK DIAMETER
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
NET WT. (LBS.)
1-7/8" 2" 2-5/16"
1" 1" 1"
2,000 5,000 5,000
3 3 4
JAW OPENING
VERTICAL CAPACITY (LBS.)
TRAILER CAPACITY (LBS.)
NET WT. (LBS.)
1¾"
2,000
10,000
12
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
NET WT. (LBS.)
TOW BALLS MODEL NUMBER
BALL-178 BALL-200 BALL-2516 PINTLE HOOK MODEL NUMBER
PINTLE RIGID HOOKS MODEL NUMBER TOW BALL series BALL
336
HOOK-R-4 HOOK-R-6 HOOK-R-10
4,000 6,000 10,000 DC-25/UPS/FC-70
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Fork Accessories
MATERIAL HANDLING
Fork Truck Mounted Brush Sweepers The rugged lightweight Fork Truck Broom is ideal for interior and exterior commercial sweeping. Great for all cleanup applications; docks, warehouses, and parking lots. Lightweight aluminum body with polypropylene bristles (replaceable). Red powder coat finish. Fork pockets measure 7¼" deep x 5" wide x 2" high. Unit attaches to forks by sliding forks into fork pockets and securing with locking screws. Optional Dust Mop attaches to broom for sweeping fine material on polished floors. MODEL NUMBER
OVERALL SIZE )W x D x H(
VSWP-48 VSWP-60 VSWP-60-DM
FORK POCKET )W x D x H(
SWEEPING WIDTH
BRISTLE LENGTH
NET WT. (LBS.)
8" 8"
44 51 10
48" x 9" x 12" 5" x 7¼" x 2" 48" 60" x 9" x 12" 5" x 7¼" x 2" 60" DUST MOP ATTACHMENT 60" WIDE
DC-20/UPS/ FC-70
Pallet Dumper/Retainer Dump loaded pallets easily without leaving the seat of your fork truck with the all welded steel constructed Pallet Dumper. Unit slides onto forks and is secured by a safety chain. Two retainers hold the pallet in place while dumping the contents into the hopper or dumpster. Once the retainers have cleared the opposite end of the pallet, raise the forks and the retainers will hold the pallet on the forks. Lift the pallet to the dumping height and rest the pallet on the edge of the dumpster. Pull the chain, releasing the fork carriage, allowing the pallet to tilt and dump the load into the hopper or dumpster. When finished, simply lower to ground until the carriage latches. MODEL NUMBER
FORK POCKET )W x H(
FORK LENGTH
OVERALL WIDTH
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
PAL-D/R
7½" x 2½"
52"
32"
2,000
NET WT. (LBS.)
340 DC-25/FC-70
Retainer
Fork Truck Fork Caddy Transport fork truck forks easily and safely. This caddy allows the user to easily remove and install forks onto a fork truck. This is usually a dangerous and time consuming process, but our fork caddy makes this a breeze. After transporting the fork to the fork truck, rotate the handle 90°. Slide the fork onto the mast. The Fork Caddy has easy-grip handles and rolls smoothly on two swivel casters. A locking screw secures the fork into the caddy to keep it in place while transporting. The comfort-grip handle pivots up to 180° to allow for easier mobility. The Fork Caddy is lightweight and small enough for easy storage as well. MODEL NUMBER
USABLE SIZE )W x H(
CASTERS
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
FC-29
7½" x 2½"
3" x 1" SWIVEL
2,000
NET WT. (LBS.)
29 DC-25/FC-70
Forged Steel Forks Change your current fork length or buy an extra pair of forks for an emergency with our new Forged Steel Forks. Forks are 4" wide each. Designed for class II carriage mounting and includes lock pin. Meets I.T.A. standards. MODEL NUMBER
F4-1.25-36 F4-1.25-48 F4-1.50-36 F4-1.50-42 F4-1.50-48 F4-1.50-60 F4-1.75-36 F4-1.75-42 F4-1.75-48 F4-1.75-60
LENGTH )INCHES(
THICKNESS )INCHES(
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
NET WT. (LBS.)
36 48 36 42 48 60 36 42 48 60
1¼" 1¼" 1½" 1½" 1½" 1½" 1¾" 1¾" 1¾" 1¾"
3,000 3,000 4,000 4,000 4,000 4,000 5,000 5,000 5,000 5,000
191 222 224 249 268 308 251 277 299 392 DC-25/FC-70
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
337
MATERIAL HANDLING Fork Accessories Rug Rams/Carpet Poles Transport rolls of carpet with our sturdy Rug Rams/Carpet Poles. Available in either carriage or fork mounted style. 2¾" diameter high strength, rotatable, replaceable pole has tapered tip. All units are made of steel construction and painted blue. Fork Mounted Rug Rams feature 7½"W x 2½"H fork pockets on 24" centers. Safety chain is included to secure unit to fork truck. Carriage Mounted Rug Rams are available in class II or III mount and feature a spring loaded locking pin to secure them to the carriage.
MODEL NUMBER
LENGTH
POLE DIAMETER
FORK MOUNTED - INVERTED CRP-108 108" 2¾" CRP-120 120" 2¾" CRP-144 144" 2¾" FORK MOUNTED CRF-108 108" 2¾" CRF-120 120" 2¾" CRF-144 144" 2¾" CARRIAGE MOUNTED - CLASS II CR-108-2 108" 2¾" CR-120-2 120" 2¾" CR-144-2 144" 2¾" CARRIAGE MOUNTED - CLASS III CR-108-3 108" 2¾" 120" 2¾" CR-120-3 CR-144-3 144" 2¾"
CARRIAGE CLASS
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
NET WT. (LBS.)
N/A N/A N/A
2,500 2,200 1,800
526 550 570
N/A N/A N/A
2,500 2,200 1,800
500 525 545
2 2 2
2,500 2,200 1,800
397 421 478
3 3 3
2,500 2,200 1,800
397 421 478
FORK MOUNTED - INVERTED Series CRP
FORK MOUNTED Series CRF
CARRIAGE MOUNTED Series CR
DC-25/FC-70
Fork Extensions Provide the extra support needed to lift long or large objects with a fork truck. Welded steel construction with cast steel tips. Steel retaining strap (loop style*) prevents fork extensions from sliding off forks during use. Powder coat yellow finish. OSHA regulations require that extensions are no more than 150% of the existing fork length. (e.g. 48" existing forks, the fork extension should not exceed 72"). *Loop Style: Insert loop at the tip of the fork and slide it up at a 45° angle then lay it down over the existing fork. Pin Style (suffix P): Remove pin and lay extension over fork or drive fork truck into the extension. Re-insert the pin behind the heel of the fork to secure extension. Rear Spacer (suffix RS): Insert the loop at the tip of the fork and slide it up at a 45° angle then lay it down over the existing forks. Load pallets into rear of trailer conveniently and easily. Practical for pushing pallets two or three deep into a trailer.
MODEL NUMBER
ACCOMMODATES FORK WIDTH
FORK EXTENSION INSIDE WIDTH
LENGTH
MAXIMUM FORK THICKNESS
NET WT. PAIR (LBS.)
FE-4-48 FE-4-54 *FE-4-63 FE-4-72 FE-4-84 FE-4-96
4" 4" 4" 4" 4" 4"
4½" 4½" 4½" 4½" 4½" 4½"
48" 54" 63" 72" 84" 96"
2" 2" 2" 2" 2" 2"
101 109 125 135 157 173
FE-5-48 FE-5-54 *FE-5-63 FE-5-72 FE-5-84 FE-5-96
5" 5" 5" 5" 5" 5"
5½" 5½" 5½" 5½" 5½" 5½"
48" 54" 63" 72" 84" 96"
2" 2" 2" 2" 2" 2"
112 126 151 155 189 201
FE-6-48 FE-6-54 *FE-6-63 FE-6-72 FE-6-84 FE-6-96
6" 6" 6" 6" 6" 6"
6½" 6½" 6½" 6½" 6½" 6½"
48" 54" 63" 72" 84" 96"
2" 2" 2" 2" 2" 2"
121 146 165 166 199 210
*RECOMMENDED MAXIMUM LENGTH FOR 42" FORKS
338
DC-25/UPS/FC-65
LOOP STYLE
PIN STYLE • Suffix P
REAR SPACER • Suffix RS
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Safety Ladders
MATERIAL HANDLING
Cross-Over Ladders Mount where you need permanent access at crossover points. The upper platform features removable two sided 42" high handrail with 21" midrail and fixed 4" toeboards to prevent objects from rolling off. Serrated steps for extra grip and safety are 24" wide and 7" deep with a step height of 10". The overall ladder width is 29". Ground legs include rubber feet for stability. All welded steel construction with removable handrails. Capacity is 500 lbs. Meets OSHA and ANSI A14.7 standards.
F
D
E
A
B C
MODEL NUMBER
NUMBER OF STEPS
A
B
C
D
E
F
COL-3-26-14 COL-3-26-23 COL-3-26-33 COL-3-26-44 COL-4-36-14 COL-4-36-23 COL-4-36-33 COL-4-36-44 COL-5-46-14 COL-5-46-23 COL-5-46-33 COL-5-46-44 COL-6-56-14 COL-6-56-23 COL-6-56-33 COL-6-56-44
3 3 3 3 4 4 4 4 5 5 5 5 6 6 6 6
26" 26" 26" 26" 36" 36" 36" 36" 46" 46" 46" 46" 56" 56" 56" 56"
14" 23" 33" 44" 14" 23" 33" 44" 14" 23" 33" 44" 14" 23" 33" 44"
54" 66" 78" 90" 66" 78" 90" 102" 78" 90" 102" 113" 90" 102" 113" 125"
72" 72" 72" 72" 82" 82" 82" 82" 92" 92" 92" 92" 102" 102" 102" 102"
30" 30" 30" 30" 40" 40" 40" 40" 50" 50" 50" 50" 60" 60" 60" 60"
24" 36" 47" 59" 24" 36" 47" 59" 24" 36" 47" 59" 24" 36" 47" 59"
.NET WT )POUNDS(
186 210 241 265 217 242 272 297 248 273 303 328 279 304 334 359 DC-35/FC-125
Alternating-Tread Stairs Alternating Tread Step design offers a shorter span than traditional steps. Features handrail on each side of unit, dual safety chain at top of stair and formed steel steps with raised surfaces for better traction. Rugged welded steel construction. Powder coated safety yellow finish. Ships knockdown for lower freight costs. MODEL NUMBER
NUMBER OF STEPS
TOP STEP HEIGHT
LENGTH
STEP ANGLE
NET WT. (POUNDS)
ATS-4-56 ATS-5-56 ATS-6-56 ATS-7-56 ATS-8-56 ATS-9-56 ATS-10-56 ATS-4-68 ATS-5-68 ATS-6-68 ATS-7-68 ATS-8-68 ATS-9-68 ATS-10-68
7 8 10 12 13 15 16 6 7 9 10 11 13 14
48" 60" 72" 84" 96" 108" 120" 48" 60" 72" 84" 96" 108" 120"
37.25" 44.91" 53.21" 61.44" 69.27" 77.49" 84.38" 25.66" 30.28" 35.36" 40.04" 45.05" 49.78" 54.75"
56° 56° 56° 56° 56° 56° 56° 68° 68° 68° 68° 68° 68° 68°
129 147 166 184 202 220 272 114 131 148 165 182 199 216 DC-35/FC-85
Walk-Thru Style Dock Ladders Prevent needless dock injuries with Walk-Thru Style Dock Ladders. Constructed of steel angle iron. Mount ladder directly to the dock face by either welding or bolting on. The extra high handrail provides maximum assistance and safety. All ladders project out 8½" from face of dock. MODEL NUMBER
OVERALL SIZE )W x H(
NUMBER OF RUNGS
TOP STEP HEIGHT
WIDTH OF STEP
DISTANCE BETWEEN STEP
NET WT. (POUNDS)
DKL-2 DKL-3 DKL-4 DKL-5 DKL-6 DKL-7 DKL-8 DKL-9 DKL-10
21" x 66" 21" x 78" 21" x 90" 21" x 102" 21" x 114" 21" x 126" 21" x 138" 21" x 150" 21" x 162"
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
12" 24" 36" 48" 60" 72" 84" 96" 108"
18" 18" 18" 18" 18" 18" 18" 18" 18"
12" 12" 12" 12" 12" 12" 12" 12" 12"
46 50 55 59 65 85 91 97 103 DC-25/FC-85
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
339
MATERIAL HANDLING Guard Rails Guard Rail Systems Protect personnel and equipment both visually and physically with our Guard Rail Systems. These economical systems can be utilized indoors or outdoors. Ideal for protecting corners of buildings and machinery from fork truck and vehicle damage. Choose between one, two, or three rail high systems. Tubular posts are machined for continuous or perpendicular rail mounting. US D.O.T. guard rail mounting and I-beam posts available, contact factory. Rail mounting hardware included with post. Floor mounting kit sold separately. Curved rails feature a 90° angle and connect with the straight railing.
series GR
MODEL NUMBER series GR-PC-YEL
series GR-CRV
Shown with Galvanized Guard Rail and Plastic End TUBULAR POST Caps series GR-TP SPRING POST model GR-SP
HEIGHT
LENGTH
MOUNTING POSTS REQUIRED
RADIUS
NET WT. (POUNDS)
------
44 66 89 112 133
------
44 66 89 112 133
46" 61" 75½" 91½"
66 89 112 133
GALVANIZED GUARD RAIL - STRAIGHT RAILS GR-4 12" 48" 2 GR-6 12" 72" 2 GR-8 12" 96" 2 GR-10 12" 120" 3 GR-12 12" 144" 3 POWDER COAT GUARD RAIL - STRAIGHT RAILS GR-4-PC-YEL 12" 48" 2 GR-6-PC-YEL 12" 72" 2 GR-8-PC-YEL 12" 96" 2 GR-10-PC-YEL 12" 120" 3 GR-12-PC-YEL 12" 144" 3 GALVANIZED GUARD RAIL - CURVED RAILS GR-6-CRV 12" 72" 2 GR-8-CRV 12" 96" 2 GR-10-CRV 12" 120" 3 GR-12-CRV 12" 144" 3
DC-20/FC-50
Guard Rail Options MODEL NUMBER Shown with Galvanized Guard Rail DROP-IN STYLE POSTS series GR-TP-DI
CONCRETE MOUNTING KIT model GR-ABK
PLASTIC END CAP model GR-CAP
GUARD RAIL LEVELS
GR-SP SPRING POST - 24" HIGH ONE GR-TP18 TUBULAR POST - 18" HIGH ONE GR-TP42 TUBULAR POST - 42" HIGH TWO GR-TP60 TUBULAR POST - 60" HIGH THREE GR-TP72 TUBULAR POST - 72" HIGH THREE TUBULAR POSTS FOR DROP IN DESIGN GR-TP18-DI 18" HIGH POST ONE GR-TP42-DI 42" HIGH POST TWO GR-TP60-DI 60" HIGH POST THREE GR-TP72-DI 72" HIGH POST THREE GR-BKT-DI EXTRA POST MOUNTING BRACKET GR-CAP )PLASTIC END CAP 7"W x 13½"H x 4"D (Adds 3" to Length GR-BG )BUFFER END GUARD 48"L x 16"H x 12½"D (Adds 28" to Length GR-TG )FLARED END GUARD 27"L x 18"H x 10"D (Adds 18" to Length GR-ABK CONCRETE ANCHOR BOLTS (4) 3/4" x 4" GR-SPP SPRING POST MOUNT PLATE FOR ASPHALT/BLACKTOP APPLICATIONS
BUFFER END GUARD FLARED END GUARD model GR-BG model GR-TG The above two End Guards can either be welded or bolted onto our Galvanized Guard Rail. Hardware not included.
STRUCTURAL GUARD RAIL series ST-GR
STRUCTURAL GUARD POSTS AND BRACKETS series STGR-TP-DI
340
DESCRIPTION
Structural Guard Rail Systems
NET WT. (LBS.)
21 41 60 89 109 46 65 94 114 5 7 40 30 2 3 DC-20/FC-50
Constructed of structural C-channel 8.2 lbs. per foot for maximum strength and protection. Railing can be removed in a matter of seconds. Available in custom lengths. MODEL NUMBER
HEIGHT
LENGTH
STRUCTURAL GUARD RAIL ST-GR-4 8" 48" ST-GR-6 8" 72" ST-GR-8 8" 96" ST-GR-10 8" 120" ST-GR-12 8" 144" TUBULAR MOUNTING POSTS WITH DROP-IN STYLE BRACKET STGR-TP-18DI 18" HIGH POST ACCOMMODATES 1 RAIL STGR-TP-42DI 42" HIGH POST ACCOMMODATES 2 RAIL STGR-TP-60DI 60" HIGH POST ACCOMMODATES 3 RAIL STGR-TP-72DI 72" HIGH POST ACCOMMODATES 3 RAIL STGR-BKT-DI EXTRA POST MOUNTING BRACKET
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
NET WT. (POUNDS)
44 66 89 112 133 47 67 95 116 5 DC-20/FC-50
Bollards
MATERIAL HANDLING
Steel Pipe Safety Bollards Bollards can be used both indoors and outdoors to protect work areas, racking and personnel. Powder coated safety yellow finish. Molded rubber caps are removable on 4½" and 5½" diameter units. Steel caps are welded on the 1¾" diameter units. Base plate measures 8" x 8", on the 4.5 and 5.5 units, and include four (4) pre-drilled mounting holes. Mounting kits and replacement caps available. Welded steel construction. MODEL NUMBER
BOL-24-2 BOL-36-2 BOL-42-2 BOL-24-4.5 BOL-36-4.5 BOL-42-4.5 BOL-24-5.5 BOL-36-5.5 BOL-42-5.5 BOL-ABK-3 BOL-ABK-4
DESCRIPTION
OUTSIDE DIAMETER
HEIGHT
NET WT. (POUNDS)
STEEL PIPE BOLLARD 24" 1¾" STEEL PIPE BOLLARD 36" 1¾" STEEL PIPE BOLLARD 42" 1¾" STEEL PIPE BOLLARD 24" 4½" STEEL PIPE BOLLARD 36" 4½" STEEL PIPE BOLLARD 42" 4½" STEEL PIPE BOLLARD 24" 5½" STEEL PIPE BOLLARD 36" 5½" STEEL PIPE BOLLARD 42" 5½" CONCRETE ANCHOR BOLTS (4) 3/8" x 3" (1¾" Dia. Bollards) CONCRETE ANCHOR BOLTS (4) 3/4" x 4" (4½" & 5½" dia. Bol)
12 15 16 34 45 50 42 57 69 2 2
DC-20/UPS/FC-50
Offset Steel Bollards Unique design features offset base plate that won't interfere with traffic. The 8" x 8" base plate includes (4) pre-drilled mounting holes (mounting hardware is sold separately). Removable rubber top cap and black/yellow safety tape included. Heavy-duty welded steel construction with a powder coat safety yellow finish is standard. MODEL NUMBER
HEIGHT
OBOL-35-4.5 OBOL-47-4.5 OBOL-53-4.5 BOL-ABK-4
OUTSIDE DIAMETER
BASE PLATE
NET WT. (POUNDS)
35" 4½" 10" x 10" 47" 4½" 10" x 10" 53" 4½" 10" x 10" CONCRETE ANCHOR BOLTS (4) 3/4" x 4"
32 41 46 2 DC-20/UPS/FC-50
Chrome-Plated Steel Bollard Improve the image of your facility while protecting people and equipment. Unit is made of steel and finished with an attractive bright chrome plating for a clean fresh look. A black plastic top cap is removable to fill the bollard with concrete for greater strength and stability. The mounting plate is predrilled with (4) ½" diameter holes for quick and easy installation. Base plate diameter is 8". MODEL NUMBER
CBOL-42-4 CBOL-ABK-3
DESCRIPTION
HEIGHT
CHROME PLATED STEEL BOLLARD 42" CONCRETE ANCHOR BOLTS (4) 3/8" x 3"
DIAMETER
4"
NET WT. (POUNDS)
26 2 DC-30/UPS/FC-50
Pour In Place Bollards Make your bollards permanent by setting them in concrete. The extra length of the Pour in Place Bollard allows you to maintain the needed height while fixing the bollard in concrete. Bollard comes with welded anchoring tabs and a removable cap so the bollard can be filled with concrete to increase its strength and durability. Powder coated yellow for high visibility. MODEL NUMBER
USABLE HEIGHT
OVERALL HEIGHT
OUTSIDE DIAMETER
NET WT. (POUNDS)
BOLPP-24-5.5 BOLPP-36-5.5 BOLPP-42-5.5 BOLPP-48-5.5
24" 36" 42" 48"
34" 46" 52" 58"
5½" 5½" 5½" 5½"
44 59 73 88 DC-20/UPS/FC-50
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
341
MATERIAL HANDLING Bollards Removable Bollards The Removable Bollard comes with a sleeve that can be set in concrete to hold the bollard. When access is needed into an area that is protected by the bollard, simply lift the bollard out of the sleeve. Replace the bollard in its sleeve to reinstate the protective barrier. Powder coated yellow for high visibility. Sleeve is included.
For a w id selecti er call 80 on, 0-LOC 8
MODEL NUMBER
USABLE HEIGHT
OVERALL HEIGHT
SLEEVE HEIGHT
BOLLARD DIAMETER
NET WT. (POUNDS)
BOL-R-36-5.5 BOL-R-42-5.5 BOL-R-48-5.5
36" 42" 48"
46" 52" 58"
10" 10" 10"
5½" 5½" 5½"
88 96 103 DC-25/UPS/FC-50
Self Storing Bollard with Door & Lock This unique bollard is designed to slide down into the ground or floor when not needed. Great for preventing access to parking areas. Each unit includes a sleeve that can be set in the ground with concrete. Bollard has a handle in the top to allow for easy lifting and lowering. Lift and twist to lock into raised position. Twist and lower to return to stored position. Includes locking tab for use with padlock (padlock not included) to prevent unauthorized operation. Steel construction with powder coat safety yellow finish. SHOWED IN LOWERED POSITIONED
MODEL NUMBER
BOL-SS-42-5.5
USABLE HEIGHT
COLLAPSED HEIGHT
SLEEVE HEIGHT
BOLLARD DIAMETER
42"
1½"
45"
5½"
NET WT. (POUNDS)
163 DC-25/UPS/FC-50
Movable Bollard (with Wheels) Movable Bollard provides a portable visual barrier when an area needs temporary protection. Ideal for use when keeping traffic out of a temporarily hazardous area or area under repair. Can be used indoors or outdoors. Mold-on-rubber wheels standard. Powder coated yellow for high visibility. MODEL NUMBER
USABLE HEIGHT
WHEEL SIZE
OUTSIDE DIAMETER
42”
10”
5½"
BOL-MB-42-5.5
NET WT. (POUNDS)
71 DC-25/UPS/FC-50
Folding Bollard Galvanized steel barrier post for parking control and security. Bollard is locked in the raised position with a padlock (padlock not included). When padlock is removed, bollard may be lowered to ground to allow for access. Base plate must be lagged to ground for proper installation (installation hardware not included). Steel construction. MODEL NUMBER
BOL-FD-36
EXTENDED HEIGHT
COLLAPSED HEIGHT
BOLLARD DIAMETER
42”
4”
1¾"
NET WT. (POUNDS)
20 DC-25/UPS/FC-50
FOLDING BOLLARD model BOL-FD-36
Removable Ornamental Bollard Provide an attractive yet functional barrier to vehicle access and parking. Bollard locks into galvanized steel socket that is cemented into the ground. When the bollard is removed, a socket cover protects the hole leaving no protrusion above the surface. MODEL NUMBER REMOVABLE ORNAMENTAL BOLLARD model BOL-OR-40
342
BOL-OR-40
USABLE HEIGHT 40”
BOLLARD DIAMETER 5½"
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
NET WT. (POUNDS) 84 DC-25/UPS/FC-50
Bollards
MATERIAL HANDLING
Bollard Caps Replace lost or damaged bollard caps. Available in Cast Steel or Molded Rubber. Easy to attach. Steel caps must be welded in place. Rubber cap installation is press-fit. CAST STEEL series BOL-CAP-S
MOLDED RUBBER series BOL-CAP-R
MODEL NUMBER
MATERIAL
INNER DIAMETER PIPE FITTING
FITS MODEL
NET WT. (POUNDS)
*BOL-CAP-4.5-S *BOL-CAP-5.5-S BOL-CAP-4.5-R BOL-CAP-5.5-R
CAST STEEL CAST STEEL MOLDED RUBBER MOLDED RUBBER
4.26" (4" SCH. 10 PIPE) 5.30" (5" SCH. 10 PIPE) 4.26" (4" SCH. 10 PIPE) 5.30" (5" SCH. 10 PIPE)
BOL-4.5 BOL-5.5 BOL-4.5 BOL-5.5
3 3 1 1
REQUIRES WELDING FOR INSTALLATION*
DC-20/UPS
Bollard/Post Covers This durable poly sleeve with red reflective rings will minimize maintenance and improve appearance. Units slide over existing bollards. No hardware needed. MODEL NUMBER
HEIGHT
OUTSIDE DIAMETER
INSIDE DIAMETER
NET WT. (POUNDS)
PBC-4 PBC-7
52" 52"
4-7/8" 7-1/2"
4-5/8" 7-1/4"
4 7 DC-25/UPS/250
Plastic Bollard Covers Eliminate the need for costly scraping and painting of unsightly bollards. The low density polyethylene thermoplastic molded sleeves slide over existing bollards. No hardware needed. Additional sizes and colors available. MODEL NUMBER
USE WITH MODEL
HEIGHT
INSIDE DIAMETER
NET WT. (POUNDS)
BPC-24-4.5 BPC-36-4.5 BPC-42-4.5 BPC-24-5.5 BPC-36-5.5 BPC-42-5.5
BOL-24-4.5 BOL-36-4.5 BOL-42-4.5 BOL-24-5.5 BOL-36-5.5 BOL-42-5.5
24" 36" 42" 24" 36" 42"
4¾" 4¾" 4¾" 5¾" 5¾" 5¾"
4 6 8 6 9 11 DC-20/UPS/FC-250
Spring Loaded Steel Bollards Designed to serve as a visual and audible warning to personnel. Unique spring-loaded design will bend and not break like rigid bollards. Prevents damage to bollard and equipment. Promotes long life. Order bollard with or without light/siren option. Light/siren option includes sensitive switches that will activate a strobe light and warning siren when contacted. Operates with two 9V batteries (not included). Simply slides into open top of bollard. Each bollard is manufactured from steel and includes a powder coat safety yellow finish. MODEL NUMBER
SPBOL-42 SPBOL-42-BL SPBOL-ABK
DESCRIPTION
SPRING BOLLARD SPRING BOLLARD W/ BEEPER & STROBE CONCRETE ANCHOR BOLTS (4) 3/8" x 3"
HEIGHT
OUTSIDE DIAMETER
NET WT. (POUNDS)
42" 42"
2½" 2½"
19 32 2 DC-20/UPS/FC-50
Protective Dome Covers for Bollards Prevent accidents and injuries from people tripping over raised bolts. Easy to use device slides over bollards covering mounting hardware and base plate for a nice clean finish. Durable yellow powder coat finish. Steel construction. No hardware required. MODEL NUMBER
USE WITH
OUTSIDE DIAMETER
HEIGHT
NET WT. (POUNDS)
DOME-4.5 DOME-5.5
4½" DIAMETER BOLLARDS 5½" DIAMETER BOLLARDS
14" 14"
3" 3"
8 9 DC-20/UPS/FC-50
Plastic Hardware Caps for Bollards Plastic hardware caps snap over the top of anchor bolts and washers to protect from weathering. Also provides for cleaner look. MODEL NUMBER
DESCRIPTION
QUANTITY PER PACKAGE
NET WT. (POUNDS)
BC-B-1.5
SNAPS OVER ANCHOR HARDWARE
4
1 DC-20/UPS/FC-250
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
343
MATERIAL HANDLING Rack Guards Low Profile Rack Guards May be used either indoors or outdoors to protect valuable pallet racking, machinery and personnel. High visibility yellow powder coat finish. Heavy-duty welded steel construction. MODEL NUMBER
DESCRIPTION
LPRO-36-9-2 LPRO-48-9-2 LPRO-36-16-2 LPRO-48-16-2 LPRO-36-9-4 LPRO-48-9-4 LPRO-36-16-4 LPRO-48-16-4 LPRO-ABK-3 LPRO-ABK-4
HEIGHT
LENGTH
OUTSIDE DIAMETER
LOW PROFILE GUARD 9" 36" 1-5/8" LOW PROFILE GUARD 9" 48" 1-5/8" LOW PROFILE GUARD 16" 36" 1-5/8" LOW PROFILE GUARD 16" 48" 1-5/8" LOW PROFILE GUARD 9" 36" 4-1/2" LOW PROFILE GUARD 9" 48" 4-1/2" LOW PROFILE GUARD 16" 36" 4-1/2" LOW PROFILE GUARD 16" 48" 4-1/2" ).CONCRETE ANCHOR BOLTS (8) 3/8" x 3" (1-5/8" Dia ).CONCRETE ANCHOR BOLTS (8) 3/4" x 4" (4-1/2" dia
NET WT. (POUNDS)
22/UPS 26/UPS 28/UPS 32/UPS 48/UPS 60/UPS 64/UPS 73/UPS 4 4
DC-20/UPS/FC-50
High Profile Machinery Guards Heavy-duty steel construction for protecting racks, building walls, expensive equipment and hundreds of other applications. All 42” high units include a 21” midrail to comply with OSHA handrailing requirements. Two base plates with four pre-drilled mounting holes in each plate. Welded steel construction. MODEL NUMBER
HPRO-36-24-2 HPRO-48-24-2 HPRO-36-36-2 HPRO-48-36-2 HPRO-36-42-2 HPRO-48-42-2 HPRO-36-24-4 HPRO-48-24-4 HPRO-36-36-4 HPRO-48-36-4 HPRO-36-42-4 HPRO-48-42-4 HPRO-ABK-3 HPRO-ABK-4
DESCRIPTION
HEIGHT
LENGTH
OUTSIDE DIAMETER
NET WT. (POUNDS)
HIGH PROFILE GUARD 24" 36" 1-5/8" HIGH PROFILE GUARD 24" 48" 1-5/8" HIGH PROFILE GUARD 36" 36" 1-5/8" HIGH PROFILE GUARD 36" 48" 1-5/8" HIGH PROFILE GUARD 42" 36" 1-5/8" HIGH PROFILE GUARD 42" 48" 1-5/8" HIGH PROFILE GUARD 24" 36" 4-1/2" HIGH PROFILE GUARD 24" 48" 4-1/2" HIGH PROFILE GUARD 36" 36" 4-1/2" HIGH PROFILE GUARD 36" 48" 4-1/2" HIGH PROFILE GUARD 42" 36" 4-1/2" HIGH PROFILE GUARD 42" 48" 4-1/2" CONCRETE ANCHOR BOLTS (8) 3/8" x 3" (1-5/8" Dia.) CONCRETE ANCHOR BOLTS (8) 3/4" x 4" (4-1/2" dia.)
30/UPS 40/UPS 38 48 42 52 53/UPS 69/UPS 74 82 89 93 4 4 DC-20/UPS/FC-50
Adjustable Width Rack Guards Protect the row ends of tandem pallet racking with this heavy duty, welded steel adjustable rack guard. Slide in design has a variable length range of 62" to 108". Includes steel mounting plates with 1" dia. holes to safely secure unit to floor. Powder coated with safety yellow finish. MODEL NUMBER
ARMG-24 ARMG-ABK
ADJUSTABLE LENGTH
HEIGHT
62" to 108" 24" CONCRETE ANCHOR BOLTS (12) 3/4" x 4"
NET WT. (POUNDS)
203 4 DC-20/FC-50
90° Triple Elbow Guards Protect the corners of machinery, buildings and offices. The 90° bend fits snug around corners to provide the ultimate protection against potential damage from fork trucks or other mobile equipment. Base plate size is 8" x 8". Welded steel construction. Powder coated safety yellow. MODEL NUMBER
TEG-24-24-4 TEG-24-36-4 TEG-24-42-4 TEG-30-24-4 TEG-30-36-4 TEG-30-42-4 TEG-ABK
344
OUTSIDE DESCRIPTION HEIGHT LENGTH DIAMETER TRIPLE ELBOW GUARD 24" 24" 4½" TRIPLE ELBOW GUARD 36" 24" 4½" TRIPLE ELBOW GUARD 42" 24" 4½" TRIPLE ELBOW GUARD 24" 30" 4½" TRIPLE ELBOW GUARD 36" 30" 4½" TRIPLE ELBOW GUARD 42" 30" 4½" )CONCRETE ANCHOR BOLTS (8) 3/4" x 4" (4-1/2" GUARDS
NET WT. (POUNDS) 69 82 90 74 88 95 4 DC-20/FC-50
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Guard Systems
MATERIAL HANDLING
Modular Guard Systems Modular Guard System can be ordered to fit almost any application. Designed for quick and easy assembly. Railing sections are installed and secured to each post with a single bolt. Select from different railing lengths to custom fit your application. Railing systems are made from heavy-duty 3" square steel tubing. Wall mounting posts may be used to secure guard assembly to a wall. Durable safety yellow powder coat finish. Steel construction. All components sold separately. RAILING SECTION MODEL NUMBER
EFFECTIVE LENGTH
OVERALL LENGTH
SQUARE TUBE (O.D.)
NET WT. (POUNDS)
48" 72" 98" 120" 144"
56" 80" 102" 128" 152"
3" 3" 3" 3" 3"
26 38 49 60 71
MG-R-4 MG-R-6 MG-R-8 MG-R-10 MG-R-12
DC-20/FC-50
MOUNTING POSTS MODEL NUMBER
DESCRIPTION
STYLE
OVERALL HEIGHT
NET WT. (POUNDS)
MG-CP-36-1 MG-CP-36-2
CORNER POST CORNER POST
SINGLE RAIL DOUBLE RAIL
36" 36"
37 49
MG-SP-36-1 MG-SP-36-2
STRAIGHT POST STRAIGHT POST
SINGLE RAIL DOUBLE RAIL
36" 36"
37 49
Fits against walls to protect drains or piping
Individual Components are Installed On-Sight
DC-20/FC-50
MOUNTING OPTIONS MODEL NUMBER
NET WT. (POUNDS)
DESCRIPTION
MG-WP-A MG-WP-B
WALL MOUNTING POST - POST TUBING WALL MOUNTING POST - RAILING SECTION TUBING
MG-KIT
CONCRETE ANCHOR BOLTS (4 ANCHORS)
7 8
SINGLE RAIL STRAIGHT POST model MG-SP-1
DOUBLE RAIL Corner Post model MG-CP-36-2
4 DC-20/FC-50
Adjustable Steel Safety Railings
RAILING SECTION series MG-R
wall mount series MG-WP
The Adjustable Railing can be used to create walking paths or as a sliding gate for continuous run handrail systems. 1¾" square tubing is painted safety yellow for high visibility. Unit stands 42" high and has a 21" midrail. Optional 96" long toe board is available. Safety yellow powder coat finish. MODEL NUMBER
ASR-96 ASR-96-4-TB
DESCRIPTION
SERVICE RANGE
NET WT. (POUNDS)
WITHOUT TOEBOARD WITH 4" HIGH TOEBOARD
96" TO 168" 96" TO 168"
54 61 DC-20/FC-50/150
Heavy Duty Column Protectors Two-piece design for protecting in-plant columns and other vertical support members. Hardware is included to connect both pieces together. Heavy duty welded steel construction. Each base plate includes (4) pre-drilled mounting holes. Concrete installation hardware sold separately. Powder coat safety yellow finish. MODEL NUMBER
CGP-24 CGP-36 CGP-48 CGP-ABK
HEIGHT
INSIDE WIDTH
INSIDE LENGTH
NET WT. (POUNDS)
24" 20" 20" 36" 20" 20" 48" 20" 20" CONCRETE ANCHOR BOLTS (8) 3/4" x 4"
132 150 168 4 DC-20/FC-50
Gantry/Jib Guards Prevent costly damage to steel columns, pipe and tubing from carts and fork trucks. Solid steel design is constructed of 1/2" thick material for maximum strength. Ideal for fixed jibs and gantry cranes. Mounting plate measures 16" wide by 13½" deep and features (6) pre-drilled mounting holes. MODEL NUMBER CG-42 CG-ABK
INSIDE INSIDE OVERALL WIDTH DEPTH HEIGHT 11" 10½" 42" CONCRETE ANCHOR BOLTS (6) 3/4" x 4"
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
NET WT. (POUNDS) 150 4 DC-20/FC-50
345
MATERIAL HANDLING Column Protectors Structural Column Protectors Provide wrap around protection to columns, pipes and tubing to prevent damage. Constructed of UV protected polyethylene. Units can be stacked two high. Easy to assemble with fasteners included.
MODEL NUMBER
HEAVY DUTY VB-6 VB-8 VB-10 VB-12 VB-8-10 VB-9R LIGHT DUTY VBS-3 VBS-4 VBS-5 VBS-6
INSIDE OPENING
OUTSIDE WIDTH
OVERALL HEIGHT
CAPACITY )POUNDS(
NET WT. (POUNDS)
6" SQUARE 8" SQUARE 10" SQUARE 12" SQUARE 8" x 10" RECTANGLE 9" ROUND
26" 26" 26" 26" 26" 26"
42" 42" 42" 42" 42" 42"
7000 @ 6 MPH 7000 @ 6 MPH 7000 @ 6 MPH 7000 @ 6 MPH 7000 @ 6 MPH 7000 @ 6 MPH
46 46 46 46 46 46
3" SQUARE 4" SQUARE 5" SQUARE 6" SQUARE
12" 12" 12" 12"
42" 42" 42" 42"
N/A N/A N/A N/A
18 18 18 18 DC-20/FC-250
Pipe and Downspout Protectors Protect down spouts and pipes attached to buildings from damage caused by fork trucks, vehicles and mowers. Our Steel Down Spout Guards fit around standard down spouts. The Poly Pipe Protector fits pipes up to 5" diameter. Easy bolt on installation - installation hardware not included. Choose steel for optimum strength or polyethylene for protection with deflection. Steel model is powder coated safety yellow.
MODEL NUMBER
MATERIAL
INSIDE )W x D(
OVERALL SIZE )W x D x H(
NET WT. (POUNDS)
VPP-5R *DSG-48
POLYETHYLENE STEEL
5" x 5" 6" x 6"
12" x 6" x 42" 10" x 6½" x 42"
6 63
DC-20/UPS/FC-250/FC-50
model VPP-5R
model DSG-48
Polyethylene Rack Protector Protect pallet racking from damage with rugged polyethylene protectors. Easy installation with quick velcro mount or concrete lag to the ground hardware included. Safety yellow color increases visibility. MODEL NUMBER
MATERIAL
USABLE OPENING SIZE
OVERALL SIZE )W x L x H(
VRP-18
POLYETHYLENE
3½"
4½" x 8" x 18"
NET WT. (POUNDS)
3 DC-20/UPS/FC-250
Rack Guard with Rubber Bumper Insert Protect pallet racking with durable wrap around protection. Fits pallet rack measuring 3" wide by 3¾" deep. Increase pallet rack column strength on impact by over 100%. Includes rubber bumper insert, 1/2" thick, and hardware. Easy to install with wrench or socket. No concrete drilling required. Steel construction. Powder coat safety yellow finish. MODEL NUMBER
MATERIAL
USABLE OPENING )W x D(
OVERALL HEIGHT
RUD-24
STEEL
3" x 3¾"
24"
NET WT. (POUNDS)
19 DC-20/UPS/FC-60
346
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Rack Guards
MATERIAL HANDLING
Low Profile Rack Guards Protect pallet racking and wall corners against damage from fork trucks, pallet trucks and carts with Low Profile Rack Guards. All components are laser cut. Quick and easy two-hole installation. Installs in half the time of other guards with two bolt holes. Safety yellow powder coat finish. Steel construction. Mounting kit sold separately. MODEL NUMBER
OVERALL HEIGHT
NPG4-12 NPG4-18 NPG4-24 NPG4-36 NPG6-12 NPG6-18 NPG6-24 NPG6-36 NPG-ABK
USABLE OPENING )W x D(
OVERALL BASE )W x D(
NET WT. (POUNDS)
12" 4¼" x 1" 8" x 3" 18" 4¼" x 1" 8" x 3" 24" 4¼" x 1" 8" x 3" 36" 4¼" x 1" 8" x 3" 12" 6¼" x 1" 10" x 3" 18" 6¼" x 1" 10" x 3" 24" 6¼" x 1" 10" x 3" 36" 6¼" x 1" 10" x 3" CONCRETE ANCHOR BOLTS (2) 3/4" x 4"
6 9 12 18 8 11 14 20 2 DC-20/UPS/FC-50 LOW PROFILE RACK GUARDS series NPG
Structural Rack Guards Economical way to protect against damage to pallet racking and wall corners. Constructed of 6" or 8" structural steel “C” channel. Available with or without a rubber bumper. Easy to install to concrete surface. Four mounting holes for maximum stability. Safety yellow powder coat finish. Installation hardware sold separately. STRUCTURAL RACK GUARDS MODEL NUMBER
OVERALL HEIGHT
USABLE OPENING )W x D(
OVERALL BASE )W x D(
NET WT. (POUNDS)
G6-12 12" 4-1/2" x 4" 7-5/8" x 6" G6-18 18" 4-1/2" x 4" 7-5/8" x 6" G6-24 24" 4-1/2" x 4" 7-5/8" x 6" G6-36 36" 4-1/2" x 4" 7-5/8" x 6" G8-12 12" 6-1/2" x 4" 9-5/8" x 6" G8-18 18" 6-1/2" x 4" 9-5/8" x 6" G8-24 24" 6-1/2" x 4" 9-5/8" x 6" G8-36 36" 6-1/2" x 4" 9-5/8" x 6" STRUCTURAL RACK GUARDS WITH RUBBER BUMPERS G6-12-B 12" 4-1/2" x 4" 7-5/8" x 6" G6-18-B 18" 4-1/2" x 4" 7-5/8" x 6" G6-24-B 24" 4-1/2" x 4" 7-5/8" x 6" G6-36-B 36" 4-1/2" x 4" 7-5/8" x 6" G8-12-B 12" 6-1/2" x 4" 9-5/8" x 6" G8-18-B 18" 6-1/2" x 4" 9-5/8" x 6" G8-24-B 24" 6-1/2" x 4" 9-5/8" x 6" G8-36-B 36" 6-1/2" x 4" 9-5/8" x 6" G-ABK CONCRETE ANCHOR BOLTS (4) 3/4" x 4"
10 16 22 28 16 21 30 38
STRUCTURAL RACK GUARDS series G
17 25 34 46 28 38 51 71 4 DC-20/UPS/FC-50 STRUCTURAL RACK GUARDS WITH RUBBER BUMPERS series G-B
Corner Guards Protect busy corners, expensive machinery and personnel with 90° perpendicular protection. "SAFETY FIRST" promotion reminds personnel of the number one priority. Steel units include powder coat safety yellow finish. Aluminum unit is unfinished. MODEL NUMBER
PCG-16 PCG-24 PCG-24-A PCG-ABK
OVERALL HEIGHT
16" 24" 24"
OVERALL LENGTH
SIDE HEIGHT
MATERIAL
16" 8" STEEL 24" 12" STEEL 24" 12" ALUMINUM CONCRETE ANCHOR BOLTS (3) 3/4" x 4"
NET WT. (POUNDS)
30 35 18 2 DC-20/UPS/FC-50
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
347
MATERIAL HANDLING Corner Protectors Corner Protectors Heavy-duty corner protectors are designed to protect corners from damage. Extremely versatile protection for in plant, offices, overhead door frames and tracks or any 90° corner. Rubber Corner Protector with Steel Frame, model RSCP-BY-39. This unit includes a steel sub-frame assembly which bolts to the corner. The rubber cover is then slipped over the steel sub-frame. Includes drywall anchors to secure steel sub-frame to corner. Projection is ½". Rubber Corner Protector, model RCP-B-BY, features black and yellow stripes for increased visibility. Includes (6) mounting holes to secure unit to wall. Hole diameter is 3/16". Corner Protector, model VCP-40, is made of shock absorbing molded polyethylene construction. 2¼" thick with one flange edge measuring 6" and the other 8". Molded Rubber Corner Protectors, series MRCG, is made from black molded rubber. Includes reflective safety yellow tape for higher visibility. MODEL NUMBER
RCP-B-BY VCP-40 MRCG-20 MRCG-39
OVERALL HEIGHT
FLANGE WIDTH
DRYWALL ANCHORS
MATERIAL
NET WT. (POUNDS)
35½" 40½" 20" 39"
3" 6" & 8" 5½" 6"
INCLUDED NOT INCLUDED NOT INCLUDED NOT INCLUDED
RUBBER POLY RUBBER RUBBER
6 3 5 8
RSCP-BY-39
VCP-40
RCP-B-BY
DC-20/UPS MRCG-39
MRCG-20
Polyethylene Wall Protector Protect building walls from scratches and dents. This wall protector is weather resistant for use both indoors and outdoors. Constructed of molded polyethylene material. Safety yellow for high visibility. Features 3/8" counter sunk holes for anchor bolts. Hardware not included. MODEL NUMBER
DESCRIPTION
OVERALL )W x H(
PROJECTION
VBG-48
POLYETHYLENE
48" x 6¼"
2¼"
NET WT. (POUNDS)
6 DC-20/UPS/FC-250
Overhead Door Track Protectors Protect the tracks of overhead doors from fork trucks, pallet trucks and other traffic with these solid steel constructed, economical Overhead Door Track Protectors. The base plate is 6" square with a 3" notch out and 9/16" diameter mounting holes. Safety yellow powder coat finish for long term wear. Steel construction. MODEL NUMBER
DSP-24 DSP-36 DSP-48 DSP-ABK
BASE PLATE SPECIFICATIONS
HEIGHT
24" 36" 48"
MOUNTING HOLE DIAMETER
6" Square 3" Notch Out 9/16" 6" Square 3" Notch Out 9/16" 6" Square 3" Notch Out 9/16" CONCRETE ANCHOR BOLTS (3) ½" x 4"
NET WT. (POUNDS)
13 20 27 3 DC-20/UPS/FC-60
Economical Overhead Door Warning Barriers
WOOD STEEL
Protect overhead doors from fork trucks and other traffic coming and going throughout each day. Intended for use as a warning system - not a fork truck stop. Constructed with tubular steel uprights and a 4" x 4" wooden beam across the top of the guard. The wooden beam can be easily and inexpensively replaced when damaged. Guard will not interfere with overhead door. Complete unit is painted high visibility OSHA safety yellow. Concrete installation kit available. Custom sizes available. MODEL NUMBER
DWB-88 DWB-810 DWB-910 DWB-1010 DWB-ABK
USABLE DOOR ).WIDTH (FT
USABLE DOOR ).HEIGHT (FT
NET WT. (POUNDS)
COLOR
8 8 YELLOW 8 10 YELLOW 9 10 YELLOW 10 10 YELLOW CONCRETE ANCHOR BOLTS (8) ¾" x 6"
395 475 490 505 10 DC-20/FC-70
348
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Laundry CONTAINERS
MATERIAL HANDLING Roll Laundry Container
CADDIE ROLL container for laundry
with folding double half door Large capacity for a low price = excellent value. Demountable. Rust resistant electrogalvanized coating. Fitted with 2 fixed and 2 swivel castors of 125 mm dia. soft tread. Tested for loads of up to 500 kg.
D
C. Roll LAUNDRY CONTAINER H.1900 4.494.50.03 with folding double half door for progressive loading Overall dimensions: 715 x 810 x H 1900 mm. Usable dimensions: 650 x 750 x H 1705 mm. Unit weight: 51 kg. Capacity: 830 dm3. Roll LAUNDRY CONTAINER H.1700 4.494.54.03 with folding double half door for progressive loading Overall dimensions: 715 x 810 x H 1700 mm. Usable dimensions: 650 x 750 x H 1505 mm. Unit weight: 49 kg. Capacity: 730 dm3.
D. REMOVABLE FOLDING
C E
F
DOUBLE HALF DOOR Folds in half so container can be opened in two stages
E. Secure can be closed with seals
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628)
or padlocks.
F. Information plate for clear product identification. Can be personalized with your company logo or other information upon request.
TRANSMASSE LAUNDRY ROLL CONTAINER H
Heavy duty construction. Side panels securely bolted into place. Tested for loads of up to 500 kg. Rust resistant electrogalvanized coating. 125 mm .dia. castors, 2 fixed and 2 swivel TRANSMASSE ROLL LAUNDRY H.1900 1 door 2 1/2 doors Reference
4.492.80.03
4.492.19.03
Overall dim. in mm
715 x 810 x H 1910
Unit weight in kg
57
Capacity in dm3
57.5 820
TRANSMASSE ROLL LAUNDRY H.1700 1 door 2 1/2 doors Reference Overall dim. in mm Unit weight in kg I
4.492.78.03
4.492.55.03
715 x 810 x H 1710 52.5
Capacity in dm3
53 730
G Available with optional tow-bars and .a wide range of castors upon request
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
349
MATERIAL HANDLING LINEN Containers Linen carts c. CADDIE SECURITY LINEN ROLL CONTAINER High capacity. Fully demountable. Lockable for security. Doors open fully for easy access. Available with optional shelves for better storage.
accessories: SET OF 4 BUMPERS 4.495.97.58
C
Fits all the CADDIE linen roll containers. FLAT SHELF 4.495.03.03 Rust resistant electrogalvanized finish. Overall dimensions: 695 x 695 x H 40 mm.
c. CLOTH COVER 4.495.61.52 - H 1900 4.495.62.52 - H 1700 4.495.63.52 - H 1500 These covers have two zip-fasteners and identification pocket: 210 x 150 mm. D
E
d. Caddie Translinge LAUNDRY TROLLEY Heavy duty design. Rust resistant white ARPOXY finish. Equipped with 3 wood laminate shelves, 2 of which can be folded up for extra storage space. 4 independent front door panels. Corner mounted bumpers to protect interior dĂŠcor.
accessories: e. PLASTIC COVER 9.940.29.54 2 zip-fasteners.
TYPE SECURITY LINEN ROLL CONTAINER Translinge
350
Reference
Overall dim. in mm
Usable dim. in mm
H 1900
4.494.98.03
715 x 810 x H 1910
650 x 750 x H 1680
H 1700
4.494.77.03
715 x 810 x H 1740
650 x 750 x H 1500
H 1500
4.494.87.03
715 x 810 x H 1540
650 x 750 x H 1300
9.940.20.50
805 x 555 x H 1840
680 x 450 x H 1610
Mesh in mm Panels/doors Base
Unit weight in kg
Safe load in kg
Capacity in dm3
500
725
51 50 x 100
38 x 160
48
68 x 140 / 65 x 95
-
60
805
46
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
625 300
490
Hygienic Trolleys
MATERIAL HANDLING
CADDIE BACTAINER TROLLEY Polyethylene Nestable when empty. For transporting wet linen. Completely watertight. Equipped with a plughole. Supplied with a removable lid.
A. BACTAINER TROLLEY 180 l 4.465.28.50 Polyethylene A
B. BACTAINER TROLLEY 360 l 4.465.38.50 Polyethylene
B
CADDIE BACTAINER TROLLEY Rust proof anodized aluminium Lightweight, yet sturdy. Perfect for use in laundries.
C. BACTAINER TROLLEY 250 l 2.290.30.11 STANDARD aluminium model
C
For transporting wet linen. Equipped with a tap and perforated metal plate for better water drainage.
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628)
D. BACTAINER TROLLEY 280 l 2.290.40.11 Lightweight aluminium Spring loaded, self adjusting platform. Ergonomic design - no bending to retrieve laundry in bottom of trolley.
D
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
351
MATERIAL HANDLING Laundry Basket Trolleys for wet linen CADDIE LAUNDRY BASKET CART Heavy duty carts for damp laundry. Rust resistant white polyester finish.
E. STANDARD LAUNDRY BASKET CART 9.940.57.50 Stackable when empty to save space. 4 swivel castors for excellent handling. Resistant to corrosion and various detergents.
E
F. HIGH BASE LAUNDRY BASKET CART 9.940.67.50 Identical to the 9.940.57.50 except base is raised by 40 cm so items are easy to retrieve in bottom of basket. Heavy duty tubular steel raised base.
F
G. LIGHT DUTY LAUNDRY BASKET CART 9.940.56.50 Cost effective design. Stackable when empty to save space. 4 swivel castors for excellent handling. Resistant to corrosion and various detergents.
H. LIGHT DUTY HIGH BASE LAUNDRY BASKET CART 9.940.66.50 Cost effective design. Identical to the 9.940.56.50 except base is raised by 30 cm so items are easy to retrieve in bottom of basket. Sturdy steel rod construction G TYPE
Reference
kg Caddie Bactainer polyethylene
180 dm3
4.465.28.50
360 dm3
4.465.38.50
Caddie Bactainer aluminium
standard
2.290.30.11
self adjusting
2.290.40.11
standard
9.940.57.50
high base
9.940.67.50
Caddie LAUNDRY BASKET CART
352
standard
9.940.56.50
high base
9.940.66.50
H Frame
Overall dim. in mm
Usable dim. in mm
Castor dia. in mm
Weight in
Polyethylene with lid
840 x 635 x H 675
675 x 505 x H 545
2 fixed + 2 swiv. Ø 80
15
1140 x 725 x H 805
1010 x 610 x H 585
2 fixed + 2 swiv. Ø 160
34
1025 x 630 x H 730
980 x 580 x H 440
2 fixed + 2 swiv. Ø 200
30
1070 x 625 x H 800
950 x 555 x H 540
2 fixed + 2 swiv. Ø 125
34
Steel wire white polyester finish
820 x 615 x H 740
740 x 540 x H 600
4 swiv. Ø 100
16
820 x 615 x H 1000
740 x 540 x H 600
4 swiv. Ø 125
29
Steel wire white polyester finish
820 x 615 x H 740
740 x 540 x H 600
4 swiv. Ø 100
12
820 x 615 x H 930
740 x 540 x H 600
4 swiv. Ø 100
16
Anodised aluminium
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Laundry Carts
MATERIAL HANDLING
Versatile design for efficiently transporting absorbent undergarments, toiletries, linens, etc. Clean and well sorted presentation of linen and disposable items, medical products... • • • •
Heavy duty design: 22 mm steel tubing. Steel wire shelves and dividers. Easy to handle: 4 NYLOX swivel castors ø 125 mm. Fitted with 2 braked castors. Easy maintenance: POLYROC coating extremely resistant to chemicals and abrasion. Attractive design: Soft, eye-pleasing colours and pure lines make this functional trolley fit any interior décor.
a. DAY-CARE TROLLEYS 2.200.35.66 Large capacity to hold everything needed for day time care units. Overall dimensions : 650 x 1200 x H.1400 mm.
b. NIGHT-care trolley
A
2.200.36.66 Less products are needed for night care. This small size trolley has been specially designed for night-care, narrow corridors and care units with a reduced number of beds. Overall dimensions: 650 x 850 x H.1400 mm.
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628)
B
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
353
Theatre MATERIAL HANDLING Operating Equipment
STERI.CADDIE A complete system of carts, baskets, accessories and specialised supports designed for the operating theatre.
For the new generation of operating theatre design. In order to improve cleaning and disinfecting of an operating theatre, it must be emptied to a maximum. No more built-in equipment. Now, STERI.CADDIE offers you specialised carts for the theatre, supplies and removal of soiled articles.
354
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Operating Theatre Equipment
MATERIAL HANDLING Supply carts STERI.CADDIE CARTS 14 storage levels. Usable space between the levels: 100 mm. Minimum usable space: 87 mm. They are fitted as standard with 4 telescopic frames or sheet metal shelves. These carts may be adapted to a wide range of uses. • 18/10 stainless steel. • Monobloc construction. • Steel tube base frame: 20 x 40 mm. • Double sided with a storage space for tanks and standard baskets 6 x 3 x 3 or 6 x 3 x 1,5. • For transferring and storing products without unnecessary handling. • Levels adjustable at intervals of 100 mm. The telescopic frames and sheet metal shelves are removable. • 4 sets of 2 hooks per side. • Nylox casters ø 125 mm (2 of which braked).
STERI.CADDIE carts
B
With 4 telescopic frames
2.222.10.18
A
With 4 sheet metal shelves.
2.222.11.18
B
C. cart (without accessories) 2.220.87.18 18/10 stainless steel. Monobloc construction.
d. Telescopic frame 2.220.16.18
18/10 stainless steel.
Load capacity: 25 kg. Composed of a support frame and a sliding shelf.
A
e. Sheet metal shelf 2.220.19.18
18/10 stainless steel.
Load capacity: 25 kg. Electrolytically polished surface. The STERI.CADDIE carts are compatible with the MULTI.CADDIE shelving system.
C
D
E
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
355
MATERIAL HANDLING Luggage Trolleys CADDIE LUGGAGE TROLLEYS
HAND TRUCK
with retractable kick stand
HAND TRUCK with runners 9.972.70.11
70.11.
72.11.
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628)
9.972.71.11
CADDIE LUGGAGE HAND TRUCKS
Hand truck with kick stand
AR 407
Hand truck with runners
TYPE
356
Reference
Hand Red truck with stand Black
9.972.70.11
Hand tr. w. runners
9.972.71.11
9.972.72.11
AR 407
9.964.07.01
EQUINOXE 27
9.964.27.01
EQUINOXE 29
9.964.29.01
FREECART
9.964.72.03
Suitcase capacity
6-7
3-4
-
EQUINOXE 27
EQUINOXE 29
Frame
Casters ø in mm
Nesting in cm
aluminum
ø 250 inflatable
-
chrome
galvanized
ø 125
26,5
ø 125 front ø 200 rear
33,5
ø 125
28 26
These light-weight aluminium luggage hand trucks can carry 6 or 7 suitcases. Carpeted platform protects baggage. 250 mm inflatable tires for excellent handling indoors and outdoors. Folding platforms for easy storage.
HAND TRUCK WITH RETRACTABLE KICK STAND Only 320 mm deep when folded . Retractable kick stand for easy horizontal loading. 9.972.70.11 available with either red or black carpet.
HAND TRUCK WITH RUNNERS Practical runners for easy loading and for use with steps. Eases transporting baggage up steps. Ergonomic hand grips.
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Luggage Trolleys
MATERIAL HANDLING Trolleys for guest use
AR 407
FREECART
EQUINOXE 29 EQUINOXE 27
9.964.07.01
9.964.72.03
9.964.27.01 9.964.29.01
TROLLEYS FOR GUEST USE
CADDIE PARK locking system for baggage trolleys.
EQUINOXE 27, EQUINOXE 29 and AR407.
Wall-mounted starting chain. 900 mm.
An ideal design, tested in hotels worldwide. EQUINOXE meets the rigorous requirements of all hotels. Heavy duty construction for tough environments. Excellent handling. For all types of luggage.
FREECART Light-weight construction for unexcelled maneuverability.
Ref 1.762.28.03 With mounting plate and key for CP locking systems
Sloped upper platform for easy loading.
CADDIE PARK starting arch. For indoors use Ref 7.763.68.01 Chrome finished steel tubing. Fitted with a starting chain with key for CP locking systems
Load capacity: 70 kg
Unit weight: 15 kg
Compact and nestable to save valuable floor space when stored.
- Capacity: up to 4 pieces of luggage - Upper basket for hand luggage with practical bag hook. - Optimal nesting to save floor space. - Bumper protects interior decor. - Large advertising space. - Available in rust resistant electro galvanized zinc finish + colorless varnish (03) or chrome plated (01).
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
357
MATERIAL HANDLING ROLL CONTAINERS CADDIE ROLL CONTAINERS
Demountable Roll STANDARD
Demountable Roll E
Nestable Roll Z-Frame STANDARD
Demountable Roll EP
Nestable Roll Z-Frame SECURITY
Demountable Roll SECURITY
Nestable Roll A-Frame STANDARD
Monobody Roll TRANSMASSE
Nestable Roll A-Frame SECURITY
CADDIE TRANSTOCK & ROULSTAR TROLLEYS
Transtock H.1100
Transtock H.1900
Transfrais
Roulstar H.1100
Roulstar H.1900
Roulstar for Long Loads
STORAGE AND TRANSPORT
Pallet converter
Cage pallet
Container
Cage pallet for bottles
Stackable hyper baskets Stackable baskets
LIGHT HANDLING
Basket carts
358
Service carts
Little carts
Transcaddie E
Transcaddie P
Dollies
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Master Inox
Roll Container
MATERIAL HANDLING
Roll CADDIE BUILT TO LAST
PRODUCT ADVANTAGES Drain hole. Rain water drains out. Clear product identification. 2 long-lasting rubber straps Safety. No sharp or aggressive edges. Profiled safety tubing. Patented Anti-distortion base with heavy duty reinforced corners. Stable on hand trucks. Safe and easy to dismantle. Ergonomic foot hole simplifies removal of the side panels.
Quick and reliable assembly. Large choice of casters.
GENERAL FEATURES All CADDIE Roll Containers are : - - - -
Tested for loads of up to 500 kg. Electrogalvanized steel wire and tubing. Fitted with 2 fixed and 2 swivel casters. Can be delivered on request with 4 swivel casters.
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
359
MATERIAL HANDLING Roll Container Nestable CADDIE Z-frame nestable Roll containers SAVES SPACE SAVES TIME EASES FLEET MANAGEMENT.
Z-Frame STANDARD and SECURITY Roll containers. The Z-frame Roll containers are fitted with ø 100 mm casters with hard tread (2 fixed and 2 swivel). Upon request they can be fitted with ø 125 mm casters with soft or hard tread.
H.1500
H.1700
H.1900
Usable height 1300 mm
Usable height 1500 mm
Usable height 1670 mm
650
715
Type
Code Number
Weight(kg)
Code Number
Weight(kg)
Code Number
Weight(kg)
Standard
4.493.00.03
32
4.493.01.03
34
4.493.02.03
35
Security
4.493.50.03
49,5
4.493.51.03
52
4.493.52.03
54,5
740
820
200
Z-frame Roll container
1505/1695/1895
Anti-distortion base frame, heavy duty square tubing 80 x 40 mm. No sharp edges. Rust resistant : electrogalvanized coating. Standard Roll container shipped with 2 rubber straps. Wire mesh of the base frames : 30 x 100 mm. Security Roll container : wire mesh of the panels : 50 x 100 mm. Nesting length : 230 mm. 21 nested Roll containers = 6 m.
1300/1500/1670
Security Z-frame Roll container H.1900
Standard Z-frame Roll container H.1900
Accessories Docket holder. Securely riveted onto the metal identification plate.
Choice of shelves.
Wire, standard or heavy duty reinforced. Flat sheet metal.
360
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Roll Container Nestable
The Standard A-frame Roll container is shipped with 2 rubber straps.
MATERIAL HANDLING
Security A-frame Roll container with 2 half doors.
Accessories : Shelf and docket holder (to be ordered separately).
Delivered with 1 folding shelf. Rust resistant electrogalvanized coating. 2 fixed and 2 swivel casters. Nesting length : 250 mm. 10 nested trolleys : 3,06 m, ground surface required : 2,19 m2 Standard A-frame Roll container. ø 100 mm casters. Polypropylene. Wire mesh of the base frame : 70 x 50 mm Security A-frame Roll container. ø 125 mm casters. Low noise Sandwich Type. Wire mesh of base frame and shelves : 90 x 50 mm. Wire mesh of doors, side and back panels : 100 x 46 mm.
720
810
STANDARD A-frame Roll container Base grill and shelves fold up for easy nesting.
760
1650 / 1400
1900 / 1750
660
810
160
1887
1650
660
715
810
SECURITY A-frame Roll container The lateral panels and shelves fold for easy nesting.
Accessories Docket holder. 4.401.53.03 Securely riveted onto the metal identification plate.
Wire shelves.
Roll A-frame H.1700 H.1900
4.406.55.03 For Standard A-frame Roll container (removable) 4.406.07.03 For Security A-frame Roll container - - 4.490.30.03 40 Standard (fixed) Type
Code Number
Weight(kg)
Security 4.490.08.03 66 1 door
2 1/2 doors + 1 shelf
4.490.09.03
72
Code Number
Weight(kg)
4.490.10.03
69
4.490.15.03
75
Large choice of casters.
ø 100 or 125 mm casters with hard or soft tread.
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
361
MATERIAL HANDLING Stock Trolleys CADDIE Transtock trolleys A NEW GENERATION OF TROLLEYS FOR OPTIMAL HANDLING AND TRANSPORT
Monobody structure
All CADDIE TRANSTOCK trolleys are fitted with 2 side panels securely bolted onto the patented base with reinforced corners. The lid or lintels screw onto the side panels.
dimensions 3 1200 x 800 mm. 1250 x 640 mm. 1320 x 700 mm.
heights 2 1850 (usable 1635 mm) and 1040 (usable 835 mm). Electrogalvanized zinc coating. Sheet metal identification plates. Factory mounted onto both the side panels. Allows fixing of identification marks.
Wire mesh
Base : 115 x 50 mm. Panels and doors : 70 x 70 mm. Lid : 65 x 70 mm. Wire shelf : 35 x 165 mm.
No overlapping parts
Simplifies loading of the lorries and storing without damage.
Profiled safety tubing TESTED FOR LOADS OF
>
450
>
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628)
The profiled tubing prevents the sharp extremities of the welded wires from injuring users or damaging merchandise.
KG
Delivered unassembled. Casters and accessories are factory mounted. Easy to assemble
casters 4 ø 125 mm, low-noise «sandwich» type, 2 fixed and 2 swivel for smooth and silent running and reduced effort.
models available as standard 30 Trolley - open at front, - open on 2 sides - with doors and lid - with doors, open at the top - with wire shelves - with wooden shelves.
362
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
WEIGH SCALES mechanical suspened scales
MATERIAL HANDLING PS 250 LIGHT INDUSTRIAL WAREHOUSE / DESPATCH PLATFORM SCALE
• A basic suspended mechanical weigher for 100’s of every day applications. • Built with a shatterproof ABS case with high strength stainless steel fittings. • Capacities from 5-100 kg. • Available with a suspended stainless steel pan. 235-6s Single Hook / Dual Marked Suspended Scales
• PS250 Heavy Duty Low Profile Parcel / Platform Scale. • Suitable for Goods Received / Despatch / Checkweighing / Animal Weighing / Industrial / Produce Catering Scale. • Platform located on four large independently adjustable leveling feet, with rubber pads to give excellent stability. overload Protection is 100%. • Powered by Internal rechargeable batteries or from the mains adapter (supplied). • Key Functions On / Off / Tare Key Units / Hold. • Weighs in 250kg x 0.1kg / 550lb x 0.2lb / 8820 oz x 50z. • Quick Release Removable Head for Recharging and Storage. • Battery will give up to 12 hours continuous use before recharging. • Head supplied with wall mounting Bracket.
5 kg x 20 g (11 lb x 1 oz.) 10 kg x 50 g (22 lb x 2 oz.) 25 kg x 100 g (56 lb x 4 oz.) 50 kg x 200 g (110 lb x 8 oz.) 100 kg x 500 g (200 lb x 1 lb) Top and Bottom Hook + Round Pan (upto 25 kg)
Call us for full prices and details
Model
Capacity & Resolution
Dimensions
PS250 Heavy Duty
250 kg x 100 kg
550 mm (W) x
Platform Scale
550 lbs x 0.2 lb
900mm (H) x 60mm
pro dec medium capacity electronic platforms 0-2500kgs Mild Steel painted, Safety Tread pattern / Robust Construction with Sealed Junction Box.
parcel / warehouse scale • Low cost high weighing performance giving: checkweighing, counting, totalising functions. • Audible and visual checkweighing functions as standard. • Strong aluminum frame + base with stainless platfrom. • Indicator can be bench column mounted (with swivel) as standard large clear display. • Battery or mains powered as required display height 930 mm.
uilt to last-Steel Support •B Channels Welded under Top Plate. •A djustable Feet-Stainless Steel levelling Feet. •P ortable Design-Can be easily Relocated. •P rices includes Salter 750 Indicator and Calibration. •R amps Available (At Extra Charge).
S122 Capacity
Platform Size mm
60 kg x 10 g
370 x 520
150 kg x 20 g
370 x 520
150 kg x 20 g
460 x 600
300 kg x 50 g
460 x 600
1,000
1,000
84
115
1,220
1,220
84
154
• Stainless Options Available (At Extra Charge).
Length mm
Width mm
Height mm
Shipping Weight
Platform List Price
Minimum Trade Increments 0.2kg (to max of 1000kg) Minimum Trade Increments 0.5kg (to max of 2500kg)
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
363
PACKAGING Mini-packing station Packing and Workstation Systems New requirements at work call for new concepts in the design of ergonomic workstations. The new products presented in this catalogue are based on the 100 years of experience and extensive development expertise of Hüdig+Rocholz. As one of our highest-priority design principles, the aim of ergonomics is therefore to optimize the working environment in line with human motor functions. Simplified work procedures and the positioning of components within easy reach improves employee performance, efficiency and satisfaction. As the leading supplier of dispatch equipment, we offer mix-and-match system components to satisfy all our customers’ needs in terms of size and complexity – from individual workstations to large interlinked systems offering access to conveying equipment
Configurator With our Planning-Tool you will get a picture of your future System. Wether it will be a single workstation or a whole packing line.
kaging For pac ation st & work ns, solutio C8 -LO call 800
364
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Mini-packing station
PACKAGING
SYSTEM 1600 •
Adjustable for height 690-960 mm as standard
•
Reinforced worktop 30 mm
•
Light-grey laminated worktop
•
Table aprons in square steel tubing, 40 x 40 mm, red
RAL 2002
•
Steel drawer, anthracite RAL 7016
•
Stable document shelf
•
Cutting system for paper, cardboard and film with
proven technology (quick-change cartridge)
with document shelf and cardboard storage rack, cutting device with 2 interchangeable cartridges, cutting width 100 cm, spindle set complete with cones and brackets
with document shelf and cardboard storage rack, steel drawer, anthracite (RAL 7016), bottom shelf, 1145 x 650 x 18 mm
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628)
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
365
PACKAGING packing station SYSTEM 2000 SYSTEM 2000 is the best-selling professional packing table system and now offers even more flexibility. Corner solutions or interlinked systems permit numerous configurations, from individual workstations to complete packing lines. The modular design allows it to be dismantled or retrofitted at any time. On the SYSTEM 2000 everything is arranged ergonomically.
ltation, ee consu For a fr 800-5628 call
infinitely adjustable by crank or motor 710-960 mm • for use in shift work • for use with packing items of different sizes • for the convenient lifting and lowering of heavy packing items
366
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
packing station
PACKAGING
The System 2000 roller packing table • with work surface as a packing table • without work surface as a transport table • with an integrated scale by request
MULTI 2000, the universal, multifunctional workbench, assembly and packing table system. Based on over 100 years of experience in the field of workbenches and packing tables, these tables supplement the successful SYSTEM 2000. The compatibility and combination of different product lines makes the products suitable for new applications and the implementation of “streamlined processes“ e.g. by combining commissioning, assembly and packaging. The same workplace can perform several functions, and it can be adapted to changing requirements whenever necessary.
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
For a w ider se call 800 lection, -5628
367
PACKAGING QUALITY MANAGEMENT station VARIO SYSTEM Its flowing, dynamic lines will fit in with any modern shop display system. New materials and techical improvements put the VATIO SYSTEM at the top of the range when it comes to handling and safety. • timeless dynacic design • prctical single-hand operation thanks to highly stable frame • hinged tear-off bar and extended clamp makes changing rolls easy • spring-loaded bar for constant pressure and ease of tear • serrated tear-off bar for paper and film as standard For cust om solutio • for paper and film rolls measuring 30 to 100 cm in width and 24 cm in diameter, max, 20 kg ns, c a ll 8 0 • supporting components in high-quality polyamide, matt black 0-5628
368
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
QUALITY MANAGEMENT station
PACKAGING
Wrapping in the shop We also offer custom solutions based on an modular system that can be furnished with dispensers for giftwrap, film and ribbon as required. Worktops, drawers and utensil holders (for seissors, adhesive tape, bows, etc.) can also be added. the rear can be used for advertising purposes or product presentation.
Versatile and space-saving The MULTI-VARIO can be assembled yourself form the wall-mounted dispensers in the VARIO range stand for max 5paper or foil dispensers and 4 or 8 ribbon dispensers mobile, four casters, two of them lockable.
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628)
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
369
PACKAGING Packing Table Build the system that’s right for you
• Simple bloltless assembly • Levels are adjustable in height on a 50 mm vertical pitch • Stepped longitudinal beams and stepped cross beams • Finish pre-galvanised • Bay load capacity 400 kg. chipboards 19 mm • Shelves max. 200 kg, depth 400 mm • Working height packing table 970 mm Speed -Rack Packing Table Height mm
Width mm
Depth mm
No. of levels
Shelf load kg
Bay load kg
pre-galvanised
970
2000
800
2
400
800
97106
971
2500
800
2
400
800
97107
Speed -Rack Packing Table with tray
370
Height mm
Width mm
Depth mm
No. of levels
Shelf load kg
Bay load kg
pre-galvanised
1970
2000
800
4
400
800
97108
1970
2500
800
4
400
800
97109
• Planning information: Nominal sizes = actual sizes • All load capacity are uniformly distributed loads - udl. • Assembly only as starter bay construction
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
packaging Materials & equipment
PACKAGING
ECONOMY PACKING BENCH • Complete with 2 Reel Holders • Upper storage shelf - 200mm deep • Worktop Height: 915mm • 25mm thick MDF worktop & lower shelf
MB156M
• For ease of transport, the unit is supplied in two components • The upper back frame is supplied separately for bolting into position
Overall L x W mm
Overall Height mm
Lower Shelf Depth mm
Weight kg
Model
1525 x 610
1525
350
70
MB156M
1830 x 760
1525
350
85
MB187M
CARTON STANDS • These carton stands help keep boxes / packaging organized & clean • Model CA074Y is mobile on 4 x 50mm swivel castors • Subject to availability
CA074Y
Description CA075Z
Mobile Static
No. of Overall Divider Sections Size L x W Height 3 610mm 1117 x 457 mm 635mm 4
Weight kg 24
CA074Y
21
CA075Z
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Model
371
PACKAGING Packaging Bench & Equipment PACKING BENCH • Height adjustable from 760 to 1050mm • 25mm Laminated Particle Board worktop which can overhang the bench either side • Includes: • Upper Shelf with 6 dividing hoops • Upper & Lower roll holders • Max load 300kg, upper shelf 50kg
General Cutter
Equipment Bin
Item Worktop Size D x L mm 900 x 1800 900 x 2100
Frame Size D x L mm 900 x 1500 900 x 1800
Model PPH-918 PPH-921
Description
Cutter Length: 1500 mm General Cutter Overall Length: 1700 mm
Model PPL-170
NOT suitable for bubble wrap
Equipment Bin
Bin Size: 500 x 186 x 182 mm
PPH-TL
GR8 DISPO SAFETY KNIFE • High performance disposable knife • Blades last 4 times longer on average due to the unique moving action
Description
Colour
Model
GR8 Dispo - Pk 10
Yellow Handle
GPCDISPO
GPCDISPO
GR8 PRO SAFETY KNIFE • Virtually undestructable • High performance knife forheavy duty professional use • Ergonomically balanced Description
Colour
GR8 Pro Black Handle Replacement Blades - Pk 10
GPCPRO
Model GPCPRO GPCPROBL
DBX SAFETY KNIFE • Many safety features including: innovatively designed cartridge encasing the blade • The built in snapper breaks the blade & retains the broken segments inside the cartridge inside the cartridge • Protective hood is pushed away from the blade as it pierces the material being cut Description
Colour
DBX Blue Replacement Cartridge - Yellow
372
Model GPCDBX GPCDBXCA
GPCDBX
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
PACKAGING
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
373
SECURITY security carriers
Security WALLETS
• Ensure your money and confidential information remains secure in these durable wallets • Made from a high grade, flame-retardant material with double stitched seams • Incorporates a secure fine toothed brass zip • Colours: Dark Blue, Green, Red
reusable security pouch
• Ideal for heavyweight two-way transmission of documents provides tamper evident protection • Address window for quick and easy despatch • Provides protection for contents during transit • Franking slip fitment for Royal Mail usage • Colours: Dark Blue, Green, Red
Key wallets
• A flat style key wallet made from a high grade flame-retardant material • Strong, durable zip and chamber • Compliant with BS7499 Part 1 in respect of key control • Colours: Dark Blue, Green, Red
ENVOPAK CARRIER
• With handles for easy lifting and transporting • Health & Safety compliant with no sharp edges • Easier to store than traditional boxes or containers • Provides tamper evident protection • Colour: Blue
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628)
Security ‘M’ seals
• Provide tamper evident protection for mailing pouches. • Simple to use – snap in to place to seal, and break to open. • Numbered seals run consecutively. • Colours: Blue, White, Red
374
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
security seals
SECURITY
POSILOK
ENVO-TITE
PULL SECURE
OMEGA XL
POSIGRIP
POST GRIP
SLIK SEAL
BOLT SEAL : SNAPPER
METAL SEAL : POSICHECK
• Offers highly visible level of tamper evident protection • Raised grip surface facilitates application • “Click” sound signifies the seal has been applied correctly • Tail is visible when sealed to show that seal is locked • Colours: Blue, Yellow
• Large flag for increased printing area • Metal locking insert for maximum security • Smooth tail is suitable for circular apertures • 3 teeth on the reverse of the seal ensure a tight grip around a sack • Tear line provides for easy removal by hand • Recess hole in flag for feeding excess tail through • Secure laser marking allows for barcoding • Special printing subject to minimum order quantity of 25k • Colours: Blue, White
• Tearline allows for removal by hand • Grips tightly around the smallest of bags • Manufactured from nylon for high security applications • Colours: Red, Yellow
• Economical and simple seal with low breaking strength • Designed for use on fire extinguishers • Large clear numbers facilitates maintenance checking and identification • Tearline allows for removal by hand • Colours: Blue, Yellow, Green
• Intricate metal insert ensures maximum seal locking strength • Smooth strap enables speedy and efficient application • Narrow tail is suited to very small apertures • Colours: Yellow, White
• C-TPAT compliant High Security barrier seal • HM Customs & Excise accepted Group 1 • Brightly coloured for high visibility in all conditions • Plastic coating protects bolt from corrosion • Serial numbers lasered on both body and bolt for higher security • Patented locking mechanism offers extra protection • Only available in multiples of 250 • Colour: Yellow
• Simple pull up design allows for speedy application • Large clear numbers for easy identification • Tearline allows for removal by hand • Double locking chamber provides extra security • Recessed locking teeth prevents sore fingers when applying • Colours: Blue, Green
• Bag grip spikes provide additional security • Double locking teeth provide non-slip grip around bags • Complete with label holder for additional information • Large clear numbers for easy identification • Tearline allows for removal by hand • Colours: Blue, Yellow, Red
• Offers low level barrier protection • Serial numbers are permanently embossed for high security • Alignment holes facilitate and verify correct closure of seals • Sophisticated design ensures maximum protection against tampering • Visible tail indicates that seal has been applied • Colour: Silver/Red
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
375
WORKSHOP EQUIPMENTIndustrial Seating DRAUGHTING CHAIRS
ADJUSTABLE DRAUGHTMANS CHAIR WITH CASTORS
Tough wearing factory & office chairs which offer durability in the workplace Height adjustable, contoured back rest Seat gas height adjustment
FIXED FOOTREST DRAUGHTMANSCHAIR WITH GLIDES
SOFT, WASHABLE POLYURETHANE
FIXED FOOTREST
Description Adjustable Draughtmans Chair with Castors Fixed Footrest Draughtmans Chair with Glides
376
Seat Size W x D mm 455 x 430
Seat Height Adjustment Min / Max
Model
405 / 580
FC1
605 / 735
FC1/FC1/D-BASE
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Industrial Chairs
WORKSHOP EQUIPMENT
Uncompromising ergonomic design High quality materials & components 3colour options available for the upholstery Red
Grey
3 YEAR GUARANTEE
Blue
please specify when ordering
DX30 CHAIR
DX30 Chair
The chairs are very comfortable to sit on & offer excellent lumbar support Gas lift controls height adjustment The angle & height of the back rest is mechanically adjusted as wellas the tilt of the seat Seat Size: 445 x 455mm Back Rest Size: 370 x 275mm The padding is made from fireproof Foam DX35 High Chair with a high quality Polyester fabric with DAR Arm Rests Chair base is constructed from anodized Aluminium in Grey & Black Mobile on swivelling twin castors whichare braked when unloaded Arm rests are optional extras
DX30 CHAIR Construction is the same as the DX30 Chair but with longer gas struts
DX35 HIGH CHAIR Construction is the same as the DX32 Chair but includes a foot ring & floor glides for improved work safety
ESD protected versions available Call for Details
DX20PU CHAIR Construction is the same as the DX30 chair ,but with Black Polyurethane seat & back which have wear resistant & washable surfaces Seat Size: 370 x 425mm Back Rest Size: 350 x 265mm
DX25PU CHAIR Construction is the same as theDX20PU chair but with longergas struts & includes a foot ring &floor glides for improved work safety
DAR ARM RESTS DX20 PU Chair
Made from Steel & Black Polyurethane 80mm high range & 50mm depth range Can be set either forwards or backwards which will allow you to sit closer to a bench
Description Fabric Chair
DX25 PU High Chair with DAR Arm Rests
Seat Height Adjustment Min / Max mm
Model
400 / 540
DX30
450 / 650
DX32
Fabric High Chair
500 / 740
DX35
PU Chair
400 / 540
DX20PU
PU High Chair
490 / 730
DX25PU
Arm Rests for the above units - pairs For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
377
WORKSHOP EQUIPMENTmobile tool cabinet Sturdy, lightweight, mobile drawer cabinet which is especially suitable for tools.
Model
Drawers
Dimensions H x W x D (mm)
Net Wt.
81.000.XXX
7 Drawers Heights: 4 x 75 mm, 2 x 100 mm, 1 x 200 mm
956 x 725 x 500
53 kg
81.001.XXX
8 Drawers Heights: 4 x 75 mm, 4 x 100 mm
956 x 725 x 500
57 kg
81.002.XXX
9 Drawers Heights: 8 x 75 mm, 1 x 100 mm
956 x 725 x 500
60 kg
Where to put tools and materials so that you can reach them easily at any time? The Lista Caddy 20 allows them to be stored safely and moved quickly to your workplace. With its manageable dimensions, the Lista Caddy 20 fits into any workshop. It is available in three drawer configurations, providing ample space for even larger hand tools and power tools. Practical accessories can also be hung easily from the side panels, enabling the Lista Caddy 20 to carry everything where it is ready to use. Its impact-proof powder coating is available in a choice of 10 standard colours.
Full extension slides / running smoothness
Central locking
Plastic profi le cover
Like all Lista drawer cabinets, the Lista Caddy 20 is also fi tted with a central locking system as standard so that all drawers can be secured simultaneously.
The Lista Caddy 20 profi le cover plate is made of plastic and fi tted with convenient oddments compartments. The handle bars integrated on each side ensure ease of mobility.
Safety locking system
Accessories
Another valuable detail which you can count on with Lista Caddy 20 is individual drawer blocking. As soon as one drawer is opened, all others are locked. This revents the cabinet from tipping forward.
The Lista Caddy 20 can be fi tted with a spray can holder, a waste container, an additional rack or a paper roll holder. The accessory is simply attached to the side panel and can be replaced at any time.
Full extension slides / running smoothness
The smooth-running slides enable fully opening drawers ensuring access to the parts in the furthest corners. The drawers have a load capacity of 20 kg.
378
The smooth-running slides enable fully opening drawers ensuring access to the parts in the furthest corners. The drawers have a load capacity of 20 kg.
Safety through fl exible edge protection The rounded corners are made from two-ply abrasion-proof plastic, acting as buffers that minimise any damage from impact with other objects.
Central locking Like all Lista drawer cabinets, the Lista Caddy 20 is also fi tted with a central locking system as standard so that all drawers can be secured simultaneously.
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
WORKSHOP EQUIPMENT
mobile tool cabinet
Easy assembly Accessories can be attached to both sides of the rows of slots.
Pegboard with door The lockable door guarantees security for your tools. The pegboard can only be combined with the tool holders.
The 10 standard colours The three-digit colour code is a component of the article number. Always complete the article number of your order with the desired colour code (e.g. 81.000.020 for RAL 7035).
010. Light blue RAL 5012
020. Light grey RAL 7035
030. Reseda green RAL 6011
040. Capri blue RAL 5019
050. Grey metallic NCS S 6502-B
060. Black NCS S 9000-N
070. Ruby red RAL 3003
080. Pigeon grey NCS S 4502-B
090. Gentian blue RAL 5010
100. Signal blue RAL 5005
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
379
WORKSHOP EQUIPMENTdrawer cabinets Drawer Cabinets 75 kg : Width 564 mm, Depth 572 mm (27 x 27E) Height 850 mm
Height 850 mm
Height 850 mm
5 drawers (full extension) Heights: 100 mm, 3 x 150 mm, 200 mm
5 drawers (full extension) Heights: 2 x 100 mm, 150 mm, 2 x 200 mm
6 drawers (full extension) Heights: 50 mm, 2 x 100 mm, 2 x 150 mm, 200 mm
Model
380
Colour
Model
Colour
Model
14.256.0100
Light Blue ( RAL 5012 )
14.256.0200
Light Grey ( RAL 7035 )
Colour
14.254.0100
Light Blue ( RAL 5012 )
14.262.0100
Light Blue ( RAL 5012 )
14.254.0200
Light Grey ( RAL 7035 )
14.262.0200
Light Grey ( RAL 7035 )
Height 850 mm
Height 850 mm
Height 850 mm
6 drawers (full extension) Heights: 2 x 75 mm, 2 x 100 mm, 2 x 200 mm
7 drawers (full extension) Heights: 2 x 75 mm, 3 x 100 mm, 2 x 150 mm
8 drawers (full extension) Heights: 50 mm, 2 x 75 mm, 4 x 100 mm, 150 mm
Model
Colour
Model
Colour
Model
Colour
14.258.0100
Light Blue ( RAL 5012 )
14.252.0100
Light Blue ( RAL 5012 )
14.250.0100
Light Blue ( RAL 5012 )
14.258.0200
Light Grey ( RAL 7035 )
14.252.0200
Light Grey ( RAL 7035 )
14.250.0200
Light Grey ( RAL 7035 )
All drawers with full extension
Drawer front
Impact-resistant coating
Central locking system
Differential extensions guided without crossbars not only ensure perfect quiet running even under a high load of stored parts but also enable full extension.
The drawer handles are fi tted with end caps and are fl ush with the cabinet housing. This looks good – and helps avoid the risk of injury.
Lista Selection 75 is available in the two colours light blue (RAL 5012) and light grey (RAL 7035). Eco-friendly powder coating makes for an impact- and wearresistant surface.
All drawer cabinets are fi tted with a patented central locking system that secures all drawers simultaneously.
Unique: Lista Script
Lista 75 provides mobile cabinets
Safety locking system
Central locking
All drawers can be labelled cleanly and systematically using the innovative handle fitted with a transparent viewing window. The drawer partition materials also provide good labelling options.
Our mobile drawer cabinets are fi tted with retainer tops with raised edged on four sides, a black ribbed mat, a trolley handle and two pairs of castor supports with two fixed and two steering castors (nylon).
A single drawer safety locking device is fi tted as standard ensuring that once one drawer is pulled out, all other drawers are blocked. This eliminates the possibility of the cabinet tipping forward.
Like all Lista drawer cabinets, the Lista Caddy 20 is also fi tted with a central locking system as standard so that all drawers can be secured simultaneously.
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
drawer cabinets
WORKSHOP EQUIPMENT
Drawer Cabinets 200 kg : Width 717 mm, depth 725 mm (36 x 36E) Height 850 mm
Height 850 mm
Height 850 mm
5 drawers (full extension) Heights: 50 mm, 2 x 100 mm, 200 mm, 300 mm
7 drawers (full extension) Heights: 2 x 75 mm, 3 x 100 mm, 2 x 150 mm
8 drawers (full extension) Heights: 50 mm, 2 x 75 mm, 4 x 100 mm, 150 mm
Model
Colour
Model
Colour
Model
Colour
14.505.0100
Light Blue ( RAL 5012 )
14.503.0100
Light Blue ( RAL 5012 )
14.502.0100
Light Blue ( RAL 5012 )
14.505.0200
Light Grey ( RAL 7035 )
14.503.0200
Light Grey ( RAL 7035 )
14.502.0200
Light Grey ( RAL 7035 )
Height 1000 mm
Height 1000 mm
Height 1000 mm
6 drawers (full extension) Heights: 50 mm, 3 x 150 mm, 2 x 200 mm
6 drawers (full extension) Heights: 100 mm, 4 x 150 mm, 200 mm
8 drawers (full extension) Heights: 2 x 75 mm, 3 x 100 mm, 3 x 150 mm
Model
Colour
Model
Colour
Model
Colour
14.510.0100
Light Blue ( RAL 5012 )
14.509.0100
Light Blue ( RAL 5012 )
14.506.0100
Light Blue ( RAL 5012 )
14.510.0200
Light Grey ( RAL 7035 )
14.509.0200
Light Grey ( RAL 7035 )
14.506.0200
Light Grey ( RAL 7035 )
Height 1450 mm
Height 1450 mm
Height 1450 mm
9 drawers (full extension) Heights: 2 x 75 mm, 2 x 100 mm, 2 x 150 mm, 2 x 200 mm, 300 mm
9 drawers (full extension) Heights: 3 x 100 mm, 5 x 150 mm, 300 mm
10 drawers (full extension) Heights: 50 mm, 5 x 100 mm, 4 x 200 mm
Model
Colour
Model
Colour
Model
Colour
14.511.0100
Light Blue ( RAL 5012 )
13.106.0100
Light Blue ( RAL 5012 )
14.512.0100
Light Blue ( RAL 5012 )
14.511.0200
Light Grey ( RAL 7035 )
13.106.0200
Light Grey ( RAL 7035 )
14.512.0200
Light Grey ( RAL 7035 )
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
381
WORKSHOP EQUIPMENTDRAWER CABINETS Lista Premium universal cabinet
Universal cabinet with hinged doors (Hinged door total height or part height) 2 base areas 717 × 600 mm (36 × 27E) 717 × 753 mm (36 × 36E) 2 heights 1000 mm, 1450 mm
Universal cabinet with sliding doors 2 base areas 1430 × 627 mm (twice 36 × 27E) 1430 × 780 mm (twice 36 × 36E) 1 height 1000 mm
Lista Premium universal cabinets with hinged doors, sliding doors or roller shutters allow you to store large volumes of materials in a small space. As they can be equipped with any combination of drawers, pull-out shelves and adjustable shelves, they can be configured perfectly to suit their purpose.
Universal cabinet with roller shutters 1 base area 1038 × 691 mm (54 × 27E) 2 heights 1450 mm, 1950 mm
382
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
DRAWER CABINETS
WORKSHOP EQUIPMENT Lista Premium drawer storage walls
Side frame The extremely stable side frame afford the drawer storage walls a high loadbearing capacity. The framework can be lined with side panels at the end of a row of shelving.
Drawers with full extension The differential extension, guided without a crossbeam, ensures that the drawers and shelves slide in and out with perfect silence, even when the materials in or on them are very heavy. The drawers are available with different load capacities (200 kg or 75 kg).
Heavy-duty pull-out drawers Heavy-duty pull-out drawers also run extremely quietly, even with a heavy load inside. Load capacity up to 350 kg.
Adjustable and universal shelves The adjustable shelves (load capacity 200 kg) are attached to the side frames by means of shelf supports whereas the universal shelves (load capacity 250 kg) are bolted to the side frames. The shelves are available plain or slotted for the purposes of partitioning with dividers.
Pull-out shelves with full extension For the storage of heavy components and devices. The goods can be stored flush with the handle by inserting sheet steel strips. Maximum load capacity, 200 kg.
Special installations for mobile equipment Mobile workshops have to be able to withstand stressful conditions. To protect both the equipment and the goods transported in it from damage, Lista uses various safeguards and safety mechanisms, such as folding fronts (figure), pull-out shelves with eyes or safety rods.
Shelf side panels They block off the sides of adjustable and universal shelves.
Lockability Lista drawer storage walls can be equipped with lockable roller shutters and hinged doors.
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
383
WORKSHOP EQUIPMENTDRAWER CABINETS Lista Selection 20/35 : The complete product line
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628)
Comprehensive product line Drawer cabinets, workbenches, hinged door and roller shutter cabinets, everything you need in one range: that’s Lista Selection 20/35. Workbenches are available with top heights of 900 mm or 850 mm. Drawer cabinets as well as hinged door and roller shutter door cabinets can be adapted to both heights. The appearance of the workbench tops and covers, too, can be uniformly and aesthetically combined. This ensures a clean continuity throughout the entire product line.
Perfect surface The two colours light blue (RAL 5012) and light grey (RAL 7035) are available as standard colours for the cabinet and the legs. Ecofriendly powder coating makes for an impactand wear-resistant surface. The drawers are dip-painted. This ensures complete corrosion protection.
384
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
DRAWER CABINETS
WORKSHOP EQUIPMENT
We offer a variety of options not only in the choice of colour, but also in the choice of covers and workbench tops. The options are wood (multiplex, beech) or laminate (black), for the mobile drawer cabinets; black plastic profi le tops are also available. The free combination of colours and covers a compelling aestehtic experience.
The clear design and versatile drawer partition material allow arrangements which are perfectly suitable for the parts to be stored.
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
385
WORKSHOP EQUIPMENT WORKBENCHES Workbenches : Length 1500 / 2000 mm, depth 750 / 800 mm, height 840 / 850 mm Measurements (all values in millimetres)
Multiplex Top
All workbenches of 750 mm depth are delivered with a multiplex top, 40 mm thickness (length options 1500 mm or 2000 mm). Product specifi cation: steam-treated beech veneer, waterproof glued multi-layer, edges bevelled, surface planed and oiled. The top is resistant to spray water, dirt and largely resistant to oil and grease.
Beech Top
All workbenches of 800 mm depth are delivered with a beech top, 50 mm thickness (length options 1500 mm or 2000 mm). Product specifi cation: steam-treated beech strips, waterproof glued, edges bevelled, surface planed and oiled. The top is resistant to spray water, dirt and largely resistant to oil and grease. Note: Wood is a natural material. Therefore, colour variations are possible. Temperature fluctuations or a change in humidity may in some cases cause the workbench top to bow slightly.
2 legs, top, suspended drawer cabinet W564 x D725 x H383 mm (27 x 36E)
Suspended drawer cabinet (Selection 75): 3 drawers (full extension) Heights: 50 mm, 100 mm, 150 mm
Model
Length (mm)
Depth (mm)
Height (mm)
Top Type
Colour
59.005.0100
1500
750
840
Multiplex
Light blue (RAL 5012)
59.005.0200
1500
750
840
Multiplex
Light grey (RAL 7035)
59.007.0100
2000
750
840
Multiplex
Light blue (RAL 5012)
59.007.0200
2000
750
840
Multiplex
Light grey (RAL 7035)
59.213.0100
1500
800
850
Beech
Light blue (RAL 5012)
59.213.0200
1500
800
850
Beech
Light grey (RAL 7035)
59.215.0100
2000
800
850
Beech
Light blue (RAL 5012)
59.215.0200
2000
800
850
Beech
Light grey (RAL 7035)
Model
Length (mm)
Depth (mm)
Height (mm)
Top Type
Colour
40.970.0100
1500
750
840
Multiplex
Light blue (RAL 5012)
40.970.0200
1500
750
840
Multiplex
Light grey (RAL 7035)
40.972.0100
2000
750
840
Multiplex
Light blue (RAL 5012)
40.972.0200
2000
750
840
Multiplex
Light grey (RAL 7035)
39.719.0100
1500
800
850
Beech
Light blue (RAL 5012)
39.719.0200
1500
800
850
Beech
Light grey (RAL 7035)
39.721.0100
2000
800
850
Beech
Light blue (RAL 5012)
39.721.0200
2000
800
850
Beech
Light grey (RAL 7035)
1 leg, top, drawer cabinet W564 x D725 x H800 mm (27 x 36E)
Drawer cabinet (Selection 75): 5 drawers (full extension) Heights: 50 mm, 2 x 100 mm, 150 mm, 300 mm
Perfect surface The two colours light blue (RAL 5012) and light grey (RAL 7035) are available as standard colours for the cabinet and the legs. Ecofriendly powder coating makes for an impactand wear-resistant surface. The drawers are dip-painted. This ensures complete corrosion protection.
386
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
workbenches
WORKSHOP EQUIPMENT
Model
Length (mm)
Depth (mm)
Height (mm)
Top Type
40.961.0100
1500
750
840
Multiplex
Light blue (RAL 5012)
40.961.0200
1500
750
840
Multiplex
Light grey (RAL 7035)
40.963.0100
2000
750
840
Multiplex
Light blue (RAL 5012)
40.963.0200
2000
750
840
Multiplex
Light grey (RAL 7035)
88.141.0100
1500
800
850
Beech
Light blue (RAL 5012)
88.141.0200
1500
800
850
Beech
Light grey (RAL 7035)
88.143.0100
2000
800
850
Beech
Light blue (RAL 5012)
88.143.0200
2000
800
850
Beech
Light grey (RAL 7035)
2 legs, top
Colour
2 legs, top, workbench drawer Model
Length (mm)
Depth (mm)
Height (mm)
Top Type
40.934.0100
1500
750
840
Multiplex
Light blue (RAL 5012)
40.934.0200
1500
750
840
Multiplex
Light grey (RAL 7035)
40.936.0100
2000
750
840
Multiplex
Light blue (RAL 5012)
40.936.0200
2000
750
840
Multiplex
Light grey (RAL 7035)
59.189.0100
1500
800
850
Beech
Light blue (RAL 5012)
59.189.0200
1500
800
850
Beech
Light grey (RAL 7035)
59.191.0100
2000
800
850
Beech
Light blue (RAL 5012)
59.191.0200
2000
800
850
Beech
Light grey (RAL 7035)
2 legs, top, suspended drawer cabinet W564 x D725 x H533 mm (27 x 36E)
Suspended drawer cabinet (Selection 75): 4 drawers Heights: 50 mm, 2 x 100 mm, 1 x 200 mm
Colour
Model
Length (mm)
Depth (mm)
Height (mm)
Top Type
Colour
59.019.0100
1500
750
840
Multiplex
Light blue (RAL 5012)
59.019.0200
1500
750
840
Multiplex
Light grey (RAL 7035)
59.040.0100
2000
750
840
Multiplex
Light blue (RAL 5012)
59.040.0200
2000
750
840
Multiplex
Light grey (RAL 7035)
59.008.0100
1500
800
850
Beech
Light blue (RAL 5012)
59.008.0200
1500
800
850
Beech
Light grey (RAL 7035)
59.013.0100
2000
800
850
Beech
Light blue (RAL 5012)
59.013.0200
2000
800
850
Beech
Light grey (RAL 7035)
Model
Length (mm)
Depth (mm)
Height (mm)
Top Type
59.039.0100
1500
750
840
Multiplex
Light blue (RAL 5012)
59.039.0200
1500
750
840
Multiplex
Light grey (RAL 7035)
59.041.0100
2000
750
840
Multiplex
Light blue (RAL 5012)
59.041.0200
2000
750
840
Multiplex
Light grey (RAL 7035)
59.009.0100
1500
800
850
Beech
Light blue (RAL 5012)
59.009.0200
1500
800
850
Beech
Light grey (RAL 7035)
59.014.0100
2000
800
850
Beech
Light blue (RAL 5012)
59.014.0200
2000
800
850
Beech
Light grey (RAL 7035)
Top, 2 drawer cabinets W564 x D725 x H800 mm (27 x 36E)
Workbench drawer: 1 drawer (full extension) Height: 150 mm
1 leg, top, drawer cabinet W564 x D725 x H800 mm (27 x 36E)
Colour
Drawer cabinet (Selection 75): 4 drawers (full extension) Heights: 2 x 100 mm, 200 mm, 300 mm
Model
Length (mm)
Depth (mm)
Height (mm)
Top Type
59.051.0100
2000
750
840
Multiplex
Light blue (RAL 5012)
59.051.0200
2000
750
840
Multiplex
Light grey (RAL 7035)
59.018.0100
2000
800
850
Beech
Light blue (RAL 5012)
59.018.0200
2000
800
850
Beech
Light grey (RAL 7035)
Left drawer cabinet (Selection 75): 5 drawers (full extension) Heights: 50 mm, 2 x 100 mm, 150 mm, 300 mm
Colour
Right drawer cabinet (Selection 75): 4 drawers (full extension) Heights: 2 x 100 mm, 200 mm, 300 mm
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
387
WORKSHOP EQUIPMENT WORKBENCHES
A flexible system meets your needs in regard to quality, efficiency and load: the modular workbench system
Save space, make room, utilise every square centimetre and set up surroundings under and over the work surface which are oriented towards the entire work process. The planning of your workstations is determined very strictly by the needs you define. The selection available on the way to an optimum workstation is extremely broad. It’s worth viewing your own needs from the perspective of our specialists. We will be happy to assist you in your order with advice and help. Whether considering the rear panel, working height or labelling: Lista Premium guarantees you an ergonomic workplace designed according to the most up-to-date information.
388
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
workbenches
WORKSHOP EQUIPMENT
Lista Premium workbenches ( Tailor-made for your work )
Workbench leg assemblies Uniform structural load-bearing capacity is 400 kg. The strong sheet steel construction of our workbenches can take a lot. It was developed by Lista for the attaching of workbench tops, storage shelves and fl oor anchors. If requested we offer a height-adjustable variation.
Support pillars Bearing function: Lista support pillars are mounted directly on the table top or stabilisation profile using the included fastening materials (only for bench depth 800 mm). The support pillars made of steel profi les are designed for the holding of components..
Shelves with raised edging More area: The MDF board with three-sided, 8 mm protruding beech raised edging has a colourless priming all round. With the matching bracket made of rectangular steel tubing, your work surface can be additionally vertically adjusted to four levels.
Drawer cabinets Everything ready to hand: Proven Lista drawer cabinets are an ideal addition to your workbench.
Plain shelves and dividers We offer smooth shelves and also slotted plain shelves for partitioning with dividers. You can also order slip-resistant ribbed mats.a
Container strip mountings and storage bins These strip mountings can be hooked in simply and are suitable for polyethylene storage bins of the sizes 2, 3 and 4.
Rear panels Create more space quickly: Lista rear panels can be hung on the support pillars without screws. Rear panels are perforated to hold tool holders and hooks.
Diverse tops Multiplex, beech, urphen or hard laminate tops are available. You’ll fi nd a suitable top surface with us for every purpose, each with its own special characteristics and advantages.
Storage shelves The multiplex top for your storage shelf is pre-drilled and includes fastening materials.
The workbench tops
Multiplex top
Urphen top
Beech top
This workbench top, made of steamed beech veneers, is suitable for general purpose work. It is glued in multiple layers and waterproof. The edges are bevelled, the surfaces are sanded and oiled.
If you need an assembly or inspection station in your workshop, then the workbench top made of pressureresistant, durable urphen with scratchproof UV coating is the right one for you.
This workbench top, made of steamed beech beams is suitable not only just for heavy-duty work in steel and machine construction, but also as a work surface in metalworking shops, automobile workshops or in schools.
Hard laminate top
In the laboratory, electronics area, for the office and desks you can depend on our hard laminate top. It is resistant to most chemicals. Its structured surface is easy to clean. The upper surface with hard laminate is 0.7 mm thick.
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
389
WORKSHOP EQUIPMENTMEDIUM DUTY BENCHES Benches Medium Duty Designed to meet the requirements of the assembly and workshop environments. • Available in a range of seven bench sizes with the choice of 3 styles of work tops and matching optional lower shelves (see page 83 for details). • The fully welded bench frames, with the legs produced from 60 x 30 x 1.6 mm RHS, are finished in stove enamel grey. • Benches are produced with a worktop height of 840 mm and fitted with adjustable feet to ensure a level work surface. • The lockable drawers and cupboard fronts are available in four stove enamel finish colours. Red Blue Green Grey Please specify when ordering. Optional Accessories • For additional 1, 2, 3 or 4 lockable drawer units and cupboards, plus other factory fitted accessories, please see optional extras. Medium Duty Work Top Options • 28 mm thick Vinyl faced blockboard with hardwood edging. • 25 mm thick laminated blockboard with hardwood edging. • 28 mm thick plastic laminated blockboard faced with Warerite or similar grey surface with formed edges.
AB157W shown with a range of optional extras.
Medium duty bench only
Medium duty bench complete with single lockable drawer
AB157W Top Options Length Width 1200 750 mm mm 900 mm 1500 750 mm mm 900 mm 610 mm 1800 750 mm mm 900 mm
AB257W 28 mm Vinyl Model Price AB127L POA AB129L POA AB157L POA AB159L POA AB186L POA AB187L POA AB189L POA
25 mm Blockboard Model Price AB127P POA AB129P POA AB157P POA AB159P POA AB186P POA AB187P POA AB189P POA
28 mm Warerite Model Price AB127W POA AB129W POA AB157W POA AB159W POA AB186W POA AB187W POA AB189W POA
Top Options Length Width 1200 750 mm mm 900 mm 1500 750 mm mm 900 mm 610 mm 1800 750 mm mm 900 mm
Medium duty bench complete with lockable cupboard
AB357W Top Options Length Width 1200 750 mm mm 900 mm 1500 750 mm mm 900 mm 610 mm 1800 750 mm mm 900 mm
390
25 mm Blockboard Model Price AB327P POA AB329P POA AB357P POA AB359P POA AB386P POA AB387P POA AB389P POA
28 mm Vinyl Model Price AB227L POA AB229L POA AB257L POA AB259L POA AB286L POA AB287L POA AB289L POA
25 mm Blockboard Model Price AB227P POA AB229P POA AB257P POA AB259P POA AB286P POA AB287P POA AB289P POA
28 mm Warerite Model Price AB227W POA AB229W POA AB257W POA AB259W POA AB286W POA AB287W POA AB289W POA
Medium duty bench complete with single lockable drawer & cupboard
AB457W
Please specify cupboard position - Left or Right. 28 mm Vinyl Model Price AB327L POA AB329L POA AB357L POA AB359L POA AB386L POA AB387L POA AB389L POA
Please specify drawer position - Left or Right.
28 mm Warerite Model Price AB327W POA AB329W POA AB357W POA AB359W POA AB386W POA AB387W POA AB389W POA
Top Options Length Width 1200 750 mm mm 900 mm 1500 750 mm mm 900 mm 610 mm 1800 750 mm mm 900 mm
Please specify drawer/cupboard position - Left or Right. 28 mm Vinyl Model Price AB427L POA AB429L POA AB457L POA AB459L POA AB486L POA AB487L POA AB489L POA
25 mm Blockboard Model Price AB427P POA AB429P POA AB457P POA AB459P POA AB486P POA AB487P POA AB489P POA
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
28 mm Warerite Model Price AB427W POA AB429W POA AB457W POA AB459W POA AB486W POA AB487W POA AB489W POA
Modular Workbenches
WORKSHOP EQUIPMENT PR222M fitted with PRS22M, PRE22M & PRSE2M
Available up to 1500mm deep to enable working from both sides Worktop height is adjustable in 25mm increments: 940mm Max Main benches are supplied fully assembled & extensions knock down Extension units are not available on their own 4colour options available for the drawers & cupboard Red
Grey
Blue
Green
please specify when ordering
MODULAR WORKBENCHES & EXTENSION UNITS
PR222M
Bench Bench mm 28mm Vinyl Length 1500 2000
Extension - only supplied with the main benches
Top Options
Top Options
25mm MDF
25mm Plywood
28mm Vinyl
25mm MDF
25mm Plywood
Depth
Model
Model
Model
Model
Model
Model
750
PR157L
PR157M
PR157P
PRE57L
PRE57M
PRE57P
900
PR159L
PR159M
PR159P
PRE59L
PRE59M
PRE59P
1250
PR222L
PR222M
PR222P
PRE22L
PRE22M
PRE22P
1500
PR225L
PR225M
PR225P
PRE25L
PRE25M
PRE25P
OPTIONAL LOWER SHELVES TO SUIT BENCHES & EXTENSION UNITS - factory fitted To Suit Bench mm Length 1500 2000
Shelf Size mm
Depth 750 900 1250 1500
Length 1500 2000
Lower Shelf to suit Bench
Lower Shelf to suit Extension
Top Options
Top Options
28mm Vinyl
25mm MDF
25mm Plywood
28mm Vinyl
Depth
Model
Model
Model
Model
25mm MDF Model
25mm Plywood Model
630
PRS57L
PRS57M
PRS57P
PRSE7L
PRSE7M
PRSE7P
780
PRS59L
PRS59M
PRS59P
PRSE9L
PRSE9M
PRSE9P
1130
PRS22L
PRS22M
PRS22P
PRSE2L
PRSE2M
PRSE2P
1380
PRS25L
PRS25M
PRS25P
PRSE5L
PRSE5M
PRSE5P
OPTIONAL EXTRAS - factory fitted Description
To Suit
Upper 2 Shelf
1500P
Upper 2 Shelf
2000P
Model RPT215Z RPT220Z
Light Rail - requires support legs
PRPT97Z
Tool Rail - requires support legs
PRPT99Z
Support Legs - for use with aboveP Electrical Powerpoint
RPT06Z PRPT98Z
Single Drawer: 440W x 570D x 155H mm
LeftP
RPT10ZL
RightP
RPT20ZR
Double Drawer: 440W x 570D x 300H mm
LeftP
RPT11ZL
RightP
RPT21ZR
Three Drawer: 440W x 570D x 445H mm
LeftP
RPT12ZL
RightP
RPT22ZR
Four Drawer: 440W x 570D x 590H mm
LeftP
RPT13ZL
RightP
RPT23ZR
Lockable Cupboard: 440W x 570D x 590H mm
LeftP
RPT14ZL
RightP
RPT24ZR
PR222M fitted with PRS22M, PRPT220Z, PRPT13ZL & PRPT21ZR
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
391
WORKSHOP EQUIPMENT WORKSTATIONS WORKSTATIONS Solid 25mm Wood worktops Hard wearing powder coat finish Drawers operate onsmooth action runners Drawer External Size 446W x 420D x 100H mm Subject to availability
WSI03Z WSI13A
WSI02Z WSI12A
OverallS ize WxDx Hm m
Description 5D rawerU nit
838x 508 x 852
Lockable Cupboard Unit ShelfU nit
Self-Assembly
Fully Assembled
Weight kg
Model
Model
43
WSI01Z
WSI11A
27
WSI02Z
WSI12A
26
WSI03Z
WSI13A
WSI01Z/WSI11A
WORKSTATIONS Solid 38mm Wood worktops Hard wearing powder coat finish Drawers operate onsmooth action runners Drawer External Size 446W x 420D x 100H mm Subject to availability
WSI06Z WSI16A
OverallS ize WxDx Hm m
Description WSI04Z WSI14A
WSI05Z/WSI15A
2 Drawer Unit Lockable Cupboard with 2 AdjustableS helves 5D rawerU nit with an AdjustableS helf
1372 x 508 x 865
Self Assembly
Fully Assembled
Weight kg
Model
Model
56
WSI04Z
WSI14A
49
WSI05Z
WSI15A
61
WSI06Z
WSI16A
WORKSTATIONS Folds in seconds giving compact storage Can be opened & folded in seconds withminimum effort due to the use of 2 gas struts Incorporates a perforated panel& 15 hooks for you to be able to hook your tools on the bench Worktop Height - In Use: 870mmˆ Subject to availability
WBI09Z WBI09Z Folded OverallS ize- Open L xWxH mm 1330 x 680 x 1380
392
OverallS ize- Folded LxWxH mm 1330x3 70x 1380
Worktop Size Lx Wm m 1200x 650
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Weight kg 58
ModelP WBI09Z
ri
WORKBENCHES
WORKSHOP EQUIPMENT
ADJUSTABLE HEIGHT WORKBENCH Laminate worktop with a Rubber edge Constructed from Steel angle Half depth bottom shelf with rear lip
WBI01Z
Overall Size L x W x H mm 1520 x 760 x 760 to 880
HEIGHT ADJUSTABLEIN 25MM INCREMENTS
Weight kg 50
Model WBI01Z
ECONOMY WORKBENCH Constructed from sheet Steel & box section Worktop & full depth bottomshelf have rear & side lips Complete with a centrally positioned lockable drawer Subject to availability
Overall Size L x W x H mm 1500 x 640 x 860
Weight kg 82
WBI02Z
2000 x 640 x 860
96
WBI03Z
Model
WBI02Z
ECONOMY WORKBENCH Manufactured from strong 45 x 45mm Steel angle For transferring equipment between workbenches Mobile on 2 fixed & 2 swivel brake 150mm castors Ideal for use with the WBI02/03Z Subject to availability
WHI04Y shown with WBI02Z Overall Size L x W x H mm 1220 x 755 x 1220
Worktop Height mm 840
Weight kg 58
Model
WHI04Y
WHI04Y
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
393
WORKSHOP EQUIPMENTStandard Workbenches Standard Workbenches Fully welded bench frames with various optional extras to meet your individual working requirements Fitted with adjustable feetto ensure a level work surface Worktop Height: 840mm Max Load
300KG
LD157M
Standard Workbench shown with a range of optional extras
LD157M & OPT104ZL
WORKTOP OPTIONS
Vinyl
21mm Vinyl faced Plywood with Wood edging
Plywood
18mm exterior Plywood with Wood edging
MFC
18mm Grey MFC with PVC edging Top Options Length mm 1500 1800
21mm Vinyl
BESPOKE SIZES AVAILABLE CALL FOR DETAILS
18mm Plywood
18mm MFC
Depth mm
Model
Model
Model
750
LD157L
LD157P
LD157M
900
LD159L
LD159P
LD159M
750
LD187L
LD187P
LD187M
900
LD189L
LD189P
LD189M
Drawers
CUPBOARD Factory fitted lockable cupboard 4colour options available for the cupboard fronts
Factory fitted lockable drawers 4colour options available for the drawer fronts Red
Grey
Blue
Green
Red
Grey
Blue
please specify when ordering Green
please specify when ordering
394
No of Drawers
Overall Size W x D x H mm
Left Model
Right Model
1 Drawer
440 x 570 x 155
OPT100ZL
OPT200ZR
2 Drawer
440 x 570 x 300
OPT101ZL
OPT201ZR
3 Drawer
440 x 570 x 445
OPT102ZL
OPT202ZR
Overall Size W x D x H mm
Left Model
Right Model
4 Drawer
440 x 570 x 590
OPT103ZL
OPT203ZR
440 x 570 x 590
OPT104ZL
OPT204ZR
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
General Purpose Workbenches
WORKSHOP EQUIPMENT GENERAL PURPOSE BENCHES Fully welded bench frames meet the requirements of the assembly & workshop environments Fitted with adjustable feet to ensure a level work surface Worktop Height: 840mm
Max Load
300KG AB157W
AB157W & OPT204ZR
General Purpose Workbench shown with a range of optional extras
WORKTOP OPTIONS
Vinyl
28mm Vinyl faced Plywood with Wood edging
WORKTOP OPTIONS
Plywood
25mm exterior Plywood with Wood edging 28mm Plastic chipboard faced with Warerite or similar Grey surface & edges
Top Options Length mm 1500 1800
28mm Vinyl
Warerite
BESPOKE SIZES AVAILABLE CALL FOR DETAILS
25mm Plywood
28mm Warerite
Depth mm
Model
Model
Model
750
AB157L
AB157P
AB157W
900
AB159L
AB159P
AB159W
750
AB187L
AB187P
AB187W
900
AB189L
AB189P
AB189W
CUPBOARD
Drawers Factory fitted lockable drawers 4colour options available for the drawer fronts Red
Grey
Blue
Factory fitted lockable cupboard 4colour options available for the cupboard fronts
Green
please specify when ordering
Red
Grey
Blue
Green
please specify when ordering
No of Drawers
Overall Size W x D x H mm
Left Model
Right Model
1 Drawer
440 x 570 x 155
OPT100ZL
OPT200ZR
2 Drawer
440 x 570 x 300
OPT101ZL
OPT201ZR
3 Drawer
440 x 570 x 445
OPT102ZL
OPT202ZR
Overall Size W x D x H mm
Left Model
Right Model
4 Drawer
440 x 570 x 590
OPT103ZL
OPT203ZR
440 x 570 x 590
OPT104ZL
OPT204ZR
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
395
WORKSHOP EQUIPMENTCantilever Workbench CANTILEVER BENCHESs Work at this bench without the restraints of cross-members Fully welded bench frames meet the requirements of the assembly & workshop/laboratory environments Fitted with adjustable feet to ensure a level work surface Worktop Height: 840mm
Max Load
300KG
CL159W
Two Cantilever Workbenches shown back-to-back with a range of optional extras
CL159W & OPT104ZL
WORKTOP OPTIONS
28mm Vinyl faced Plywood with Wood edging 25mm exterior Plywood with Wood edging 28mm Plastic Chipboard faced with Warerite or similar Grey surface & edges Conductive Black Rubber Overlay Matting - available on request Top Options
Length mm 1500 1800
28mm Vinyl
BESPOKE SIZES AVAILABLE CALL FOR DETAILS
Vinyl Plywood Warerite
25mm Plywood
28mm Warerite
Depth mm
Model
Model
Model
750
CL157L
CL157P
CL157W
900
CL159L
CL159P
CL159W
750
CL187L
CL187P
CL187W
900
CL189L
CL189P
CL189W
Drawers
CUPBOARD Factory fitted lockable cupboard 4colour options available for the cupboard fronts
Factory fitted lockable drawers 4colour options available for the drawer fronts Red
Grey
Blue
Green Red
Grey
Blue
Green
please specify when ordering please specify when ordering
396
No of Drawers
Overall Size W x D x H mm
Left Model
Right Model
1 Drawer
440 x 570 x 155
OPT100ZL
OPT200ZR
2 Drawer
440 x 570 x 300
OPT101ZL
OPT201ZR
3 Drawer
440 x 570 x 445
OPT102ZL
OPT202ZR
Overall Size W x D x H mm
Left Model
Right Model
4 Drawer
440 x 570 x 590
OPT103ZL
OPT203ZR
440 x 570 x 590
OPT104ZL
OPT204ZR
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Heavy Duty benches
WORKSHOP EQUIPMENT HEAVY DUTY BENCHES Fully welded bench frames meet the heavy demandof a busy workshop Fitted with Steel feet enabling the bench tobe securely fastenedto the floor Worktop Height: 860mm
Max Load
300KG HD157S
Heavy Duty Workbench shownwith a range of optional extras
HD157S & OPT204ZR
WORKTOP OPTIONS
Steel
25mm Plywood with Wood edging
WORKTOP OPTIONS
Plywood
28mm Chipboard faced with Warerite surface & edging
Warerite
2mm Steel - stove enamel Grey finish
Top Options Length mm 1500 1800
28mm Vinyl
BESPOKE SIZES AVAILABLE CALL FOR DETAILS
25mm Plywood
28mm Warerite
Depth mm
Model
Model
Model
750
AB157L
AB157P
AB157W
900
AB159L
AB159P
AB159W
750
AB187L
AB187P
AB187W
900
AB189L
AB189P
AB189W
CUPBOARD
Drawers Factory fitted lockable drawers 4colour options available for the drawer fronts Red
Grey
Blue
Factory fitted lockable cupboard 4colour options available for the cupboard fronts
Green
please specify when ordering
Red
Grey
Blue
Green
please specify when ordering
No of Drawers
Overall Size W x D x H mm
Left Model
Right Model
1 Drawer
440 x 570 x 155
OPT100ZL
OPT200ZR
2 Drawer
440 x 570 x 300
OPT101ZL
OPT201ZR
3 Drawer
440 x 570 x 445
OPT102ZL
OPT202ZR
Overall Size W x D x H mm
Left Model
Right Model
4 Drawer
440 x 570 x 590
OPT103ZL
OPT203ZR
440 x 570 x 590
OPT104ZL
OPT204ZR
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
397
WORKSHOP EQUIPMENTErgonomic benches
Frames are epoxy powder coated Steel in Dark Grey RAL7045. The worktops are either 25mm Melamine-Laminateor 26mm ESD-Laminate on particle board. ESD benchesare earthed via a protective 1 mega-ohm resistor. Supplied knock down for self-assembly
WORKBENCH TP Worktop D x W mm 500 x 700
TP 507
ESD Model TP 507 ESD
500 x 1000
TP 510
TP 510 ESD
700 x 1000
TP 710
TP 710 ESD
700 x 1200
TP 712
TP 712 ESD
700 x 1500
TP 715
TP 715 ESD
700 x 1800
TP 718
TP 718 ESD
900 x 1500
TP 915
TP 915 ESD
900 x 1800
TP 918
TP 918 ESD
Model
Angle Extension 500 x 1000
TP 510 K
TP 510 K ESD
700 x 1200
TP 712 K
TP 712 K ESD
WORKBENCH WITH SHELF TPH Worktop D x W mm 700 x 1200
TPH 712
ESD Model TPH 712 ESD
700 x 1500
TPH 715
TPH 715 ESD
700 x 1800
TPH 718
TPH 718 ESD
900 x 1500
TPH 915
TPH 915 ESD
900 x 1800
TPH 918
TPH 918 ESD
Model
MOVEABLE BENCH SAP Worktop D x W mm 500 x 700
SAP 507
ESD Model SAP 507 ESD
700 x 1000
SAP 710
SAP 710 ESD
700 x 1500
SAP 715
SAP 715 ESD
Model
ESD protected workbenches are for use in the electronics industry & comply with EN61340-5-1
WORKBENCH WITH SHELF TPH Height adjustable from 650 to 900mm Can be also supplied as a line orangle extension
WORKBENCH WITH SHELF TPH Construction as TP with upright profiles& a 310 mm deep Laminate shelf Upper shelf is height adjustable from 1080 to 1550mm
MOVEABLE BENCH SAP Construction as TP but with 100mmswivel castors, 2 braked Height adjustable from 650 to 900mmLower shelf is an optional extra - Call for Details
Lower Shelf
398
500 x 700
AT 507
AT 507 ESD
700 x 1000
AT 710
AT 710 ESD
Workbench with shelf TPH
Workbench TP
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Movable Bench SAP
Accessories for TPH Benches
1
WORKSHOP EQUIPMENT
2
METAL SHELF TH
3
BIN RAIL BP
For picking/stacking bins Height & angle adjusts Load Capacity: 30kg
AUXILIARY SHELF SH
For picking/stacking bins Aluminium profile Load Capacity: 30kg
No.
5&6
1
2
TOOL & LIGHTING SUPPORT KT Includes 1 x C-profile & sliding hook Order extra bar to mount tools & light
TOOL & LIGHTING SUPPORT KT Twin 54w flicker free fluorescent lights Pre-wired 3 metre cable to plug Built in diffuser
3 4
5
6 7
7
4
8
Overall Size D x W mm 145 x 1119
To Suit TPH bench length 1200
Standard Model TH 120
ESD Model TH 120 ESD
145 x 1419
1500
TH 150
TH 150 ESD
145 x 1719
1800
TH 180
TH 180 ESD
1115 Length
1200
BP 120
BP 120 ESD
1415 Length
1500
BP 150
BP 150 ESD
1715 Length
1800
BP 180
BP 180 ESD
310 x 1200
1200
SH 120
SH 120 ESD
310 x 1500
1500
SH 150
SH 150 ESD
310 x 1800
1800
SH 180
SH 180 ESD
210 x 460
-
CKV 400
CKV 400 ESD
1200 Length
1200
KT 120
1500 Length
1500
KT 150
1800 Length
1800
KT 180
1200 Length - Bar
1200
SPR 120
1500 Length - Bar
1500
SPR 150
1800 Length - Bar
1800
SPR 180
1200 Length
-
OL-254/E
1120 x 450
1200
LP 1200
1420 x 450
1500
LP 1500
1720 x 450
1800
LP 1800
72 x 72 x 1060
1200
TJK 1204
72 x 72 x 1360
1500
TJK 1504
72 x 72 x 1660
1800
TJK 1804
8
No.
Pre-wired 3 metre cable to plug 4x13A UK Sockets CE Approved
9
Epoxy coated Steel Single point locking Load capacity 30kg per drawer Not suitable for500mm deep benches
Order extra bar to mount tools & light
ELECTRICAL POWER CHANNELS
590mm long arm Angle adjustable Load Capacity: 15kg
For more than one shelf on your bench Load Capacity: 50kg
STEEL CABINETS ML
LOUVRED PANEL LP
SWIVEL ARM & TRAY CKV
9
Overall Size D x W x H mm 580 x 453 x 142
Drawer Height mm 1 x 140
ML 01
580 x 490 x 351
1 x 60 & 2 x 120
ML 02
580 x 490 x 532
1 x 60, 2 x 120 & 1 x 180
ML 03
580 x 490 x 670 - mobile
1 x 60, 2 x 120 & 1 x 180
ML 04
580 x 490 x 532
1 x 120 & 1 x 360
ML 05
580 x 490 x 532
1 x 480mm Cupboard
ML 05D
580 x 490 x 762
1 x 60, 3 x 120, 1 x 180
ML 06
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Model
399
WORKSHOP EQUIPMENT ADJUSTABLE BENCHES ADJUSTABLE WORKBENCHES Stylish design with good leg room Height adjustable from 700 to 1000mm by Allen Key, Hand Crank or Electric Motor Flush bench foot print 25mm Laminate Particle Board Worktops Working Loads:250kg (Allen Key) 200kg (Hand Crank) 200kg Electric Motor Electric motor takes 19 secs. from minimum to maximum
IDEAL FOR STANDING OR SEATED WORK
ESD protected versions available Call for Details WB815EL shown with Accessories
WB815
Allen Key Adjustment
400
Electric Motor Adjustment
Hand Crank Adjustment
Worktop Sizes D x W mm
Allen Key Adjustment
Hand Crank Adjustment
Model
Model
Electric Motor Adjustment Model
800 x 1073
WB-811
WB-811C
WB-811EL
800 x 1500
WB-815
WB-815C
WB-815EL
800 x 1800
WB-818
WB-818C
WB-818EL
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Accessories for Benches
WORKSHOP EQUIPMENT
FULL WIDTH OVER BENCH ACCESSORIES ARE MOUNTED ONUPRIGHT PROFILES & SMALLER MODULES ON ACCESSORY FRAMES 1073mm wide benches can accept 1 x 100 module from the tilting shelf or bin rail options 1500mm wide benches can accept 2 x 70 modules from the tilting shelf or bin rail options 1800mm wide benches can accept one of each size, 70 & 100 tilting shelf or bin rail options UPRIGHTS
ACCESSORY FRAME
Needed for upright mounting accessories 2x900mm uprights & horizontal profile
UPPER SHELF
Needed for accessory mounting & accessories.1 x 500mm uprights horizontal profile
Height adjustable 25mm shelves. Mounts onupright. Load capacity: 50kg
Bench Width
Model
Bench Width
Model
Bench Width
Size mm
Model
1073 mm
AL2X110W
1073 mm
-
1073 mm
310 x 1073
ALH-110
1500 mm
AL2X150W
1500 mm
AKK-150
1500 mm
310 x 1500
ALH-150
1800 mm
AL2X180W
1800 mm
AKK-180
1800 mm
310 x 1800
ALH-180
OVERHEAD SUPPORT
OVERHEAD & SIDE LIGHT
Steel bracket for tools & OL light Mounts on upright
Pre-wired flicker free bulbs. Adjusts for angle. Side light mounts on upright
POWER CHANNEL
Pre-wired power channel with 4 x UK Sockets, 2 on each side. 3 metre cable to plug
Bench Width
Model
Item
Model
Bench Width
Features
Model
1073 mm
HSB-110
1800 mm
HSB-180
1200mm Overhead Light 2 x 54w Bulb
OL224E
1800 mm
Full Width Channel & 4 Sockets
TJK-904
HSB-150
SL224E
1073 mm
1500 mm
590mm Side Light 2 x 24w Bulb
BIN RAIL
TILTING SHELF
Adjusts for height, angle & depth. Mounts on accessory frame. Load capacity: 30kg
1500 mm
TJK-1504 TJK-1804
MONITOR ARMS
Aluminium profile bin rail. Mounts on accessory frame. Accepts most bins
Mounts on accessory frame. For LCD monitors with VESA 75 or 100 fittings. MA arm moves from 95-425mm. Load 5kg
Bench Width
Size mm
Model
Bench Width
Size mm
Model
Item
Model
1500/1800 mm
400 x 660
ASH-70
1500/1800 mm
685
BP-70
LCD Screen Bracket
MH
1073/1800 mm
400 x 960
ASH-100
1073/1800 mm
985
BP-100
LCD Screen Bracket & Arm
MA
PC STAND & KEYBOARD SHELF
Mounted under worktop. PC holder adjusts from 395-500H mm & 130-240W mm.Keyboard tray is 250 x 500 x 110 mm &includes Pull Out Mouse Mat Item
Model
Adjustable PC Holder
CPU
Pull Out Keyboard Shelf
NT-500ESD
CORNER UNIT
SIDE TABLE
Used with 2 x WB Benches to create 90ยบ angle. Not suitable with WBC or WBEL units. Load 50kg
Installed on left or right with brackets adjustable in height. Load 50kg
Size mm
Model
Size mm
Model
1153 x 1153
WB-1212CT
800 x 400
WB-804ST
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
401
Workshop WORKSHOP EQUIPMENT Mobile Products UNIVERSAL TROLLEY A versatile trolley for PC, printer or monitoring equipment Frames are epoxy powder coated Light Grey RAL7035 Vertical profiles are of Aluminium Worktops are of 25mm Laminated Particle Board Mobile on 100mm swivel castors, 2 with brakes
Product Trolley3
Includes Shelves
Overall Size D x W x H mm 650 x 650 x 1415
WTR 140
650 x 530
TS 605
650 x 530
TAS 605
460 x 370 x 345
LMC 02
Extra ShelfAdjustable Shelf Drawer Unit2
Adjustment for Height & Angle x 100mm drawers
Model
Pull-out Keyboard Tray
Mouse Mat
260 x 500 x 110
NT 500
Electrical Power Channel
4 x UK Sockets & 3 metre cable to plug
72 x 72 x 470
TJK-404
MOVEABLE BENCH
Max Load
150 KG
STEEL TROLLEY
Height adjustable from 690 to 990mm Integrated lower shelf Epoxy powder coated steel Light Grey RAL7035 Mobile on 100mm swivel castors, 2 with brakes
Max Load
75 KG
Per Shelf
Worktop Size D x W mm 700 x 500
Single point locking Drawer handle with label holder Epoxy powder coated steel Dark Grey RAL7045 Fluted Rubber mat Mobile on 100mm swivel castors, 2with brakes Load 30kg per drawer Overall Size D x W x H mm 580 x 490 x 670
Model C
TR 705
Model M L 04
INDUSTRIAL TROLLEY For use in production, repair or storage areas Frames are epoxy powder coated Dark Grey RAL7045 Bottom shelf of Steel with fluted Rubber mat Mobile on 125mm swivel castors, 2 with brakes
Max Load
150 KG
Includes
Trolley
Shelves: 3 x ISS407 1 x ISS 607
625 x 777 x 1725
Adjustment for Height, Depth & Angle: 0 to 30o Front Retaining Lip Load Capacity: 40kg
400 x 680
ISS 407
600 x 680
ISS 607
Bin Rail
Double Profile
685 Length
BP 70
Perforated Panel
9mm Perforations at 38mm Centres
686 x 750
HPP 73
Cupboard Unit
Of Perforated Steel with lock, shelf & connectors
310 x 687 x 700
HCU 73
-
Steel Shelf
402
Overall Size D x W x H mm
Product
Model IT 170
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
IT 170 KIT
Maintenance Trolleys
WORKSHOP EQUIPMENT
MAINTENANCE TROLLEYS Roller bearing drawers with 50kg UDL capacity Lockable cupboards with adjustable Steel shelf Mobile on 4 x 125mm castors with 2 brakes Maximum Load Capacity: 200kg UDL
Individual drawer safety triggers to prevent accidental opening Choice of 30mm Multiplex Worktop or Steel top tray with a non-slip Rubber mat
Max Load
200 KG
16913241.11v
16913200.11v
Overall Size Worktop W x D x H mm Type 2 x 700mm Cupboard 1000 x 550 x 925 Rubber each with a shelf 1000 x 550 x 955 Multiplex Configuration
Model
Configuration
16913200.11v 16913201.11v
8 x 175mm Drawers
Overall Size Worktop W x D x H mm Type 1000 x 550 x 925 Rubber
16913240.11v
1000 x 550 x 955 Multiplex
16913241.11v
Model
Max Load
200 KG
16913221.11v please note the drawers are on the left hand side & the cupboard is on the right hand side
Configuration
Overall Size W x D x H mm
16913223.11v please note the drawers are on the left hand side & the cupboard is on the right hand side
Worktop Type
1 x 700mm Cupboard 1000 x 550 x 925 Rubber with a shelf & 4 x 1000 x 550 x 955 Multiplex 175mm Drawers
Model 16913220.11v 16913221.11v
Configuration
Overall Size W x D x H mm
Worktop Type
1 x 700mm Cupboard 1000 x 550 x 925 Rubber with a shelf, 1 x 75 & 5 x 125mm Drawers 1000 x 550 x 955 Multiplex
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Model 16913223.11v 16913224.11v
403
Weight WORKSHOP EQUIPMENT Industrial Scales INDUSTRIAL TROLLEY Accurate, easy to read display Large 25.4mm Backlit LCD display Functions include On/Off Zero Tare Auto shutdown feature turns off the weight display after 2minutes of none use Battery alert will display ‘LO’when the battery is weak This unit continues to display the weight after the item has been removed Ideal for weighing over sized goods Overall Size mm 278 x 318 x 56
Capacity
Model
45kg x 100g & 100lbs x 0.2lbs
GP45
110kg x 200g & 250lbs x 0.5lbs
GP110
Max Load
2500 KG
INDUSTRIAL TROLLEY Place the beams up to 2 metres apart Both beam are fitted with a lifting handle & adjustable feet Functions include On/Off Zero Tare Ideal for Pallets, Long Loads, Containers etc
404
INDICATOR Weights are clearly displayed in 7 x 20mm highdigits which is Backlit LCD for excellent viewing Scales will display Low Battery when the unit requires recharging. The battery lasts 15 hoursof continuous use & is charged via the charger.The display turns itself off after 2 minutes Overall Size mm
Capacity
Model
2 qty of 1200 x 100 Beams
2500kg x 0.5kg
DP1200
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Industrial Weight Scales
WORKSHOP EQUIPMENT
ED JUNIOR CRANEWEIGHER IP55 rated for outdoors Sleep mode - maximise battery life Display - 6 digit LCD 26mm high digits Power - 2 x C cell replaceable batteries Units of measure - kg, tonnes, lbs & newtons Compact construction - minimal headroom loss Hooks & shackles - a choice of top & bottom fittings Peak hold facility - enables capture of peak readings of each weight
SLEEP MODE TO MAXIMISE THE BATTERY LIFE
Capacity
Top Shackle Bottom Shackle
Top Shackle Bottom Hook
Model
Model
1000kg x 1kg
36190-0038
EDjr-2.5K-OS-NS-WC
2000kg x 2kg
36190-0046
EDjr-5K-OS-NS-WC
5000kg x 5kg
36190-0053
EDjr-10K-OS-NS-WC
10,000kg x 10kg
36190-0103
EDjr-25K-S-NS-WC
Max Load
3000 KG
BP PLATFORMS
FLOOR & DRUM WEIGHING SCALE Ideal for the weighing of Drums, Sack Trucks & Trolleys etc where ease of operation & accuracy is essential 6digit 20mm (0.8�) LED Display Powered by internal rechargable batteries which gives up to 30 hours of continuous use Functions include On/Off Zero Tare Capacity 500kg x 0.2g
Overall Size L x W x H mm 1050 x 1050 x 46
Indicator/Readout Stand
Low profile design: 90mm high Hard wearing powder coated finish Fitted with four swivel feet shear beam load cells Top access holes for installing, lifting & leveling Links to an indicator DP90 Give the ability to connect to a printer Functions include On/Off Zero Tare Mains or battery operated CE marked & WEE Directive compliant
DS1000
Overall Size L x W x H mm 1250 x 1250 x 90
Weight kg 111
BP-1250
816965002061
1500 x 1500 x 90
153
BP-1500
Model
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Model
405
WORKSHOP EQUIPMENT PVC STRIP CURTAINS Swivel Hinge Headrail system • The Heavy duty Galvanised Swivel hinge headrail system is suitable for 300 mm and 400 mm wide pvc strips and is recommended where forklifts are in use.
Clear PVC Strip Size
Overlap %
Maximum Height
300 x 3
56
5500
300 x 3
80
6000
400 x 4
60
9000
400 x 4
100
10000
Price Sq M
Replacement PVC • All sizes of PVC are available from Stock including Standard, Polargrade, double ribbed, green and bronze welding and various colours. • The PVC can be supplied in 50 metre rolls or cut to your required length.
Sliding Track • If your situation requires the curtain to be moveable both systems can be supplied on sliding track. • The track is formed from cold rolled galvanised steel and can be provided with face or underside fixing brackets. CHAINSCREEN
FLYMESH
Hook-on Headrail system
• Hook-on headrail system available in Stainless Steel and Galvanised finishes. • Suitable for use with 200 mm, 300 mm and 400 mm wide pvc strips. • Recommended for pedestrian and pallet truck traffic. • Both the Swivel Hinge and Hook-on systems have a variety of overlaps to suit all applications.
Clear PVC Strip Size
406
Overlap %
Maximum Height
200 x 2
36
2400
200 x 2
77
2750
300 x 2
36
3000
300 x 2
63
4500
300 x 2
90
5500
300 x 3
36
3000
300 x 3
63
4500
300 x 3
90
6000
400 x 4
56
7500
400 x 4
77
9000
400 x 4
100
10000
Price Per Sq M Galv Stainless
50m Rolls std
Keep Flying Insects out Food preparation areas can be kept free of insects by choosing one of these two effective types of screening for doorways which allow good air flow but are simple to fit and clean. Chainscreen system Made from durable lightweight anodised aluminium chain. This wall of glittering metal will deter the vast majority of flying insects. Flymesh system Made from flexible black Suntex strips. This fine guage mesh screen has no equal when it comes to keeping out unwanted insects.
Anodised Aluminium Chain including ‘Z’ Hanging Rail 760 mm wide x 2100 mm high 900 mm wide x 2100 mm high
200 mm wide black suntex with weights on stainless Steel hook-on. 36% overlap. Other sizes available on request. 856 mm wide x 2100 mm high 1020 mm wide x 2100 mm high
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
SAFETY & SECURITY
WORKSHOP EQUIPMENT
Securikey provides a range of convex mirrors to suit security & safety applications. Computer designed curvature & Pure silver coating gives them the sharpest & brightest image possible Mirrors Exterior
180 Degree
Mirrors Hemisphere
Features:
Features:
• Can be used internally or externally
• Suitable for retail & Industrial use
• Impact resistant acrylic face
• 180º wall mounting - Supplied with dome top screws
• Wall mounted can also be fixed to a post with optional fitting kit
• 360º ceiling mounting - With dome top screws. Can be suspended with kit included
• Sizes from 450 to 900mm • Moisture resistant • Galvanised fittings
Exterior 450mm dia. 600mm dia. 900mm dia.
• Impact resistant acrylic 360 Degree Hemisphere Model Price 600mm 180º M18535H 900mm 180º M18553H 600mm 360º M18585H 900mm 360º M18590H
Model Price M18044S M18062S M18114S
Mirrors Interior
Mirrors Fork Lift Rear View
Features: • Impact resistant acrylic face • ‘J’ Bracket mounting adjusts to any angle • Sizes from 300 to 900mm • Rectangular model for restricted spaces • Suits retail & Industrial use • View inaccessible areas
Features: • Prevents accidents and injuries • Clear & Bright reflection • Impact resistant acrylic • ‘T’ Bar back for internal use • ABS back for internal/external use
Interior Model Model Price 300mm dia. M18020J AED 472.45 AED 545.85 450mm dia. M18038J AED 826.20 600mm dia. M18056J AED 833.05 600 x 400mm M18330A
300
x 150 mm Model Price ‘T’ Bar back M19952T AED 431.85 ABS back M19952A AED 499.15
Vehicle / Laptop Security Box
Master Lock - Python Cable Lock
Key Storage Box
•S uitable for use in cars, boats or caravans
• Used on construction and industrial sites
• Never be locked out again
•F ix to anchor points in the boot with cable lock (not included) •S trong steel construction
• Suitable for use with the Vehicle / Laptop Box
• Ideal for maintenance teams, cleaning service employees, construction workers etc...
•E uro profile locking mechanism
• Fully adjustable to suit other applications
• 10,000 possible codes
•S turdy carrying handle
• Standard cable length 1.8m x 10mm dia
• Diecast construction to resist corrosion
•E xternal 405 x 355 x 120 mm eight 13 kg •W
Model SDLTS
• Additional cables available up to 9m
Price Model 8413D
Price AED 149.50
Model 5401D
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Price
407
WORKSHOP EQUIPMENT Hose Reels TOOL BALANCER Automatic Rewind Units come complete with a swivel bracket supplied loose for site assembly Positive Latching Mechanism - automatically locks hose at desired length Subject to availability
HRA01Z
HRA05Z
HRW04Z
HRA06Z Hose
Hose Colour
Hose Length
Hose Dia. mm
Case Size L x W x H mm
Polyurethane
Blue
8 metre
12
570 x 300 x 320
Rubber
Red
8 metre
10
430 x 200 x 370
Rubber
Red
15 metre
10
Rubber
Red
15 metre
Rubber
Red
15 metre
Case Colour
Case Material
Max Pressure
Weight kg
Model
Black
Polypropylene
300 Psi
14
HRA05Z
Blue
Polypropylene
300 Psi
9
HRA01Z
430 x 200 x 370
Blue
Polypropylene
300 Psi
10.5
HRA02Z
10
520 x 220 x 560
Black
Metal
300 Psi
22
HRA06Z
13
520 x 220 x 560
Black
Metal
300 Psi
23
HRA07Z
Polypropylene
-
10.5
HRW04Z
Air Hoses
Water Hoses PVC
Green
15 metre
10
430 x 200 x 370
Green
TOOL BALANCER For workshop use - reduce operator fatigue & cut down assembly time Ideal for assembly line jobs - from small tools to industrial guns etc Easily adjustable to suit exact weight of tool Spring operated rewind system Subject to availability
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628) HRB08Z
408
Capacity
Cable Travel
Cable Dia
0.4 - 1.8kg
1.25m
2 mm
Case Size L x W x H mm 150 x 40 x 220
Weight kg 0.45
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Model HRB08Z
SAFETY MATTING
WORKSHOP EQUIPMENT COBAMAT INTER
COBAMAT STANDARD
• Hole size 22mm x 22mm • Thickness 12mm • Added grip in both directions • Fights against operator fatigue •A vailable in Red, Black, Green & Blue
• Totally reversible • Flame retardent to DIN 4102 •R esistant to mild acids & alkalis • Conforms to BIA anti-slip test
Dimensions (L x W) 0.6m x 10m 0.9m x 10m 1.2m x 10m Edging per linear meter
WORKSTATION MAT
• Offers users comfort even in barefoot applications • Gives added cross grip in wet/oily areas • Available in Red, Black, Green & Blue
Dimensions (L x W) 0.6m x 10m 0.9m x 10m 1.2m x 10m Edging per linear meter
WORKSAFE MAT
anufactured from flexible vinyl • Products are supplied with a •M • Thickness 12mm y ellow bevelled edge to prevent • Gives a safe operating surface tripping as debris falls through the • Cross ribbed to prevent slipping product when oils are around • Helps to reduce fatigue • In black with yellow borders
• Hole size 30mm x 10mm • Thickness 12mm xtremely hygienic and pleasing •E to the eye asy to clean with mild •E detergent or pressure washer
Dimensions (L x W) 0.6m x 1.2m Standard 1.0m x 1.5m Standard 1.2m x 1.8m Standard 0.6m x 1.2m Heavy 1.0m x 1.5m Heavy 1.2m x 1.8m Heavy
• Manufactured from extremely hard wearing rubber • I deally suited to relieve operator fatigue • Moulded bevel edge increases safety
• Unique underside design p revents the mat from slipping on the floor • Allows swarf and other debris to fall through • In black or grease resistant blue
Dimensions (L x W) 0.9m x 1.5m Black (Grease Resistant) 0.9m x 1.5m Blue (Grease proof)
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
409
WORKSHOP EQUIPMENTSAFETY MATTING SOLID
BLACK
STANDARD ANTI FATIGUE
SAFETY ANTI FATIGUE
SOLID FATIGUE STEP AND FATIGUE STEP BLACK
• Manufactured from 100% closed cell vinyl foam • Designed to reduce operator fatigue, leading to increased productivity • Insulates against cold concrete floors • Ideal for assembly lines and packaging areas • Pebble surface allows ease of cleaning • Thickness 9mm • In Grey or Charcoal
• As Standard Anti Fatigue, but supplied with bright yellow borders to increase safety awareness whilst eliminating operator fatigue
• Manufactured from extremely durable rubber (Black only) • Designed to offer the highest comfort factor • 0.9m x 0.9m tiles interlock to form mat size and shape of your choice • Ideal for use where employees are standing for prolonged periods • Thickness 16mm • Optional extras: Corner units, bevelled edge units & connectors
• Made from hard wearing rubber • Soft yet resilient material offers excellent fatigue relief properties • Slip resistant •V ersatile units (0.9m x 0.9m) interlock to fit any size area. • High drainage properties • Thickness 16mm •O ptional extras: Corner units, bevelled edge units & connectors
Dimensions (L x W) 0.9m x 0.9m Black Corners Black Edging per 0.9m Black Connectors Black Edging per 0.9m Yellow Corners Yellow
Dimensions (L x W) 0.9m x 0.9m Black Corners Black Edging per 0.9m Black Connectors Black Edging per 0.9m Yellow Corners Yellow
Dimensions (L x W) 0.6m x 0.9m 0.9m x 1.5m 0.9m x 18.3m
Price
DECKPLATE
• Diamond surface provides greater traction and extended wear. • Foam back relieves employee fatigue • Resistant to many industrial chemicals • Top surface is easily cleaned • Thickness 14mm
Dimensions (L x W) 0.6m x 0.9m Black 0.9m x 1.5m Black 0.9m x 3m Black 0.9m x 6m Black
410
Price
Dimensions (L x W) 0.6m x 0.9m 0.9m x 1.5m 0.9m x 18.3m
Price
SAFETY DECKPLATE
• Yellow bordering edges for added safety • Self extinguishing and chemical resistant surface • Withstands the most demanding applications • Foam back offers superb ergonomic benefit • Thickness 14mm
Dimensions (L x W) Price 0.6m x 0.9m Black/Yellow Border 0.6m x 1.5m Black/Yellow Border 0.9m x 3m Black/Yellow Border 0.9m x 6m Black/Yellow Border
FLUTED ANTI FATIGUE
Price
• Durable PVC fluted surface for demanding industrial applications • Foam back to offer fatigue relief for long periods of standing
Dimensions (L x W) 0.6m x 0.9m 0.9m x 1.5m 0.9m x 3m
Price
• Bevelled edges prevent trips within the workplace • Thickness 10mm • In black only
Price
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628)
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
WORKSTATIONS
WORKSHOP EQUIPMENT
INDUSTRIAL WORKSTATIONS • Versatile workstations for the industrial environment • Epoxy Polyester coated all Steel construction • Writing desk, cubby hole & lockable drawer • 3 point locking secure cupboard • Rear panels are supplied separately for on-site assembly Basic Workstation 1219H x 914W x 457D mm Model: WWKGU Information Station 2000H x 915W x 457D mm Model: WISGU
Toolholder Station 2000H x 915W x 457D mm Model: WTSGU
Quality Control Station 2000H x 915W x 457D mm Model: WQSGU
COMPUTER WORKSTATIONS • Epoxy Polyester coated all Steel construction • Choice of designs for Standard or Flat Screen Monitors • Lockable Monitor & Keyboard units & Cupboards - Supplied with 2 Keys
Flat Top Compact Computer Station 1040H x 650W x 522D mm Model: WFCGU
Standard Compact Computer Station 1695H x 650W x 525D mm Model: WCCGU
Flat Screen Compact Computer Station 1695H x 650W x 525D mm Model: WSCGU
Flat Top Computer Station 1219H x 915W x 485D mm Model: WLCGU
Wide Computer Station 1794H x 915W x 525D mm Model: WTCGU
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
411
cloakrooms leisure products Cloakroom / leisure products Will not rust or corrode Constructed from Plastic & Aluminium Benches are fully demountable for storage Colour options available
Beige
Red
Blue
Green
White
please specify when ordering
Double Coat Bench with Hooks
Child Size Coat Bench
BASIC BENCH - O/H 450MM Size L x D mm 1000 1200 1500 1800 2000
x x x x x
400 B 400 400 400 B 400
Model 1040S B1240S B1540S 1840S B2040S
Basic Bench
SINGLE COAT BENCH - O/H 1800MM DOUBLE COAT BENCH - O/H 1800MM Size L x D mm 1000 1200 1500 1800 2000
x x x x x
STORAGE PEN
400 400 400 400 400
No of Hooks
Model
6C 9C 12 15 18
1040S 1240S C1540S C1840S C2050S
Size L x D mm 1000 1200 1500 1800 2000
x x x x x
800 800 800 800 800
No of Hooks 6C 9C 12 15 18
Model 1080D 1280D C1580D C1880D C2080D
WALL RACK Available in Matching Colours
Overall Size W x D x H mm 800 x 800 x 850
412
Model PP08
Length mm 1000 1200 1500 1800 2000
Depth mm 40 40 40 40 40
No of Hooks 5 6 7 9 10
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Model WR1000 WR1200 WR1500 WR1800 WR2000
Cloakroom Equipment CLUB CLOAKROOM SEATING
cloakrooms
Ash seat slats (FSC approved source)fitted to a Steel seat support frame 45mm dia. round tube legs Sturdy Aluminium coat hooks Seat Height: 450mm Overall Height: 1750mm Colour options
Silver
B lue
Yellow
Black
Red
G reen
please specify when ordering
SINGLE SIDED BENCHES Length mm
Depth mm
No of Hooks
Leg Sets
Bench
Optional Back Rest
Model
Model
Model
1000
400
5
2
RS10X
RSB10
RSR10M
1500
400
7
2
RS15X
RSB15
RSR15M
2000
400
10
2
RS20X
RSB20
RSR20M
2500
400
12
3
RS25X
RSB25
RSR25M
3000
400
14
3
RS30X
RSB30
RSR30M Optional Shoe Rack
SINGLE SIDED BENCHES
Optional Shoe Rack
Length mm
Depth mm
No of Hooks
Leg Sets
Bench
Optional Back Rest
Model
Model
Model
1000
800
10
2
RD10X
RDB10
RDR10M
1500
800
14
2
RD15X
RDB15
RDR15M
2000
800
20
2
RD20X
RDB20
RDR20M
2500
800
24
3
RD25X
RDB25
RDR25M
3000
800
28
3
RD30X
RDB30
RDR30M
MONO BENCH
FREESTANDING BENCHES
Floor/wall fixedbench 450mm high
Basic bench 450mm high
Length mm
Depth mm
Legs Sets
Mono Bench
Model
2
R10
1000
450
2
RM10
315
2
R15
1500
450
2
RM15
2000
315
2
R20
2000
450
2
RM20
2500
315
3
R25
2500
450
3
RM25
3000
315
3
R30
3000
450
3
RM30
Length mm
Depth mm
Legs Sets
1000
315
1500
Basic Bench
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Model
413
cloakrooms Cloakroom Equipment
SS12
SS10H
DS20H DS24
NOW SUPPLIED WITH UNBREAKABLE PLASTIC HOOKS Frames available in: Black, Grey, Red & BlueHooks available in: Red, Green, Blue, Yellow, Black & Grey
STORAGE PEN
Ash or Sapele Timber slats Single Sided Units: 400mm wide Double Sided Units: 762mm wide All units are 1803mm high
Single or Double Sided With Hooks or Hangers Shoe Baskets are available as an Optional Extra Bespoke units available- Call For Details
Manufactured from 38 x 38mm RHS Steel frame work. Tops & seat slats are of 70 x 32mm Sapele Timber,with four radiused corners, & have been sanded, sealed & polished with a tough, hardwearing lacquer
COMPLETE WITH HOOKS Length mm
COMPLETE WITH BLACK HANGERS
Single Sided No of Hooks
915
6S
1220
9S
1525
12
Double Sided No of Hooks
Model
Length mm
S6
12
DS12
915
S9
18
DS18
1220
24
DS24
1525
Model
SS12
Single Sided No of Hooks 6S 8S 10
Model
Double Sided No of Hooks
Model
S6H
12
DS12H
S8H
16
DS16H
20
DS20H
SS10H
BENCH SEATS & COAT RAILS Benches have Sapele timber slats with four radiused corners which have been sanded, sealed & polished Coat Rails are pre-drilled ready for wall mounting
Length mm
Benches 400H x 300W mm Model
CR12
Coat Rails 70 x 20mm Sapele Model
915
B36
CR6
1220
B48
CR9
1525
B60
CR12
B60
414
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
BENCHES
cloakrooms
EASy SERIES
Framework in steel tube 30 x 30 x 1,5 mm.Legs with rubber push rods. Seat made of varnished wooden laths 100x.20 mm. Painting, by depositing epoxy powders. Cross-linking in a kiln at 180 °C. Standard colour Grey RAL 7035.Material supplied assembled. Outfit • Back coat rack • Upper hat rack
BE0520LE
BE0315LE
BE0110LE
Model
Dim W x D x H
EASY10
100 x 35 x 45
EASY15
150 x 35 x 45
EASY20
200 x 35 x 45
FREESTYLE SERIES Steel framework bench - seat made of tubular steel covered with red PVC laths Outfit • Back coat rack
Model
Dim W x D x H
BE0210P
100 x 35 x 45
BE0615P
150 x 35 x 45
BE0820P
200 x 35 x 45
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
415
PREMISES ROPE & BELT BARRIERS ROPE BARRIERS High quality polished Stainless Steel postsfor a durable & aesthetic finish The ropes are made from Polyester Ideal where you need to channel traffic; hotels,airports, warehouses, offices, showrooms etc 4way connectivity SHL01Z
SRL21R
SPL21Z SPL11Z
your message goes here
SRL22B
SRL25B
SIMPLY BUY YOUR POST& ADD YOUR ROPE TO MEETYOUR REQUIREMENTS SIGN BOARD - create your own message
RSLS8Z
Description Sign Board
ROPE BARRIERS
Model RSLS8Z
ROPES - with silver polished ‘Q’ hooks
Stainless Steel Post with Ball Head
Post Size H x W mm 987 x 320
Stainless Steel Post with Top Hat Head
935 x 320
Wall Hook
-
Description
Post Size H x W mm 370 x 205
Rope Length mm
SPL11Z
Rope Colour Red
SPL21Z
Blue
1500
SHL01Z
Black
Model
Model SRL21R SRL22B SRL25B
ROPE BARRIERS High quality polished Stainless Steel postsfor a durable & aesthetic finish Also available in Black coated Steel post(models RPLB4R, )RPLB5B & RPLB6B The 2m retractable belt is made from Nylon Ideal for where you need to channel traffic; hotels, airports, warehouses, offices,showrooms etc Belt Size: 50mm High& 1800mm Length 3way connectivity
Wall Mounted Belt Barrier RWLS9B
BELT BARRIERS Black Belt Barrier RPLB4R / RPLB5B / RPLB6B
Description
Post Size H x W mm
Red Retractable Belt Barrier Blue Retractable Belt Barrier Black Retractable Belt Barrier
930 x 350
Receiving End Post
Black Model
Stainless Steel Model
RPLB4R
RPLS1R
RPLB5B
RPLS2B
RPLB6B
RPLS3B
RRLB8P
RRLS9P
DOUBLE BELT BARRIER & WALL MOUNTEDBELT BARRIER Stainless Steel Belt Barrier RPLS1R / RPLS2B / RPLS3B
416
Double Belt Barrier RDLS7B
Description
Post Size H x W mm
Model
Double Retractable Belt Barrier - Blue
985 x 320
RDLS7B
Wall Mounted Retractable Belt Barrier - Blue
-
RWLS9B
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Posts & Barriers
PREMISES
GUARDA - LIGHTWEIGHT CHAIN POSTS For quick & easy cordoning off space in warehouses etc Available in a choice of 3 base styles Triangular Plastic base filled with concrete for outdoor use Round Plastic hollow base to be filled with sand, water etc Square hard Rubber base Sets consist of 6 chain posts, 10M chain, 10 connecting links & 10 hooks
Version
Height mm
Colour
Red & White Triangular Plastic Base - Concrete Filled Black & Yellow Red & White
Square Hard Rubber Base
Black & Yellow
870
Red & White
Round Plastic Hollow Base
Black & Yellow
Base mm
Weight kg
300 SL
19.5
265 x 265
12
300 ø
6
Model 175.16.146 175.13.735 175.19.176 175.17.668 175.15.850 175.17.247
TRAFFIC LINE - BELT POSTS
WALL MOUNTED BELT CARTRIDGES
Flexible system providing demarcation of public areas from traffic routes Powder coated Aluminium posts Moulded bases with reflective disks Secure 4 point fixing for permanent installation fixings not included Self-tensioning belts with retraction feature Overall Height: 985mm Post Dia: 60mm
Belt Colour
3000mm Belt Length Model
Model
Black & Yellow
179.14.759
179.22.511
Belt Colour
Model
Post Colour Yellow Red
For entrances, doorways, stairs etc Easy to fix bracket Black Cartridge Belt Length-3000mm Self tensioning
4000mm Belt Length
Yellow
179.17.353
179.26.335
Black/Yellow Striped
179.18.124
Red & White
179.19.970
179.28.335
Black/Yellow/Black
179.19.708
Red
179.15.362
179.24.575
Red/White Striped
179.13.738
Wall Clip
179.16.000
Black/Red/Black
179.16.023
Belt Link
179.17.430
Black/Silver/Black
179.18.931
PARKING POSTS
COMMANDER - DROPDOWN FRAME POST
CONTROLLER PLUS -DROP DOWN POST
68mm profile design requires minimum ground clearance Sturdy Steel post 70/50mm section Blocking width 780mm Hot dip Galvanised with Red reflective rings Cylinder lock supplied
Version Commander Controller Plus
Surface Fixing
Height mm 570
112.19.889
Fixing into Concrete
570 (330 below ground)
112.19.774
Surface Fix - Keyed Alike
950
114.19.490
Surface Fix - Individually Keyed
950
114.13.120
Mounting
Model
Semi-automatic foot controlled lockable post 68mm profile design requires minimum ground clearance Unlock & gently push the post, making it recline Press the foot pedal at the base to make the post rise & lock Anodised Aluminium with Red reflective strips Surface mounted on an Aluminium bracket plate
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
417
Barrier Systems PREMISES SITE MAINTENANCE TRAFFIC LINE - HEAVY DUTYPALLET RACKING PROTECTORS Conform to DIN 4844 Safety Guidelines Provide protection from vulnerable frame ends & uprights Made in Steel & powder coated Yellow with Black bands Can effectively be used to protect machines, partitioning,mezzanine support columns, concrete columns etc Right angle - for corner protection bolted on 2 sides U-Profile - for three sided protection bolted on 3 sides TUV tested for strength & build quality Description
Right Angle
U-Profile Surface Fixing Bolts1
Overall Size H x W x Gauge mm 400 x 160 x 5
Fixing Bolts Required per protector 4
Weight kg 8
197.15.928
400 x 160 x 6 800 x 160 x 6
4
9
197.13.182
4
16
197.14.605
1200 x 160 x 6
4
22
197.18.380
400 x 160 x 6
6
11
197.18.365
-
0.2
100.17.393
2 x 100
Model
TRAFFIC LINE -COLLISION PROTECTION BARS Protect your shelves, cabinets, machinery etc Low profile design allows easy access to pedestrians Size: 76mm Dia., 3mm wall thickness Surface mounted with extra strength base plates Powder coated in Yellow with Black bands Description Protection Bars Fixing Bolts (4 per guard)
Overall Size H x W mm 86 x 400
Weight kg 5
195.13.478
86 x 800
7.5
195.19.220
86 x 1200
10
195.14.143
12 x 100
0.2
100.17.393
Model
TRAFFIC LINE - IMPACT PROTECTION RAILING SYSTEM - TUV APPROVED Extremely strong & versatile protective railing system Manufactured in structural Steel & hot dip Galvanised finish with Yellow powder coat - ideal for external use TUV tested for strength & build quality Posts: 100 x 100mm section Base Plate: 200 x 200mm Surface fixing 4 bolts Lateral Rails: 120 x 80mm section
Description
Overall Size H x W mm
Weight kg
Model
Bollard
1000 x 100 x 100
16
194.13.700
End Post
500 x 100 x 100
10
194.15.765
Centre Post
500 x 100 x 100
10.5
194.18.142
90 Angle Post
500 x 100 x 100
10.5
End Post
1000 x 100 x 100
17
Centre Post
1000 x 100 x 100
90o Angle Post
1000 x 100 x 100
o
418
194.15.032
Cross Bar 120 x 80mm 1000
Weight kg 9.5
194.16.672
194.13.501
1200
11.5
194.14.863
18
194.13.894
1500
14
194.16.449
18
194.15.572
2000
18
194.13.826
)F o r m o r e i n f o r m a t i o n , v i s i t w w w . l o c 8 . a e o r c a l l t o l l f r e e 8 0 0 - L O C 8 ( 5 6 2 8
Model
PREMISES
SITE&MAINTENANCE Posts Barriers COMMANDER - DROPDOWN FRAME POST Constructed from 100mm welded heavy duty square tubular Steel Ideal for dividing manufacturing units & equipment in warehouses etc Mounted on square floor plates with pre-drilled fixing holes for fixing to the floor. fixings not supplied The corner rail gives the option of a protective cage around equipment Finish: Stove Enamel Yellow
Triple Rail
Corner Section
SBR304
SBR200
Single Rail SBR104 Double Rail
Rail Length
SBR204
Single Rail Height 380mm
Triple Rail Height 1120mm
Model
Weight
Model
Weight
Model
1220mm2
7 kg
SBR104
58 kg
SBR204
84 kg
SBR304
1830mm4
1 kg
SBR106
76 kg
SBR206
111 kg
SBR306
2440mm5
0 kg
SBR108
94 kg
SBR208
129 kg
SBR308
50 kg
SBR100
94 kg
SBR200
136 kg
SBR300
Corner Section 1m x 1m
Weight
Double Rail Height 750mm
COMMANDER - DROPDOWN FRAME POST The rails on this protective barrier system are easy to remove allowing cost efficient access to machinery Posts are constructed from 80mm heavy duty square tubular Steel, & the rails from 100 x 50mm tubular Steel Mounted on square floor plates which are pre-drilled for fixing to the floor, fixings not supplied Finish: Stove enamel Yellow
SBLR04 & 2 x SBLP11
4 x SBLR04 & 2 x SBLP21 & 1 x SBLP22 Weight kg 9
SBLR04
1830 mm
13
SBLR06
2440 mm
17.5
SBLR08
Corner Post6
3000 mm
21.5
SBLR10
In Line Post6
Rail Length 1220 mm
Model
Description End Post5
Single Rail - 500mm High Weight kg .5
Model
Double Rail - 1100mm High Weight kg
Model
SBLP11
10
SBLP21
SBLP12
10.5
SBLP22
SBLP13
10.5
SBLP23
COMMANDER - DROPDOWN FRAME POST
These units provide isolation for drums & machinery offering protection to products & operators Manufactured from rectangular hollow section Steel these units can be bolted together in a line or at right angles Pre-drilled base plates for fixing to the floor with 12mm bolts, not provided Extension units are supplied with 2 joining bolts Finished in a stoved enamel safety Yellow
Standard Unit
Description Standard Extension Standard Extension
Length mm 1000 1000 1500 1500
Extension Unit
Height mm 1000 1000 1000 1000
Model SB1000 SE1000 SB1500 SE1500
)F o r m o r e i n f o r m a t i o n , v i s i t w w w . l o c 8 . a e o r c a l l t o l l f r e e 8 0 0 - L O C 8 ( 5 6 2 8
419
PREMISES Bollards & Posts FIXED BOLLARDS
PUSHLOCK PARKING POSTS
Offer permanent restriction ofaccess & protection for buildings Can be supplied with locating eyes to enable chains to be attachedfor boundary demarcation Finish: Black/Yellow Complete with installation literature Fixings not included
EXCAVATED
SURFACE
Folding post which is ideal for driveways& individual parking spaces Features an integral lock which can be‘keyed alike’ in multiple quantities Finish: Yellow Powder Coat Complete with installation literature Fixings not included
INTEGRAL LOCK CAN BE ‘KEYED ALIKE’
Type Surface Excavated
Section 89mm
Above Ground 910mm
Below Ground -
Weight kg 9
SURFACE
400mm
12
EXCAVATED
Model
COLLAPSIBLE POSTS
420
Height mm 765
Weight kg 6
Height mm 625
Weight kg 6
Model PUSHLOCK
TELESCOPIC MOLE PARKING POSTS Designed to be lowered into the groundwhen not in use but simple to raiseinto position when required Integral weatherproof lock which can be‘keyed alike’ in multiple quantities the light duty version requires a shackle padlock Finish: Galvanised Complete with installation literature Fixings not included
Lock into position with a shackle lock Anchor plates available to give a moresecure fixing - Call for Details Complete with installation literature Finish: Galvanised Fixings not included
Section mm 60
Section mm 60
PUSHLOCK
70mm
Above Below Ground Ground 590mm 720mm
Weight kg 12.5
LIGHTDUTY
89mm
700mm 400mm
17.5
HEAVYDUTY
Type
Section
Model
Light
COLLAPSIBLE
Heavy
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Model
Portable stores portable stores
1
Instant secure storage solution supplied in a flat pack form Can be linked together to create any size of store All panels are lightweight & easily handled by 2 people so no needfor hi-cab cranes or forklifts Can be dismantled & re-assembled again for transportation or site growth Fully Galvanised body with Green or Blue powder coat finish
Overall Size D x W mm 2075 x 2140
Door Size mm
Internal Depth mm 2000
3060 x 2140
1250
3000
KDC3
4000
KDC4
4050 x 2140
3
2
Model KDC2
2
Chemical stores Instant secure bunded storage solution supplied in a flat pack form Can be linked together to create any size of store All panels are lightweight & easily handled by 2 people so no need for hi-cab cranes or forklifts Can be dismantled & re-assembled again for transportation or site growthLifting eyes incorporated for lifting by a crane once fully assembled Fully welded sumped base to contain any spillage
Overall Size H x W mm 2160 x 2430 2160 x 3160 2160 x 4160
Door Size mm 800 each door
PREMISES
Internal Depth mm 2000K
1
3
Model DCC2
3000K
DCC3
4000K
DCC4
FLAT PACK OFFICE CABINS Instant low cost accommodation supplied in a flat pack form Can be linked together to create any size of cabin Double glazed windows completewith shutters for additional security Fitted with lights & sockets All panels are fully insulated Secure locking system White or Blue powder coat finish- please specify when ordering
Overall Size DxW 10ft x 8ftO 20ft x 8ftO
Model FC10 FC20 For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
421
PREMISES ground & raised dock tunnels GROUND & RAISED DOCK TUNNELS KDTR is used to cover large distances between vehicles & loading doors KDT rotates for applications where direct access cannot be achieved Can be supplied to fit specific size
Overall Size W x H x D mm
Model
3400 x 3500 x 3000
KDTR
3400 x 4500 x 3000
KDTR-G
4200 x 4500 x 1000
KDT
GROUND & RAISED DOCK TUNNELS Create a seal between dock opening & vehicle Help create a comfortable working environment& reduce costly heat loss Full height re-inforced dock shelters Double spring scissor action impact absorbers with heavy duty apron to prevent damage to the building Can be supplied to fit specific size
Overall Size W x H x D mm
Model
Raised Dock Shelter
3400 x 3500 x 650
KDRL
Ground Dock Shelter
3400 x 4500 x 700
KDG
Description
Warehouses & Dock Tunnels / Shelters Ideal for temporary storage Can be relocated as your business grows These warehouses are constructed using a Galvanised Steel frame & PVC fabric Highly versatile & strong structures that canbe used in all climates & conditions Very low costs - easily repaired & maintained No need for expensive & disruptive foundations Erected in just days creating minimaldisruption to your operations Fully compliant to British Standards for wind& snow loadings. Full technical support & civil engineering advice available
422
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
PVC Strip Curtains
PREMISES
SWIVEL HINGEHEADRAIL SYSTEM Heavy duty Galvanised swivel hinge headrail system which is suitable for 300 & 400mm strips Recommended where forklifts are in use Headrail comes pre-assembled & strips are cut to length ready to hang Variety of overlaps to suit your needs
Hook-on Headrail SyStem Hook-on headrail system available in Stainless Steel & Galvanised finishes Suitable for use with 200, 300 &400mm strips Recommended for pedestrian &pallet truck traffic Variety of overlaps to suit your needs
MaXBULLET HEADRAIL SYSTEM Headrail made from cross-linked Polymer Suitable for pedestrian doorways Kits are supplied 965W x 2000H mm complete with rails & strips cut to length & punched –ready to hang
REPLACEMENT PVC All sizes of PVC are available including Standard, Polargrade, Double Ribbed, Green & Bronze welding & various colours The PVC can be supplied in 50m rolls or cut to your required length 50m PVC rolls
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
423
PREMISES TRAFFIC MANAGEMENT ROCOL Traffic Management If you have responsibility for health and safety in your organisation, you will know how important it is to manage the speed and flow of traffic on your site. Health & Safety Executive figures place vehicle accidents as the second biggest killer in the workplace but unfortunately, it is often only when an accident occurs that the need for traffic management is addressed. It is difficult to raise speed awareness with drivers on private roads, so it’s important to introduce a traffic management system that reduces speed and is easy to alter when requirements on your site change. The Pacer® speed ramp is recognised internationally as an effective method of speed reduction. Speed ramps are recommended by the Workplace (Health, Safety & Welfare) Regulations 1992 as a ‘suitable speed retarder’ and the Pacer® range provides for speed reductions down to 10, 20 or 30 kmh. The Pacer® brand is recognised for its durability and effectiveness and with the addition of Pacer2® to the range, the scope of applications has increased to include all budgets and locations. Because of the modular construction of all Pacer® products, they are easy to relocate as traffic management needs alter or increase. ROCOL Site Safety‑Systems specialists are available to give free site surveys and easy to use layout guides assist in optimising the use of Pacer® systems. Pacer® traffic management systems have already proved a valuable asset to thousands of organisations and will clearly state to employees, customers and the public that safety is a priority on your site.
424
10
20
30
KMH
KMH
KMH
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
TRAFFIC MANAGEMENT
PREMISES
Pacer® & Mini Pacer® The Pacer® system has been successfully utilised worldwide as a speed deterrent for over 15 years. Its unique construction utilising hard, high impact virgin rubber guarantees an extremely durable product that has been tested with loads of up to 40 tonnes. The Pacer®system is ideal for areas of intense, heavy traffic such as manufacturing sites, large retail parks and hospitals. Available in standard or mini size, the features include: • Typical design life of ten years. • Modular construction which provides for easy installation and relocation to suit individual site requirements. Patented Expandaplug fixing system.
• Yellow and black rubber sections providing a highly visible speed deterrent. • Integrated red and green cats eyes which provide maximum visibility for the ramps at night and allow night time directional traffic flow. • A grooved surface assisting traction in wet and icy conditions. • An opening for a steel pole to align the modules, which can be substituted for cables and hoses in temporary applications. • Patented Expandaplug fixing system for use in concrete and asphalt. • End caps which allow for the safe passage of fork lift trucks and bicycles. • Standard size dimensions of 410 x 250 x 68mm.
10 KMH
20
Cats eye system for superior night time visibility.
KMH
• Mini size dimensions of 345 x 250 x 50mm.
Manufacturing Sites Distribution Depots Hospital Complexes Mass Transit Sites Utility Companies Service Areas
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
425
OFFICE COMPUTER CABINET
Pull out shelf
Computer cabinet - 40-602-2044 • The cabinet is ideal for use in manufacturing, engineering and other industrial environments. The monitor storage section has a door opening W x H 590 x 650 mm, with a Plexiglas window. • The lower storage section has lockable double doors, opening W x H 590 x 855 mm and is equipped with a movable shelf, an energy panel with 5 earthed sockets and a ventilation fan with filter. Inside depth of cabinet is 530 mm. The computer cabinet has 4 adjustable feet. Available in beige or blue (please state when ordering) • Pull out shelf fits in the bottom part of a computer cabinet. Fitted with telescopic guides which allow a 110% pull-out. Supplied complete with attachments. • Castor kit consists of 4 x 75mm castors two with brake. Attaches to the pre drilled threaded holes on the underside of a computer cabinet.
Castor Kit
Computer cabinet Mini- 40-601-2001 • The computer cabinet mini is designed for protecting computers against dust, knocks and bumps in industrial environments. The cabinet has an opening of 590 x 650mm with lockable door fitted with Plexiglas window, lockable, pull-out keyboard shelf and mouse mat with a pull out to the left or right. Available in beige or blue (please state colour when ordering) Computer cabinet Mini Description
426
Dimension W x D x H
Max load EDLPart No.
Model
Computer cabinet
150kg
642 x 545 x 1733 mm
40-602-2044
Additional pull-out shelf
50kg
560 x 400 mm
40-357-2001
Castor kit (4 castors)
150 kg
ø 75 mm
40-441-0004
Computer cabinet Mini
35kg
642 x 545 x 866
40-601-2001
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
NOTICE BOARDS
OFFICE
Felt Noticeboards
Corded Hessian Noticeboards
Bright, elegant and durable these aluminium framed felt noticeboards are pinnable and Velcro® friendly.
• 12mm pinboard core
• 12mm pinboard core
• Aluminium framed as standard • Fabric is flame retardant to BS476 Class 1, BS5867,
• Felt is flame retardant to BS 476, Part 7, Class 1 • Choice of 6 felt colours
Part 2 and colourfast to BS1006, Level 5/6
• Choice of 8 fabric colours
Description Dimensions Model Price w x h mm 90 x 60 mm D201012 £24.00 1200 x 90 mm D201014 £34.25 Felt Noticeboards 1200 x 1200 mm D201015 £41.25 1800 x 1200 mm D201017 £54.85
Classic Showcases
Description Dimensions Model Price w x h 90 x 60 mm D209212 £25.25 Corded Hessian 1200 x 90 mm D209214 £36.65 Noticeboards 1200 x 1200 mm D209215 £44.50 1800 x 1200 mm D209217 £60.65
Prestige Showcases
• 12mm pinboard core • Anodised aluminium frame • Felt covered backboard - FR Class 1 • Felt covered 2mm pinboard core - FR Class 1
• 4mm toughened safety glass sliding doors
• Clear lockable polycarbonate glazed door - FR Class 1
• Doors are totally encapsulated within frame
• Discrete allen key locking mechanism
• Chrome finger pulls and push button lock
• Anodised aluminium frame
• Radius nylon reinforced safety corners
• Choice of 6 felt coloured backboards
• Choice of 6 felt backboard colours
• Supplied complete with fixing
• Supplied complete with fixings
Description Dimensions
Description Dimensions Model Price Model Price w x h w x h 90 x 60 mm D213100 £64.00 90 x 60 mm D215001 £133.50 1200 x 900 mm D213101 £85.75 1200 x 90 mm D215003 £176.00 Classic Showcases Prestige Showcases 1200 x 1200 mm D215004 £206.50 1200 x 1200 mm D213102 £102.85 1800 x 1200 mm D215008 £273.25 1800 x 1200 mm D213106 £171.50
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
427
OFFICE WHITEBOARDS Non Magnetic Whiteboards
• Double sided boards guaranteed for 5 years • Anodised aluminium frame • Supplied complete with fixings Description Non Magnetic Whiteboards
Dimensions Model Price w x h 0.9 x 0.6m W102033 £17.25 1.2 x 0.9m W102035 £22.85 1.8 x 1.2m W102039 £54.85 2.4 x 1.2m W102040 £68.65
Magnetic Whiteboards
• Single sided - surface guaranteed for 30 years • Alu zinc balancer on reverse for stability and flatness • Anodised aluminium frame • Lightweight honeycomb core • Supplied complete with fixings
Description MagneticWhiteboards
Dimensions Model Price w x h 0.9 x 0.6m W102063 £34.35 1.2 x 0.9m W102064 £57.25 1.2 x 1.2m W102067 £98.50 1.8 x 1.2m W102068 £125.75
Description
Model
Price
Whiteboard Accessories • Whiteboard Stater Pack includes - 6 markers, 1 pen holder, 1 felt eraser and 1 board renovator
Dry Marker Pens 0.3m Clip-on Pen Shelf Whiteboard Starter Pack
W906017 W900000 W904010
£3.85 £3.25 £10.95
Mobile Whiteboards
Portable Display Systems
• Double sided non magnetic dry-wipe surfaces • 5 year board guarantee
• Aluminium Frame - no detachable components
• Board rotates through 360O
• Velcro® friendly loop nylon panel size - 0.69 x 1.0m
• Powder coated steel frame
• Loop nylon is flame retardant to BS5876, Part 2
• Heavy duty rubber tyred castors will not mark floors
• 7 colours - option of colour combinations per side
• 4 castors - 2 lockable
Description
Description Mobile Whiteboards
428
Dimensions Model Price w x h 1.2 x 0.9m W106001 £160.75 1.5 x 1.2m W106003 £186.50 1.8 x 1.2m W106004
Single Sided - 6 Panel System Single Sided - 8 Panel System Double Sided - 6 Panel System Double Sided - 8 Panel System Carry Bag
Model
Price
D217001 D217004 D217002 D217005 D217003
£245.75 £331.50 £297.25 £388.50 £36.50
)F o r m o r e i n f o r m a t i o n , v i s i t w w w . l o c 8 . a e o r c a l l t o l l f r e e 8 0 0 - L O C 8 ( 5 6 2 8
Office Filing Systems
OFFICE
GRIP-A-STRIP
You know how it is with overcrowded memo and notice boards that soon become messy and unclear. Or there is the trick with the elastic band and drawing pins to keep something on the wall freed of that old, ugly notice board. The Grip-a-Strip is not only much easier and efficient to use, the aluminium clamping frame is also highly attractive. The Grip-a-Strip is available in three standard lengths: 60, 90 and 120 cm in the colour aluminium. The Grip-a-Strip is provided as standard with drilled holes and fastening material. This means: buy it, hang it up, use it! The Grip-a-Strip consists of an impact-resistant aluminium profile, with a running mechanism of small synthetic wheels. At the ends the profile is neatly finished with black caps. In no time at all you have your paper from A7 to A0 firmly attached. Maps, posters, drawings, memos, flip-over charts, offers, production statistics, etc. can all be simply slid into the Grip-a-Strip. Once in, the paper can no longer fall out of the profile. Once again, with a simple hand movement (pull the poster, drawing, etc. 90 o towards you) you bring it out of the Grip-a-Strip without any damage whatsoever. The applications of the Grip-a-Strip are many: in the office, for memos and info bulletins; at home, for posters and shopping lists; at school for drawings and work; in the production hall, for time statements and production statistics; in conference spaces, for flip-over charts and presentation drawings, etc. In short: the possibilities of use of the Grip-a-Strip are boundless. Description Stand. pack. / min. order qty. Grip-a-Strip of 600 mm 6/1 Grip-a-Strip of 900 mm 6/1 Grip-a-Strip of 1200 mm 6/1
Order no. 7980600 7980900 7981200
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
429
OFFICE Reception Furniture
INVITE RECEPTION • •
Ordering Information
Invite is a modular reception system These base units, complemented with counter tops, shelves & other accessories, create smart & professional reception units
To ensure the correct components are ordered,including cut-back legs in the correct positions, &tops suitably drilled for top boxes, a drawing of therequired arrangement must be provided with theorder. Help can be given by discussing your needswith our Sales or CAD department
Colour Options Available
• Oak
•
Beech Maple Other colour options available - Call for Details These Receptions are delivered built-up.Therefore you must complete a questionnaire about access
BASE UNITS
The base units are plain top units Drill holes for counter tops or shelves will be made if specified on your order, adding 10%
Rectangular Base Units W x D x H mm
Model
800 x 800 x 727
PRUT08-8P
1200 x 800 x 727
PRUT12-8P
1400 x 800 x 727
PRUT14-8P
1600 x 800 x 727
PRUT16-8P
1800 x 800 x 727
PRUT18-8P
Rectangular Base Units with Wheelchair Access W x D x H mm
Model
1600 x 800 x 727
PRUT16-8PW
1800 x 800 x 727
PRUT18-8PW
Convex Radius Base Units
COUNTER TOPS & ACCESSORIES Straight Counter Tops W x D x H mm Model 800 x 325 x 465 PRCT8 1200 x 325 x 465 PRCT12 1400 x 325 x 465 PRCT14 1600 x 325 x 465 PRCT16 1800 x 325 x 465 PRCT18 Convex Radius Counter Tops W x D x H mm
Model
900 radius x 325 x 465
PRCTR9
1200 radius x 325 x 465
PRCTR12
Hatch & Gate Module W x D x H mm
Model
1000 x 800 x 727
PRHM
Available Left or Right Hand (Right Hand Shown) Concave Radius Counter Tops W x D x H mm
Model
1200 radius x 325 x 465
PRCTCR12
Pigeon Hole Unit
W x D x H mm
Model
W x D x H mm
Model
900 radius x 727
PRUTR9-8P
560 x 300 x 439
PRPHU
1200 radius x 727
PRUTR12-8P
Convex Radius Base Unit with Wheelchair Access W x D x H mm
Model
1200 radius x 727
PRUTR12-8PW
Concave Radius Base Unit
430
When situated against a wall, the Lift-up Hatch & Gate unit must be firmly secured to a wall.This is your responsibility & instructions will beleft with the unit
W x D x H mm
Model
1200 radius x 727
PRUTCR12-8P
Rectangular Reception Shelves W x D x H mm Model 800 x 300 x 305 PRS8 1200 x 300 x 305 PRS12 1400 x 300 x 305 PRS14 1600 x 300 x 305 PRS16 1800 x 300 x 305 PRS18 Radius Reception Shelves W x D x H mm
Model
900 radius x 300 x 465 1200 radius x 300 x 465
PRSR9 PRSR12
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Reception Seating
OFFICE
FORUM SEATING • •
A simple low cost range of modular reception seating Comfortable & practical solution for all reception areas
FRS
FR1
FR1A2
FR1AL
FR1AR
Forum Unit Chair
Overall Size W x D x H mm 560 x 820 x 910
Forum Unit Chair - Left Arm
660 x 820 x 910
FR1AL
Forum Unit Chair - Right Arm
660 x 820 x 910
FR1AR
Forum Unit Arm Chair
860 x 820 x 910
FR1A2
Forum Corner Segment
470 x 550 x 910
FRS
Forum Unit Table (Maple/Beech Top)
770 x 770 x 300
FRT
Description
Model FR1
FRT
ENCOUNTER SEATING • • •
These attractive tub chairs & sofas will enhanceany reception or informal meeting area Stylish & comfortable Choice of fabric or leather look finishes
Stock Colours
Leather Look
Blue Fabric
Overall Size W x D x H mm (D) Encounter Single Tub Seat Blue, Fully Upholstered 700 x 660 x 780 Black, Leather Look 700 x 660 x 780 (E) Encounter Sofa Tub Seat Blue, Fully Uphostered 1235 x 630 x 770 Black, Leather Look 1235 x 630 x 770 Description
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Model EN3/F/BLUE EN1/PU/BLK EN4/F/BLUE EN2/PU/BLK
431
OFFICE Office Furniture IMPACT AFFORDABLE DESKING
STANDARD WORKSTATIONS (A) No Pedestals
(B) Single Pedestal Desk (2 Drawer)
(C) Single Pedestal Desk (3 Drawer)
(D) Double Pedestal Desk
• •
18mm worktops with 2mm PVC edging Comprehensive range of matching storage W x D x H mm Model (A) Standard - No Pedestal (OAK,MA,BCH) 1200 x 800 x 720 ZIMSW12SPX2 1600 x 800 x 720 ZIMSW16SPX2 1800 x 800 x 720 ZIMSW18SPX2 (B) Standard - Single Pedestal - 2 Drawer (OAK,MA,BCH) 1200 x 800 x 720 ZIMSW12SP2D 1600 x 800 x 720 ZIMSW16SP2D 1800 x 800 x 720 ZIMSW18SP2D (C) Standard - Single Pedestal - 3 Drawer (OAK,MA,BCH) 1200 x 800 x 720 ZIMSW12SP3D 1600 x 800 x 720 ZIMSW16SP3D 1800 x 800 x 720 ZIMSW18SP3D (D) Standard - Double Pedestal (OAK,MA,BCH) 1600 x 800 x 720 (2 x 2 Drawers) ZIMSW16/2X2D 1800 x 800 x 720 (2 x 2 Drawers) ZIMSW18/2X2D 1600 x 800 x 720 (2 x 3 Drawers) ZIMSW16/2X3D 1800 x 800 x 720 (2 x 3 Drawers) ZIMSW18/2X3D 1600 x 800 x 720 (2 & 3 Drawers) ZIMSW16/2D3D 1800 x 800 x 720 (2 & 3 Drawers) ZIMSW18/2D3D
CORE WORKSTATIONS (E) Core Workstation - Cantilever Leg Rectangular Workstation
W x D x H mm
(E) Core Workstation - Panel End
Model
Price
(E) Core Workstation Cantilever Leg (O/G,M/S,B/S) Left Hand 1600 x 1200/800/600 x 720 ZIM16LCF Left Hand 1800 x 1200/800/600 x 720 ZIM18LCF Right Hand 1600 x 1200/800/600 x 720 ZIM16RCF Right Hand 1800 x 1200/800/600 x 720 ZIM18RCF (E) Core Workstation Panel End (OAK,MA,BCH) Left Hand 1600 x 1200/800/600 x 720 ZIM16LP Left Hand 1800 x 1200/800/600 x 720 ZIM18LP Right Hand 1600 x 1200/800/600 x 720 ZIM16RP Right Hand 1800 x 1200/800/600 x 720 ZIM18RP
RECTANGULAR WORKSTATIONS
(F) Rectangular Workstation - Panel End
(F) Rectangular Workstation - Cantilever
Rectangular Workstation
Leg
W x D x H mm Model (F) Rectangular Workstation Cantilever Leg (O/G,M/S,B/S) 800 x 800 x 720 ZIM0808CF 1200 x 800 x 720 ZIM1208CF 1400 x 800 x 720 ZIM1408CF 1600 x 800 x 720 ZIM1608CF 1800 x 800 x 720 ZIM1808CF (F) Rectangular Workstation Panel End (OAK,MA,BCH) 800 x 800 x 720 ZIM0808P 1200 x 800 x 720 ZIM1208P 1400 x 800 x 720 ZIM1408P 1600 x 800 x 720 ZIM1608P 1800 x 800 x 720 ZIM1808P
WAVE WORKSTATIONS (G) Wave Workstation - Cantilever Leg
(G) Wave Workstation - Panel End
W x D x H mm
Model
(G) Wave Workstation Cantilever Leg (O/G,M/S,B/S) Left Hand 1400 x 800/1000 x 720 ZIM1410LWC Left Hand 1600 x 800/1000 x 720 ZIM1610LWC Right Hand 1400 x 800/1000 x 720 ZIM1410RWC Right Hand 1600 x 800/1000 x 720 ZIM1610RWC (G) Wave Workstation Panel End (OAK,MA,BCH) Left Hand 1400 x 800/1000 x 720 ZIM1410LWP Left Hand 1600 x 800/1000 x 720 ZIM1610LWP Right Hand 1400 x 800/1000 x 720 ZIM1410RWP Right Hand 1600 x 800/1000 x 720 ZIM1610RWP
Ordering Information When placing your order please suffix the productcode with the relevant code for the colour yourequire e.g. add B/S forBeech & Silver = ZIM16LCFB/S please refer to the swatches shown
432
O/G Oak & Graphite
M/S Maple & Silver
B/S Beech & Silver
OAK
MA
BCH
Oak
Maple
Beech
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Office Furniture
OFFICE
STORAGE & TABLES OAK
MA
BCH
Oak
Maple
Beech
O/G
M/S
Oak & Graphite
B/S
Maple & Silver
OAK
MA
BCH
Oak
Maple
Beech
Beech & Silver
W x D x H mm
Model
(H) Low Mobile Pedestals (OAK,MA,BCH) 392 x 600 x 550 - 2 Drawer
MP2
392 x 600 x 550 - 3 Drawer
MP3
(I) Desk High Pedestals (OAK,MA,BCH) 392 x 600 x 720
IMDHP63
392 x 800 x 720
IMDHP83
)K(
)H(
(J) High Mobile Pedestals (OAK,MA,BCH) 392 x 600 x 680 - 3 Drawer
)M(
HMP3
(K) Low Mobile Steel Pedestals 400 x 575 x 580 - 3 Drawer
JMRP01SIL
)J(
)I(
)L(
Workmode / Jetstream Pedestals 392 x 600 x 727
DHP36
392 x 800 x 727
DHP38
W x D x H mm
Model
(L) Desk End Cupboard (OAK,MA,BCH) 800 x 500 x 720 - Locks Fitted
ZSU708DD
Shelf
SUS08
(M) Filing Cabinets - Locks Fitted (OAK,MA,BCH) 490 x 640 x 720 - 2 Drawer
SUFC2
490 x 640 x 1066 - 3 Drawer
SUFC3
490 x 640 x 1421 - 4 Drawer
SUFC4
)O(
)N(
(N) Bookcases (OAK,MA,BCH) 800 x 310 x 800 - 1 Shelf
ZIMBC800
800 x 310 x 1400 - 2 Shelves
ZIMBC1400
800 x 310 x 1600 - 3 Shelves
ZIMBC1600
800 x 310 x 1800 - 3 Shelves
ZIMBC1800
Extra Bookcase Shelf
IMBCS80
(P) Conference Tablewith Tubular Legs
(O) Desk High Bookcase (OAK,MA,BCH) 800 x 310 x 720 - 1 Shelf
ZIMBC728
Bookcase Shelf
IMBCS80
W x D x H mm
Model
(P) Rectangular Conference Tables (O/G,M/S,B/S) 1200 x 800 x 727
ZTABT12
1600 x 800 x 727
ZTABT16
(Q) Circular Conference Tables (OAK,MA,BCH) 1000 Diameter
ZTABTD10
1200 Diameter
ZTABTD12
(Q) Conference Table with Cruciform Leg
Ordering Information When placing your order please suffix the productcode with the relevant code for the colour yourequire e.g. add BCH for Beech = ZIMBC800BCH- please refer to the swatches shown.
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
433
OFFICE Workmode Office Furniture - Cantilever Leg WORKMODE OFFICE FURNITURE REAL SYSTEMS DESKING • • •
25mm MFC worktops with cable ports Solid 3mm PVC edging Comprehensive range of matchingstorage & tables - Call for details Ordering Information When placing your order please suffix the productcode with the relevant code for the colour yourequire e.g. add B/S forBeech & Silver = ZIM16LCFB/S please refer to the swatches shown
O/G
M/S
Oak & Graphite
Maple & Silver
B/S Beech & Silver
CORE WORKSTATIONS W x D x H mm
Model
Left Hand 1600 x 1200/800/600 x 727
ZWM16LC
Left Hand 1800 x 1200/800/600 x 727
ZWM18LC
Right Hand 1600 x 1200/800/600 x 727
ZWM16RC
Right Hand 1800 x 1200/800/600 x 727
ZWM18RC
RECTANGULAR WORKSTATIONS
W x D x H mm
Model
800 x 800 x 727
ZWM8080C
1200 x 800 x 727
ZWM1280C
1400 x 800 x 727
ZWM1480C
1600 x 800 x 727
ZWM1680C
1800 x 800 x 727
ZWM1880C
WAVE WORKSTATIONS
W x D x H mm
Model
Left Hand 1400 x 1000/800 x 727
ZWM1410LWC
Left Hand 1600 x 1000/800 x 727
ZWM1610LWC
Right Hand 1400 x 1000/800 x 727
ZWM1410RWC
Right Hand 1600 x 1000/800 x 727
ZWM1610RWC
NARROW RECTANGULAR WORKSTATIONS
434
W x D x H mm
Model
800 x 600 x 727
ZWM8060C
1200 x 600 x 727
ZWM1260C
1600 x 600 x 727
ZWM1660C
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Workmode Office Furniture - Panel End
OFFICE
WORKMODE OFFICE FURNITURE REAL SYSTEMS DESKING • • •
25mm MFC worktops with cable ports Solid 3mm PVC edging Comprehensive range of matching storage & tables - Call for details Ordering Information When placing your order please suffix the productcode with the relevant code for the colour yourequire e.g. add B/S forBeech & Silver = ZIM16LCFB/S please refer to the swatches shown
OAK
MA
BCH
Oak
Maple
Beech
CORE WORKSTATIONS W x D x H mm
Model
Left Hand 1600 x 1200/800/600 x 727
ZWM16LP
Left Hand 1800 x 1200/800/600 x 727
ZWM18LP
Right Hand 1600 x 1200/800/600 x 727
ZWM16RP
Right Hand 1800 x 1200/800/600 x 727
ZWM18RP
RECTANGULAR WORKSTATIONS W x D x H mm
Model
800 x 800 x 727
ZWM8080P
1200 x 800 x 727
ZWM1280P
1400 x 800 x 727
ZWM1480P
1600 x 800 x 727
ZWM1680P
1800 x 800 x 727
ZWM1880P
WAVE WORKSTATIONS W x D x H mm
Model
Left Hand 1400 x 1000/800 x 727
ZWM1410LWP
Left Hand 1600 x 1000/800 x 727
ZWM1610LWP
Right Hand 1400 x 1000/800 x 727
ZWM1410RWP
Right Hand 1600 x 1000/800 x 727
ZWM1610RWP
NARROW RECTANGULAR WORKSTATIONS W x D x H mm
Model
800 x 600 x 727
ZWM8060P
1200 x 600 x 727
ZWM1260P
1600 x 600 x 727
ZWM1660P
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
435
OFFICE Executive Office Furniture PRIME OFFICE FURNITURE RICH FINISH WITH FINE DETAILING the perfect solution for the executive office • • •
CORE WORKSTATIONS
36mm thick work surfaces Circular cable ports on desk Full depth modesty panels
W x D x H mm Model Bow Front Executive Desk (CH, HM) 1800 x 1050 x 750 ZWSPME389 Writing Pads Black PVC WSWP2150/PBLK
RETURN SHELF / CONNECTION TOPS
W x D x H mm
Model
(A) Return Shelf (CH, HM) 890 x 590 x 750 WSPME392 (B) Connection Top (CH, HM) Left Hand 900 x 1000 x 36 WSPMECT (L) Right Hand 900 x 1000 x 36 WSPMECT (R) (C) Metal Black Leg 75 diameter x 720 WSMLPL720-3E
PEDESTALS W x D x H mm Model (D) Under Desk Pedestals (CH, HM) (supplied without Top) 400 x 550 x 714 WSPM166 (E) Top for Pedestals 36mm thick WSPME166T
LOW STORAGE W x D x H mm
Model
(F) Double Door Cabinet (CH, HM) Supplied complete with 1 shelf 800 x 560 x 750 WSPME313 (G) 2 Drawer Lateral Filer (CH, HM) 800 x 560 x 750 WSPME312
Ordering Information When placing your order please suffix the product code with the relevant code for the colour you require e.g. add CH for Wildbrine Cherry = ZPME389CH- please refer to the swatches shown. Wildbrine Cherry
436
CH
Lucida Pear
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
LP
Executive Office Furniture
HIGH STORAGE (H) High Cabinet with Wooden Doors
(I) High Cabinet with Glass Doors
OFFICE
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628) W x D x H mm
Model
(H) High Cabinet with Wooden Doors (CH, HM) Supplied complete with 4 shelves 800 x 450 x 2005 ZWSPM2080 (I) High Cabinet with Glass Doors (CH, HM) Supplied complete with 4 shelves 800 x 450 x 2005 ZWSPM2080GD
TABLES (J) Oval Conference Table W x D x H mm
Model
(J) Oval Conference Table (CH, HM) 1800 x 900 x 750 ZWSPM135 2400 x 1100 x 750 ZWSPM136 (K) Round Meeting Table (CH, HM) 1200 diameter x 750 ZWSPM123 1000 diameter x 750 ZWSPM127 (K) Round Meeting Table
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
437
OFFICE Jetstream Office Furniture JETSTREAM OFFICE FURNITURE UP TO THE MINUTE APPEARANCE • • •
25mm MFC worktops with cable ports Wood finish panels Comprehensive range of matching storage & tables - Call for details Ordering Information When placing your order please suffix the productcode with the relevant code for the colour yourequire e.g. add B/S forBeech & Silver = ZIM16LCFB/S please refer to the swatches shown
M/S
B/S
Maple & Silver
Beech & Silver
CORE WORKSTATIONS W x D x H mm
Model
Core Workstation (M/S, B/S) Left Hand 1600 x 1200/800/600 x 727 ZJT16LCW Left Hand 1800 x 1200/800/600 x 727 ZJT18LCW Right Hand 1600 x 1200/800/600 x 727 ZJT16RCW Right Hand 1800 x 1200/800/600 x 727 ZJT18RCW
RECTANGULAR WORKSTATIONS W x D x H mm Model Rectangular Workstation (M/S, B/S) 800 x 800 x 727 ZJT8080CW 1200 x 800 x 727 ZJT1280CW 1400 x 800 x 727 ZJT1480CW 1600 x 800 x 727 ZJT1680CW 1800 x 800 x 727 ZJT1880CW
WAVE WORKSTATIONS W x D x H mm
Model
Wave Workstation (M/S, Left Hand 1400 x 1000/800 x 727 Left Hand 1600 x 1000/800 x 727 Right Hand 1400 x 1000/800 x 727 Right Hand 1600 x 1000/800 x 727
B/S) ZJT1410LWCW ZJT1610LWCW ZJT1410RWCW ZJT1610RWCW
NARROW RECTANGULAR WORKSTATIONS W x D x H mm Narrow Rect.Workstation 800 x 600 x 727 1200 x 600 x 727 1600 x 600 x 727
438
Model (M/S, B/S) ZJT8060CW ZJT1260CW ZJT1660CW
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Office Screens
OFFICE
DESK SCREENS • • • •
Provide privacy & noise reduction in your office 40mm depth with a fabric finish & a MFC core Brackets are supplied to fit to the desk tops 6 colour options: Blue
Black
Red
Charcoal
Burgundy
Overall Size W x H mm 1600 x 187/370
EDS160
1800 x 187/370
EDS180
2026 x 187/370
EDS202
2226 x 187/370
EDS222
Model
Green
WOODEN SCREENS • •
Ideal for transforming your Canteen area, Reception area, Waiting Roomsetc into cosy areas Supplied complete with silver feet
Line Design
Square Design
Plus Design
Design
Trellis Design
Solid Design
Model
Line
WSLI26
Square
WSSQ24
Plus Open Grid Design
Overall Size W x H mm
Open Grid
940 x 1720
WSPL25 WSOG62
Trellis
WSTR63
Solid
WSSO23
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
439
OFFICE Office cabinets CONTRACT STORAGE FILING CABINETS • • • •
Fitted with an anti-tilt device that prevents more than one drawer being open at a time Modern swan neck, flush, anti-snag handles Central locking on all cabinets Available in Coffee Cream, Goose Grey or Black
Ordering Information When placing your order please suffix the product code with the relevant code for the colour you require e.g. add C/C for Coffee Cream = A0C4C/C - please refer to the swatches shown. No. of Drawers 2
Overall Size W x D x H mm 470 x 622 x 711
A0C2*
3
470 x 622 x 1016
A0C3*
4
470 x 622 x 1321
A0C4*
Model
CONTRACT STATIONERY CUPBOARDS •
•
1 & 3 shelf models available in a choice of Goose Grey or Coffee Cream, these double door units are supplied fitted with shelves & are ideal for storing everyday files & stationery itemsA Black dual purpose shelf is available as an optional extra
No. of Shelves 1
Overall Size W x D x H mm 914 x 400 x 1000
3
914 x 400 x 1806
E722A03*
4
914 x 400 x 1950
E782A04G/G*
-
Additional Dual Shelf
E198P1
Model E402A01*
CONTRACT SIDE OPENING TAMBOURS • • •
Tambour units are priced empty ready to accept storage fitments as shown Units are manufactured with a welded carcass for greater strength Note: Storage fitments will not be installed into any Tambours on delivery but will be left on site with instructions for self assembly
Maple/Silver
Beech/Silver
Goose Grey
Overall Size W x D x H mm 1000 x 470 x 1016
IME101SOTG/G
1000 x 470 x 1651
IME161SOTG/G
1000 x 470 x 1968
IME191SOTG/G
Shelf
Grey, allow 60mm
BBSP1
Filing Rail
Allow 285mm with files
BUR
Description Tambours
440
Model
Oak/Graphite
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Drawing Hanger Systems TROLLEY CARRIER
TROLLEY CARRIER
•
• •
• •
Maximise the number of drawings stored per square metre of floor space Easily manoeuvred around the office Holds a maximum of 20 hangers, with or without handles & offers a capacity of 2000* sheets*dependant on paper weight & thickness
Overall Size H x W x D mm 960 x 725 x 640
Capacity Sheets
1260 x 915 x 640
2000
1360 x 1000 x 640
Ideal for use in the office or project reference site Hangers can be flipped through like a book with out the need to open the hanger
Powerful Clamp Hinge
Optional Carry Handle
Model
Overall Hanger Length mm 720
Paper Clamping Length mm 650
TA1/TCADA1
910
841
TA0
720
650
TCADA0
995
925
TROLLEY CARRIER
TROLLEY CARRIER
•
•
•
Suitable for a permanent filing location, particularly if space is at a premium Holds a maximum of 10 hangers, with or withouthandles & offers a capacity of 500* sheets*dependant on paper weight & thickness
• •
OFFICE
Capacity Sheets
Model A1 A0
100
A1CAD A0CAD
Steel cabinet which holds up to 1000* sheets*dependant on paper weight & thickness Finished in 2 tone Grey or Coffee/Cream.Other colours are available upon request Planstrips are available - Call for Details
A0 4 PRONG
AT A0 2 PRONG
Overall Size Capacity Model H x W x D mm Sheets Standard Drawing & Plan Cabinet Overall Size H x W x D mm 182 x 730 x 285 182 x 920 x 285 182 x 730 x 285 1360 x 1005 x 640
Capacity Sheets
Model WA1
500
WA0 WCADA1 WCADA0
A1 4 PRONG
1105 x 740 x 430 1380 x 920 x 430
1000
A0 2 PRONG A0 4 PRONG
Anti-Tilt Drawing & Plan Cabinet 1380 x 920 x 430
800
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
AT A0 2 PRONG AT A0 4 PRONG
441
OFFICE ROTARY FILIN G SYSTEMS
ROTARY FILING SYSTEMS • • • • •
Laminated shelf design - no bowing Lightweight shelves rotate on needle bearings Central axle runs on needle bearings at every level Castor bases & high stands gives max loading on each shelf without the unit swaying 2 Shelf Colours Available 2 Stand/Castor Base Colours Available
Beech
W hite
Chrome
Black
Please specify colour when ordering Overall Size Dia. x H mm
Description
No of A4 Folders Held
Model RF2C05T
Rotary Filing System
442
2 Shelves with Castor Base - With Top
680 x 870
54
2 Shelves with Castor Base - With Top
850 x 870
80
RF2C08T
2 Shelves with High Stand - Without Top
680 x 1520
54
RF2H05N
2 Shelves with High Stand - With Top
680 x 1520
54
RF2H05T
3 Shelves with Castor Base - With Top
680 x 1240
81
RF3C08T
3 Shelves with Castor Base - With Top
850 x 1240
120
RF3C12T
4 Shelves with Castor Base - With Top
680 x 1620
108
RF4C10T
4 Shelves with Castor Base - Without Top
850 x 1620
160
RF4C16N
4 Shelves with Castor Base - With Top
850 x 1620
160
RF4C16T
5 Shelves with Castor Base - Without Top
850 x 1975
200
RF5C20N
5 Shelves with Castor Base - With Top
850 x 1975
200
RF5C20T
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Chair Mats
OFFICE
CLEARTEX ULTIMAT • • • •
Ideal for Home & Office Flooring The ultimate in quality, clarity & durability Manufactured from crystal clear Polycarbonate The toughest & most durable protection for floors
Mat Size L x W mm
Model
Gripper Backed Mat suitable for Carpeted Floors 1190 x 890
FC118923ER
1200 x 1500
FC1115223ER
Smooth Backed Mat suitable for Hard Floors 1190 x 890
FC128919ER
1200 x 1500
FC1215219ER
CLEARTEX ADVANTAGEMAT • • • •
Ideal for Home & Office Flooring Affordable, long lasting floor protection Manufactured from a unique PVC formulation for a more durable & clearer PVC mat The toughest & most durable protection for floors
Mat Size L x W mm
Model
Gripper Backed Mat suitable for Carpeted Floors 1200 x 900
FC119225EV
1200 x 1500
FC1115225EV
Smooth Backed Mat suitable for Hard Floors 1200 x 900
FC129225EV
1200 x 1500
FC1215225EV
COMPUTEX ANTI-STATIC • •
Protects your electrical equipment from the damaging effects of static Dissipates static electricity without the needfor a ground cordManufactured from a unique PVC formulation for the clearest, most durable anti-static mat
Mat Size L x W mm
Shape
Model
Gripper Backed Mat suitable for Carpeted Floors 1200 x 900 With Lip FC319225LV 1200 x 1500R ectangular FC3115225EV Smooth Backed Mat suitable for Hard Floors 1200 x 900 With Lip FC329232LV 1200 x 1500R
ectangular
FC3215232EV
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
443
OFFICE Office Seating PRISM OPERATOR CHAIRS • • •
Prism Stock Fabric Colours
Choice of tilting mechanisms Waterfall-front seat Seat depth: 440mm
Black
Blue
Red
Grey
Charcoal
PSM1 PSM3
PSM2 ZPSM1/FC1D Description
Model
High Back - Permanent Contact Back
PSM1
High Back Operator - Asynchro Tilt
PSM2
High Back Operator - Synchro Tilt
PSM3
High Back Draughting Chair
ZPSM1/FC1D
Fixed Arms - pair
PSMLA
Height Adjustable Arms - pair
PSMHA
Folding Arms - pair
PSMFA
Chrome Base
PSMCB
PSMLA
PSMHA
PSMFA
PSMCB
PRISM OPERATOR CHAIRS • • • •
Piveting lock tilt mechanism & added cushioning for executive levels of comfort Seat Size: 495W x 515D mm Back Size: 595H x 485W mm Seat Height: 425/515 mm
AM2HB/F/BLUE
AM3/PU/BLK Leather Stock Colours
Black
444
Fabric Stock Colours
Blue
Black
CO/PAB
Description
Model
Amber Fabric Chair - Blue Fabric
AM2HB/F/BLUE
Amber Fabric Chair - Black Fabric
AM2HB/F/BLK
Amber Fabric Chair - Black Leather
AM1HB/L/BLK
Amber Visitor Chair - Black Polyurethane
AM3/PU/BLK
Polished Base
CO/PAB
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
AM1HB/L/BLK
Multi-Purpose Furniture
OFFICE
BEAM BENCHES •
Heavy duty Polypropylene chairs mounted on a strong & durable Steel frame Seat Height: 450mm
•
BBT03Z
BBT04Z
3 Seater
Overall Size L x D x H mm 1670 x 550 x 790
Weight kg 15
BBT03Z
4 Seater
2235 x 550 x 790
19
BBT04Z
Description
FOLDING CHAIR
Model
CHAIR BULK LOAD SACK TRUCK
•
Manufactured from heavy duty blow moulded Plastic Ideal for use with the Folding Tables shown on page 440
•
• • •
•
Toe Plate Size: 565W x 150D mm Full welded Steel construction Mobile on 200 x 50mm Cushion Roller Bearing Wheels Ideal for moving stacked chairs
FFC00Z Overall Size W x D x H mm 405 x 400 x 450
Weight kg 4.5
Model FFC00Z
CHAIR BULK LOAD SACK TRUCK •
Overall Size W x D x H mm 1168 x 570 x 380
Weight kg 14.5
Model TS142H
FCBL46
Flexible collapsible chair with upholstered seat & back
‘STABIL’ FOLDING CHAIRS •
Stable & robust folding Chair with Plastic seat & back
FCBE46
Seat Size W x D x H mm
Colour
Model ‘Stabil’ Chairs
Extra Folding Chairs 380 x 290 x 460
Blue
FCBE46
Black
FCBL46
‘Stabil’ Folding Chairs Blue SCBE44 Black SCBL44 390 x 390 x 445 White SCWH44 ‘Stabil’ Folding Chair Trolley - Holds 50 Chairs 485 x 1010 x 1700
-
SCT00Y
‘Stabil’ Folding Chair Trolley - Complete with 50 Chairs 485 x 1010 x 1700
-
SCT50Y
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
445
OFFICE Canteen Tables BEAM BENCHES • •
•
Ideal for use in eating areas inoffices, halls, factories, warehouses& retail premises Seats are manufactured from moulded Polypropylene mounted on a strong Steel frame Table top is manufactured from Chipboard with a Melamine coating
CBT42Z
Description
No. of Seats
Overall Size L x W x H mm
Table Size L x W mm
Weight kg
Model
Peninsula Units - Access 1 Way
2
1690 x 510 x 790
600 x 600
26
CBT21Z
4
1690 x 915 x 790
1100 x 600
38
CBT41Z
1690 x 1495 x 790 1600 x 600
55
CBT61Z
1100 x 600
38
CBT42Z
1690 x 1495 x 790 1600 x 600
55
CBT62Z
6
Island Units - Access 2 Ways
4
THE HEAVY DUTY POLYPROPYLENE SEATS &HARDWEARING MELAMINE WORKTOP ARE MOUNTED ON A STRONG & DURABLE STEEL FRAME
446
6
1690 x 915 x 790
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Folding Tables & Chairs
OFFICE
FOLDING TABLES • • •
Manufactured from Heavy DutyBlow Moulded Plastic Models FFT03Z & FFT04Z easily foldfrom the centre of the tablemaking them easy to carry All models of tables have folding legs which fit neatly underneath the table for compact storage
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628)
4 x FFC00Z
From This
To This
To This
Models FFT03Z Overall Size L x W x H mm
Folded Size L x W x H mm
& FFT04Z Only
Weight kg
Order in Multiples of
Model
4
FFC00Z
-
FST01Z
-
FFT03Z
Folding Chair 405 x 400 x 450
1040 x 460 x 215
4.5 Tables with Folding Legs
1200 x 600 x 740
1200 x 600 x 60
8.5
1830 x 760 x 720
1830 x 760 x 43
15
FST02Z
Folding Tables with Folding Legs 1200 x 600 x 740
610 x 600 x 90
10
1830 x 760 x 720
915 x 760 x 86
16
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
FFT04Z
447
OFFICE Lightweight Folding Tables CONTOUR FOLDING TABLES
PREMIER FOLDING TABLES
•
•
Constructed from lightweight Aluminium with a Laminated surface
Laminated surface with Polyurethane edging
gP57 Sparta gP57 Sparta
gP58 Japanese Beech
gP58 Japanese Beech Description
Folding Table
Stacking Bench
Overall Size L x W x H mm 1220 x 685 x 698
Weight kg 8
C/CB2
Model
1220 x 760 x 698
9.5
C/CA2
1830 x 685 x 698
12
C/AB2
1830 x 760 x 698
13
1220 x 254 x 483 1830 x 254 x 483
Description
Overall Size L x W x H mm 1220 x 685 x 698
Weight kg 13
P/CB3
1220 x 760 x 698
13.5
P/CA3
1830 x 685 x 698
19
P/AB3
C/AA2
1830 x 760 x 698
19.5
P/AA3
5
C/CF2
1220 x 254 x 483
6.5
P/CF3
7
C/AF2
1830 x 254 x 483
7
P/AF3
Folding Table
Stacking Bench
ALI TOPPED TABLES
TRANSPORTATION TROLLEYS
•
• • • • •
•
Model
Multi-purpose Aluminium table ideal foryour home, garden or outdoor catering Folds flat for ease of transportation
Ideal for storing & moving your folding tables Safety Features Include: Storage straps Braked castors Non-slip surface
Heat Resistant
A3001
A2501 Description Ali Top Table FastFold Folding Tool
448
Overall Size L x W x H mm 1220 x 610 x 698
AL/CC7B
Description
1220 x 610 x 760
AL/CC7A
Small Table Trolley7 Large Table Trolley1
Model
A9001
Tables Held 41
Overall Size L x W x H mm 875 x 745 x 1127 675 x 745 x 1127
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Model A3001 A2501
Canteen Tables
OFFICE
Canteen Tables
Description Artist Chair Low Table - 4 Legs
Colour Polished Beechwood Walnut Veneer Beech Veneer Walnut Veneer
Description
Colour
Picasso Polyurethane Chair
Black
Low Table - Column Base
Beech Veneer Walnut Veneer
Overall Size Dia. x H mm 800 x 743
Overall Size Dia. x H mm 800 x 740
Model ART0514BCH ART0514WAL ZCC84BV ZCC84WV
Model CC61BLK ZCC80BV ZCC80WV
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
449
OFFICE Office Equipment FOLDING TROLLEY • • • • •
Attractive yet durable folding trolley Can be folded in one simple move Mobile on 4 x 100mm swivel Rubber tyred castors, 2 with brakes Clearance between shelves: 300mm Overall Size when folded: 580 x 100 x 1080mm
CI203Y Folded
Overall Size L x W x H mm
Weight
Model
580 x 450 x 890
14 kg
CI203Y
FOLDING STEPS & BLUE FOAM HANDLE
PLASTIC KICK STEP • •
•
CI203Y
•
Strong & Durable Manufactured in quality durable Plastic, this stepis lightweight & easy to move The unit has 3 spring loaded castors that retract when weight is applied
Comply to EN-14183 Standard Tubular Steel frame with Plastic non-slip treads, non-slip feet & Blue Foam Rubber handle Tread Size:380W x260Dmm
•
•
FJS72Z FJS73Z KA007Z
Base Øm m
Top Øm m
450
Weight kg
Model
3.5
KA007Z
Overall Size when folded H x W x D mm
Wt kg
Model
490
830 x 470 x 550
1080 x 470 x 90
4
FJS72Z
720
1060 x 470 x 880
1350 x 470 x 90
9
FJS73Z
950
1295 x 470 x 1100
1620 x 470 x 90
12
FJS74Z
Height of top tread
2 3 4
WOODEN DECK TROLLEY
MULTI POSITION TROLLEY
• • •
•
•
Non-marking wheels Superb Quality This trolley has a quality Wooden deck & Chrome Plated folding handle Mobile on 2 fixed, & 2 swivel 100mm non-marking Rubber castors
• • •
Overall Size L x W x H mm 740 x 480 x 860
450
Overall Size when erected H x W x D mm
No. of Treads
Weight kg 11
Model GI110Y
Telescopic handle with an Aluminium expanding & contracting base Fits easily into a car boot/ van Corner buffers for added protection Mobile on 4 x100mm castors
O/A Size - Open L x W x H mm 725 x 420 x 960
O/A Size - Folded L x W x H mm 570 x 420 x 230
Weight kg 8.5
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Model GI001Y
Office Storage Systems
OFFICE
OSU01Z OSU02Z OSU03Z
STORAGE UNITS • • • •
Practical storage solutions for your office Ideal for use in schools, office, mailrooms & receptions Storage options include suspension file drawers, small compartment drawers, cupboards & drawers Available in a choice of Beech or Birch finish
Description
Finish
6 Open Storage Spaces, 3 Cupboards, 4 Suspension File Drawers
Beech
3 Open Storage Spaces, 18 Pigeon Holes, 4 Suspension File Drawers
Beech
Shelves, Glass Doors & 12 Small Drawers
Birch Birch Beech Birch
Overall Size W x D x H mm 900 x 450 x 2000 900 x 450 x 2000 900 x 450 x 2000
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Model OSU01Z OSU11Z OSU02Z OSU12Z OSU03Z OSU13Z
451
OFFICE Literature Display Systems WALL DISPLAYS
WALL DISPLAYS
• • •
• •
Economical & visually appealing Easy to assemble using the Aluminium wall bar provided Mix & match all dispenser sizes to create your own unique literature display
WD8A416TF
WD16TF
WD16A4
Description
Overall Size W x H mm
WD8A4
WWDA4
Model
WWDTF
WWDA5
8 x A4 Dispensers
450 x 760
WD8A4
Description
Overall Size D x W x H mm
16 x A4 Dispensers
900 x 760
WD16A4
A4 Dispenser
75 x 240 x 365
WWDA4
16 x 1/3 A4 Dispensers
450 x 680
WD16TF
A5 Dispenser
75 x 170 x 280
WWDA5
8 A4 & 16 x 1/3 A4 Dispensers
900 x 680
WD8A416TF
/3 A4 Dispenser
75 x 125 x 280
WWDTF
•
•
•
1
•
Attractive wall mounted display with A4 holders. All edges arepolished smooth Holders have fullheight sides to keep your literature upright Other colours available Callfor Details
•
• • • • WM4A4 White
WM4A4 Black
Lightweight yet sturdy with 5 legged base Assembled in minutes without tools Fully interchangeable brochure holders Transportable &visually striking Spinners rotate independently Complete with C36TF header sleeve
Description
Colour
4 x A4 Pockets
Black/White
130 x 240 x 750
WM4A4
18 x A5 Dispensers
8 x A4 Pockets
Black/White
130 x 450 x 750
WM8A4
36 x 1/3 A4 Dispensers
16 x A4 Pockets
Black/White
139 x 900 x 750
WM16A4
6 A4, 6 A5 & 12 x 1/3 A4 Dispensers
Model
WALL MOUNTED WALL DISPLAYS
• • •
F12A4
Description 6 x A4 Dispensers 12 x A4 Dispensers
Overall Size Base x H mm 550 x 1700
C18A4
Model
18 x A4 Dispensers
C18A4HS C18A5HS
550 x 1760
C36TFHS C6A46A512TF
WALL MOUNTED WALL DISPLAYS • • • • •
Lightweight yet sturdy legged base Assembled in minutes without tools Ideal for high traffic areas Easily transportable
C18A5
Overall Size Base x H mm
Description
Overall Size D x W x H mm
•
Model
FLOOR STANDING CAROUSELS
WALL MOUNTED WALL DISPLAYS
452
Strong & clear Acrylic holder for outdoor use Hinged lid keep all your literature dry
High quality brochure holder with tiered steps Consolidate your literature in one holder Re-inforced sides to eliminate breakages 35mm of storage in each pocket Available in packs or singles
F6A4
Description
Overall Size D x W x H mm
Pack Qty
Model
2 x A4 Pockets
120 x 230 x 320
5
SU2A4
4 x A4 Pockets
190 x 230 x 320
4
SU4A4
F6A4
4 x A5 Pockets
190 x 157 x 320
4
SU4A5
F12A4
4 x 1/3 A4 Pockets
190 x 110 x 320
8
SU4TF
Model
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
C6A46A512TF
Literature Display Systems
OFFICE
VERTICAL & ROTARY CON-TUR LITERATURE RACKS • • • •
Exclusive Con-Tur design totally eliminating paper curl Manufactured from prime Steel with a baked Enamel finish Vertical racks will wall mount with provided key hole slotsor can be used as stand alone units by using the optional legs 4 colour options:
Tan
Black
Putty
Con-Tur design keeps literatureup right.
Grey
please specify when ordering
Paper curl is eliminated.
VERTICAL RACKS TO ORGANISE & STORE YOUR LITERATURE
20 Pockets
11 Pockets
5 Pockets
ROTARY RACKS TO ORGANISE & STORE YOUR LITERATURE
360˚
20 Pockets
Optional Legs
Description
Overall Size W x H x D mm
44 Pockets
360˚
80 Pockets
Weight kg
Model
Vertical Racks Literature Rack - 5 Pockets
248 x 514 x 105
4
403
Literature Rack - 11 Pockets
248 x 914 x 105
7.5
402
Literature Rack - 20 Pockets
248 x 1473 x 105
11.5
400
Optional Legs
-
1.5
408-A
Rotary Racks Literature Rack - 20 Pockets3
59 x 587 x 359
22
409
Literature Rack - 44 Pockets3
59 x 1232 x 359
39
410
Literature Rack - 80 Pockets3
59 x 1737 x 359
60
415
HORIZONTAL LITERATURE RACKS • • • •
Steel construction For floor or desktop use Convenient storage for literature & file folders Colour : Tan (other colours available on request)
• • • •
Rigid racks - will NOT twist or warp Each opening can be easily labelled Rubber feet are provided Stackable with a modular design
Horizontal Literature Rack - 9 Openings
Overall Size W x D x H mm 859 x 281 x 275
Weight kg 12
431-75
Horizontal Literature Rack - 12 Openings
859 x 281 x 362
16
432-75
Horizontal Literature Rack - 15 Openings
859 x 281 x 450
18
434-75
Description
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Model
453
OFFICE Display Systems T-Card Planning System Kits OFFiCe PLAnneR KiT • •
Available in 5 standard sizes in 170gsm card T-CARDS packaged in boxes of 100, available in 10 colours - see below forthe colours & please specify when ordering
OFFiCe PLAnneR KiT
Dimensions (mm) B C D 28 49 16.5 45 53 35 60 85 48.5 92 120 80 124 180 112
Size
Panels & coloured T-cards may be used as daily/weekly, job planner/message centre. Contents: 7 x 24 slot panels, index panel, wall rails, Size 2 T-Cards. Size: 480 x 480mm
Model T-Cards
•
Model 29110
1
20010
1.5
20015
2
20020
3
20030
PRinTeR T-CARDS- Print T-Cards directly from your computer. Size 2, 180 per pack.Size 3, 80 per pack. Available in White, Yellow, Green, Blue & Pink - please specify
4
20040 Printer T-Cards
2
PTC-2
3
PTC-3
WORKLOAD PRODUCTION BOARD KIT
PLANNED MAINTENANCE KIT
Title each panel to preferred job stages & progress job T-Card stage by stage to produce a production overview board.
A simple & economical maintenance board scheduling yearly maintenance requirements by months.
Economical & simple yearly multi ap plication display board. Displays a yearly schedule by months & days
Contents: 12 x 32 slot panels, wall rails,title strips, size 2 T-Cards.Size: 772W x 550Dmm
Contents: 12 x 32 slot panels, wall supports, title strips, 5 boxes (size 2) T-cards. Size: 772W x 550Dmm 550Dmm
Contents: 12 x 54 slot panels, indexpanel, wall supports, day/month labels, 10 boxes (size 2), T-cards (10 colours).Size: 960W x 772Dmm
Model
Model
Model
WPMB-32
29112
- professionally display your documentation
MAGNETIC BACKED DOCUMENT POCKETS •
Size A3
A4
PLANNED MAINTENANCE KIT
WPDB-32
DOCUMENT DISPLAY POCKETS
454
Size 1 Size 1.5 Size 2 Size 3 Size 4
A 15 15 15 15 15
For whiteboard use, 5 per pack
Style
Model
Portrait
M8250A3P
Landscape
M8250A3L
MAGNETIC BACKED DOCUMENT POCKETS •
Size A3
For felt noticeboard use, 5 per pack
Style
Model
Portrait
HL8250A3P
Landscape
HL8250A3L
MAGNETIC BACKED DOCUMENT POCKETS •
Size A3
Style
Model
Portrait
AD8250A3P
Landscape
AD8250A3L
Covers
8250301
Covers
8250301
Covers
8250301
M8250A4P
Portrait
HL8250A4P
Portrait
AD8250A4P
Landscape
M8250A4L
Landscape
HL8250A4L
Landscape
AD8250A4L
Covers
8250300
Covers
8250300
Covers
8250300
A4
•
For general use, 5 per pack
Portrait
A4
•
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
•
No more overloaded, untidy info displays Colour coded Plastic document pockets & covers ensure paperwork is secure & protected Document pocket packs available in White, Yellow, Red, Dark Blue, Green, Blue-Grey, Grey& Transparent-please specify
Display Systems
OFFICE
CASCADING DOCUMENT DISPLAY RACKS • •
All Steel, wall mounted document display racks 7 colour options available: Yellow
Grey White
1
Red
Blue
Green
3
4
5
2 Umbra Grey
Grey Alu
6
7
Add colour code to single colour rack reference. For mixed colour units the bottom 2 pockets must be the same colour. State on order coloured pocket sequence starting from bottom 2 upwards
No of Pockets
Document Size
4
A5 (Visible Edge: Portrait Style 45mm Landscape Style 38mm)
10 16
Document Format Portrait
CDUA5P4/..
Landscape
CDUA5L4/..
Portrait
CDUA5P10/..
Landscape
CDUA5L10/..
Portrait
CDUA5P16/..
Landscape
CDUA5L16/..
Model
819002
Magnetic Backing/Wall Fixing 4 pockets units only
No of Pockets
Document Size
4
A4 (Visible Edge: Portrait Style 68mm Landscape Style 45mm)
10 16
Document Format Portrait
Model CDUA4P4/..
Landscape
CDUA4L4/..
Portrait
CDUA4P10/..
Landscape
CDUA4L10/..
Portrait
CDUA4P16/..
Landscape
CDUA4L16/.. 819002
Magnetic Backing/Wall Fixing 4 pockets units only
PRINTED WHITEBOARDS Aluminium framed, dry wipe surface
WALL MOUNTED PRINTED WHITEBOARDS REVOLVING PRINTED WHITEBOARDS Overall Size L x H mm
Printed Surface Model
Non-Magnetic Whiteboards 900 x 600
ENM0906/PR
1200 x 900
ENM1209/PR
1500 x 1200
ENM1512/PR
1800 x 1200
ENM1812/PR
2400 x 1200
ENM2412/PR Magnetic Whiteboards
Printed single side revolving whiteboard complete with Steel stand & lockable castors Double side printing available - Call for Details Overall Size L x H mm
Printed Surface 1 x Printed & 1 x Plain Model
Non-Magnetic Revolving Whiteboards 1200 x 900
ENMR1209/PR
1500 x 1200
ENMR1512/PR
900 x 600
EM0906/PR
1200 x 900
EM1209/PR
1500 x 1200
EM1512/PR
1200 x 900
EMR1209/PR
1800 x 1200
EM1812/PR
1500 x 1200
EMR1512/PR
2400 x 1200
EM2412/PR
1800 x 1200
EMR1812/PR
1800 x 1200
ENMR1812/PR Magnetic Revolving Whiteboards
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
455
OFFICE Whiteboards SLIMLINE NON MAGNETIC WHITEBOARDS
SLIMLINE MAGNETIC WHITEBOARDS
• • •
• • •
Ideal for office & meeting room use Aluminium profile frame Single sided Description Non Magnetic Whiteboards
Overall Size W x H mm 900 x 600 1200 x 900 1800 x 1200 2400 x 1200
Model
Description
W1500906X-AF W1501209X-AF W1501812X-AF W1502412X-AF
Magnetic Whiteboards
WHITEBOARD ACCESSORIES
Overall Size W x H mm 900 x 600 1200 x 900 1800 x 1200 2400 x 1200
Model W1550906X-AF W1551209X-AF W1551812X-AF W1552412X-AF
Description
Model
Description
Model
Felt Eraser
W999010-F
Dry Marker Pens - Pack of 12
W999013-STAS
Pen Holder - 6 Pens
W999004
0.3m Clip on Pen Shelf
W999003-03XAF
Whiteboard Cleaner 400ml Foam
W999012-FA
MOBILE WHITEBOARDS
WHEELED FLIP CHART EASEL
• • • • • •
• •
Double sided non magnetic dry-wipe surfaces 5 year board guarantee Board rotates through 360 Powder coated Steel frame Heavy duty non-marking Rubber tyred castors 4 castors - 2 lockable O
Description Mobile Whiteboards
456
Versatile drywipe magnetic surface Aluminium profile frame Single sided
• • • •
Deluxe, height adjustable, wheeled Flip Chart Easel Dry wipe Steel blackboard which is suitable for use with magnets Magnet friendly arms fold out from the side of the board Integral pen shelf Pad size: A1 5 Lockable castors
Overall Size W x H mm 900 x 1200
W3500912-DWDW
1500 x 1200
W3501512-DWDW
Description
Model
1800 x 1200
W3501812-DWDW
Wheeled Flip Chart Easel
P100006
Model
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Key Cabinets
OFFICE
KEYSTOR • • • •
Sturdy Steel cabinets with a tough powder coated, light Grey finish Fixed coloured & numbered hook bars, with matching key tabs Removable key control index with the 3 larger models Key locking complete with 2 keys
K048 K030 K064
20 Hook Key Cabinet
Overall Size H x W x D mm 255 x 180 x 80K
30 Hook Key Cabinet
300 x 210 x 80
42 Hook Key Cabinet
320 x 245 x 80K
042
48 Hook Key Cabinet
350 x 300 x 80K
048
64 Hook Key Cabinet
450 x 300 x 80K
064
100 Hook Key Cabinet
550 x 380 x 80K
100
Description
Model 020 K030
K020
K042
COMBI CABINETS •
• •
Designed to offer secure storage for keys& personal belongings, such as mobile phones, cameras, purses & wallets Key Cabinets are secured by aprogrammable electronic lock Storage Cupboards are supplied with a security Cam Lock & 2 keys
KCC2004ZE
KCC0502ZE
Description
Overall Size H x W x D mm
Weight kg
Model
50 Hook Cabinet with 2 Cupboards & Shelves
550 x 380 x 205
14
KCC0502ZE
100 Hook Cabinet with 4 Cupboards
550 x 730 x 205
24
KCC1004ZE
200 Hook Cabinet with 4 Cupboards
550 x 730 x 205
24
KCC2004ZE
4 Cupboard Expander Unit
550 x 380 x 205
11
KCC0004Z
IDEAL TO SUITA VARIETY OF APPLICATIONS FROM OFFICES, SHOPS TO WAREHOUSES & COMMERCIAL SITES
KCC0004Z
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
457
MAILROOM
Mailroom Benches
CUPBOARD / LOCKER BENCHES • A continuation of the Durable Mailroom Benches, including all the attractive features of this range • Features include end panels & lockable sliding doors • 4 & 6 locker versions are also available, ideal for organised secure storage of equipment & supplies
MB1577D
Length mm 1200 1500 1800
Depth mm 750 750 750
MB1577L
Cupboard with Sliding Lockable Door
Height mm
4 Locker Unit
6 Locker Unit
Model
Model
Model
750
MB1277D
MB1277L
-
900
MB1279D
MB1279L
-
750
MB1577D
-
MB1577L
900
MB1579D
-
MB1579L
750
MB1877D
-
-
900
MB1879D
-
-
CLEARVIEW SORTING UNITS • Made from sturdy transparent Acrylic, clearview shelving provides an efficient way to sort mail • Shelves are adjustable within the vertical columns • Scalloped edge front slots make it easy to label each compartment
• Pack of 5 Extra Shelves MB1277B Shown with MBC1200 + Extra Shelves
Model MBES05
• Max 36 shelves (16 Included) Each compartment 335D x 277W x 100Hmm
458
MB1577D shown with MBC1500 + Extra Shelves
• Max 45 shelves (16 Included) Each compartment 335D x 277W x 100Hmm
Overall Size L x D x H mm
Model
Overall Size L x D x H mm
Model
1200 x 360 x 1048
MBC1200
1500 x 470 x 1048
MBC1500
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Mailroom Sorting Systems
MAILROOM
POST LOCKERS • Manufactured from sheet Steel in Grey • Lockers are equipped with a masterdoor to allow authorised access • Supplied complete with cylinder locks(with 2 keys) & a master key forthe master door • Each compartment is 290W mm witha post hole which is 240W mm
PLW12Z
No of Boxes
Overall Size W x D x H mm
Model
Wall Mounted Unit 760 x 450 x 820
12
PLW12Z
Floor Standing Unit 380 x 450 x 1910
15
PLF15Z
760 x 450 x 1910
30
PLF30Z
PLF30Z
PLF15Z
POST LOCKERS • Manufactured from sheet Steel in Grey • Complete with 14 compartments - idealfor sorting post, brochures etc • Compartment Size:245W x 340D x 105H mm
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628)
Overall Size W x D x H mm
Colour
Model
300 x 350 x 1800
Aluminium Lacquer Black
MSA30Z MSB35Z
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
2xMSB25Z
459
MAILROOM
Mailroom Sorting Systems
MAIL SORTING SHELF UNITS • Practical yet stylish sorting units which are ideal for post sorting • Shelves are adjustable at 32mm intervals & edged with a slanted Aluminium profile which makes labelling easier • Finished in a Hardwearing Beech Laminate • Supplied with a pack of 20 labels
AVAILABLE WITH 18 OR 54 SHELVES. IDEAL FOR ALL YOUR MAIL SORTING NEEDS
Overall Size W x D x H mm
No of Shelves
Model
Mail Sorting Shelf Unit 315 x 400 x 1880
18
MSS18Z
915 x 400 x 1880
54
MSS54Z
Accessories Extra Shelf - 280W x 365D mm
MSSS28
Pack of 20 Labels
MSSL20
MSS54Z MSS18Z
DOCUMENT & SORTING SHELVES • Practical yet stylish sorting units which are ideal for document & post sorting • Shelves are adjustable at 32mm intervals & edged with an Aluminium profile which makes labelling easier • The units are finished in a Hardwearing Beech Laminate
AVAILABLE WITH 42 OR 84 SHELVES. IDEAL FOR ALL YOUR MAIL SORTING NEEDS
Overall Size W x D x H mm
No of Shelves
Model
Document & Sorting Shelves 830 x 400 x 1880 DSS42Z
42
DSS42Z
84
DSS84Z
Accessories Extra Shelves to fit the above units
460
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
DSSS48
Mailroom Sorting Systems
MAILROOM
MAIL SORTING SYSTEM • ‘See through’ design prevents mail being overlooked • Compartment Size: 340 x 145mm • This modern sorting system has been especially designed to offer an effective way of ensuring all mail is correctly sorted • Each compartment clearly identified • Manufactured from light gauge mesh & is lightweight & ideal for mounting on a table
No. of Compartments 18 24
Overall Size W x D x H 1085 x 420 x 955 1445 x 420 x 955
Weight kg
Model
20
MT960Z
30
MT961Z
MT960Z
MT964Y MT962Z
STATIC MAIL SORTER
MOBILE MAIL SORTER
• This unit is available either free standing on its own stand or for bench mounting if required • It has 20 easily identified compartments • Stand is manufactured from 25mm square tubular Steel
• This mail sorter has 12 easily identified compartments & is available with or without a mobile trolley • The trolley is mobile on 100mm Rubber castors
Description Post Sorter & Stand Post Sorter only
Overall Size mm WxDxH 1450 x 457 x 1830 1450 x 457 x 1525
Compartment Size mm WxDxH 355 x 457 x 297 355 x 457 x 297
Weight kg
Model
28
MT962Z
18
MT963Z
Description Post Sorter & Trolley Post Sorter only
Overall Size mm WxDxH 1375 x 380 x 1610 1065 x 380 x 1220
Compartment Size mm WxDxH 355 x 380 x 305 355 x 380 x 305
Weight kg
Model
28
MT964Y
11
MT965Z
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
461
MAILROOM
Mail Distribution Trolleys
MT988Y
PB800Z
SC983Y & PB800Z
MT987Y
POST BAG HOLDERS
POST DISTRIBUTION STAIRCLIMBER
• Manufactured from strong tubular Steel • Notches on the top of the frames hold postal bags into place (postal bags not included) • Mobile on 4 x 75mm swivel non-marking castors
• Manufactured from strong tubular Steel • Supplied with 2 Plastic coated mesh baskets • Mobile on 3 x 150mm wheels in a tri-wheel mount. These are mounted inside the frame
Postal Bags Held 1 2
Overall Size W x D x H mm 390 x 390 x 1130 390 x 770 x 1130
Weight kg 8 12
Model MT987Y MT988Y
Overall Size W x D x H mm 535 x 920 x 940
Basket Size W x D x H mm 470 x 370 x 320
Rear Pannier Basket - 320 x 210 x 360/420
Weight kg 23
SC983Y
2
PB800Z
Model
POST ROOM TROLLEY • Manufactured in tubular Steel with 50 x 50mm mesh infil • 6 mesh compartments & a storage tray • Mobile on 4 x 100mm swivel non-marking castors with Plastic corner buffers
GS9126
GS9125
POST BAG HOLDERS • GS9125: Re-inforced Heavy Duty PVC bag • GS9126: Constructed from Galvanised Steel sides & ends • Fully welded frame & exterior grade Plywood deck • Unloaded Height: Bag - 650mm & Box - 800mm Overall Size L x W x H mm
Wheels
935 x 730 x 932
125mm Cushion
Load Weight Capacity kg
MT991Y Model
Self Levelling Trolleys - Bag 100 kg
40
GS9125
Overall Size L x W x H mm
Weight kg
Model
GS9126
1020 x 500 x 1020
16
MT991Y
Self Levelling Trolleys - Box 935 x 730 x 932
462
125mm Cushion
100 kg
50
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Mail Distribution Trolleys
MAILROOM
MT964Y MT985Y & PB800Z
Zinc Rails to facilitate hanging files
Wheels situated inside the frame
PB800Z
MAIL SORTING SYSTEM • Manufactured from strong tubular Steel • Supplied with 2 Plastic coated mesh baskets • Mobile on 2 x 200mm fixed Grey non-marking wheels & 2 x 75mm swivel Grey non-marking castors. The 200mm wheels are fitted within the frame of the unit to helpprevent damage to furniture & doorways • These units also incorporate 2 removable Zinc rails in each basket. This allows the units to facilitate hanging files
CHROME PLATED WIRE TRAY TROLLEY
Overall Size W x D x H mm 530 x 820 x 910
Basket Size W x D x H mm 470 x 370 x 320
Weight kg 18
MT983Y
530 x 950 x 910
470 x 520 x 320
19
MT984Y
530 x 1230 x 910
470 x 770 x 320
24
MT985Y
2
PB800Z
Rear Pannier Basket - 320 x 210 x 360/420
Model
WIRE BASKET PARTS TROLLEY • Manufactured from mild Steel • Load Capacity: 25kg per basket maximum of 150kg per trolley • Comes complete with 4 Plastic coated mesh baskets constructed from 25 x 25mm mesh • Mobile on 2 fixed & 2 swivel 100mm Nylon castors
• Hygienic - Easy to clean • Removable centre shelffor bulky loads • Mobile on 2large fixed200 mm wheels & 2 swivel braked 125 mm castors
2xSPB99Z SP100Y & 2 x SPB99Z
Overall Size L x W x H mm
Weight kg
Model
860 x 660 x 990
17.5
SWI52Y
Overall Size L x W x H mm 610 x 450 x 1500
Basket Size L x W x H mm 430 x 175 x 180
Weight kg 26
SP100Y
2
SPB99Z
Extra Basket
Braked Castors - Factory Fitted to Swivel Castors
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Model
SP000Z
463
MAILROOM MAIL DISTRIBUTION TROLLEYS
MT962Z
MT964Y
static MAIL sorter
mobile MAIL sorter
This unit is available either free standing on its own stand or for bench mounting if required. It has 20 easily identified compartments. Stand is manufactured from 25 mm square tubular steel. Finish: Epoxy powder coated: Red.
This mail sorter has 12 easily identified compartments and is available with or without a mobile trolley. The mobile trolley is fitted with 100 mm rubber castors. Finish: Epoxy powder coated: Red.
Description
Overall Compartment Size mm Size mm D x W x H D x W x H
Description
Overall Compartment Size mm Size mm D x W x H D x W x H
Post Sorter and Stand
457 x 1450 x 1830
Post Sorter only
457 x 1450 x 1525
Weight kg
Model
Price
457 x 355 x 297
28
MT962Z
POA
Post Sorter and Trolley
380 x 1375 x 1610
457 x 355 x 297
18
MT963Z
POA
Post Sorter only
380 x 1065 x 1220
MT960Z
Weight kg
Model
Price
380 x 355 x 305
28
MT964Y
POA
380 x 355 x 305
11
MT965Z
POA
MAIL SORTING SYSTEM • ‘See through’ design prevents mail being ••overlooked • Each compartment clearly identified • Space saving • Lightweight and sturdy This modern sorting system has been especially designed to offer an effective way of ensuring all mail is correctly sorted. The unit is manufactured from light gauge mesh and is therefore lightweight and ideal for mounting on a table. Finish: Epoxy powder coated: Red. Number of Compartment Overall compartments Size Size mm HxWxD
464
Model
Price
18 340 x 145
955 x 1085 MT960Z x 420
POA
24 340 x 145
955 x 1445 MT961Z x 420
POA
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
MAILROOM SORTING SYSTEMS
MAILROOM
GS885Y
MAIL DISTRIBUTION TROLLEYS Constructed in strong tubular steel, these mail trolleys are supplied complete with 2 white plastic coated removable wire baskets. The generous 200 mm wheels are fitted within the frame to prevent damage to furniture and doorways. Finish: Red Epoxy Powder Coated Frame.
GS883Y Overall Dimensions W x D x H mm
Basket Dimensions Wheels W x D x H mm
Maximum Load kg
Weight kg
Model
Price
520 x 740
450 x 355
2 x 75 mm
x 920
x 280
Swivel castors
100
15
GS883Y
POA
455 x 760 x 280
2 x 200 mm Fixed Wheels
130
22
GS885Y
POA
520 x 1140 x 920
GS880Y
GS881Y
MAIL DISTRIBUTION TROLLEYS Constructed in strong tubular steel, these trolleys are fitted with 2 large and 1 small plastic coated removable wire baskets. The 2 off large non-marking wheels are fitted within the frame, and the front non-marking castors are fitted with non-marking buffers to prevent damage to furniture and doorways.
Overall Dimensions W x D x H mm
Basket Dimensions Wheels W x D x H mm mm
Maximum Load Weight kg kg
Model
Price
620 x 1100
x 970
1 off 270 x 180 x 360
2 off 450 x 355 x 280 2 x 100 grey rubber swivel castors
200
22
GS880Y
POA
620 x 1460 x 995
2 off 455 x 760 x 280 1 off 270 x 180 x 360
2 x 200 Grey rubber Wheels
200
31
GS881Y
POA
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
465
VISITOR MANAGEMENT
contractor management
staff ID
Systems adaptable to all working environments: • Offices • Warehouses • Manufacturing Facilities • Schools/Universities • Hospitals • Banks
466
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
visitor control
VISITOR MANAGEMENT your access to visitor management
and inspection systems
inspection
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
467
VISITOR MANAGEMENTVISITOR PASS
The simplest way to manage your visitors • Projects a professional corporate image whilst giving you complete control over the management of your visitors. • Identifies and validates every visitor to your site • Can also be used to control vehicles or identify temporary staff. • Comply with health & safety regulations by ensuring every visitor has the relevant health & safety information for your site. • Easy to use. The visitor or host writes the details once and they are copied on to the register for future reference or to form a fire register in an emergency.
Your logo here
Each pass is individually numbered
Discretion sheet to protect information from view
Wristbands
468
Site health & Safety procedures
Landscape Card Holder
Stock Lanyard
Multi-lingual
Personalised Lanyard
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
INSPECTION SYSTEM
VISITOR MANAGEMENT
Inspecting equipment on a regular basis can help ensure that accidents and danger to employees and sometimes the public, is kept to a minimum. LOC8 has a suite of inspection systems available to help organisations streamline their processes and meet these legal obligations. Two of the more popular inspection systems include: • Fork Lift Truck Inspection System – Safe-truck • Scaffold Inspection System – Safe-scaff
Safe-truck • The simplest way to inspect your lift trucks • Ensure that all of your trucks receive pre-shift inspections • Build an inspection history. • Provide a permanent record of all your inspections • Provide a visual safety status indicator so that you can see at a glance if a truck is safe to use. • Ensure that you comply with HSE best practice guidelines (as described in its publication, Safety in Working with Lift Trucks) that trucks should be inspected at the beginning of each shift.
Safe-scaff Scaffold inspecting made easy… Ensure that inspections are carried out and recorded at regular intervals Build an inspection history. Provide a permanent record of all your inspections. Provide a visual safety status indicator so that you can see at a glance if the scaffold is safe to use. Ensure that you comply with the Work at Height Regulations 2005 Easy to use. The simple checklist ensures that no components are forgotten. Safe-scaff enables you to inspect all scaffold and scaffold towers in accordance with the Working at Height Regulations 2005. The system provides a checklist to record all inspections at appropriate intervals as well as a visible identification for all workers as to the safety status of the scaffold. At the same time as the report is completed, it automatically updates the Scaffold Inspection Log which is the chronological record of all inspections carried out. This report not only lists all inspections but can highlight recurring faults identified at inspection time. Our suite of inspection systems also include: • Safe-tower : Scaffold tower inspections • Safe-rack : Pallet racking inspections • Safe-ladder : Ladder inspections • Safe-crane : Pendulum crane inspections • Safe-fleet : Fleet & pool vehicle inspections • Safe-vehicle : HGV inspections • Safe-MEWP : Mobile Elevated Work Platform inspections • Safe-station : Work station inspections
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
469
ACCESS
ACCESS STEPS
KA003Z
KiCk - StepS are manufactured from quality steel for maximum safety and durability. Snap-lock quick assembly, mounted on 3 retractable polypropylene castors. The rubber base ring holds firmly to the floor and the Kick - Step will not slide, roll or tip over. Finish: Stove enamelled steel.
Available in 5 colours, red, blue, black, grey and green. Please specify when ordering.
Loaded Unloaded Base Top Weight Model Height mm Height mm Ø mm Ø mm kg 415
425
410
280
4.5
KA003Z
HS501Z
Plastic step - up
• All Weather Strong Injection Moulding
• Stackable
• Non slip feet... • Grey or Black - Please specify colour when ordering. This versatile step is manufactured from injection moulded plastic Complete with non-slip feet. Lightweight and stackable. Platform Height mm
470
240
Platform size W x D mm
Overall Size mm
Weight kg
Model
Price
425 x 280
480 x 330
1
HS501Z
POA
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Price POA
Steps
HEAVY DUTY Handy Steps
Handy Steps
A super range of lightweight static step units fitted with all weather non-slip injection moulded treads. Finish: Beige powder coated.
6 Colour Options Available: Please specify colour when ordering.
Steps
ACCESS
H x W x D mm
1 285 x 400 x 400 2 405 x 415 x 730 2 with post 1400 x 415 x 730 • Strong Steel Frame • Stable • Nestable
Weight
Model
Price
3 kg 5 kg 5.5 kg
HS301Z HS302Z HS312Z
POA POA POA
Blue Green
Red
Beige
• Stable • Lightweight This range of Handy Steps is constructed from tubular steel and manufactured and approved to European GS standard. Fitted with all weather non-slip injected moulded treads. Tread size: W 400 mm x D 200 mm. Finish: Powder coated.
HS302Z
GS311Z
GS312Z
HS312Z
HS301Z
Yellow Grey
Steps 1 1 with post 2 2 with post
H x W x D mm 266 x 457 x 370 1200 x 457 x 370 432 x 515 x 638 1330 x 515 x 638
Weight 3 kg 4 kg 5 kg 6 kg
Model GS301Z GS311Z GS302Z GS312Z
Price POA POA POA POA
Handy Steps 4 Color Options Available:
Blue
Red
Grey
Yellow
Please specify color when ordering.
• Lightweight This handy step is constructed from tubular steel and fitted with all weather non-slip injected moulded treads. Of all welded construction with its own lifting/ support handle. Fitted with non-marking grey rubber feet and finished in epoxy powder coating.
HS322Z
HS322Z
Overall Height mm
Overall Width mm
Overall Depth mm
1300
515
638
Weight kg
Model
8
HS322Z
Price
POA
• 4 Colour Options Available Please specify colour when ordering.
Blue
Red
Green
Beige
HS3212
MS7312
double sided steps These units are fitted with all weather non-slip injected moulded treads and grey rubber feet. Mobile models are fitted with 4 80mm sprung retractable swivel castors which retract when weight is applied. Tread Size: 400 x 200mm Description
Platform
Overall
Weight
Height mm
H x W x L mm
kg
Model
Price
Mobile 2 step without handle
500
575 x 490 x 610
11
MS7212
POA
Mobile 2 step with handle
500
1245 x 490 x 610
13
MS7312
POA
Static 2 step without handle
500
555 x 460 x 610
11
HS3212
POA
Static 2 step with handle
500
1225 x 460 x 610
13
HS3312
POA
HS9222
Mobile Step - TILT AND PULL This double sided 2 step unit has non-slip ribbed rubber treads. Tubular steel frame fitted with 2 swivel castors and handle on one side for ease of manoeuvrability. Finish epoxy powder coated red. Top Overall Overall Tread Step Width Depth Height Size Weight Model Price 390 mm 400 mm 410 mm 1120 mm 290 x 160 mm
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
7 kg
HS9222
POA
471
ACCESS ALUMINIUM STEPS TAURUS TME • Comply to EN-131 Standard • Enclosed hinge system provides extra stability & allows closure & storage in restricted space • Large handrails & 850mm guardrails for extra safety • The wheels allow easy movement around warehousing • Integral tool tray in the guardrail enabling safestorage of tools & materials when in use
profile of double tread section designed to give maximum strength, durability & total reliability No. of Treads 6
Platform Overall Size Overall Weight Height - In Use Height when kg mm H x W x D mm folded mm 1410 2272 x 620 x 1182 2441 16
Model ALT-193206
7
1645
2507 x 650 x 1330
2691
18
ALT-193207
9
2115
2977 x 710 x 1627
3191
24
ALT-193209
11
2585
3447 x 770 x 1924
3691
27
ALT-193211
TAURUS TDO • Comply to EN-131 Standard • Large Rubber anti-slip feet for increased stability • Benefit from a Black powder coatedfinish - keep your hands warm & clean • Red top tread to indicate the maximum recommended step height • Enclosed hinge system which stops the unit from unexpectedly closing, • providing greater strength • Subject to availability
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628)
4
Platform Height mm 950
5
1200
1250 x 520 x 1045
1725
11
ALT-192505
6
1400
1500 x 550 x 1215
2025
12.5
ALT-192506
8
1900
2000 x 615 x 1555
2525
16.5
ALT-192508
10
2350
2500 x 675 x 1900
3025
20
ALT-192510
12
2800
3000 x 730 x 2240
3525
24
ALT-192512
No. of Treads
472
Overall Size Overall Height Weight In Use when folded kg H x W x D mm mm 1000 x 490 x 870 1525 9.5
ALT-192504
Model
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
ALT-192506
ALUMINIUM STEPS
ACCESS
VERA • Comply to EN-131 Standard • Large Platform Size: 450 x 500mm • Integral tool tray in the guardrail • Welded ribbed Aluminium, this quality folding warehouse stepladder is comfortable, sturdy& includes a large platform, whichallows safe work at height • Equipped with two reinforcing arms, which prevent sudden unwanted openingor closing & are used to move theladder via two 125mm Rubber wheels
No. of Treads
Platform Overall Overall Size - In Use Height Height when H x W x D mm mm folded mm
Weight kg
Model SV-VERA-6
6
1400
2200 x 700 x 1640
2460
17
SV-VERA-6
8
1900
2660 x 740 x 1970
2970
20
SV-VERA-8
10
2300
3100 x 780 x 2340
3460
23
SV-VERA-10
12
2800
3570 x 820 x 2700
3940
26
SV-VERA-12
CASTELLANA • Comply to EN-131 Standard • Unit incorporates a Tool Tray • Large handrails for increased safety • Welded ribbed Aluminium folding ladder with a large platform featuring kickplates, 1000mm guardrail & handrail allowing you to workin a • comfortable & safe manner • Subject to availability
SV-CAST-8
No. of Treads
Platform Height mm
Overall Overall Size - In Use Weight Height when H x W x D mm kg folded mm
6
1600
2600 x 1010 x 1600
2850
31
8
2150
3150 x 1170 x 1920
3360
35
SV-CAST-8
10
2650
3650 x 1170 x 2200
3950
39
SV-CAST-10
12
3160
4160 x 1330 x 2500
4510
44
SV-CAST-12
14
3750
4750 x 1500 x 2800
5060
48
SV-CAST-14
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Model SV-CAST-6
473
ACCESS
ALUMINIUM STEPS
DOUBLE SIDED PICKING STEPS • Comply to EN-131 standard • Ideal for a wide variety of environments • Double sided for good access • 4 x 100mm castors fitted either sideof the step for greater manoeuvrability • This unit incorporates a double handrail either side of the unit as well as a guardrail for optimum safety
IDEAL FOR ACCESS TO YOUR SHELVING
No. of Treads 4
Overall Size H x W x D mm 1600 x 468 x 1097
Platform Height mm 985
Weight kg 9.5
SV-DCS004
5
1830 x 490 x 1285
1240
10.5
SV-DCS005
6
2065 x 515 x 1465
1490
11.5
SV-DCS006
7
2295 x 545 x 1670
1740
12.5
SV-DCS007
8
2525 x 570 x 1860
1990
13.5
SV-DCS008
9
2750 x 593 x 2055
2240
15
SV-DCS009
10
2980 x 620 x 2290
2490
16
SV-DCS010
11
3195 x 640 x 2490
2740
17.5
SV-DCS011
13
3665 x 695 x 2855
3240
21.5
SV-DCS013
Model
ALUMINIUM WAREHOUSE STEPS • Comply to EN-131 standard • Wheels at the back of the unit make this range of steps easy to manoeuvre • Constructed from Aluminiumwith heavy duty back supports& side handrails
IDEAL FOR MANY APPLICATIONS &INDUSTRIES
474
No. of Treads 4
Open Height to Platform mm 1000
Weight kg 10
ALW04Z
5
1220
11
ALW05Z
6
1460
13
ALW06Z
7
1710
15
ALW07Z
8
1950
16
ALW08Z
10
2440
20
ALW10Z
12
2930
24
ALW12Z
14
3420
27
ALW14Z
Model
ALW05Z
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
ALW14Z
Glass fibre steps
ACCESS
GLASS FIBRE WIDE STEPS • Certified to BS EN-131 • Manufactured from a Glass Fibre frame with Aluminium treads • Wheels at the back of the unitmake this range of steps easy to manoeuvre • The unit incorporates a safety chain at the front of the platform for increased safety • Platform size: 400D x 600W mm
SAFETY CHAIn
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628) GLF26Z No. of Treads
Open Height mm
Platform Height mm
Closed Height mm
Weight kg
Model
2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1410 1625 1855 2050 2260 2470 2700
385 610 835 1050 1260 1480 1710
1570 1750 2020 2225 2490 2730 2965
8G 9G 11 14 16 18 20
LF22Z LF23Z GLF24Z GLF25Z GLF26Z GLF27Z GLF28Z
GLF24Z
GLASS FIBRE FOLDING STEPS WITH LARGE PLATFORM • Large working platform with handrails • Comply to EN-131 Standard • Space between rungs: 300mm • Fitted with serrated Aluminium treads & anti-slip Rubber feet • Platform size: 575D x 400Wmm • Handles are supplied loose for easy assembly
LARGE DOUBLE HANDRAILS
LARGE WORKING PLATFORM
IDEAL FOR ALL ACCESS & MAINTENANCE APPLICATIONS FJG04Z
FJG03Z
No. of Height of Treads Top Tread mm 3 890
Overall Size - In Use H x W x D mm 1790 x 642 x 1147
Overall Size - Folded H x W x D mm 1932 x 642 x 170
Weight kg 12.5
FJG03Z
Model
4
1154
2054 x 679 x 1346
2232 x 679 x 170
14
FJG04Z
5
1433
2333 x 716 x 1536
2532 x 716 x 170
15.5
FJG05Z
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
475
ACCESS Glass Fibre Steps GLASS FIBRE LADDER • Comply to EN-131 Standard • Available for use as a stepladder, extension ladder & freestanding extension ladder.Unique sliding mechanism makes conversion between modes easy • Manufactured from a Glass Fibre framewith Aluminium rungs & Nylon support strap • Non-slip treads for comfort & safety • Wide base & heavy dutyfeet for stability & grip • Insulated to 10,000V • Ideal for use in an electrical environment
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628)
GFL07Z
No. of Treads
Folded Height mm
Stepladder Height mm
Extension Ladder Length mm
Weight kg
Model
6
1690
2393
3375
13
GFL06Z
7
1975
2925
4220
14.5G
GFL07Z
FL07Z
GLASS FIBRE LADDER • Comply to EN-131 Standard • Locking Mechanism to ensure increased safety • Roller Wheels for ease of movement on a building/against a wall • Tested to 100,000V - far beyond most products • Available for use as a stepladder, extension ladder or freestanding extension ladder
wall wheels stabiliser bar
No. of Treads
476
Closed Extended Overall Weight Length Length Height in aa kg mm mm position mm
Model
3x8
2400
5470
2300
21
SV-V3-3x8
3 x 10
3000
7450
2900
32
SV-V3-3x10
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
3 WAY ALUMINIUM STEPS
ACCESS
• PROFESSIONAL
3 WAY COMBINATION LADDER WITH WORK TRAY
• • A stepladder, an extension ladder and a stairwell ladder in one product! Suitable for both professional and domestic use, the unique sliding, mechanism enables easy conversion into each mode. The wide splayed base and heavy duty feet give stability and grip. The strong work tray is useable in all positions and takes loads up to 12 kg. • • Comply to EN-131 Standard • Complete with strong work tray • Load Capacity: 130kg • Closed Length: 1900 mm SVEUR3-3x8
Extension Stepladder
Stairwell Ladder
Stairwell Ladder
Model
Extended Ladder Length
Weight (kg)
AFA15Z
2740 mm
7.5
EUR0 3
Three-section combination ladder can be used as stepladder with base stabiliser, free standing combination (‘reform’) ladder and as a 3 part extension ladder- equipped with sliding wall wheels from 3x8 model upwards. When used as a stepladder, the third section serves only as a guardrail.
Wall Wheels
Base Stabiliser
Model
No. of Rungs
Overall Height (mm)
Platform Height (mm)
Weight (kg)
SVEUR3-3x6
3x6
1800
1700
12
SVEUR3-3x8
3x8
2400
2300
15
SVEUR3-3x10
3 x 10
3000
2900
20
SVEUR3-3x12
3 x 12
3500
3400
26
SVEUR3-3x14
3 x 14
4100
4000
32
LUXE 3
SVLX3-7+8+8
This premium quality professional aluminium combination ladder is available for use as a stepladder. extension ladder or freestanding extension ladder, and for use on stairwells. This is a superior professional quality ladder, which features wall wheels as standard and a unique patented adjustable stabiliser. Featuring large comfortable rungs, which are flat at the correct usage angle of 70 degrees. Strong, safe, durable and versatile, this is one ladder that gives the user a variety of capabilities and options. Comply to EN-131 Standard • Wall Wheels as Standard • Unique Patented Adjustable Stabiliser
Unique Patented Stabiliser
Model
No. of Rungs
Overall Height (mm)
Platform Height (mm)
Weight (kg)
SVLX3-6+7+7
6+7+7
2250
2100
16.5
SVLX3-7+8+8
7+8+8
2550
2400
18.5
SVLX3-8+9+9
8+9+9
2850
2700
20
SVLX3-9+10+10
9 + 10 + 10
3100
3000
25
SVLX3-10+11+11
10 + 11 + 11
3400
3300
30
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
477
ACCESS EXTENSION 3 WAY LADDERS MOUNTER • Unit has Roller Wheels for easy movement on a building • Large stabilizer bar to stop the unit sinking in the ground • Comply to EN-131 Standard This premium quality professional aluminium combination ladder enables the user to benefit from a black powder coated finish, which keeps the users hands warm and prevents dirt accumulation, caused by oxidisation of bare metal. Available for use as a stepladder, extension ladder or freestanding extension ladder, this is a superior professional quality ladder which features wall wheels as standard and a large sturdy stabiliser. The stabiliser ensures safe easy use in the most demanding circumstances. Featuring large comfortable flat ‘D’ rungs, which are 45mm deep and are flat at the correct usage angle of 70 degrees, there is no product comparable in the market today. Strong, safe, durable and versatile, this is one ladder that gives the user a variety of capabilities and options and keeps the users hands warm and clean at the same time.
Superior Mechanism
Model
Wall Wheels
No. of Rungs
Large Stabilizer
Maximum Height (mm)
Weight (kg)
ALT-123610
3 x 10
6900
24
ALT-123612
3 x 12
8000
28
ALT-123614
3 x 14
9350
34
ALT-123610
PROFESSIONAL 5 WAY COMBINATION LADDER This versatile combination ladder can be used as a stepladder. an extension ladder, a stairwell ladder, a level platform and a stairwell platform. Suitable for nrofessional and domestic use, the unit is of rigid construction with a wide base stabiliser. Quick and easy to set up, the unit has twist lock adjustment for easy height adjustment and a level platform in any position • Comply to EN-131 Standard • Complete with large non-slip platform • Load Capacity: 150kg
Model
Stepladder Top Rung Height
Extension Platform Height
Maximum Platform Height
Weight (kg)
AFA59Z
1560 mm
2740 mm
1200 mm
16.5
Level Platform
StepLadder
Extension Ladder Twist lock system
478
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Portable STEPS
ACCESS
• Tread Size: 500mm wide x 150mm deep • Platform Size: 500mm wide x 300mm deep • Rubber Treads • 2 x 150mm Nylon wheels • 600mm high rear handrail
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628)
• GS Approved version also available
Fort Steel framed Steps for Safety, Strength & Durability
MS0608
MS0605
MS0603
Access Heights Safely
FORT ARROW RANGE OF STEPS • 3 Colour Options Available
Blue
Red
Grey
Available in two versions - as a standard step and also the GS version which is manufactured and approved to the European GS Standard. This medium duty range of steps is ideal for warehouses, shops, offices etc. Tubular steel construction with non-slip rubber treads. Units are easy to manoeuvre on the 2 wheels - simply use the handles to lift the front and wheel into position. Standard Version
GS Version
No. of Steps
Platform Height (mm)
Overall Dimensions when erected H x W x D (mm)
Weight (kg)
MS0603
GS0603
3
750
1450 x 640 x 1110
26
MS0604
GS0604
4
1000
1700 x 670 x 1220
29
MS0605
GS0605
5
1250
1950 x 700 x 1535
32
MS0606
GS0606
6
1500
2200 x 730 x 1745
36
MS0607
GS0607
7
1750
2450 x 760 x 1955
41
MS0608
GS0608
8
2000
2700 x 790 x 2165
44
GS0608
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
479
ACCESS HEAVY DUTY MOBILE STEPS MANUFACTURED AND APPROVED TO EUROPEAN GS STANDARDS • Large Working Top Platform • Safe • Sturdy • 3 to 15 steps • Tread Size: 590mm wide x 128mm deep
Fort Steel framed Steps for Safety, Strength & Durability
Heavy duty steel framed mobile steps with platform heights from 0.69 to 3.45 metres. Robust design gives maximum rigidity stability yet highly manoeuvrable. Lifting step feature deters access until steps are safely grounded. UNIQUE SAFETY ACTION Single action lever raises castors and lowers bottom step when unit is positioned for use. Handle mechanism is fitted to the right hand side as standard. Platform Size: Width 540 x Depth 590 mm Finish:- Blue durable high gloss powder coated 6 Step units and above are sent folded for delivery - easy to erect. OPTIONAL EXTRAS TOOL TRAY/ WIRE MESH BASKET The steel tool tray or wire mesh basket hooks on to the top guard rail. Epoxy powder coated - blue.
GS9306R
Model
Description
Overall Dimensions L x W x H mm
BSK93M
Wire mesh basket for GS step
615 x 260 x 210
BSK93T
Tool tray for GS step
615 x 260 x 210
BSK58M
Wire mesh basket for MS step
650 x 260 x 210
BSK58T
Tool tray for MS step
650 x 260 x 210
BSK69M
Wire mesh basket for MS step, wider
895 x 260 x 210
BSK69T
Tool tray for MS step, wider
895 x 260 x 210
Model
480
Rubber Covered nonslip treads Platform
Expanded Steel Treads Platform
Aluminium non-slip treads Platform
No. of Steps
Platform Height (mm)
Step Width (mm)
Overall Dimensions when erected H x W x D (mm)
Weight (kg)
GS9303R
GS9303M
GS9303A
3
690
490
1790 x 680 x 972
44
GS9304R
GS9304M
GS9304A
4
920
490
2020 x 680 x 1104
50
GS9305R
GS9305M
GS9305A
5
1150
490
2250 x 910 x 1237
56
GS9306R
GS9306M
GS9306A
6
1380
490
2480 x 960 x 1370
68
GS9307R
GS9307M
GS9307A
7
1610
490
2710 x 1010 x 1503
77
GS908R
GS9308M
GS9308A
8
1840
490
2940 x 1060 x 1635
87
GS9309R
GS9309M
GS9309A
9
2070
490
3170 x 1110 x 1768
96
GS9310R
GS9310M
GS9310A
10
2300
490
3400 x 1160 x 1901
105
GS9311R
GS9311M
GS9311A
11
2530
490
3630 x 1210 x 2034
114
GS9312R
GS9312M
GS9312A
12
2760
490
3860 x 1260 x 2167
123
GS9313R
GS9313M
GS9313A
13
2990
490
4090 x 1370 x 2299
132
GS9314R
GS9314M
GS9314A
14
3220
490
4320 x 1420 x 2432
140
GS9315R
GS9315M
GS9315A
15
3450
490
4550 x 1425 x 2565
149
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Access Platforms
ACCESS
FORT EASY SLOPE PLATFORMS • Easy Slope 48oIncline - for safe & easy use • Extra Wide Treads: 750W x 180Dmm • Platform Size: 800W x 1200Dmm • Removable platform chains on three sides for access • Fitted with grip lift mechanism fitted to the right hand side, to facilitate movement on the castors • Available powder coated Blue or Galvanised
Fort Steel Framed Steps for Safety, Strength & Durability
No. of Platform Steps Height mm 3 4 5 6
Overall Size H x W x D mm
Weight kg
690
1690 x 950 x 1826
74
920
1920 x 950 x 2033
1150
2150 x 950 x 2240
1380
2380 x 950 x 2447
82 90 98
Finish
Model
Powder Coated
MS9103M
Galvanised
MS9103G
Powder Coated
MS9104M
Galvanised
MS9104G
Powder Coated
MS9105M
Galvanised
MS9105G
Powder Coated
MS9106M
Galvanised
MS9106G
MS9106M
FORT EASY SLOPE PLATFORMS • Manufactured & approved to the recognised European GS standard • Easy Slope 48 Inc line - for safe & easy use • Extra Wide Treads: 750W x 180D mm • Inward opening gates on 3 sides of the platform • Fitted with grip lift mechanism to facilitate movement on the castors • Platform Size: 800W x 1200L mm
Optional retro-fit lifting barrier to the front (entry) of the platform of these steps.
Model SB910GS
No. of Steps 2
Platform Height 460 mm
Overall Size H x W x D mm 1460 x 960 x 1479
Weight kg 62
GS9102M
3
690 mm
1690 x 960 x 1686
72
GS9103M
4
920 mm
1920 x 960 x 1893
82
GS9104M
5
1150 mm
2150 x 960 x 2100
101
GS9105M
6
1380 mm
2380 x 980 x 2307
115
GS9106M
7
1610 mm 2610 x 1030 x 2514
130
GS9107M
8
1840 mm 2840 x 1080 x 2721
144
GS9108M
Model
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
GS9108M
481
ACCESS ACCESS tOWERS EASY SLOPE PLATFORMS • Comply to EN-1298 • The enclosed hinge system provides easy folding & unfolding with extra stability • Large anti-slip feetprovide extra strength • Working Height is approx. 2mabove the Platform Height • This compact folding tower hasbasic size of 750D x 1850Wmm • The base fits between standarddoors without dis-assembly
ALTK 2-3.8M - shown with 2 stabilisers but comes with 4
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628)
Toeboards & 4 x Stabilisers supplied as standard with 3.8M platform& above
OTHER CONFIGURATIONS AVAILABLE - CALL FOR DETAILS
K2 Folded
ALTK 2-0.7M - shown with 3 x Horizontal Braces
482
K2 Base unit fits through standard doorways.
Description
Model
Folding Base to 700mm
ALTK2-0.7M
Horizontal Braces (included in 3 Systems below)
ALTK2-HB
System to 1800mm Platform Height
ALTK2-1.8M
System to 3800mm Platform Height
ALTK2-3.8M
System to 5800mm Platform Height
ALTK2-5.8M
Toeboard Set (included in 2 systems above)
ALTK2-TB
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
access towers
ACCESS
ROLLER S
JollY
• Folding Base Unit fits through standard doors • 4 Swivel Castors for increased manoeuvrability • Comply to EN1004 - Part 3 Standard • Lightweight Aluminium foldable tower • Overall size: 1600 x 800mm
• The base unit folds to fit through door ways • Comply to EN1004 - Part 3 Standard • Quick & easy installation • Made of lightweight Aluminium tubular alloy (ø 50 mm) with non skid knurled rungs • Toeboards are included with System C & above
Roller S being Folded
Roller S Folded
Simply lean the hook on the rung & pressslightly to fix the brace immediately
Description
Plat. Height mm
Model
System A
950
SV-JOL0.95M
Model
System B
1620
SV-JOL1.62M
Base Pack - 1m Plat. Height
Weight kg 25
SV-ROLLER
System C
3420
SV-JOL3.42M
System to 2.45m Plat. Height
38
SV-ROL2.45M
System D
5220
SV-JOL5.22M
System to 3.95m Plat. Height
63.5
SV-ROL3.95M
System E
7020
SV-JOL7.02M
System to 6m Plat. Height
84.5
SV-ROL6.00M
System F
8820
SV-JOL8.82M
Toeboard (included in 3.95/6m Systems)
-
SV-ROLLER-TB
System G
10620
SV-JOL10.62M
Description
MTB SYSTEM - MODULAR TRIANGLE BRIDGE • Comply to EN-12811 • Quick & easy construction • Compact for storage & transport • Levellers available for uneven surfaces - CALL FOR DETAILS • This system has been equipped with unique stackable trusses, available in lengths of 2000, 3000 & 4000mm • The lightweight Triangle Bridge can be assembled on floor level & brought to the height required by a hand winch ASSEMBLED AT GROUND LEVEL FOR ULTIMATE SAFETY DEMONSTRATIONS AVAILABLE THROUGH YOUR LOCAL ACCESS SPECIALIST 00:03
00:06
showing how the unique trusses stack neatly for transport due to their unique ‘v’ shape design
00:09
00:12
FROM THE GROUND TO 5 METRES IN 12 MINUTES For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
483
ACCESS
MOBILE STEPS
The two step model MS7112 complete with removable handle for left or right fitting
MS7112
MS7013 MS7014
Mobile Steps • All Weather Non-slip Injected Moulded Treads. Available as a standard version and also as a GS version which is manufactured and approved to the European GS Standard. Strong tubular steel frame fitted with 4 sprung retractable swivel castors. These give the steps their easy mobility but when body weight is added they retract and remain firm and safe on rubber feet. Wheels 80 mm dia swivel rubber tyred non marking. COLOUR OPTIONS AVAILABLE: Please specify when ordering
Standard Version: • 4 Colour Options Available GS7014
Blue
Green
Red
Beige
GS Version: • 2 Colour Options Available
GS7013
GS7012
484
Blue
Red
Platform Platform Overall Size Weight Description Height mm Dim W x D mm L x W x H mm kg Standard Version 2 step without handle 500 400 x 200 510 x 520 x 575 8 Handle only for above 2 step with handle 500 400 x 200 510 x 520 x 1245 11 3 step 770 400 x 400 840 x 550 x 1470 22 4 step 1020 400 x 400 1040 x 550 x 1720 25 5 step 1140 400 x 460 1160 x 665 x 1980 28 6 step 1370 400 x 460 1320 x 750 x 2210 31 GS Version 2 step with handle 470 400 x 200 620 x 510 x 1330 15 3 step 735 400 x 400 870 x 620 x 1445 17 4 step 980 400 x 400 1040 x 650 x 1690 23
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
MS8116 Model Price
MS7012 MS003Z MS7112 MS7013 MS7014 MS8115 MS8116
POA POA POA POA POA POA POA
GS7012 GS7013 GS7014
POA POA POA
PREMIER MOBILE STEPS
ACCESS
MS6012 fitted with MS002Z
MS6014
MS6013
THE PREMIER RANGE OF Mobile Steps • Large Working Platform • Epoxy Powder Coated • All Weather Non-slip Injected Moulded Treads • 4 Colour Options Available. Blue Green Please specify colour when ordering.
Red
Inset sprung loaded roller
Beige
The ultimate in safety. The feet have inset rollers that give greater mobility, but grip firmly to the floor when body weight is applied. The 2 step model is available with or without post.
Description
2 Step 3 Step 4 Step 5 Step
Platform Height mm 508 762 1016 1290
Platform Size mm 400 x 200 400 x 400 400 x 400 400 x 400
Overall Size Weight L x W x H mm Kg 584 x 533 x 635 7 813 x 533 x 1473 13 1016 x 533 x 1702 20 1440 x 560 x 1950 25
Model Price MS6012 MS6013 MS6014 MS6015
Optional extra safety post with handgrip for two step model. Height from floor 1350 mm
POA POA POA POA
MS002Z
Mobile Steps WITH BARRIERS Close up of Safety Barrier
• 4 Colour Options Available Please specify when ordering
Blue
Green
Red
Beige
MS6015
Similar in design to the above units, these steps are fitted with 1 metre high platform rails, deep kick plates and safety barriers. No Platform of Height Steps mm 3 762 4 1016 5 1290
FD6013
Platform Size W x D mm 400 x 400 400 x 400 400 x 400
Overall Weight H x W x D kg Model Price mm 1762 x 22 FD6013 POA 533 x 813 2016 x 25 FD6014 POA 533 x1016 2290 x 28 FD6015 POA 560 x1440
MS6015 For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
485
ACCESS TILT ‘N’ PUSh STEPS
MS7814P fitted with MS710Z
• Standard or GS version available • Galvanised or Blue painted finish • Large Platform size: 490 x 600 mm • Optional extra: inward opening rear gate GS7815P
Please specify when ordering
• Low maintenance • Robust Available in two versions - As a standard step and also the GS version which is manufactured and approved to the European GS Standard. Both versions are available either in Galvanised finish or Blue epoxy powder coated finish. The large working top platform and optional extra of a factory fitted inward opening rear gate makes them ideal for loading and unloading items. The steps have two handles at the front, fitted with knuckle guard hand grips for lifting. This facilitates mobility of the unit on the two fixed rear nylon 100 mm castors. • Platform rail height: 1000 mm • Tread Size: 490 x 160 mm
No Platform Overall Weight of Height Dimensions kg Treads mm H x W x D mm
Galvanised Units
Blue Painted Units
MS700Z
Model Price Model Price
Optional Inward Opening Gate
Standard Version 3 750
1750 x 660 x 1235
43
MS7803G
POA
4 1000
2000 x 660 x 1420
48
MS7804G
POA MS7814P POA
5 1250
2250 x 660 x 1605
54
MS7805G
POA MS7815P POA
6 1500
2500 x 660 x 1790
60
MS7806G
POA MS7816P POA
Inward Opening gate - factory fitted to the rear
MS7813P
POA
MS700Z
POA
MS710Z
POA
GS7803G
POA
GS7813P
POA
GS Version 3 750
1750 x 820 x 1235
4 1000
2000 x 820 x 1420 48 GS7804G POA GS7814P POA
5 1250
2250 x 1020 x 1605
43
54
2500 x 1120 60 x 1790 factory fitted Inward Opening gate to the rear 6 1500
486
GS7805G
POA
GS7815P
POA
GS7806G
POA
GS7816P
POA
GS700Z
POA
GS710Z
POA
Hardwearing Galvanised Model
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
MS7806G
FOLDABLE STEPS
ACCESS
contract economy range • Thread Size: 450mm wide x 145mm deep • Platform Size: 450mm wide x 300mm deep • Expanded Steel Threads • 2 x 200mm black rubber tyred wheels Constructed from tabular steel with expanded steel threads. The steps are mademobile with the use of the lever operated retractable front castors. Finish: Expoxy Powder Coated Blue
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628)
Lever operated retractable castors.
MS0508
MS0508
No. of Steps
Platform Height (mm)
Overall Size HxWxD (mm)
Weight kg
Model
Price
3
750
1450x650x895
35
MS0503
POA
4
1000
1700x650x1040
38
MS0504
POA
5
1250
1950x690x1185
41
MS0505
POA
6
1500
2200x720x1330
44
MS0506
POA
7
1750
2450x770x1475
47
MS0507
POA
8
2000
2700x790x1620
50
MS0508
POA
9
2250
2950x810x1765
53
MS0509
POA
10
2500
3200x840x1910
56
MS05010
POA
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
487
ACCESS
FOLDING Steps
FGS7805M shown folded
FGS7808M
FGS7805M
QUICK FOLDING STEPS • • • •
Approved to European GS Standard Tread Size: 450mm wide x 145mm deep Expanded Steel Treads Folds and unfolds without the use of nuts and bolts
• Platform Size: 450mm wide x 300mm deep • 2 x 200mm black rubber tyred wheels
Manufactured and approved to the recognised European GS Standard. Constructed from tubular steel with two handles at the front, fitted with knuckle guard hand grips, which facilitate movement when the unit is erect. The units have a unique mechanism allowing the unit to be folded and un-folded quickly without the use of nuts and bolts. No of Platform Steps Height mm
Overall Dimensions when erected H x W x D mm
4
1000
1700 x 650 x 1310
930 x 650 x 1830
40
FGS7804M
POA
5
1250
1950 x 690 x 1520
930 x 690 x 2120
45
FGS7805M
POA
6
1500
2200 x 720 x 1730
930 x 720 x 2410
50
FGS7806M
POA
7
1750
2450 x 770 x 1940
930 x 770 x 2700
55
FGS7807M
POA
8
2000
2700 x 790 x 2150
930 x 790 x 2990
60
FGS7808M
POA
488
Dimensions Weight when Folded Model Price kg H x W x D mm
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
MEDIUM DUTY STEPS
ACCESS
MEDIUM DUTY MOBILE STEPS • Tread Size: 490 x 130mm • Platform Size: - Standard Version: 540 x 460mm Deep GS Version: 540 x 300mm Deep
Available in two versions - as a standard step and also the GS version which is manufactured and approved to the European GS Standard. Fully welded construction with expanded mild steel mesh treads. The lever operated safety bar helps deter access when steps are mobile. Finish: Epoxy Powder Coated Blue / Red Safety Bar Rear Platform Handrail height: Standard Version: 1000mm GS Version: 600mm Wheels: 2 x 200mm Black Rubber Tyred 1 x 100mm Polypropylene castor
GS Version GS0408M
No of Weight Steps kg Standard Version 5 38 6 48 7 58 8 68 9 78 GS Version 5 43 6 48 7 52 8 57 9 61
Standard Version MS0406M
Platform Height mm
Overall size L x W x H mm
1150 1380 1610 1840 2070
1150 x 700 x 2150 1285 x 700 x 2380 1420 x 700 x 2610 1550 x 700 x 2840 1685 x 700 x 3070
MS0405M MS0406M MS0407M MS0408M MS0409M
POA POA POA POA POA
1150 1380 1610 1840 2070
1210 x 730 x 1850 1415 x 750 x 2080 1600 x 780 x 2310 1790 x 810 x 2540 1985 x 830 x 2770
GS0405M GS0406M GS0407M GS0408M GS0409M
POA POA POA POA POA
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Model Price
489
ACCESS HEAVY DUTY MOBILE Steps • Safe • Tread Size 165 x 490 mm • Strong • Two Sizes of Platform Available • 3 to 18 Steps • Choice of Treads This range of steel framed mobile steps is easily manoeuvrable. Available with a choice of either non-slip rubber or expanded mesh treads. Fitted with lever operated retractable front castors and a safety bar which deters access to steps when in the mobile position. Finish: Epoxy Powder Coated - Red. 6 Step units and above are sent folded for delivery - easy to erect. Platform Handrail Height 1000 mm x 200 mm Black Rubber Tyred Wheels:- 2 2 x 100 mm Nylon Castors
Optional Plywood Shelf As shown below an optional plywood storage shelf is available on this range of steps. To Suit 3 - 6 Steps 7 - 12 Steps 13 - 18 Steps
Model MS990B MS991B MS992B
Price
MS9808M
Platform size: 460 mm Depth x 540 mm Width No Platform Weight Expanded Steel Treads Rubber covered Treads of Height Overall Size kg Steps mm L x W x H mm Model Price Model Price 3 22 690 890 x 700 x 1690 MS9803M POA MS9803R POA 4 32 920 1100 x 700 x 1920 MS9804M POA MS9804R POA 5 42 1150 1200 x 700 x 2150 MS9805M POA MS9805R POA 6 52 1380 1370 x 700 x 2380 MS9806M POA MS9806R POA 7 62 1610 1530 x 700 x 2610 MS9807M POA MS9807R POA 8 72 1840 1700 x 700 x 2840 MS9808M POA MS9808R POA 9 82 2070 1860 x 700 x 3070 MS9809M POA MS9809R POA 10 92 2300 2020 x 700 x 3300 MS9810M POA MS9810R POA 11 107 2530 2190 x 800 x 3530 MS9811M POA MS9811R POA 12 122 2760 2360 x 800 x 3760 MS9812M POA MS9812R POA 13 137 2990 2520 x 1150 x 3990 MS9813M POA MS9813R POA 14 152 3220 2690 x 1230 x 4220 MS9814M POA MS9814R POA 15 167 3450 2850 x 1230 x 4450 MS9815M POA MS9815R POA 16 182 3680 2920 x 1230 x 4680 MS9816M POA MS9816R POA 17 197 3910 3180 x 1400 x 4910 MS9817M POA MS9817R POA 18 212 4140 3350 x 1400 x 5140 MS9818M POA MS9818R POA
490
Platform Size: 590 mm Depth x 540 mm Width Expanded Steel Treads Rubber covered Treads Overall Size L x W x H mm Model Price Model Price 1060 x 700 x 1690 MS9903M POA MS9903R POA 1270 x 700 x 1920 MS9904M POA MS9904R POA 1370 x 700 x 2150 MS9905M POA MS9905R POA 1540 x 700 x 2380 MS9906M POA MS9906R POA 1700 x 700 x 2610 MS9907M POA MS9907R POA 1870 x 700 x 2840 MS9908M POA MS9908R POA 2030 x 700 x 3070 MS9909M POA MS9909R POA 2190 x 700 x 3300 MS9910M POA MS9910R POA 2360 x 800 x 3530 MS9911M POA MS9911R POA 2530 x 800 x 3760 MS9912M POA MS9912R POA 2690 x 1230 x 3990 MS9913M POA MS9913R POA 2860 x 1230 x 4220 MS9914M POA MS9914R POA 3020 x 1230 x 4450 MS9915M POA MS9915R POA 3190 x 1230 x 4680 MS9916M POA MS9916R POA 3350 x 1400 x 4910 MS9917M POA MS9917R POA 3520 x 1400 x 5140 MS9918M POA MS9918R POA
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
HEAVY DUTY MOBILE Steps
ACCESS
• Safe • Strong • Platform Height .69 to 4 m • Large working top platform 600 x 540 or 600 x 820 mm • From 3 to 18 steps One of the safest, most complete range currently available. The strongly constructed steps are highly manoeuvrable and stable. Finish: Blue durable high gloss powder coated. 6 Step units and above are sent folded for delivery - easy to erect.
Red Safety Barrier
MS5822 MS5831
No. Weight Platform Step Overall Rubber covered Expanded steel Aluminium of (kg) Height Width Dimensions non-slip treads Price treads and Price non-slip Steps (m) (m) L x W x H (m) platform Model platform Model tread Model 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
* * * * * * * *
25 35 45 55 65 75 85 95 110 125 140 155 170 185 200 215 150 170 190 210 230 250 270
0.69 0.92 1.15 1.38 1.61 1.84 2.07 2.30 2.53 2.76 2.99 3.22 3.45 3.68 3.91 4.14 2.53 2.76 2.99 3.22 3.45 3.68 3.91
.490 1.06x.700x1.69 .490 1.27x.700x1.92 .490 1.37x.700x2.15 .490 1.54x.700x2.38 .490 1.70x.700x2.61 .490 1.87x.700x2.84 .490 2.03x.700x3.07 .490 2.19x.700x3.30 .490 2.36x.800x3.53 .490 2.53x.800x3.76 .490 2.69x1.15x3.99 .490 2.86x1.23x4.22 .490 3.02x1.23x4.45 .490 3.19x1.23x4.68 .490 3.35x1.40x4.91 .490 3.52x1.40x5.14 .770 2.36x.950x3.53 .770 2.53x.950x3.76 .770 2.69x1.15x3.99 .770 2.86x1.23x4.22 .770 3.02x1.23x4.45 .770 3.19x1.23x4.68 .770 3.35x1.40x4.91
MS5781 MS5791 MS5801 MS5811 MS5821 MS5831 MS5841 MS5851 MS5861 MS5871 MS5881 MS5891 MS5901 MS5111 MS5121 MS5131 MS6961 MS6971 MS6981 MS6991 MS6901 MS6911 MS6921
POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA POA
MS5782 MS5792 MS5802 MS5812 MS5822 MS5832 MS5842 MS5852 MS5862 MS5872 MS5882 MS5892 MS5902 MS5112 MS5122 MS5132 MS6962 MS6972 MS6982 MS6992 MS6902 MS6912 MS6922
280 4.14 .770 3.52x1.40x5.14 MS6931
POA
MS6932
Price
POA MS5783 POA POA MS5793 POA POA MS5803 POA POA MS5813 POA POA MS5823 POA POA MS5833 POA POA MS5843 POA POA MS5853 POA POA MS5863 POA POA MS5873 POA POA MS5883 POA POA MS5893 POA POA MS5903 POA POA MS5113 POA POA MS5123 POA POA MS5133 POA POA MS6963 POA POA MS6973 POA POA MS6983 POA POA MS6993 POA POA MS6903 POA POA MS6913 POA POA MS6923 POA POA POA MS6933
OPTIONAL EXTRAS SAFETY BARRIER A red safety barrier as shown can be fitted to this range of steps.
REAR INWARD OPENING GATE To allow access from the rear of the platform an inward opening gate can be fitted to the rear of the platform handrail.
Description Safety Barrier to suit steps 490mm wide Safety Barrier to suit steps 770mm wide Inward Opening Gate to suit steps 490mm wide Inward Opening Gate to suit steps 770mm wide
Model FD500Z FD600Z MS500Z MS600Z
Price
Unique Safety Action This feature lifts the bottom step preventing access until the unit is grounded and safe to use. This also prevents knocked shins when wheeling the steps between locations.
PLEASE ENSURE TO CHECK THE OVERALL HEIGHT BEFORE ORDERING
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
491
HEALTH & ENVIRONMENT First Aid Kits BS-8599-1 COMPLIANTWORKPLACE FIRSTAID KITS
BURNS KIT • Burns Kits in a soft bag or hard case
• Contained in a high-density Plastic box witha wall mounting bracket
CB551 First Aid Kits
Description
First Aid Kit Refills
Model
Model
Small First Aid Kit
CB551
CB560
Medium First Aid Kit
CB552
CB561
Large First Aid Kit
CB553
CB562
FW001B
Contents
Small First Kid Kit
Medium First Kid Kit
Large First Kid Kit
Assorted Washproof Plasters
40
60
100
Self Adhesive Finger Bandage (35 x 35mm)
2
3
4
HSE First Aid Dressing (120 x 120mm)
4
6
8
HSE First Aid Dressing (180 x 180mm)
1
2
2
No. 16 HSE Eye Pad Dressing - Boxed
2
3
4
Disposable Non-woven Triangular Bandage
2
3
4
Kayform Conforming Bandage - (75mm x 4.5M)
1
2
2
Description
Model
Burns Kit in Soft Bag
FW001B
Burns Kit in Hard Case
FW001D
Burns Kit Refills
FW001C
Kaypore Tape - (25mm x 10M)
1
1
1
Contents
Quantity
Kays Alcohol Free Antiseptic Wipes
20
30
40
Burn Gel Dressing (50 x 150mm)
2
Universal Tough Cut Scissors
1
1
1
Burn Gel Dressing (100 x 100mm)
2
Blue Nitrile powder free Disposable Gloves - Lge
6 Pairs
9 Pairs
12 Pairs
Burn Gel Dressing (200 x 200mm)
1
Foil Blanket - (2150 x 1500mm)
1
2
3
Burn Blot Sachet (3.5g)
8
Resuscitation Aid with One-way Valve
1
1
2
Burn Gel Bottle (125ml)
1
First Aid Guidance Leaflet
1
1
1
Conforming Bandage (75mm x 4M)
3
Safety Pins
6
12
24
Large Universal Shears
1
Burn Gel Dressing - (100 x 100mm)
1
2
2
Disposable Gloves
1 Pair
F C B E
1410
D
A
RES310 CO250 CO253
CO266 Product A B
Model
25 x 20ml
CO266
500ml
CO250
C
Eye Wash Station
10 x 20ml Pods & 2 Boxed Eye Pods
1410
D
Eye Wash Poster
-
CO253
100 Wipes
BL196
50ml Alcohol-Free Sanitizer
RES310
500ml Alcohol Sanitizer
RES600
Washproof
DT393
Fabric
DT409
E F
G
H I
492
Eye Wash
Description
Anti-bacterial Wipes & Spray Assorted Plasters
Blue (Kitchens)
DT400
Disposable Medical Gloves
100 Small
AWD201
100 Medium
AWD202
100 Large
AWD203
First Aid Sign
100 x 250mm
FA00619S
BL196
G
BL196
H
I
AWD202
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
FA00619S
Visible Storage
HEALTH & ENVIRONMENT
VisibLe stORaGe Cabinets • 6mm toughened safety glass: BS6206 • Strong welded construction from 0.9mm Steel • Re-inforced double skin doors with maximum area viewing panels • 3 way chrome lever locking handle with semi-concealed internal mechanism • Steel Shelf Capacity: 75kg UDL • Glass Shelf Capacity: 50kg UDL • 4 colour options available with the Grey Body: Red
white
Blue
Green
please specify when ordering
Solid single colour unit salso available - Light Grey, Blue, Green, Red & White
88V894 88V994 88V793
Cabinets Overall Size H x W x D mm 1830 x 915 x 460 1830 x 1220 x 460 915 x 460 x 460 915 x 915 x 460
88V944
Shelves 3 Steel 2 Steel
Model
EXTRA SHELVES
88V894
Overall Size W x D mm
88V824 88V944
460 x 460
88V994
Wall Visible Cabinet 712 x 915 x 300
2 Steel
915 x 460
88V793
Split Visible Cabinet 1830 x 915 x 460
2 Steel & 2 Glass
1220 x 460
88S894
Shelves
Model
Steel
88ES44V
Glass
88ES44G
Steel
88ES94V
Glass
88ES94G
Steel
88ES24V
Glass
88ES24G
• Strong welded construction from 0.9mm Steel • Re-inforced mesh panel door(s) • Suitable for PPE, tools, computer peripherals etc • Secured by 3 way Chrome lever locking handle • 4 colour options available with the Grey Body:
MesH DOOR Cabinets
Red
Yellow
Blue
Green
please specify when ordering
Solid single colour units also available in the above colours & Dark Grey
give ventilation & visibility whilst maintaining security 88MD894L 88MD894R
Overall Size H x W x D mm 1830 x 915 x 459 1830 x 459 x 459 915 x 915 x 459 915 x 459 x 459
88MD844
88MD894L
Shelf Configuration
Model
1/2 Louvred 2 Shelves 88MD894L Centre Divider, 88MD894R Hanging Rail & 3 Shelves 3 Shelves 88MD894 3 Shelves 1 Shelf
88MD844 88MD994 88MD944
88MD944
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
88MD994
493
HEALTH & ENVIRONMENTHealthcare Trolleys Healthcare Trolleys - with a 10 Year Guarantee Healthcare Trolleys
MEDICAL/BOOK TROLLEY
• Strong Polyethylene moulded trolleys • Non-conductive & resistant to most substances • Mobile on 2 x 200mm rear castors & 2 x 100mm braked swivel castors with corner buffers
• Six slanted shelves for easy access • Strong heavy gauge Steel trolleys • Clearance between slanted shelves: 280mm • Mobile on 4 quiet & easy running 100mm swivel castors, 2 with brakes • Subject to availability
Max Load
180 KG
GIM23L
GIB40L
Overall Size L x W x H mm 813 x 610 x 1067
Size Between Shelves 380 mm
Weight kg 24
Model GIB40L
DEEP TRAY TROLLEYS
Overall Size L x W x H mm 730 x 432 x 1041
Shelf Depth mm 165
Weight kg 28
Model GIM23L
GREY SHELF TROLLEYS • Super Strong Polyethylene Moulded Trolleys • Will not rust, dent or chip - easy to clean • These easy to manoeuvre units are ideal for use in healthcare applications such as hospitals & surgeries • Mobile on 4 x 100mm swivel castors, 2 with brakes
• 70mm deep trays • Strong Polyethylene moulded trolleys • Non-conductive & resistant to most substances • GI627L - clearance between shelves: 660mm • GI637L - clearance between shelves: 305mm • Mobile on 4 swivel 100mm castors, 2 with brakes
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628)
GI541L GI543L GI637L
Description 2 Tray Unit 3 Tray Unit
494
Overall Size L x W x H mm 610 x 460 x 980 610 x 460 x 1000
Weight kg 10.5 14
Model GI627L GI637L
No of Shelves 36
Overall Size L x W x H mm
Clearance Between Shelves
Weight kg
Model
10 x 458 x 840
305 mm
11
GI541L
46
10 x 458 x 915
222 mm
13
GI542L
56
10 x 458 x 915
159 mm
17
GI543L
66
10 x 458 x 1143
159 mm
19
GI544L
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
healthcare Trolleys
HEALTH & ENVIRONMENT
SHELF TROLLEYS
COLLECTOR TROLLEY
• Clearance between shelves: 280mm • Complete with Grey Aluminium uprights • 25mm lip on 3 sides & a 5mm rim on 1 side • Mobile on 4 swivel 75mm ‘quietcastors’
• Mobile on 4 x swivel castors - 2 with brakes • 3 Grey Plastic containers & 2 bins, all removable
Max Load
100 KG
GIC816
HI424Y &HI004Z Description
Overall Size L x W x H mm
Weight kg
Model
Grey 3 Shelf Trolley
800 x 410 x 790
8
HI424Y
Optional Buckets 332 x 232 x 172 to fit the above model 336 x 236 x 562
-
HI004Z
Overall Size L x W x H mm 800 x 440 x 930
Weight kg 15
Model GIC816
PCI09Y
IDEAL FOR BULKY ITEMS PCI08Y
Overall Size - L x W x H mm External
Internal
Capacity Litres
Weight kg
Model
1210 x 710 x 820
940 x 620 x 610
250
32
PCI08Y
350
39
PCI09Y
1420 x 750 x 860 1150 x 650 x 640
CONTAINER TRUCKS • Removable Polypropylene containers • Push/pull handle & 2 fixed & 2 swivel 125mm Rubber castors make the units manoeuvrable
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
495
HEALTH & ENVIRONMENT
laundry trolleys
VErsaCarEsYsTEMs - servo-X • Quickly & easily folded so ideal for use where space is a premium • The bags incorporate drag handles, top closure system & are easily removed from the frame • Mobile on 4 x 75mm non-marking wheels
Capacity Litres 100
Bag Variations 1 x 100L Bag
Overall Size L x W x H mm 460 x 390 x 960
NX-1001
150
1 x 150L Bag
760 x 460 x 760
NX-1501
200
2 x 100L Bag
760 x 460 x 960
NX-1002
200
1 x 200L Bag
760 x 460 x 960
NX-2001
NX-1501
Modeli
NX-1001
XTRA SYSTEMS - NUSAX • Ideal for many environments including,office, hotels, hospitals etc • Unit incorporates 2 spacious trays to accommodate your onboard cleaning materials • Permit basic cleaning duties to be achieved with waste collection - save time & improve standards • Mobile on 4 x 200mm non-marking wheels
Capacity Litres
Bag Variations
Overall Size L x W x H mm
Model
260
1 x 120L Bag & 2 x 70L Bags
1125 x 665 x 980
NSX-260
NSX-260
VERSACARESYSTEMS - NUBAG • Provide a collection & separation system for all your laundry facilities - inside or out • Ideal for many environments including,office, hotels, hospitals etc • The bags incorporate drag handles, top closure system & are easily removed from the trolley • Mobile on 4 x 200mm non-marking wheels
Call us for full prices and details 800-LOC8 (5628)
496
Capacity Litres
Bag Variations
Overall Size L x W x H mm
Model
300
3 x 100L Bags
1110 x 665 x 1115
NB-3003
NB-3003
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
hygiene trolleys
HEALTH & ENVIRONMENT LAUNDRY TROLLEYS • Strong, removable Canvas sack] • Chrome Plated Steel tubular frame • Base frame to support the sack • Mobile on 4 x 70mm swivel non-marking Rubber castors • Model HI552Y folds forcompact storage
Max Load
150 KG
HI551Y HI552Y
Overall Size Folded Size L x W x H mm H x W x D mm Rectangular Model9 20 x 560 x 880 Folding X Type Model 685 x 590 x 10301 200 x 590 x 380 Description
Weight kg 14 9
Model HI551Y HI552Y
FOLDING LAUNDRY TROLLEY
HEAVY DUTY FOLDING LAUNDRY TROLLEY
• Strong Plastic frame & PVC sack • Base frame to support the sack • Mobile on 4 x 75mm swivel Rubber castors
• Strong Zinc Plated frame • PVC bag: 232 Litres • Lightweight & folds for compact storage • Mobile on 4 x 125mm swivel Rubber castors • Burst strength of bag:160lb/sq. in
Max Load
70 KG
HI513Y
GS4212 Overall Size - Open Overall Size - Folded L x W x H mm L x W x H mm 682 x 583 x 835 682 x 178 x 1030
Weight kg 10
Overall Size L x W x H mm 710 x 660 x 950
Model GS4212
Weight kg 9
Model HI513Y
LAUNDRY TROLLEYS • Strong rigid frame supporting a re-inforced PVC sack • Unit is able to turn in its own length • Cubic capacity: 370 Litres
Max Load
250 KG
IDEAL FOR LAUNDRY SHOPS GS427H
Overall Size - Bag L x W x H mm 910 x 610 x 660
Overall Size - Frame L x W x H mm 980 x 710 x 1010
Wheels - 2 Fixed Centrally & 2 Sliding each End 200 x 50 Cushion Roller Bearing 200 x 50 Nylon
Weight kg 35
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Model GS427H GS427N
497
HEALTH & ENVIRONMENT Vacuum Cleaners HENRY & HETTY • Strong, removable Canvas sack • Chrome Plated Steel tubular frame • Base frame to support the sack • Mobile on 4 x 70mm swivelnon-marking Rubber castors • Model HI552Y folds forcompact storage
Capacity Litres
Overall Size L x W x H mm
Weight kg
9
340 x 340 x 370
6.9
Disposable Bags - Pack of 10
JAMES - ECO FRIENDLY
CHARLES
• Complete with tools • Energy Saving Hi/Lo switch 800/500 Watts of power- 230 volts • Caddy top providesspace for cable & tools • 3 Aluminium pipes • Two stage Microflo’dust bags • 8 Litre Capacity
• Complete with tools • 1200 Watts of power- 240 volts • 2 Aluminium pipes • Big filters & disposable dust bags for dry use • Safety float valve for wet use • 16 Litre Capacity - Dry • 9 Litre Capacity - Wet
HENRY HETTY 604015
Airflow
Range M
Overall Size L x W x H mm
Weight kg
Model
Airflow
Range M
Overall Size L x W x H mm
Weight kg
Model
30 l/sec
26.8
340 x 340 x 340
5.2J
AMES
40 l/sec
26.8
355 x 355 x 500
7.1
CHARLES
• WV900: 1200 Watts WVD902: 2 x 1200 Watts • Complete with tools • Structofoam container - will NOT dent or scratch • 2 year warranty • Other colours available- Call for Details
• NVQ570: 1200 Watts • NVDQ570: 2 x 1200 Watts • Complete with tools • Structofoam container - will NOT dent or scratch • 2 year warranty • Other colours available- Call for Details
Motor Single Twin
Capacity Litres
Overall Size L x W x H mm
23
415 x 415 x 615
Disposable Bags - Pack of 10
498
Model
Weight kg 12
Model
Motor
NVQ570
Single
14.5
NVDQ572 604017
Capacity Dry Wet
40 30 Twin Litres Litres
Overall Size L x W x H mm 720 x 490 x 880
Weight kg 20 22.5W
Disposable Bags - Pack of 10
For more information, visit www.loc8.ae or call toll free 800-LOC8 (5628)
Model WV900 VD902 604018
Improving your warehouse operation has never been easier!
We provide AutoCAD design services to help our clients maximise their warehousing facilities to save time, space and money. For your free consultation, call 800-LOC8 (5628)